1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @c Copyright (C) 1988-2013 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
5 @c makeinfo ignores cmds prev to setfilename, so its arg cannot make use
6 @c of @set vars. However, you can override filename with makeinfo -o.
13 @settitle Debugging with @value{GDBN}
14 @setchapternewpage odd
23 @c To avoid file-name clashes between index.html and Index.html, when
24 @c the manual is produced on a Posix host and then moved to a
25 @c case-insensitive filesystem (e.g., MS-Windows), we separate the
26 @c indices into two: Concept Index and all the rest.
30 @c readline appendices use @vindex, @findex and @ftable,
31 @c annotate.texi and gdbmi use @findex.
34 @c !!set GDB manual's edition---not the same as GDB version!
35 @c This is updated by GNU Press.
38 @c !!set GDB edit command default editor
41 @c THIS MANUAL REQUIRES TEXINFO 4.0 OR LATER.
43 @c This is a dir.info fragment to support semi-automated addition of
44 @c manuals to an info tree.
45 @dircategory Software development
47 * Gdb: (gdb). The GNU debugger.
51 @c man begin COPYRIGHT
52 Copyright @copyright{} 1988-2013 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
54 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
55 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3 or
56 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
57 Invariant Sections being ``Free Software'' and ``Free Software Needs
58 Free Documentation'', with the Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
59 and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
61 (a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You are free to copy and modify
62 this GNU Manual. Buying copies from GNU Press supports the FSF in
63 developing GNU and promoting software freedom.''
68 This file documents the @sc{gnu} debugger @value{GDBN}.
70 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, of @cite{Debugging with
71 @value{GDBN}: the @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger} for @value{GDBN}
72 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
73 @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
75 Version @value{GDBVN}.
81 @title Debugging with @value{GDBN}
82 @subtitle The @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger
84 @subtitle @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN}
85 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
87 @subtitle @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
89 @author Richard Stallman, Roland Pesch, Stan Shebs, et al.
93 \hfill (Send bugs and comments on @value{GDBN} to @value{BUGURL}.)\par
94 \hfill {\it Debugging with @value{GDBN}}\par
95 \hfill \TeX{}info \texinfoversion\par
99 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
100 Published by the Free Software Foundation @*
101 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor,
102 Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA@*
103 ISBN 978-0-9831592-3-0 @*
110 @node Top, Summary, (dir), (dir)
112 @top Debugging with @value{GDBN}
114 This file describes @value{GDBN}, the @sc{gnu} symbolic debugger.
116 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN}
117 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
118 @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
120 Version @value{GDBVN}.
122 Copyright (C) 1988-2013 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
124 This edition of the GDB manual is dedicated to the memory of Fred
125 Fish. Fred was a long-standing contributor to GDB and to Free
126 software in general. We will miss him.
129 * Summary:: Summary of @value{GDBN}
130 * Sample Session:: A sample @value{GDBN} session
132 * Invocation:: Getting in and out of @value{GDBN}
133 * Commands:: @value{GDBN} commands
134 * Running:: Running programs under @value{GDBN}
135 * Stopping:: Stopping and continuing
136 * Reverse Execution:: Running programs backward
137 * Process Record and Replay:: Recording inferior's execution and replaying it
138 * Stack:: Examining the stack
139 * Source:: Examining source files
140 * Data:: Examining data
141 * Optimized Code:: Debugging optimized code
142 * Macros:: Preprocessor Macros
143 * Tracepoints:: Debugging remote targets non-intrusively
144 * Overlays:: Debugging programs that use overlays
146 * Languages:: Using @value{GDBN} with different languages
148 * Symbols:: Examining the symbol table
149 * Altering:: Altering execution
150 * GDB Files:: @value{GDBN} files
151 * Targets:: Specifying a debugging target
152 * Remote Debugging:: Debugging remote programs
153 * Configurations:: Configuration-specific information
154 * Controlling GDB:: Controlling @value{GDBN}
155 * Extending GDB:: Extending @value{GDBN}
156 * Interpreters:: Command Interpreters
157 * TUI:: @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
158 * Emacs:: Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
159 * GDB/MI:: @value{GDBN}'s Machine Interface.
160 * Annotations:: @value{GDBN}'s annotation interface.
161 * JIT Interface:: Using the JIT debugging interface.
162 * In-Process Agent:: In-Process Agent
164 * GDB Bugs:: Reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
166 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
167 * Command Line Editing: (rluserman). Command Line Editing
168 * Using History Interactively: (history). Using History Interactively
170 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
171 * Command Line Editing:: Command Line Editing
172 * Using History Interactively:: Using History Interactively
174 * In Memoriam:: In Memoriam
175 * Formatting Documentation:: How to format and print @value{GDBN} documentation
176 * Installing GDB:: Installing GDB
177 * Maintenance Commands:: Maintenance Commands
178 * Remote Protocol:: GDB Remote Serial Protocol
179 * Agent Expressions:: The GDB Agent Expression Mechanism
180 * Target Descriptions:: How targets can describe themselves to
182 * Operating System Information:: Getting additional information from
184 * Trace File Format:: GDB trace file format
185 * Index Section Format:: .gdb_index section format
186 * Man Pages:: Manual pages
187 * Copying:: GNU General Public License says
188 how you can copy and share GDB
189 * GNU Free Documentation License:: The license for this documentation
190 * Concept Index:: Index of @value{GDBN} concepts
191 * Command and Variable Index:: Index of @value{GDBN} commands, variables,
192 functions, and Python data types
200 @unnumbered Summary of @value{GDBN}
202 The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
203 going on ``inside'' another program while it executes---or what another
204 program was doing at the moment it crashed.
206 @value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
207 these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
211 Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
214 Make your program stop on specified conditions.
217 Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
220 Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
221 effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
224 You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C and C@t{++}.
225 For more information, see @ref{Supported Languages,,Supported Languages}.
226 For more information, see @ref{C,,C and C++}.
228 Support for D is partial. For information on D, see
232 Support for Modula-2 is partial. For information on Modula-2, see
233 @ref{Modula-2,,Modula-2}.
235 Support for OpenCL C is partial. For information on OpenCL C, see
236 @ref{OpenCL C,,OpenCL C}.
239 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
240 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
241 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
245 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, although
246 it may be necessary to refer to some variables with a trailing
249 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Objective-C,
250 using either the Apple/NeXT or the GNU Objective-C runtime.
253 * Free Software:: Freely redistributable software
254 * Free Documentation:: Free Software Needs Free Documentation
255 * Contributors:: Contributors to GDB
259 @unnumberedsec Free Software
261 @value{GDBN} is @dfn{free software}, protected by the @sc{gnu}
262 General Public License
263 (GPL). The GPL gives you the freedom to copy or adapt a licensed
264 program---but every person getting a copy also gets with it the
265 freedom to modify that copy (which means that they must get access to
266 the source code), and the freedom to distribute further copies.
267 Typical software companies use copyrights to limit your freedoms; the
268 Free Software Foundation uses the GPL to preserve these freedoms.
270 Fundamentally, the General Public License is a license which says that
271 you have these freedoms and that you cannot take these freedoms away
274 @node Free Documentation
275 @unnumberedsec Free Software Needs Free Documentation
277 The biggest deficiency in the free software community today is not in
278 the software---it is the lack of good free documentation that we can
279 include with the free software. Many of our most important
280 programs do not come with free reference manuals and free introductory
281 texts. Documentation is an essential part of any software package;
282 when an important free software package does not come with a free
283 manual and a free tutorial, that is a major gap. We have many such
286 Consider Perl, for instance. The tutorial manuals that people
287 normally use are non-free. How did this come about? Because the
288 authors of those manuals published them with restrictive terms---no
289 copying, no modification, source files not available---which exclude
290 them from the free software world.
292 That wasn't the first time this sort of thing happened, and it was far
293 from the last. Many times we have heard a GNU user eagerly describe a
294 manual that he is writing, his intended contribution to the community,
295 only to learn that he had ruined everything by signing a publication
296 contract to make it non-free.
298 Free documentation, like free software, is a matter of freedom, not
299 price. The problem with the non-free manual is not that publishers
300 charge a price for printed copies---that in itself is fine. (The Free
301 Software Foundation sells printed copies of manuals, too.) The
302 problem is the restrictions on the use of the manual. Free manuals
303 are available in source code form, and give you permission to copy and
304 modify. Non-free manuals do not allow this.
306 The criteria of freedom for a free manual are roughly the same as for
307 free software. Redistribution (including the normal kinds of
308 commercial redistribution) must be permitted, so that the manual can
309 accompany every copy of the program, both on-line and on paper.
311 Permission for modification of the technical content is crucial too.
312 When people modify the software, adding or changing features, if they
313 are conscientious they will change the manual too---so they can
314 provide accurate and clear documentation for the modified program. A
315 manual that leaves you no choice but to write a new manual to document
316 a changed version of the program is not really available to our
319 Some kinds of limits on the way modification is handled are
320 acceptable. For example, requirements to preserve the original
321 author's copyright notice, the distribution terms, or the list of
322 authors, are ok. It is also no problem to require modified versions
323 to include notice that they were modified. Even entire sections that
324 may not be deleted or changed are acceptable, as long as they deal
325 with nontechnical topics (like this one). These kinds of restrictions
326 are acceptable because they don't obstruct the community's normal use
329 However, it must be possible to modify all the @emph{technical}
330 content of the manual, and then distribute the result in all the usual
331 media, through all the usual channels. Otherwise, the restrictions
332 obstruct the use of the manual, it is not free, and we need another
333 manual to replace it.
335 Please spread the word about this issue. Our community continues to
336 lose manuals to proprietary publishing. If we spread the word that
337 free software needs free reference manuals and free tutorials, perhaps
338 the next person who wants to contribute by writing documentation will
339 realize, before it is too late, that only free manuals contribute to
340 the free software community.
342 If you are writing documentation, please insist on publishing it under
343 the GNU Free Documentation License or another free documentation
344 license. Remember that this decision requires your approval---you
345 don't have to let the publisher decide. Some commercial publishers
346 will use a free license if you insist, but they will not propose the
347 option; it is up to you to raise the issue and say firmly that this is
348 what you want. If the publisher you are dealing with refuses, please
349 try other publishers. If you're not sure whether a proposed license
350 is free, write to @email{licensing@@gnu.org}.
352 You can encourage commercial publishers to sell more free, copylefted
353 manuals and tutorials by buying them, and particularly by buying
354 copies from the publishers that paid for their writing or for major
355 improvements. Meanwhile, try to avoid buying non-free documentation
356 at all. Check the distribution terms of a manual before you buy it,
357 and insist that whoever seeks your business must respect your freedom.
358 Check the history of the book, and try to reward the publishers that
359 have paid or pay the authors to work on it.
361 The Free Software Foundation maintains a list of free documentation
362 published by other publishers, at
363 @url{http://www.fsf.org/doc/other-free-books.html}.
366 @unnumberedsec Contributors to @value{GDBN}
368 Richard Stallman was the original author of @value{GDBN}, and of many
369 other @sc{gnu} programs. Many others have contributed to its
370 development. This section attempts to credit major contributors. One
371 of the virtues of free software is that everyone is free to contribute
372 to it; with regret, we cannot actually acknowledge everyone here. The
373 file @file{ChangeLog} in the @value{GDBN} distribution approximates a
374 blow-by-blow account.
376 Changes much prior to version 2.0 are lost in the mists of time.
379 @emph{Plea:} Additions to this section are particularly welcome. If you
380 or your friends (or enemies, to be evenhanded) have been unfairly
381 omitted from this list, we would like to add your names!
384 So that they may not regard their many labors as thankless, we
385 particularly thank those who shepherded @value{GDBN} through major
387 Andrew Cagney (releases 6.3, 6.2, 6.1, 6.0, 5.3, 5.2, 5.1 and 5.0);
388 Jim Blandy (release 4.18);
389 Jason Molenda (release 4.17);
390 Stan Shebs (release 4.14);
391 Fred Fish (releases 4.16, 4.15, 4.13, 4.12, 4.11, 4.10, and 4.9);
392 Stu Grossman and John Gilmore (releases 4.8, 4.7, 4.6, 4.5, and 4.4);
393 John Gilmore (releases 4.3, 4.2, 4.1, 4.0, and 3.9);
394 Jim Kingdon (releases 3.5, 3.4, and 3.3);
395 and Randy Smith (releases 3.2, 3.1, and 3.0).
397 Richard Stallman, assisted at various times by Peter TerMaat, Chris
398 Hanson, and Richard Mlynarik, handled releases through 2.8.
400 Michael Tiemann is the author of most of the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} support
401 in @value{GDBN}, with significant additional contributions from Per
402 Bothner and Daniel Berlin. James Clark wrote the @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
403 demangler. Early work on C@t{++} was by Peter TerMaat (who also did
404 much general update work leading to release 3.0).
406 @value{GDBN} uses the BFD subroutine library to examine multiple
407 object-file formats; BFD was a joint project of David V.
408 Henkel-Wallace, Rich Pixley, Steve Chamberlain, and John Gilmore.
410 David Johnson wrote the original COFF support; Pace Willison did
411 the original support for encapsulated COFF.
413 Brent Benson of Harris Computer Systems contributed DWARF 2 support.
415 Adam de Boor and Bradley Davis contributed the ISI Optimum V support.
416 Per Bothner, Noboyuki Hikichi, and Alessandro Forin contributed MIPS
418 Jean-Daniel Fekete contributed Sun 386i support.
419 Chris Hanson improved the HP9000 support.
420 Noboyuki Hikichi and Tomoyuki Hasei contributed Sony/News OS 3 support.
421 David Johnson contributed Encore Umax support.
422 Jyrki Kuoppala contributed Altos 3068 support.
423 Jeff Law contributed HP PA and SOM support.
424 Keith Packard contributed NS32K support.
425 Doug Rabson contributed Acorn Risc Machine support.
426 Bob Rusk contributed Harris Nighthawk CX-UX support.
427 Chris Smith contributed Convex support (and Fortran debugging).
428 Jonathan Stone contributed Pyramid support.
429 Michael Tiemann contributed SPARC support.
430 Tim Tucker contributed support for the Gould NP1 and Gould Powernode.
431 Pace Willison contributed Intel 386 support.
432 Jay Vosburgh contributed Symmetry support.
433 Marko Mlinar contributed OpenRISC 1000 support.
435 Andreas Schwab contributed M68K @sc{gnu}/Linux support.
437 Rich Schaefer and Peter Schauer helped with support of SunOS shared
440 Jay Fenlason and Roland McGrath ensured that @value{GDBN} and GAS agree
441 about several machine instruction sets.
443 Patrick Duval, Ted Goldstein, Vikram Koka and Glenn Engel helped develop
444 remote debugging. Intel Corporation, Wind River Systems, AMD, and ARM
445 contributed remote debugging modules for the i960, VxWorks, A29K UDI,
446 and RDI targets, respectively.
448 Brian Fox is the author of the readline libraries providing
449 command-line editing and command history.
451 Andrew Beers of SUNY Buffalo wrote the language-switching code, the
452 Modula-2 support, and contributed the Languages chapter of this manual.
454 Fred Fish wrote most of the support for Unix System Vr4.
455 He also enhanced the command-completion support to cover C@t{++} overloaded
458 Hitachi America (now Renesas America), Ltd. sponsored the support for
459 H8/300, H8/500, and Super-H processors.
461 NEC sponsored the support for the v850, Vr4xxx, and Vr5xxx processors.
463 Mitsubishi (now Renesas) sponsored the support for D10V, D30V, and M32R/D
466 Toshiba sponsored the support for the TX39 Mips processor.
468 Matsushita sponsored the support for the MN10200 and MN10300 processors.
470 Fujitsu sponsored the support for SPARClite and FR30 processors.
472 Kung Hsu, Jeff Law, and Rick Sladkey added support for hardware
475 Michael Snyder added support for tracepoints.
477 Stu Grossman wrote gdbserver.
479 Jim Kingdon, Peter Schauer, Ian Taylor, and Stu Grossman made
480 nearly innumerable bug fixes and cleanups throughout @value{GDBN}.
482 The following people at the Hewlett-Packard Company contributed
483 support for the PA-RISC 2.0 architecture, HP-UX 10.20, 10.30, and 11.0
484 (narrow mode), HP's implementation of kernel threads, HP's aC@t{++}
485 compiler, and the Text User Interface (nee Terminal User Interface):
486 Ben Krepp, Richard Title, John Bishop, Susan Macchia, Kathy Mann,
487 Satish Pai, India Paul, Steve Rehrauer, and Elena Zannoni. Kim Haase
488 provided HP-specific information in this manual.
490 DJ Delorie ported @value{GDBN} to MS-DOS, for the DJGPP project.
491 Robert Hoehne made significant contributions to the DJGPP port.
493 Cygnus Solutions has sponsored @value{GDBN} maintenance and much of its
494 development since 1991. Cygnus engineers who have worked on @value{GDBN}
495 fulltime include Mark Alexander, Jim Blandy, Per Bothner, Kevin
496 Buettner, Edith Epstein, Chris Faylor, Fred Fish, Martin Hunt, Jim
497 Ingham, John Gilmore, Stu Grossman, Kung Hsu, Jim Kingdon, John Metzler,
498 Fernando Nasser, Geoffrey Noer, Dawn Perchik, Rich Pixley, Zdenek
499 Radouch, Keith Seitz, Stan Shebs, David Taylor, and Elena Zannoni. In
500 addition, Dave Brolley, Ian Carmichael, Steve Chamberlain, Nick Clifton,
501 JT Conklin, Stan Cox, DJ Delorie, Ulrich Drepper, Frank Eigler, Doug
502 Evans, Sean Fagan, David Henkel-Wallace, Richard Henderson, Jeff
503 Holcomb, Jeff Law, Jim Lemke, Tom Lord, Bob Manson, Michael Meissner,
504 Jason Merrill, Catherine Moore, Drew Moseley, Ken Raeburn, Gavin
505 Romig-Koch, Rob Savoye, Jamie Smith, Mike Stump, Ian Taylor, Angela
506 Thomas, Michael Tiemann, Tom Tromey, Ron Unrau, Jim Wilson, and David
507 Zuhn have made contributions both large and small.
509 Andrew Cagney, Fernando Nasser, and Elena Zannoni, while working for
510 Cygnus Solutions, implemented the original @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
512 Jim Blandy added support for preprocessor macros, while working for Red
515 Andrew Cagney designed @value{GDBN}'s architecture vector. Many
516 people including Andrew Cagney, Stephane Carrez, Randolph Chung, Nick
517 Duffek, Richard Henderson, Mark Kettenis, Grace Sainsbury, Kei
518 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Andreas Schwab, Jason
519 Thorpe, Corinna Vinschen, Ulrich Weigand, and Elena Zannoni, helped
520 with the migration of old architectures to this new framework.
522 Andrew Cagney completely re-designed and re-implemented @value{GDBN}'s
523 unwinder framework, this consisting of a fresh new design featuring
524 frame IDs, independent frame sniffers, and the sentinel frame. Mark
525 Kettenis implemented the @sc{dwarf 2} unwinder, Jeff Johnston the
526 libunwind unwinder, and Andrew Cagney the dummy, sentinel, tramp, and
527 trad unwinders. The architecture-specific changes, each involving a
528 complete rewrite of the architecture's frame code, were carried out by
529 Jim Blandy, Joel Brobecker, Kevin Buettner, Andrew Cagney, Stephane
530 Carrez, Randolph Chung, Orjan Friberg, Richard Henderson, Daniel
531 Jacobowitz, Jeff Johnston, Mark Kettenis, Theodore A. Roth, Kei
532 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Corinna Vinschen, and Ulrich
535 Christian Zankel, Ross Morley, Bob Wilson, and Maxim Grigoriev from
536 Tensilica, Inc.@: contributed support for Xtensa processors. Others
537 who have worked on the Xtensa port of @value{GDBN} in the past include
538 Steve Tjiang, John Newlin, and Scott Foehner.
540 Michael Eager and staff of Xilinx, Inc., contributed support for the
541 Xilinx MicroBlaze architecture.
544 @chapter A Sample @value{GDBN} Session
546 You can use this manual at your leisure to read all about @value{GDBN}.
547 However, a handful of commands are enough to get started using the
548 debugger. This chapter illustrates those commands.
551 In this sample session, we emphasize user input like this: @b{input},
552 to make it easier to pick out from the surrounding output.
555 @c FIXME: this example may not be appropriate for some configs, where
556 @c FIXME...primary interest is in remote use.
558 One of the preliminary versions of @sc{gnu} @code{m4} (a generic macro
559 processor) exhibits the following bug: sometimes, when we change its
560 quote strings from the default, the commands used to capture one macro
561 definition within another stop working. In the following short @code{m4}
562 session, we define a macro @code{foo} which expands to @code{0000}; we
563 then use the @code{m4} built-in @code{defn} to define @code{bar} as the
564 same thing. However, when we change the open quote string to
565 @code{<QUOTE>} and the close quote string to @code{<UNQUOTE>}, the same
566 procedure fails to define a new synonym @code{baz}:
575 @b{define(bar,defn(`foo'))}
579 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
581 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
584 m4: End of input: 0: fatal error: EOF in string
588 Let us use @value{GDBN} to try to see what is going on.
591 $ @b{@value{GDBP} m4}
592 @c FIXME: this falsifies the exact text played out, to permit smallbook
593 @c FIXME... format to come out better.
594 @value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
595 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
597 There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
600 @value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
605 @value{GDBN} reads only enough symbol data to know where to find the
606 rest when needed; as a result, the first prompt comes up very quickly.
607 We now tell @value{GDBN} to use a narrower display width than usual, so
608 that examples fit in this manual.
611 (@value{GDBP}) @b{set width 70}
615 We need to see how the @code{m4} built-in @code{changequote} works.
616 Having looked at the source, we know the relevant subroutine is
617 @code{m4_changequote}, so we set a breakpoint there with the @value{GDBN}
618 @code{break} command.
621 (@value{GDBP}) @b{break m4_changequote}
622 Breakpoint 1 at 0x62f4: file builtin.c, line 879.
626 Using the @code{run} command, we start @code{m4} running under @value{GDBN}
627 control; as long as control does not reach the @code{m4_changequote}
628 subroutine, the program runs as usual:
631 (@value{GDBP}) @b{run}
632 Starting program: /work/Editorial/gdb/gnu/m4/m4
640 To trigger the breakpoint, we call @code{changequote}. @value{GDBN}
641 suspends execution of @code{m4}, displaying information about the
642 context where it stops.
645 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
647 Breakpoint 1, m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
649 879 if (bad_argc(TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[0]),argc,1,3))
653 Now we use the command @code{n} (@code{next}) to advance execution to
654 the next line of the current function.
658 882 set_quotes((argc >= 2) ? TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[1])\
663 @code{set_quotes} looks like a promising subroutine. We can go into it
664 by using the command @code{s} (@code{step}) instead of @code{next}.
665 @code{step} goes to the next line to be executed in @emph{any}
666 subroutine, so it steps into @code{set_quotes}.
670 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
672 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
676 The display that shows the subroutine where @code{m4} is now
677 suspended (and its arguments) is called a stack frame display. It
678 shows a summary of the stack. We can use the @code{backtrace}
679 command (which can also be spelled @code{bt}), to see where we are
680 in the stack as a whole: the @code{backtrace} command displays a
681 stack frame for each active subroutine.
684 (@value{GDBP}) @b{bt}
685 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
687 #1 0x6344 in m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
689 #2 0x8174 in expand_macro (sym=0x33320) at macro.c:242
690 #3 0x7a88 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=209696, td=0xf7fffa30)
692 #4 0x79dc in expand_input () at macro.c:40
693 #5 0x2930 in main (argc=0, argv=0xf7fffb20) at m4.c:195
697 We step through a few more lines to see what happens. The first two
698 times, we can use @samp{s}; the next two times we use @code{n} to avoid
699 falling into the @code{xstrdup} subroutine.
703 0x3b5c 532 if (rquote != def_rquote)
705 0x3b80 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? \
706 def_lquote : xstrdup(lq);
708 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
711 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
715 The last line displayed looks a little odd; we can examine the variables
716 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} to see if they are in fact the new left
717 and right quotes we specified. We use the command @code{p}
718 (@code{print}) to see their values.
721 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p lquote}
722 $1 = 0x35d40 "<QUOTE>"
723 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p rquote}
724 $2 = 0x35d50 "<UNQUOTE>"
728 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} are indeed the new left and right quotes.
729 To look at some context, we can display ten lines of source
730 surrounding the current line with the @code{l} (@code{list}) command.
736 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? def_lquote\
738 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
741 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
742 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
749 Let us step past the two lines that set @code{len_lquote} and
750 @code{len_rquote}, and then examine the values of those variables.
754 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
757 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote}
759 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote}
764 That certainly looks wrong, assuming @code{len_lquote} and
765 @code{len_rquote} are meant to be the lengths of @code{lquote} and
766 @code{rquote} respectively. We can set them to better values using
767 the @code{p} command, since it can print the value of
768 any expression---and that expression can include subroutine calls and
772 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote=strlen(lquote)}
774 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote=strlen(rquote)}
779 Is that enough to fix the problem of using the new quotes with the
780 @code{m4} built-in @code{defn}? We can allow @code{m4} to continue
781 executing with the @code{c} (@code{continue}) command, and then try the
782 example that caused trouble initially:
788 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
795 Success! The new quotes now work just as well as the default ones. The
796 problem seems to have been just the two typos defining the wrong
797 lengths. We allow @code{m4} exit by giving it an EOF as input:
801 Program exited normally.
805 The message @samp{Program exited normally.} is from @value{GDBN}; it
806 indicates @code{m4} has finished executing. We can end our @value{GDBN}
807 session with the @value{GDBN} @code{quit} command.
810 (@value{GDBP}) @b{quit}
814 @chapter Getting In and Out of @value{GDBN}
816 This chapter discusses how to start @value{GDBN}, and how to get out of it.
820 type @samp{@value{GDBP}} to start @value{GDBN}.
822 type @kbd{quit} or @kbd{Ctrl-d} to exit.
826 * Invoking GDB:: How to start @value{GDBN}
827 * Quitting GDB:: How to quit @value{GDBN}
828 * Shell Commands:: How to use shell commands inside @value{GDBN}
829 * Logging Output:: How to log @value{GDBN}'s output to a file
833 @section Invoking @value{GDBN}
835 Invoke @value{GDBN} by running the program @code{@value{GDBP}}. Once started,
836 @value{GDBN} reads commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit.
838 You can also run @code{@value{GDBP}} with a variety of arguments and options,
839 to specify more of your debugging environment at the outset.
841 The command-line options described here are designed
842 to cover a variety of situations; in some environments, some of these
843 options may effectively be unavailable.
845 The most usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument,
846 specifying an executable program:
849 @value{GDBP} @var{program}
853 You can also start with both an executable program and a core file
857 @value{GDBP} @var{program} @var{core}
860 You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
861 to debug a running process:
864 @value{GDBP} @var{program} 1234
868 would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
869 named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
871 Taking advantage of the second command-line argument requires a fairly
872 complete operating system; when you use @value{GDBN} as a remote
873 debugger attached to a bare board, there may not be any notion of
874 ``process'', and there is often no way to get a core dump. @value{GDBN}
875 will warn you if it is unable to attach or to read core dumps.
877 You can optionally have @code{@value{GDBP}} pass any arguments after the
878 executable file to the inferior using @code{--args}. This option stops
881 @value{GDBP} --args gcc -O2 -c foo.c
883 This will cause @code{@value{GDBP}} to debug @code{gcc}, and to set
884 @code{gcc}'s command-line arguments (@pxref{Arguments}) to @samp{-O2 -c foo.c}.
886 You can run @code{@value{GDBP}} without printing the front material, which describes
887 @value{GDBN}'s non-warranty, by specifying @code{-silent}:
894 You can further control how @value{GDBN} starts up by using command-line
895 options. @value{GDBN} itself can remind you of the options available.
905 to display all available options and briefly describe their use
906 (@samp{@value{GDBP} -h} is a shorter equivalent).
908 All options and command line arguments you give are processed
909 in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the
910 @samp{-x} option is used.
914 * File Options:: Choosing files
915 * Mode Options:: Choosing modes
916 * Startup:: What @value{GDBN} does during startup
920 @subsection Choosing Files
922 When @value{GDBN} starts, it reads any arguments other than options as
923 specifying an executable file and core file (or process ID). This is
924 the same as if the arguments were specified by the @samp{-se} and
925 @samp{-c} (or @samp{-p}) options respectively. (@value{GDBN} reads the
926 first argument that does not have an associated option flag as
927 equivalent to the @samp{-se} option followed by that argument; and the
928 second argument that does not have an associated option flag, if any, as
929 equivalent to the @samp{-c}/@samp{-p} option followed by that argument.)
930 If the second argument begins with a decimal digit, @value{GDBN} will
931 first attempt to attach to it as a process, and if that fails, attempt
932 to open it as a corefile. If you have a corefile whose name begins with
933 a digit, you can prevent @value{GDBN} from treating it as a pid by
934 prefixing it with @file{./}, e.g.@: @file{./12345}.
936 If @value{GDBN} has not been configured to included core file support,
937 such as for most embedded targets, then it will complain about a second
938 argument and ignore it.
940 Many options have both long and short forms; both are shown in the
941 following list. @value{GDBN} also recognizes the long forms if you truncate
942 them, so long as enough of the option is present to be unambiguous.
943 (If you prefer, you can flag option arguments with @samp{--} rather
944 than @samp{-}, though we illustrate the more usual convention.)
946 @c NOTE: the @cindex entries here use double dashes ON PURPOSE. This
947 @c way, both those who look for -foo and --foo in the index, will find
951 @item -symbols @var{file}
953 @cindex @code{--symbols}
955 Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
957 @item -exec @var{file}
959 @cindex @code{--exec}
961 Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when appropriate,
962 and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core dump.
966 Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
969 @item -core @var{file}
971 @cindex @code{--core}
973 Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
975 @item -pid @var{number}
976 @itemx -p @var{number}
979 Connect to process ID @var{number}, as with the @code{attach} command.
981 @item -command @var{file}
983 @cindex @code{--command}
985 Execute commands from file @var{file}. The contents of this file is
986 evaluated exactly as the @code{source} command would.
987 @xref{Command Files,, Command files}.
989 @item -eval-command @var{command}
990 @itemx -ex @var{command}
991 @cindex @code{--eval-command}
993 Execute a single @value{GDBN} command.
995 This option may be used multiple times to call multiple commands. It may
996 also be interleaved with @samp{-command} as required.
999 @value{GDBP} -ex 'target sim' -ex 'load' \
1000 -x setbreakpoints -ex 'run' a.out
1003 @item -init-command @var{file}
1004 @itemx -ix @var{file}
1005 @cindex @code{--init-command}
1007 Execute commands from file @var{file} before loading the inferior (but
1008 after loading gdbinit files).
1011 @item -init-eval-command @var{command}
1012 @itemx -iex @var{command}
1013 @cindex @code{--init-eval-command}
1015 Execute a single @value{GDBN} command before loading the inferior (but
1016 after loading gdbinit files).
1019 @item -directory @var{directory}
1020 @itemx -d @var{directory}
1021 @cindex @code{--directory}
1023 Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source and script files.
1027 @cindex @code{--readnow}
1029 Read each symbol file's entire symbol table immediately, rather than
1030 the default, which is to read it incrementally as it is needed.
1031 This makes startup slower, but makes future operations faster.
1036 @subsection Choosing Modes
1038 You can run @value{GDBN} in various alternative modes---for example, in
1039 batch mode or quiet mode.
1047 Do not execute commands found in any initialization file.
1048 There are three init files, loaded in the following order:
1051 @item @file{system.gdbinit}
1052 This is the system-wide init file.
1053 Its location is specified with the @code{--with-system-gdbinit}
1054 configure option (@pxref{System-wide configuration}).
1055 It is loaded first when @value{GDBN} starts, before command line options
1056 have been processed.
1057 @item @file{~/.gdbinit}
1058 This is the init file in your home directory.
1059 It is loaded next, after @file{system.gdbinit}, and before
1060 command options have been processed.
1061 @item @file{./.gdbinit}
1062 This is the init file in the current directory.
1063 It is loaded last, after command line options other than @code{-x} and
1064 @code{-ex} have been processed. Command line options @code{-x} and
1065 @code{-ex} are processed last, after @file{./.gdbinit} has been loaded.
1068 For further documentation on startup processing, @xref{Startup}.
1069 For documentation on how to write command files,
1070 @xref{Command Files,,Command Files}.
1075 Do not execute commands found in @file{~/.gdbinit}, the init file
1076 in your home directory.
1082 @cindex @code{--quiet}
1083 @cindex @code{--silent}
1085 ``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
1086 messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
1089 @cindex @code{--batch}
1090 Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the
1091 command files specified with @samp{-x} (and all commands from
1092 initialization files, if not inhibited with @samp{-n}). Exit with
1093 nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN} commands
1094 in the command files. Batch mode also disables pagination, sets unlimited
1095 terminal width and height @pxref{Screen Size}, and acts as if @kbd{set confirm
1096 off} were in effect (@pxref{Messages/Warnings}).
1098 Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for
1099 example to download and run a program on another computer; in order to
1100 make this more useful, the message
1103 Program exited normally.
1107 (which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under
1108 @value{GDBN} control terminates) is not issued when running in batch
1112 @cindex @code{--batch-silent}
1113 Run in batch mode exactly like @samp{-batch}, but totally silently. All
1114 @value{GDBN} output to @code{stdout} is prevented (@code{stderr} is
1115 unaffected). This is much quieter than @samp{-silent} and would be useless
1116 for an interactive session.
1118 This is particularly useful when using targets that give @samp{Loading section}
1119 messages, for example.
1121 Note that targets that give their output via @value{GDBN}, as opposed to
1122 writing directly to @code{stdout}, will also be made silent.
1124 @item -return-child-result
1125 @cindex @code{--return-child-result}
1126 The return code from @value{GDBN} will be the return code from the child
1127 process (the process being debugged), with the following exceptions:
1131 @value{GDBN} exits abnormally. E.g., due to an incorrect argument or an
1132 internal error. In this case the exit code is the same as it would have been
1133 without @samp{-return-child-result}.
1135 The user quits with an explicit value. E.g., @samp{quit 1}.
1137 The child process never runs, or is not allowed to terminate, in which case
1138 the exit code will be -1.
1141 This option is useful in conjunction with @samp{-batch} or @samp{-batch-silent},
1142 when @value{GDBN} is being used as a remote program loader or simulator
1147 @cindex @code{--nowindows}
1149 ``No windows''. If @value{GDBN} comes with a graphical user interface
1150 (GUI) built in, then this option tells @value{GDBN} to only use the command-line
1151 interface. If no GUI is available, this option has no effect.
1155 @cindex @code{--windows}
1157 If @value{GDBN} includes a GUI, then this option requires it to be
1160 @item -cd @var{directory}
1162 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
1163 instead of the current directory.
1165 @item -data-directory @var{directory}
1166 @cindex @code{--data-directory}
1167 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its data directory.
1168 The data directory is where @value{GDBN} searches for its
1169 auxiliary files. @xref{Data Files}.
1173 @cindex @code{--fullname}
1175 @sc{gnu} Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a
1176 subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line
1177 number in a standard, recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is
1178 displayed (which includes each time your program stops). This
1179 recognizable format looks like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by
1180 the file name, line number and character position separated by colons,
1181 and a newline. The Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two
1182 @samp{\032} characters as a signal to display the source code for the
1185 @item -annotate @var{level}
1186 @cindex @code{--annotate}
1187 This option sets the @dfn{annotation level} inside @value{GDBN}. Its
1188 effect is identical to using @samp{set annotate @var{level}}
1189 (@pxref{Annotations}). The annotation @var{level} controls how much
1190 information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt, values of
1191 expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0 is the
1192 normal, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a subprocess of
1193 @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable for programs
1194 that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 has been deprecated.
1196 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
1200 @cindex @code{--args}
1201 Change interpretation of command line so that arguments following the
1202 executable file are passed as command line arguments to the inferior.
1203 This option stops option processing.
1205 @item -baud @var{bps}
1207 @cindex @code{--baud}
1209 Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
1210 interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
1212 @item -l @var{timeout}
1214 Set the timeout (in seconds) of any communication used by @value{GDBN}
1215 for remote debugging.
1217 @item -tty @var{device}
1218 @itemx -t @var{device}
1219 @cindex @code{--tty}
1221 Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
1222 @c FIXME: kingdon thinks there is more to -tty. Investigate.
1224 @c resolve the situation of these eventually
1226 @cindex @code{--tui}
1227 Activate the @dfn{Text User Interface} when starting. The Text User
1228 Interface manages several text windows on the terminal, showing
1229 source, assembly, registers and @value{GDBN} command outputs
1230 (@pxref{TUI, ,@value{GDBN} Text User Interface}). Do not use this
1231 option if you run @value{GDBN} from Emacs (@pxref{Emacs, ,
1232 Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}).
1235 @c @cindex @code{--xdb}
1236 @c Run in XDB compatibility mode, allowing the use of certain XDB commands.
1237 @c For information, see the file @file{xdb_trans.html}, which is usually
1238 @c installed in the directory @code{/opt/langtools/wdb/doc} on HP-UX
1241 @item -interpreter @var{interp}
1242 @cindex @code{--interpreter}
1243 Use the interpreter @var{interp} for interface with the controlling
1244 program or device. This option is meant to be set by programs which
1245 communicate with @value{GDBN} using it as a back end.
1246 @xref{Interpreters, , Command Interpreters}.
1248 @samp{--interpreter=mi} (or @samp{--interpreter=mi2}) causes
1249 @value{GDBN} to use the @dfn{@sc{gdb/mi} interface} (@pxref{GDB/MI, ,
1250 The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}) included since @value{GDBN} version 6.0. The
1251 previous @sc{gdb/mi} interface, included in @value{GDBN} version 5.3 and
1252 selected with @samp{--interpreter=mi1}, is deprecated. Earlier
1253 @sc{gdb/mi} interfaces are no longer supported.
1256 @cindex @code{--write}
1257 Open the executable and core files for both reading and writing. This
1258 is equivalent to the @samp{set write on} command inside @value{GDBN}
1262 @cindex @code{--statistics}
1263 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print statistics about time and
1264 memory usage after it completes each command and returns to the prompt.
1267 @cindex @code{--version}
1268 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print its version number and
1269 no-warranty blurb, and exit.
1271 @item -configuration
1272 @cindex @code{--configuration}
1273 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print details about its build-time
1274 configuration parameters, and then exit. These details can be
1275 important when reporting @value{GDBN} bugs (@pxref{GDB Bugs}).
1280 @subsection What @value{GDBN} Does During Startup
1281 @cindex @value{GDBN} startup
1283 Here's the description of what @value{GDBN} does during session startup:
1287 Sets up the command interpreter as specified by the command line
1288 (@pxref{Mode Options, interpreter}).
1292 Reads the system-wide @dfn{init file} (if @option{--with-system-gdbinit} was
1293 used when building @value{GDBN}; @pxref{System-wide configuration,
1294 ,System-wide configuration and settings}) and executes all the commands in
1297 @anchor{Home Directory Init File}
1299 Reads the init file (if any) in your home directory@footnote{On
1300 DOS/Windows systems, the home directory is the one pointed to by the
1301 @code{HOME} environment variable.} and executes all the commands in
1304 @anchor{Option -init-eval-command}
1306 Executes commands and command files specified by the @samp{-iex} and
1307 @samp{-ix} options in their specified order. Usually you should use the
1308 @samp{-ex} and @samp{-x} options instead, but this way you can apply
1309 settings before @value{GDBN} init files get executed and before inferior
1313 Processes command line options and operands.
1315 @anchor{Init File in the Current Directory during Startup}
1317 Reads and executes the commands from init file (if any) in the current
1318 working directory as long as @samp{set auto-load local-gdbinit} is set to
1319 @samp{on} (@pxref{Init File in the Current Directory}).
1320 This is only done if the current directory is
1321 different from your home directory. Thus, you can have more than one
1322 init file, one generic in your home directory, and another, specific
1323 to the program you are debugging, in the directory where you invoke
1327 If the command line specified a program to debug, or a process to
1328 attach to, or a core file, @value{GDBN} loads any auto-loaded
1329 scripts provided for the program or for its loaded shared libraries.
1330 @xref{Auto-loading}.
1332 If you wish to disable the auto-loading during startup,
1333 you must do something like the following:
1336 $ gdb -iex "set auto-load python-scripts off" myprogram
1339 Option @samp{-ex} does not work because the auto-loading is then turned
1343 Executes commands and command files specified by the @samp{-ex} and
1344 @samp{-x} options in their specified order. @xref{Command Files}, for
1345 more details about @value{GDBN} command files.
1348 Reads the command history recorded in the @dfn{history file}.
1349 @xref{Command History}, for more details about the command history and the
1350 files where @value{GDBN} records it.
1353 Init files use the same syntax as @dfn{command files} (@pxref{Command
1354 Files}) and are processed by @value{GDBN} in the same way. The init
1355 file in your home directory can set options (such as @samp{set
1356 complaints}) that affect subsequent processing of command line options
1357 and operands. Init files are not executed if you use the @samp{-nx}
1358 option (@pxref{Mode Options, ,Choosing Modes}).
1360 To display the list of init files loaded by gdb at startup, you
1361 can use @kbd{gdb --help}.
1363 @cindex init file name
1364 @cindex @file{.gdbinit}
1365 @cindex @file{gdb.ini}
1366 The @value{GDBN} init files are normally called @file{.gdbinit}.
1367 The DJGPP port of @value{GDBN} uses the name @file{gdb.ini}, due to
1368 the limitations of file names imposed by DOS filesystems. The Windows
1369 port of @value{GDBN} uses the standard name, but if it finds a
1370 @file{gdb.ini} file in your home directory, it warns you about that
1371 and suggests to rename the file to the standard name.
1375 @section Quitting @value{GDBN}
1376 @cindex exiting @value{GDBN}
1377 @cindex leaving @value{GDBN}
1380 @kindex quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1381 @kindex q @r{(@code{quit})}
1382 @item quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1384 To exit @value{GDBN}, use the @code{quit} command (abbreviated
1385 @code{q}), or type an end-of-file character (usually @kbd{Ctrl-d}). If you
1386 do not supply @var{expression}, @value{GDBN} will terminate normally;
1387 otherwise it will terminate using the result of @var{expression} as the
1392 An interrupt (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}) does not exit from @value{GDBN}, but rather
1393 terminates the action of any @value{GDBN} command that is in progress and
1394 returns to @value{GDBN} command level. It is safe to type the interrupt
1395 character at any time because @value{GDBN} does not allow it to take effect
1396 until a time when it is safe.
1398 If you have been using @value{GDBN} to control an attached process or
1399 device, you can release it with the @code{detach} command
1400 (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running Process}).
1402 @node Shell Commands
1403 @section Shell Commands
1405 If you need to execute occasional shell commands during your
1406 debugging session, there is no need to leave or suspend @value{GDBN}; you can
1407 just use the @code{shell} command.
1412 @cindex shell escape
1413 @item shell @var{command-string}
1414 @itemx !@var{command-string}
1415 Invoke a standard shell to execute @var{command-string}.
1416 Note that no space is needed between @code{!} and @var{command-string}.
1417 If it exists, the environment variable @code{SHELL} determines which
1418 shell to run. Otherwise @value{GDBN} uses the default shell
1419 (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix systems, @file{COMMAND.COM} on MS-DOS, etc.).
1422 The utility @code{make} is often needed in development environments.
1423 You do not have to use the @code{shell} command for this purpose in
1428 @cindex calling make
1429 @item make @var{make-args}
1430 Execute the @code{make} program with the specified
1431 arguments. This is equivalent to @samp{shell make @var{make-args}}.
1434 @node Logging Output
1435 @section Logging Output
1436 @cindex logging @value{GDBN} output
1437 @cindex save @value{GDBN} output to a file
1439 You may want to save the output of @value{GDBN} commands to a file.
1440 There are several commands to control @value{GDBN}'s logging.
1444 @item set logging on
1446 @item set logging off
1448 @cindex logging file name
1449 @item set logging file @var{file}
1450 Change the name of the current logfile. The default logfile is @file{gdb.txt}.
1451 @item set logging overwrite [on|off]
1452 By default, @value{GDBN} will append to the logfile. Set @code{overwrite} if
1453 you want @code{set logging on} to overwrite the logfile instead.
1454 @item set logging redirect [on|off]
1455 By default, @value{GDBN} output will go to both the terminal and the logfile.
1456 Set @code{redirect} if you want output to go only to the log file.
1457 @kindex show logging
1459 Show the current values of the logging settings.
1463 @chapter @value{GDBN} Commands
1465 You can abbreviate a @value{GDBN} command to the first few letters of the command
1466 name, if that abbreviation is unambiguous; and you can repeat certain
1467 @value{GDBN} commands by typing just @key{RET}. You can also use the @key{TAB}
1468 key to get @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest of a word in a command (or to
1469 show you the alternatives available, if there is more than one possibility).
1472 * Command Syntax:: How to give commands to @value{GDBN}
1473 * Completion:: Command completion
1474 * Help:: How to ask @value{GDBN} for help
1477 @node Command Syntax
1478 @section Command Syntax
1480 A @value{GDBN} command is a single line of input. There is no limit on
1481 how long it can be. It starts with a command name, which is followed by
1482 arguments whose meaning depends on the command name. For example, the
1483 command @code{step} accepts an argument which is the number of times to
1484 step, as in @samp{step 5}. You can also use the @code{step} command
1485 with no arguments. Some commands do not allow any arguments.
1487 @cindex abbreviation
1488 @value{GDBN} command names may always be truncated if that abbreviation is
1489 unambiguous. Other possible command abbreviations are listed in the
1490 documentation for individual commands. In some cases, even ambiguous
1491 abbreviations are allowed; for example, @code{s} is specially defined as
1492 equivalent to @code{step} even though there are other commands whose
1493 names start with @code{s}. You can test abbreviations by using them as
1494 arguments to the @code{help} command.
1496 @cindex repeating commands
1497 @kindex RET @r{(repeat last command)}
1498 A blank line as input to @value{GDBN} (typing just @key{RET}) means to
1499 repeat the previous command. Certain commands (for example, @code{run})
1500 will not repeat this way; these are commands whose unintentional
1501 repetition might cause trouble and which you are unlikely to want to
1502 repeat. User-defined commands can disable this feature; see
1503 @ref{Define, dont-repeat}.
1505 The @code{list} and @code{x} commands, when you repeat them with
1506 @key{RET}, construct new arguments rather than repeating
1507 exactly as typed. This permits easy scanning of source or memory.
1509 @value{GDBN} can also use @key{RET} in another way: to partition lengthy
1510 output, in a way similar to the common utility @code{more}
1511 (@pxref{Screen Size,,Screen Size}). Since it is easy to press one
1512 @key{RET} too many in this situation, @value{GDBN} disables command
1513 repetition after any command that generates this sort of display.
1515 @kindex # @r{(a comment)}
1517 Any text from a @kbd{#} to the end of the line is a comment; it does
1518 nothing. This is useful mainly in command files (@pxref{Command
1519 Files,,Command Files}).
1521 @cindex repeating command sequences
1522 @kindex Ctrl-o @r{(operate-and-get-next)}
1523 The @kbd{Ctrl-o} binding is useful for repeating a complex sequence of
1524 commands. This command accepts the current line, like @key{RET}, and
1525 then fetches the next line relative to the current line from the history
1529 @section Command Completion
1532 @cindex word completion
1533 @value{GDBN} can fill in the rest of a word in a command for you, if there is
1534 only one possibility; it can also show you what the valid possibilities
1535 are for the next word in a command, at any time. This works for @value{GDBN}
1536 commands, @value{GDBN} subcommands, and the names of symbols in your program.
1538 Press the @key{TAB} key whenever you want @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest
1539 of a word. If there is only one possibility, @value{GDBN} fills in the
1540 word, and waits for you to finish the command (or press @key{RET} to
1541 enter it). For example, if you type
1543 @c FIXME "@key" does not distinguish its argument sufficiently to permit
1544 @c complete accuracy in these examples; space introduced for clarity.
1545 @c If texinfo enhancements make it unnecessary, it would be nice to
1546 @c replace " @key" by "@key" in the following...
1548 (@value{GDBP}) info bre @key{TAB}
1552 @value{GDBN} fills in the rest of the word @samp{breakpoints}, since that is
1553 the only @code{info} subcommand beginning with @samp{bre}:
1556 (@value{GDBP}) info breakpoints
1560 You can either press @key{RET} at this point, to run the @code{info
1561 breakpoints} command, or backspace and enter something else, if
1562 @samp{breakpoints} does not look like the command you expected. (If you
1563 were sure you wanted @code{info breakpoints} in the first place, you
1564 might as well just type @key{RET} immediately after @samp{info bre},
1565 to exploit command abbreviations rather than command completion).
1567 If there is more than one possibility for the next word when you press
1568 @key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} sounds a bell. You can either supply more
1569 characters and try again, or just press @key{TAB} a second time;
1570 @value{GDBN} displays all the possible completions for that word. For
1571 example, you might want to set a breakpoint on a subroutine whose name
1572 begins with @samp{make_}, but when you type @kbd{b make_@key{TAB}} @value{GDBN}
1573 just sounds the bell. Typing @key{TAB} again displays all the
1574 function names in your program that begin with those characters, for
1578 (@value{GDBP}) b make_ @key{TAB}
1579 @exdent @value{GDBN} sounds bell; press @key{TAB} again, to see:
1580 make_a_section_from_file make_environ
1581 make_abs_section make_function_type
1582 make_blockvector make_pointer_type
1583 make_cleanup make_reference_type
1584 make_command make_symbol_completion_list
1585 (@value{GDBP}) b make_
1589 After displaying the available possibilities, @value{GDBN} copies your
1590 partial input (@samp{b make_} in the example) so you can finish the
1593 If you just want to see the list of alternatives in the first place, you
1594 can press @kbd{M-?} rather than pressing @key{TAB} twice. @kbd{M-?}
1595 means @kbd{@key{META} ?}. You can type this either by holding down a
1596 key designated as the @key{META} shift on your keyboard (if there is
1597 one) while typing @kbd{?}, or as @key{ESC} followed by @kbd{?}.
1599 @cindex quotes in commands
1600 @cindex completion of quoted strings
1601 Sometimes the string you need, while logically a ``word'', may contain
1602 parentheses or other characters that @value{GDBN} normally excludes from
1603 its notion of a word. To permit word completion to work in this
1604 situation, you may enclose words in @code{'} (single quote marks) in
1605 @value{GDBN} commands.
1607 The most likely situation where you might need this is in typing the
1608 name of a C@t{++} function. This is because C@t{++} allows function
1609 overloading (multiple definitions of the same function, distinguished
1610 by argument type). For example, when you want to set a breakpoint you
1611 may need to distinguish whether you mean the version of @code{name}
1612 that takes an @code{int} parameter, @code{name(int)}, or the version
1613 that takes a @code{float} parameter, @code{name(float)}. To use the
1614 word-completion facilities in this situation, type a single quote
1615 @code{'} at the beginning of the function name. This alerts
1616 @value{GDBN} that it may need to consider more information than usual
1617 when you press @key{TAB} or @kbd{M-?} to request word completion:
1620 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble( @kbd{M-?}
1621 bubble(double,double) bubble(int,int)
1622 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1625 In some cases, @value{GDBN} can tell that completing a name requires using
1626 quotes. When this happens, @value{GDBN} inserts the quote for you (while
1627 completing as much as it can) if you do not type the quote in the first
1631 (@value{GDBP}) b bub @key{TAB}
1632 @exdent @value{GDBN} alters your input line to the following, and rings a bell:
1633 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1637 In general, @value{GDBN} can tell that a quote is needed (and inserts it) if
1638 you have not yet started typing the argument list when you ask for
1639 completion on an overloaded symbol.
1641 For more information about overloaded functions, see @ref{C Plus Plus
1642 Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}. You can use the command @code{set
1643 overload-resolution off} to disable overload resolution;
1644 see @ref{Debugging C Plus Plus, ,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
1646 @cindex completion of structure field names
1647 @cindex structure field name completion
1648 @cindex completion of union field names
1649 @cindex union field name completion
1650 When completing in an expression which looks up a field in a
1651 structure, @value{GDBN} also tries@footnote{The completer can be
1652 confused by certain kinds of invalid expressions. Also, it only
1653 examines the static type of the expression, not the dynamic type.} to
1654 limit completions to the field names available in the type of the
1658 (@value{GDBP}) p gdb_stdout.@kbd{M-?}
1659 magic to_fputs to_rewind
1660 to_data to_isatty to_write
1661 to_delete to_put to_write_async_safe
1666 This is because the @code{gdb_stdout} is a variable of the type
1667 @code{struct ui_file} that is defined in @value{GDBN} sources as
1674 ui_file_flush_ftype *to_flush;
1675 ui_file_write_ftype *to_write;
1676 ui_file_write_async_safe_ftype *to_write_async_safe;
1677 ui_file_fputs_ftype *to_fputs;
1678 ui_file_read_ftype *to_read;
1679 ui_file_delete_ftype *to_delete;
1680 ui_file_isatty_ftype *to_isatty;
1681 ui_file_rewind_ftype *to_rewind;
1682 ui_file_put_ftype *to_put;
1689 @section Getting Help
1690 @cindex online documentation
1693 You can always ask @value{GDBN} itself for information on its commands,
1694 using the command @code{help}.
1697 @kindex h @r{(@code{help})}
1700 You can use @code{help} (abbreviated @code{h}) with no arguments to
1701 display a short list of named classes of commands:
1705 List of classes of commands:
1707 aliases -- Aliases of other commands
1708 breakpoints -- Making program stop at certain points
1709 data -- Examining data
1710 files -- Specifying and examining files
1711 internals -- Maintenance commands
1712 obscure -- Obscure features
1713 running -- Running the program
1714 stack -- Examining the stack
1715 status -- Status inquiries
1716 support -- Support facilities
1717 tracepoints -- Tracing of program execution without
1718 stopping the program
1719 user-defined -- User-defined commands
1721 Type "help" followed by a class name for a list of
1722 commands in that class.
1723 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1725 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1728 @c the above line break eliminates huge line overfull...
1730 @item help @var{class}
1731 Using one of the general help classes as an argument, you can get a
1732 list of the individual commands in that class. For example, here is the
1733 help display for the class @code{status}:
1736 (@value{GDBP}) help status
1741 @c Line break in "show" line falsifies real output, but needed
1742 @c to fit in smallbook page size.
1743 info -- Generic command for showing things
1744 about the program being debugged
1745 show -- Generic command for showing things
1748 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1750 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1754 @item help @var{command}
1755 With a command name as @code{help} argument, @value{GDBN} displays a
1756 short paragraph on how to use that command.
1759 @item apropos @var{args}
1760 The @code{apropos} command searches through all of the @value{GDBN}
1761 commands, and their documentation, for the regular expression specified in
1762 @var{args}. It prints out all matches found. For example:
1773 alias -- Define a new command that is an alias of an existing command
1774 aliases -- Aliases of other commands
1775 d -- Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions
1776 del -- Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions
1777 delete -- Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions
1782 @item complete @var{args}
1783 The @code{complete @var{args}} command lists all the possible completions
1784 for the beginning of a command. Use @var{args} to specify the beginning of the
1785 command you want completed. For example:
1791 @noindent results in:
1802 @noindent This is intended for use by @sc{gnu} Emacs.
1805 In addition to @code{help}, you can use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{info}
1806 and @code{show} to inquire about the state of your program, or the state
1807 of @value{GDBN} itself. Each command supports many topics of inquiry; this
1808 manual introduces each of them in the appropriate context. The listings
1809 under @code{info} and under @code{show} in the Command, Variable, and
1810 Function Index point to all the sub-commands. @xref{Command and Variable
1816 @kindex i @r{(@code{info})}
1818 This command (abbreviated @code{i}) is for describing the state of your
1819 program. For example, you can show the arguments passed to a function
1820 with @code{info args}, list the registers currently in use with @code{info
1821 registers}, or list the breakpoints you have set with @code{info breakpoints}.
1822 You can get a complete list of the @code{info} sub-commands with
1823 @w{@code{help info}}.
1827 You can assign the result of an expression to an environment variable with
1828 @code{set}. For example, you can set the @value{GDBN} prompt to a $-sign with
1829 @code{set prompt $}.
1833 In contrast to @code{info}, @code{show} is for describing the state of
1834 @value{GDBN} itself.
1835 You can change most of the things you can @code{show}, by using the
1836 related command @code{set}; for example, you can control what number
1837 system is used for displays with @code{set radix}, or simply inquire
1838 which is currently in use with @code{show radix}.
1841 To display all the settable parameters and their current
1842 values, you can use @code{show} with no arguments; you may also use
1843 @code{info set}. Both commands produce the same display.
1844 @c FIXME: "info set" violates the rule that "info" is for state of
1845 @c FIXME...program. Ck w/ GNU: "info set" to be called something else,
1846 @c FIXME...or change desc of rule---eg "state of prog and debugging session"?
1850 Here are several miscellaneous @code{show} subcommands, all of which are
1851 exceptional in lacking corresponding @code{set} commands:
1854 @kindex show version
1855 @cindex @value{GDBN} version number
1857 Show what version of @value{GDBN} is running. You should include this
1858 information in @value{GDBN} bug-reports. If multiple versions of
1859 @value{GDBN} are in use at your site, you may need to determine which
1860 version of @value{GDBN} you are running; as @value{GDBN} evolves, new
1861 commands are introduced, and old ones may wither away. Also, many
1862 system vendors ship variant versions of @value{GDBN}, and there are
1863 variant versions of @value{GDBN} in @sc{gnu}/Linux distributions as well.
1864 The version number is the same as the one announced when you start
1867 @kindex show copying
1868 @kindex info copying
1869 @cindex display @value{GDBN} copyright
1872 Display information about permission for copying @value{GDBN}.
1874 @kindex show warranty
1875 @kindex info warranty
1877 @itemx info warranty
1878 Display the @sc{gnu} ``NO WARRANTY'' statement, or a warranty,
1879 if your version of @value{GDBN} comes with one.
1881 @kindex show configuration
1882 @item show configuration
1883 Display detailed information about the way @value{GDBN} was configured
1884 when it was built. This displays the optional arguments passed to the
1885 @file{configure} script and also configuration parameters detected
1886 automatically by @command{configure}. When reporting a @value{GDBN}
1887 bug (@pxref{GDB Bugs}), it is important to include this information in
1893 @chapter Running Programs Under @value{GDBN}
1895 When you run a program under @value{GDBN}, you must first generate
1896 debugging information when you compile it.
1898 You may start @value{GDBN} with its arguments, if any, in an environment
1899 of your choice. If you are doing native debugging, you may redirect
1900 your program's input and output, debug an already running process, or
1901 kill a child process.
1904 * Compilation:: Compiling for debugging
1905 * Starting:: Starting your program
1906 * Arguments:: Your program's arguments
1907 * Environment:: Your program's environment
1909 * Working Directory:: Your program's working directory
1910 * Input/Output:: Your program's input and output
1911 * Attach:: Debugging an already-running process
1912 * Kill Process:: Killing the child process
1914 * Inferiors and Programs:: Debugging multiple inferiors and programs
1915 * Threads:: Debugging programs with multiple threads
1916 * Forks:: Debugging forks
1917 * Checkpoint/Restart:: Setting a @emph{bookmark} to return to later
1921 @section Compiling for Debugging
1923 In order to debug a program effectively, you need to generate
1924 debugging information when you compile it. This debugging information
1925 is stored in the object file; it describes the data type of each
1926 variable or function and the correspondence between source line numbers
1927 and addresses in the executable code.
1929 To request debugging information, specify the @samp{-g} option when you run
1932 Programs that are to be shipped to your customers are compiled with
1933 optimizations, using the @samp{-O} compiler option. However, some
1934 compilers are unable to handle the @samp{-g} and @samp{-O} options
1935 together. Using those compilers, you cannot generate optimized
1936 executables containing debugging information.
1938 @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C@t{++} compiler, supports @samp{-g} with or
1939 without @samp{-O}, making it possible to debug optimized code. We
1940 recommend that you @emph{always} use @samp{-g} whenever you compile a
1941 program. You may think your program is correct, but there is no sense
1942 in pushing your luck. For more information, see @ref{Optimized Code}.
1944 Older versions of the @sc{gnu} C compiler permitted a variant option
1945 @w{@samp{-gg}} for debugging information. @value{GDBN} no longer supports this
1946 format; if your @sc{gnu} C compiler has this option, do not use it.
1948 @value{GDBN} knows about preprocessor macros and can show you their
1949 expansion (@pxref{Macros}). Most compilers do not include information
1950 about preprocessor macros in the debugging information if you specify
1951 the @option{-g} flag alone. Version 3.1 and later of @value{NGCC},
1952 the @sc{gnu} C compiler, provides macro information if you are using
1953 the DWARF debugging format, and specify the option @option{-g3}.
1955 @xref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your Program or GCC,
1956 gcc.info, Using the @sc{gnu} Compiler Collection (GCC)}, for more
1957 information on @value{NGCC} options affecting debug information.
1959 You will have the best debugging experience if you use the latest
1960 version of the DWARF debugging format that your compiler supports.
1961 DWARF is currently the most expressive and best supported debugging
1962 format in @value{GDBN}.
1966 @section Starting your Program
1972 @kindex r @r{(@code{run})}
1975 Use the @code{run} command to start your program under @value{GDBN}.
1976 You must first specify the program name (except on VxWorks) with an
1977 argument to @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Invocation, ,Getting In and Out of
1978 @value{GDBN}}), or by using the @code{file} or @code{exec-file} command
1979 (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
1983 If you are running your program in an execution environment that
1984 supports processes, @code{run} creates an inferior process and makes
1985 that process run your program. In some environments without processes,
1986 @code{run} jumps to the start of your program. Other targets,
1987 like @samp{remote}, are always running. If you get an error
1988 message like this one:
1991 The "remote" target does not support "run".
1992 Try "help target" or "continue".
1996 then use @code{continue} to run your program. You may need @code{load}
1997 first (@pxref{load}).
1999 The execution of a program is affected by certain information it
2000 receives from its superior. @value{GDBN} provides ways to specify this
2001 information, which you must do @emph{before} starting your program. (You
2002 can change it after starting your program, but such changes only affect
2003 your program the next time you start it.) This information may be
2004 divided into four categories:
2007 @item The @emph{arguments.}
2008 Specify the arguments to give your program as the arguments of the
2009 @code{run} command. If a shell is available on your target, the shell
2010 is used to pass the arguments, so that you may use normal conventions
2011 (such as wildcard expansion or variable substitution) in describing
2013 In Unix systems, you can control which shell is used with the
2014 @code{SHELL} environment variable.
2015 @xref{Arguments, ,Your Program's Arguments}.
2017 @item The @emph{environment.}
2018 Your program normally inherits its environment from @value{GDBN}, but you can
2019 use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{set environment} and @code{unset
2020 environment} to change parts of the environment that affect
2021 your program. @xref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}.
2023 @item The @emph{working directory.}
2024 Your program inherits its working directory from @value{GDBN}. You can set
2025 the @value{GDBN} working directory with the @code{cd} command in @value{GDBN}.
2026 @xref{Working Directory, ,Your Program's Working Directory}.
2028 @item The @emph{standard input and output.}
2029 Your program normally uses the same device for standard input and
2030 standard output as @value{GDBN} is using. You can redirect input and output
2031 in the @code{run} command line, or you can use the @code{tty} command to
2032 set a different device for your program.
2033 @xref{Input/Output, ,Your Program's Input and Output}.
2036 @emph{Warning:} While input and output redirection work, you cannot use
2037 pipes to pass the output of the program you are debugging to another
2038 program; if you attempt this, @value{GDBN} is likely to wind up debugging the
2042 When you issue the @code{run} command, your program begins to execute
2043 immediately. @xref{Stopping, ,Stopping and Continuing}, for discussion
2044 of how to arrange for your program to stop. Once your program has
2045 stopped, you may call functions in your program, using the @code{print}
2046 or @code{call} commands. @xref{Data, ,Examining Data}.
2048 If the modification time of your symbol file has changed since the last
2049 time @value{GDBN} read its symbols, @value{GDBN} discards its symbol
2050 table, and reads it again. When it does this, @value{GDBN} tries to retain
2051 your current breakpoints.
2056 @cindex run to main procedure
2057 The name of the main procedure can vary from language to language.
2058 With C or C@t{++}, the main procedure name is always @code{main}, but
2059 other languages such as Ada do not require a specific name for their
2060 main procedure. The debugger provides a convenient way to start the
2061 execution of the program and to stop at the beginning of the main
2062 procedure, depending on the language used.
2064 The @samp{start} command does the equivalent of setting a temporary
2065 breakpoint at the beginning of the main procedure and then invoking
2066 the @samp{run} command.
2068 @cindex elaboration phase
2069 Some programs contain an @dfn{elaboration} phase where some startup code is
2070 executed before the main procedure is called. This depends on the
2071 languages used to write your program. In C@t{++}, for instance,
2072 constructors for static and global objects are executed before
2073 @code{main} is called. It is therefore possible that the debugger stops
2074 before reaching the main procedure. However, the temporary breakpoint
2075 will remain to halt execution.
2077 Specify the arguments to give to your program as arguments to the
2078 @samp{start} command. These arguments will be given verbatim to the
2079 underlying @samp{run} command. Note that the same arguments will be
2080 reused if no argument is provided during subsequent calls to
2081 @samp{start} or @samp{run}.
2083 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration. In
2084 these cases, using the @code{start} command would stop the execution of
2085 your program too late, as the program would have already completed the
2086 elaboration phase. Under these circumstances, insert breakpoints in your
2087 elaboration code before running your program.
2089 @kindex set exec-wrapper
2090 @item set exec-wrapper @var{wrapper}
2091 @itemx show exec-wrapper
2092 @itemx unset exec-wrapper
2093 When @samp{exec-wrapper} is set, the specified wrapper is used to
2094 launch programs for debugging. @value{GDBN} starts your program
2095 with a shell command of the form @kbd{exec @var{wrapper}
2096 @var{program}}. Quoting is added to @var{program} and its
2097 arguments, but not to @var{wrapper}, so you should add quotes if
2098 appropriate for your shell. The wrapper runs until it executes
2099 your program, and then @value{GDBN} takes control.
2101 You can use any program that eventually calls @code{execve} with
2102 its arguments as a wrapper. Several standard Unix utilities do
2103 this, e.g.@: @code{env} and @code{nohup}. Any Unix shell script ending
2104 with @code{exec "$@@"} will also work.
2106 For example, you can use @code{env} to pass an environment variable to
2107 the debugged program, without setting the variable in your shell's
2111 (@value{GDBP}) set exec-wrapper env 'LD_PRELOAD=libtest.so'
2115 This command is available when debugging locally on most targets, excluding
2116 @sc{djgpp}, Cygwin, MS Windows, and QNX Neutrino.
2118 @kindex set disable-randomization
2119 @item set disable-randomization
2120 @itemx set disable-randomization on
2121 This option (enabled by default in @value{GDBN}) will turn off the native
2122 randomization of the virtual address space of the started program. This option
2123 is useful for multiple debugging sessions to make the execution better
2124 reproducible and memory addresses reusable across debugging sessions.
2126 This feature is implemented only on certain targets, including @sc{gnu}/Linux.
2127 On @sc{gnu}/Linux you can get the same behavior using
2130 (@value{GDBP}) set exec-wrapper setarch `uname -m` -R
2133 @item set disable-randomization off
2134 Leave the behavior of the started executable unchanged. Some bugs rear their
2135 ugly heads only when the program is loaded at certain addresses. If your bug
2136 disappears when you run the program under @value{GDBN}, that might be because
2137 @value{GDBN} by default disables the address randomization on platforms, such
2138 as @sc{gnu}/Linux, which do that for stand-alone programs. Use @kbd{set
2139 disable-randomization off} to try to reproduce such elusive bugs.
2141 On targets where it is available, virtual address space randomization
2142 protects the programs against certain kinds of security attacks. In these
2143 cases the attacker needs to know the exact location of a concrete executable
2144 code. Randomizing its location makes it impossible to inject jumps misusing
2145 a code at its expected addresses.
2147 Prelinking shared libraries provides a startup performance advantage but it
2148 makes addresses in these libraries predictable for privileged processes by
2149 having just unprivileged access at the target system. Reading the shared
2150 library binary gives enough information for assembling the malicious code
2151 misusing it. Still even a prelinked shared library can get loaded at a new
2152 random address just requiring the regular relocation process during the
2153 startup. Shared libraries not already prelinked are always loaded at
2154 a randomly chosen address.
2156 Position independent executables (PIE) contain position independent code
2157 similar to the shared libraries and therefore such executables get loaded at
2158 a randomly chosen address upon startup. PIE executables always load even
2159 already prelinked shared libraries at a random address. You can build such
2160 executable using @command{gcc -fPIE -pie}.
2162 Heap (malloc storage), stack and custom mmap areas are always placed randomly
2163 (as long as the randomization is enabled).
2165 @item show disable-randomization
2166 Show the current setting of the explicit disable of the native randomization of
2167 the virtual address space of the started program.
2172 @section Your Program's Arguments
2174 @cindex arguments (to your program)
2175 The arguments to your program can be specified by the arguments of the
2177 They are passed to a shell, which expands wildcard characters and
2178 performs redirection of I/O, and thence to your program. Your
2179 @code{SHELL} environment variable (if it exists) specifies what shell
2180 @value{GDBN} uses. If you do not define @code{SHELL}, @value{GDBN} uses
2181 the default shell (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix).
2183 On non-Unix systems, the program is usually invoked directly by
2184 @value{GDBN}, which emulates I/O redirection via the appropriate system
2185 calls, and the wildcard characters are expanded by the startup code of
2186 the program, not by the shell.
2188 @code{run} with no arguments uses the same arguments used by the previous
2189 @code{run}, or those set by the @code{set args} command.
2194 Specify the arguments to be used the next time your program is run. If
2195 @code{set args} has no arguments, @code{run} executes your program
2196 with no arguments. Once you have run your program with arguments,
2197 using @code{set args} before the next @code{run} is the only way to run
2198 it again without arguments.
2202 Show the arguments to give your program when it is started.
2206 @section Your Program's Environment
2208 @cindex environment (of your program)
2209 The @dfn{environment} consists of a set of environment variables and
2210 their values. Environment variables conventionally record such things as
2211 your user name, your home directory, your terminal type, and your search
2212 path for programs to run. Usually you set up environment variables with
2213 the shell and they are inherited by all the other programs you run. When
2214 debugging, it can be useful to try running your program with a modified
2215 environment without having to start @value{GDBN} over again.
2219 @item path @var{directory}
2220 Add @var{directory} to the front of the @code{PATH} environment variable
2221 (the search path for executables) that will be passed to your program.
2222 The value of @code{PATH} used by @value{GDBN} does not change.
2223 You may specify several directory names, separated by whitespace or by a
2224 system-dependent separator character (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on
2225 MS-DOS and MS-Windows). If @var{directory} is already in the path, it
2226 is moved to the front, so it is searched sooner.
2228 You can use the string @samp{$cwd} to refer to whatever is the current
2229 working directory at the time @value{GDBN} searches the path. If you
2230 use @samp{.} instead, it refers to the directory where you executed the
2231 @code{path} command. @value{GDBN} replaces @samp{.} in the
2232 @var{directory} argument (with the current path) before adding
2233 @var{directory} to the search path.
2234 @c 'path' is explicitly nonrepeatable, but RMS points out it is silly to
2235 @c document that, since repeating it would be a no-op.
2239 Display the list of search paths for executables (the @code{PATH}
2240 environment variable).
2242 @kindex show environment
2243 @item show environment @r{[}@var{varname}@r{]}
2244 Print the value of environment variable @var{varname} to be given to
2245 your program when it starts. If you do not supply @var{varname},
2246 print the names and values of all environment variables to be given to
2247 your program. You can abbreviate @code{environment} as @code{env}.
2249 @kindex set environment
2250 @item set environment @var{varname} @r{[}=@var{value}@r{]}
2251 Set environment variable @var{varname} to @var{value}. The value
2252 changes for your program only, not for @value{GDBN} itself. @var{value} may
2253 be any string; the values of environment variables are just strings, and
2254 any interpretation is supplied by your program itself. The @var{value}
2255 parameter is optional; if it is eliminated, the variable is set to a
2257 @c "any string" here does not include leading, trailing
2258 @c blanks. Gnu asks: does anyone care?
2260 For example, this command:
2267 tells the debugged program, when subsequently run, that its user is named
2268 @samp{foo}. (The spaces around @samp{=} are used for clarity here; they
2269 are not actually required.)
2271 @kindex unset environment
2272 @item unset environment @var{varname}
2273 Remove variable @var{varname} from the environment to be passed to your
2274 program. This is different from @samp{set env @var{varname} =};
2275 @code{unset environment} removes the variable from the environment,
2276 rather than assigning it an empty value.
2279 @emph{Warning:} On Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program using
2281 by your @code{SHELL} environment variable if it exists (or
2282 @code{/bin/sh} if not). If your @code{SHELL} variable names a shell
2283 that runs an initialization file---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell, or
2284 @file{.bashrc} for BASH---any variables you set in that file affect
2285 your program. You may wish to move setting of environment variables to
2286 files that are only run when you sign on, such as @file{.login} or
2289 @node Working Directory
2290 @section Your Program's Working Directory
2292 @cindex working directory (of your program)
2293 Each time you start your program with @code{run}, it inherits its
2294 working directory from the current working directory of @value{GDBN}.
2295 The @value{GDBN} working directory is initially whatever it inherited
2296 from its parent process (typically the shell), but you can specify a new
2297 working directory in @value{GDBN} with the @code{cd} command.
2299 The @value{GDBN} working directory also serves as a default for the commands
2300 that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
2305 @cindex change working directory
2306 @item cd @r{[}@var{directory}@r{]}
2307 Set the @value{GDBN} working directory to @var{directory}. If not
2308 given, @var{directory} uses @file{'~'}.
2312 Print the @value{GDBN} working directory.
2315 It is generally impossible to find the current working directory of
2316 the process being debugged (since a program can change its directory
2317 during its run). If you work on a system where @value{GDBN} is
2318 configured with the @file{/proc} support, you can use the @code{info
2319 proc} command (@pxref{SVR4 Process Information}) to find out the
2320 current working directory of the debuggee.
2323 @section Your Program's Input and Output
2328 By default, the program you run under @value{GDBN} does input and output to
2329 the same terminal that @value{GDBN} uses. @value{GDBN} switches the terminal
2330 to its own terminal modes to interact with you, but it records the terminal
2331 modes your program was using and switches back to them when you continue
2332 running your program.
2335 @kindex info terminal
2337 Displays information recorded by @value{GDBN} about the terminal modes your
2341 You can redirect your program's input and/or output using shell
2342 redirection with the @code{run} command. For example,
2349 starts your program, diverting its output to the file @file{outfile}.
2352 @cindex controlling terminal
2353 Another way to specify where your program should do input and output is
2354 with the @code{tty} command. This command accepts a file name as
2355 argument, and causes this file to be the default for future @code{run}
2356 commands. It also resets the controlling terminal for the child
2357 process, for future @code{run} commands. For example,
2364 directs that processes started with subsequent @code{run} commands
2365 default to do input and output on the terminal @file{/dev/ttyb} and have
2366 that as their controlling terminal.
2368 An explicit redirection in @code{run} overrides the @code{tty} command's
2369 effect on the input/output device, but not its effect on the controlling
2372 When you use the @code{tty} command or redirect input in the @code{run}
2373 command, only the input @emph{for your program} is affected. The input
2374 for @value{GDBN} still comes from your terminal. @code{tty} is an alias
2375 for @code{set inferior-tty}.
2377 @cindex inferior tty
2378 @cindex set inferior controlling terminal
2379 You can use the @code{show inferior-tty} command to tell @value{GDBN} to
2380 display the name of the terminal that will be used for future runs of your
2384 @item set inferior-tty /dev/ttyb
2385 @kindex set inferior-tty
2386 Set the tty for the program being debugged to /dev/ttyb.
2388 @item show inferior-tty
2389 @kindex show inferior-tty
2390 Show the current tty for the program being debugged.
2394 @section Debugging an Already-running Process
2399 @item attach @var{process-id}
2400 This command attaches to a running process---one that was started
2401 outside @value{GDBN}. (@code{info files} shows your active
2402 targets.) The command takes as argument a process ID. The usual way to
2403 find out the @var{process-id} of a Unix process is with the @code{ps} utility,
2404 or with the @samp{jobs -l} shell command.
2406 @code{attach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} a second time after
2407 executing the command.
2410 To use @code{attach}, your program must be running in an environment
2411 which supports processes; for example, @code{attach} does not work for
2412 programs on bare-board targets that lack an operating system. You must
2413 also have permission to send the process a signal.
2415 When you use @code{attach}, the debugger finds the program running in
2416 the process first by looking in the current working directory, then (if
2417 the program is not found) by using the source file search path
2418 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories}). You can also use
2419 the @code{file} command to load the program. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
2422 The first thing @value{GDBN} does after arranging to debug the specified
2423 process is to stop it. You can examine and modify an attached process
2424 with all the @value{GDBN} commands that are ordinarily available when
2425 you start processes with @code{run}. You can insert breakpoints; you
2426 can step and continue; you can modify storage. If you would rather the
2427 process continue running, you may use the @code{continue} command after
2428 attaching @value{GDBN} to the process.
2433 When you have finished debugging the attached process, you can use the
2434 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control. Detaching
2435 the process continues its execution. After the @code{detach} command,
2436 that process and @value{GDBN} become completely independent once more, and you
2437 are ready to @code{attach} another process or start one with @code{run}.
2438 @code{detach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
2439 executing the command.
2442 If you exit @value{GDBN} while you have an attached process, you detach
2443 that process. If you use the @code{run} command, you kill that process.
2444 By default, @value{GDBN} asks for confirmation if you try to do either of these
2445 things; you can control whether or not you need to confirm by using the
2446 @code{set confirm} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
2450 @section Killing the Child Process
2455 Kill the child process in which your program is running under @value{GDBN}.
2458 This command is useful if you wish to debug a core dump instead of a
2459 running process. @value{GDBN} ignores any core dump file while your program
2462 On some operating systems, a program cannot be executed outside @value{GDBN}
2463 while you have breakpoints set on it inside @value{GDBN}. You can use the
2464 @code{kill} command in this situation to permit running your program
2465 outside the debugger.
2467 The @code{kill} command is also useful if you wish to recompile and
2468 relink your program, since on many systems it is impossible to modify an
2469 executable file while it is running in a process. In this case, when you
2470 next type @code{run}, @value{GDBN} notices that the file has changed, and
2471 reads the symbol table again (while trying to preserve your current
2472 breakpoint settings).
2474 @node Inferiors and Programs
2475 @section Debugging Multiple Inferiors and Programs
2477 @value{GDBN} lets you run and debug multiple programs in a single
2478 session. In addition, @value{GDBN} on some systems may let you run
2479 several programs simultaneously (otherwise you have to exit from one
2480 before starting another). In the most general case, you can have
2481 multiple threads of execution in each of multiple processes, launched
2482 from multiple executables.
2485 @value{GDBN} represents the state of each program execution with an
2486 object called an @dfn{inferior}. An inferior typically corresponds to
2487 a process, but is more general and applies also to targets that do not
2488 have processes. Inferiors may be created before a process runs, and
2489 may be retained after a process exits. Inferiors have unique
2490 identifiers that are different from process ids. Usually each
2491 inferior will also have its own distinct address space, although some
2492 embedded targets may have several inferiors running in different parts
2493 of a single address space. Each inferior may in turn have multiple
2494 threads running in it.
2496 To find out what inferiors exist at any moment, use @w{@code{info
2500 @kindex info inferiors
2501 @item info inferiors
2502 Print a list of all inferiors currently being managed by @value{GDBN}.
2504 @value{GDBN} displays for each inferior (in this order):
2508 the inferior number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2511 the target system's inferior identifier
2514 the name of the executable the inferior is running.
2519 An asterisk @samp{*} preceding the @value{GDBN} inferior number
2520 indicates the current inferior.
2524 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
2527 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2528 Num Description Executable
2529 2 process 2307 hello
2530 * 1 process 3401 goodbye
2533 To switch focus between inferiors, use the @code{inferior} command:
2536 @kindex inferior @var{infno}
2537 @item inferior @var{infno}
2538 Make inferior number @var{infno} the current inferior. The argument
2539 @var{infno} is the inferior number assigned by @value{GDBN}, as shown
2540 in the first field of the @samp{info inferiors} display.
2544 You can get multiple executables into a debugging session via the
2545 @code{add-inferior} and @w{@code{clone-inferior}} commands. On some
2546 systems @value{GDBN} can add inferiors to the debug session
2547 automatically by following calls to @code{fork} and @code{exec}. To
2548 remove inferiors from the debugging session use the
2549 @w{@code{remove-inferiors}} command.
2552 @kindex add-inferior
2553 @item add-inferior [ -copies @var{n} ] [ -exec @var{executable} ]
2554 Adds @var{n} inferiors to be run using @var{executable} as the
2555 executable. @var{n} defaults to 1. If no executable is specified,
2556 the inferiors begins empty, with no program. You can still assign or
2557 change the program assigned to the inferior at any time by using the
2558 @code{file} command with the executable name as its argument.
2560 @kindex clone-inferior
2561 @item clone-inferior [ -copies @var{n} ] [ @var{infno} ]
2562 Adds @var{n} inferiors ready to execute the same program as inferior
2563 @var{infno}. @var{n} defaults to 1. @var{infno} defaults to the
2564 number of the current inferior. This is a convenient command when you
2565 want to run another instance of the inferior you are debugging.
2568 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2569 Num Description Executable
2570 * 1 process 29964 helloworld
2571 (@value{GDBP}) clone-inferior
2574 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2575 Num Description Executable
2577 * 1 process 29964 helloworld
2580 You can now simply switch focus to inferior 2 and run it.
2582 @kindex remove-inferiors
2583 @item remove-inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2584 Removes the inferior or inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}. It is not
2585 possible to remove an inferior that is running with this command. For
2586 those, use the @code{kill} or @code{detach} command first.
2590 To quit debugging one of the running inferiors that is not the current
2591 inferior, you can either detach from it by using the @w{@code{detach
2592 inferior}} command (allowing it to run independently), or kill it
2593 using the @w{@code{kill inferiors}} command:
2596 @kindex detach inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2597 @item detach inferior @var{infno}@dots{}
2598 Detach from the inferior or inferiors identified by @value{GDBN}
2599 inferior number(s) @var{infno}@dots{}. Note that the inferior's entry
2600 still stays on the list of inferiors shown by @code{info inferiors},
2601 but its Description will show @samp{<null>}.
2603 @kindex kill inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2604 @item kill inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2605 Kill the inferior or inferiors identified by @value{GDBN} inferior
2606 number(s) @var{infno}@dots{}. Note that the inferior's entry still
2607 stays on the list of inferiors shown by @code{info inferiors}, but its
2608 Description will show @samp{<null>}.
2611 After the successful completion of a command such as @code{detach},
2612 @code{detach inferiors}, @code{kill} or @code{kill inferiors}, or after
2613 a normal process exit, the inferior is still valid and listed with
2614 @code{info inferiors}, ready to be restarted.
2617 To be notified when inferiors are started or exit under @value{GDBN}'s
2618 control use @w{@code{set print inferior-events}}:
2621 @kindex set print inferior-events
2622 @cindex print messages on inferior start and exit
2623 @item set print inferior-events
2624 @itemx set print inferior-events on
2625 @itemx set print inferior-events off
2626 The @code{set print inferior-events} command allows you to enable or
2627 disable printing of messages when @value{GDBN} notices that new
2628 inferiors have started or that inferiors have exited or have been
2629 detached. By default, these messages will not be printed.
2631 @kindex show print inferior-events
2632 @item show print inferior-events
2633 Show whether messages will be printed when @value{GDBN} detects that
2634 inferiors have started, exited or have been detached.
2637 Many commands will work the same with multiple programs as with a
2638 single program: e.g., @code{print myglobal} will simply display the
2639 value of @code{myglobal} in the current inferior.
2642 Occasionaly, when debugging @value{GDBN} itself, it may be useful to
2643 get more info about the relationship of inferiors, programs, address
2644 spaces in a debug session. You can do that with the @w{@code{maint
2645 info program-spaces}} command.
2648 @kindex maint info program-spaces
2649 @item maint info program-spaces
2650 Print a list of all program spaces currently being managed by
2653 @value{GDBN} displays for each program space (in this order):
2657 the program space number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2660 the name of the executable loaded into the program space, with e.g.,
2661 the @code{file} command.
2666 An asterisk @samp{*} preceding the @value{GDBN} program space number
2667 indicates the current program space.
2669 In addition, below each program space line, @value{GDBN} prints extra
2670 information that isn't suitable to display in tabular form. For
2671 example, the list of inferiors bound to the program space.
2674 (@value{GDBP}) maint info program-spaces
2677 Bound inferiors: ID 1 (process 21561)
2681 Here we can see that no inferior is running the program @code{hello},
2682 while @code{process 21561} is running the program @code{goodbye}. On
2683 some targets, it is possible that multiple inferiors are bound to the
2684 same program space. The most common example is that of debugging both
2685 the parent and child processes of a @code{vfork} call. For example,
2688 (@value{GDBP}) maint info program-spaces
2691 Bound inferiors: ID 2 (process 18050), ID 1 (process 18045)
2694 Here, both inferior 2 and inferior 1 are running in the same program
2695 space as a result of inferior 1 having executed a @code{vfork} call.
2699 @section Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads
2701 @cindex threads of execution
2702 @cindex multiple threads
2703 @cindex switching threads
2704 In some operating systems, such as HP-UX and Solaris, a single program
2705 may have more than one @dfn{thread} of execution. The precise semantics
2706 of threads differ from one operating system to another, but in general
2707 the threads of a single program are akin to multiple processes---except
2708 that they share one address space (that is, they can all examine and
2709 modify the same variables). On the other hand, each thread has its own
2710 registers and execution stack, and perhaps private memory.
2712 @value{GDBN} provides these facilities for debugging multi-thread
2716 @item automatic notification of new threads
2717 @item @samp{thread @var{threadno}}, a command to switch among threads
2718 @item @samp{info threads}, a command to inquire about existing threads
2719 @item @samp{thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{args}},
2720 a command to apply a command to a list of threads
2721 @item thread-specific breakpoints
2722 @item @samp{set print thread-events}, which controls printing of
2723 messages on thread start and exit.
2724 @item @samp{set libthread-db-search-path @var{path}}, which lets
2725 the user specify which @code{libthread_db} to use if the default choice
2726 isn't compatible with the program.
2730 @emph{Warning:} These facilities are not yet available on every
2731 @value{GDBN} configuration where the operating system supports threads.
2732 If your @value{GDBN} does not support threads, these commands have no
2733 effect. For example, a system without thread support shows no output
2734 from @samp{info threads}, and always rejects the @code{thread} command,
2738 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2739 (@value{GDBP}) thread 1
2740 Thread ID 1 not known. Use the "info threads" command to
2741 see the IDs of currently known threads.
2743 @c FIXME to implementors: how hard would it be to say "sorry, this GDB
2744 @c doesn't support threads"?
2747 @cindex focus of debugging
2748 @cindex current thread
2749 The @value{GDBN} thread debugging facility allows you to observe all
2750 threads while your program runs---but whenever @value{GDBN} takes
2751 control, one thread in particular is always the focus of debugging.
2752 This thread is called the @dfn{current thread}. Debugging commands show
2753 program information from the perspective of the current thread.
2755 @cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message
2756 @cindex thread identifier (system)
2757 @c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2758 @c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2759 @c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2760 Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2761 the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2762 form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}. @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2763 whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2764 @sc{gnu}/Linux, you might see
2767 [New Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 25582)]
2771 when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread. In contrast, on an SGI system,
2772 the @var{systag} is simply something like @samp{process 368}, with no
2775 @c FIXME!! (1) Does the [New...] message appear even for the very first
2776 @c thread of a program, or does it only appear for the
2777 @c second---i.e.@: when it becomes obvious we have a multithread
2779 @c (2) *Is* there necessarily a first thread always? Or do some
2780 @c multithread systems permit starting a program with multiple
2781 @c threads ab initio?
2783 @cindex thread number
2784 @cindex thread identifier (GDB)
2785 For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
2786 number---always a single integer---with each thread in your program.
2789 @kindex info threads
2790 @item info threads @r{[}@var{id}@dots{}@r{]}
2791 Display a summary of all threads currently in your program. Optional
2792 argument @var{id}@dots{} is one or more thread ids separated by spaces, and
2793 means to print information only about the specified thread or threads.
2794 @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2798 the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2801 the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
2804 the thread's name, if one is known. A thread can either be named by
2805 the user (see @code{thread name}, below), or, in some cases, by the
2809 the current stack frame summary for that thread
2813 An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
2814 indicates the current thread.
2818 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
2821 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2823 3 process 35 thread 27 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2824 2 process 35 thread 23 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2825 * 1 process 35 thread 13 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
2829 On Solaris, you can display more information about user threads with a
2830 Solaris-specific command:
2833 @item maint info sol-threads
2834 @kindex maint info sol-threads
2835 @cindex thread info (Solaris)
2836 Display info on Solaris user threads.
2840 @kindex thread @var{threadno}
2841 @item thread @var{threadno}
2842 Make thread number @var{threadno} the current thread. The command
2843 argument @var{threadno} is the internal @value{GDBN} thread number, as
2844 shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads} display.
2845 @value{GDBN} responds by displaying the system identifier of the thread
2846 you selected, and its current stack frame summary:
2849 (@value{GDBP}) thread 2
2850 [Switching to thread 2 (Thread 0xb7fdab70 (LWP 12747))]
2851 #0 some_function (ignore=0x0) at example.c:8
2852 8 printf ("hello\n");
2856 As with the @samp{[New @dots{}]} message, the form of the text after
2857 @samp{Switching to} depends on your system's conventions for identifying
2860 @vindex $_thread@r{, convenience variable}
2861 The debugger convenience variable @samp{$_thread} contains the number
2862 of the current thread. You may find this useful in writing breakpoint
2863 conditional expressions, command scripts, and so forth. See
2864 @xref{Convenience Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for general
2865 information on convenience variables.
2867 @kindex thread apply
2868 @cindex apply command to several threads
2869 @item thread apply [@var{threadno} | all] @var{command}
2870 The @code{thread apply} command allows you to apply the named
2871 @var{command} to one or more threads. Specify the numbers of the
2872 threads that you want affected with the command argument
2873 @var{threadno}. It can be a single thread number, one of the numbers
2874 shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads} display; or it
2875 could be a range of thread numbers, as in @code{2-4}. To apply a
2876 command to all threads, type @kbd{thread apply all @var{command}}.
2879 @cindex name a thread
2880 @item thread name [@var{name}]
2881 This command assigns a name to the current thread. If no argument is
2882 given, any existing user-specified name is removed. The thread name
2883 appears in the @samp{info threads} display.
2885 On some systems, such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, @value{GDBN} is able to
2886 determine the name of the thread as given by the OS. On these
2887 systems, a name specified with @samp{thread name} will override the
2888 system-give name, and removing the user-specified name will cause
2889 @value{GDBN} to once again display the system-specified name.
2892 @cindex search for a thread
2893 @item thread find [@var{regexp}]
2894 Search for and display thread ids whose name or @var{systag}
2895 matches the supplied regular expression.
2897 As well as being the complement to the @samp{thread name} command,
2898 this command also allows you to identify a thread by its target
2899 @var{systag}. For instance, on @sc{gnu}/Linux, the target @var{systag}
2903 (@value{GDBN}) thread find 26688
2904 Thread 4 has target id 'Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 26688)'
2905 (@value{GDBN}) info thread 4
2907 4 Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 26688) 0x00000031ca6cd372 in select ()
2910 @kindex set print thread-events
2911 @cindex print messages on thread start and exit
2912 @item set print thread-events
2913 @itemx set print thread-events on
2914 @itemx set print thread-events off
2915 The @code{set print thread-events} command allows you to enable or
2916 disable printing of messages when @value{GDBN} notices that new threads have
2917 started or that threads have exited. By default, these messages will
2918 be printed if detection of these events is supported by the target.
2919 Note that these messages cannot be disabled on all targets.
2921 @kindex show print thread-events
2922 @item show print thread-events
2923 Show whether messages will be printed when @value{GDBN} detects that threads
2924 have started and exited.
2927 @xref{Thread Stops,,Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs}, for
2928 more information about how @value{GDBN} behaves when you stop and start
2929 programs with multiple threads.
2931 @xref{Set Watchpoints,,Setting Watchpoints}, for information about
2932 watchpoints in programs with multiple threads.
2934 @anchor{set libthread-db-search-path}
2936 @kindex set libthread-db-search-path
2937 @cindex search path for @code{libthread_db}
2938 @item set libthread-db-search-path @r{[}@var{path}@r{]}
2939 If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
2940 directories @value{GDBN} will use to search for @code{libthread_db}.
2941 If you omit @var{path}, @samp{libthread-db-search-path} will be reset to
2942 its default value (@code{$sdir:$pdir} on @sc{gnu}/Linux and Solaris systems).
2943 Internally, the default value comes from the @code{LIBTHREAD_DB_SEARCH_PATH}
2946 On @sc{gnu}/Linux and Solaris systems, @value{GDBN} uses a ``helper''
2947 @code{libthread_db} library to obtain information about threads in the
2948 inferior process. @value{GDBN} will use @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
2949 to find @code{libthread_db}. @value{GDBN} also consults first if inferior
2950 specific thread debugging library loading is enabled
2951 by @samp{set auto-load libthread-db} (@pxref{libthread_db.so.1 file}).
2953 A special entry @samp{$sdir} for @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
2954 refers to the default system directories that are
2955 normally searched for loading shared libraries. The @samp{$sdir} entry
2956 is the only kind not needing to be enabled by @samp{set auto-load libthread-db}
2957 (@pxref{libthread_db.so.1 file}).
2959 A special entry @samp{$pdir} for @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
2960 refers to the directory from which @code{libpthread}
2961 was loaded in the inferior process.
2963 For any @code{libthread_db} library @value{GDBN} finds in above directories,
2964 @value{GDBN} attempts to initialize it with the current inferior process.
2965 If this initialization fails (which could happen because of a version
2966 mismatch between @code{libthread_db} and @code{libpthread}), @value{GDBN}
2967 will unload @code{libthread_db}, and continue with the next directory.
2968 If none of @code{libthread_db} libraries initialize successfully,
2969 @value{GDBN} will issue a warning and thread debugging will be disabled.
2971 Setting @code{libthread-db-search-path} is currently implemented
2972 only on some platforms.
2974 @kindex show libthread-db-search-path
2975 @item show libthread-db-search-path
2976 Display current libthread_db search path.
2978 @kindex set debug libthread-db
2979 @kindex show debug libthread-db
2980 @cindex debugging @code{libthread_db}
2981 @item set debug libthread-db
2982 @itemx show debug libthread-db
2983 Turns on or off display of @code{libthread_db}-related events.
2984 Use @code{1} to enable, @code{0} to disable.
2988 @section Debugging Forks
2990 @cindex fork, debugging programs which call
2991 @cindex multiple processes
2992 @cindex processes, multiple
2993 On most systems, @value{GDBN} has no special support for debugging
2994 programs which create additional processes using the @code{fork}
2995 function. When a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug the
2996 parent process and the child process will run unimpeded. If you have
2997 set a breakpoint in any code which the child then executes, the child
2998 will get a @code{SIGTRAP} signal which (unless it catches the signal)
2999 will cause it to terminate.
3001 However, if you want to debug the child process there is a workaround
3002 which isn't too painful. Put a call to @code{sleep} in the code which
3003 the child process executes after the fork. It may be useful to sleep
3004 only if a certain environment variable is set, or a certain file exists,
3005 so that the delay need not occur when you don't want to run @value{GDBN}
3006 on the child. While the child is sleeping, use the @code{ps} program to
3007 get its process ID. Then tell @value{GDBN} (a new invocation of
3008 @value{GDBN} if you are also debugging the parent process) to attach to
3009 the child process (@pxref{Attach}). From that point on you can debug
3010 the child process just like any other process which you attached to.
3012 On some systems, @value{GDBN} provides support for debugging programs that
3013 create additional processes using the @code{fork} or @code{vfork} functions.
3014 Currently, the only platforms with this feature are HP-UX (11.x and later
3015 only?) and @sc{gnu}/Linux (kernel version 2.5.60 and later).
3017 By default, when a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug
3018 the parent process and the child process will run unimpeded.
3020 If you want to follow the child process instead of the parent process,
3021 use the command @w{@code{set follow-fork-mode}}.
3024 @kindex set follow-fork-mode
3025 @item set follow-fork-mode @var{mode}
3026 Set the debugger response to a program call of @code{fork} or
3027 @code{vfork}. A call to @code{fork} or @code{vfork} creates a new
3028 process. The @var{mode} argument can be:
3032 The original process is debugged after a fork. The child process runs
3033 unimpeded. This is the default.
3036 The new process is debugged after a fork. The parent process runs
3041 @kindex show follow-fork-mode
3042 @item show follow-fork-mode
3043 Display the current debugger response to a @code{fork} or @code{vfork} call.
3046 @cindex debugging multiple processes
3047 On Linux, if you want to debug both the parent and child processes, use the
3048 command @w{@code{set detach-on-fork}}.
3051 @kindex set detach-on-fork
3052 @item set detach-on-fork @var{mode}
3053 Tells gdb whether to detach one of the processes after a fork, or
3054 retain debugger control over them both.
3058 The child process (or parent process, depending on the value of
3059 @code{follow-fork-mode}) will be detached and allowed to run
3060 independently. This is the default.
3063 Both processes will be held under the control of @value{GDBN}.
3064 One process (child or parent, depending on the value of
3065 @code{follow-fork-mode}) is debugged as usual, while the other
3070 @kindex show detach-on-fork
3071 @item show detach-on-fork
3072 Show whether detach-on-fork mode is on/off.
3075 If you choose to set @samp{detach-on-fork} mode off, then @value{GDBN}
3076 will retain control of all forked processes (including nested forks).
3077 You can list the forked processes under the control of @value{GDBN} by
3078 using the @w{@code{info inferiors}} command, and switch from one fork
3079 to another by using the @code{inferior} command (@pxref{Inferiors and
3080 Programs, ,Debugging Multiple Inferiors and Programs}).
3082 To quit debugging one of the forked processes, you can either detach
3083 from it by using the @w{@code{detach inferiors}} command (allowing it
3084 to run independently), or kill it using the @w{@code{kill inferiors}}
3085 command. @xref{Inferiors and Programs, ,Debugging Multiple Inferiors
3088 If you ask to debug a child process and a @code{vfork} is followed by an
3089 @code{exec}, @value{GDBN} executes the new target up to the first
3090 breakpoint in the new target. If you have a breakpoint set on
3091 @code{main} in your original program, the breakpoint will also be set on
3092 the child process's @code{main}.
3094 On some systems, when a child process is spawned by @code{vfork}, you
3095 cannot debug the child or parent until an @code{exec} call completes.
3097 If you issue a @code{run} command to @value{GDBN} after an @code{exec}
3098 call executes, the new target restarts. To restart the parent
3099 process, use the @code{file} command with the parent executable name
3100 as its argument. By default, after an @code{exec} call executes,
3101 @value{GDBN} discards the symbols of the previous executable image.
3102 You can change this behaviour with the @w{@code{set follow-exec-mode}}
3106 @kindex set follow-exec-mode
3107 @item set follow-exec-mode @var{mode}
3109 Set debugger response to a program call of @code{exec}. An
3110 @code{exec} call replaces the program image of a process.
3112 @code{follow-exec-mode} can be:
3116 @value{GDBN} creates a new inferior and rebinds the process to this
3117 new inferior. The program the process was running before the
3118 @code{exec} call can be restarted afterwards by restarting the
3124 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3126 Id Description Executable
3129 process 12020 is executing new program: prog2
3130 Program exited normally.
3131 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3132 Id Description Executable
3138 @value{GDBN} keeps the process bound to the same inferior. The new
3139 executable image replaces the previous executable loaded in the
3140 inferior. Restarting the inferior after the @code{exec} call, with
3141 e.g., the @code{run} command, restarts the executable the process was
3142 running after the @code{exec} call. This is the default mode.
3147 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3148 Id Description Executable
3151 process 12020 is executing new program: prog2
3152 Program exited normally.
3153 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3154 Id Description Executable
3161 You can use the @code{catch} command to make @value{GDBN} stop whenever
3162 a @code{fork}, @code{vfork}, or @code{exec} call is made. @xref{Set
3163 Catchpoints, ,Setting Catchpoints}.
3165 @node Checkpoint/Restart
3166 @section Setting a @emph{Bookmark} to Return to Later
3171 @cindex snapshot of a process
3172 @cindex rewind program state
3174 On certain operating systems@footnote{Currently, only
3175 @sc{gnu}/Linux.}, @value{GDBN} is able to save a @dfn{snapshot} of a
3176 program's state, called a @dfn{checkpoint}, and come back to it
3179 Returning to a checkpoint effectively undoes everything that has
3180 happened in the program since the @code{checkpoint} was saved. This
3181 includes changes in memory, registers, and even (within some limits)
3182 system state. Effectively, it is like going back in time to the
3183 moment when the checkpoint was saved.
3185 Thus, if you're stepping thru a program and you think you're
3186 getting close to the point where things go wrong, you can save
3187 a checkpoint. Then, if you accidentally go too far and miss
3188 the critical statement, instead of having to restart your program
3189 from the beginning, you can just go back to the checkpoint and
3190 start again from there.
3192 This can be especially useful if it takes a lot of time or
3193 steps to reach the point where you think the bug occurs.
3195 To use the @code{checkpoint}/@code{restart} method of debugging:
3200 Save a snapshot of the debugged program's current execution state.
3201 The @code{checkpoint} command takes no arguments, but each checkpoint
3202 is assigned a small integer id, similar to a breakpoint id.
3204 @kindex info checkpoints
3205 @item info checkpoints
3206 List the checkpoints that have been saved in the current debugging
3207 session. For each checkpoint, the following information will be
3214 @item Source line, or label
3217 @kindex restart @var{checkpoint-id}
3218 @item restart @var{checkpoint-id}
3219 Restore the program state that was saved as checkpoint number
3220 @var{checkpoint-id}. All program variables, registers, stack frames
3221 etc.@: will be returned to the values that they had when the checkpoint
3222 was saved. In essence, gdb will ``wind back the clock'' to the point
3223 in time when the checkpoint was saved.
3225 Note that breakpoints, @value{GDBN} variables, command history etc.
3226 are not affected by restoring a checkpoint. In general, a checkpoint
3227 only restores things that reside in the program being debugged, not in
3230 @kindex delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
3231 @item delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
3232 Delete the previously-saved checkpoint identified by @var{checkpoint-id}.
3236 Returning to a previously saved checkpoint will restore the user state
3237 of the program being debugged, plus a significant subset of the system
3238 (OS) state, including file pointers. It won't ``un-write'' data from
3239 a file, but it will rewind the file pointer to the previous location,
3240 so that the previously written data can be overwritten. For files
3241 opened in read mode, the pointer will also be restored so that the
3242 previously read data can be read again.
3244 Of course, characters that have been sent to a printer (or other
3245 external device) cannot be ``snatched back'', and characters received
3246 from eg.@: a serial device can be removed from internal program buffers,
3247 but they cannot be ``pushed back'' into the serial pipeline, ready to
3248 be received again. Similarly, the actual contents of files that have
3249 been changed cannot be restored (at this time).
3251 However, within those constraints, you actually can ``rewind'' your
3252 program to a previously saved point in time, and begin debugging it
3253 again --- and you can change the course of events so as to debug a
3254 different execution path this time.
3256 @cindex checkpoints and process id
3257 Finally, there is one bit of internal program state that will be
3258 different when you return to a checkpoint --- the program's process
3259 id. Each checkpoint will have a unique process id (or @var{pid}),
3260 and each will be different from the program's original @var{pid}.
3261 If your program has saved a local copy of its process id, this could
3262 potentially pose a problem.
3264 @subsection A Non-obvious Benefit of Using Checkpoints
3266 On some systems such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, address space randomization
3267 is performed on new processes for security reasons. This makes it
3268 difficult or impossible to set a breakpoint, or watchpoint, on an
3269 absolute address if you have to restart the program, since the
3270 absolute location of a symbol will change from one execution to the
3273 A checkpoint, however, is an @emph{identical} copy of a process.
3274 Therefore if you create a checkpoint at (eg.@:) the start of main,
3275 and simply return to that checkpoint instead of restarting the
3276 process, you can avoid the effects of address randomization and
3277 your symbols will all stay in the same place.
3280 @chapter Stopping and Continuing
3282 The principal purposes of using a debugger are so that you can stop your
3283 program before it terminates; or so that, if your program runs into
3284 trouble, you can investigate and find out why.
3286 Inside @value{GDBN}, your program may stop for any of several reasons,
3287 such as a signal, a breakpoint, or reaching a new line after a
3288 @value{GDBN} command such as @code{step}. You may then examine and
3289 change variables, set new breakpoints or remove old ones, and then
3290 continue execution. Usually, the messages shown by @value{GDBN} provide
3291 ample explanation of the status of your program---but you can also
3292 explicitly request this information at any time.
3295 @kindex info program
3297 Display information about the status of your program: whether it is
3298 running or not, what process it is, and why it stopped.
3302 * Breakpoints:: Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
3303 * Continuing and Stepping:: Resuming execution
3304 * Skipping Over Functions and Files::
3305 Skipping over functions and files
3307 * Thread Stops:: Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
3311 @section Breakpoints, Watchpoints, and Catchpoints
3314 A @dfn{breakpoint} makes your program stop whenever a certain point in
3315 the program is reached. For each breakpoint, you can add conditions to
3316 control in finer detail whether your program stops. You can set
3317 breakpoints with the @code{break} command and its variants (@pxref{Set
3318 Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}), to specify the place where your program
3319 should stop by line number, function name or exact address in the
3322 On some systems, you can set breakpoints in shared libraries before
3323 the executable is run. There is a minor limitation on HP-UX systems:
3324 you must wait until the executable is run in order to set breakpoints
3325 in shared library routines that are not called directly by the program
3326 (for example, routines that are arguments in a @code{pthread_create}
3330 @cindex data breakpoints
3331 @cindex memory tracing
3332 @cindex breakpoint on memory address
3333 @cindex breakpoint on variable modification
3334 A @dfn{watchpoint} is a special breakpoint that stops your program
3335 when the value of an expression changes. The expression may be a value
3336 of a variable, or it could involve values of one or more variables
3337 combined by operators, such as @samp{a + b}. This is sometimes called
3338 @dfn{data breakpoints}. You must use a different command to set
3339 watchpoints (@pxref{Set Watchpoints, ,Setting Watchpoints}), but aside
3340 from that, you can manage a watchpoint like any other breakpoint: you
3341 enable, disable, and delete both breakpoints and watchpoints using the
3344 You can arrange to have values from your program displayed automatically
3345 whenever @value{GDBN} stops at a breakpoint. @xref{Auto Display,,
3349 @cindex breakpoint on events
3350 A @dfn{catchpoint} is another special breakpoint that stops your program
3351 when a certain kind of event occurs, such as the throwing of a C@t{++}
3352 exception or the loading of a library. As with watchpoints, you use a
3353 different command to set a catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints, ,Setting
3354 Catchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a catchpoint like any
3355 other breakpoint. (To stop when your program receives a signal, use the
3356 @code{handle} command; see @ref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
3358 @cindex breakpoint numbers
3359 @cindex numbers for breakpoints
3360 @value{GDBN} assigns a number to each breakpoint, watchpoint, or
3361 catchpoint when you create it; these numbers are successive integers
3362 starting with one. In many of the commands for controlling various
3363 features of breakpoints you use the breakpoint number to say which
3364 breakpoint you want to change. Each breakpoint may be @dfn{enabled} or
3365 @dfn{disabled}; if disabled, it has no effect on your program until you
3368 @cindex breakpoint ranges
3369 @cindex ranges of breakpoints
3370 Some @value{GDBN} commands accept a range of breakpoints on which to
3371 operate. A breakpoint range is either a single breakpoint number, like
3372 @samp{5}, or two such numbers, in increasing order, separated by a
3373 hyphen, like @samp{5-7}. When a breakpoint range is given to a command,
3374 all breakpoints in that range are operated on.
3377 * Set Breaks:: Setting breakpoints
3378 * Set Watchpoints:: Setting watchpoints
3379 * Set Catchpoints:: Setting catchpoints
3380 * Delete Breaks:: Deleting breakpoints
3381 * Disabling:: Disabling breakpoints
3382 * Conditions:: Break conditions
3383 * Break Commands:: Breakpoint command lists
3384 * Dynamic Printf:: Dynamic printf
3385 * Save Breakpoints:: How to save breakpoints in a file
3386 * Static Probe Points:: Listing static probe points
3387 * Error in Breakpoints:: ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
3388 * Breakpoint-related Warnings:: ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
3392 @subsection Setting Breakpoints
3394 @c FIXME LMB what does GDB do if no code on line of breakpt?
3395 @c consider in particular declaration with/without initialization.
3397 @c FIXME 2 is there stuff on this already? break at fun start, already init?
3400 @kindex b @r{(@code{break})}
3401 @vindex $bpnum@r{, convenience variable}
3402 @cindex latest breakpoint
3403 Breakpoints are set with the @code{break} command (abbreviated
3404 @code{b}). The debugger convenience variable @samp{$bpnum} records the
3405 number of the breakpoint you've set most recently; see @ref{Convenience
3406 Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for a discussion of what you can do with
3407 convenience variables.
3410 @item break @var{location}
3411 Set a breakpoint at the given @var{location}, which can specify a
3412 function name, a line number, or an address of an instruction.
3413 (@xref{Specify Location}, for a list of all the possible ways to
3414 specify a @var{location}.) The breakpoint will stop your program just
3415 before it executes any of the code in the specified @var{location}.
3417 When using source languages that permit overloading of symbols, such as
3418 C@t{++}, a function name may refer to more than one possible place to break.
3419 @xref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous Expressions}, for a discussion of
3422 It is also possible to insert a breakpoint that will stop the program
3423 only if a specific thread (@pxref{Thread-Specific Breakpoints})
3424 or a specific task (@pxref{Ada Tasks}) hits that breakpoint.
3427 When called without any arguments, @code{break} sets a breakpoint at
3428 the next instruction to be executed in the selected stack frame
3429 (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the Stack}). In any selected frame but the
3430 innermost, this makes your program stop as soon as control
3431 returns to that frame. This is similar to the effect of a
3432 @code{finish} command in the frame inside the selected frame---except
3433 that @code{finish} does not leave an active breakpoint. If you use
3434 @code{break} without an argument in the innermost frame, @value{GDBN} stops
3435 the next time it reaches the current location; this may be useful
3438 @value{GDBN} normally ignores breakpoints when it resumes execution, until at
3439 least one instruction has been executed. If it did not do this, you
3440 would be unable to proceed past a breakpoint without first disabling the
3441 breakpoint. This rule applies whether or not the breakpoint already
3442 existed when your program stopped.
3444 @item break @dots{} if @var{cond}
3445 Set a breakpoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
3446 @var{cond} each time the breakpoint is reached, and stop only if the
3447 value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
3448 @samp{@dots{}} stands for one of the possible arguments described
3449 above (or no argument) specifying where to break. @xref{Conditions,
3450 ,Break Conditions}, for more information on breakpoint conditions.
3453 @item tbreak @var{args}
3454 Set a breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args} are the
3455 same as for the @code{break} command, and the breakpoint is set in the same
3456 way, but the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the first time your
3457 program stops there. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
3460 @cindex hardware breakpoints
3461 @item hbreak @var{args}
3462 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint. @var{args} are the same as for the
3463 @code{break} command and the breakpoint is set in the same way, but the
3464 breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware may not
3465 have this support. The main purpose of this is EPROM/ROM code
3466 debugging, so you can set a breakpoint at an instruction without
3467 changing the instruction. This can be used with the new trap-generation
3468 provided by SPARClite DSU and most x86-based targets. These targets
3469 will generate traps when a program accesses some data or instruction
3470 address that is assigned to the debug registers. However the hardware
3471 breakpoint registers can take a limited number of breakpoints. For
3472 example, on the DSU, only two data breakpoints can be set at a time, and
3473 @value{GDBN} will reject this command if more than two are used. Delete
3474 or disable unused hardware breakpoints before setting new ones
3475 (@pxref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}).
3476 @xref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
3477 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
3478 breakpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
3479 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
3482 @item thbreak @var{args}
3483 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args}
3484 are the same as for the @code{hbreak} command and the breakpoint is set in
3485 the same way. However, like the @code{tbreak} command,
3486 the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the
3487 first time your program stops there. Also, like the @code{hbreak}
3488 command, the breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware
3489 may not have this support. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
3490 See also @ref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
3493 @cindex regular expression
3494 @cindex breakpoints at functions matching a regexp
3495 @cindex set breakpoints in many functions
3496 @item rbreak @var{regex}
3497 Set breakpoints on all functions matching the regular expression
3498 @var{regex}. This command sets an unconditional breakpoint on all
3499 matches, printing a list of all breakpoints it set. Once these
3500 breakpoints are set, they are treated just like the breakpoints set with
3501 the @code{break} command. You can delete them, disable them, or make
3502 them conditional the same way as any other breakpoint.
3504 The syntax of the regular expression is the standard one used with tools
3505 like @file{grep}. Note that this is different from the syntax used by
3506 shells, so for instance @code{foo*} matches all functions that include
3507 an @code{fo} followed by zero or more @code{o}s. There is an implicit
3508 @code{.*} leading and trailing the regular expression you supply, so to
3509 match only functions that begin with @code{foo}, use @code{^foo}.
3511 @cindex non-member C@t{++} functions, set breakpoint in
3512 When debugging C@t{++} programs, @code{rbreak} is useful for setting
3513 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
3516 @cindex set breakpoints on all functions
3517 The @code{rbreak} command can be used to set breakpoints in
3518 @strong{all} the functions in a program, like this:
3521 (@value{GDBP}) rbreak .
3524 @item rbreak @var{file}:@var{regex}
3525 If @code{rbreak} is called with a filename qualification, it limits
3526 the search for functions matching the given regular expression to the
3527 specified @var{file}. This can be used, for example, to set breakpoints on
3528 every function in a given file:
3531 (@value{GDBP}) rbreak file.c:.
3534 The colon separating the filename qualifier from the regex may
3535 optionally be surrounded by spaces.
3537 @kindex info breakpoints
3538 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info breakpoints}
3539 @item info breakpoints @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
3540 @itemx info break @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
3541 Print a table of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints set and
3542 not deleted. Optional argument @var{n} means print information only
3543 about the specified breakpoint(s) (or watchpoint(s) or catchpoint(s)).
3544 For each breakpoint, following columns are printed:
3547 @item Breakpoint Numbers
3549 Breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint.
3551 Whether the breakpoint is marked to be disabled or deleted when hit.
3552 @item Enabled or Disabled
3553 Enabled breakpoints are marked with @samp{y}. @samp{n} marks breakpoints
3554 that are not enabled.
3556 Where the breakpoint is in your program, as a memory address. For a
3557 pending breakpoint whose address is not yet known, this field will
3558 contain @samp{<PENDING>}. Such breakpoint won't fire until a shared
3559 library that has the symbol or line referred by breakpoint is loaded.
3560 See below for details. A breakpoint with several locations will
3561 have @samp{<MULTIPLE>} in this field---see below for details.
3563 Where the breakpoint is in the source for your program, as a file and
3564 line number. For a pending breakpoint, the original string passed to
3565 the breakpoint command will be listed as it cannot be resolved until
3566 the appropriate shared library is loaded in the future.
3570 If a breakpoint is conditional, there are two evaluation modes: ``host'' and
3571 ``target''. If mode is ``host'', breakpoint condition evaluation is done by
3572 @value{GDBN} on the host's side. If it is ``target'', then the condition
3573 is evaluated by the target. The @code{info break} command shows
3574 the condition on the line following the affected breakpoint, together with
3575 its condition evaluation mode in between parentheses.
3577 Breakpoint commands, if any, are listed after that. A pending breakpoint is
3578 allowed to have a condition specified for it. The condition is not parsed for
3579 validity until a shared library is loaded that allows the pending
3580 breakpoint to resolve to a valid location.
3583 @code{info break} with a breakpoint
3584 number @var{n} as argument lists only that breakpoint. The
3585 convenience variable @code{$_} and the default examining-address for
3586 the @code{x} command are set to the address of the last breakpoint
3587 listed (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}).
3590 @code{info break} displays a count of the number of times the breakpoint
3591 has been hit. This is especially useful in conjunction with the
3592 @code{ignore} command. You can ignore a large number of breakpoint
3593 hits, look at the breakpoint info to see how many times the breakpoint
3594 was hit, and then run again, ignoring one less than that number. This
3595 will get you quickly to the last hit of that breakpoint.
3598 For a breakpoints with an enable count (xref) greater than 1,
3599 @code{info break} also displays that count.
3603 @value{GDBN} allows you to set any number of breakpoints at the same place in
3604 your program. There is nothing silly or meaningless about this. When
3605 the breakpoints are conditional, this is even useful
3606 (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
3608 @cindex multiple locations, breakpoints
3609 @cindex breakpoints, multiple locations
3610 It is possible that a breakpoint corresponds to several locations
3611 in your program. Examples of this situation are:
3615 Multiple functions in the program may have the same name.
3618 For a C@t{++} constructor, the @value{NGCC} compiler generates several
3619 instances of the function body, used in different cases.
3622 For a C@t{++} template function, a given line in the function can
3623 correspond to any number of instantiations.
3626 For an inlined function, a given source line can correspond to
3627 several places where that function is inlined.
3630 In all those cases, @value{GDBN} will insert a breakpoint at all
3631 the relevant locations.
3633 A breakpoint with multiple locations is displayed in the breakpoint
3634 table using several rows---one header row, followed by one row for
3635 each breakpoint location. The header row has @samp{<MULTIPLE>} in the
3636 address column. The rows for individual locations contain the actual
3637 addresses for locations, and show the functions to which those
3638 locations belong. The number column for a location is of the form
3639 @var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number}.
3644 Num Type Disp Enb Address What
3645 1 breakpoint keep y <MULTIPLE>
3647 breakpoint already hit 1 time
3648 1.1 y 0x080486a2 in void foo<int>() at t.cc:8
3649 1.2 y 0x080486ca in void foo<double>() at t.cc:8
3652 Each location can be individually enabled or disabled by passing
3653 @var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number} as argument to the
3654 @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands. Note that you cannot
3655 delete the individual locations from the list, you can only delete the
3656 entire list of locations that belong to their parent breakpoint (with
3657 the @kbd{delete @var{num}} command, where @var{num} is the number of
3658 the parent breakpoint, 1 in the above example). Disabling or enabling
3659 the parent breakpoint (@pxref{Disabling}) affects all of the locations
3660 that belong to that breakpoint.
3662 @cindex pending breakpoints
3663 It's quite common to have a breakpoint inside a shared library.
3664 Shared libraries can be loaded and unloaded explicitly,
3665 and possibly repeatedly, as the program is executed. To support
3666 this use case, @value{GDBN} updates breakpoint locations whenever
3667 any shared library is loaded or unloaded. Typically, you would
3668 set a breakpoint in a shared library at the beginning of your
3669 debugging session, when the library is not loaded, and when the
3670 symbols from the library are not available. When you try to set
3671 breakpoint, @value{GDBN} will ask you if you want to set
3672 a so called @dfn{pending breakpoint}---breakpoint whose address
3673 is not yet resolved.
3675 After the program is run, whenever a new shared library is loaded,
3676 @value{GDBN} reevaluates all the breakpoints. When a newly loaded
3677 shared library contains the symbol or line referred to by some
3678 pending breakpoint, that breakpoint is resolved and becomes an
3679 ordinary breakpoint. When a library is unloaded, all breakpoints
3680 that refer to its symbols or source lines become pending again.
3682 This logic works for breakpoints with multiple locations, too. For
3683 example, if you have a breakpoint in a C@t{++} template function, and
3684 a newly loaded shared library has an instantiation of that template,
3685 a new location is added to the list of locations for the breakpoint.
3687 Except for having unresolved address, pending breakpoints do not
3688 differ from regular breakpoints. You can set conditions or commands,
3689 enable and disable them and perform other breakpoint operations.
3691 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling what
3692 happens when the @samp{break} command cannot resolve breakpoint
3693 address specification to an address:
3695 @kindex set breakpoint pending
3696 @kindex show breakpoint pending
3698 @item set breakpoint pending auto
3699 This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} cannot find the breakpoint
3700 location, it queries you whether a pending breakpoint should be created.
3702 @item set breakpoint pending on
3703 This indicates that an unrecognized breakpoint location should automatically
3704 result in a pending breakpoint being created.
3706 @item set breakpoint pending off
3707 This indicates that pending breakpoints are not to be created. Any
3708 unrecognized breakpoint location results in an error. This setting does
3709 not affect any pending breakpoints previously created.
3711 @item show breakpoint pending
3712 Show the current behavior setting for creating pending breakpoints.
3715 The settings above only affect the @code{break} command and its
3716 variants. Once breakpoint is set, it will be automatically updated
3717 as shared libraries are loaded and unloaded.
3719 @cindex automatic hardware breakpoints
3720 For some targets, @value{GDBN} can automatically decide if hardware or
3721 software breakpoints should be used, depending on whether the
3722 breakpoint address is read-only or read-write. This applies to
3723 breakpoints set with the @code{break} command as well as to internal
3724 breakpoints set by commands like @code{next} and @code{finish}. For
3725 breakpoints set with @code{hbreak}, @value{GDBN} will always use hardware
3728 You can control this automatic behaviour with the following commands::
3730 @kindex set breakpoint auto-hw
3731 @kindex show breakpoint auto-hw
3733 @item set breakpoint auto-hw on
3734 This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} sets a breakpoint, it
3735 will try to use the target memory map to decide if software or hardware
3736 breakpoint must be used.
3738 @item set breakpoint auto-hw off
3739 This indicates @value{GDBN} should not automatically select breakpoint
3740 type. If the target provides a memory map, @value{GDBN} will warn when
3741 trying to set software breakpoint at a read-only address.
3744 @value{GDBN} normally implements breakpoints by replacing the program code
3745 at the breakpoint address with a special instruction, which, when
3746 executed, given control to the debugger. By default, the program
3747 code is so modified only when the program is resumed. As soon as
3748 the program stops, @value{GDBN} restores the original instructions. This
3749 behaviour guards against leaving breakpoints inserted in the
3750 target should gdb abrubptly disconnect. However, with slow remote
3751 targets, inserting and removing breakpoint can reduce the performance.
3752 This behavior can be controlled with the following commands::
3754 @kindex set breakpoint always-inserted
3755 @kindex show breakpoint always-inserted
3757 @item set breakpoint always-inserted off
3758 All breakpoints, including newly added by the user, are inserted in
3759 the target only when the target is resumed. All breakpoints are
3760 removed from the target when it stops.
3762 @item set breakpoint always-inserted on
3763 Causes all breakpoints to be inserted in the target at all times. If
3764 the user adds a new breakpoint, or changes an existing breakpoint, the
3765 breakpoints in the target are updated immediately. A breakpoint is
3766 removed from the target only when breakpoint itself is removed.
3768 @cindex non-stop mode, and @code{breakpoint always-inserted}
3769 @item set breakpoint always-inserted auto
3770 This is the default mode. If @value{GDBN} is controlling the inferior
3771 in non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}), gdb behaves as if
3772 @code{breakpoint always-inserted} mode is on. If @value{GDBN} is
3773 controlling the inferior in all-stop mode, @value{GDBN} behaves as if
3774 @code{breakpoint always-inserted} mode is off.
3777 @value{GDBN} handles conditional breakpoints by evaluating these conditions
3778 when a breakpoint breaks. If the condition is true, then the process being
3779 debugged stops, otherwise the process is resumed.
3781 If the target supports evaluating conditions on its end, @value{GDBN} may
3782 download the breakpoint, together with its conditions, to it.
3784 This feature can be controlled via the following commands:
3786 @kindex set breakpoint condition-evaluation
3787 @kindex show breakpoint condition-evaluation
3789 @item set breakpoint condition-evaluation host
3790 This option commands @value{GDBN} to evaluate the breakpoint
3791 conditions on the host's side. Unconditional breakpoints are sent to
3792 the target which in turn receives the triggers and reports them back to GDB
3793 for condition evaluation. This is the standard evaluation mode.
3795 @item set breakpoint condition-evaluation target
3796 This option commands @value{GDBN} to download breakpoint conditions
3797 to the target at the moment of their insertion. The target
3798 is responsible for evaluating the conditional expression and reporting
3799 breakpoint stop events back to @value{GDBN} whenever the condition
3800 is true. Due to limitations of target-side evaluation, some conditions
3801 cannot be evaluated there, e.g., conditions that depend on local data
3802 that is only known to the host. Examples include
3803 conditional expressions involving convenience variables, complex types
3804 that cannot be handled by the agent expression parser and expressions
3805 that are too long to be sent over to the target, specially when the
3806 target is a remote system. In these cases, the conditions will be
3807 evaluated by @value{GDBN}.
3809 @item set breakpoint condition-evaluation auto
3810 This is the default mode. If the target supports evaluating breakpoint
3811 conditions on its end, @value{GDBN} will download breakpoint conditions to
3812 the target (limitations mentioned previously apply). If the target does
3813 not support breakpoint condition evaluation, then @value{GDBN} will fallback
3814 to evaluating all these conditions on the host's side.
3818 @cindex negative breakpoint numbers
3819 @cindex internal @value{GDBN} breakpoints
3820 @value{GDBN} itself sometimes sets breakpoints in your program for
3821 special purposes, such as proper handling of @code{longjmp} (in C
3822 programs). These internal breakpoints are assigned negative numbers,
3823 starting with @code{-1}; @samp{info breakpoints} does not display them.
3824 You can see these breakpoints with the @value{GDBN} maintenance command
3825 @samp{maint info breakpoints} (@pxref{maint info breakpoints}).
3828 @node Set Watchpoints
3829 @subsection Setting Watchpoints
3831 @cindex setting watchpoints
3832 You can use a watchpoint to stop execution whenever the value of an
3833 expression changes, without having to predict a particular place where
3834 this may happen. (This is sometimes called a @dfn{data breakpoint}.)
3835 The expression may be as simple as the value of a single variable, or
3836 as complex as many variables combined by operators. Examples include:
3840 A reference to the value of a single variable.
3843 An address cast to an appropriate data type. For example,
3844 @samp{*(int *)0x12345678} will watch a 4-byte region at the specified
3845 address (assuming an @code{int} occupies 4 bytes).
3848 An arbitrarily complex expression, such as @samp{a*b + c/d}. The
3849 expression can use any operators valid in the program's native
3850 language (@pxref{Languages}).
3853 You can set a watchpoint on an expression even if the expression can
3854 not be evaluated yet. For instance, you can set a watchpoint on
3855 @samp{*global_ptr} before @samp{global_ptr} is initialized.
3856 @value{GDBN} will stop when your program sets @samp{global_ptr} and
3857 the expression produces a valid value. If the expression becomes
3858 valid in some other way than changing a variable (e.g.@: if the memory
3859 pointed to by @samp{*global_ptr} becomes readable as the result of a
3860 @code{malloc} call), @value{GDBN} may not stop until the next time
3861 the expression changes.
3863 @cindex software watchpoints
3864 @cindex hardware watchpoints
3865 Depending on your system, watchpoints may be implemented in software or
3866 hardware. @value{GDBN} does software watchpointing by single-stepping your
3867 program and testing the variable's value each time, which is hundreds of
3868 times slower than normal execution. (But this may still be worth it, to
3869 catch errors where you have no clue what part of your program is the
3872 On some systems, such as HP-UX, PowerPC, @sc{gnu}/Linux and most other
3873 x86-based targets, @value{GDBN} includes support for hardware
3874 watchpoints, which do not slow down the running of your program.
3878 @item watch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]} @r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}
3879 Set a watchpoint for an expression. @value{GDBN} will break when the
3880 expression @var{expr} is written into by the program and its value
3881 changes. The simplest (and the most popular) use of this command is
3882 to watch the value of a single variable:
3885 (@value{GDBP}) watch foo
3888 If the command includes a @code{@r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]}}
3889 argument, @value{GDBN} breaks only when the thread identified by
3890 @var{threadnum} changes the value of @var{expr}. If any other threads
3891 change the value of @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} will not break. Note
3892 that watchpoints restricted to a single thread in this way only work
3893 with Hardware Watchpoints.
3895 Ordinarily a watchpoint respects the scope of variables in @var{expr}
3896 (see below). The @code{-location} argument tells @value{GDBN} to
3897 instead watch the memory referred to by @var{expr}. In this case,
3898 @value{GDBN} will evaluate @var{expr}, take the address of the result,
3899 and watch the memory at that address. The type of the result is used
3900 to determine the size of the watched memory. If the expression's
3901 result does not have an address, then @value{GDBN} will print an
3904 The @code{@r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}} argument allows creation
3905 of masked watchpoints, if the current architecture supports this
3906 feature (e.g., PowerPC Embedded architecture, see @ref{PowerPC
3907 Embedded}.) A @dfn{masked watchpoint} specifies a mask in addition
3908 to an address to watch. The mask specifies that some bits of an address
3909 (the bits which are reset in the mask) should be ignored when matching
3910 the address accessed by the inferior against the watchpoint address.
3911 Thus, a masked watchpoint watches many addresses simultaneously---those
3912 addresses whose unmasked bits are identical to the unmasked bits in the
3913 watchpoint address. The @code{mask} argument implies @code{-location}.
3917 (@value{GDBP}) watch foo mask 0xffff00ff
3918 (@value{GDBP}) watch *0xdeadbeef mask 0xffffff00
3922 @item rwatch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]} @r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}
3923 Set a watchpoint that will break when the value of @var{expr} is read
3927 @item awatch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]} @r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}
3928 Set a watchpoint that will break when @var{expr} is either read from
3929 or written into by the program.
3931 @kindex info watchpoints @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
3932 @item info watchpoints @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
3933 This command prints a list of watchpoints, using the same format as
3934 @code{info break} (@pxref{Set Breaks}).
3937 If you watch for a change in a numerically entered address you need to
3938 dereference it, as the address itself is just a constant number which will
3939 never change. @value{GDBN} refuses to create a watchpoint that watches
3940 a never-changing value:
3943 (@value{GDBP}) watch 0x600850
3944 Cannot watch constant value 0x600850.
3945 (@value{GDBP}) watch *(int *) 0x600850
3946 Watchpoint 1: *(int *) 6293584
3949 @value{GDBN} sets a @dfn{hardware watchpoint} if possible. Hardware
3950 watchpoints execute very quickly, and the debugger reports a change in
3951 value at the exact instruction where the change occurs. If @value{GDBN}
3952 cannot set a hardware watchpoint, it sets a software watchpoint, which
3953 executes more slowly and reports the change in value at the next
3954 @emph{statement}, not the instruction, after the change occurs.
3956 @cindex use only software watchpoints
3957 You can force @value{GDBN} to use only software watchpoints with the
3958 @kbd{set can-use-hw-watchpoints 0} command. With this variable set to
3959 zero, @value{GDBN} will never try to use hardware watchpoints, even if
3960 the underlying system supports them. (Note that hardware-assisted
3961 watchpoints that were set @emph{before} setting
3962 @code{can-use-hw-watchpoints} to zero will still use the hardware
3963 mechanism of watching expression values.)
3966 @item set can-use-hw-watchpoints
3967 @kindex set can-use-hw-watchpoints
3968 Set whether or not to use hardware watchpoints.
3970 @item show can-use-hw-watchpoints
3971 @kindex show can-use-hw-watchpoints
3972 Show the current mode of using hardware watchpoints.
3975 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
3976 watchpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
3977 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
3979 When you issue the @code{watch} command, @value{GDBN} reports
3982 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: @var{expr}
3986 if it was able to set a hardware watchpoint.
3988 Currently, the @code{awatch} and @code{rwatch} commands can only set
3989 hardware watchpoints, because accesses to data that don't change the
3990 value of the watched expression cannot be detected without examining
3991 every instruction as it is being executed, and @value{GDBN} does not do
3992 that currently. If @value{GDBN} finds that it is unable to set a
3993 hardware breakpoint with the @code{awatch} or @code{rwatch} command, it
3994 will print a message like this:
3997 Expression cannot be implemented with read/access watchpoint.
4000 Sometimes, @value{GDBN} cannot set a hardware watchpoint because the
4001 data type of the watched expression is wider than what a hardware
4002 watchpoint on the target machine can handle. For example, some systems
4003 can only watch regions that are up to 4 bytes wide; on such systems you
4004 cannot set hardware watchpoints for an expression that yields a
4005 double-precision floating-point number (which is typically 8 bytes
4006 wide). As a work-around, it might be possible to break the large region
4007 into a series of smaller ones and watch them with separate watchpoints.
4009 If you set too many hardware watchpoints, @value{GDBN} might be unable
4010 to insert all of them when you resume the execution of your program.
4011 Since the precise number of active watchpoints is unknown until such
4012 time as the program is about to be resumed, @value{GDBN} might not be
4013 able to warn you about this when you set the watchpoints, and the
4014 warning will be printed only when the program is resumed:
4017 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: Could not insert watchpoint
4021 If this happens, delete or disable some of the watchpoints.
4023 Watching complex expressions that reference many variables can also
4024 exhaust the resources available for hardware-assisted watchpoints.
4025 That's because @value{GDBN} needs to watch every variable in the
4026 expression with separately allocated resources.
4028 If you call a function interactively using @code{print} or @code{call},
4029 any watchpoints you have set will be inactive until @value{GDBN} reaches another
4030 kind of breakpoint or the call completes.
4032 @value{GDBN} automatically deletes watchpoints that watch local
4033 (automatic) variables, or expressions that involve such variables, when
4034 they go out of scope, that is, when the execution leaves the block in
4035 which these variables were defined. In particular, when the program
4036 being debugged terminates, @emph{all} local variables go out of scope,
4037 and so only watchpoints that watch global variables remain set. If you
4038 rerun the program, you will need to set all such watchpoints again. One
4039 way of doing that would be to set a code breakpoint at the entry to the
4040 @code{main} function and when it breaks, set all the watchpoints.
4042 @cindex watchpoints and threads
4043 @cindex threads and watchpoints
4044 In multi-threaded programs, watchpoints will detect changes to the
4045 watched expression from every thread.
4048 @emph{Warning:} In multi-threaded programs, software watchpoints
4049 have only limited usefulness. If @value{GDBN} creates a software
4050 watchpoint, it can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a
4051 single thread}. If you are confident that the expression can only
4052 change due to the current thread's activity (and if you are also
4053 confident that no other thread can become current), then you can use
4054 software watchpoints as usual. However, @value{GDBN} may not notice
4055 when a non-current thread's activity changes the expression. (Hardware
4056 watchpoints, in contrast, watch an expression in all threads.)
4059 @xref{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}.
4061 @node Set Catchpoints
4062 @subsection Setting Catchpoints
4063 @cindex catchpoints, setting
4064 @cindex exception handlers
4065 @cindex event handling
4067 You can use @dfn{catchpoints} to cause the debugger to stop for certain
4068 kinds of program events, such as C@t{++} exceptions or the loading of a
4069 shared library. Use the @code{catch} command to set a catchpoint.
4073 @item catch @var{event}
4074 Stop when @var{event} occurs. @var{event} can be any of the following:
4077 @item throw @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
4078 @itemx rethrow @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
4079 @itemx catch @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
4080 @cindex stop on C@t{++} exceptions
4081 The throwing, re-throwing, or catching of a C@t{++} exception.
4083 If @var{regexp} is given, then only exceptions whose type matches the
4084 regular expression will be caught.
4086 @vindex $_exception@r{, convenience variable}
4087 The convenience variable @code{$_exception} is available at an
4088 exception-related catchpoint, on some systems. This holds the
4089 exception being thrown.
4091 There are currently some limitations to C@t{++} exception handling in
4096 The support for these commands is system-dependent. Currently, only
4097 systems using the @samp{gnu-v3} C@t{++} ABI (@pxref{ABI}) are
4101 The regular expression feature and the @code{$_exception} convenience
4102 variable rely on the presence of some SDT probes in @code{libstdc++}.
4103 If these probes are not present, then these features cannot be used.
4104 These probes were first available in the GCC 4.8 release, but whether
4105 or not they are available in your GCC also depends on how it was
4109 The @code{$_exception} convenience variable is only valid at the
4110 instruction at which an exception-related catchpoint is set.
4113 When an exception-related catchpoint is hit, @value{GDBN} stops at a
4114 location in the system library which implements runtime exception
4115 support for C@t{++}, usually @code{libstdc++}. You can use @code{up}
4116 (@pxref{Selection}) to get to your code.
4119 If you call a function interactively, @value{GDBN} normally returns
4120 control to you when the function has finished executing. If the call
4121 raises an exception, however, the call may bypass the mechanism that
4122 returns control to you and cause your program either to abort or to
4123 simply continue running until it hits a breakpoint, catches a signal
4124 that @value{GDBN} is listening for, or exits. This is the case even if
4125 you set a catchpoint for the exception; catchpoints on exceptions are
4126 disabled within interactive calls. @xref{Calling}, for information on
4127 controlling this with @code{set unwind-on-terminating-exception}.
4130 You cannot raise an exception interactively.
4133 You cannot install an exception handler interactively.
4137 @cindex Ada exception catching
4138 @cindex catch Ada exceptions
4139 An Ada exception being raised. If an exception name is specified
4140 at the end of the command (eg @code{catch exception Program_Error}),
4141 the debugger will stop only when this specific exception is raised.
4142 Otherwise, the debugger stops execution when any Ada exception is raised.
4144 When inserting an exception catchpoint on a user-defined exception whose
4145 name is identical to one of the exceptions defined by the language, the
4146 fully qualified name must be used as the exception name. Otherwise,
4147 @value{GDBN} will assume that it should stop on the pre-defined exception
4148 rather than the user-defined one. For instance, assuming an exception
4149 called @code{Constraint_Error} is defined in package @code{Pck}, then
4150 the command to use to catch such exceptions is @kbd{catch exception
4151 Pck.Constraint_Error}.
4153 @item exception unhandled
4154 An exception that was raised but is not handled by the program.
4157 A failed Ada assertion.
4160 @cindex break on fork/exec
4161 A call to @code{exec}. This is currently only available for HP-UX
4165 @itemx syscall @r{[}@var{name} @r{|} @var{number}@r{]} @dots{}
4166 @cindex break on a system call.
4167 A call to or return from a system call, a.k.a.@: @dfn{syscall}. A
4168 syscall is a mechanism for application programs to request a service
4169 from the operating system (OS) or one of the OS system services.
4170 @value{GDBN} can catch some or all of the syscalls issued by the
4171 debuggee, and show the related information for each syscall. If no
4172 argument is specified, calls to and returns from all system calls
4175 @var{name} can be any system call name that is valid for the
4176 underlying OS. Just what syscalls are valid depends on the OS. On
4177 GNU and Unix systems, you can find the full list of valid syscall
4178 names on @file{/usr/include/asm/unistd.h}.
4180 @c For MS-Windows, the syscall names and the corresponding numbers
4181 @c can be found, e.g., on this URL:
4182 @c http://www.metasploit.com/users/opcode/syscalls.html
4183 @c but we don't support Windows syscalls yet.
4185 Normally, @value{GDBN} knows in advance which syscalls are valid for
4186 each OS, so you can use the @value{GDBN} command-line completion
4187 facilities (@pxref{Completion,, command completion}) to list the
4190 You may also specify the system call numerically. A syscall's
4191 number is the value passed to the OS's syscall dispatcher to
4192 identify the requested service. When you specify the syscall by its
4193 name, @value{GDBN} uses its database of syscalls to convert the name
4194 into the corresponding numeric code, but using the number directly
4195 may be useful if @value{GDBN}'s database does not have the complete
4196 list of syscalls on your system (e.g., because @value{GDBN} lags
4197 behind the OS upgrades).
4199 The example below illustrates how this command works if you don't provide
4203 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall
4204 Catchpoint 1 (syscall)
4206 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4208 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'close'), \
4209 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4213 Catchpoint 1 (returned from syscall 'close'), \
4214 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4218 Here is an example of catching a system call by name:
4221 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall chroot
4222 Catchpoint 1 (syscall 'chroot' [61])
4224 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4226 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'chroot'), \
4227 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4231 Catchpoint 1 (returned from syscall 'chroot'), \
4232 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4236 An example of specifying a system call numerically. In the case
4237 below, the syscall number has a corresponding entry in the XML
4238 file, so @value{GDBN} finds its name and prints it:
4241 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 252
4242 Catchpoint 1 (syscall(s) 'exit_group')
4244 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4246 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'exit_group'), \
4247 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4251 Program exited normally.
4255 However, there can be situations when there is no corresponding name
4256 in XML file for that syscall number. In this case, @value{GDBN} prints
4257 a warning message saying that it was not able to find the syscall name,
4258 but the catchpoint will be set anyway. See the example below:
4261 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 764
4262 warning: The number '764' does not represent a known syscall.
4263 Catchpoint 2 (syscall 764)
4267 If you configure @value{GDBN} using the @samp{--without-expat} option,
4268 it will not be able to display syscall names. Also, if your
4269 architecture does not have an XML file describing its system calls,
4270 you will not be able to see the syscall names. It is important to
4271 notice that these two features are used for accessing the syscall
4272 name database. In either case, you will see a warning like this:
4275 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall
4276 warning: Could not open "syscalls/i386-linux.xml"
4277 warning: Could not load the syscall XML file 'syscalls/i386-linux.xml'.
4278 GDB will not be able to display syscall names.
4279 Catchpoint 1 (syscall)
4283 Of course, the file name will change depending on your architecture and system.
4285 Still using the example above, you can also try to catch a syscall by its
4286 number. In this case, you would see something like:
4289 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 252
4290 Catchpoint 1 (syscall(s) 252)
4293 Again, in this case @value{GDBN} would not be able to display syscall's names.
4296 A call to @code{fork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX
4300 A call to @code{vfork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX
4303 @item load @r{[}regexp@r{]}
4304 @itemx unload @r{[}regexp@r{]}
4305 The loading or unloading of a shared library. If @var{regexp} is
4306 given, then the catchpoint will stop only if the regular expression
4307 matches one of the affected libraries.
4309 @item signal @r{[}@var{signal}@dots{} @r{|} @samp{all}@r{]}
4310 The delivery of a signal.
4312 With no arguments, this catchpoint will catch any signal that is not
4313 used internally by @value{GDBN}, specifically, all signals except
4314 @samp{SIGTRAP} and @samp{SIGINT}.
4316 With the argument @samp{all}, all signals, including those used by
4317 @value{GDBN}, will be caught. This argument cannot be used with other
4320 Otherwise, the arguments are a list of signal names as given to
4321 @code{handle} (@pxref{Signals}). Only signals specified in this list
4324 One reason that @code{catch signal} can be more useful than
4325 @code{handle} is that you can attach commands and conditions to the
4328 When a signal is caught by a catchpoint, the signal's @code{stop} and
4329 @code{print} settings, as specified by @code{handle}, are ignored.
4330 However, whether the signal is still delivered to the inferior depends
4331 on the @code{pass} setting; this can be changed in the catchpoint's
4336 @item tcatch @var{event}
4337 Set a catchpoint that is enabled only for one stop. The catchpoint is
4338 automatically deleted after the first time the event is caught.
4342 Use the @code{info break} command to list the current catchpoints.
4346 @subsection Deleting Breakpoints
4348 @cindex clearing breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
4349 @cindex deleting breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
4350 It is often necessary to eliminate a breakpoint, watchpoint, or
4351 catchpoint once it has done its job and you no longer want your program
4352 to stop there. This is called @dfn{deleting} the breakpoint. A
4353 breakpoint that has been deleted no longer exists; it is forgotten.
4355 With the @code{clear} command you can delete breakpoints according to
4356 where they are in your program. With the @code{delete} command you can
4357 delete individual breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints by specifying
4358 their breakpoint numbers.
4360 It is not necessary to delete a breakpoint to proceed past it. @value{GDBN}
4361 automatically ignores breakpoints on the first instruction to be executed
4362 when you continue execution without changing the execution address.
4367 Delete any breakpoints at the next instruction to be executed in the
4368 selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). When
4369 the innermost frame is selected, this is a good way to delete a
4370 breakpoint where your program just stopped.
4372 @item clear @var{location}
4373 Delete any breakpoints set at the specified @var{location}.
4374 @xref{Specify Location}, for the various forms of @var{location}; the
4375 most useful ones are listed below:
4378 @item clear @var{function}
4379 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{function}
4380 Delete any breakpoints set at entry to the named @var{function}.
4382 @item clear @var{linenum}
4383 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
4384 Delete any breakpoints set at or within the code of the specified
4385 @var{linenum} of the specified @var{filename}.
4388 @cindex delete breakpoints
4390 @kindex d @r{(@code{delete})}
4391 @item delete @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
4392 Delete the breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints of the breakpoint
4393 ranges specified as arguments. If no argument is specified, delete all
4394 breakpoints (@value{GDBN} asks confirmation, unless you have @code{set
4395 confirm off}). You can abbreviate this command as @code{d}.
4399 @subsection Disabling Breakpoints
4401 @cindex enable/disable a breakpoint
4402 Rather than deleting a breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint, you might
4403 prefer to @dfn{disable} it. This makes the breakpoint inoperative as if
4404 it had been deleted, but remembers the information on the breakpoint so
4405 that you can @dfn{enable} it again later.
4407 You disable and enable breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints with
4408 the @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands, optionally specifying
4409 one or more breakpoint numbers as arguments. Use @code{info break} to
4410 print a list of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints if you
4411 do not know which numbers to use.
4413 Disabling and enabling a breakpoint that has multiple locations
4414 affects all of its locations.
4416 A breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint can have any of several
4417 different states of enablement:
4421 Enabled. The breakpoint stops your program. A breakpoint set
4422 with the @code{break} command starts out in this state.
4424 Disabled. The breakpoint has no effect on your program.
4426 Enabled once. The breakpoint stops your program, but then becomes
4429 Enabled for a count. The breakpoint stops your program for the next
4430 N times, then becomes disabled.
4432 Enabled for deletion. The breakpoint stops your program, but
4433 immediately after it does so it is deleted permanently. A breakpoint
4434 set with the @code{tbreak} command starts out in this state.
4437 You can use the following commands to enable or disable breakpoints,
4438 watchpoints, and catchpoints:
4442 @kindex dis @r{(@code{disable})}
4443 @item disable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
4444 Disable the specified breakpoints---or all breakpoints, if none are
4445 listed. A disabled breakpoint has no effect but is not forgotten. All
4446 options such as ignore-counts, conditions and commands are remembered in
4447 case the breakpoint is enabled again later. You may abbreviate
4448 @code{disable} as @code{dis}.
4451 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
4452 Enable the specified breakpoints (or all defined breakpoints). They
4453 become effective once again in stopping your program.
4455 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} once @var{range}@dots{}
4456 Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} disables any
4457 of these breakpoints immediately after stopping your program.
4459 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} count @var{count} @var{range}@dots{}
4460 Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} records
4461 @var{count} with each of the specified breakpoints, and decrements a
4462 breakpoint's count when it is hit. When any count reaches 0,
4463 @value{GDBN} disables that breakpoint. If a breakpoint has an ignore
4464 count (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}), that will be
4465 decremented to 0 before @var{count} is affected.
4467 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} delete @var{range}@dots{}
4468 Enable the specified breakpoints to work once, then die. @value{GDBN}
4469 deletes any of these breakpoints as soon as your program stops there.
4470 Breakpoints set by the @code{tbreak} command start out in this state.
4473 @c FIXME: I think the following ``Except for [...] @code{tbreak}'' is
4474 @c confusing: tbreak is also initially enabled.
4475 Except for a breakpoint set with @code{tbreak} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
4476 ,Setting Breakpoints}), breakpoints that you set are initially enabled;
4477 subsequently, they become disabled or enabled only when you use one of
4478 the commands above. (The command @code{until} can set and delete a
4479 breakpoint of its own, but it does not change the state of your other
4480 breakpoints; see @ref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and
4484 @subsection Break Conditions
4485 @cindex conditional breakpoints
4486 @cindex breakpoint conditions
4488 @c FIXME what is scope of break condition expr? Context where wanted?
4489 @c in particular for a watchpoint?
4490 The simplest sort of breakpoint breaks every time your program reaches a
4491 specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for a
4492 breakpoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
4493 programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A breakpoint with
4494 a condition evaluates the expression each time your program reaches it,
4495 and your program stops only if the condition is @emph{true}.
4497 This is the converse of using assertions for program validation; in that
4498 situation, you want to stop when the assertion is violated---that is,
4499 when the condition is false. In C, if you want to test an assertion expressed
4500 by the condition @var{assert}, you should set the condition
4501 @samp{! @var{assert}} on the appropriate breakpoint.
4503 Conditions are also accepted for watchpoints; you may not need them,
4504 since a watchpoint is inspecting the value of an expression anyhow---but
4505 it might be simpler, say, to just set a watchpoint on a variable name,
4506 and specify a condition that tests whether the new value is an interesting
4509 Break conditions can have side effects, and may even call functions in
4510 your program. This can be useful, for example, to activate functions
4511 that log program progress, or to use your own print functions to
4512 format special data structures. The effects are completely predictable
4513 unless there is another enabled breakpoint at the same address. (In
4514 that case, @value{GDBN} might see the other breakpoint first and stop your
4515 program without checking the condition of this one.) Note that
4516 breakpoint commands are usually more convenient and flexible than break
4518 purpose of performing side effects when a breakpoint is reached
4519 (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint Command Lists}).
4521 Breakpoint conditions can also be evaluated on the target's side if
4522 the target supports it. Instead of evaluating the conditions locally,
4523 @value{GDBN} encodes the expression into an agent expression
4524 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}) suitable for execution on the target,
4525 independently of @value{GDBN}. Global variables become raw memory
4526 locations, locals become stack accesses, and so forth.
4528 In this case, @value{GDBN} will only be notified of a breakpoint trigger
4529 when its condition evaluates to true. This mechanism may provide faster
4530 response times depending on the performance characteristics of the target
4531 since it does not need to keep @value{GDBN} informed about
4532 every breakpoint trigger, even those with false conditions.
4534 Break conditions can be specified when a breakpoint is set, by using
4535 @samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{break} command. @xref{Set
4536 Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}. They can also be changed at any time
4537 with the @code{condition} command.
4539 You can also use the @code{if} keyword with the @code{watch} command.
4540 The @code{catch} command does not recognize the @code{if} keyword;
4541 @code{condition} is the only way to impose a further condition on a
4546 @item condition @var{bnum} @var{expression}
4547 Specify @var{expression} as the break condition for breakpoint,
4548 watchpoint, or catchpoint number @var{bnum}. After you set a condition,
4549 breakpoint @var{bnum} stops your program only if the value of
4550 @var{expression} is true (nonzero, in C). When you use
4551 @code{condition}, @value{GDBN} checks @var{expression} immediately for
4552 syntactic correctness, and to determine whether symbols in it have
4553 referents in the context of your breakpoint. If @var{expression} uses
4554 symbols not referenced in the context of the breakpoint, @value{GDBN}
4555 prints an error message:
4558 No symbol "foo" in current context.
4563 not actually evaluate @var{expression} at the time the @code{condition}
4564 command (or a command that sets a breakpoint with a condition, like
4565 @code{break if @dots{}}) is given, however. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
4567 @item condition @var{bnum}
4568 Remove the condition from breakpoint number @var{bnum}. It becomes
4569 an ordinary unconditional breakpoint.
4572 @cindex ignore count (of breakpoint)
4573 A special case of a breakpoint condition is to stop only when the
4574 breakpoint has been reached a certain number of times. This is so
4575 useful that there is a special way to do it, using the @dfn{ignore
4576 count} of the breakpoint. Every breakpoint has an ignore count, which
4577 is an integer. Most of the time, the ignore count is zero, and
4578 therefore has no effect. But if your program reaches a breakpoint whose
4579 ignore count is positive, then instead of stopping, it just decrements
4580 the ignore count by one and continues. As a result, if the ignore count
4581 value is @var{n}, the breakpoint does not stop the next @var{n} times
4582 your program reaches it.
4586 @item ignore @var{bnum} @var{count}
4587 Set the ignore count of breakpoint number @var{bnum} to @var{count}.
4588 The next @var{count} times the breakpoint is reached, your program's
4589 execution does not stop; other than to decrement the ignore count, @value{GDBN}
4592 To make the breakpoint stop the next time it is reached, specify
4595 When you use @code{continue} to resume execution of your program from a
4596 breakpoint, you can specify an ignore count directly as an argument to
4597 @code{continue}, rather than using @code{ignore}. @xref{Continuing and
4598 Stepping,,Continuing and Stepping}.
4600 If a breakpoint has a positive ignore count and a condition, the
4601 condition is not checked. Once the ignore count reaches zero,
4602 @value{GDBN} resumes checking the condition.
4604 You could achieve the effect of the ignore count with a condition such
4605 as @w{@samp{$foo-- <= 0}} using a debugger convenience variable that
4606 is decremented each time. @xref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
4610 Ignore counts apply to breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints.
4613 @node Break Commands
4614 @subsection Breakpoint Command Lists
4616 @cindex breakpoint commands
4617 You can give any breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint) a series of
4618 commands to execute when your program stops due to that breakpoint. For
4619 example, you might want to print the values of certain expressions, or
4620 enable other breakpoints.
4624 @kindex end@r{ (breakpoint commands)}
4625 @item commands @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
4626 @itemx @dots{} @var{command-list} @dots{}
4628 Specify a list of commands for the given breakpoints. The commands
4629 themselves appear on the following lines. Type a line containing just
4630 @code{end} to terminate the commands.
4632 To remove all commands from a breakpoint, type @code{commands} and
4633 follow it immediately with @code{end}; that is, give no commands.
4635 With no argument, @code{commands} refers to the last breakpoint,
4636 watchpoint, or catchpoint set (not to the breakpoint most recently
4637 encountered). If the most recent breakpoints were set with a single
4638 command, then the @code{commands} will apply to all the breakpoints
4639 set by that command. This applies to breakpoints set by
4640 @code{rbreak}, and also applies when a single @code{break} command
4641 creates multiple breakpoints (@pxref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous
4645 Pressing @key{RET} as a means of repeating the last @value{GDBN} command is
4646 disabled within a @var{command-list}.
4648 You can use breakpoint commands to start your program up again. Simply
4649 use the @code{continue} command, or @code{step}, or any other command
4650 that resumes execution.
4652 Any other commands in the command list, after a command that resumes
4653 execution, are ignored. This is because any time you resume execution
4654 (even with a simple @code{next} or @code{step}), you may encounter
4655 another breakpoint---which could have its own command list, leading to
4656 ambiguities about which list to execute.
4659 If the first command you specify in a command list is @code{silent}, the
4660 usual message about stopping at a breakpoint is not printed. This may
4661 be desirable for breakpoints that are to print a specific message and
4662 then continue. If none of the remaining commands print anything, you
4663 see no sign that the breakpoint was reached. @code{silent} is
4664 meaningful only at the beginning of a breakpoint command list.
4666 The commands @code{echo}, @code{output}, and @code{printf} allow you to
4667 print precisely controlled output, and are often useful in silent
4668 breakpoints. @xref{Output, ,Commands for Controlled Output}.
4670 For example, here is how you could use breakpoint commands to print the
4671 value of @code{x} at entry to @code{foo} whenever @code{x} is positive.
4677 printf "x is %d\n",x
4682 One application for breakpoint commands is to compensate for one bug so
4683 you can test for another. Put a breakpoint just after the erroneous line
4684 of code, give it a condition to detect the case in which something
4685 erroneous has been done, and give it commands to assign correct values
4686 to any variables that need them. End with the @code{continue} command
4687 so that your program does not stop, and start with the @code{silent}
4688 command so that no output is produced. Here is an example:
4699 @node Dynamic Printf
4700 @subsection Dynamic Printf
4702 @cindex dynamic printf
4704 The dynamic printf command @code{dprintf} combines a breakpoint with
4705 formatted printing of your program's data to give you the effect of
4706 inserting @code{printf} calls into your program on-the-fly, without
4707 having to recompile it.
4709 In its most basic form, the output goes to the GDB console. However,
4710 you can set the variable @code{dprintf-style} for alternate handling.
4711 For instance, you can ask to format the output by calling your
4712 program's @code{printf} function. This has the advantage that the
4713 characters go to the program's output device, so they can recorded in
4714 redirects to files and so forth.
4716 If you are doing remote debugging with a stub or agent, you can also
4717 ask to have the printf handled by the remote agent. In addition to
4718 ensuring that the output goes to the remote program's device along
4719 with any other output the program might produce, you can also ask that
4720 the dprintf remain active even after disconnecting from the remote
4721 target. Using the stub/agent is also more efficient, as it can do
4722 everything without needing to communicate with @value{GDBN}.
4726 @item dprintf @var{location},@var{template},@var{expression}[,@var{expression}@dots{}]
4727 Whenever execution reaches @var{location}, print the values of one or
4728 more @var{expressions} under the control of the string @var{template}.
4729 To print several values, separate them with commas.
4731 @item set dprintf-style @var{style}
4732 Set the dprintf output to be handled in one of several different
4733 styles enumerated below. A change of style affects all existing
4734 dynamic printfs immediately. (If you need individual control over the
4735 print commands, simply define normal breakpoints with
4736 explicitly-supplied command lists.)
4739 @kindex dprintf-style gdb
4740 Handle the output using the @value{GDBN} @code{printf} command.
4743 @kindex dprintf-style call
4744 Handle the output by calling a function in your program (normally
4748 @kindex dprintf-style agent
4749 Have the remote debugging agent (such as @code{gdbserver}) handle
4750 the output itself. This style is only available for agents that
4751 support running commands on the target.
4753 @item set dprintf-function @var{function}
4754 Set the function to call if the dprintf style is @code{call}. By
4755 default its value is @code{printf}. You may set it to any expression.
4756 that @value{GDBN} can evaluate to a function, as per the @code{call}
4759 @item set dprintf-channel @var{channel}
4760 Set a ``channel'' for dprintf. If set to a non-empty value,
4761 @value{GDBN} will evaluate it as an expression and pass the result as
4762 a first argument to the @code{dprintf-function}, in the manner of
4763 @code{fprintf} and similar functions. Otherwise, the dprintf format
4764 string will be the first argument, in the manner of @code{printf}.
4766 As an example, if you wanted @code{dprintf} output to go to a logfile
4767 that is a standard I/O stream assigned to the variable @code{mylog},
4768 you could do the following:
4771 (gdb) set dprintf-style call
4772 (gdb) set dprintf-function fprintf
4773 (gdb) set dprintf-channel mylog
4774 (gdb) dprintf 25,"at line 25, glob=%d\n",glob
4775 Dprintf 1 at 0x123456: file main.c, line 25.
4777 1 dprintf keep y 0x00123456 in main at main.c:25
4778 call (void) fprintf (mylog,"at line 25, glob=%d\n",glob)
4783 Note that the @code{info break} displays the dynamic printf commands
4784 as normal breakpoint commands; you can thus easily see the effect of
4785 the variable settings.
4787 @item set disconnected-dprintf on
4788 @itemx set disconnected-dprintf off
4789 @kindex set disconnected-dprintf
4790 Choose whether @code{dprintf} commands should continue to run if
4791 @value{GDBN} has disconnected from the target. This only applies
4792 if the @code{dprintf-style} is @code{agent}.
4794 @item show disconnected-dprintf off
4795 @kindex show disconnected-dprintf
4796 Show the current choice for disconnected @code{dprintf}.
4800 @value{GDBN} does not check the validity of function and channel,
4801 relying on you to supply values that are meaningful for the contexts
4802 in which they are being used. For instance, the function and channel
4803 may be the values of local variables, but if that is the case, then
4804 all enabled dynamic prints must be at locations within the scope of
4805 those locals. If evaluation fails, @value{GDBN} will report an error.
4807 @node Save Breakpoints
4808 @subsection How to save breakpoints to a file
4810 To save breakpoint definitions to a file use the @w{@code{save
4811 breakpoints}} command.
4814 @kindex save breakpoints
4815 @cindex save breakpoints to a file for future sessions
4816 @item save breakpoints [@var{filename}]
4817 This command saves all current breakpoint definitions together with
4818 their commands and ignore counts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
4819 suitable for use in a later debugging session. This includes all
4820 types of breakpoints (breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints,
4821 tracepoints). To read the saved breakpoint definitions, use the
4822 @code{source} command (@pxref{Command Files}). Note that watchpoints
4823 with expressions involving local variables may fail to be recreated
4824 because it may not be possible to access the context where the
4825 watchpoint is valid anymore. Because the saved breakpoint definitions
4826 are simply a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands that recreate the
4827 breakpoints, you can edit the file in your favorite editing program,
4828 and remove the breakpoint definitions you're not interested in, or
4829 that can no longer be recreated.
4832 @node Static Probe Points
4833 @subsection Static Probe Points
4835 @cindex static probe point, SystemTap
4836 @value{GDBN} supports @dfn{SDT} probes in the code. @acronym{SDT} stands
4837 for Statically Defined Tracing, and the probes are designed to have a tiny
4838 runtime code and data footprint, and no dynamic relocations. They are
4839 usable from assembly, C and C@t{++} languages. See
4840 @uref{http://sourceware.org/systemtap/wiki/UserSpaceProbeImplementation}
4841 for a good reference on how the @acronym{SDT} probes are implemented.
4843 Currently, @code{SystemTap} (@uref{http://sourceware.org/systemtap/})
4844 @acronym{SDT} probes are supported on ELF-compatible systems. See
4845 @uref{http://sourceware.org/systemtap/wiki/AddingUserSpaceProbingToApps}
4846 for more information on how to add @code{SystemTap} @acronym{SDT} probes
4847 in your applications.
4849 @cindex semaphores on static probe points
4850 Some probes have an associated semaphore variable; for instance, this
4851 happens automatically if you defined your probe using a DTrace-style
4852 @file{.d} file. If your probe has a semaphore, @value{GDBN} will
4853 automatically enable it when you specify a breakpoint using the
4854 @samp{-probe-stap} notation. But, if you put a breakpoint at a probe's
4855 location by some other method (e.g., @code{break file:line}), then
4856 @value{GDBN} will not automatically set the semaphore.
4858 You can examine the available static static probes using @code{info
4859 probes}, with optional arguments:
4863 @item info probes stap @r{[}@var{provider} @r{[}@var{name} @r{[}@var{objfile}@r{]}@r{]}@r{]}
4864 If given, @var{provider} is a regular expression used to match against provider
4865 names when selecting which probes to list. If omitted, probes by all
4866 probes from all providers are listed.
4868 If given, @var{name} is a regular expression to match against probe names
4869 when selecting which probes to list. If omitted, probe names are not
4870 considered when deciding whether to display them.
4872 If given, @var{objfile} is a regular expression used to select which
4873 object files (executable or shared libraries) to examine. If not
4874 given, all object files are considered.
4876 @item info probes all
4877 List the available static probes, from all types.
4880 @vindex $_probe_arg@r{, convenience variable}
4881 A probe may specify up to twelve arguments. These are available at the
4882 point at which the probe is defined---that is, when the current PC is
4883 at the probe's location. The arguments are available using the
4884 convenience variables (@pxref{Convenience Vars})
4885 @code{$_probe_arg0}@dots{}@code{$_probe_arg11}. Each probe argument is
4886 an integer of the appropriate size; types are not preserved. The
4887 convenience variable @code{$_probe_argc} holds the number of arguments
4888 at the current probe point.
4890 These variables are always available, but attempts to access them at
4891 any location other than a probe point will cause @value{GDBN} to give
4895 @c @ifclear BARETARGET
4896 @node Error in Breakpoints
4897 @subsection ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
4899 If you request too many active hardware-assisted breakpoints and
4900 watchpoints, you will see this error message:
4902 @c FIXME: the precise wording of this message may change; the relevant
4903 @c source change is not committed yet (Sep 3, 1999).
4905 Stopped; cannot insert breakpoints.
4906 You may have requested too many hardware breakpoints and watchpoints.
4910 This message is printed when you attempt to resume the program, since
4911 only then @value{GDBN} knows exactly how many hardware breakpoints and
4912 watchpoints it needs to insert.
4914 When this message is printed, you need to disable or remove some of the
4915 hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints, and then continue.
4917 @node Breakpoint-related Warnings
4918 @subsection ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
4919 @cindex breakpoint address adjusted
4921 Some processor architectures place constraints on the addresses at
4922 which breakpoints may be placed. For architectures thus constrained,
4923 @value{GDBN} will attempt to adjust the breakpoint's address to comply
4924 with the constraints dictated by the architecture.
4926 One example of such an architecture is the Fujitsu FR-V. The FR-V is
4927 a VLIW architecture in which a number of RISC-like instructions may be
4928 bundled together for parallel execution. The FR-V architecture
4929 constrains the location of a breakpoint instruction within such a
4930 bundle to the instruction with the lowest address. @value{GDBN}
4931 honors this constraint by adjusting a breakpoint's address to the
4932 first in the bundle.
4934 It is not uncommon for optimized code to have bundles which contain
4935 instructions from different source statements, thus it may happen that
4936 a breakpoint's address will be adjusted from one source statement to
4937 another. Since this adjustment may significantly alter @value{GDBN}'s
4938 breakpoint related behavior from what the user expects, a warning is
4939 printed when the breakpoint is first set and also when the breakpoint
4942 A warning like the one below is printed when setting a breakpoint
4943 that's been subject to address adjustment:
4946 warning: Breakpoint address adjusted from 0x00010414 to 0x00010410.
4949 Such warnings are printed both for user settable and @value{GDBN}'s
4950 internal breakpoints. If you see one of these warnings, you should
4951 verify that a breakpoint set at the adjusted address will have the
4952 desired affect. If not, the breakpoint in question may be removed and
4953 other breakpoints may be set which will have the desired behavior.
4954 E.g., it may be sufficient to place the breakpoint at a later
4955 instruction. A conditional breakpoint may also be useful in some
4956 cases to prevent the breakpoint from triggering too often.
4958 @value{GDBN} will also issue a warning when stopping at one of these
4959 adjusted breakpoints:
4962 warning: Breakpoint 1 address previously adjusted from 0x00010414
4966 When this warning is encountered, it may be too late to take remedial
4967 action except in cases where the breakpoint is hit earlier or more
4968 frequently than expected.
4970 @node Continuing and Stepping
4971 @section Continuing and Stepping
4975 @cindex resuming execution
4976 @dfn{Continuing} means resuming program execution until your program
4977 completes normally. In contrast, @dfn{stepping} means executing just
4978 one more ``step'' of your program, where ``step'' may mean either one
4979 line of source code, or one machine instruction (depending on what
4980 particular command you use). Either when continuing or when stepping,
4981 your program may stop even sooner, due to a breakpoint or a signal. (If
4982 it stops due to a signal, you may want to use @code{handle}, or use
4983 @samp{signal 0} to resume execution. @xref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
4987 @kindex c @r{(@code{continue})}
4988 @kindex fg @r{(resume foreground execution)}
4989 @item continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
4990 @itemx c @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
4991 @itemx fg @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
4992 Resume program execution, at the address where your program last stopped;
4993 any breakpoints set at that address are bypassed. The optional argument
4994 @var{ignore-count} allows you to specify a further number of times to
4995 ignore a breakpoint at this location; its effect is like that of
4996 @code{ignore} (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
4998 The argument @var{ignore-count} is meaningful only when your program
4999 stopped due to a breakpoint. At other times, the argument to
5000 @code{continue} is ignored.
5002 The synonyms @code{c} and @code{fg} (for @dfn{foreground}, as the
5003 debugged program is deemed to be the foreground program) are provided
5004 purely for convenience, and have exactly the same behavior as
5008 To resume execution at a different place, you can use @code{return}
5009 (@pxref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}) to go back to the
5010 calling function; or @code{jump} (@pxref{Jumping, ,Continuing at a
5011 Different Address}) to go to an arbitrary location in your program.
5013 A typical technique for using stepping is to set a breakpoint
5014 (@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; Watchpoints; and Catchpoints}) at the
5015 beginning of the function or the section of your program where a problem
5016 is believed to lie, run your program until it stops at that breakpoint,
5017 and then step through the suspect area, examining the variables that are
5018 interesting, until you see the problem happen.
5022 @kindex s @r{(@code{step})}
5024 Continue running your program until control reaches a different source
5025 line, then stop it and return control to @value{GDBN}. This command is
5026 abbreviated @code{s}.
5029 @c "without debugging information" is imprecise; actually "without line
5030 @c numbers in the debugging information". (gcc -g1 has debugging info but
5031 @c not line numbers). But it seems complex to try to make that
5032 @c distinction here.
5033 @emph{Warning:} If you use the @code{step} command while control is
5034 within a function that was compiled without debugging information,
5035 execution proceeds until control reaches a function that does have
5036 debugging information. Likewise, it will not step into a function which
5037 is compiled without debugging information. To step through functions
5038 without debugging information, use the @code{stepi} command, described
5042 The @code{step} command only stops at the first instruction of a source
5043 line. This prevents the multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
5044 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc. @code{step} continues
5045 to stop if a function that has debugging information is called within
5046 the line. In other words, @code{step} @emph{steps inside} any functions
5047 called within the line.
5049 Also, the @code{step} command only enters a function if there is line
5050 number information for the function. Otherwise it acts like the
5051 @code{next} command. This avoids problems when using @code{cc -gl}
5052 on @acronym{MIPS} machines. Previously, @code{step} entered subroutines if there
5053 was any debugging information about the routine.
5055 @item step @var{count}
5056 Continue running as in @code{step}, but do so @var{count} times. If a
5057 breakpoint is reached, or a signal not related to stepping occurs before
5058 @var{count} steps, stepping stops right away.
5061 @kindex n @r{(@code{next})}
5062 @item next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
5063 Continue to the next source line in the current (innermost) stack frame.
5064 This is similar to @code{step}, but function calls that appear within
5065 the line of code are executed without stopping. Execution stops when
5066 control reaches a different line of code at the original stack level
5067 that was executing when you gave the @code{next} command. This command
5068 is abbreviated @code{n}.
5070 An argument @var{count} is a repeat count, as for @code{step}.
5073 @c FIX ME!! Do we delete this, or is there a way it fits in with
5074 @c the following paragraph? --- Vctoria
5076 @c @code{next} within a function that lacks debugging information acts like
5077 @c @code{step}, but any function calls appearing within the code of the
5078 @c function are executed without stopping.
5080 The @code{next} command only stops at the first instruction of a
5081 source line. This prevents multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
5082 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc.
5084 @kindex set step-mode
5086 @cindex functions without line info, and stepping
5087 @cindex stepping into functions with no line info
5088 @itemx set step-mode on
5089 The @code{set step-mode on} command causes the @code{step} command to
5090 stop at the first instruction of a function which contains no debug line
5091 information rather than stepping over it.
5093 This is useful in cases where you may be interested in inspecting the
5094 machine instructions of a function which has no symbolic info and do not
5095 want @value{GDBN} to automatically skip over this function.
5097 @item set step-mode off
5098 Causes the @code{step} command to step over any functions which contains no
5099 debug information. This is the default.
5101 @item show step-mode
5102 Show whether @value{GDBN} will stop in or step over functions without
5103 source line debug information.
5106 @kindex fin @r{(@code{finish})}
5108 Continue running until just after function in the selected stack frame
5109 returns. Print the returned value (if any). This command can be
5110 abbreviated as @code{fin}.
5112 Contrast this with the @code{return} command (@pxref{Returning,
5113 ,Returning from a Function}).
5116 @kindex u @r{(@code{until})}
5117 @cindex run until specified location
5120 Continue running until a source line past the current line, in the
5121 current stack frame, is reached. This command is used to avoid single
5122 stepping through a loop more than once. It is like the @code{next}
5123 command, except that when @code{until} encounters a jump, it
5124 automatically continues execution until the program counter is greater
5125 than the address of the jump.
5127 This means that when you reach the end of a loop after single stepping
5128 though it, @code{until} makes your program continue execution until it
5129 exits the loop. In contrast, a @code{next} command at the end of a loop
5130 simply steps back to the beginning of the loop, which forces you to step
5131 through the next iteration.
5133 @code{until} always stops your program if it attempts to exit the current
5136 @code{until} may produce somewhat counterintuitive results if the order
5137 of machine code does not match the order of the source lines. For
5138 example, in the following excerpt from a debugging session, the @code{f}
5139 (@code{frame}) command shows that execution is stopped at line
5140 @code{206}; yet when we use @code{until}, we get to line @code{195}:
5144 #0 main (argc=4, argv=0xf7fffae8) at m4.c:206
5146 (@value{GDBP}) until
5147 195 for ( ; argc > 0; NEXTARG) @{
5150 This happened because, for execution efficiency, the compiler had
5151 generated code for the loop closure test at the end, rather than the
5152 start, of the loop---even though the test in a C @code{for}-loop is
5153 written before the body of the loop. The @code{until} command appeared
5154 to step back to the beginning of the loop when it advanced to this
5155 expression; however, it has not really gone to an earlier
5156 statement---not in terms of the actual machine code.
5158 @code{until} with no argument works by means of single
5159 instruction stepping, and hence is slower than @code{until} with an
5162 @item until @var{location}
5163 @itemx u @var{location}
5164 Continue running your program until either the specified location is
5165 reached, or the current stack frame returns. @var{location} is any of
5166 the forms described in @ref{Specify Location}.
5167 This form of the command uses temporary breakpoints, and
5168 hence is quicker than @code{until} without an argument. The specified
5169 location is actually reached only if it is in the current frame. This
5170 implies that @code{until} can be used to skip over recursive function
5171 invocations. For instance in the code below, if the current location is
5172 line @code{96}, issuing @code{until 99} will execute the program up to
5173 line @code{99} in the same invocation of factorial, i.e., after the inner
5174 invocations have returned.
5177 94 int factorial (int value)
5179 96 if (value > 1) @{
5180 97 value *= factorial (value - 1);
5187 @kindex advance @var{location}
5188 @item advance @var{location}
5189 Continue running the program up to the given @var{location}. An argument is
5190 required, which should be of one of the forms described in
5191 @ref{Specify Location}.
5192 Execution will also stop upon exit from the current stack
5193 frame. This command is similar to @code{until}, but @code{advance} will
5194 not skip over recursive function calls, and the target location doesn't
5195 have to be in the same frame as the current one.
5199 @kindex si @r{(@code{stepi})}
5201 @itemx stepi @var{arg}
5203 Execute one machine instruction, then stop and return to the debugger.
5205 It is often useful to do @samp{display/i $pc} when stepping by machine
5206 instructions. This makes @value{GDBN} automatically display the next
5207 instruction to be executed, each time your program stops. @xref{Auto
5208 Display,, Automatic Display}.
5210 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{step}.
5214 @kindex ni @r{(@code{nexti})}
5216 @itemx nexti @var{arg}
5218 Execute one machine instruction, but if it is a function call,
5219 proceed until the function returns.
5221 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{next}.
5225 @anchor{range stepping}
5226 @cindex range stepping
5227 @cindex target-assisted range stepping
5228 By default, and if available, @value{GDBN} makes use of
5229 target-assisted @dfn{range stepping}. In other words, whenever you
5230 use a stepping command (e.g., @code{step}, @code{next}), @value{GDBN}
5231 tells the target to step the corresponding range of instruction
5232 addresses instead of issuing multiple single-steps. This speeds up
5233 line stepping, particularly for remote targets. Ideally, there should
5234 be no reason you would want to turn range stepping off. However, it's
5235 possible that a bug in the debug info, a bug in the remote stub (for
5236 remote targets), or even a bug in @value{GDBN} could make line
5237 stepping behave incorrectly when target-assisted range stepping is
5238 enabled. You can use the following command to turn off range stepping
5242 @kindex set range-stepping
5243 @kindex show range-stepping
5244 @item set range-stepping
5245 @itemx show range-stepping
5246 Control whether range stepping is enabled.
5248 If @code{on}, and the target supports it, @value{GDBN} tells the
5249 target to step a range of addresses itself, instead of issuing
5250 multiple single-steps. If @code{off}, @value{GDBN} always issues
5251 single-steps, even if range stepping is supported by the target. The
5252 default is @code{on}.
5256 @node Skipping Over Functions and Files
5257 @section Skipping Over Functions and Files
5258 @cindex skipping over functions and files
5260 The program you are debugging may contain some functions which are
5261 uninteresting to debug. The @code{skip} comand lets you tell @value{GDBN} to
5262 skip a function or all functions in a file when stepping.
5264 For example, consider the following C function:
5275 Suppose you wish to step into the functions @code{foo} and @code{bar}, but you
5276 are not interested in stepping through @code{boring}. If you run @code{step}
5277 at line 103, you'll enter @code{boring()}, but if you run @code{next}, you'll
5278 step over both @code{foo} and @code{boring}!
5280 One solution is to @code{step} into @code{boring} and use the @code{finish}
5281 command to immediately exit it. But this can become tedious if @code{boring}
5282 is called from many places.
5284 A more flexible solution is to execute @kbd{skip boring}. This instructs
5285 @value{GDBN} never to step into @code{boring}. Now when you execute
5286 @code{step} at line 103, you'll step over @code{boring} and directly into
5289 You can also instruct @value{GDBN} to skip all functions in a file, with, for
5290 example, @code{skip file boring.c}.
5293 @kindex skip function
5294 @item skip @r{[}@var{linespec}@r{]}
5295 @itemx skip function @r{[}@var{linespec}@r{]}
5296 After running this command, the function named by @var{linespec} or the
5297 function containing the line named by @var{linespec} will be skipped over when
5298 stepping. @xref{Specify Location}.
5300 If you do not specify @var{linespec}, the function you're currently debugging
5303 (If you have a function called @code{file} that you want to skip, use
5304 @kbd{skip function file}.)
5307 @item skip file @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
5308 After running this command, any function whose source lives in @var{filename}
5309 will be skipped over when stepping.
5311 If you do not specify @var{filename}, functions whose source lives in the file
5312 you're currently debugging will be skipped.
5315 Skips can be listed, deleted, disabled, and enabled, much like breakpoints.
5316 These are the commands for managing your list of skips:
5320 @item info skip @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5321 Print details about the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified,
5322 print a table with details about all functions and files marked for skipping.
5323 @code{info skip} prints the following information about each skip:
5327 A number identifying this skip.
5329 The type of this skip, either @samp{function} or @samp{file}.
5330 @item Enabled or Disabled
5331 Enabled skips are marked with @samp{y}. Disabled skips are marked with @samp{n}.
5333 For function skips, this column indicates the address in memory of the function
5334 being skipped. If you've set a function skip on a function which has not yet
5335 been loaded, this field will contain @samp{<PENDING>}. Once a shared library
5336 which has the function is loaded, @code{info skip} will show the function's
5339 For file skips, this field contains the filename being skipped. For functions
5340 skips, this field contains the function name and its line number in the file
5341 where it is defined.
5345 @item skip delete @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5346 Delete the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified, delete all
5350 @item skip enable @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5351 Enable the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified, enable all
5354 @kindex skip disable
5355 @item skip disable @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5356 Disable the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified, disable all
5365 A signal is an asynchronous event that can happen in a program. The
5366 operating system defines the possible kinds of signals, and gives each
5367 kind a name and a number. For example, in Unix @code{SIGINT} is the
5368 signal a program gets when you type an interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c});
5369 @code{SIGSEGV} is the signal a program gets from referencing a place in
5370 memory far away from all the areas in use; @code{SIGALRM} occurs when
5371 the alarm clock timer goes off (which happens only if your program has
5372 requested an alarm).
5374 @cindex fatal signals
5375 Some signals, including @code{SIGALRM}, are a normal part of the
5376 functioning of your program. Others, such as @code{SIGSEGV}, indicate
5377 errors; these signals are @dfn{fatal} (they kill your program immediately) if the
5378 program has not specified in advance some other way to handle the signal.
5379 @code{SIGINT} does not indicate an error in your program, but it is normally
5380 fatal so it can carry out the purpose of the interrupt: to kill the program.
5382 @value{GDBN} has the ability to detect any occurrence of a signal in your
5383 program. You can tell @value{GDBN} in advance what to do for each kind of
5386 @cindex handling signals
5387 Normally, @value{GDBN} is set up to let the non-erroneous signals like
5388 @code{SIGALRM} be silently passed to your program
5389 (so as not to interfere with their role in the program's functioning)
5390 but to stop your program immediately whenever an error signal happens.
5391 You can change these settings with the @code{handle} command.
5394 @kindex info signals
5398 Print a table of all the kinds of signals and how @value{GDBN} has been told to
5399 handle each one. You can use this to see the signal numbers of all
5400 the defined types of signals.
5402 @item info signals @var{sig}
5403 Similar, but print information only about the specified signal number.
5405 @code{info handle} is an alias for @code{info signals}.
5407 @item catch signal @r{[}@var{signal}@dots{} @r{|} @samp{all}@r{]}
5408 Set a catchpoint for the indicated signals. @xref{Set Catchpoints},
5409 for details about this command.
5412 @item handle @var{signal} @r{[}@var{keywords}@dots{}@r{]}
5413 Change the way @value{GDBN} handles signal @var{signal}. @var{signal}
5414 can be the number of a signal or its name (with or without the
5415 @samp{SIG} at the beginning); a list of signal numbers of the form
5416 @samp{@var{low}-@var{high}}; or the word @samp{all}, meaning all the
5417 known signals. Optional arguments @var{keywords}, described below,
5418 say what change to make.
5422 The keywords allowed by the @code{handle} command can be abbreviated.
5423 Their full names are:
5427 @value{GDBN} should not stop your program when this signal happens. It may
5428 still print a message telling you that the signal has come in.
5431 @value{GDBN} should stop your program when this signal happens. This implies
5432 the @code{print} keyword as well.
5435 @value{GDBN} should print a message when this signal happens.
5438 @value{GDBN} should not mention the occurrence of the signal at all. This
5439 implies the @code{nostop} keyword as well.
5443 @value{GDBN} should allow your program to see this signal; your program
5444 can handle the signal, or else it may terminate if the signal is fatal
5445 and not handled. @code{pass} and @code{noignore} are synonyms.
5449 @value{GDBN} should not allow your program to see this signal.
5450 @code{nopass} and @code{ignore} are synonyms.
5454 When a signal stops your program, the signal is not visible to the
5456 continue. Your program sees the signal then, if @code{pass} is in
5457 effect for the signal in question @emph{at that time}. In other words,
5458 after @value{GDBN} reports a signal, you can use the @code{handle}
5459 command with @code{pass} or @code{nopass} to control whether your
5460 program sees that signal when you continue.
5462 The default is set to @code{nostop}, @code{noprint}, @code{pass} for
5463 non-erroneous signals such as @code{SIGALRM}, @code{SIGWINCH} and
5464 @code{SIGCHLD}, and to @code{stop}, @code{print}, @code{pass} for the
5467 You can also use the @code{signal} command to prevent your program from
5468 seeing a signal, or cause it to see a signal it normally would not see,
5469 or to give it any signal at any time. For example, if your program stopped
5470 due to some sort of memory reference error, you might store correct
5471 values into the erroneous variables and continue, hoping to see more
5472 execution; but your program would probably terminate immediately as
5473 a result of the fatal signal once it saw the signal. To prevent this,
5474 you can continue with @samp{signal 0}. @xref{Signaling, ,Giving your
5477 @cindex extra signal information
5478 @anchor{extra signal information}
5480 On some targets, @value{GDBN} can inspect extra signal information
5481 associated with the intercepted signal, before it is actually
5482 delivered to the program being debugged. This information is exported
5483 by the convenience variable @code{$_siginfo}, and consists of data
5484 that is passed by the kernel to the signal handler at the time of the
5485 receipt of a signal. The data type of the information itself is
5486 target dependent. You can see the data type using the @code{ptype
5487 $_siginfo} command. On Unix systems, it typically corresponds to the
5488 standard @code{siginfo_t} type, as defined in the @file{signal.h}
5491 Here's an example, on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, printing the stray
5492 referenced address that raised a segmentation fault.
5496 (@value{GDBP}) continue
5497 Program received signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault.
5498 0x0000000000400766 in main ()
5500 (@value{GDBP}) ptype $_siginfo
5507 struct @{...@} _kill;
5508 struct @{...@} _timer;
5510 struct @{...@} _sigchld;
5511 struct @{...@} _sigfault;
5512 struct @{...@} _sigpoll;
5515 (@value{GDBP}) ptype $_siginfo._sifields._sigfault
5519 (@value{GDBP}) p $_siginfo._sifields._sigfault.si_addr
5520 $1 = (void *) 0x7ffff7ff7000
5524 Depending on target support, @code{$_siginfo} may also be writable.
5527 @section Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs
5529 @cindex stopped threads
5530 @cindex threads, stopped
5532 @cindex continuing threads
5533 @cindex threads, continuing
5535 @value{GDBN} supports debugging programs with multiple threads
5536 (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads}). There
5537 are two modes of controlling execution of your program within the
5538 debugger. In the default mode, referred to as @dfn{all-stop mode},
5539 when any thread in your program stops (for example, at a breakpoint
5540 or while being stepped), all other threads in the program are also stopped by
5541 @value{GDBN}. On some targets, @value{GDBN} also supports
5542 @dfn{non-stop mode}, in which other threads can continue to run freely while
5543 you examine the stopped thread in the debugger.
5546 * All-Stop Mode:: All threads stop when GDB takes control
5547 * Non-Stop Mode:: Other threads continue to execute
5548 * Background Execution:: Running your program asynchronously
5549 * Thread-Specific Breakpoints:: Controlling breakpoints
5550 * Interrupted System Calls:: GDB may interfere with system calls
5551 * Observer Mode:: GDB does not alter program behavior
5555 @subsection All-Stop Mode
5557 @cindex all-stop mode
5559 In all-stop mode, whenever your program stops under @value{GDBN} for any reason,
5560 @emph{all} threads of execution stop, not just the current thread. This
5561 allows you to examine the overall state of the program, including
5562 switching between threads, without worrying that things may change
5565 Conversely, whenever you restart the program, @emph{all} threads start
5566 executing. @emph{This is true even when single-stepping} with commands
5567 like @code{step} or @code{next}.
5569 In particular, @value{GDBN} cannot single-step all threads in lockstep.
5570 Since thread scheduling is up to your debugging target's operating
5571 system (not controlled by @value{GDBN}), other threads may
5572 execute more than one statement while the current thread completes a
5573 single step. Moreover, in general other threads stop in the middle of a
5574 statement, rather than at a clean statement boundary, when the program
5577 You might even find your program stopped in another thread after
5578 continuing or even single-stepping. This happens whenever some other
5579 thread runs into a breakpoint, a signal, or an exception before the
5580 first thread completes whatever you requested.
5582 @cindex automatic thread selection
5583 @cindex switching threads automatically
5584 @cindex threads, automatic switching
5585 Whenever @value{GDBN} stops your program, due to a breakpoint or a
5586 signal, it automatically selects the thread where that breakpoint or
5587 signal happened. @value{GDBN} alerts you to the context switch with a
5588 message such as @samp{[Switching to Thread @var{n}]} to identify the
5591 On some OSes, you can modify @value{GDBN}'s default behavior by
5592 locking the OS scheduler to allow only a single thread to run.
5595 @item set scheduler-locking @var{mode}
5596 @cindex scheduler locking mode
5597 @cindex lock scheduler
5598 Set the scheduler locking mode. If it is @code{off}, then there is no
5599 locking and any thread may run at any time. If @code{on}, then only the
5600 current thread may run when the inferior is resumed. The @code{step}
5601 mode optimizes for single-stepping; it prevents other threads
5602 from preempting the current thread while you are stepping, so that
5603 the focus of debugging does not change unexpectedly.
5604 Other threads only rarely (or never) get a chance to run
5605 when you step. They are more likely to run when you @samp{next} over a
5606 function call, and they are completely free to run when you use commands
5607 like @samp{continue}, @samp{until}, or @samp{finish}. However, unless another
5608 thread hits a breakpoint during its timeslice, @value{GDBN} does not change
5609 the current thread away from the thread that you are debugging.
5611 @item show scheduler-locking
5612 Display the current scheduler locking mode.
5615 @cindex resume threads of multiple processes simultaneously
5616 By default, when you issue one of the execution commands such as
5617 @code{continue}, @code{next} or @code{step}, @value{GDBN} allows only
5618 threads of the current inferior to run. For example, if @value{GDBN}
5619 is attached to two inferiors, each with two threads, the
5620 @code{continue} command resumes only the two threads of the current
5621 inferior. This is useful, for example, when you debug a program that
5622 forks and you want to hold the parent stopped (so that, for instance,
5623 it doesn't run to exit), while you debug the child. In other
5624 situations, you may not be interested in inspecting the current state
5625 of any of the processes @value{GDBN} is attached to, and you may want
5626 to resume them all until some breakpoint is hit. In the latter case,
5627 you can instruct @value{GDBN} to allow all threads of all the
5628 inferiors to run with the @w{@code{set schedule-multiple}} command.
5631 @kindex set schedule-multiple
5632 @item set schedule-multiple
5633 Set the mode for allowing threads of multiple processes to be resumed
5634 when an execution command is issued. When @code{on}, all threads of
5635 all processes are allowed to run. When @code{off}, only the threads
5636 of the current process are resumed. The default is @code{off}. The
5637 @code{scheduler-locking} mode takes precedence when set to @code{on},
5638 or while you are stepping and set to @code{step}.
5640 @item show schedule-multiple
5641 Display the current mode for resuming the execution of threads of
5646 @subsection Non-Stop Mode
5648 @cindex non-stop mode
5650 @c This section is really only a place-holder, and needs to be expanded
5651 @c with more details.
5653 For some multi-threaded targets, @value{GDBN} supports an optional
5654 mode of operation in which you can examine stopped program threads in
5655 the debugger while other threads continue to execute freely. This
5656 minimizes intrusion when debugging live systems, such as programs
5657 where some threads have real-time constraints or must continue to
5658 respond to external events. This is referred to as @dfn{non-stop} mode.
5660 In non-stop mode, when a thread stops to report a debugging event,
5661 @emph{only} that thread is stopped; @value{GDBN} does not stop other
5662 threads as well, in contrast to the all-stop mode behavior. Additionally,
5663 execution commands such as @code{continue} and @code{step} apply by default
5664 only to the current thread in non-stop mode, rather than all threads as
5665 in all-stop mode. This allows you to control threads explicitly in
5666 ways that are not possible in all-stop mode --- for example, stepping
5667 one thread while allowing others to run freely, stepping
5668 one thread while holding all others stopped, or stepping several threads
5669 independently and simultaneously.
5671 To enter non-stop mode, use this sequence of commands before you run
5672 or attach to your program:
5675 # Enable the async interface.
5678 # If using the CLI, pagination breaks non-stop.
5681 # Finally, turn it on!
5685 You can use these commands to manipulate the non-stop mode setting:
5688 @kindex set non-stop
5689 @item set non-stop on
5690 Enable selection of non-stop mode.
5691 @item set non-stop off
5692 Disable selection of non-stop mode.
5693 @kindex show non-stop
5695 Show the current non-stop enablement setting.
5698 Note these commands only reflect whether non-stop mode is enabled,
5699 not whether the currently-executing program is being run in non-stop mode.
5700 In particular, the @code{set non-stop} preference is only consulted when
5701 @value{GDBN} starts or connects to the target program, and it is generally
5702 not possible to switch modes once debugging has started. Furthermore,
5703 since not all targets support non-stop mode, even when you have enabled
5704 non-stop mode, @value{GDBN} may still fall back to all-stop operation by
5707 In non-stop mode, all execution commands apply only to the current thread
5708 by default. That is, @code{continue} only continues one thread.
5709 To continue all threads, issue @code{continue -a} or @code{c -a}.
5711 You can use @value{GDBN}'s background execution commands
5712 (@pxref{Background Execution}) to run some threads in the background
5713 while you continue to examine or step others from @value{GDBN}.
5714 The MI execution commands (@pxref{GDB/MI Program Execution}) are
5715 always executed asynchronously in non-stop mode.
5717 Suspending execution is done with the @code{interrupt} command when
5718 running in the background, or @kbd{Ctrl-c} during foreground execution.
5719 In all-stop mode, this stops the whole process;
5720 but in non-stop mode the interrupt applies only to the current thread.
5721 To stop the whole program, use @code{interrupt -a}.
5723 Other execution commands do not currently support the @code{-a} option.
5725 In non-stop mode, when a thread stops, @value{GDBN} doesn't automatically make
5726 that thread current, as it does in all-stop mode. This is because the
5727 thread stop notifications are asynchronous with respect to @value{GDBN}'s
5728 command interpreter, and it would be confusing if @value{GDBN} unexpectedly
5729 changed to a different thread just as you entered a command to operate on the
5730 previously current thread.
5732 @node Background Execution
5733 @subsection Background Execution
5735 @cindex foreground execution
5736 @cindex background execution
5737 @cindex asynchronous execution
5738 @cindex execution, foreground, background and asynchronous
5740 @value{GDBN}'s execution commands have two variants: the normal
5741 foreground (synchronous) behavior, and a background
5742 (asynchronous) behavior. In foreground execution, @value{GDBN} waits for
5743 the program to report that some thread has stopped before prompting for
5744 another command. In background execution, @value{GDBN} immediately gives
5745 a command prompt so that you can issue other commands while your program runs.
5747 You need to explicitly enable asynchronous mode before you can use
5748 background execution commands. You can use these commands to
5749 manipulate the asynchronous mode setting:
5752 @kindex set target-async
5753 @item set target-async on
5754 Enable asynchronous mode.
5755 @item set target-async off
5756 Disable asynchronous mode.
5757 @kindex show target-async
5758 @item show target-async
5759 Show the current target-async setting.
5762 If the target doesn't support async mode, @value{GDBN} issues an error
5763 message if you attempt to use the background execution commands.
5765 To specify background execution, add a @code{&} to the command. For example,
5766 the background form of the @code{continue} command is @code{continue&}, or
5767 just @code{c&}. The execution commands that accept background execution
5773 @xref{Starting, , Starting your Program}.
5777 @xref{Attach, , Debugging an Already-running Process}.
5781 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, step}.
5785 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, stepi}.
5789 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, next}.
5793 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, nexti}.
5797 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, continue}.
5801 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, finish}.
5805 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, until}.
5809 Background execution is especially useful in conjunction with non-stop
5810 mode for debugging programs with multiple threads; see @ref{Non-Stop Mode}.
5811 However, you can also use these commands in the normal all-stop mode with
5812 the restriction that you cannot issue another execution command until the
5813 previous one finishes. Examples of commands that are valid in all-stop
5814 mode while the program is running include @code{help} and @code{info break}.
5816 You can interrupt your program while it is running in the background by
5817 using the @code{interrupt} command.
5824 Suspend execution of the running program. In all-stop mode,
5825 @code{interrupt} stops the whole process, but in non-stop mode, it stops
5826 only the current thread. To stop the whole program in non-stop mode,
5827 use @code{interrupt -a}.
5830 @node Thread-Specific Breakpoints
5831 @subsection Thread-Specific Breakpoints
5833 When your program has multiple threads (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging
5834 Programs with Multiple Threads}), you can choose whether to set
5835 breakpoints on all threads, or on a particular thread.
5838 @cindex breakpoints and threads
5839 @cindex thread breakpoints
5840 @kindex break @dots{} thread @var{threadno}
5841 @item break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno}
5842 @itemx break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno} if @dots{}
5843 @var{linespec} specifies source lines; there are several ways of
5844 writing them (@pxref{Specify Location}), but the effect is always to
5845 specify some source line.
5847 Use the qualifier @samp{thread @var{threadno}} with a breakpoint command
5848 to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
5849 particular thread reaches this breakpoint. @var{threadno} is one of the
5850 numeric thread identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown in the first
5851 column of the @samp{info threads} display.
5853 If you do not specify @samp{thread @var{threadno}} when you set a
5854 breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} threads of your
5857 You can use the @code{thread} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
5858 well; in this case, place @samp{thread @var{threadno}} before or
5859 after the breakpoint condition, like this:
5862 (@value{GDBP}) break frik.c:13 thread 28 if bartab > lim
5867 @node Interrupted System Calls
5868 @subsection Interrupted System Calls
5870 @cindex thread breakpoints and system calls
5871 @cindex system calls and thread breakpoints
5872 @cindex premature return from system calls
5873 There is an unfortunate side effect when using @value{GDBN} to debug
5874 multi-threaded programs. If one thread stops for a
5875 breakpoint, or for some other reason, and another thread is blocked in a
5876 system call, then the system call may return prematurely. This is a
5877 consequence of the interaction between multiple threads and the signals
5878 that @value{GDBN} uses to implement breakpoints and other events that
5881 To handle this problem, your program should check the return value of
5882 each system call and react appropriately. This is good programming
5885 For example, do not write code like this:
5891 The call to @code{sleep} will return early if a different thread stops
5892 at a breakpoint or for some other reason.
5894 Instead, write this:
5899 unslept = sleep (unslept);
5902 A system call is allowed to return early, so the system is still
5903 conforming to its specification. But @value{GDBN} does cause your
5904 multi-threaded program to behave differently than it would without
5907 Also, @value{GDBN} uses internal breakpoints in the thread library to
5908 monitor certain events such as thread creation and thread destruction.
5909 When such an event happens, a system call in another thread may return
5910 prematurely, even though your program does not appear to stop.
5913 @subsection Observer Mode
5915 If you want to build on non-stop mode and observe program behavior
5916 without any chance of disruption by @value{GDBN}, you can set
5917 variables to disable all of the debugger's attempts to modify state,
5918 whether by writing memory, inserting breakpoints, etc. These operate
5919 at a low level, intercepting operations from all commands.
5921 When all of these are set to @code{off}, then @value{GDBN} is said to
5922 be @dfn{observer mode}. As a convenience, the variable
5923 @code{observer} can be set to disable these, plus enable non-stop
5926 Note that @value{GDBN} will not prevent you from making nonsensical
5927 combinations of these settings. For instance, if you have enabled
5928 @code{may-insert-breakpoints} but disabled @code{may-write-memory},
5929 then breakpoints that work by writing trap instructions into the code
5930 stream will still not be able to be placed.
5935 @item set observer on
5936 @itemx set observer off
5937 When set to @code{on}, this disables all the permission variables
5938 below (except for @code{insert-fast-tracepoints}), plus enables
5939 non-stop debugging. Setting this to @code{off} switches back to
5940 normal debugging, though remaining in non-stop mode.
5943 Show whether observer mode is on or off.
5945 @kindex may-write-registers
5946 @item set may-write-registers on
5947 @itemx set may-write-registers off
5948 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to alter the values of
5949 registers, such as with assignment expressions in @code{print}, or the
5950 @code{jump} command. It defaults to @code{on}.
5952 @item show may-write-registers
5953 Show the current permission to write registers.
5955 @kindex may-write-memory
5956 @item set may-write-memory on
5957 @itemx set may-write-memory off
5958 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to alter the contents
5959 of memory, such as with assignment expressions in @code{print}. It
5960 defaults to @code{on}.
5962 @item show may-write-memory
5963 Show the current permission to write memory.
5965 @kindex may-insert-breakpoints
5966 @item set may-insert-breakpoints on
5967 @itemx set may-insert-breakpoints off
5968 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert breakpoints.
5969 This affects all breakpoints, including internal breakpoints defined
5970 by @value{GDBN}. It defaults to @code{on}.
5972 @item show may-insert-breakpoints
5973 Show the current permission to insert breakpoints.
5975 @kindex may-insert-tracepoints
5976 @item set may-insert-tracepoints on
5977 @itemx set may-insert-tracepoints off
5978 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert (regular)
5979 tracepoints at the beginning of a tracing experiment. It affects only
5980 non-fast tracepoints, fast tracepoints being under the control of
5981 @code{may-insert-fast-tracepoints}. It defaults to @code{on}.
5983 @item show may-insert-tracepoints
5984 Show the current permission to insert tracepoints.
5986 @kindex may-insert-fast-tracepoints
5987 @item set may-insert-fast-tracepoints on
5988 @itemx set may-insert-fast-tracepoints off
5989 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert fast
5990 tracepoints at the beginning of a tracing experiment. It affects only
5991 fast tracepoints, regular (non-fast) tracepoints being under the
5992 control of @code{may-insert-tracepoints}. It defaults to @code{on}.
5994 @item show may-insert-fast-tracepoints
5995 Show the current permission to insert fast tracepoints.
5997 @kindex may-interrupt
5998 @item set may-interrupt on
5999 @itemx set may-interrupt off
6000 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to interrupt or stop
6001 program execution. When this variable is @code{off}, the
6002 @code{interrupt} command will have no effect, nor will
6003 @kbd{Ctrl-c}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6005 @item show may-interrupt
6006 Show the current permission to interrupt or stop the program.
6010 @node Reverse Execution
6011 @chapter Running programs backward
6012 @cindex reverse execution
6013 @cindex running programs backward
6015 When you are debugging a program, it is not unusual to realize that
6016 you have gone too far, and some event of interest has already happened.
6017 If the target environment supports it, @value{GDBN} can allow you to
6018 ``rewind'' the program by running it backward.
6020 A target environment that supports reverse execution should be able
6021 to ``undo'' the changes in machine state that have taken place as the
6022 program was executing normally. Variables, registers etc.@: should
6023 revert to their previous values. Obviously this requires a great
6024 deal of sophistication on the part of the target environment; not
6025 all target environments can support reverse execution.
6027 When a program is executed in reverse, the instructions that
6028 have most recently been executed are ``un-executed'', in reverse
6029 order. The program counter runs backward, following the previous
6030 thread of execution in reverse. As each instruction is ``un-executed'',
6031 the values of memory and/or registers that were changed by that
6032 instruction are reverted to their previous states. After executing
6033 a piece of source code in reverse, all side effects of that code
6034 should be ``undone'', and all variables should be returned to their
6035 prior values@footnote{
6036 Note that some side effects are easier to undo than others. For instance,
6037 memory and registers are relatively easy, but device I/O is hard. Some
6038 targets may be able undo things like device I/O, and some may not.
6040 The contract between @value{GDBN} and the reverse executing target
6041 requires only that the target do something reasonable when
6042 @value{GDBN} tells it to execute backwards, and then report the
6043 results back to @value{GDBN}. Whatever the target reports back to
6044 @value{GDBN}, @value{GDBN} will report back to the user. @value{GDBN}
6045 assumes that the memory and registers that the target reports are in a
6046 consistant state, but @value{GDBN} accepts whatever it is given.
6049 If you are debugging in a target environment that supports
6050 reverse execution, @value{GDBN} provides the following commands.
6053 @kindex reverse-continue
6054 @kindex rc @r{(@code{reverse-continue})}
6055 @item reverse-continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
6056 @itemx rc @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
6057 Beginning at the point where your program last stopped, start executing
6058 in reverse. Reverse execution will stop for breakpoints and synchronous
6059 exceptions (signals), just like normal execution. Behavior of
6060 asynchronous signals depends on the target environment.
6062 @kindex reverse-step
6063 @kindex rs @r{(@code{step})}
6064 @item reverse-step @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6065 Run the program backward until control reaches the start of a
6066 different source line; then stop it, and return control to @value{GDBN}.
6068 Like the @code{step} command, @code{reverse-step} will only stop
6069 at the beginning of a source line. It ``un-executes'' the previously
6070 executed source line. If the previous source line included calls to
6071 debuggable functions, @code{reverse-step} will step (backward) into
6072 the called function, stopping at the beginning of the @emph{last}
6073 statement in the called function (typically a return statement).
6075 Also, as with the @code{step} command, if non-debuggable functions are
6076 called, @code{reverse-step} will run thru them backward without stopping.
6078 @kindex reverse-stepi
6079 @kindex rsi @r{(@code{reverse-stepi})}
6080 @item reverse-stepi @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6081 Reverse-execute one machine instruction. Note that the instruction
6082 to be reverse-executed is @emph{not} the one pointed to by the program
6083 counter, but the instruction executed prior to that one. For instance,
6084 if the last instruction was a jump, @code{reverse-stepi} will take you
6085 back from the destination of the jump to the jump instruction itself.
6087 @kindex reverse-next
6088 @kindex rn @r{(@code{reverse-next})}
6089 @item reverse-next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6090 Run backward to the beginning of the previous line executed in
6091 the current (innermost) stack frame. If the line contains function
6092 calls, they will be ``un-executed'' without stopping. Starting from
6093 the first line of a function, @code{reverse-next} will take you back
6094 to the caller of that function, @emph{before} the function was called,
6095 just as the normal @code{next} command would take you from the last
6096 line of a function back to its return to its caller
6097 @footnote{Unless the code is too heavily optimized.}.
6099 @kindex reverse-nexti
6100 @kindex rni @r{(@code{reverse-nexti})}
6101 @item reverse-nexti @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6102 Like @code{nexti}, @code{reverse-nexti} executes a single instruction
6103 in reverse, except that called functions are ``un-executed'' atomically.
6104 That is, if the previously executed instruction was a return from
6105 another function, @code{reverse-nexti} will continue to execute
6106 in reverse until the call to that function (from the current stack
6109 @kindex reverse-finish
6110 @item reverse-finish
6111 Just as the @code{finish} command takes you to the point where the
6112 current function returns, @code{reverse-finish} takes you to the point
6113 where it was called. Instead of ending up at the end of the current
6114 function invocation, you end up at the beginning.
6116 @kindex set exec-direction
6117 @item set exec-direction
6118 Set the direction of target execution.
6119 @item set exec-direction reverse
6120 @cindex execute forward or backward in time
6121 @value{GDBN} will perform all execution commands in reverse, until the
6122 exec-direction mode is changed to ``forward''. Affected commands include
6123 @code{step, stepi, next, nexti, continue, and finish}. The @code{return}
6124 command cannot be used in reverse mode.
6125 @item set exec-direction forward
6126 @value{GDBN} will perform all execution commands in the normal fashion.
6127 This is the default.
6131 @node Process Record and Replay
6132 @chapter Recording Inferior's Execution and Replaying It
6133 @cindex process record and replay
6134 @cindex recording inferior's execution and replaying it
6136 On some platforms, @value{GDBN} provides a special @dfn{process record
6137 and replay} target that can record a log of the process execution, and
6138 replay it later with both forward and reverse execution commands.
6141 When this target is in use, if the execution log includes the record
6142 for the next instruction, @value{GDBN} will debug in @dfn{replay
6143 mode}. In the replay mode, the inferior does not really execute code
6144 instructions. Instead, all the events that normally happen during
6145 code execution are taken from the execution log. While code is not
6146 really executed in replay mode, the values of registers (including the
6147 program counter register) and the memory of the inferior are still
6148 changed as they normally would. Their contents are taken from the
6152 If the record for the next instruction is not in the execution log,
6153 @value{GDBN} will debug in @dfn{record mode}. In this mode, the
6154 inferior executes normally, and @value{GDBN} records the execution log
6157 The process record and replay target supports reverse execution
6158 (@pxref{Reverse Execution}), even if the platform on which the
6159 inferior runs does not. However, the reverse execution is limited in
6160 this case by the range of the instructions recorded in the execution
6161 log. In other words, reverse execution on platforms that don't
6162 support it directly can only be done in the replay mode.
6164 When debugging in the reverse direction, @value{GDBN} will work in
6165 replay mode as long as the execution log includes the record for the
6166 previous instruction; otherwise, it will work in record mode, if the
6167 platform supports reverse execution, or stop if not.
6169 For architecture environments that support process record and replay,
6170 @value{GDBN} provides the following commands:
6173 @kindex target record
6174 @kindex target record-full
6175 @kindex target record-btrace
6178 @kindex record btrace
6182 @item record @var{method}
6183 This command starts the process record and replay target. The
6184 recording method can be specified as parameter. Without a parameter
6185 the command uses the @code{full} recording method. The following
6186 recording methods are available:
6190 Full record/replay recording using @value{GDBN}'s software record and
6191 replay implementation. This method allows replaying and reverse
6195 Hardware-supported instruction recording. This method does not allow
6196 replaying and reverse execution.
6198 This recording method may not be available on all processors.
6201 The process record and replay target can only debug a process that is
6202 already running. Therefore, you need first to start the process with
6203 the @kbd{run} or @kbd{start} commands, and then start the recording
6204 with the @kbd{record @var{method}} command.
6206 Both @code{record @var{method}} and @code{rec @var{method}} are
6207 aliases of @code{target record-@var{method}}.
6209 @cindex displaced stepping, and process record and replay
6210 Displaced stepping (@pxref{Maintenance Commands,, displaced stepping})
6211 will be automatically disabled when process record and replay target
6212 is started. That's because the process record and replay target
6213 doesn't support displaced stepping.
6215 @cindex non-stop mode, and process record and replay
6216 @cindex asynchronous execution, and process record and replay
6217 If the inferior is in the non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) or in
6218 the asynchronous execution mode (@pxref{Background Execution}), not
6219 all recording methods are available. The @code{full} recording method
6220 does not support these two modes.
6225 Stop the process record and replay target. When process record and
6226 replay target stops, the entire execution log will be deleted and the
6227 inferior will either be terminated, or will remain in its final state.
6229 When you stop the process record and replay target in record mode (at
6230 the end of the execution log), the inferior will be stopped at the
6231 next instruction that would have been recorded. In other words, if
6232 you record for a while and then stop recording, the inferior process
6233 will be left in the same state as if the recording never happened.
6235 On the other hand, if the process record and replay target is stopped
6236 while in replay mode (that is, not at the end of the execution log,
6237 but at some earlier point), the inferior process will become ``live''
6238 at that earlier state, and it will then be possible to continue the
6239 usual ``live'' debugging of the process from that state.
6241 When the inferior process exits, or @value{GDBN} detaches from it,
6242 process record and replay target will automatically stop itself.
6246 Go to a specific location in the execution log. There are several
6247 ways to specify the location to go to:
6250 @item record goto begin
6251 @itemx record goto start
6252 Go to the beginning of the execution log.
6254 @item record goto end
6255 Go to the end of the execution log.
6257 @item record goto @var{n}
6258 Go to instruction number @var{n} in the execution log.
6262 @item record save @var{filename}
6263 Save the execution log to a file @file{@var{filename}}.
6264 Default filename is @file{gdb_record.@var{process_id}}, where
6265 @var{process_id} is the process ID of the inferior.
6267 This command may not be available for all recording methods.
6269 @kindex record restore
6270 @item record restore @var{filename}
6271 Restore the execution log from a file @file{@var{filename}}.
6272 File must have been created with @code{record save}.
6274 @kindex set record full
6275 @item set record full insn-number-max @var{limit}
6276 @itemx set record full insn-number-max unlimited
6277 Set the limit of instructions to be recorded for the @code{full}
6278 recording method. Default value is 200000.
6280 If @var{limit} is a positive number, then @value{GDBN} will start
6281 deleting instructions from the log once the number of the record
6282 instructions becomes greater than @var{limit}. For every new recorded
6283 instruction, @value{GDBN} will delete the earliest recorded
6284 instruction to keep the number of recorded instructions at the limit.
6285 (Since deleting recorded instructions loses information, @value{GDBN}
6286 lets you control what happens when the limit is reached, by means of
6287 the @code{stop-at-limit} option, described below.)
6289 If @var{limit} is @code{unlimited} or zero, @value{GDBN} will never
6290 delete recorded instructions from the execution log. The number of
6291 recorded instructions is limited only by the available memory.
6293 @kindex show record full
6294 @item show record full insn-number-max
6295 Show the limit of instructions to be recorded with the @code{full}
6298 @item set record full stop-at-limit
6299 Control the behavior of the @code{full} recording method when the
6300 number of recorded instructions reaches the limit. If ON (the
6301 default), @value{GDBN} will stop when the limit is reached for the
6302 first time and ask you whether you want to stop the inferior or
6303 continue running it and recording the execution log. If you decide
6304 to continue recording, each new recorded instruction will cause the
6305 oldest one to be deleted.
6307 If this option is OFF, @value{GDBN} will automatically delete the
6308 oldest record to make room for each new one, without asking.
6310 @item show record full stop-at-limit
6311 Show the current setting of @code{stop-at-limit}.
6313 @item set record full memory-query
6314 Control the behavior when @value{GDBN} is unable to record memory
6315 changes caused by an instruction for the @code{full} recording method.
6316 If ON, @value{GDBN} will query whether to stop the inferior in that
6319 If this option is OFF (the default), @value{GDBN} will automatically
6320 ignore the effect of such instructions on memory. Later, when
6321 @value{GDBN} replays this execution log, it will mark the log of this
6322 instruction as not accessible, and it will not affect the replay
6325 @item show record full memory-query
6326 Show the current setting of @code{memory-query}.
6330 Show various statistics about the recording depending on the recording
6335 For the @code{full} recording method, it shows the state of process
6336 record and its in-memory execution log buffer, including:
6340 Whether in record mode or replay mode.
6342 Lowest recorded instruction number (counting from when the current execution log started recording instructions).
6344 Highest recorded instruction number.
6346 Current instruction about to be replayed (if in replay mode).
6348 Number of instructions contained in the execution log.
6350 Maximum number of instructions that may be contained in the execution log.
6354 For the @code{btrace} recording method, it shows the number of
6355 instructions that have been recorded and the number of blocks of
6356 sequential control-flow that is formed by the recorded instructions.
6359 @kindex record delete
6362 When record target runs in replay mode (``in the past''), delete the
6363 subsequent execution log and begin to record a new execution log starting
6364 from the current address. This means you will abandon the previously
6365 recorded ``future'' and begin recording a new ``future''.
6367 @kindex record instruction-history
6368 @kindex rec instruction-history
6369 @item record instruction-history
6370 Disassembles instructions from the recorded execution log. By
6371 default, ten instructions are disassembled. This can be changed using
6372 the @code{set record instruction-history-size} command. Instructions
6373 are printed in execution order. There are several ways to specify
6374 what part of the execution log to disassemble:
6377 @item record instruction-history @var{insn}
6378 Disassembles ten instructions starting from instruction number
6381 @item record instruction-history @var{insn}, +/-@var{n}
6382 Disassembles @var{n} instructions around instruction number
6383 @var{insn}. If @var{n} is preceded with @code{+}, disassembles
6384 @var{n} instructions after instruction number @var{insn}. If
6385 @var{n} is preceded with @code{-}, disassembles @var{n}
6386 instructions before instruction number @var{insn}.
6388 @item record instruction-history
6389 Disassembles ten more instructions after the last disassembly.
6391 @item record instruction-history -
6392 Disassembles ten more instructions before the last disassembly.
6394 @item record instruction-history @var{begin} @var{end}
6395 Disassembles instructions beginning with instruction number
6396 @var{begin} until instruction number @var{end}. The instruction
6397 number @var{end} is not included.
6400 This command may not be available for all recording methods.
6403 @item set record instruction-history-size @var{size}
6404 @itemx set record instruction-history-size unlimited
6405 Define how many instructions to disassemble in the @code{record
6406 instruction-history} command. The default value is 10.
6407 A @var{size} of @code{unlimited} means unlimited instructions.
6410 @item show record instruction-history-size
6411 Show how many instructions to disassemble in the @code{record
6412 instruction-history} command.
6414 @kindex record function-call-history
6415 @kindex rec function-call-history
6416 @item record function-call-history
6417 Prints the execution history at function granularity. It prints one
6418 line for each sequence of instructions that belong to the same
6419 function giving the name of that function, the source lines
6420 for this instruction sequence (if the @code{/l} modifier is
6421 specified), and the instructions numbers that form the sequence (if
6422 the @code{/i} modifier is specified).
6425 (@value{GDBP}) @b{list 1, 10}
6436 (@value{GDBP}) @b{record function-call-history /l}
6442 By default, ten lines are printed. This can be changed using the
6443 @code{set record function-call-history-size} command. Functions are
6444 printed in execution order. There are several ways to specify what
6448 @item record function-call-history @var{func}
6449 Prints ten functions starting from function number @var{func}.
6451 @item record function-call-history @var{func}, +/-@var{n}
6452 Prints @var{n} functions around function number @var{func}. If
6453 @var{n} is preceded with @code{+}, prints @var{n} functions after
6454 function number @var{func}. If @var{n} is preceded with @code{-},
6455 prints @var{n} functions before function number @var{func}.
6457 @item record function-call-history
6458 Prints ten more functions after the last ten-line print.
6460 @item record function-call-history -
6461 Prints ten more functions before the last ten-line print.
6463 @item record function-call-history @var{begin} @var{end}
6464 Prints functions beginning with function number @var{begin} until
6465 function number @var{end}. The function number @var{end} is not
6469 This command may not be available for all recording methods.
6471 @item set record function-call-history-size @var{size}
6472 @itemx set record function-call-history-size unlimited
6473 Define how many lines to print in the
6474 @code{record function-call-history} command. The default value is 10.
6475 A size of @code{unlimited} means unlimited lines.
6477 @item show record function-call-history-size
6478 Show how many lines to print in the
6479 @code{record function-call-history} command.
6484 @chapter Examining the Stack
6486 When your program has stopped, the first thing you need to know is where it
6487 stopped and how it got there.
6490 Each time your program performs a function call, information about the call
6492 That information includes the location of the call in your program,
6493 the arguments of the call,
6494 and the local variables of the function being called.
6495 The information is saved in a block of data called a @dfn{stack frame}.
6496 The stack frames are allocated in a region of memory called the @dfn{call
6499 When your program stops, the @value{GDBN} commands for examining the
6500 stack allow you to see all of this information.
6502 @cindex selected frame
6503 One of the stack frames is @dfn{selected} by @value{GDBN} and many
6504 @value{GDBN} commands refer implicitly to the selected frame. In
6505 particular, whenever you ask @value{GDBN} for the value of a variable in
6506 your program, the value is found in the selected frame. There are
6507 special @value{GDBN} commands to select whichever frame you are
6508 interested in. @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
6510 When your program stops, @value{GDBN} automatically selects the
6511 currently executing frame and describes it briefly, similar to the
6512 @code{frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}).
6515 * Frames:: Stack frames
6516 * Backtrace:: Backtraces
6517 * Frame Filter Management:: Managing frame filters
6518 * Selection:: Selecting a frame
6519 * Frame Info:: Information on a frame
6524 @section Stack Frames
6526 @cindex frame, definition
6528 The call stack is divided up into contiguous pieces called @dfn{stack
6529 frames}, or @dfn{frames} for short; each frame is the data associated
6530 with one call to one function. The frame contains the arguments given
6531 to the function, the function's local variables, and the address at
6532 which the function is executing.
6534 @cindex initial frame
6535 @cindex outermost frame
6536 @cindex innermost frame
6537 When your program is started, the stack has only one frame, that of the
6538 function @code{main}. This is called the @dfn{initial} frame or the
6539 @dfn{outermost} frame. Each time a function is called, a new frame is
6540 made. Each time a function returns, the frame for that function invocation
6541 is eliminated. If a function is recursive, there can be many frames for
6542 the same function. The frame for the function in which execution is
6543 actually occurring is called the @dfn{innermost} frame. This is the most
6544 recently created of all the stack frames that still exist.
6546 @cindex frame pointer
6547 Inside your program, stack frames are identified by their addresses. A
6548 stack frame consists of many bytes, each of which has its own address; each
6549 kind of computer has a convention for choosing one byte whose
6550 address serves as the address of the frame. Usually this address is kept
6551 in a register called the @dfn{frame pointer register}
6552 (@pxref{Registers, $fp}) while execution is going on in that frame.
6554 @cindex frame number
6555 @value{GDBN} assigns numbers to all existing stack frames, starting with
6556 zero for the innermost frame, one for the frame that called it,
6557 and so on upward. These numbers do not really exist in your program;
6558 they are assigned by @value{GDBN} to give you a way of designating stack
6559 frames in @value{GDBN} commands.
6561 @c The -fomit-frame-pointer below perennially causes hbox overflow
6562 @c underflow problems.
6563 @cindex frameless execution
6564 Some compilers provide a way to compile functions so that they operate
6565 without stack frames. (For example, the @value{NGCC} option
6567 @samp{-fomit-frame-pointer}
6569 generates functions without a frame.)
6570 This is occasionally done with heavily used library functions to save
6571 the frame setup time. @value{GDBN} has limited facilities for dealing
6572 with these function invocations. If the innermost function invocation
6573 has no stack frame, @value{GDBN} nevertheless regards it as though
6574 it had a separate frame, which is numbered zero as usual, allowing
6575 correct tracing of the function call chain. However, @value{GDBN} has
6576 no provision for frameless functions elsewhere in the stack.
6579 @kindex frame@r{, command}
6580 @cindex current stack frame
6581 @item frame @var{args}
6582 The @code{frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame to another,
6583 and to print the stack frame you select. @var{args} may be either the
6584 address of the frame or the stack frame number. Without an argument,
6585 @code{frame} prints the current stack frame.
6587 @kindex select-frame
6588 @cindex selecting frame silently
6590 The @code{select-frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame
6591 to another without printing the frame. This is the silent version of
6599 @cindex call stack traces
6600 A backtrace is a summary of how your program got where it is. It shows one
6601 line per frame, for many frames, starting with the currently executing
6602 frame (frame zero), followed by its caller (frame one), and on up the
6605 @anchor{backtrace-command}
6608 @kindex bt @r{(@code{backtrace})}
6611 Print a backtrace of the entire stack: one line per frame for all
6612 frames in the stack.
6614 You can stop the backtrace at any time by typing the system interrupt
6615 character, normally @kbd{Ctrl-c}.
6617 @item backtrace @var{n}
6619 Similar, but print only the innermost @var{n} frames.
6621 @item backtrace -@var{n}
6623 Similar, but print only the outermost @var{n} frames.
6625 @item backtrace full
6627 @itemx bt full @var{n}
6628 @itemx bt full -@var{n}
6629 Print the values of the local variables also. @var{n} specifies the
6630 number of frames to print, as described above.
6632 @item backtrace no-filters
6633 @itemx bt no-filters
6634 @itemx bt no-filters @var{n}
6635 @itemx bt no-filters -@var{n}
6636 @itemx bt no-filters full
6637 @itemx bt no-filters full @var{n}
6638 @itemx bt no-filters full -@var{n}
6639 Do not run Python frame filters on this backtrace. @xref{Frame
6640 Filter API}, for more information. Additionally use @ref{disable
6641 frame-filter all} to turn off all frame filters. This is only
6642 relevant when @value{GDBN} has been configured with @code{Python}
6648 The names @code{where} and @code{info stack} (abbreviated @code{info s})
6649 are additional aliases for @code{backtrace}.
6651 @cindex multiple threads, backtrace
6652 In a multi-threaded program, @value{GDBN} by default shows the
6653 backtrace only for the current thread. To display the backtrace for
6654 several or all of the threads, use the command @code{thread apply}
6655 (@pxref{Threads, thread apply}). For example, if you type @kbd{thread
6656 apply all backtrace}, @value{GDBN} will display the backtrace for all
6657 the threads; this is handy when you debug a core dump of a
6658 multi-threaded program.
6660 Each line in the backtrace shows the frame number and the function name.
6661 The program counter value is also shown---unless you use @code{set
6662 print address off}. The backtrace also shows the source file name and
6663 line number, as well as the arguments to the function. The program
6664 counter value is omitted if it is at the beginning of the code for that
6667 Here is an example of a backtrace. It was made with the command
6668 @samp{bt 3}, so it shows the innermost three frames.
6672 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
6674 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=0x2b600, data=...) at macro.c:242
6675 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=177664, td=0xf7fffb08)
6677 (More stack frames follow...)
6682 The display for frame zero does not begin with a program counter
6683 value, indicating that your program has stopped at the beginning of the
6684 code for line @code{993} of @code{builtin.c}.
6687 The value of parameter @code{data} in frame 1 has been replaced by
6688 @code{@dots{}}. By default, @value{GDBN} prints the value of a parameter
6689 only if it is a scalar (integer, pointer, enumeration, etc). See command
6690 @kbd{set print frame-arguments} in @ref{Print Settings} for more details
6691 on how to configure the way function parameter values are printed.
6693 @cindex optimized out, in backtrace
6694 @cindex function call arguments, optimized out
6695 If your program was compiled with optimizations, some compilers will
6696 optimize away arguments passed to functions if those arguments are
6697 never used after the call. Such optimizations generate code that
6698 passes arguments through registers, but doesn't store those arguments
6699 in the stack frame. @value{GDBN} has no way of displaying such
6700 arguments in stack frames other than the innermost one. Here's what
6701 such a backtrace might look like:
6705 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
6707 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=<optimized out>) at macro.c:242
6708 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=<optimized out>, td=0xf7fffb08)
6710 (More stack frames follow...)
6715 The values of arguments that were not saved in their stack frames are
6716 shown as @samp{<optimized out>}.
6718 If you need to display the values of such optimized-out arguments,
6719 either deduce that from other variables whose values depend on the one
6720 you are interested in, or recompile without optimizations.
6722 @cindex backtrace beyond @code{main} function
6723 @cindex program entry point
6724 @cindex startup code, and backtrace
6725 Most programs have a standard user entry point---a place where system
6726 libraries and startup code transition into user code. For C this is
6727 @code{main}@footnote{
6728 Note that embedded programs (the so-called ``free-standing''
6729 environment) are not required to have a @code{main} function as the
6730 entry point. They could even have multiple entry points.}.
6731 When @value{GDBN} finds the entry function in a backtrace
6732 it will terminate the backtrace, to avoid tracing into highly
6733 system-specific (and generally uninteresting) code.
6735 If you need to examine the startup code, or limit the number of levels
6736 in a backtrace, you can change this behavior:
6739 @item set backtrace past-main
6740 @itemx set backtrace past-main on
6741 @kindex set backtrace
6742 Backtraces will continue past the user entry point.
6744 @item set backtrace past-main off
6745 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the user entry point. This is the
6748 @item show backtrace past-main
6749 @kindex show backtrace
6750 Display the current user entry point backtrace policy.
6752 @item set backtrace past-entry
6753 @itemx set backtrace past-entry on
6754 Backtraces will continue past the internal entry point of an application.
6755 This entry point is encoded by the linker when the application is built,
6756 and is likely before the user entry point @code{main} (or equivalent) is called.
6758 @item set backtrace past-entry off
6759 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the internal entry point of an
6760 application. This is the default.
6762 @item show backtrace past-entry
6763 Display the current internal entry point backtrace policy.
6765 @item set backtrace limit @var{n}
6766 @itemx set backtrace limit 0
6767 @itemx set backtrace limit unlimited
6768 @cindex backtrace limit
6769 Limit the backtrace to @var{n} levels. A value of @code{unlimited}
6770 or zero means unlimited levels.
6772 @item show backtrace limit
6773 Display the current limit on backtrace levels.
6776 You can control how file names are displayed.
6779 @item set filename-display
6780 @itemx set filename-display relative
6781 @cindex filename-display
6782 Display file names relative to the compilation directory. This is the default.
6784 @item set filename-display basename
6785 Display only basename of a filename.
6787 @item set filename-display absolute
6788 Display an absolute filename.
6790 @item show filename-display
6791 Show the current way to display filenames.
6794 @node Frame Filter Management
6795 @section Management of Frame Filters.
6796 @cindex managing frame filters
6798 Frame filters are Python based utilities to manage and decorate the
6799 output of frames. @xref{Frame Filter API}, for further information.
6801 Managing frame filters is performed by several commands available
6802 within @value{GDBN}, detailed here.
6805 @kindex info frame-filter
6806 @item info frame-filter
6807 Print a list of installed frame filters from all dictionaries, showing
6808 their name, priority and enabled status.
6810 @kindex disable frame-filter
6811 @anchor{disable frame-filter all}
6812 @item disable frame-filter @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name}
6813 Disable a frame filter in the dictionary matching
6814 @var{filter-dictionary}, or @code{all}, and @var{filter-name}.
6815 @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{all}, @code{global},
6816 @code{progspace} or the name of the object file where the frame filter
6817 dictionary resides. When @code{all} is specified, all frame filters
6818 across all dictionaries are disabled. @var{filter-name} is the name
6819 of the frame filter and is used when @code{all} is not the option for
6820 @var{filter-dictionary}. A disabled frame-filter is not deleted, it
6821 may be enabled again later.
6823 @kindex enable frame-filter
6824 @item enable frame-filter @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name}
6825 Enable a frame filter in the dictionary matching
6826 @var{filter-dictionary}, or @code{all}, and @var{filter-name}.
6827 @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{all}, @code{global},
6828 @code{progspace} or the name of the object file where the frame filter
6829 dictionary resides. When @code{all} is specified, all frame filters across
6830 all dictionaries are enabled. @var{filter-name} is the name of the frame
6831 filter and is used when @code{all} is not the option for
6832 @var{filter-dictionary}.
6837 (gdb) info frame-filter
6839 global frame-filters:
6840 Priority Enabled Name
6841 1000 No PrimaryFunctionFilter
6844 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
6845 Priority Enabled Name
6846 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
6848 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
6849 Priority Enabled Name
6850 999 Yes BuildProgra Filter
6852 (gdb) disable frame-filter /build/test BuildProgramFilter
6853 (gdb) info frame-filter
6855 global frame-filters:
6856 Priority Enabled Name
6857 1000 No PrimaryFunctionFilter
6860 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
6861 Priority Enabled Name
6862 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
6864 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
6865 Priority Enabled Name
6866 999 No BuildProgramFilter
6868 (gdb) enable frame-filter global PrimaryFunctionFilter
6869 (gdb) info frame-filter
6871 global frame-filters:
6872 Priority Enabled Name
6873 1000 Yes PrimaryFunctionFilter
6876 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
6877 Priority Enabled Name
6878 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
6880 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
6881 Priority Enabled Name
6882 999 No BuildProgramFilter
6885 @kindex set frame-filter priority
6886 @item set frame-filter priority @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name} @var{priority}
6887 Set the @var{priority} of a frame filter in the dictionary matching
6888 @var{filter-dictionary}, and the frame filter name matching
6889 @var{filter-name}. @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{global},
6890 @code{progspace} or the name of the object file where the frame filter
6891 dictionary resides. @var{priority} is an integer.
6893 @kindex show frame-filter priority
6894 @item show frame-filter priority @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name}
6895 Show the @var{priority} of a frame filter in the dictionary matching
6896 @var{filter-dictionary}, and the frame filter name matching
6897 @var{filter-name}. @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{global},
6898 @code{progspace} or the name of the object file where the frame filter
6904 (gdb) info frame-filter
6906 global frame-filters:
6907 Priority Enabled Name
6908 1000 Yes PrimaryFunctionFilter
6911 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
6912 Priority Enabled Name
6913 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
6915 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
6916 Priority Enabled Name
6917 999 No BuildProgramFilter
6919 (gdb) set frame-filter priority global Reverse 50
6920 (gdb) info frame-filter
6922 global frame-filters:
6923 Priority Enabled Name
6924 1000 Yes PrimaryFunctionFilter
6927 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
6928 Priority Enabled Name
6929 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
6931 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
6932 Priority Enabled Name
6933 999 No BuildProgramFilter
6938 @section Selecting a Frame
6940 Most commands for examining the stack and other data in your program work on
6941 whichever stack frame is selected at the moment. Here are the commands for
6942 selecting a stack frame; all of them finish by printing a brief description
6943 of the stack frame just selected.
6946 @kindex frame@r{, selecting}
6947 @kindex f @r{(@code{frame})}
6950 Select frame number @var{n}. Recall that frame zero is the innermost
6951 (currently executing) frame, frame one is the frame that called the
6952 innermost one, and so on. The highest-numbered frame is the one for
6955 @item frame @var{addr}
6957 Select the frame at address @var{addr}. This is useful mainly if the
6958 chaining of stack frames has been damaged by a bug, making it
6959 impossible for @value{GDBN} to assign numbers properly to all frames. In
6960 addition, this can be useful when your program has multiple stacks and
6961 switches between them.
6963 On the SPARC architecture, @code{frame} needs two addresses to
6964 select an arbitrary frame: a frame pointer and a stack pointer.
6966 On the @acronym{MIPS} and Alpha architecture, it needs two addresses: a stack
6967 pointer and a program counter.
6969 On the 29k architecture, it needs three addresses: a register stack
6970 pointer, a program counter, and a memory stack pointer.
6974 Move @var{n} frames up the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
6975 advances toward the outermost frame, to higher frame numbers, to frames
6976 that have existed longer. @var{n} defaults to one.
6979 @kindex do @r{(@code{down})}
6981 Move @var{n} frames down the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
6982 advances toward the innermost frame, to lower frame numbers, to frames
6983 that were created more recently. @var{n} defaults to one. You may
6984 abbreviate @code{down} as @code{do}.
6987 All of these commands end by printing two lines of output describing the
6988 frame. The first line shows the frame number, the function name, the
6989 arguments, and the source file and line number of execution in that
6990 frame. The second line shows the text of that source line.
6998 #1 0x22f0 in main (argc=1, argv=0xf7fffbf4, env=0xf7fffbfc)
7000 10 read_input_file (argv[i]);
7004 After such a printout, the @code{list} command with no arguments
7005 prints ten lines centered on the point of execution in the frame.
7006 You can also edit the program at the point of execution with your favorite
7007 editing program by typing @code{edit}.
7008 @xref{List, ,Printing Source Lines},
7012 @kindex down-silently
7014 @item up-silently @var{n}
7015 @itemx down-silently @var{n}
7016 These two commands are variants of @code{up} and @code{down},
7017 respectively; they differ in that they do their work silently, without
7018 causing display of the new frame. They are intended primarily for use
7019 in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the output might be unnecessary and
7024 @section Information About a Frame
7026 There are several other commands to print information about the selected
7032 When used without any argument, this command does not change which
7033 frame is selected, but prints a brief description of the currently
7034 selected stack frame. It can be abbreviated @code{f}. With an
7035 argument, this command is used to select a stack frame.
7036 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
7039 @kindex info f @r{(@code{info frame})}
7042 This command prints a verbose description of the selected stack frame,
7047 the address of the frame
7049 the address of the next frame down (called by this frame)
7051 the address of the next frame up (caller of this frame)
7053 the language in which the source code corresponding to this frame is written
7055 the address of the frame's arguments
7057 the address of the frame's local variables
7059 the program counter saved in it (the address of execution in the caller frame)
7061 which registers were saved in the frame
7064 @noindent The verbose description is useful when
7065 something has gone wrong that has made the stack format fail to fit
7066 the usual conventions.
7068 @item info frame @var{addr}
7069 @itemx info f @var{addr}
7070 Print a verbose description of the frame at address @var{addr}, without
7071 selecting that frame. The selected frame remains unchanged by this
7072 command. This requires the same kind of address (more than one for some
7073 architectures) that you specify in the @code{frame} command.
7074 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
7078 Print the arguments of the selected frame, each on a separate line.
7082 Print the local variables of the selected frame, each on a separate
7083 line. These are all variables (declared either static or automatic)
7084 accessible at the point of execution of the selected frame.
7090 @chapter Examining Source Files
7092 @value{GDBN} can print parts of your program's source, since the debugging
7093 information recorded in the program tells @value{GDBN} what source files were
7094 used to build it. When your program stops, @value{GDBN} spontaneously prints
7095 the line where it stopped. Likewise, when you select a stack frame
7096 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}), @value{GDBN} prints the line where
7097 execution in that frame has stopped. You can print other portions of
7098 source files by explicit command.
7100 If you use @value{GDBN} through its @sc{gnu} Emacs interface, you may
7101 prefer to use Emacs facilities to view source; see @ref{Emacs, ,Using
7102 @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}.
7105 * List:: Printing source lines
7106 * Specify Location:: How to specify code locations
7107 * Edit:: Editing source files
7108 * Search:: Searching source files
7109 * Source Path:: Specifying source directories
7110 * Machine Code:: Source and machine code
7114 @section Printing Source Lines
7117 @kindex l @r{(@code{list})}
7118 To print lines from a source file, use the @code{list} command
7119 (abbreviated @code{l}). By default, ten lines are printed.
7120 There are several ways to specify what part of the file you want to
7121 print; see @ref{Specify Location}, for the full list.
7123 Here are the forms of the @code{list} command most commonly used:
7126 @item list @var{linenum}
7127 Print lines centered around line number @var{linenum} in the
7128 current source file.
7130 @item list @var{function}
7131 Print lines centered around the beginning of function
7135 Print more lines. If the last lines printed were printed with a
7136 @code{list} command, this prints lines following the last lines
7137 printed; however, if the last line printed was a solitary line printed
7138 as part of displaying a stack frame (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the
7139 Stack}), this prints lines centered around that line.
7142 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
7145 @cindex @code{list}, how many lines to display
7146 By default, @value{GDBN} prints ten source lines with any of these forms of
7147 the @code{list} command. You can change this using @code{set listsize}:
7150 @kindex set listsize
7151 @item set listsize @var{count}
7152 @itemx set listsize unlimited
7153 Make the @code{list} command display @var{count} source lines (unless
7154 the @code{list} argument explicitly specifies some other number).
7155 Setting @var{count} to @code{unlimited} or 0 means there's no limit.
7157 @kindex show listsize
7159 Display the number of lines that @code{list} prints.
7162 Repeating a @code{list} command with @key{RET} discards the argument,
7163 so it is equivalent to typing just @code{list}. This is more useful
7164 than listing the same lines again. An exception is made for an
7165 argument of @samp{-}; that argument is preserved in repetition so that
7166 each repetition moves up in the source file.
7168 In general, the @code{list} command expects you to supply zero, one or two
7169 @dfn{linespecs}. Linespecs specify source lines; there are several ways
7170 of writing them (@pxref{Specify Location}), but the effect is always
7171 to specify some source line.
7173 Here is a complete description of the possible arguments for @code{list}:
7176 @item list @var{linespec}
7177 Print lines centered around the line specified by @var{linespec}.
7179 @item list @var{first},@var{last}
7180 Print lines from @var{first} to @var{last}. Both arguments are
7181 linespecs. When a @code{list} command has two linespecs, and the
7182 source file of the second linespec is omitted, this refers to
7183 the same source file as the first linespec.
7185 @item list ,@var{last}
7186 Print lines ending with @var{last}.
7188 @item list @var{first},
7189 Print lines starting with @var{first}.
7192 Print lines just after the lines last printed.
7195 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
7198 As described in the preceding table.
7201 @node Specify Location
7202 @section Specifying a Location
7203 @cindex specifying location
7206 Several @value{GDBN} commands accept arguments that specify a location
7207 of your program's code. Since @value{GDBN} is a source-level
7208 debugger, a location usually specifies some line in the source code;
7209 for that reason, locations are also known as @dfn{linespecs}.
7211 Here are all the different ways of specifying a code location that
7212 @value{GDBN} understands:
7216 Specifies the line number @var{linenum} of the current source file.
7219 @itemx +@var{offset}
7220 Specifies the line @var{offset} lines before or after the @dfn{current
7221 line}. For the @code{list} command, the current line is the last one
7222 printed; for the breakpoint commands, this is the line at which
7223 execution stopped in the currently selected @dfn{stack frame}
7224 (@pxref{Frames, ,Frames}, for a description of stack frames.) When
7225 used as the second of the two linespecs in a @code{list} command,
7226 this specifies the line @var{offset} lines up or down from the first
7229 @item @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
7230 Specifies the line @var{linenum} in the source file @var{filename}.
7231 If @var{filename} is a relative file name, then it will match any
7232 source file name with the same trailing components. For example, if
7233 @var{filename} is @samp{gcc/expr.c}, then it will match source file
7234 name of @file{/build/trunk/gcc/expr.c}, but not
7235 @file{/build/trunk/libcpp/expr.c} or @file{/build/trunk/gcc/x-expr.c}.
7237 @item @var{function}
7238 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}.
7239 For example, in C, this is the line with the open brace.
7241 @item @var{function}:@var{label}
7242 Specifies the line where @var{label} appears in @var{function}.
7244 @item @var{filename}:@var{function}
7245 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}
7246 in the file @var{filename}. You only need the file name with a
7247 function name to avoid ambiguity when there are identically named
7248 functions in different source files.
7251 Specifies the line at which the label named @var{label} appears.
7252 @value{GDBN} searches for the label in the function corresponding to
7253 the currently selected stack frame. If there is no current selected
7254 stack frame (for instance, if the inferior is not running), then
7255 @value{GDBN} will not search for a label.
7257 @item *@var{address}
7258 Specifies the program address @var{address}. For line-oriented
7259 commands, such as @code{list} and @code{edit}, this specifies a source
7260 line that contains @var{address}. For @code{break} and other
7261 breakpoint oriented commands, this can be used to set breakpoints in
7262 parts of your program which do not have debugging information or
7265 Here @var{address} may be any expression valid in the current working
7266 language (@pxref{Languages, working language}) that specifies a code
7267 address. In addition, as a convenience, @value{GDBN} extends the
7268 semantics of expressions used in locations to cover the situations
7269 that frequently happen during debugging. Here are the various forms
7273 @item @var{expression}
7274 Any expression valid in the current working language.
7276 @item @var{funcaddr}
7277 An address of a function or procedure derived from its name. In C,
7278 C@t{++}, Java, Objective-C, Fortran, minimal, and assembly, this is
7279 simply the function's name @var{function} (and actually a special case
7280 of a valid expression). In Pascal and Modula-2, this is
7281 @code{&@var{function}}. In Ada, this is @code{@var{function}'Address}
7282 (although the Pascal form also works).
7284 This form specifies the address of the function's first instruction,
7285 before the stack frame and arguments have been set up.
7287 @item '@var{filename}'::@var{funcaddr}
7288 Like @var{funcaddr} above, but also specifies the name of the source
7289 file explicitly. This is useful if the name of the function does not
7290 specify the function unambiguously, e.g., if there are several
7291 functions with identical names in different source files.
7294 @cindex breakpoint at static probe point
7295 @item -pstap|-probe-stap @r{[}@var{objfile}:@r{[}@var{provider}:@r{]}@r{]}@var{name}
7296 The @sc{gnu}/Linux tool @code{SystemTap} provides a way for
7297 applications to embed static probes. @xref{Static Probe Points}, for more
7298 information on finding and using static probes. This form of linespec
7299 specifies the location of such a static probe.
7301 If @var{objfile} is given, only probes coming from that shared library
7302 or executable matching @var{objfile} as a regular expression are considered.
7303 If @var{provider} is given, then only probes from that provider are considered.
7304 If several probes match the spec, @value{GDBN} will insert a breakpoint at
7305 each one of those probes.
7311 @section Editing Source Files
7312 @cindex editing source files
7315 @kindex e @r{(@code{edit})}
7316 To edit the lines in a source file, use the @code{edit} command.
7317 The editing program of your choice
7318 is invoked with the current line set to
7319 the active line in the program.
7320 Alternatively, there are several ways to specify what part of the file you
7321 want to print if you want to see other parts of the program:
7324 @item edit @var{location}
7325 Edit the source file specified by @code{location}. Editing starts at
7326 that @var{location}, e.g., at the specified source line of the
7327 specified file. @xref{Specify Location}, for all the possible forms
7328 of the @var{location} argument; here are the forms of the @code{edit}
7329 command most commonly used:
7332 @item edit @var{number}
7333 Edit the current source file with @var{number} as the active line number.
7335 @item edit @var{function}
7336 Edit the file containing @var{function} at the beginning of its definition.
7341 @subsection Choosing your Editor
7342 You can customize @value{GDBN} to use any editor you want
7344 The only restriction is that your editor (say @code{ex}), recognizes the
7345 following command-line syntax:
7347 ex +@var{number} file
7349 The optional numeric value +@var{number} specifies the number of the line in
7350 the file where to start editing.}.
7351 By default, it is @file{@value{EDITOR}}, but you can change this
7352 by setting the environment variable @code{EDITOR} before using
7353 @value{GDBN}. For example, to configure @value{GDBN} to use the
7354 @code{vi} editor, you could use these commands with the @code{sh} shell:
7360 or in the @code{csh} shell,
7362 setenv EDITOR /usr/bin/vi
7367 @section Searching Source Files
7368 @cindex searching source files
7370 There are two commands for searching through the current source file for a
7375 @kindex forward-search
7376 @kindex fo @r{(@code{forward-search})}
7377 @item forward-search @var{regexp}
7378 @itemx search @var{regexp}
7379 The command @samp{forward-search @var{regexp}} checks each line,
7380 starting with the one following the last line listed, for a match for
7381 @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can use the
7382 synonym @samp{search @var{regexp}} or abbreviate the command name as
7385 @kindex reverse-search
7386 @item reverse-search @var{regexp}
7387 The command @samp{reverse-search @var{regexp}} checks each line, starting
7388 with the one before the last line listed and going backward, for a match
7389 for @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can abbreviate
7390 this command as @code{rev}.
7394 @section Specifying Source Directories
7397 @cindex directories for source files
7398 Executable programs sometimes do not record the directories of the source
7399 files from which they were compiled, just the names. Even when they do,
7400 the directories could be moved between the compilation and your debugging
7401 session. @value{GDBN} has a list of directories to search for source files;
7402 this is called the @dfn{source path}. Each time @value{GDBN} wants a source file,
7403 it tries all the directories in the list, in the order they are present
7404 in the list, until it finds a file with the desired name.
7406 For example, suppose an executable references the file
7407 @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}, and our source path is
7408 @file{/mnt/cross}. The file is first looked up literally; if this
7409 fails, @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} is tried; if this
7410 fails, @file{/mnt/cross/foo.c} is opened; if this fails, an error
7411 message is printed. @value{GDBN} does not look up the parts of the
7412 source file name, such as @file{/mnt/cross/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}.
7413 Likewise, the subdirectories of the source path are not searched: if
7414 the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the binary refers to
7415 @file{foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would not find it under
7416 @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib}.
7418 Plain file names, relative file names with leading directories, file
7419 names containing dots, etc.@: are all treated as described above; for
7420 instance, if the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the source file
7421 is recorded as @file{../lib/foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would first try
7422 @file{../lib/foo.c}, then @file{/mnt/cross/../lib/foo.c}, and after
7423 that---@file{/mnt/cross/foo.c}.
7425 Note that the executable search path is @emph{not} used to locate the
7428 Whenever you reset or rearrange the source path, @value{GDBN} clears out
7429 any information it has cached about where source files are found and where
7430 each line is in the file.
7434 When you start @value{GDBN}, its source path includes only @samp{cdir}
7435 and @samp{cwd}, in that order.
7436 To add other directories, use the @code{directory} command.
7438 The search path is used to find both program source files and @value{GDBN}
7439 script files (read using the @samp{-command} option and @samp{source} command).
7441 In addition to the source path, @value{GDBN} provides a set of commands
7442 that manage a list of source path substitution rules. A @dfn{substitution
7443 rule} specifies how to rewrite source directories stored in the program's
7444 debug information in case the sources were moved to a different
7445 directory between compilation and debugging. A rule is made of
7446 two strings, the first specifying what needs to be rewritten in
7447 the path, and the second specifying how it should be rewritten.
7448 In @ref{set substitute-path}, we name these two parts @var{from} and
7449 @var{to} respectively. @value{GDBN} does a simple string replacement
7450 of @var{from} with @var{to} at the start of the directory part of the
7451 source file name, and uses that result instead of the original file
7452 name to look up the sources.
7454 Using the previous example, suppose the @file{foo-1.0} tree has been
7455 moved from @file{/usr/src} to @file{/mnt/cross}, then you can tell
7456 @value{GDBN} to replace @file{/usr/src} in all source path names with
7457 @file{/mnt/cross}. The first lookup will then be
7458 @file{/mnt/cross/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} in place of the original location
7459 of @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}. To define a source path
7460 substitution rule, use the @code{set substitute-path} command
7461 (@pxref{set substitute-path}).
7463 To avoid unexpected substitution results, a rule is applied only if the
7464 @var{from} part of the directory name ends at a directory separator.
7465 For instance, a rule substituting @file{/usr/source} into
7466 @file{/mnt/cross} will be applied to @file{/usr/source/foo-1.0} but
7467 not to @file{/usr/sourceware/foo-2.0}. And because the substitution
7468 is applied only at the beginning of the directory name, this rule will
7469 not be applied to @file{/root/usr/source/baz.c} either.
7471 In many cases, you can achieve the same result using the @code{directory}
7472 command. However, @code{set substitute-path} can be more efficient in
7473 the case where the sources are organized in a complex tree with multiple
7474 subdirectories. With the @code{directory} command, you need to add each
7475 subdirectory of your project. If you moved the entire tree while
7476 preserving its internal organization, then @code{set substitute-path}
7477 allows you to direct the debugger to all the sources with one single
7480 @code{set substitute-path} is also more than just a shortcut command.
7481 The source path is only used if the file at the original location no
7482 longer exists. On the other hand, @code{set substitute-path} modifies
7483 the debugger behavior to look at the rewritten location instead. So, if
7484 for any reason a source file that is not relevant to your executable is
7485 located at the original location, a substitution rule is the only
7486 method available to point @value{GDBN} at the new location.
7488 @cindex @samp{--with-relocated-sources}
7489 @cindex default source path substitution
7490 You can configure a default source path substitution rule by
7491 configuring @value{GDBN} with the
7492 @samp{--with-relocated-sources=@var{dir}} option. The @var{dir}
7493 should be the name of a directory under @value{GDBN}'s configured
7494 prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or @samp{--exec-prefix}), and
7495 directory names in debug information under @var{dir} will be adjusted
7496 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
7497 location. This is useful if @value{GDBN}, libraries or executables
7498 with debug information and corresponding source code are being moved
7502 @item directory @var{dirname} @dots{}
7503 @item dir @var{dirname} @dots{}
7504 Add directory @var{dirname} to the front of the source path. Several
7505 directory names may be given to this command, separated by @samp{:}
7506 (@samp{;} on MS-DOS and MS-Windows, where @samp{:} usually appears as
7507 part of absolute file names) or
7508 whitespace. You may specify a directory that is already in the source
7509 path; this moves it forward, so @value{GDBN} searches it sooner.
7513 @vindex $cdir@r{, convenience variable}
7514 @vindex $cwd@r{, convenience variable}
7515 @cindex compilation directory
7516 @cindex current directory
7517 @cindex working directory
7518 @cindex directory, current
7519 @cindex directory, compilation
7520 You can use the string @samp{$cdir} to refer to the compilation
7521 directory (if one is recorded), and @samp{$cwd} to refer to the current
7522 working directory. @samp{$cwd} is not the same as @samp{.}---the former
7523 tracks the current working directory as it changes during your @value{GDBN}
7524 session, while the latter is immediately expanded to the current
7525 directory at the time you add an entry to the source path.
7528 Reset the source path to its default value (@samp{$cdir:$cwd} on Unix systems). This requires confirmation.
7530 @c RET-repeat for @code{directory} is explicitly disabled, but since
7531 @c repeating it would be a no-op we do not say that. (thanks to RMS)
7533 @item set directories @var{path-list}
7534 @kindex set directories
7535 Set the source path to @var{path-list}.
7536 @samp{$cdir:$cwd} are added if missing.
7538 @item show directories
7539 @kindex show directories
7540 Print the source path: show which directories it contains.
7542 @anchor{set substitute-path}
7543 @item set substitute-path @var{from} @var{to}
7544 @kindex set substitute-path
7545 Define a source path substitution rule, and add it at the end of the
7546 current list of existing substitution rules. If a rule with the same
7547 @var{from} was already defined, then the old rule is also deleted.
7549 For example, if the file @file{/foo/bar/baz.c} was moved to
7550 @file{/mnt/cross/baz.c}, then the command
7553 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src /mnt/cross
7557 will tell @value{GDBN} to replace @samp{/usr/src} with
7558 @samp{/mnt/cross}, which will allow @value{GDBN} to find the file
7559 @file{baz.c} even though it was moved.
7561 In the case when more than one substitution rule have been defined,
7562 the rules are evaluated one by one in the order where they have been
7563 defined. The first one matching, if any, is selected to perform
7566 For instance, if we had entered the following commands:
7569 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src/include /mnt/include
7570 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src /mnt/src
7574 @value{GDBN} would then rewrite @file{/usr/src/include/defs.h} into
7575 @file{/mnt/include/defs.h} by using the first rule. However, it would
7576 use the second rule to rewrite @file{/usr/src/lib/foo.c} into
7577 @file{/mnt/src/lib/foo.c}.
7580 @item unset substitute-path [path]
7581 @kindex unset substitute-path
7582 If a path is specified, search the current list of substitution rules
7583 for a rule that would rewrite that path. Delete that rule if found.
7584 A warning is emitted by the debugger if no rule could be found.
7586 If no path is specified, then all substitution rules are deleted.
7588 @item show substitute-path [path]
7589 @kindex show substitute-path
7590 If a path is specified, then print the source path substitution rule
7591 which would rewrite that path, if any.
7593 If no path is specified, then print all existing source path substitution
7598 If your source path is cluttered with directories that are no longer of
7599 interest, @value{GDBN} may sometimes cause confusion by finding the wrong
7600 versions of source. You can correct the situation as follows:
7604 Use @code{directory} with no argument to reset the source path to its default value.
7607 Use @code{directory} with suitable arguments to reinstall the
7608 directories you want in the source path. You can add all the
7609 directories in one command.
7613 @section Source and Machine Code
7614 @cindex source line and its code address
7616 You can use the command @code{info line} to map source lines to program
7617 addresses (and vice versa), and the command @code{disassemble} to display
7618 a range of addresses as machine instructions. You can use the command
7619 @code{set disassemble-next-line} to set whether to disassemble next
7620 source line when execution stops. When run under @sc{gnu} Emacs
7621 mode, the @code{info line} command causes the arrow to point to the
7622 line specified. Also, @code{info line} prints addresses in symbolic form as
7627 @item info line @var{linespec}
7628 Print the starting and ending addresses of the compiled code for
7629 source line @var{linespec}. You can specify source lines in any of
7630 the ways documented in @ref{Specify Location}.
7633 For example, we can use @code{info line} to discover the location of
7634 the object code for the first line of function
7635 @code{m4_changequote}:
7637 @c FIXME: I think this example should also show the addresses in
7638 @c symbolic form, as they usually would be displayed.
7640 (@value{GDBP}) info line m4_changequote
7641 Line 895 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x634c and ends at 0x6350.
7645 @cindex code address and its source line
7646 We can also inquire (using @code{*@var{addr}} as the form for
7647 @var{linespec}) what source line covers a particular address:
7649 (@value{GDBP}) info line *0x63ff
7650 Line 926 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x63e4 and ends at 0x6404.
7653 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info line}
7654 @cindex @code{x} command, default address
7655 @kindex x@r{(examine), and} info line
7656 After @code{info line}, the default address for the @code{x} command
7657 is changed to the starting address of the line, so that @samp{x/i} is
7658 sufficient to begin examining the machine code (@pxref{Memory,
7659 ,Examining Memory}). Also, this address is saved as the value of the
7660 convenience variable @code{$_} (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
7665 @cindex assembly instructions
7666 @cindex instructions, assembly
7667 @cindex machine instructions
7668 @cindex listing machine instructions
7670 @itemx disassemble /m
7671 @itemx disassemble /r
7672 This specialized command dumps a range of memory as machine
7673 instructions. It can also print mixed source+disassembly by specifying
7674 the @code{/m} modifier and print the raw instructions in hex as well as
7675 in symbolic form by specifying the @code{/r}.
7676 The default memory range is the function surrounding the
7677 program counter of the selected frame. A single argument to this
7678 command is a program counter value; @value{GDBN} dumps the function
7679 surrounding this value. When two arguments are given, they should
7680 be separated by a comma, possibly surrounded by whitespace. The
7681 arguments specify a range of addresses to dump, in one of two forms:
7684 @item @var{start},@var{end}
7685 the addresses from @var{start} (inclusive) to @var{end} (exclusive)
7686 @item @var{start},+@var{length}
7687 the addresses from @var{start} (inclusive) to
7688 @code{@var{start}+@var{length}} (exclusive).
7692 When 2 arguments are specified, the name of the function is also
7693 printed (since there could be several functions in the given range).
7695 The argument(s) can be any expression yielding a numeric value, such as
7696 @samp{0x32c4}, @samp{&main+10} or @samp{$pc - 8}.
7698 If the range of memory being disassembled contains current program counter,
7699 the instruction at that location is shown with a @code{=>} marker.
7702 The following example shows the disassembly of a range of addresses of
7703 HP PA-RISC 2.0 code:
7706 (@value{GDBP}) disas 0x32c4, 0x32e4
7707 Dump of assembler code from 0x32c4 to 0x32e4:
7708 0x32c4 <main+204>: addil 0,dp
7709 0x32c8 <main+208>: ldw 0x22c(sr0,r1),r26
7710 0x32cc <main+212>: ldil 0x3000,r31
7711 0x32d0 <main+216>: ble 0x3f8(sr4,r31)
7712 0x32d4 <main+220>: ldo 0(r31),rp
7713 0x32d8 <main+224>: addil -0x800,dp
7714 0x32dc <main+228>: ldo 0x588(r1),r26
7715 0x32e0 <main+232>: ldil 0x3000,r31
7716 End of assembler dump.
7719 Here is an example showing mixed source+assembly for Intel x86, when the
7720 program is stopped just after function prologue:
7723 (@value{GDBP}) disas /m main
7724 Dump of assembler code for function main:
7726 0x08048330 <+0>: push %ebp
7727 0x08048331 <+1>: mov %esp,%ebp
7728 0x08048333 <+3>: sub $0x8,%esp
7729 0x08048336 <+6>: and $0xfffffff0,%esp
7730 0x08048339 <+9>: sub $0x10,%esp
7732 6 printf ("Hello.\n");
7733 => 0x0804833c <+12>: movl $0x8048440,(%esp)
7734 0x08048343 <+19>: call 0x8048284 <puts@@plt>
7738 0x08048348 <+24>: mov $0x0,%eax
7739 0x0804834d <+29>: leave
7740 0x0804834e <+30>: ret
7742 End of assembler dump.
7745 Here is another example showing raw instructions in hex for AMD x86-64,
7748 (gdb) disas /r 0x400281,+10
7749 Dump of assembler code from 0x400281 to 0x40028b:
7750 0x0000000000400281: 38 36 cmp %dh,(%rsi)
7751 0x0000000000400283: 2d 36 34 2e 73 sub $0x732e3436,%eax
7752 0x0000000000400288: 6f outsl %ds:(%rsi),(%dx)
7753 0x0000000000400289: 2e 32 00 xor %cs:(%rax),%al
7754 End of assembler dump.
7757 Addresses cannot be specified as a linespec (@pxref{Specify Location}).
7758 So, for example, if you want to disassemble function @code{bar}
7759 in file @file{foo.c}, you must type @samp{disassemble 'foo.c'::bar}
7760 and not @samp{disassemble foo.c:bar}.
7762 Some architectures have more than one commonly-used set of instruction
7763 mnemonics or other syntax.
7765 For programs that were dynamically linked and use shared libraries,
7766 instructions that call functions or branch to locations in the shared
7767 libraries might show a seemingly bogus location---it's actually a
7768 location of the relocation table. On some architectures, @value{GDBN}
7769 might be able to resolve these to actual function names.
7772 @kindex set disassembly-flavor
7773 @cindex Intel disassembly flavor
7774 @cindex AT&T disassembly flavor
7775 @item set disassembly-flavor @var{instruction-set}
7776 Select the instruction set to use when disassembling the
7777 program via the @code{disassemble} or @code{x/i} commands.
7779 Currently this command is only defined for the Intel x86 family. You
7780 can set @var{instruction-set} to either @code{intel} or @code{att}.
7781 The default is @code{att}, the AT&T flavor used by default by Unix
7782 assemblers for x86-based targets.
7784 @kindex show disassembly-flavor
7785 @item show disassembly-flavor
7786 Show the current setting of the disassembly flavor.
7790 @kindex set disassemble-next-line
7791 @kindex show disassemble-next-line
7792 @item set disassemble-next-line
7793 @itemx show disassemble-next-line
7794 Control whether or not @value{GDBN} will disassemble the next source
7795 line or instruction when execution stops. If ON, @value{GDBN} will
7796 display disassembly of the next source line when execution of the
7797 program being debugged stops. This is @emph{in addition} to
7798 displaying the source line itself, which @value{GDBN} always does if
7799 possible. If the next source line cannot be displayed for some reason
7800 (e.g., if @value{GDBN} cannot find the source file, or there's no line
7801 info in the debug info), @value{GDBN} will display disassembly of the
7802 next @emph{instruction} instead of showing the next source line. If
7803 AUTO, @value{GDBN} will display disassembly of next instruction only
7804 if the source line cannot be displayed. This setting causes
7805 @value{GDBN} to display some feedback when you step through a function
7806 with no line info or whose source file is unavailable. The default is
7807 OFF, which means never display the disassembly of the next line or
7813 @chapter Examining Data
7815 @cindex printing data
7816 @cindex examining data
7819 The usual way to examine data in your program is with the @code{print}
7820 command (abbreviated @code{p}), or its synonym @code{inspect}. It
7821 evaluates and prints the value of an expression of the language your
7822 program is written in (@pxref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with
7823 Different Languages}). It may also print the expression using a
7824 Python-based pretty-printer (@pxref{Pretty Printing}).
7827 @item print @var{expr}
7828 @itemx print /@var{f} @var{expr}
7829 @var{expr} is an expression (in the source language). By default the
7830 value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
7831 you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
7832 @var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
7836 @itemx print /@var{f}
7837 @cindex reprint the last value
7838 If you omit @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} displays the last value again (from the
7839 @dfn{value history}; @pxref{Value History, ,Value History}). This allows you to
7840 conveniently inspect the same value in an alternative format.
7843 A more low-level way of examining data is with the @code{x} command.
7844 It examines data in memory at a specified address and prints it in a
7845 specified format. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
7847 If you are interested in information about types, or about how the
7848 fields of a struct or a class are declared, use the @code{ptype @var{exp}}
7849 command rather than @code{print}. @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol
7852 @cindex exploring hierarchical data structures
7854 Another way of examining values of expressions and type information is
7855 through the Python extension command @code{explore} (available only if
7856 the @value{GDBN} build is configured with @code{--with-python}). It
7857 offers an interactive way to start at the highest level (or, the most
7858 abstract level) of the data type of an expression (or, the data type
7859 itself) and explore all the way down to leaf scalar values/fields
7860 embedded in the higher level data types.
7863 @item explore @var{arg}
7864 @var{arg} is either an expression (in the source language), or a type
7865 visible in the current context of the program being debugged.
7868 The working of the @code{explore} command can be illustrated with an
7869 example. If a data type @code{struct ComplexStruct} is defined in your
7879 struct ComplexStruct
7881 struct SimpleStruct *ss_p;
7887 followed by variable declarations as
7890 struct SimpleStruct ss = @{ 10, 1.11 @};
7891 struct ComplexStruct cs = @{ &ss, @{ 0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9 @} @};
7895 then, the value of the variable @code{cs} can be explored using the
7896 @code{explore} command as follows.
7900 The value of `cs' is a struct/class of type `struct ComplexStruct' with
7901 the following fields:
7903 ss_p = <Enter 0 to explore this field of type `struct SimpleStruct *'>
7904 arr = <Enter 1 to explore this field of type `int [10]'>
7906 Enter the field number of choice:
7910 Since the fields of @code{cs} are not scalar values, you are being
7911 prompted to chose the field you want to explore. Let's say you choose
7912 the field @code{ss_p} by entering @code{0}. Then, since this field is a
7913 pointer, you will be asked if it is pointing to a single value. From
7914 the declaration of @code{cs} above, it is indeed pointing to a single
7915 value, hence you enter @code{y}. If you enter @code{n}, then you will
7916 be asked if it were pointing to an array of values, in which case this
7917 field will be explored as if it were an array.
7920 `cs.ss_p' is a pointer to a value of type `struct SimpleStruct'
7921 Continue exploring it as a pointer to a single value [y/n]: y
7922 The value of `*(cs.ss_p)' is a struct/class of type `struct
7923 SimpleStruct' with the following fields:
7925 i = 10 .. (Value of type `int')
7926 d = 1.1100000000000001 .. (Value of type `double')
7928 Press enter to return to parent value:
7932 If the field @code{arr} of @code{cs} was chosen for exploration by
7933 entering @code{1} earlier, then since it is as array, you will be
7934 prompted to enter the index of the element in the array that you want
7938 `cs.arr' is an array of `int'.
7939 Enter the index of the element you want to explore in `cs.arr': 5
7941 `(cs.arr)[5]' is a scalar value of type `int'.
7945 Press enter to return to parent value:
7948 In general, at any stage of exploration, you can go deeper towards the
7949 leaf values by responding to the prompts appropriately, or hit the
7950 return key to return to the enclosing data structure (the @i{higher}
7951 level data structure).
7953 Similar to exploring values, you can use the @code{explore} command to
7954 explore types. Instead of specifying a value (which is typically a
7955 variable name or an expression valid in the current context of the
7956 program being debugged), you specify a type name. If you consider the
7957 same example as above, your can explore the type
7958 @code{struct ComplexStruct} by passing the argument
7959 @code{struct ComplexStruct} to the @code{explore} command.
7962 (gdb) explore struct ComplexStruct
7966 By responding to the prompts appropriately in the subsequent interactive
7967 session, you can explore the type @code{struct ComplexStruct} in a
7968 manner similar to how the value @code{cs} was explored in the above
7971 The @code{explore} command also has two sub-commands,
7972 @code{explore value} and @code{explore type}. The former sub-command is
7973 a way to explicitly specify that value exploration of the argument is
7974 being invoked, while the latter is a way to explicitly specify that type
7975 exploration of the argument is being invoked.
7978 @item explore value @var{expr}
7979 @cindex explore value
7980 This sub-command of @code{explore} explores the value of the
7981 expression @var{expr} (if @var{expr} is an expression valid in the
7982 current context of the program being debugged). The behavior of this
7983 command is identical to that of the behavior of the @code{explore}
7984 command being passed the argument @var{expr}.
7986 @item explore type @var{arg}
7987 @cindex explore type
7988 This sub-command of @code{explore} explores the type of @var{arg} (if
7989 @var{arg} is a type visible in the current context of program being
7990 debugged), or the type of the value/expression @var{arg} (if @var{arg}
7991 is an expression valid in the current context of the program being
7992 debugged). If @var{arg} is a type, then the behavior of this command is
7993 identical to that of the @code{explore} command being passed the
7994 argument @var{arg}. If @var{arg} is an expression, then the behavior of
7995 this command will be identical to that of the @code{explore} command
7996 being passed the type of @var{arg} as the argument.
8000 * Expressions:: Expressions
8001 * Ambiguous Expressions:: Ambiguous Expressions
8002 * Variables:: Program variables
8003 * Arrays:: Artificial arrays
8004 * Output Formats:: Output formats
8005 * Memory:: Examining memory
8006 * Auto Display:: Automatic display
8007 * Print Settings:: Print settings
8008 * Pretty Printing:: Python pretty printing
8009 * Value History:: Value history
8010 * Convenience Vars:: Convenience variables
8011 * Convenience Funs:: Convenience functions
8012 * Registers:: Registers
8013 * Floating Point Hardware:: Floating point hardware
8014 * Vector Unit:: Vector Unit
8015 * OS Information:: Auxiliary data provided by operating system
8016 * Memory Region Attributes:: Memory region attributes
8017 * Dump/Restore Files:: Copy between memory and a file
8018 * Core File Generation:: Cause a program dump its core
8019 * Character Sets:: Debugging programs that use a different
8020 character set than GDB does
8021 * Caching Remote Data:: Data caching for remote targets
8022 * Searching Memory:: Searching memory for a sequence of bytes
8026 @section Expressions
8029 @code{print} and many other @value{GDBN} commands accept an expression and
8030 compute its value. Any kind of constant, variable or operator defined
8031 by the programming language you are using is valid in an expression in
8032 @value{GDBN}. This includes conditional expressions, function calls,
8033 casts, and string constants. It also includes preprocessor macros, if
8034 you compiled your program to include this information; see
8037 @cindex arrays in expressions
8038 @value{GDBN} supports array constants in expressions input by
8039 the user. The syntax is @{@var{element}, @var{element}@dots{}@}. For example,
8040 you can use the command @code{print @{1, 2, 3@}} to create an array
8041 of three integers. If you pass an array to a function or assign it
8042 to a program variable, @value{GDBN} copies the array to memory that
8043 is @code{malloc}ed in the target program.
8045 Because C is so widespread, most of the expressions shown in examples in
8046 this manual are in C. @xref{Languages, , Using @value{GDBN} with Different
8047 Languages}, for information on how to use expressions in other
8050 In this section, we discuss operators that you can use in @value{GDBN}
8051 expressions regardless of your programming language.
8053 @cindex casts, in expressions
8054 Casts are supported in all languages, not just in C, because it is so
8055 useful to cast a number into a pointer in order to examine a structure
8056 at that address in memory.
8057 @c FIXME: casts supported---Mod2 true?
8059 @value{GDBN} supports these operators, in addition to those common
8060 to programming languages:
8064 @samp{@@} is a binary operator for treating parts of memory as arrays.
8065 @xref{Arrays, ,Artificial Arrays}, for more information.
8068 @samp{::} allows you to specify a variable in terms of the file or
8069 function where it is defined. @xref{Variables, ,Program Variables}.
8071 @cindex @{@var{type}@}
8072 @cindex type casting memory
8073 @cindex memory, viewing as typed object
8074 @cindex casts, to view memory
8075 @item @{@var{type}@} @var{addr}
8076 Refers to an object of type @var{type} stored at address @var{addr} in
8077 memory. @var{addr} may be any expression whose value is an integer or
8078 pointer (but parentheses are required around binary operators, just as in
8079 a cast). This construct is allowed regardless of what kind of data is
8080 normally supposed to reside at @var{addr}.
8083 @node Ambiguous Expressions
8084 @section Ambiguous Expressions
8085 @cindex ambiguous expressions
8087 Expressions can sometimes contain some ambiguous elements. For instance,
8088 some programming languages (notably Ada, C@t{++} and Objective-C) permit
8089 a single function name to be defined several times, for application in
8090 different contexts. This is called @dfn{overloading}. Another example
8091 involving Ada is generics. A @dfn{generic package} is similar to C@t{++}
8092 templates and is typically instantiated several times, resulting in
8093 the same function name being defined in different contexts.
8095 In some cases and depending on the language, it is possible to adjust
8096 the expression to remove the ambiguity. For instance in C@t{++}, you
8097 can specify the signature of the function you want to break on, as in
8098 @kbd{break @var{function}(@var{types})}. In Ada, using the fully
8099 qualified name of your function often makes the expression unambiguous
8102 When an ambiguity that needs to be resolved is detected, the debugger
8103 has the capability to display a menu of numbered choices for each
8104 possibility, and then waits for the selection with the prompt @samp{>}.
8105 The first option is always @samp{[0] cancel}, and typing @kbd{0 @key{RET}}
8106 aborts the current command. If the command in which the expression was
8107 used allows more than one choice to be selected, the next option in the
8108 menu is @samp{[1] all}, and typing @kbd{1 @key{RET}} selects all possible
8111 For example, the following session excerpt shows an attempt to set a
8112 breakpoint at the overloaded symbol @code{String::after}.
8113 We choose three particular definitions of that function name:
8115 @c FIXME! This is likely to change to show arg type lists, at least
8118 (@value{GDBP}) b String::after
8121 [2] file:String.cc; line number:867
8122 [3] file:String.cc; line number:860
8123 [4] file:String.cc; line number:875
8124 [5] file:String.cc; line number:853
8125 [6] file:String.cc; line number:846
8126 [7] file:String.cc; line number:735
8128 Breakpoint 1 at 0xb26c: file String.cc, line 867.
8129 Breakpoint 2 at 0xb344: file String.cc, line 875.
8130 Breakpoint 3 at 0xafcc: file String.cc, line 846.
8131 Multiple breakpoints were set.
8132 Use the "delete" command to delete unwanted
8139 @kindex set multiple-symbols
8140 @item set multiple-symbols @var{mode}
8141 @cindex multiple-symbols menu
8143 This option allows you to adjust the debugger behavior when an expression
8146 By default, @var{mode} is set to @code{all}. If the command with which
8147 the expression is used allows more than one choice, then @value{GDBN}
8148 automatically selects all possible choices. For instance, inserting
8149 a breakpoint on a function using an ambiguous name results in a breakpoint
8150 inserted on each possible match. However, if a unique choice must be made,
8151 then @value{GDBN} uses the menu to help you disambiguate the expression.
8152 For instance, printing the address of an overloaded function will result
8153 in the use of the menu.
8155 When @var{mode} is set to @code{ask}, the debugger always uses the menu
8156 when an ambiguity is detected.
8158 Finally, when @var{mode} is set to @code{cancel}, the debugger reports
8159 an error due to the ambiguity and the command is aborted.
8161 @kindex show multiple-symbols
8162 @item show multiple-symbols
8163 Show the current value of the @code{multiple-symbols} setting.
8167 @section Program Variables
8169 The most common kind of expression to use is the name of a variable
8172 Variables in expressions are understood in the selected stack frame
8173 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}); they must be either:
8177 global (or file-static)
8184 visible according to the scope rules of the
8185 programming language from the point of execution in that frame
8188 @noindent This means that in the function
8203 you can examine and use the variable @code{a} whenever your program is
8204 executing within the function @code{foo}, but you can only use or
8205 examine the variable @code{b} while your program is executing inside
8206 the block where @code{b} is declared.
8208 @cindex variable name conflict
8209 There is an exception: you can refer to a variable or function whose
8210 scope is a single source file even if the current execution point is not
8211 in this file. But it is possible to have more than one such variable or
8212 function with the same name (in different source files). If that
8213 happens, referring to that name has unpredictable effects. If you wish,
8214 you can specify a static variable in a particular function or file by
8215 using the colon-colon (@code{::}) notation:
8217 @cindex colon-colon, context for variables/functions
8219 @c info cannot cope with a :: index entry, but why deprive hard copy readers?
8220 @cindex @code{::}, context for variables/functions
8223 @var{file}::@var{variable}
8224 @var{function}::@var{variable}
8228 Here @var{file} or @var{function} is the name of the context for the
8229 static @var{variable}. In the case of file names, you can use quotes to
8230 make sure @value{GDBN} parses the file name as a single word---for example,
8231 to print a global value of @code{x} defined in @file{f2.c}:
8234 (@value{GDBP}) p 'f2.c'::x
8237 The @code{::} notation is normally used for referring to
8238 static variables, since you typically disambiguate uses of local variables
8239 in functions by selecting the appropriate frame and using the
8240 simple name of the variable. However, you may also use this notation
8241 to refer to local variables in frames enclosing the selected frame:
8250 process (a); /* Stop here */
8261 For example, if there is a breakpoint at the commented line,
8262 here is what you might see
8263 when the program stops after executing the call @code{bar(0)}:
8268 (@value{GDBP}) p bar::a
8271 #2 0x080483d0 in foo (a=5) at foobar.c:12
8274 (@value{GDBP}) p bar::a
8278 @cindex C@t{++} scope resolution
8279 These uses of @samp{::} are very rarely in conflict with the very similar
8280 use of the same notation in C@t{++}. @value{GDBN} also supports use of the C@t{++}
8281 scope resolution operator in @value{GDBN} expressions.
8282 @c FIXME: Um, so what happens in one of those rare cases where it's in
8285 @cindex wrong values
8286 @cindex variable values, wrong
8287 @cindex function entry/exit, wrong values of variables
8288 @cindex optimized code, wrong values of variables
8290 @emph{Warning:} Occasionally, a local variable may appear to have the
8291 wrong value at certain points in a function---just after entry to a new
8292 scope, and just before exit.
8294 You may see this problem when you are stepping by machine instructions.
8295 This is because, on most machines, it takes more than one instruction to
8296 set up a stack frame (including local variable definitions); if you are
8297 stepping by machine instructions, variables may appear to have the wrong
8298 values until the stack frame is completely built. On exit, it usually
8299 also takes more than one machine instruction to destroy a stack frame;
8300 after you begin stepping through that group of instructions, local
8301 variable definitions may be gone.
8303 This may also happen when the compiler does significant optimizations.
8304 To be sure of always seeing accurate values, turn off all optimization
8307 @cindex ``No symbol "foo" in current context''
8308 Another possible effect of compiler optimizations is to optimize
8309 unused variables out of existence, or assign variables to registers (as
8310 opposed to memory addresses). Depending on the support for such cases
8311 offered by the debug info format used by the compiler, @value{GDBN}
8312 might not be able to display values for such local variables. If that
8313 happens, @value{GDBN} will print a message like this:
8316 No symbol "foo" in current context.
8319 To solve such problems, either recompile without optimizations, or use a
8320 different debug info format, if the compiler supports several such
8321 formats. @xref{Compilation}, for more information on choosing compiler
8322 options. @xref{C, ,C and C@t{++}}, for more information about debug
8323 info formats that are best suited to C@t{++} programs.
8325 If you ask to print an object whose contents are unknown to
8326 @value{GDBN}, e.g., because its data type is not completely specified
8327 by the debug information, @value{GDBN} will say @samp{<incomplete
8328 type>}. @xref{Symbols, incomplete type}, for more about this.
8330 If you append @kbd{@@entry} string to a function parameter name you get its
8331 value at the time the function got called. If the value is not available an
8332 error message is printed. Entry values are available only with some compilers.
8333 Entry values are normally also printed at the function parameter list according
8334 to @ref{set print entry-values}.
8337 Breakpoint 1, d (i=30) at gdb.base/entry-value.c:29
8343 (gdb) print i@@entry
8347 Strings are identified as arrays of @code{char} values without specified
8348 signedness. Arrays of either @code{signed char} or @code{unsigned char} get
8349 printed as arrays of 1 byte sized integers. @code{-fsigned-char} or
8350 @code{-funsigned-char} @value{NGCC} options have no effect as @value{GDBN}
8351 defines literal string type @code{"char"} as @code{char} without a sign.
8356 signed char var1[] = "A";
8359 You get during debugging
8364 $2 = @{65 'A', 0 '\0'@}
8368 @section Artificial Arrays
8370 @cindex artificial array
8372 @kindex @@@r{, referencing memory as an array}
8373 It is often useful to print out several successive objects of the
8374 same type in memory; a section of an array, or an array of
8375 dynamically determined size for which only a pointer exists in the
8378 You can do this by referring to a contiguous span of memory as an
8379 @dfn{artificial array}, using the binary operator @samp{@@}. The left
8380 operand of @samp{@@} should be the first element of the desired array
8381 and be an individual object. The right operand should be the desired length
8382 of the array. The result is an array value whose elements are all of
8383 the type of the left argument. The first element is actually the left
8384 argument; the second element comes from bytes of memory immediately
8385 following those that hold the first element, and so on. Here is an
8386 example. If a program says
8389 int *array = (int *) malloc (len * sizeof (int));
8393 you can print the contents of @code{array} with
8399 The left operand of @samp{@@} must reside in memory. Array values made
8400 with @samp{@@} in this way behave just like other arrays in terms of
8401 subscripting, and are coerced to pointers when used in expressions.
8402 Artificial arrays most often appear in expressions via the value history
8403 (@pxref{Value History, ,Value History}), after printing one out.
8405 Another way to create an artificial array is to use a cast.
8406 This re-interprets a value as if it were an array.
8407 The value need not be in memory:
8409 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[2])0x12345678
8410 $1 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
8413 As a convenience, if you leave the array length out (as in
8414 @samp{(@var{type}[])@var{value}}) @value{GDBN} calculates the size to fill
8415 the value (as @samp{sizeof(@var{value})/sizeof(@var{type})}:
8417 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[])0x12345678
8418 $2 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
8421 Sometimes the artificial array mechanism is not quite enough; in
8422 moderately complex data structures, the elements of interest may not
8423 actually be adjacent---for example, if you are interested in the values
8424 of pointers in an array. One useful work-around in this situation is
8425 to use a convenience variable (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
8426 Variables}) as a counter in an expression that prints the first
8427 interesting value, and then repeat that expression via @key{RET}. For
8428 instance, suppose you have an array @code{dtab} of pointers to
8429 structures, and you are interested in the values of a field @code{fv}
8430 in each structure. Here is an example of what you might type:
8440 @node Output Formats
8441 @section Output Formats
8443 @cindex formatted output
8444 @cindex output formats
8445 By default, @value{GDBN} prints a value according to its data type. Sometimes
8446 this is not what you want. For example, you might want to print a number
8447 in hex, or a pointer in decimal. Or you might want to view data in memory
8448 at a certain address as a character string or as an instruction. To do
8449 these things, specify an @dfn{output format} when you print a value.
8451 The simplest use of output formats is to say how to print a value
8452 already computed. This is done by starting the arguments of the
8453 @code{print} command with a slash and a format letter. The format
8454 letters supported are:
8458 Regard the bits of the value as an integer, and print the integer in
8462 Print as integer in signed decimal.
8465 Print as integer in unsigned decimal.
8468 Print as integer in octal.
8471 Print as integer in binary. The letter @samp{t} stands for ``two''.
8472 @footnote{@samp{b} cannot be used because these format letters are also
8473 used with the @code{x} command, where @samp{b} stands for ``byte'';
8474 see @ref{Memory,,Examining Memory}.}
8477 @cindex unknown address, locating
8478 @cindex locate address
8479 Print as an address, both absolute in hexadecimal and as an offset from
8480 the nearest preceding symbol. You can use this format used to discover
8481 where (in what function) an unknown address is located:
8484 (@value{GDBP}) p/a 0x54320
8485 $3 = 0x54320 <_initialize_vx+396>
8489 The command @code{info symbol 0x54320} yields similar results.
8490 @xref{Symbols, info symbol}.
8493 Regard as an integer and print it as a character constant. This
8494 prints both the numerical value and its character representation. The
8495 character representation is replaced with the octal escape @samp{\nnn}
8496 for characters outside the 7-bit @sc{ascii} range.
8498 Without this format, @value{GDBN} displays @code{char},
8499 @w{@code{unsigned char}}, and @w{@code{signed char}} data as character
8500 constants. Single-byte members of vectors are displayed as integer
8504 Regard the bits of the value as a floating point number and print
8505 using typical floating point syntax.
8508 @cindex printing strings
8509 @cindex printing byte arrays
8510 Regard as a string, if possible. With this format, pointers to single-byte
8511 data are displayed as null-terminated strings and arrays of single-byte data
8512 are displayed as fixed-length strings. Other values are displayed in their
8515 Without this format, @value{GDBN} displays pointers to and arrays of
8516 @code{char}, @w{@code{unsigned char}}, and @w{@code{signed char}} as
8517 strings. Single-byte members of a vector are displayed as an integer
8521 @cindex raw printing
8522 Print using the @samp{raw} formatting. By default, @value{GDBN} will
8523 use a Python-based pretty-printer, if one is available (@pxref{Pretty
8524 Printing}). This typically results in a higher-level display of the
8525 value's contents. The @samp{r} format bypasses any Python
8526 pretty-printer which might exist.
8529 For example, to print the program counter in hex (@pxref{Registers}), type
8536 Note that no space is required before the slash; this is because command
8537 names in @value{GDBN} cannot contain a slash.
8539 To reprint the last value in the value history with a different format,
8540 you can use the @code{print} command with just a format and no
8541 expression. For example, @samp{p/x} reprints the last value in hex.
8544 @section Examining Memory
8546 You can use the command @code{x} (for ``examine'') to examine memory in
8547 any of several formats, independently of your program's data types.
8549 @cindex examining memory
8551 @kindex x @r{(examine memory)}
8552 @item x/@var{nfu} @var{addr}
8555 Use the @code{x} command to examine memory.
8558 @var{n}, @var{f}, and @var{u} are all optional parameters that specify how
8559 much memory to display and how to format it; @var{addr} is an
8560 expression giving the address where you want to start displaying memory.
8561 If you use defaults for @var{nfu}, you need not type the slash @samp{/}.
8562 Several commands set convenient defaults for @var{addr}.
8565 @item @var{n}, the repeat count
8566 The repeat count is a decimal integer; the default is 1. It specifies
8567 how much memory (counting by units @var{u}) to display.
8568 @c This really is **decimal**; unaffected by 'set radix' as of GDB
8571 @item @var{f}, the display format
8572 The display format is one of the formats used by @code{print}
8573 (@samp{x}, @samp{d}, @samp{u}, @samp{o}, @samp{t}, @samp{a}, @samp{c},
8574 @samp{f}, @samp{s}), and in addition @samp{i} (for machine instructions).
8575 The default is @samp{x} (hexadecimal) initially. The default changes
8576 each time you use either @code{x} or @code{print}.
8578 @item @var{u}, the unit size
8579 The unit size is any of
8585 Halfwords (two bytes).
8587 Words (four bytes). This is the initial default.
8589 Giant words (eight bytes).
8592 Each time you specify a unit size with @code{x}, that size becomes the
8593 default unit the next time you use @code{x}. For the @samp{i} format,
8594 the unit size is ignored and is normally not written. For the @samp{s} format,
8595 the unit size defaults to @samp{b}, unless it is explicitly given.
8596 Use @kbd{x /hs} to display 16-bit char strings and @kbd{x /ws} to display
8597 32-bit strings. The next use of @kbd{x /s} will again display 8-bit strings.
8598 Note that the results depend on the programming language of the
8599 current compilation unit. If the language is C, the @samp{s}
8600 modifier will use the UTF-16 encoding while @samp{w} will use
8601 UTF-32. The encoding is set by the programming language and cannot
8604 @item @var{addr}, starting display address
8605 @var{addr} is the address where you want @value{GDBN} to begin displaying
8606 memory. The expression need not have a pointer value (though it may);
8607 it is always interpreted as an integer address of a byte of memory.
8608 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information on expressions. The default for
8609 @var{addr} is usually just after the last address examined---but several
8610 other commands also set the default address: @code{info breakpoints} (to
8611 the address of the last breakpoint listed), @code{info line} (to the
8612 starting address of a line), and @code{print} (if you use it to display
8613 a value from memory).
8616 For example, @samp{x/3uh 0x54320} is a request to display three halfwords
8617 (@code{h}) of memory, formatted as unsigned decimal integers (@samp{u}),
8618 starting at address @code{0x54320}. @samp{x/4xw $sp} prints the four
8619 words (@samp{w}) of memory above the stack pointer (here, @samp{$sp};
8620 @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}) in hexadecimal (@samp{x}).
8622 Since the letters indicating unit sizes are all distinct from the
8623 letters specifying output formats, you do not have to remember whether
8624 unit size or format comes first; either order works. The output
8625 specifications @samp{4xw} and @samp{4wx} mean exactly the same thing.
8626 (However, the count @var{n} must come first; @samp{wx4} does not work.)
8628 Even though the unit size @var{u} is ignored for the formats @samp{s}
8629 and @samp{i}, you might still want to use a count @var{n}; for example,
8630 @samp{3i} specifies that you want to see three machine instructions,
8631 including any operands. For convenience, especially when used with
8632 the @code{display} command, the @samp{i} format also prints branch delay
8633 slot instructions, if any, beyond the count specified, which immediately
8634 follow the last instruction that is within the count. The command
8635 @code{disassemble} gives an alternative way of inspecting machine
8636 instructions; see @ref{Machine Code,,Source and Machine Code}.
8638 All the defaults for the arguments to @code{x} are designed to make it
8639 easy to continue scanning memory with minimal specifications each time
8640 you use @code{x}. For example, after you have inspected three machine
8641 instructions with @samp{x/3i @var{addr}}, you can inspect the next seven
8642 with just @samp{x/7}. If you use @key{RET} to repeat the @code{x} command,
8643 the repeat count @var{n} is used again; the other arguments default as
8644 for successive uses of @code{x}.
8646 When examining machine instructions, the instruction at current program
8647 counter is shown with a @code{=>} marker. For example:
8650 (@value{GDBP}) x/5i $pc-6
8651 0x804837f <main+11>: mov %esp,%ebp
8652 0x8048381 <main+13>: push %ecx
8653 0x8048382 <main+14>: sub $0x4,%esp
8654 => 0x8048385 <main+17>: movl $0x8048460,(%esp)
8655 0x804838c <main+24>: call 0x80482d4 <puts@@plt>
8658 @cindex @code{$_}, @code{$__}, and value history
8659 The addresses and contents printed by the @code{x} command are not saved
8660 in the value history because there is often too much of them and they
8661 would get in the way. Instead, @value{GDBN} makes these values available for
8662 subsequent use in expressions as values of the convenience variables
8663 @code{$_} and @code{$__}. After an @code{x} command, the last address
8664 examined is available for use in expressions in the convenience variable
8665 @code{$_}. The contents of that address, as examined, are available in
8666 the convenience variable @code{$__}.
8668 If the @code{x} command has a repeat count, the address and contents saved
8669 are from the last memory unit printed; this is not the same as the last
8670 address printed if several units were printed on the last line of output.
8672 @cindex remote memory comparison
8673 @cindex verify remote memory image
8674 When you are debugging a program running on a remote target machine
8675 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), you may wish to verify the program's image in the
8676 remote machine's memory against the executable file you downloaded to
8677 the target. The @code{compare-sections} command is provided for such
8681 @kindex compare-sections
8682 @item compare-sections @r{[}@var{section-name}@r{]}
8683 Compare the data of a loadable section @var{section-name} in the
8684 executable file of the program being debugged with the same section in
8685 the remote machine's memory, and report any mismatches. With no
8686 arguments, compares all loadable sections. This command's
8687 availability depends on the target's support for the @code{"qCRC"}
8692 @section Automatic Display
8693 @cindex automatic display
8694 @cindex display of expressions
8696 If you find that you want to print the value of an expression frequently
8697 (to see how it changes), you might want to add it to the @dfn{automatic
8698 display list} so that @value{GDBN} prints its value each time your program stops.
8699 Each expression added to the list is given a number to identify it;
8700 to remove an expression from the list, you specify that number.
8701 The automatic display looks like this:
8705 3: bar[5] = (struct hack *) 0x3804
8709 This display shows item numbers, expressions and their current values. As with
8710 displays you request manually using @code{x} or @code{print}, you can
8711 specify the output format you prefer; in fact, @code{display} decides
8712 whether to use @code{print} or @code{x} depending your format
8713 specification---it uses @code{x} if you specify either the @samp{i}
8714 or @samp{s} format, or a unit size; otherwise it uses @code{print}.
8718 @item display @var{expr}
8719 Add the expression @var{expr} to the list of expressions to display
8720 each time your program stops. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
8722 @code{display} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
8724 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{expr}
8725 For @var{fmt} specifying only a display format and not a size or
8726 count, add the expression @var{expr} to the auto-display list but
8727 arrange to display it each time in the specified format @var{fmt}.
8728 @xref{Output Formats,,Output Formats}.
8730 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{addr}
8731 For @var{fmt} @samp{i} or @samp{s}, or including a unit-size or a
8732 number of units, add the expression @var{addr} as a memory address to
8733 be examined each time your program stops. Examining means in effect
8734 doing @samp{x/@var{fmt} @var{addr}}. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
8737 For example, @samp{display/i $pc} can be helpful, to see the machine
8738 instruction about to be executed each time execution stops (@samp{$pc}
8739 is a common name for the program counter; @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
8742 @kindex delete display
8744 @item undisplay @var{dnums}@dots{}
8745 @itemx delete display @var{dnums}@dots{}
8746 Remove items from the list of expressions to display. Specify the
8747 numbers of the displays that you want affected with the command
8748 argument @var{dnums}. It can be a single display number, one of the
8749 numbers shown in the first field of the @samp{info display} display;
8750 or it could be a range of display numbers, as in @code{2-4}.
8752 @code{undisplay} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
8753 (Otherwise you would just get the error @samp{No display number @dots{}}.)
8755 @kindex disable display
8756 @item disable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
8757 Disable the display of item numbers @var{dnums}. A disabled display
8758 item is not printed automatically, but is not forgotten. It may be
8759 enabled again later. Specify the numbers of the displays that you
8760 want affected with the command argument @var{dnums}. It can be a
8761 single display number, one of the numbers shown in the first field of
8762 the @samp{info display} display; or it could be a range of display
8763 numbers, as in @code{2-4}.
8765 @kindex enable display
8766 @item enable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
8767 Enable display of item numbers @var{dnums}. It becomes effective once
8768 again in auto display of its expression, until you specify otherwise.
8769 Specify the numbers of the displays that you want affected with the
8770 command argument @var{dnums}. It can be a single display number, one
8771 of the numbers shown in the first field of the @samp{info display}
8772 display; or it could be a range of display numbers, as in @code{2-4}.
8775 Display the current values of the expressions on the list, just as is
8776 done when your program stops.
8778 @kindex info display
8780 Print the list of expressions previously set up to display
8781 automatically, each one with its item number, but without showing the
8782 values. This includes disabled expressions, which are marked as such.
8783 It also includes expressions which would not be displayed right now
8784 because they refer to automatic variables not currently available.
8787 @cindex display disabled out of scope
8788 If a display expression refers to local variables, then it does not make
8789 sense outside the lexical context for which it was set up. Such an
8790 expression is disabled when execution enters a context where one of its
8791 variables is not defined. For example, if you give the command
8792 @code{display last_char} while inside a function with an argument
8793 @code{last_char}, @value{GDBN} displays this argument while your program
8794 continues to stop inside that function. When it stops elsewhere---where
8795 there is no variable @code{last_char}---the display is disabled
8796 automatically. The next time your program stops where @code{last_char}
8797 is meaningful, you can enable the display expression once again.
8799 @node Print Settings
8800 @section Print Settings
8802 @cindex format options
8803 @cindex print settings
8804 @value{GDBN} provides the following ways to control how arrays, structures,
8805 and symbols are printed.
8808 These settings are useful for debugging programs in any language:
8812 @item set print address
8813 @itemx set print address on
8814 @cindex print/don't print memory addresses
8815 @value{GDBN} prints memory addresses showing the location of stack
8816 traces, structure values, pointer values, breakpoints, and so forth,
8817 even when it also displays the contents of those addresses. The default
8818 is @code{on}. For example, this is what a stack frame display looks like with
8819 @code{set print address on}:
8824 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<<", rq=0x34c88 ">>")
8826 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
8830 @item set print address off
8831 Do not print addresses when displaying their contents. For example,
8832 this is the same stack frame displayed with @code{set print address off}:
8836 (@value{GDBP}) set print addr off
8838 #0 set_quotes (lq="<<", rq=">>") at input.c:530
8839 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
8843 You can use @samp{set print address off} to eliminate all machine
8844 dependent displays from the @value{GDBN} interface. For example, with
8845 @code{print address off}, you should get the same text for backtraces on
8846 all machines---whether or not they involve pointer arguments.
8849 @item show print address
8850 Show whether or not addresses are to be printed.
8853 When @value{GDBN} prints a symbolic address, it normally prints the
8854 closest earlier symbol plus an offset. If that symbol does not uniquely
8855 identify the address (for example, it is a name whose scope is a single
8856 source file), you may need to clarify. One way to do this is with
8857 @code{info line}, for example @samp{info line *0x4537}. Alternately,
8858 you can set @value{GDBN} to print the source file and line number when
8859 it prints a symbolic address:
8862 @item set print symbol-filename on
8863 @cindex source file and line of a symbol
8864 @cindex symbol, source file and line
8865 Tell @value{GDBN} to print the source file name and line number of a
8866 symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
8868 @item set print symbol-filename off
8869 Do not print source file name and line number of a symbol. This is the
8872 @item show print symbol-filename
8873 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} will print the source file name and
8874 line number of a symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
8877 Another situation where it is helpful to show symbol filenames and line
8878 numbers is when disassembling code; @value{GDBN} shows you the line
8879 number and source file that corresponds to each instruction.
8881 Also, you may wish to see the symbolic form only if the address being
8882 printed is reasonably close to the closest earlier symbol:
8885 @item set print max-symbolic-offset @var{max-offset}
8886 @itemx set print max-symbolic-offset unlimited
8887 @cindex maximum value for offset of closest symbol
8888 Tell @value{GDBN} to only display the symbolic form of an address if the
8889 offset between the closest earlier symbol and the address is less than
8890 @var{max-offset}. The default is @code{unlimited}, which tells @value{GDBN}
8891 to always print the symbolic form of an address if any symbol precedes
8892 it. Zero is equivalent to @code{unlimited}.
8894 @item show print max-symbolic-offset
8895 Ask how large the maximum offset is that @value{GDBN} prints in a
8899 @cindex wild pointer, interpreting
8900 @cindex pointer, finding referent
8901 If you have a pointer and you are not sure where it points, try
8902 @samp{set print symbol-filename on}. Then you can determine the name
8903 and source file location of the variable where it points, using
8904 @samp{p/a @var{pointer}}. This interprets the address in symbolic form.
8905 For example, here @value{GDBN} shows that a variable @code{ptt} points
8906 at another variable @code{t}, defined in @file{hi2.c}:
8909 (@value{GDBP}) set print symbol-filename on
8910 (@value{GDBP}) p/a ptt
8911 $4 = 0xe008 <t in hi2.c>
8915 @emph{Warning:} For pointers that point to a local variable, @samp{p/a}
8916 does not show the symbol name and filename of the referent, even with
8917 the appropriate @code{set print} options turned on.
8920 You can also enable @samp{/a}-like formatting all the time using
8921 @samp{set print symbol on}:
8924 @item set print symbol on
8925 Tell @value{GDBN} to print the symbol corresponding to an address, if
8928 @item set print symbol off
8929 Tell @value{GDBN} not to print the symbol corresponding to an
8930 address. In this mode, @value{GDBN} will still print the symbol
8931 corresponding to pointers to functions. This is the default.
8933 @item show print symbol
8934 Show whether @value{GDBN} will display the symbol corresponding to an
8938 Other settings control how different kinds of objects are printed:
8941 @item set print array
8942 @itemx set print array on
8943 @cindex pretty print arrays
8944 Pretty print arrays. This format is more convenient to read,
8945 but uses more space. The default is off.
8947 @item set print array off
8948 Return to compressed format for arrays.
8950 @item show print array
8951 Show whether compressed or pretty format is selected for displaying
8954 @cindex print array indexes
8955 @item set print array-indexes
8956 @itemx set print array-indexes on
8957 Print the index of each element when displaying arrays. May be more
8958 convenient to locate a given element in the array or quickly find the
8959 index of a given element in that printed array. The default is off.
8961 @item set print array-indexes off
8962 Stop printing element indexes when displaying arrays.
8964 @item show print array-indexes
8965 Show whether the index of each element is printed when displaying
8968 @item set print elements @var{number-of-elements}
8969 @itemx set print elements unlimited
8970 @cindex number of array elements to print
8971 @cindex limit on number of printed array elements
8972 Set a limit on how many elements of an array @value{GDBN} will print.
8973 If @value{GDBN} is printing a large array, it stops printing after it has
8974 printed the number of elements set by the @code{set print elements} command.
8975 This limit also applies to the display of strings.
8976 When @value{GDBN} starts, this limit is set to 200.
8977 Setting @var{number-of-elements} to @code{unlimited} or zero means
8978 that the number of elements to print is unlimited.
8980 @item show print elements
8981 Display the number of elements of a large array that @value{GDBN} will print.
8982 If the number is 0, then the printing is unlimited.
8984 @item set print frame-arguments @var{value}
8985 @kindex set print frame-arguments
8986 @cindex printing frame argument values
8987 @cindex print all frame argument values
8988 @cindex print frame argument values for scalars only
8989 @cindex do not print frame argument values
8990 This command allows to control how the values of arguments are printed
8991 when the debugger prints a frame (@pxref{Frames}). The possible
8996 The values of all arguments are printed.
8999 Print the value of an argument only if it is a scalar. The value of more
9000 complex arguments such as arrays, structures, unions, etc, is replaced
9001 by @code{@dots{}}. This is the default. Here is an example where
9002 only scalar arguments are shown:
9005 #1 0x08048361 in call_me (i=3, s=@dots{}, ss=0xbf8d508c, u=@dots{}, e=green)
9010 None of the argument values are printed. Instead, the value of each argument
9011 is replaced by @code{@dots{}}. In this case, the example above now becomes:
9014 #1 0x08048361 in call_me (i=@dots{}, s=@dots{}, ss=@dots{}, u=@dots{}, e=@dots{})
9019 By default, only scalar arguments are printed. This command can be used
9020 to configure the debugger to print the value of all arguments, regardless
9021 of their type. However, it is often advantageous to not print the value
9022 of more complex parameters. For instance, it reduces the amount of
9023 information printed in each frame, making the backtrace more readable.
9024 Also, it improves performance when displaying Ada frames, because
9025 the computation of large arguments can sometimes be CPU-intensive,
9026 especially in large applications. Setting @code{print frame-arguments}
9027 to @code{scalars} (the default) or @code{none} avoids this computation,
9028 thus speeding up the display of each Ada frame.
9030 @item show print frame-arguments
9031 Show how the value of arguments should be displayed when printing a frame.
9033 @anchor{set print entry-values}
9034 @item set print entry-values @var{value}
9035 @kindex set print entry-values
9036 Set printing of frame argument values at function entry. In some cases
9037 @value{GDBN} can determine the value of function argument which was passed by
9038 the function caller, even if the value was modified inside the called function
9039 and therefore is different. With optimized code, the current value could be
9040 unavailable, but the entry value may still be known.
9042 The default value is @code{default} (see below for its description). Older
9043 @value{GDBN} behaved as with the setting @code{no}. Compilers not supporting
9044 this feature will behave in the @code{default} setting the same way as with the
9047 This functionality is currently supported only by DWARF 2 debugging format and
9048 the compiler has to produce @samp{DW_TAG_GNU_call_site} tags. With
9049 @value{NGCC}, you need to specify @option{-O -g} during compilation, to get
9052 The @var{value} parameter can be one of the following:
9056 Print only actual parameter values, never print values from function entry
9060 #0 different (val=6)
9061 #0 lost (val=<optimized out>)
9063 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
9067 Print only parameter values from function entry point. The actual parameter
9068 values are never printed.
9070 #0 equal (val@@entry=5)
9071 #0 different (val@@entry=5)
9072 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
9073 #0 born (val@@entry=<optimized out>)
9074 #0 invalid (val@@entry=<optimized out>)
9078 Print only parameter values from function entry point. If value from function
9079 entry point is not known while the actual value is known, print the actual
9080 value for such parameter.
9082 #0 equal (val@@entry=5)
9083 #0 different (val@@entry=5)
9084 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
9086 #0 invalid (val@@entry=<optimized out>)
9090 Print actual parameter values. If actual parameter value is not known while
9091 value from function entry point is known, print the entry point value for such
9095 #0 different (val=6)
9096 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
9098 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
9102 Always print both the actual parameter value and its value from function entry
9103 point, even if values of one or both are not available due to compiler
9106 #0 equal (val=5, val@@entry=5)
9107 #0 different (val=6, val@@entry=5)
9108 #0 lost (val=<optimized out>, val@@entry=5)
9109 #0 born (val=10, val@@entry=<optimized out>)
9110 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>, val@@entry=<optimized out>)
9114 Print the actual parameter value if it is known and also its value from
9115 function entry point if it is known. If neither is known, print for the actual
9116 value @code{<optimized out>}. If not in MI mode (@pxref{GDB/MI}) and if both
9117 values are known and identical, print the shortened
9118 @code{param=param@@entry=VALUE} notation.
9120 #0 equal (val=val@@entry=5)
9121 #0 different (val=6, val@@entry=5)
9122 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
9124 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
9128 Always print the actual parameter value. Print also its value from function
9129 entry point, but only if it is known. If not in MI mode (@pxref{GDB/MI}) and
9130 if both values are known and identical, print the shortened
9131 @code{param=param@@entry=VALUE} notation.
9133 #0 equal (val=val@@entry=5)
9134 #0 different (val=6, val@@entry=5)
9135 #0 lost (val=<optimized out>, val@@entry=5)
9137 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
9141 For analysis messages on possible failures of frame argument values at function
9142 entry resolution see @ref{set debug entry-values}.
9144 @item show print entry-values
9145 Show the method being used for printing of frame argument values at function
9148 @item set print repeats @var{number-of-repeats}
9149 @itemx set print repeats unlimited
9150 @cindex repeated array elements
9151 Set the threshold for suppressing display of repeated array
9152 elements. When the number of consecutive identical elements of an
9153 array exceeds the threshold, @value{GDBN} prints the string
9154 @code{"<repeats @var{n} times>"}, where @var{n} is the number of
9155 identical repetitions, instead of displaying the identical elements
9156 themselves. Setting the threshold to @code{unlimited} or zero will
9157 cause all elements to be individually printed. The default threshold
9160 @item show print repeats
9161 Display the current threshold for printing repeated identical
9164 @item set print null-stop
9165 @cindex @sc{null} elements in arrays
9166 Cause @value{GDBN} to stop printing the characters of an array when the first
9167 @sc{null} is encountered. This is useful when large arrays actually
9168 contain only short strings.
9171 @item show print null-stop
9172 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops printing an array on the first
9173 @sc{null} character.
9175 @item set print pretty on
9176 @cindex print structures in indented form
9177 @cindex indentation in structure display
9178 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in an indented format with one member
9179 per line, like this:
9194 @item set print pretty off
9195 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in a compact format, like this:
9199 $1 = @{next = 0x0, flags = @{sweet = 1, sour = 1@}, \
9200 meat = 0x54 "Pork"@}
9205 This is the default format.
9207 @item show print pretty
9208 Show which format @value{GDBN} is using to print structures.
9210 @item set print sevenbit-strings on
9211 @cindex eight-bit characters in strings
9212 @cindex octal escapes in strings
9213 Print using only seven-bit characters; if this option is set,
9214 @value{GDBN} displays any eight-bit characters (in strings or
9215 character values) using the notation @code{\}@var{nnn}. This setting is
9216 best if you are working in English (@sc{ascii}) and you use the
9217 high-order bit of characters as a marker or ``meta'' bit.
9219 @item set print sevenbit-strings off
9220 Print full eight-bit characters. This allows the use of more
9221 international character sets, and is the default.
9223 @item show print sevenbit-strings
9224 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} is printing only seven-bit characters.
9226 @item set print union on
9227 @cindex unions in structures, printing
9228 Tell @value{GDBN} to print unions which are contained in structures
9229 and other unions. This is the default setting.
9231 @item set print union off
9232 Tell @value{GDBN} not to print unions which are contained in
9233 structures and other unions. @value{GDBN} will print @code{"@{...@}"}
9236 @item show print union
9237 Ask @value{GDBN} whether or not it will print unions which are contained in
9238 structures and other unions.
9240 For example, given the declarations
9243 typedef enum @{Tree, Bug@} Species;
9244 typedef enum @{Big_tree, Acorn, Seedling@} Tree_forms;
9245 typedef enum @{Caterpillar, Cocoon, Butterfly@}
9256 struct thing foo = @{Tree, @{Acorn@}@};
9260 with @code{set print union on} in effect @samp{p foo} would print
9263 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{tree = Acorn, bug = Cocoon@}@}
9267 and with @code{set print union off} in effect it would print
9270 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{...@}@}
9274 @code{set print union} affects programs written in C-like languages
9280 These settings are of interest when debugging C@t{++} programs:
9283 @cindex demangling C@t{++} names
9284 @item set print demangle
9285 @itemx set print demangle on
9286 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than in the encoded
9287 (``mangled'') form passed to the assembler and linker for type-safe
9288 linkage. The default is on.
9290 @item show print demangle
9291 Show whether C@t{++} names are printed in mangled or demangled form.
9293 @item set print asm-demangle
9294 @itemx set print asm-demangle on
9295 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than their mangled form, even
9296 in assembler code printouts such as instruction disassemblies.
9299 @item show print asm-demangle
9300 Show whether C@t{++} names in assembly listings are printed in mangled
9303 @cindex C@t{++} symbol decoding style
9304 @cindex symbol decoding style, C@t{++}
9305 @kindex set demangle-style
9306 @item set demangle-style @var{style}
9307 Choose among several encoding schemes used by different compilers to
9308 represent C@t{++} names. The choices for @var{style} are currently:
9312 Allow @value{GDBN} to choose a decoding style by inspecting your program.
9313 This is the default.
9316 Decode based on the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler (@code{g++}) encoding algorithm.
9319 Decode based on the HP ANSI C@t{++} (@code{aCC}) encoding algorithm.
9322 Decode based on the Lucid C@t{++} compiler (@code{lcc}) encoding algorithm.
9325 Decode using the algorithm in the @cite{C@t{++} Annotated Reference Manual}.
9326 @strong{Warning:} this setting alone is not sufficient to allow
9327 debugging @code{cfront}-generated executables. @value{GDBN} would
9328 require further enhancement to permit that.
9331 If you omit @var{style}, you will see a list of possible formats.
9333 @item show demangle-style
9334 Display the encoding style currently in use for decoding C@t{++} symbols.
9336 @item set print object
9337 @itemx set print object on
9338 @cindex derived type of an object, printing
9339 @cindex display derived types
9340 When displaying a pointer to an object, identify the @emph{actual}
9341 (derived) type of the object rather than the @emph{declared} type, using
9342 the virtual function table. Note that the virtual function table is
9343 required---this feature can only work for objects that have run-time
9344 type identification; a single virtual method in the object's declared
9345 type is sufficient. Note that this setting is also taken into account when
9346 working with variable objects via MI (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
9348 @item set print object off
9349 Display only the declared type of objects, without reference to the
9350 virtual function table. This is the default setting.
9352 @item show print object
9353 Show whether actual, or declared, object types are displayed.
9355 @item set print static-members
9356 @itemx set print static-members on
9357 @cindex static members of C@t{++} objects
9358 Print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object. The default is on.
9360 @item set print static-members off
9361 Do not print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object.
9363 @item show print static-members
9364 Show whether C@t{++} static members are printed or not.
9366 @item set print pascal_static-members
9367 @itemx set print pascal_static-members on
9368 @cindex static members of Pascal objects
9369 @cindex Pascal objects, static members display
9370 Print static members when displaying a Pascal object. The default is on.
9372 @item set print pascal_static-members off
9373 Do not print static members when displaying a Pascal object.
9375 @item show print pascal_static-members
9376 Show whether Pascal static members are printed or not.
9378 @c These don't work with HP ANSI C++ yet.
9379 @item set print vtbl
9380 @itemx set print vtbl on
9381 @cindex pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables
9382 @cindex virtual functions (C@t{++}) display
9383 @cindex VTBL display
9384 Pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables. The default is off.
9385 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
9386 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
9388 @item set print vtbl off
9389 Do not pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables.
9391 @item show print vtbl
9392 Show whether C@t{++} virtual function tables are pretty printed, or not.
9395 @node Pretty Printing
9396 @section Pretty Printing
9398 @value{GDBN} provides a mechanism to allow pretty-printing of values using
9399 Python code. It greatly simplifies the display of complex objects. This
9400 mechanism works for both MI and the CLI.
9403 * Pretty-Printer Introduction:: Introduction to pretty-printers
9404 * Pretty-Printer Example:: An example pretty-printer
9405 * Pretty-Printer Commands:: Pretty-printer commands
9408 @node Pretty-Printer Introduction
9409 @subsection Pretty-Printer Introduction
9411 When @value{GDBN} prints a value, it first sees if there is a pretty-printer
9412 registered for the value. If there is then @value{GDBN} invokes the
9413 pretty-printer to print the value. Otherwise the value is printed normally.
9415 Pretty-printers are normally named. This makes them easy to manage.
9416 The @samp{info pretty-printer} command will list all the installed
9417 pretty-printers with their names.
9418 If a pretty-printer can handle multiple data types, then its
9419 @dfn{subprinters} are the printers for the individual data types.
9420 Each such subprinter has its own name.
9421 The format of the name is @var{printer-name};@var{subprinter-name}.
9423 Pretty-printers are installed by @dfn{registering} them with @value{GDBN}.
9424 Typically they are automatically loaded and registered when the corresponding
9425 debug information is loaded, thus making them available without having to
9426 do anything special.
9428 There are three places where a pretty-printer can be registered.
9432 Pretty-printers registered globally are available when debugging
9436 Pretty-printers registered with a program space are available only
9437 when debugging that program.
9438 @xref{Progspaces In Python}, for more details on program spaces in Python.
9441 Pretty-printers registered with an objfile are loaded and unloaded
9442 with the corresponding objfile (e.g., shared library).
9443 @xref{Objfiles In Python}, for more details on objfiles in Python.
9446 @xref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}, for further information on how
9447 pretty-printers are selected,
9449 @xref{Writing a Pretty-Printer}, for implementing pretty printers
9452 @node Pretty-Printer Example
9453 @subsection Pretty-Printer Example
9455 Here is how a C@t{++} @code{std::string} looks without a pretty-printer:
9458 (@value{GDBP}) print s
9460 static npos = 4294967295,
9462 <std::allocator<char>> = @{
9463 <__gnu_cxx::new_allocator<char>> = @{
9464 <No data fields>@}, <No data fields>
9466 members of std::basic_string<char, std::char_traits<char>,
9467 std::allocator<char> >::_Alloc_hider:
9468 _M_p = 0x804a014 "abcd"
9473 With a pretty-printer for @code{std::string} only the contents are printed:
9476 (@value{GDBP}) print s
9480 @node Pretty-Printer Commands
9481 @subsection Pretty-Printer Commands
9482 @cindex pretty-printer commands
9485 @kindex info pretty-printer
9486 @item info pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
9487 Print the list of installed pretty-printers.
9488 This includes disabled pretty-printers, which are marked as such.
9490 @var{object-regexp} is a regular expression matching the objects
9491 whose pretty-printers to list.
9492 Objects can be @code{global}, the program space's file
9493 (@pxref{Progspaces In Python}),
9494 and the object files within that program space (@pxref{Objfiles In Python}).
9495 @xref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}, for details on how @value{GDBN}
9496 looks up a printer from these three objects.
9498 @var{name-regexp} is a regular expression matching the name of the printers
9501 @kindex disable pretty-printer
9502 @item disable pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
9503 Disable pretty-printers matching @var{object-regexp} and @var{name-regexp}.
9504 A disabled pretty-printer is not forgotten, it may be enabled again later.
9506 @kindex enable pretty-printer
9507 @item enable pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
9508 Enable pretty-printers matching @var{object-regexp} and @var{name-regexp}.
9513 Suppose we have three pretty-printers installed: one from library1.so
9514 named @code{foo} that prints objects of type @code{foo}, and
9515 another from library2.so named @code{bar} that prints two types of objects,
9516 @code{bar1} and @code{bar2}.
9519 (gdb) info pretty-printer
9526 (gdb) info pretty-printer library2
9531 (gdb) disable pretty-printer library1
9533 2 of 3 printers enabled
9534 (gdb) info pretty-printer
9541 (gdb) disable pretty-printer library2 bar:bar1
9543 1 of 3 printers enabled
9544 (gdb) info pretty-printer library2
9551 (gdb) disable pretty-printer library2 bar
9553 0 of 3 printers enabled
9554 (gdb) info pretty-printer library2
9563 Note that for @code{bar} the entire printer can be disabled,
9564 as can each individual subprinter.
9567 @section Value History
9569 @cindex value history
9570 @cindex history of values printed by @value{GDBN}
9571 Values printed by the @code{print} command are saved in the @value{GDBN}
9572 @dfn{value history}. This allows you to refer to them in other expressions.
9573 Values are kept until the symbol table is re-read or discarded
9574 (for example with the @code{file} or @code{symbol-file} commands).
9575 When the symbol table changes, the value history is discarded,
9576 since the values may contain pointers back to the types defined in the
9581 @cindex history number
9582 The values printed are given @dfn{history numbers} by which you can
9583 refer to them. These are successive integers starting with one.
9584 @code{print} shows you the history number assigned to a value by
9585 printing @samp{$@var{num} = } before the value; here @var{num} is the
9588 To refer to any previous value, use @samp{$} followed by the value's
9589 history number. The way @code{print} labels its output is designed to
9590 remind you of this. Just @code{$} refers to the most recent value in
9591 the history, and @code{$$} refers to the value before that.
9592 @code{$$@var{n}} refers to the @var{n}th value from the end; @code{$$2}
9593 is the value just prior to @code{$$}, @code{$$1} is equivalent to
9594 @code{$$}, and @code{$$0} is equivalent to @code{$}.
9596 For example, suppose you have just printed a pointer to a structure and
9597 want to see the contents of the structure. It suffices to type
9603 If you have a chain of structures where the component @code{next} points
9604 to the next one, you can print the contents of the next one with this:
9611 You can print successive links in the chain by repeating this
9612 command---which you can do by just typing @key{RET}.
9614 Note that the history records values, not expressions. If the value of
9615 @code{x} is 4 and you type these commands:
9623 then the value recorded in the value history by the @code{print} command
9624 remains 4 even though the value of @code{x} has changed.
9629 Print the last ten values in the value history, with their item numbers.
9630 This is like @samp{p@ $$9} repeated ten times, except that @code{show
9631 values} does not change the history.
9633 @item show values @var{n}
9634 Print ten history values centered on history item number @var{n}.
9637 Print ten history values just after the values last printed. If no more
9638 values are available, @code{show values +} produces no display.
9641 Pressing @key{RET} to repeat @code{show values @var{n}} has exactly the
9642 same effect as @samp{show values +}.
9644 @node Convenience Vars
9645 @section Convenience Variables
9647 @cindex convenience variables
9648 @cindex user-defined variables
9649 @value{GDBN} provides @dfn{convenience variables} that you can use within
9650 @value{GDBN} to hold on to a value and refer to it later. These variables
9651 exist entirely within @value{GDBN}; they are not part of your program, and
9652 setting a convenience variable has no direct effect on further execution
9653 of your program. That is why you can use them freely.
9655 Convenience variables are prefixed with @samp{$}. Any name preceded by
9656 @samp{$} can be used for a convenience variable, unless it is one of
9657 the predefined machine-specific register names (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
9658 (Value history references, in contrast, are @emph{numbers} preceded
9659 by @samp{$}. @xref{Value History, ,Value History}.)
9661 You can save a value in a convenience variable with an assignment
9662 expression, just as you would set a variable in your program.
9666 set $foo = *object_ptr
9670 would save in @code{$foo} the value contained in the object pointed to by
9673 Using a convenience variable for the first time creates it, but its
9674 value is @code{void} until you assign a new value. You can alter the
9675 value with another assignment at any time.
9677 Convenience variables have no fixed types. You can assign a convenience
9678 variable any type of value, including structures and arrays, even if
9679 that variable already has a value of a different type. The convenience
9680 variable, when used as an expression, has the type of its current value.
9683 @kindex show convenience
9684 @cindex show all user variables and functions
9685 @item show convenience
9686 Print a list of convenience variables used so far, and their values,
9687 as well as a list of the convenience functions.
9688 Abbreviated @code{show conv}.
9690 @kindex init-if-undefined
9691 @cindex convenience variables, initializing
9692 @item init-if-undefined $@var{variable} = @var{expression}
9693 Set a convenience variable if it has not already been set. This is useful
9694 for user-defined commands that keep some state. It is similar, in concept,
9695 to using local static variables with initializers in C (except that
9696 convenience variables are global). It can also be used to allow users to
9697 override default values used in a command script.
9699 If the variable is already defined then the expression is not evaluated so
9700 any side-effects do not occur.
9703 One of the ways to use a convenience variable is as a counter to be
9704 incremented or a pointer to be advanced. For example, to print
9705 a field from successive elements of an array of structures:
9709 print bar[$i++]->contents
9713 Repeat that command by typing @key{RET}.
9715 Some convenience variables are created automatically by @value{GDBN} and given
9716 values likely to be useful.
9719 @vindex $_@r{, convenience variable}
9721 The variable @code{$_} is automatically set by the @code{x} command to
9722 the last address examined (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}). Other
9723 commands which provide a default address for @code{x} to examine also
9724 set @code{$_} to that address; these commands include @code{info line}
9725 and @code{info breakpoint}. The type of @code{$_} is @code{void *}
9726 except when set by the @code{x} command, in which case it is a pointer
9727 to the type of @code{$__}.
9729 @vindex $__@r{, convenience variable}
9731 The variable @code{$__} is automatically set by the @code{x} command
9732 to the value found in the last address examined. Its type is chosen
9733 to match the format in which the data was printed.
9736 @vindex $_exitcode@r{, convenience variable}
9737 The variable @code{$_exitcode} is automatically set to the exit code when
9738 the program being debugged terminates.
9741 The variable @code{$_exception} is set to the exception object being
9742 thrown at an exception-related catchpoint. @xref{Set Catchpoints}.
9745 @itemx $_probe_arg0@dots{}$_probe_arg11
9746 Arguments to a static probe. @xref{Static Probe Points}.
9749 @vindex $_sdata@r{, inspect, convenience variable}
9750 The variable @code{$_sdata} contains extra collected static tracepoint
9751 data. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}. Note that
9752 @code{$_sdata} could be empty, if not inspecting a trace buffer, or
9753 if extra static tracepoint data has not been collected.
9756 @vindex $_siginfo@r{, convenience variable}
9757 The variable @code{$_siginfo} contains extra signal information
9758 (@pxref{extra signal information}). Note that @code{$_siginfo}
9759 could be empty, if the application has not yet received any signals.
9760 For example, it will be empty before you execute the @code{run} command.
9763 @vindex $_tlb@r{, convenience variable}
9764 The variable @code{$_tlb} is automatically set when debugging
9765 applications running on MS-Windows in native mode or connected to
9766 gdbserver that supports the @code{qGetTIBAddr} request.
9767 @xref{General Query Packets}.
9768 This variable contains the address of the thread information block.
9772 On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
9773 begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
9774 name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
9776 @node Convenience Funs
9777 @section Convenience Functions
9779 @cindex convenience functions
9780 @value{GDBN} also supplies some @dfn{convenience functions}. These
9781 have a syntax similar to convenience variables. A convenience
9782 function can be used in an expression just like an ordinary function;
9783 however, a convenience function is implemented internally to
9786 These functions require @value{GDBN} to be configured with
9787 @code{Python} support.
9791 @item $_memeq(@var{buf1}, @var{buf2}, @var{length})
9792 @findex $_memeq@r{, convenience function}
9793 Returns one if the @var{length} bytes at the addresses given by
9794 @var{buf1} and @var{buf2} are equal.
9795 Otherwise it returns zero.
9797 @item $_regex(@var{str}, @var{regex})
9798 @findex $_regex@r{, convenience function}
9799 Returns one if the string @var{str} matches the regular expression
9800 @var{regex}. Otherwise it returns zero.
9801 The syntax of the regular expression is that specified by @code{Python}'s
9802 regular expression support.
9804 @item $_streq(@var{str1}, @var{str2})
9805 @findex $_streq@r{, convenience function}
9806 Returns one if the strings @var{str1} and @var{str2} are equal.
9807 Otherwise it returns zero.
9809 @item $_strlen(@var{str})
9810 @findex $_strlen@r{, convenience function}
9811 Returns the length of string @var{str}.
9815 @value{GDBN} provides the ability to list and get help on
9816 convenience functions.
9820 @kindex help function
9821 @cindex show all convenience functions
9822 Print a list of all convenience functions.
9829 You can refer to machine register contents, in expressions, as variables
9830 with names starting with @samp{$}. The names of registers are different
9831 for each machine; use @code{info registers} to see the names used on
9835 @kindex info registers
9836 @item info registers
9837 Print the names and values of all registers except floating-point
9838 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
9840 @kindex info all-registers
9841 @cindex floating point registers
9842 @item info all-registers
9843 Print the names and values of all registers, including floating-point
9844 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
9846 @item info registers @var{regname} @dots{}
9847 Print the @dfn{relativized} value of each specified register @var{regname}.
9848 As discussed in detail below, register values are normally relative to
9849 the selected stack frame. @var{regname} may be any register name valid on
9850 the machine you are using, with or without the initial @samp{$}.
9853 @cindex stack pointer register
9854 @cindex program counter register
9855 @cindex process status register
9856 @cindex frame pointer register
9857 @cindex standard registers
9858 @value{GDBN} has four ``standard'' register names that are available (in
9859 expressions) on most machines---whenever they do not conflict with an
9860 architecture's canonical mnemonics for registers. The register names
9861 @code{$pc} and @code{$sp} are used for the program counter register and
9862 the stack pointer. @code{$fp} is used for a register that contains a
9863 pointer to the current stack frame, and @code{$ps} is used for a
9864 register that contains the processor status. For example,
9865 you could print the program counter in hex with
9872 or print the instruction to be executed next with
9879 or add four to the stack pointer@footnote{This is a way of removing
9880 one word from the stack, on machines where stacks grow downward in
9881 memory (most machines, nowadays). This assumes that the innermost
9882 stack frame is selected; setting @code{$sp} is not allowed when other
9883 stack frames are selected. To pop entire frames off the stack,
9884 regardless of machine architecture, use @code{return};
9885 see @ref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}.} with
9891 Whenever possible, these four standard register names are available on
9892 your machine even though the machine has different canonical mnemonics,
9893 so long as there is no conflict. The @code{info registers} command
9894 shows the canonical names. For example, on the SPARC, @code{info
9895 registers} displays the processor status register as @code{$psr} but you
9896 can also refer to it as @code{$ps}; and on x86-based machines @code{$ps}
9897 is an alias for the @sc{eflags} register.
9899 @value{GDBN} always considers the contents of an ordinary register as an
9900 integer when the register is examined in this way. Some machines have
9901 special registers which can hold nothing but floating point; these
9902 registers are considered to have floating point values. There is no way
9903 to refer to the contents of an ordinary register as floating point value
9904 (although you can @emph{print} it as a floating point value with
9905 @samp{print/f $@var{regname}}).
9907 Some registers have distinct ``raw'' and ``virtual'' data formats. This
9908 means that the data format in which the register contents are saved by
9909 the operating system is not the same one that your program normally
9910 sees. For example, the registers of the 68881 floating point
9911 coprocessor are always saved in ``extended'' (raw) format, but all C
9912 programs expect to work with ``double'' (virtual) format. In such
9913 cases, @value{GDBN} normally works with the virtual format only (the format
9914 that makes sense for your program), but the @code{info registers} command
9915 prints the data in both formats.
9917 @cindex SSE registers (x86)
9918 @cindex MMX registers (x86)
9919 Some machines have special registers whose contents can be interpreted
9920 in several different ways. For example, modern x86-based machines
9921 have SSE and MMX registers that can hold several values packed
9922 together in several different formats. @value{GDBN} refers to such
9923 registers in @code{struct} notation:
9926 (@value{GDBP}) print $xmm1
9928 v4_float = @{0, 3.43859137e-038, 1.54142831e-044, 1.821688e-044@},
9929 v2_double = @{9.92129282474342e-303, 2.7585945287983262e-313@},
9930 v16_int8 = "\000\000\000\000\3706;\001\v\000\000\000\r\000\000",
9931 v8_int16 = @{0, 0, 14072, 315, 11, 0, 13, 0@},
9932 v4_int32 = @{0, 20657912, 11, 13@},
9933 v2_int64 = @{88725056443645952, 55834574859@},
9934 uint128 = 0x0000000d0000000b013b36f800000000
9939 To set values of such registers, you need to tell @value{GDBN} which
9940 view of the register you wish to change, as if you were assigning
9941 value to a @code{struct} member:
9944 (@value{GDBP}) set $xmm1.uint128 = 0x000000000000000000000000FFFFFFFF
9947 Normally, register values are relative to the selected stack frame
9948 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). This means that you get the
9949 value that the register would contain if all stack frames farther in
9950 were exited and their saved registers restored. In order to see the
9951 true contents of hardware registers, you must select the innermost
9952 frame (with @samp{frame 0}).
9954 However, @value{GDBN} must deduce where registers are saved, from the machine
9955 code generated by your compiler. If some registers are not saved, or if
9956 @value{GDBN} is unable to locate the saved registers, the selected stack
9957 frame makes no difference.
9959 @node Floating Point Hardware
9960 @section Floating Point Hardware
9961 @cindex floating point
9963 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give
9964 you more information about the status of the floating point hardware.
9969 Display hardware-dependent information about the floating
9970 point unit. The exact contents and layout vary depending on the
9971 floating point chip. Currently, @samp{info float} is supported on
9972 the ARM and x86 machines.
9976 @section Vector Unit
9979 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give you
9980 more information about the status of the vector unit.
9985 Display information about the vector unit. The exact contents and
9986 layout vary depending on the hardware.
9989 @node OS Information
9990 @section Operating System Auxiliary Information
9991 @cindex OS information
9993 @value{GDBN} provides interfaces to useful OS facilities that can help
9994 you debug your program.
9996 @cindex auxiliary vector
9997 @cindex vector, auxiliary
9998 Some operating systems supply an @dfn{auxiliary vector} to programs at
9999 startup. This is akin to the arguments and environment that you
10000 specify for a program, but contains a system-dependent variety of
10001 binary values that tell system libraries important details about the
10002 hardware, operating system, and process. Each value's purpose is
10003 identified by an integer tag; the meanings are well-known but system-specific.
10004 Depending on the configuration and operating system facilities,
10005 @value{GDBN} may be able to show you this information. For remote
10006 targets, this functionality may further depend on the remote stub's
10007 support of the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet, see
10008 @ref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}.
10013 Display the auxiliary vector of the inferior, which can be either a
10014 live process or a core dump file. @value{GDBN} prints each tag value
10015 numerically, and also shows names and text descriptions for recognized
10016 tags. Some values in the vector are numbers, some bit masks, and some
10017 pointers to strings or other data. @value{GDBN} displays each value in the
10018 most appropriate form for a recognized tag, and in hexadecimal for
10019 an unrecognized tag.
10022 On some targets, @value{GDBN} can access operating system-specific
10023 information and show it to you. The types of information available
10024 will differ depending on the type of operating system running on the
10025 target. The mechanism used to fetch the data is described in
10026 @ref{Operating System Information}. For remote targets, this
10027 functionality depends on the remote stub's support of the
10028 @samp{qXfer:osdata:read} packet, see @ref{qXfer osdata read}.
10032 @item info os @var{infotype}
10034 Display OS information of the requested type.
10036 On @sc{gnu}/Linux, the following values of @var{infotype} are valid:
10038 @anchor{linux info os infotypes}
10040 @kindex info os processes
10042 Display the list of processes on the target. For each process,
10043 @value{GDBN} prints the process identifier, the name of the user, the
10044 command corresponding to the process, and the list of processor cores
10045 that the process is currently running on. (To understand what these
10046 properties mean, for this and the following info types, please consult
10047 the general @sc{gnu}/Linux documentation.)
10049 @kindex info os procgroups
10051 Display the list of process groups on the target. For each process,
10052 @value{GDBN} prints the identifier of the process group that it belongs
10053 to, the command corresponding to the process group leader, the process
10054 identifier, and the command line of the process. The list is sorted
10055 first by the process group identifier, then by the process identifier,
10056 so that processes belonging to the same process group are grouped together
10057 and the process group leader is listed first.
10059 @kindex info os threads
10061 Display the list of threads running on the target. For each thread,
10062 @value{GDBN} prints the identifier of the process that the thread
10063 belongs to, the command of the process, the thread identifier, and the
10064 processor core that it is currently running on. The main thread of a
10065 process is not listed.
10067 @kindex info os files
10069 Display the list of open file descriptors on the target. For each
10070 file descriptor, @value{GDBN} prints the identifier of the process
10071 owning the descriptor, the command of the owning process, the value
10072 of the descriptor, and the target of the descriptor.
10074 @kindex info os sockets
10076 Display the list of Internet-domain sockets on the target. For each
10077 socket, @value{GDBN} prints the address and port of the local and
10078 remote endpoints, the current state of the connection, the creator of
10079 the socket, the IP address family of the socket, and the type of the
10082 @kindex info os shm
10084 Display the list of all System V shared-memory regions on the target.
10085 For each shared-memory region, @value{GDBN} prints the region key,
10086 the shared-memory identifier, the access permissions, the size of the
10087 region, the process that created the region, the process that last
10088 attached to or detached from the region, the current number of live
10089 attaches to the region, and the times at which the region was last
10090 attached to, detach from, and changed.
10092 @kindex info os semaphores
10094 Display the list of all System V semaphore sets on the target. For each
10095 semaphore set, @value{GDBN} prints the semaphore set key, the semaphore
10096 set identifier, the access permissions, the number of semaphores in the
10097 set, the user and group of the owner and creator of the semaphore set,
10098 and the times at which the semaphore set was operated upon and changed.
10100 @kindex info os msg
10102 Display the list of all System V message queues on the target. For each
10103 message queue, @value{GDBN} prints the message queue key, the message
10104 queue identifier, the access permissions, the current number of bytes
10105 on the queue, the current number of messages on the queue, the processes
10106 that last sent and received a message on the queue, the user and group
10107 of the owner and creator of the message queue, the times at which a
10108 message was last sent and received on the queue, and the time at which
10109 the message queue was last changed.
10111 @kindex info os modules
10113 Display the list of all loaded kernel modules on the target. For each
10114 module, @value{GDBN} prints the module name, the size of the module in
10115 bytes, the number of times the module is used, the dependencies of the
10116 module, the status of the module, and the address of the loaded module
10121 If @var{infotype} is omitted, then list the possible values for
10122 @var{infotype} and the kind of OS information available for each
10123 @var{infotype}. If the target does not return a list of possible
10124 types, this command will report an error.
10127 @node Memory Region Attributes
10128 @section Memory Region Attributes
10129 @cindex memory region attributes
10131 @dfn{Memory region attributes} allow you to describe special handling
10132 required by regions of your target's memory. @value{GDBN} uses
10133 attributes to determine whether to allow certain types of memory
10134 accesses; whether to use specific width accesses; and whether to cache
10135 target memory. By default the description of memory regions is
10136 fetched from the target (if the current target supports this), but the
10137 user can override the fetched regions.
10139 Defined memory regions can be individually enabled and disabled. When a
10140 memory region is disabled, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when
10141 accessing memory in that region. Similarly, if no memory regions have
10142 been defined, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when accessing
10145 When a memory region is defined, it is given a number to identify it;
10146 to enable, disable, or remove a memory region, you specify that number.
10150 @item mem @var{lower} @var{upper} @var{attributes}@dots{}
10151 Define a memory region bounded by @var{lower} and @var{upper} with
10152 attributes @var{attributes}@dots{}, and add it to the list of regions
10153 monitored by @value{GDBN}. Note that @var{upper} == 0 is a special
10154 case: it is treated as the target's maximum memory address.
10155 (0xffff on 16 bit targets, 0xffffffff on 32 bit targets, etc.)
10158 Discard any user changes to the memory regions and use target-supplied
10159 regions, if available, or no regions if the target does not support.
10162 @item delete mem @var{nums}@dots{}
10163 Remove memory regions @var{nums}@dots{} from the list of regions
10164 monitored by @value{GDBN}.
10166 @kindex disable mem
10167 @item disable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
10168 Disable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
10169 A disabled memory region is not forgotten.
10170 It may be enabled again later.
10173 @item enable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
10174 Enable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
10178 Print a table of all defined memory regions, with the following columns
10182 @item Memory Region Number
10183 @item Enabled or Disabled.
10184 Enabled memory regions are marked with @samp{y}.
10185 Disabled memory regions are marked with @samp{n}.
10188 The address defining the inclusive lower bound of the memory region.
10191 The address defining the exclusive upper bound of the memory region.
10194 The list of attributes set for this memory region.
10199 @subsection Attributes
10201 @subsubsection Memory Access Mode
10202 The access mode attributes set whether @value{GDBN} may make read or
10203 write accesses to a memory region.
10205 While these attributes prevent @value{GDBN} from performing invalid
10206 memory accesses, they do nothing to prevent the target system, I/O DMA,
10207 etc.@: from accessing memory.
10211 Memory is read only.
10213 Memory is write only.
10215 Memory is read/write. This is the default.
10218 @subsubsection Memory Access Size
10219 The access size attribute tells @value{GDBN} to use specific sized
10220 accesses in the memory region. Often memory mapped device registers
10221 require specific sized accesses. If no access size attribute is
10222 specified, @value{GDBN} may use accesses of any size.
10226 Use 8 bit memory accesses.
10228 Use 16 bit memory accesses.
10230 Use 32 bit memory accesses.
10232 Use 64 bit memory accesses.
10235 @c @subsubsection Hardware/Software Breakpoints
10236 @c The hardware/software breakpoint attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
10237 @c will use hardware or software breakpoints for the internal breakpoints
10238 @c used by the step, next, finish, until, etc. commands.
10242 @c Always use hardware breakpoints
10243 @c @item swbreak (default)
10246 @subsubsection Data Cache
10247 The data cache attributes set whether @value{GDBN} will cache target
10248 memory. While this generally improves performance by reducing debug
10249 protocol overhead, it can lead to incorrect results because @value{GDBN}
10250 does not know about volatile variables or memory mapped device
10255 Enable @value{GDBN} to cache target memory.
10257 Disable @value{GDBN} from caching target memory. This is the default.
10260 @subsection Memory Access Checking
10261 @value{GDBN} can be instructed to refuse accesses to memory that is
10262 not explicitly described. This can be useful if accessing such
10263 regions has undesired effects for a specific target, or to provide
10264 better error checking. The following commands control this behaviour.
10267 @kindex set mem inaccessible-by-default
10268 @item set mem inaccessible-by-default [on|off]
10269 If @code{on} is specified, make @value{GDBN} treat memory not
10270 explicitly described by the memory ranges as non-existent and refuse accesses
10271 to such memory. The checks are only performed if there's at least one
10272 memory range defined. If @code{off} is specified, make @value{GDBN}
10273 treat the memory not explicitly described by the memory ranges as RAM.
10274 The default value is @code{on}.
10275 @kindex show mem inaccessible-by-default
10276 @item show mem inaccessible-by-default
10277 Show the current handling of accesses to unknown memory.
10281 @c @subsubsection Memory Write Verification
10282 @c The memory write verification attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
10283 @c will re-reads data after each write to verify the write was successful.
10287 @c @item noverify (default)
10290 @node Dump/Restore Files
10291 @section Copy Between Memory and a File
10292 @cindex dump/restore files
10293 @cindex append data to a file
10294 @cindex dump data to a file
10295 @cindex restore data from a file
10297 You can use the commands @code{dump}, @code{append}, and
10298 @code{restore} to copy data between target memory and a file. The
10299 @code{dump} and @code{append} commands write data to a file, and the
10300 @code{restore} command reads data from a file back into the inferior's
10301 memory. Files may be in binary, Motorola S-record, Intel hex, or
10302 Tektronix Hex format; however, @value{GDBN} can only append to binary
10308 @item dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
10309 @itemx dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
10310 Dump the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
10311 or the value of @var{expr}, to @var{filename} in the given format.
10313 The @var{format} parameter may be any one of:
10320 Motorola S-record format.
10322 Tektronix Hex format.
10325 @value{GDBN} uses the same definitions of these formats as the
10326 @sc{gnu} binary utilities, like @samp{objdump} and @samp{objcopy}. If
10327 @var{format} is omitted, @value{GDBN} dumps the data in raw binary
10331 @item append @r{[}binary@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
10332 @itemx append @r{[}binary@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
10333 Append the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
10334 or the value of @var{expr}, to the file @var{filename}, in raw binary form.
10335 (@value{GDBN} can only append data to files in raw binary form.)
10338 @item restore @var{filename} @r{[}binary@r{]} @var{bias} @var{start} @var{end}
10339 Restore the contents of file @var{filename} into memory. The
10340 @code{restore} command can automatically recognize any known @sc{bfd}
10341 file format, except for raw binary. To restore a raw binary file you
10342 must specify the optional keyword @code{binary} after the filename.
10344 If @var{bias} is non-zero, its value will be added to the addresses
10345 contained in the file. Binary files always start at address zero, so
10346 they will be restored at address @var{bias}. Other bfd files have
10347 a built-in location; they will be restored at offset @var{bias}
10348 from that location.
10350 If @var{start} and/or @var{end} are non-zero, then only data between
10351 file offset @var{start} and file offset @var{end} will be restored.
10352 These offsets are relative to the addresses in the file, before
10353 the @var{bias} argument is applied.
10357 @node Core File Generation
10358 @section How to Produce a Core File from Your Program
10359 @cindex dump core from inferior
10361 A @dfn{core file} or @dfn{core dump} is a file that records the memory
10362 image of a running process and its process status (register values
10363 etc.). Its primary use is post-mortem debugging of a program that
10364 crashed while it ran outside a debugger. A program that crashes
10365 automatically produces a core file, unless this feature is disabled by
10366 the user. @xref{Files}, for information on invoking @value{GDBN} in
10367 the post-mortem debugging mode.
10369 Occasionally, you may wish to produce a core file of the program you
10370 are debugging in order to preserve a snapshot of its state.
10371 @value{GDBN} has a special command for that.
10375 @kindex generate-core-file
10376 @item generate-core-file [@var{file}]
10377 @itemx gcore [@var{file}]
10378 Produce a core dump of the inferior process. The optional argument
10379 @var{file} specifies the file name where to put the core dump. If not
10380 specified, the file name defaults to @file{core.@var{pid}}, where
10381 @var{pid} is the inferior process ID.
10383 Note that this command is implemented only for some systems (as of
10384 this writing, @sc{gnu}/Linux, FreeBSD, Solaris, and S390).
10387 @node Character Sets
10388 @section Character Sets
10389 @cindex character sets
10391 @cindex translating between character sets
10392 @cindex host character set
10393 @cindex target character set
10395 If the program you are debugging uses a different character set to
10396 represent characters and strings than the one @value{GDBN} uses itself,
10397 @value{GDBN} can automatically translate between the character sets for
10398 you. The character set @value{GDBN} uses we call the @dfn{host
10399 character set}; the one the inferior program uses we call the
10400 @dfn{target character set}.
10402 For example, if you are running @value{GDBN} on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, which
10403 uses the ISO Latin 1 character set, but you are using @value{GDBN}'s
10404 remote protocol (@pxref{Remote Debugging}) to debug a program
10405 running on an IBM mainframe, which uses the @sc{ebcdic} character set,
10406 then the host character set is Latin-1, and the target character set is
10407 @sc{ebcdic}. If you give @value{GDBN} the command @code{set
10408 target-charset EBCDIC-US}, then @value{GDBN} translates between
10409 @sc{ebcdic} and Latin 1 as you print character or string values, or use
10410 character and string literals in expressions.
10412 @value{GDBN} has no way to automatically recognize which character set
10413 the inferior program uses; you must tell it, using the @code{set
10414 target-charset} command, described below.
10416 Here are the commands for controlling @value{GDBN}'s character set
10420 @item set target-charset @var{charset}
10421 @kindex set target-charset
10422 Set the current target character set to @var{charset}. To display the
10423 list of supported target character sets, type
10424 @kbd{@w{set target-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}}.
10426 @item set host-charset @var{charset}
10427 @kindex set host-charset
10428 Set the current host character set to @var{charset}.
10430 By default, @value{GDBN} uses a host character set appropriate to the
10431 system it is running on; you can override that default using the
10432 @code{set host-charset} command. On some systems, @value{GDBN} cannot
10433 automatically determine the appropriate host character set. In this
10434 case, @value{GDBN} uses @samp{UTF-8}.
10436 @value{GDBN} can only use certain character sets as its host character
10437 set. If you type @kbd{@w{set host-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}},
10438 @value{GDBN} will list the host character sets it supports.
10440 @item set charset @var{charset}
10441 @kindex set charset
10442 Set the current host and target character sets to @var{charset}. As
10443 above, if you type @kbd{@w{set charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}},
10444 @value{GDBN} will list the names of the character sets that can be used
10445 for both host and target.
10448 @kindex show charset
10449 Show the names of the current host and target character sets.
10451 @item show host-charset
10452 @kindex show host-charset
10453 Show the name of the current host character set.
10455 @item show target-charset
10456 @kindex show target-charset
10457 Show the name of the current target character set.
10459 @item set target-wide-charset @var{charset}
10460 @kindex set target-wide-charset
10461 Set the current target's wide character set to @var{charset}. This is
10462 the character set used by the target's @code{wchar_t} type. To
10463 display the list of supported wide character sets, type
10464 @kbd{@w{set target-wide-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}}.
10466 @item show target-wide-charset
10467 @kindex show target-wide-charset
10468 Show the name of the current target's wide character set.
10471 Here is an example of @value{GDBN}'s character set support in action.
10472 Assume that the following source code has been placed in the file
10473 @file{charset-test.c}:
10479 = @{72, 101, 108, 108, 111, 44, 32, 119,
10480 111, 114, 108, 100, 33, 10, 0@};
10481 char ibm1047_hello[]
10482 = @{200, 133, 147, 147, 150, 107, 64, 166,
10483 150, 153, 147, 132, 90, 37, 0@};
10487 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
10491 In this program, @code{ascii_hello} and @code{ibm1047_hello} are arrays
10492 containing the string @samp{Hello, world!} followed by a newline,
10493 encoded in the @sc{ascii} and @sc{ibm1047} character sets.
10495 We compile the program, and invoke the debugger on it:
10498 $ gcc -g charset-test.c -o charset-test
10499 $ gdb -nw charset-test
10500 GNU gdb 2001-12-19-cvs
10501 Copyright 2001 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
10506 We can use the @code{show charset} command to see what character sets
10507 @value{GDBN} is currently using to interpret and display characters and
10511 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
10512 The current host and target character set is `ISO-8859-1'.
10516 For the sake of printing this manual, let's use @sc{ascii} as our
10517 initial character set:
10519 (@value{GDBP}) set charset ASCII
10520 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
10521 The current host and target character set is `ASCII'.
10525 Let's assume that @sc{ascii} is indeed the correct character set for our
10526 host system --- in other words, let's assume that if @value{GDBN} prints
10527 characters using the @sc{ascii} character set, our terminal will display
10528 them properly. Since our current target character set is also
10529 @sc{ascii}, the contents of @code{ascii_hello} print legibly:
10532 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
10533 $1 = 0x401698 "Hello, world!\n"
10534 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
10539 @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and string
10540 literals you use in expressions:
10543 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
10548 The @sc{ascii} character set uses the number 43 to encode the @samp{+}
10551 @value{GDBN} relies on the user to tell it which character set the
10552 target program uses. If we print @code{ibm1047_hello} while our target
10553 character set is still @sc{ascii}, we get jibberish:
10556 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
10557 $4 = 0x4016a8 "\310\205\223\223\226k@@\246\226\231\223\204Z%"
10558 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
10563 If we invoke the @code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB},
10564 @value{GDBN} tells us the character sets it supports:
10567 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
10568 ASCII EBCDIC-US IBM1047 ISO-8859-1
10569 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
10572 We can select @sc{ibm1047} as our target character set, and examine the
10573 program's strings again. Now the @sc{ascii} string is wrong, but
10574 @value{GDBN} translates the contents of @code{ibm1047_hello} from the
10575 target character set, @sc{ibm1047}, to the host character set,
10576 @sc{ascii}, and they display correctly:
10579 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset IBM1047
10580 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
10581 The current host character set is `ASCII'.
10582 The current target character set is `IBM1047'.
10583 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
10584 $6 = 0x401698 "\110\145%%?\054\040\167?\162%\144\041\012"
10585 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
10587 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
10588 $8 = 0x4016a8 "Hello, world!\n"
10589 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
10594 As above, @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and
10595 string literals you use in expressions:
10598 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
10603 The @sc{ibm1047} character set uses the number 78 to encode the @samp{+}
10606 @node Caching Remote Data
10607 @section Caching Data of Remote Targets
10608 @cindex caching data of remote targets
10610 @value{GDBN} caches data exchanged between the debugger and a
10611 remote target (@pxref{Remote Debugging}). Such caching generally improves
10612 performance, because it reduces the overhead of the remote protocol by
10613 bundling memory reads and writes into large chunks. Unfortunately, simply
10614 caching everything would lead to incorrect results, since @value{GDBN}
10615 does not necessarily know anything about volatile values, memory-mapped I/O
10616 addresses, etc. Furthermore, in non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode})
10617 memory can be changed @emph{while} a gdb command is executing.
10618 Therefore, by default, @value{GDBN} only caches data
10619 known to be on the stack@footnote{In non-stop mode, it is moderately
10620 rare for a running thread to modify the stack of a stopped thread
10621 in a way that would interfere with a backtrace, and caching of
10622 stack reads provides a significant speed up of remote backtraces.}.
10623 Other regions of memory can be explicitly marked as
10624 cacheable; see @pxref{Memory Region Attributes}.
10627 @kindex set remotecache
10628 @item set remotecache on
10629 @itemx set remotecache off
10630 This option no longer does anything; it exists for compatibility
10633 @kindex show remotecache
10634 @item show remotecache
10635 Show the current state of the obsolete remotecache flag.
10637 @kindex set stack-cache
10638 @item set stack-cache on
10639 @itemx set stack-cache off
10640 Enable or disable caching of stack accesses. When @code{ON}, use
10641 caching. By default, this option is @code{ON}.
10643 @kindex show stack-cache
10644 @item show stack-cache
10645 Show the current state of data caching for memory accesses.
10647 @kindex info dcache
10648 @item info dcache @r{[}line@r{]}
10649 Print the information about the data cache performance. The
10650 information displayed includes the dcache width and depth, and for
10651 each cache line, its number, address, and how many times it was
10652 referenced. This command is useful for debugging the data cache
10655 If a line number is specified, the contents of that line will be
10658 @item set dcache size @var{size}
10659 @cindex dcache size
10660 @kindex set dcache size
10661 Set maximum number of entries in dcache (dcache depth above).
10663 @item set dcache line-size @var{line-size}
10664 @cindex dcache line-size
10665 @kindex set dcache line-size
10666 Set number of bytes each dcache entry caches (dcache width above).
10667 Must be a power of 2.
10669 @item show dcache size
10670 @kindex show dcache size
10671 Show maximum number of dcache entries. See also @ref{Caching Remote Data, info dcache}.
10673 @item show dcache line-size
10674 @kindex show dcache line-size
10675 Show default size of dcache lines. See also @ref{Caching Remote Data, info dcache}.
10679 @node Searching Memory
10680 @section Search Memory
10681 @cindex searching memory
10683 Memory can be searched for a particular sequence of bytes with the
10684 @code{find} command.
10688 @item find @r{[}/@var{sn}@r{]} @var{start_addr}, +@var{len}, @var{val1} @r{[}, @var{val2}, @dots{}@r{]}
10689 @itemx find @r{[}/@var{sn}@r{]} @var{start_addr}, @var{end_addr}, @var{val1} @r{[}, @var{val2}, @dots{}@r{]}
10690 Search memory for the sequence of bytes specified by @var{val1}, @var{val2},
10691 etc. The search begins at address @var{start_addr} and continues for either
10692 @var{len} bytes or through to @var{end_addr} inclusive.
10695 @var{s} and @var{n} are optional parameters.
10696 They may be specified in either order, apart or together.
10699 @item @var{s}, search query size
10700 The size of each search query value.
10706 halfwords (two bytes)
10710 giant words (eight bytes)
10713 All values are interpreted in the current language.
10714 This means, for example, that if the current source language is C/C@t{++}
10715 then searching for the string ``hello'' includes the trailing '\0'.
10717 If the value size is not specified, it is taken from the
10718 value's type in the current language.
10719 This is useful when one wants to specify the search
10720 pattern as a mixture of types.
10721 Note that this means, for example, that in the case of C-like languages
10722 a search for an untyped 0x42 will search for @samp{(int) 0x42}
10723 which is typically four bytes.
10725 @item @var{n}, maximum number of finds
10726 The maximum number of matches to print. The default is to print all finds.
10729 You can use strings as search values. Quote them with double-quotes
10731 The string value is copied into the search pattern byte by byte,
10732 regardless of the endianness of the target and the size specification.
10734 The address of each match found is printed as well as a count of the
10735 number of matches found.
10737 The address of the last value found is stored in convenience variable
10739 A count of the number of matches is stored in @samp{$numfound}.
10741 For example, if stopped at the @code{printf} in this function:
10747 static char hello[] = "hello-hello";
10748 static struct @{ char c; short s; int i; @}
10749 __attribute__ ((packed)) mixed
10750 = @{ 'c', 0x1234, 0x87654321 @};
10751 printf ("%s\n", hello);
10756 you get during debugging:
10759 (gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), "hello"
10760 0x804956d <hello.1620+6>
10762 (gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), 'h', 'e', 'l', 'l', 'o'
10763 0x8049567 <hello.1620>
10764 0x804956d <hello.1620+6>
10766 (gdb) find /b1 &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), 'h', 0x65, 'l'
10767 0x8049567 <hello.1620>
10769 (gdb) find &mixed, +sizeof(mixed), (char) 'c', (short) 0x1234, (int) 0x87654321
10770 0x8049560 <mixed.1625>
10772 (gdb) print $numfound
10775 $2 = (void *) 0x8049560
10778 @node Optimized Code
10779 @chapter Debugging Optimized Code
10780 @cindex optimized code, debugging
10781 @cindex debugging optimized code
10783 Almost all compilers support optimization. With optimization
10784 disabled, the compiler generates assembly code that corresponds
10785 directly to your source code, in a simplistic way. As the compiler
10786 applies more powerful optimizations, the generated assembly code
10787 diverges from your original source code. With help from debugging
10788 information generated by the compiler, @value{GDBN} can map from
10789 the running program back to constructs from your original source.
10791 @value{GDBN} is more accurate with optimization disabled. If you
10792 can recompile without optimization, it is easier to follow the
10793 progress of your program during debugging. But, there are many cases
10794 where you may need to debug an optimized version.
10796 When you debug a program compiled with @samp{-g -O}, remember that the
10797 optimizer has rearranged your code; the debugger shows you what is
10798 really there. Do not be too surprised when the execution path does not
10799 exactly match your source file! An extreme example: if you define a
10800 variable, but never use it, @value{GDBN} never sees that
10801 variable---because the compiler optimizes it out of existence.
10803 Some things do not work as well with @samp{-g -O} as with just
10804 @samp{-g}, particularly on machines with instruction scheduling. If in
10805 doubt, recompile with @samp{-g} alone, and if this fixes the problem,
10806 please report it to us as a bug (including a test case!).
10807 @xref{Variables}, for more information about debugging optimized code.
10810 * Inline Functions:: How @value{GDBN} presents inlining
10811 * Tail Call Frames:: @value{GDBN} analysis of jumps to functions
10814 @node Inline Functions
10815 @section Inline Functions
10816 @cindex inline functions, debugging
10818 @dfn{Inlining} is an optimization that inserts a copy of the function
10819 body directly at each call site, instead of jumping to a shared
10820 routine. @value{GDBN} displays inlined functions just like
10821 non-inlined functions. They appear in backtraces. You can view their
10822 arguments and local variables, step into them with @code{step}, skip
10823 them with @code{next}, and escape from them with @code{finish}.
10824 You can check whether a function was inlined by using the
10825 @code{info frame} command.
10827 For @value{GDBN} to support inlined functions, the compiler must
10828 record information about inlining in the debug information ---
10829 @value{NGCC} using the @sc{dwarf 2} format does this, and several
10830 other compilers do also. @value{GDBN} only supports inlined functions
10831 when using @sc{dwarf 2}. Versions of @value{NGCC} before 4.1
10832 do not emit two required attributes (@samp{DW_AT_call_file} and
10833 @samp{DW_AT_call_line}); @value{GDBN} does not display inlined
10834 function calls with earlier versions of @value{NGCC}. It instead
10835 displays the arguments and local variables of inlined functions as
10836 local variables in the caller.
10838 The body of an inlined function is directly included at its call site;
10839 unlike a non-inlined function, there are no instructions devoted to
10840 the call. @value{GDBN} still pretends that the call site and the
10841 start of the inlined function are different instructions. Stepping to
10842 the call site shows the call site, and then stepping again shows
10843 the first line of the inlined function, even though no additional
10844 instructions are executed.
10846 This makes source-level debugging much clearer; you can see both the
10847 context of the call and then the effect of the call. Only stepping by
10848 a single instruction using @code{stepi} or @code{nexti} does not do
10849 this; single instruction steps always show the inlined body.
10851 There are some ways that @value{GDBN} does not pretend that inlined
10852 function calls are the same as normal calls:
10856 Setting breakpoints at the call site of an inlined function may not
10857 work, because the call site does not contain any code. @value{GDBN}
10858 may incorrectly move the breakpoint to the next line of the enclosing
10859 function, after the call. This limitation will be removed in a future
10860 version of @value{GDBN}; until then, set a breakpoint on an earlier line
10861 or inside the inlined function instead.
10864 @value{GDBN} cannot locate the return value of inlined calls after
10865 using the @code{finish} command. This is a limitation of compiler-generated
10866 debugging information; after @code{finish}, you can step to the next line
10867 and print a variable where your program stored the return value.
10871 @node Tail Call Frames
10872 @section Tail Call Frames
10873 @cindex tail call frames, debugging
10875 Function @code{B} can call function @code{C} in its very last statement. In
10876 unoptimized compilation the call of @code{C} is immediately followed by return
10877 instruction at the end of @code{B} code. Optimizing compiler may replace the
10878 call and return in function @code{B} into one jump to function @code{C}
10879 instead. Such use of a jump instruction is called @dfn{tail call}.
10881 During execution of function @code{C}, there will be no indication in the
10882 function call stack frames that it was tail-called from @code{B}. If function
10883 @code{A} regularly calls function @code{B} which tail-calls function @code{C},
10884 then @value{GDBN} will see @code{A} as the caller of @code{C}. However, in
10885 some cases @value{GDBN} can determine that @code{C} was tail-called from
10886 @code{B}, and it will then create fictitious call frame for that, with the
10887 return address set up as if @code{B} called @code{C} normally.
10889 This functionality is currently supported only by DWARF 2 debugging format and
10890 the compiler has to produce @samp{DW_TAG_GNU_call_site} tags. With
10891 @value{NGCC}, you need to specify @option{-O -g} during compilation, to get
10894 @kbd{info frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info}) will indicate the tail call frame
10895 kind by text @code{tail call frame} such as in this sample @value{GDBN} output:
10899 0x40066b <b(int, double)+11>: jmp 0x400640 <c(int, double)>
10901 Stack level 1, frame at 0x7fffffffda30:
10902 rip = 0x40066d in b (amd64-entry-value.cc:59); saved rip 0x4004c5
10903 tail call frame, caller of frame at 0x7fffffffda30
10904 source language c++.
10905 Arglist at unknown address.
10906 Locals at unknown address, Previous frame's sp is 0x7fffffffda30
10909 The detection of all the possible code path executions can find them ambiguous.
10910 There is no execution history stored (possible @ref{Reverse Execution} is never
10911 used for this purpose) and the last known caller could have reached the known
10912 callee by multiple different jump sequences. In such case @value{GDBN} still
10913 tries to show at least all the unambiguous top tail callers and all the
10914 unambiguous bottom tail calees, if any.
10917 @anchor{set debug entry-values}
10918 @item set debug entry-values
10919 @kindex set debug entry-values
10920 When set to on, enables printing of analysis messages for both frame argument
10921 values at function entry and tail calls. It will show all the possible valid
10922 tail calls code paths it has considered. It will also print the intersection
10923 of them with the final unambiguous (possibly partial or even empty) code path
10926 @item show debug entry-values
10927 @kindex show debug entry-values
10928 Show the current state of analysis messages printing for both frame argument
10929 values at function entry and tail calls.
10932 The analysis messages for tail calls can for example show why the virtual tail
10933 call frame for function @code{c} has not been recognized (due to the indirect
10934 reference by variable @code{x}):
10937 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (void);
10938 void (*x) (void) = c;
10939 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (void) @{ x++; @}
10940 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (void) @{ a (); @}
10941 int main (void) @{ x (); return 0; @}
10943 Breakpoint 1, DW_OP_GNU_entry_value resolving cannot find
10944 DW_TAG_GNU_call_site 0x40039a in main
10946 3 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (void) @{ x++; @}
10949 #1 0x000000000040039a in main () at t.c:5
10952 Another possibility is an ambiguous virtual tail call frames resolution:
10956 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) f (void) @{ i++; @}
10957 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) e (void) @{ f (); @}
10958 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) d (void) @{ f (); @}
10959 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (void) @{ d (); @}
10960 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) b (void)
10961 @{ if (i) c (); else e (); @}
10962 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (void) @{ b (); @}
10963 int main (void) @{ a (); return 0; @}
10965 tailcall: initial: 0x4004d2(a) 0x4004ce(b) 0x4004b2(c) 0x4004a2(d)
10966 tailcall: compare: 0x4004d2(a) 0x4004cc(b) 0x400492(e)
10967 tailcall: reduced: 0x4004d2(a) |
10970 #1 0x00000000004004d2 in a () at t.c:8
10971 #2 0x0000000000400395 in main () at t.c:9
10974 @set CALLSEQ1A @code{main@value{ARROW}a@value{ARROW}b@value{ARROW}c@value{ARROW}d@value{ARROW}f}
10975 @set CALLSEQ2A @code{main@value{ARROW}a@value{ARROW}b@value{ARROW}e@value{ARROW}f}
10977 @c Convert CALLSEQ#A to CALLSEQ#B depending on HAVE_MAKEINFO_CLICK.
10978 @ifset HAVE_MAKEINFO_CLICK
10979 @set ARROW @click{}
10980 @set CALLSEQ1B @clicksequence{@value{CALLSEQ1A}}
10981 @set CALLSEQ2B @clicksequence{@value{CALLSEQ2A}}
10983 @ifclear HAVE_MAKEINFO_CLICK
10985 @set CALLSEQ1B @value{CALLSEQ1A}
10986 @set CALLSEQ2B @value{CALLSEQ2A}
10989 Frames #0 and #2 are real, #1 is a virtual tail call frame.
10990 The code can have possible execution paths @value{CALLSEQ1B} or
10991 @value{CALLSEQ2B}, @value{GDBN} cannot find which one from the inferior state.
10993 @code{initial:} state shows some random possible calling sequence @value{GDBN}
10994 has found. It then finds another possible calling sequcen - that one is
10995 prefixed by @code{compare:}. The non-ambiguous intersection of these two is
10996 printed as the @code{reduced:} calling sequence. That one could have many
10997 futher @code{compare:} and @code{reduced:} statements as long as there remain
10998 any non-ambiguous sequence entries.
11000 For the frame of function @code{b} in both cases there are different possible
11001 @code{$pc} values (@code{0x4004cc} or @code{0x4004ce}), therefore this frame is
11002 also ambigous. The only non-ambiguous frame is the one for function @code{a},
11003 therefore this one is displayed to the user while the ambiguous frames are
11006 There can be also reasons why printing of frame argument values at function
11011 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (int i) @{ v++; @}
11012 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (int i);
11013 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) b (int i) @{ a (i); @}
11014 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (int i)
11015 @{ if (i) b (i - 1); else c (0); @}
11016 int main (void) @{ a (5); return 0; @}
11019 #0 c (i=i@@entry=0) at t.c:2
11020 #1 0x0000000000400428 in a (DW_OP_GNU_entry_value resolving has found
11021 function "a" at 0x400420 can call itself via tail calls
11022 i=<optimized out>) at t.c:6
11023 #2 0x000000000040036e in main () at t.c:7
11026 @value{GDBN} cannot find out from the inferior state if and how many times did
11027 function @code{a} call itself (via function @code{b}) as these calls would be
11028 tail calls. Such tail calls would modify thue @code{i} variable, therefore
11029 @value{GDBN} cannot be sure the value it knows would be right - @value{GDBN}
11030 prints @code{<optimized out>} instead.
11033 @chapter C Preprocessor Macros
11035 Some languages, such as C and C@t{++}, provide a way to define and invoke
11036 ``preprocessor macros'' which expand into strings of tokens.
11037 @value{GDBN} can evaluate expressions containing macro invocations, show
11038 the result of macro expansion, and show a macro's definition, including
11039 where it was defined.
11041 You may need to compile your program specially to provide @value{GDBN}
11042 with information about preprocessor macros. Most compilers do not
11043 include macros in their debugging information, even when you compile
11044 with the @option{-g} flag. @xref{Compilation}.
11046 A program may define a macro at one point, remove that definition later,
11047 and then provide a different definition after that. Thus, at different
11048 points in the program, a macro may have different definitions, or have
11049 no definition at all. If there is a current stack frame, @value{GDBN}
11050 uses the macros in scope at that frame's source code line. Otherwise,
11051 @value{GDBN} uses the macros in scope at the current listing location;
11054 Whenever @value{GDBN} evaluates an expression, it always expands any
11055 macro invocations present in the expression. @value{GDBN} also provides
11056 the following commands for working with macros explicitly.
11060 @kindex macro expand
11061 @cindex macro expansion, showing the results of preprocessor
11062 @cindex preprocessor macro expansion, showing the results of
11063 @cindex expanding preprocessor macros
11064 @item macro expand @var{expression}
11065 @itemx macro exp @var{expression}
11066 Show the results of expanding all preprocessor macro invocations in
11067 @var{expression}. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does
11068 not parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression;
11069 it can be any string of tokens.
11072 @item macro expand-once @var{expression}
11073 @itemx macro exp1 @var{expression}
11074 @cindex expand macro once
11075 @i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Show the results of
11076 expanding those preprocessor macro invocations that appear explicitly in
11077 @var{expression}. Macro invocations appearing in that expansion are
11078 left unchanged. This command allows you to see the effect of a
11079 particular macro more clearly, without being confused by further
11080 expansions. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does not
11081 parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression; it
11082 can be any string of tokens.
11085 @cindex macro definition, showing
11086 @cindex definition of a macro, showing
11087 @cindex macros, from debug info
11088 @item info macro [-a|-all] [--] @var{macro}
11089 Show the current definition or all definitions of the named @var{macro},
11090 and describe the source location or compiler command-line where that
11091 definition was established. The optional double dash is to signify the end of
11092 argument processing and the beginning of @var{macro} for non C-like macros where
11093 the macro may begin with a hyphen.
11095 @kindex info macros
11096 @item info macros @var{linespec}
11097 Show all macro definitions that are in effect at the location specified
11098 by @var{linespec}, and describe the source location or compiler
11099 command-line where those definitions were established.
11101 @kindex macro define
11102 @cindex user-defined macros
11103 @cindex defining macros interactively
11104 @cindex macros, user-defined
11105 @item macro define @var{macro} @var{replacement-list}
11106 @itemx macro define @var{macro}(@var{arglist}) @var{replacement-list}
11107 Introduce a definition for a preprocessor macro named @var{macro},
11108 invocations of which are replaced by the tokens given in
11109 @var{replacement-list}. The first form of this command defines an
11110 ``object-like'' macro, which takes no arguments; the second form
11111 defines a ``function-like'' macro, which takes the arguments given in
11114 A definition introduced by this command is in scope in every
11115 expression evaluated in @value{GDBN}, until it is removed with the
11116 @code{macro undef} command, described below. The definition overrides
11117 all definitions for @var{macro} present in the program being debugged,
11118 as well as any previous user-supplied definition.
11120 @kindex macro undef
11121 @item macro undef @var{macro}
11122 Remove any user-supplied definition for the macro named @var{macro}.
11123 This command only affects definitions provided with the @code{macro
11124 define} command, described above; it cannot remove definitions present
11125 in the program being debugged.
11129 List all the macros defined using the @code{macro define} command.
11132 @cindex macros, example of debugging with
11133 Here is a transcript showing the above commands in action. First, we
11134 show our source files:
11139 #include "sample.h"
11142 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
11147 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
11149 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
11151 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
11158 Now, we compile the program using the @sc{gnu} C compiler,
11159 @value{NGCC}. We pass the @option{-gdwarf-2}@footnote{This is the
11160 minimum. Recent versions of @value{NGCC} support @option{-gdwarf-3}
11161 and @option{-gdwarf-4}; we recommend always choosing the most recent
11162 version of DWARF.} @emph{and} @option{-g3} flags to ensure the compiler
11163 includes information about preprocessor macros in the debugging
11167 $ gcc -gdwarf-2 -g3 sample.c -o sample
11171 Now, we start @value{GDBN} on our sample program:
11175 GNU gdb 2002-05-06-cvs
11176 Copyright 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
11177 GDB is free software, @dots{}
11181 We can expand macros and examine their definitions, even when the
11182 program is not running. @value{GDBN} uses the current listing position
11183 to decide which macro definitions are in scope:
11186 (@value{GDBP}) list main
11189 5 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
11194 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
11196 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
11197 (@value{GDBP}) info macro ADD
11198 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:5
11199 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
11200 (@value{GDBP}) info macro Q
11201 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.h:1
11202 included at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:2
11204 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand ADD(1)
11205 expands to: (42 + 1)
11206 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand-once ADD(1)
11207 expands to: once (M + 1)
11211 In the example above, note that @code{macro expand-once} expands only
11212 the macro invocation explicit in the original text --- the invocation of
11213 @code{ADD} --- but does not expand the invocation of the macro @code{M},
11214 which was introduced by @code{ADD}.
11216 Once the program is running, @value{GDBN} uses the macro definitions in
11217 force at the source line of the current stack frame:
11220 (@value{GDBP}) break main
11221 Breakpoint 1 at 0x8048370: file sample.c, line 10.
11223 Starting program: /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample
11225 Breakpoint 1, main () at sample.c:10
11226 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
11230 At line 10, the definition of the macro @code{N} at line 9 is in force:
11233 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
11234 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:9
11236 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
11237 expands to: 28 < 42
11238 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
11243 As we step over directives that remove @code{N}'s definition, and then
11244 give it a new definition, @value{GDBN} finds the definition (or lack
11245 thereof) in force at each point:
11248 (@value{GDBP}) next
11250 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
11251 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
11252 The symbol `N' has no definition as a C/C++ preprocessor macro
11253 at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:12
11254 (@value{GDBP}) next
11256 14 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
11257 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
11258 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:13
11260 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
11261 expands to: 1729 < 42
11262 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
11267 In addition to source files, macros can be defined on the compilation command
11268 line using the @option{-D@var{name}=@var{value}} syntax. For macros defined in
11269 such a way, @value{GDBN} displays the location of their definition as line zero
11270 of the source file submitted to the compiler.
11273 (@value{GDBP}) info macro __STDC__
11274 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:0
11281 @chapter Tracepoints
11282 @c This chapter is based on the documentation written by Michael
11283 @c Snyder, David Taylor, Jim Blandy, and Elena Zannoni.
11285 @cindex tracepoints
11286 In some applications, it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt
11287 the program's execution long enough for the developer to learn
11288 anything helpful about its behavior. If the program's correctness
11289 depends on its real-time behavior, delays introduced by a debugger
11290 might cause the program to change its behavior drastically, or perhaps
11291 fail, even when the code itself is correct. It is useful to be able
11292 to observe the program's behavior without interrupting it.
11294 Using @value{GDBN}'s @code{trace} and @code{collect} commands, you can
11295 specify locations in the program, called @dfn{tracepoints}, and
11296 arbitrary expressions to evaluate when those tracepoints are reached.
11297 Later, using the @code{tfind} command, you can examine the values
11298 those expressions had when the program hit the tracepoints. The
11299 expressions may also denote objects in memory---structures or arrays,
11300 for example---whose values @value{GDBN} should record; while visiting
11301 a particular tracepoint, you may inspect those objects as if they were
11302 in memory at that moment. However, because @value{GDBN} records these
11303 values without interacting with you, it can do so quickly and
11304 unobtrusively, hopefully not disturbing the program's behavior.
11306 The tracepoint facility is currently available only for remote
11307 targets. @xref{Targets}. In addition, your remote target must know
11308 how to collect trace data. This functionality is implemented in the
11309 remote stub; however, none of the stubs distributed with @value{GDBN}
11310 support tracepoints as of this writing. The format of the remote
11311 packets used to implement tracepoints are described in @ref{Tracepoint
11314 It is also possible to get trace data from a file, in a manner reminiscent
11315 of corefiles; you specify the filename, and use @code{tfind} to search
11316 through the file. @xref{Trace Files}, for more details.
11318 This chapter describes the tracepoint commands and features.
11321 * Set Tracepoints::
11322 * Analyze Collected Data::
11323 * Tracepoint Variables::
11327 @node Set Tracepoints
11328 @section Commands to Set Tracepoints
11330 Before running such a @dfn{trace experiment}, an arbitrary number of
11331 tracepoints can be set. A tracepoint is actually a special type of
11332 breakpoint (@pxref{Set Breaks}), so you can manipulate it using
11333 standard breakpoint commands. For instance, as with breakpoints,
11334 tracepoint numbers are successive integers starting from one, and many
11335 of the commands associated with tracepoints take the tracepoint number
11336 as their argument, to identify which tracepoint to work on.
11338 For each tracepoint, you can specify, in advance, some arbitrary set
11339 of data that you want the target to collect in the trace buffer when
11340 it hits that tracepoint. The collected data can include registers,
11341 local variables, or global data. Later, you can use @value{GDBN}
11342 commands to examine the values these data had at the time the
11343 tracepoint was hit.
11345 Tracepoints do not support every breakpoint feature. Ignore counts on
11346 tracepoints have no effect, and tracepoints cannot run @value{GDBN}
11347 commands when they are hit. Tracepoints may not be thread-specific
11350 @cindex fast tracepoints
11351 Some targets may support @dfn{fast tracepoints}, which are inserted in
11352 a different way (such as with a jump instead of a trap), that is
11353 faster but possibly restricted in where they may be installed.
11355 @cindex static tracepoints
11356 @cindex markers, static tracepoints
11357 @cindex probing markers, static tracepoints
11358 Regular and fast tracepoints are dynamic tracing facilities, meaning
11359 that they can be used to insert tracepoints at (almost) any location
11360 in the target. Some targets may also support controlling @dfn{static
11361 tracepoints} from @value{GDBN}. With static tracing, a set of
11362 instrumentation points, also known as @dfn{markers}, are embedded in
11363 the target program, and can be activated or deactivated by name or
11364 address. These are usually placed at locations which facilitate
11365 investigating what the target is actually doing. @value{GDBN}'s
11366 support for static tracing includes being able to list instrumentation
11367 points, and attach them with @value{GDBN} defined high level
11368 tracepoints that expose the whole range of convenience of
11369 @value{GDBN}'s tracepoints support. Namely, support for collecting
11370 registers values and values of global or local (to the instrumentation
11371 point) variables; tracepoint conditions and trace state variables.
11372 The act of installing a @value{GDBN} static tracepoint on an
11373 instrumentation point, or marker, is referred to as @dfn{probing} a
11374 static tracepoint marker.
11376 @code{gdbserver} supports tracepoints on some target systems.
11377 @xref{Server,,Tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}}.
11379 This section describes commands to set tracepoints and associated
11380 conditions and actions.
11383 * Create and Delete Tracepoints::
11384 * Enable and Disable Tracepoints::
11385 * Tracepoint Passcounts::
11386 * Tracepoint Conditions::
11387 * Trace State Variables::
11388 * Tracepoint Actions::
11389 * Listing Tracepoints::
11390 * Listing Static Tracepoint Markers::
11391 * Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments::
11392 * Tracepoint Restrictions::
11395 @node Create and Delete Tracepoints
11396 @subsection Create and Delete Tracepoints
11399 @cindex set tracepoint
11401 @item trace @var{location}
11402 The @code{trace} command is very similar to the @code{break} command.
11403 Its argument @var{location} can be a source line, a function name, or
11404 an address in the target program. @xref{Specify Location}. The
11405 @code{trace} command defines a tracepoint, which is a point in the
11406 target program where the debugger will briefly stop, collect some
11407 data, and then allow the program to continue. Setting a tracepoint or
11408 changing its actions takes effect immediately if the remote stub
11409 supports the @samp{InstallInTrace} feature (@pxref{install tracepoint
11411 If remote stub doesn't support the @samp{InstallInTrace} feature, all
11412 these changes don't take effect until the next @code{tstart}
11413 command, and once a trace experiment is running, further changes will
11414 not have any effect until the next trace experiment starts. In addition,
11415 @value{GDBN} supports @dfn{pending tracepoints}---tracepoints whose
11416 address is not yet resolved. (This is similar to pending breakpoints.)
11417 Pending tracepoints are not downloaded to the target and not installed
11418 until they are resolved. The resolution of pending tracepoints requires
11419 @value{GDBN} support---when debugging with the remote target, and
11420 @value{GDBN} disconnects from the remote stub (@pxref{disconnected
11421 tracing}), pending tracepoints can not be resolved (and downloaded to
11422 the remote stub) while @value{GDBN} is disconnected.
11424 Here are some examples of using the @code{trace} command:
11427 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo.c:121} // a source file and line number
11429 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace +2} // 2 lines forward
11431 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace my_function} // first source line of function
11433 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *my_function} // EXACT start address of function
11435 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *0x2117c4} // an address
11439 You can abbreviate @code{trace} as @code{tr}.
11441 @item trace @var{location} if @var{cond}
11442 Set a tracepoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
11443 @var{cond} each time the tracepoint is reached, and collect data only
11444 if the value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
11445 @xref{Tracepoint Conditions, ,Tracepoint Conditions}, for more
11446 information on tracepoint conditions.
11448 @item ftrace @var{location} [ if @var{cond} ]
11449 @cindex set fast tracepoint
11450 @cindex fast tracepoints, setting
11452 The @code{ftrace} command sets a fast tracepoint. For targets that
11453 support them, fast tracepoints will use a more efficient but possibly
11454 less general technique to trigger data collection, such as a jump
11455 instruction instead of a trap, or some sort of hardware support. It
11456 may not be possible to create a fast tracepoint at the desired
11457 location, in which case the command will exit with an explanatory
11460 @value{GDBN} handles arguments to @code{ftrace} exactly as for
11463 On 32-bit x86-architecture systems, fast tracepoints normally need to
11464 be placed at an instruction that is 5 bytes or longer, but can be
11465 placed at 4-byte instructions if the low 64K of memory of the target
11466 program is available to install trampolines. Some Unix-type systems,
11467 such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, exclude low addresses from the program's
11468 address space; but for instance with the Linux kernel it is possible
11469 to let @value{GDBN} use this area by doing a @command{sysctl} command
11470 to set the @code{mmap_min_addr} kernel parameter, as in
11473 sudo sysctl -w vm.mmap_min_addr=32768
11477 which sets the low address to 32K, which leaves plenty of room for
11478 trampolines. The minimum address should be set to a page boundary.
11480 @item strace @var{location} [ if @var{cond} ]
11481 @cindex set static tracepoint
11482 @cindex static tracepoints, setting
11483 @cindex probe static tracepoint marker
11485 The @code{strace} command sets a static tracepoint. For targets that
11486 support it, setting a static tracepoint probes a static
11487 instrumentation point, or marker, found at @var{location}. It may not
11488 be possible to set a static tracepoint at the desired location, in
11489 which case the command will exit with an explanatory message.
11491 @value{GDBN} handles arguments to @code{strace} exactly as for
11492 @code{trace}, with the addition that the user can also specify
11493 @code{-m @var{marker}} as @var{location}. This probes the marker
11494 identified by the @var{marker} string identifier. This identifier
11495 depends on the static tracepoint backend library your program is
11496 using. You can find all the marker identifiers in the @samp{ID} field
11497 of the @code{info static-tracepoint-markers} command output.
11498 @xref{Listing Static Tracepoint Markers,,Listing Static Tracepoint
11499 Markers}. For example, in the following small program using the UST
11505 trace_mark(ust, bar33, "str %s", "FOOBAZ");
11510 the marker id is composed of joining the first two arguments to the
11511 @code{trace_mark} call with a slash, which translates to:
11514 (@value{GDBP}) info static-tracepoint-markers
11515 Cnt Enb ID Address What
11516 1 n ust/bar33 0x0000000000400ddc in main at stexample.c:22
11522 so you may probe the marker above with:
11525 (@value{GDBP}) strace -m ust/bar33
11528 Static tracepoints accept an extra collect action --- @code{collect
11529 $_sdata}. This collects arbitrary user data passed in the probe point
11530 call to the tracing library. In the UST example above, you'll see
11531 that the third argument to @code{trace_mark} is a printf-like format
11532 string. The user data is then the result of running that formating
11533 string against the following arguments. Note that @code{info
11534 static-tracepoint-markers} command output lists that format string in
11535 the @samp{Data:} field.
11537 You can inspect this data when analyzing the trace buffer, by printing
11538 the $_sdata variable like any other variable available to
11539 @value{GDBN}. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}.
11542 @cindex last tracepoint number
11543 @cindex recent tracepoint number
11544 @cindex tracepoint number
11545 The convenience variable @code{$tpnum} records the tracepoint number
11546 of the most recently set tracepoint.
11548 @kindex delete tracepoint
11549 @cindex tracepoint deletion
11550 @item delete tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
11551 Permanently delete one or more tracepoints. With no argument, the
11552 default is to delete all tracepoints. Note that the regular
11553 @code{delete} command can remove tracepoints also.
11558 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace 1 2 3} // remove three tracepoints
11560 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace} // remove all tracepoints
11564 You can abbreviate this command as @code{del tr}.
11567 @node Enable and Disable Tracepoints
11568 @subsection Enable and Disable Tracepoints
11570 These commands are deprecated; they are equivalent to plain @code{disable} and @code{enable}.
11573 @kindex disable tracepoint
11574 @item disable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
11575 Disable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints if no argument
11576 @var{num} is given. A disabled tracepoint will have no effect during
11577 a trace experiment, but it is not forgotten. You can re-enable
11578 a disabled tracepoint using the @code{enable tracepoint} command.
11579 If the command is issued during a trace experiment and the debug target
11580 has support for disabling tracepoints during a trace experiment, then the
11581 change will be effective immediately. Otherwise, it will be applied to the
11582 next trace experiment.
11584 @kindex enable tracepoint
11585 @item enable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
11586 Enable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints. If this command is
11587 issued during a trace experiment and the debug target supports enabling
11588 tracepoints during a trace experiment, then the enabled tracepoints will
11589 become effective immediately. Otherwise, they will become effective the
11590 next time a trace experiment is run.
11593 @node Tracepoint Passcounts
11594 @subsection Tracepoint Passcounts
11598 @cindex tracepoint pass count
11599 @item passcount @r{[}@var{n} @r{[}@var{num}@r{]]}
11600 Set the @dfn{passcount} of a tracepoint. The passcount is a way to
11601 automatically stop a trace experiment. If a tracepoint's passcount is
11602 @var{n}, then the trace experiment will be automatically stopped on
11603 the @var{n}'th time that tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number
11604 @var{num} is not specified, the @code{passcount} command sets the
11605 passcount of the most recently defined tracepoint. If no passcount is
11606 given, the trace experiment will run until stopped explicitly by the
11612 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 5 2} // Stop on the 5th execution of
11613 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// tracepoint 2}
11615 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 12} // Stop on the 12th execution of the
11616 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// most recently defined tracepoint.}
11617 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
11618 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 3}
11619 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace bar}
11620 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 2}
11621 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace baz}
11622 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 1} // Stop tracing when foo has been
11623 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// executed 3 times OR when bar has}
11624 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// been executed 2 times}
11625 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// OR when baz has been executed 1 time.}
11629 @node Tracepoint Conditions
11630 @subsection Tracepoint Conditions
11631 @cindex conditional tracepoints
11632 @cindex tracepoint conditions
11634 The simplest sort of tracepoint collects data every time your program
11635 reaches a specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for
11636 a tracepoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
11637 programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A
11638 tracepoint with a condition evaluates the expression each time your
11639 program reaches it, and data collection happens only if the condition
11642 Tracepoint conditions can be specified when a tracepoint is set, by
11643 using @samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{trace} command.
11644 @xref{Create and Delete Tracepoints, ,Setting Tracepoints}. They can
11645 also be set or changed at any time with the @code{condition} command,
11646 just as with breakpoints.
11648 Unlike breakpoint conditions, @value{GDBN} does not actually evaluate
11649 the conditional expression itself. Instead, @value{GDBN} encodes the
11650 expression into an agent expression (@pxref{Agent Expressions})
11651 suitable for execution on the target, independently of @value{GDBN}.
11652 Global variables become raw memory locations, locals become stack
11653 accesses, and so forth.
11655 For instance, suppose you have a function that is usually called
11656 frequently, but should not be called after an error has occurred. You
11657 could use the following tracepoint command to collect data about calls
11658 of that function that happen while the error code is propagating
11659 through the program; an unconditional tracepoint could end up
11660 collecting thousands of useless trace frames that you would have to
11664 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{trace normal_operation if errcode > 0}
11667 @node Trace State Variables
11668 @subsection Trace State Variables
11669 @cindex trace state variables
11671 A @dfn{trace state variable} is a special type of variable that is
11672 created and managed by target-side code. The syntax is the same as
11673 that for GDB's convenience variables (a string prefixed with ``$''),
11674 but they are stored on the target. They must be created explicitly,
11675 using a @code{tvariable} command. They are always 64-bit signed
11678 Trace state variables are remembered by @value{GDBN}, and downloaded
11679 to the target along with tracepoint information when the trace
11680 experiment starts. There are no intrinsic limits on the number of
11681 trace state variables, beyond memory limitations of the target.
11683 @cindex convenience variables, and trace state variables
11684 Although trace state variables are managed by the target, you can use
11685 them in print commands and expressions as if they were convenience
11686 variables; @value{GDBN} will get the current value from the target
11687 while the trace experiment is running. Trace state variables share
11688 the same namespace as other ``$'' variables, which means that you
11689 cannot have trace state variables with names like @code{$23} or
11690 @code{$pc}, nor can you have a trace state variable and a convenience
11691 variable with the same name.
11695 @item tvariable $@var{name} [ = @var{expression} ]
11697 The @code{tvariable} command creates a new trace state variable named
11698 @code{$@var{name}}, and optionally gives it an initial value of
11699 @var{expression}. @var{expression} is evaluated when this command is
11700 entered; the result will be converted to an integer if possible,
11701 otherwise @value{GDBN} will report an error. A subsequent
11702 @code{tvariable} command specifying the same name does not create a
11703 variable, but instead assigns the supplied initial value to the
11704 existing variable of that name, overwriting any previous initial
11705 value. The default initial value is 0.
11707 @item info tvariables
11708 @kindex info tvariables
11709 List all the trace state variables along with their initial values.
11710 Their current values may also be displayed, if the trace experiment is
11713 @item delete tvariable @r{[} $@var{name} @dots{} @r{]}
11714 @kindex delete tvariable
11715 Delete the given trace state variables, or all of them if no arguments
11720 @node Tracepoint Actions
11721 @subsection Tracepoint Action Lists
11725 @cindex tracepoint actions
11726 @item actions @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
11727 This command will prompt for a list of actions to be taken when the
11728 tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number @var{num} is not
11729 specified, this command sets the actions for the one that was most
11730 recently defined (so that you can define a tracepoint and then say
11731 @code{actions} without bothering about its number). You specify the
11732 actions themselves on the following lines, one action at a time, and
11733 terminate the actions list with a line containing just @code{end}. So
11734 far, the only defined actions are @code{collect}, @code{teval}, and
11735 @code{while-stepping}.
11737 @code{actions} is actually equivalent to @code{commands} (@pxref{Break
11738 Commands, ,Breakpoint Command Lists}), except that only the defined
11739 actions are allowed; any other @value{GDBN} command is rejected.
11741 @cindex remove actions from a tracepoint
11742 To remove all actions from a tracepoint, type @samp{actions @var{num}}
11743 and follow it immediately with @samp{end}.
11746 (@value{GDBP}) @b{collect @var{data}} // collect some data
11748 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while-stepping 5} // single-step 5 times, collect data
11750 (@value{GDBP}) @b{end} // signals the end of actions.
11753 In the following example, the action list begins with @code{collect}
11754 commands indicating the things to be collected when the tracepoint is
11755 hit. Then, in order to single-step and collect additional data
11756 following the tracepoint, a @code{while-stepping} command is used,
11757 followed by the list of things to be collected after each step in a
11758 sequence of single steps. The @code{while-stepping} command is
11759 terminated by its own separate @code{end} command. Lastly, the action
11760 list is terminated by an @code{end} command.
11763 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
11764 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
11765 Enter actions for tracepoint 1, one per line:
11768 > while-stepping 12
11769 > collect $pc, arr[i]
11774 @kindex collect @r{(tracepoints)}
11775 @item collect@r{[}/@var{mods}@r{]} @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
11776 Collect values of the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit.
11777 This command accepts a comma-separated list of any valid expressions.
11778 In addition to global, static, or local variables, the following
11779 special arguments are supported:
11783 Collect all registers.
11786 Collect all function arguments.
11789 Collect all local variables.
11792 Collect the return address. This is helpful if you want to see more
11796 Collects the number of arguments from the static probe at which the
11797 tracepoint is located.
11798 @xref{Static Probe Points}.
11800 @item $_probe_arg@var{n}
11801 @var{n} is an integer between 0 and 11. Collects the @var{n}th argument
11802 from the static probe at which the tracepoint is located.
11803 @xref{Static Probe Points}.
11806 @vindex $_sdata@r{, collect}
11807 Collect static tracepoint marker specific data. Only available for
11808 static tracepoints. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action
11809 Lists}. On the UST static tracepoints library backend, an
11810 instrumentation point resembles a @code{printf} function call. The
11811 tracing library is able to collect user specified data formatted to a
11812 character string using the format provided by the programmer that
11813 instrumented the program. Other backends have similar mechanisms.
11814 Here's an example of a UST marker call:
11817 const char master_name[] = "$your_name";
11818 trace_mark(channel1, marker1, "hello %s", master_name)
11821 In this case, collecting @code{$_sdata} collects the string
11822 @samp{hello $yourname}. When analyzing the trace buffer, you can
11823 inspect @samp{$_sdata} like any other variable available to
11827 You can give several consecutive @code{collect} commands, each one
11828 with a single argument, or one @code{collect} command with several
11829 arguments separated by commas; the effect is the same.
11831 The optional @var{mods} changes the usual handling of the arguments.
11832 @code{s} requests that pointers to chars be handled as strings, in
11833 particular collecting the contents of the memory being pointed at, up
11834 to the first zero. The upper bound is by default the value of the
11835 @code{print elements} variable; if @code{s} is followed by a decimal
11836 number, that is the upper bound instead. So for instance
11837 @samp{collect/s25 mystr} collects as many as 25 characters at
11840 The command @code{info scope} (@pxref{Symbols, info scope}) is
11841 particularly useful for figuring out what data to collect.
11843 @kindex teval @r{(tracepoints)}
11844 @item teval @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
11845 Evaluate the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit. This
11846 command accepts a comma-separated list of expressions. The results
11847 are discarded, so this is mainly useful for assigning values to trace
11848 state variables (@pxref{Trace State Variables}) without adding those
11849 values to the trace buffer, as would be the case if the @code{collect}
11852 @kindex while-stepping @r{(tracepoints)}
11853 @item while-stepping @var{n}
11854 Perform @var{n} single-step instruction traces after the tracepoint,
11855 collecting new data after each step. The @code{while-stepping}
11856 command is followed by the list of what to collect while stepping
11857 (followed by its own @code{end} command):
11860 > while-stepping 12
11861 > collect $regs, myglobal
11867 Note that @code{$pc} is not automatically collected by
11868 @code{while-stepping}; you need to explicitly collect that register if
11869 you need it. You may abbreviate @code{while-stepping} as @code{ws} or
11872 @item set default-collect @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
11873 @kindex set default-collect
11874 @cindex default collection action
11875 This variable is a list of expressions to collect at each tracepoint
11876 hit. It is effectively an additional @code{collect} action prepended
11877 to every tracepoint action list. The expressions are parsed
11878 individually for each tracepoint, so for instance a variable named
11879 @code{xyz} may be interpreted as a global for one tracepoint, and a
11880 local for another, as appropriate to the tracepoint's location.
11882 @item show default-collect
11883 @kindex show default-collect
11884 Show the list of expressions that are collected by default at each
11889 @node Listing Tracepoints
11890 @subsection Listing Tracepoints
11893 @kindex info tracepoints @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
11894 @kindex info tp @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
11895 @cindex information about tracepoints
11896 @item info tracepoints @r{[}@var{num}@dots{}@r{]}
11897 Display information about the tracepoint @var{num}. If you don't
11898 specify a tracepoint number, displays information about all the
11899 tracepoints defined so far. The format is similar to that used for
11900 @code{info breakpoints}; in fact, @code{info tracepoints} is the same
11901 command, simply restricting itself to tracepoints.
11903 A tracepoint's listing may include additional information specific to
11908 its passcount as given by the @code{passcount @var{n}} command
11911 the state about installed on target of each location
11915 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info trace}
11916 Num Type Disp Enb Address What
11917 1 tracepoint keep y 0x0804ab57 in foo() at main.cxx:7
11919 collect globfoo, $regs
11924 2 tracepoint keep y <MULTIPLE>
11926 2.1 y 0x0804859c in func4 at change-loc.h:35
11927 installed on target
11928 2.2 y 0xb7ffc480 in func4 at change-loc.h:35
11929 installed on target
11930 2.3 y <PENDING> set_tracepoint
11931 3 tracepoint keep y 0x080485b1 in foo at change-loc.c:29
11932 not installed on target
11937 This command can be abbreviated @code{info tp}.
11940 @node Listing Static Tracepoint Markers
11941 @subsection Listing Static Tracepoint Markers
11944 @kindex info static-tracepoint-markers
11945 @cindex information about static tracepoint markers
11946 @item info static-tracepoint-markers
11947 Display information about all static tracepoint markers defined in the
11950 For each marker, the following columns are printed:
11954 An incrementing counter, output to help readability. This is not a
11957 The marker ID, as reported by the target.
11958 @item Enabled or Disabled
11959 Probed markers are tagged with @samp{y}. @samp{n} identifies marks
11960 that are not enabled.
11962 Where the marker is in your program, as a memory address.
11964 Where the marker is in the source for your program, as a file and line
11965 number. If the debug information included in the program does not
11966 allow @value{GDBN} to locate the source of the marker, this column
11967 will be left blank.
11971 In addition, the following information may be printed for each marker:
11975 User data passed to the tracing library by the marker call. In the
11976 UST backend, this is the format string passed as argument to the
11978 @item Static tracepoints probing the marker
11979 The list of static tracepoints attached to the marker.
11983 (@value{GDBP}) info static-tracepoint-markers
11984 Cnt ID Enb Address What
11985 1 ust/bar2 y 0x0000000000400e1a in main at stexample.c:25
11986 Data: number1 %d number2 %d
11987 Probed by static tracepoints: #2
11988 2 ust/bar33 n 0x0000000000400c87 in main at stexample.c:24
11994 @node Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
11995 @subsection Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
11998 @kindex tstart [ @var{notes} ]
11999 @cindex start a new trace experiment
12000 @cindex collected data discarded
12002 This command starts the trace experiment, and begins collecting data.
12003 It has the side effect of discarding all the data collected in the
12004 trace buffer during the previous trace experiment. If any arguments
12005 are supplied, they are taken as a note and stored with the trace
12006 experiment's state. The notes may be arbitrary text, and are
12007 especially useful with disconnected tracing in a multi-user context;
12008 the notes can explain what the trace is doing, supply user contact
12009 information, and so forth.
12011 @kindex tstop [ @var{notes} ]
12012 @cindex stop a running trace experiment
12014 This command stops the trace experiment. If any arguments are
12015 supplied, they are recorded with the experiment as a note. This is
12016 useful if you are stopping a trace started by someone else, for
12017 instance if the trace is interfering with the system's behavior and
12018 needs to be stopped quickly.
12020 @strong{Note}: a trace experiment and data collection may stop
12021 automatically if any tracepoint's passcount is reached
12022 (@pxref{Tracepoint Passcounts}), or if the trace buffer becomes full.
12025 @cindex status of trace data collection
12026 @cindex trace experiment, status of
12028 This command displays the status of the current trace data
12032 Here is an example of the commands we described so far:
12035 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace gdb_c_test}
12036 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
12037 Enter actions for tracepoint #1, one per line.
12038 > collect $regs,$locals,$args
12039 > while-stepping 11
12043 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
12044 [time passes @dots{}]
12045 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstop}
12048 @anchor{disconnected tracing}
12049 @cindex disconnected tracing
12050 You can choose to continue running the trace experiment even if
12051 @value{GDBN} disconnects from the target, voluntarily or
12052 involuntarily. For commands such as @code{detach}, the debugger will
12053 ask what you want to do with the trace. But for unexpected
12054 terminations (@value{GDBN} crash, network outage), it would be
12055 unfortunate to lose hard-won trace data, so the variable
12056 @code{disconnected-tracing} lets you decide whether the trace should
12057 continue running without @value{GDBN}.
12060 @item set disconnected-tracing on
12061 @itemx set disconnected-tracing off
12062 @kindex set disconnected-tracing
12063 Choose whether a tracing run should continue to run if @value{GDBN}
12064 has disconnected from the target. Note that @code{detach} or
12065 @code{quit} will ask you directly what to do about a running trace no
12066 matter what this variable's setting, so the variable is mainly useful
12067 for handling unexpected situations, such as loss of the network.
12069 @item show disconnected-tracing
12070 @kindex show disconnected-tracing
12071 Show the current choice for disconnected tracing.
12075 When you reconnect to the target, the trace experiment may or may not
12076 still be running; it might have filled the trace buffer in the
12077 meantime, or stopped for one of the other reasons. If it is running,
12078 it will continue after reconnection.
12080 Upon reconnection, the target will upload information about the
12081 tracepoints in effect. @value{GDBN} will then compare that
12082 information to the set of tracepoints currently defined, and attempt
12083 to match them up, allowing for the possibility that the numbers may
12084 have changed due to creation and deletion in the meantime. If one of
12085 the target's tracepoints does not match any in @value{GDBN}, the
12086 debugger will create a new tracepoint, so that you have a number with
12087 which to specify that tracepoint. This matching-up process is
12088 necessarily heuristic, and it may result in useless tracepoints being
12089 created; you may simply delete them if they are of no use.
12091 @cindex circular trace buffer
12092 If your target agent supports a @dfn{circular trace buffer}, then you
12093 can run a trace experiment indefinitely without filling the trace
12094 buffer; when space runs out, the agent deletes already-collected trace
12095 frames, oldest first, until there is enough room to continue
12096 collecting. This is especially useful if your tracepoints are being
12097 hit too often, and your trace gets terminated prematurely because the
12098 buffer is full. To ask for a circular trace buffer, simply set
12099 @samp{circular-trace-buffer} to on. You can set this at any time,
12100 including during tracing; if the agent can do it, it will change
12101 buffer handling on the fly, otherwise it will not take effect until
12105 @item set circular-trace-buffer on
12106 @itemx set circular-trace-buffer off
12107 @kindex set circular-trace-buffer
12108 Choose whether a tracing run should use a linear or circular buffer
12109 for trace data. A linear buffer will not lose any trace data, but may
12110 fill up prematurely, while a circular buffer will discard old trace
12111 data, but it will have always room for the latest tracepoint hits.
12113 @item show circular-trace-buffer
12114 @kindex show circular-trace-buffer
12115 Show the current choice for the trace buffer. Note that this may not
12116 match the agent's current buffer handling, nor is it guaranteed to
12117 match the setting that might have been in effect during a past run,
12118 for instance if you are looking at frames from a trace file.
12123 @item set trace-buffer-size @var{n}
12124 @itemx set trace-buffer-size unlimited
12125 @kindex set trace-buffer-size
12126 Request that the target use a trace buffer of @var{n} bytes. Not all
12127 targets will honor the request; they may have a compiled-in size for
12128 the trace buffer, or some other limitation. Set to a value of
12129 @code{unlimited} or @code{-1} to let the target use whatever size it
12130 likes. This is also the default.
12132 @item show trace-buffer-size
12133 @kindex show trace-buffer-size
12134 Show the current requested size for the trace buffer. Note that this
12135 will only match the actual size if the target supports size-setting,
12136 and was able to handle the requested size. For instance, if the
12137 target can only change buffer size between runs, this variable will
12138 not reflect the change until the next run starts. Use @code{tstatus}
12139 to get a report of the actual buffer size.
12143 @item set trace-user @var{text}
12144 @kindex set trace-user
12146 @item show trace-user
12147 @kindex show trace-user
12149 @item set trace-notes @var{text}
12150 @kindex set trace-notes
12151 Set the trace run's notes.
12153 @item show trace-notes
12154 @kindex show trace-notes
12155 Show the trace run's notes.
12157 @item set trace-stop-notes @var{text}
12158 @kindex set trace-stop-notes
12159 Set the trace run's stop notes. The handling of the note is as for
12160 @code{tstop} arguments; the set command is convenient way to fix a
12161 stop note that is mistaken or incomplete.
12163 @item show trace-stop-notes
12164 @kindex show trace-stop-notes
12165 Show the trace run's stop notes.
12169 @node Tracepoint Restrictions
12170 @subsection Tracepoint Restrictions
12172 @cindex tracepoint restrictions
12173 There are a number of restrictions on the use of tracepoints. As
12174 described above, tracepoint data gathering occurs on the target
12175 without interaction from @value{GDBN}. Thus the full capabilities of
12176 the debugger are not available during data gathering, and then at data
12177 examination time, you will be limited by only having what was
12178 collected. The following items describe some common problems, but it
12179 is not exhaustive, and you may run into additional difficulties not
12185 Tracepoint expressions are intended to gather objects (lvalues). Thus
12186 the full flexibility of GDB's expression evaluator is not available.
12187 You cannot call functions, cast objects to aggregate types, access
12188 convenience variables or modify values (except by assignment to trace
12189 state variables). Some language features may implicitly call
12190 functions (for instance Objective-C fields with accessors), and therefore
12191 cannot be collected either.
12194 Collection of local variables, either individually or in bulk with
12195 @code{$locals} or @code{$args}, during @code{while-stepping} may
12196 behave erratically. The stepping action may enter a new scope (for
12197 instance by stepping into a function), or the location of the variable
12198 may change (for instance it is loaded into a register). The
12199 tracepoint data recorded uses the location information for the
12200 variables that is correct for the tracepoint location. When the
12201 tracepoint is created, it is not possible, in general, to determine
12202 where the steps of a @code{while-stepping} sequence will advance the
12203 program---particularly if a conditional branch is stepped.
12206 Collection of an incompletely-initialized or partially-destroyed object
12207 may result in something that @value{GDBN} cannot display, or displays
12208 in a misleading way.
12211 When @value{GDBN} displays a pointer to character it automatically
12212 dereferences the pointer to also display characters of the string
12213 being pointed to. However, collecting the pointer during tracing does
12214 not automatically collect the string. You need to explicitly
12215 dereference the pointer and provide size information if you want to
12216 collect not only the pointer, but the memory pointed to. For example,
12217 @code{*ptr@@50} can be used to collect the 50 element array pointed to
12221 It is not possible to collect a complete stack backtrace at a
12222 tracepoint. Instead, you may collect the registers and a few hundred
12223 bytes from the stack pointer with something like @code{*(unsigned char *)$esp@@300}
12224 (adjust to use the name of the actual stack pointer register on your
12225 target architecture, and the amount of stack you wish to capture).
12226 Then the @code{backtrace} command will show a partial backtrace when
12227 using a trace frame. The number of stack frames that can be examined
12228 depends on the sizes of the frames in the collected stack. Note that
12229 if you ask for a block so large that it goes past the bottom of the
12230 stack, the target agent may report an error trying to read from an
12234 If you do not collect registers at a tracepoint, @value{GDBN} can
12235 infer that the value of @code{$pc} must be the same as the address of
12236 the tracepoint and use that when you are looking at a trace frame
12237 for that tracepoint. However, this cannot work if the tracepoint has
12238 multiple locations (for instance if it was set in a function that was
12239 inlined), or if it has a @code{while-stepping} loop. In those cases
12240 @value{GDBN} will warn you that it can't infer @code{$pc}, and default
12245 @node Analyze Collected Data
12246 @section Using the Collected Data
12248 After the tracepoint experiment ends, you use @value{GDBN} commands
12249 for examining the trace data. The basic idea is that each tracepoint
12250 collects a trace @dfn{snapshot} every time it is hit and another
12251 snapshot every time it single-steps. All these snapshots are
12252 consecutively numbered from zero and go into a buffer, and you can
12253 examine them later. The way you examine them is to @dfn{focus} on a
12254 specific trace snapshot. When the remote stub is focused on a trace
12255 snapshot, it will respond to all @value{GDBN} requests for memory and
12256 registers by reading from the buffer which belongs to that snapshot,
12257 rather than from @emph{real} memory or registers of the program being
12258 debugged. This means that @strong{all} @value{GDBN} commands
12259 (@code{print}, @code{info registers}, @code{backtrace}, etc.) will
12260 behave as if we were currently debugging the program state as it was
12261 when the tracepoint occurred. Any requests for data that are not in
12262 the buffer will fail.
12265 * tfind:: How to select a trace snapshot
12266 * tdump:: How to display all data for a snapshot
12267 * save tracepoints:: How to save tracepoints for a future run
12271 @subsection @code{tfind @var{n}}
12274 @cindex select trace snapshot
12275 @cindex find trace snapshot
12276 The basic command for selecting a trace snapshot from the buffer is
12277 @code{tfind @var{n}}, which finds trace snapshot number @var{n},
12278 counting from zero. If no argument @var{n} is given, the next
12279 snapshot is selected.
12281 Here are the various forms of using the @code{tfind} command.
12285 Find the first snapshot in the buffer. This is a synonym for
12286 @code{tfind 0} (since 0 is the number of the first snapshot).
12289 Stop debugging trace snapshots, resume @emph{live} debugging.
12292 Same as @samp{tfind none}.
12295 No argument means find the next trace snapshot.
12298 Find the previous trace snapshot before the current one. This permits
12299 retracing earlier steps.
12301 @item tfind tracepoint @var{num}
12302 Find the next snapshot associated with tracepoint @var{num}. Search
12303 proceeds forward from the last examined trace snapshot. If no
12304 argument @var{num} is given, it means find the next snapshot collected
12305 for the same tracepoint as the current snapshot.
12307 @item tfind pc @var{addr}
12308 Find the next snapshot associated with the value @var{addr} of the
12309 program counter. Search proceeds forward from the last examined trace
12310 snapshot. If no argument @var{addr} is given, it means find the next
12311 snapshot with the same value of PC as the current snapshot.
12313 @item tfind outside @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
12314 Find the next snapshot whose PC is outside the given range of
12315 addresses (exclusive).
12317 @item tfind range @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
12318 Find the next snapshot whose PC is between @var{addr1} and
12319 @var{addr2} (inclusive).
12321 @item tfind line @r{[}@var{file}:@r{]}@var{n}
12322 Find the next snapshot associated with the source line @var{n}. If
12323 the optional argument @var{file} is given, refer to line @var{n} in
12324 that source file. Search proceeds forward from the last examined
12325 trace snapshot. If no argument @var{n} is given, it means find the
12326 next line other than the one currently being examined; thus saying
12327 @code{tfind line} repeatedly can appear to have the same effect as
12328 stepping from line to line in a @emph{live} debugging session.
12331 The default arguments for the @code{tfind} commands are specifically
12332 designed to make it easy to scan through the trace buffer. For
12333 instance, @code{tfind} with no argument selects the next trace
12334 snapshot, and @code{tfind -} with no argument selects the previous
12335 trace snapshot. So, by giving one @code{tfind} command, and then
12336 simply hitting @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine all the trace
12337 snapshots in order. Or, by saying @code{tfind -} and then hitting
12338 @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine the snapshots in reverse order.
12339 The @code{tfind line} command with no argument selects the snapshot
12340 for the next source line executed. The @code{tfind pc} command with
12341 no argument selects the next snapshot with the same program counter
12342 (PC) as the current frame. The @code{tfind tracepoint} command with
12343 no argument selects the next trace snapshot collected by the same
12344 tracepoint as the current one.
12346 In addition to letting you scan through the trace buffer manually,
12347 these commands make it easy to construct @value{GDBN} scripts that
12348 scan through the trace buffer and print out whatever collected data
12349 you are interested in. Thus, if we want to examine the PC, FP, and SP
12350 registers from each trace frame in the buffer, we can say this:
12353 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
12354 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
12355 > printf "Frame %d, PC = %08X, SP = %08X, FP = %08X\n", \
12356 $trace_frame, $pc, $sp, $fp
12360 Frame 0, PC = 0020DC64, SP = 0030BF3C, FP = 0030BF44
12361 Frame 1, PC = 0020DC6C, SP = 0030BF38, FP = 0030BF44
12362 Frame 2, PC = 0020DC70, SP = 0030BF34, FP = 0030BF44
12363 Frame 3, PC = 0020DC74, SP = 0030BF30, FP = 0030BF44
12364 Frame 4, PC = 0020DC78, SP = 0030BF2C, FP = 0030BF44
12365 Frame 5, PC = 0020DC7C, SP = 0030BF28, FP = 0030BF44
12366 Frame 6, PC = 0020DC80, SP = 0030BF24, FP = 0030BF44
12367 Frame 7, PC = 0020DC84, SP = 0030BF20, FP = 0030BF44
12368 Frame 8, PC = 0020DC88, SP = 0030BF1C, FP = 0030BF44
12369 Frame 9, PC = 0020DC8E, SP = 0030BF18, FP = 0030BF44
12370 Frame 10, PC = 00203F6C, SP = 0030BE3C, FP = 0030BF14
12373 Or, if we want to examine the variable @code{X} at each source line in
12377 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
12378 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
12379 > printf "Frame %d, X == %d\n", $trace_frame, X
12389 @subsection @code{tdump}
12391 @cindex dump all data collected at tracepoint
12392 @cindex tracepoint data, display
12394 This command takes no arguments. It prints all the data collected at
12395 the current trace snapshot.
12398 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace 444}
12399 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
12400 Enter actions for tracepoint #2, one per line:
12401 > collect $regs, $locals, $args, gdb_long_test
12404 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
12406 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind line 444}
12407 #0 gdb_test (p1=0x11, p2=0x22, p3=0x33, p4=0x44, p5=0x55, p6=0x66)
12409 444 printp( "%s: arguments = 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X\n", )
12411 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tdump}
12412 Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 1:
12413 d0 0xc4aa0085 -995491707
12417 d4 0x71aea3d 119204413
12420 d7 0x380035 3670069
12421 a0 0x19e24a 1696330
12422 a1 0x3000668 50333288
12424 a3 0x322000 3284992
12425 a4 0x3000698 50333336
12426 a5 0x1ad3cc 1758156
12427 fp 0x30bf3c 0x30bf3c
12428 sp 0x30bf34 0x30bf34
12430 pc 0x20b2c8 0x20b2c8
12434 p = 0x20e5b4 "gdb-test"
12441 gdb_long_test = 17 '\021'
12446 @code{tdump} works by scanning the tracepoint's current collection
12447 actions and printing the value of each expression listed. So
12448 @code{tdump} can fail, if after a run, you change the tracepoint's
12449 actions to mention variables that were not collected during the run.
12451 Also, for tracepoints with @code{while-stepping} loops, @code{tdump}
12452 uses the collected value of @code{$pc} to distinguish between trace
12453 frames that were collected at the tracepoint hit, and frames that were
12454 collected while stepping. This allows it to correctly choose whether
12455 to display the basic list of collections, or the collections from the
12456 body of the while-stepping loop. However, if @code{$pc} was not collected,
12457 then @code{tdump} will always attempt to dump using the basic collection
12458 list, and may fail if a while-stepping frame does not include all the
12459 same data that is collected at the tracepoint hit.
12460 @c This is getting pretty arcane, example would be good.
12462 @node save tracepoints
12463 @subsection @code{save tracepoints @var{filename}}
12464 @kindex save tracepoints
12465 @kindex save-tracepoints
12466 @cindex save tracepoints for future sessions
12468 This command saves all current tracepoint definitions together with
12469 their actions and passcounts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
12470 suitable for use in a later debugging session. To read the saved
12471 tracepoint definitions, use the @code{source} command (@pxref{Command
12472 Files}). The @w{@code{save-tracepoints}} command is a deprecated
12473 alias for @w{@code{save tracepoints}}
12475 @node Tracepoint Variables
12476 @section Convenience Variables for Tracepoints
12477 @cindex tracepoint variables
12478 @cindex convenience variables for tracepoints
12481 @vindex $trace_frame
12482 @item (int) $trace_frame
12483 The current trace snapshot (a.k.a.@: @dfn{frame}) number, or -1 if no
12484 snapshot is selected.
12486 @vindex $tracepoint
12487 @item (int) $tracepoint
12488 The tracepoint for the current trace snapshot.
12490 @vindex $trace_line
12491 @item (int) $trace_line
12492 The line number for the current trace snapshot.
12494 @vindex $trace_file
12495 @item (char []) $trace_file
12496 The source file for the current trace snapshot.
12498 @vindex $trace_func
12499 @item (char []) $trace_func
12500 The name of the function containing @code{$tracepoint}.
12503 Note: @code{$trace_file} is not suitable for use in @code{printf},
12504 use @code{output} instead.
12506 Here's a simple example of using these convenience variables for
12507 stepping through all the trace snapshots and printing some of their
12508 data. Note that these are not the same as trace state variables,
12509 which are managed by the target.
12512 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
12514 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while $trace_frame != -1}
12515 > output $trace_file
12516 > printf ", line %d (tracepoint #%d)\n", $trace_line, $tracepoint
12522 @section Using Trace Files
12523 @cindex trace files
12525 In some situations, the target running a trace experiment may no
12526 longer be available; perhaps it crashed, or the hardware was needed
12527 for a different activity. To handle these cases, you can arrange to
12528 dump the trace data into a file, and later use that file as a source
12529 of trace data, via the @code{target tfile} command.
12534 @item tsave [ -r ] @var{filename}
12535 @itemx tsave [-ctf] @var{dirname}
12536 Save the trace data to @var{filename}. By default, this command
12537 assumes that @var{filename} refers to the host filesystem, so if
12538 necessary @value{GDBN} will copy raw trace data up from the target and
12539 then save it. If the target supports it, you can also supply the
12540 optional argument @code{-r} (``remote'') to direct the target to save
12541 the data directly into @var{filename} in its own filesystem, which may be
12542 more efficient if the trace buffer is very large. (Note, however, that
12543 @code{target tfile} can only read from files accessible to the host.)
12544 By default, this command will save trace frame in tfile format.
12545 You can supply the optional argument @code{-ctf} to save date in CTF
12546 format. The @dfn{Common Trace Format} (CTF) is proposed as a trace format
12547 that can be shared by multiple debugging and tracing tools. Please go to
12548 @indicateurl{http://www.efficios.com/ctf} to get more information.
12550 @kindex target tfile
12554 @item target tfile @var{filename}
12555 @itemx target ctf @var{dirname}
12556 Use the file named @var{filename} or directory named @var{dirname} as
12557 a source of trace data. Commands that examine data work as they do with
12558 a live target, but it is not possible to run any new trace experiments.
12559 @code{tstatus} will report the state of the trace run at the moment
12560 the data was saved, as well as the current trace frame you are examining.
12561 @var{filename} or @var{dirname} must be on a filesystem accessible to
12565 (@value{GDBP}) target ctf ctf.ctf
12566 (@value{GDBP}) tfind
12567 Found trace frame 0, tracepoint 2
12568 39 ++a; /* set tracepoint 1 here */
12569 (@value{GDBP}) tdump
12570 Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 0:
12574 c = @{"123", "456", "789", "123", "456", "789"@}
12575 d = @{@{@{a = 1, b = 2@}, @{a = 3, b = 4@}@}, @{@{a = 5, b = 6@}, @{a = 7, b = 8@}@}@}
12583 @chapter Debugging Programs That Use Overlays
12586 If your program is too large to fit completely in your target system's
12587 memory, you can sometimes use @dfn{overlays} to work around this
12588 problem. @value{GDBN} provides some support for debugging programs that
12592 * How Overlays Work:: A general explanation of overlays.
12593 * Overlay Commands:: Managing overlays in @value{GDBN}.
12594 * Automatic Overlay Debugging:: @value{GDBN} can find out which overlays are
12595 mapped by asking the inferior.
12596 * Overlay Sample Program:: A sample program using overlays.
12599 @node How Overlays Work
12600 @section How Overlays Work
12601 @cindex mapped overlays
12602 @cindex unmapped overlays
12603 @cindex load address, overlay's
12604 @cindex mapped address
12605 @cindex overlay area
12607 Suppose you have a computer whose instruction address space is only 64
12608 kilobytes long, but which has much more memory which can be accessed by
12609 other means: special instructions, segment registers, or memory
12610 management hardware, for example. Suppose further that you want to
12611 adapt a program which is larger than 64 kilobytes to run on this system.
12613 One solution is to identify modules of your program which are relatively
12614 independent, and need not call each other directly; call these modules
12615 @dfn{overlays}. Separate the overlays from the main program, and place
12616 their machine code in the larger memory. Place your main program in
12617 instruction memory, but leave at least enough space there to hold the
12618 largest overlay as well.
12620 Now, to call a function located in an overlay, you must first copy that
12621 overlay's machine code from the large memory into the space set aside
12622 for it in the instruction memory, and then jump to its entry point
12625 @c NB: In the below the mapped area's size is greater or equal to the
12626 @c size of all overlays. This is intentional to remind the developer
12627 @c that overlays don't necessarily need to be the same size.
12631 Data Instruction Larger
12632 Address Space Address Space Address Space
12633 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+
12635 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+<-- overlay 1
12636 | program | | main | .----| overlay 1 | load address
12637 | variables | | program | | +-----------+
12638 | and heap | | | | | |
12639 +-----------+ | | | +-----------+<-- overlay 2
12640 | | +-----------+ | | | load address
12641 +-----------+ | | | .-| overlay 2 |
12643 mapped --->+-----------+ | | +-----------+
12644 address | | | | | |
12645 | overlay | <-' | | |
12646 | area | <---' +-----------+<-- overlay 3
12647 | | <---. | | load address
12648 +-----------+ `--| overlay 3 |
12655 @anchor{A code overlay}A code overlay
12659 The diagram (@pxref{A code overlay}) shows a system with separate data
12660 and instruction address spaces. To map an overlay, the program copies
12661 its code from the larger address space to the instruction address space.
12662 Since the overlays shown here all use the same mapped address, only one
12663 may be mapped at a time. For a system with a single address space for
12664 data and instructions, the diagram would be similar, except that the
12665 program variables and heap would share an address space with the main
12666 program and the overlay area.
12668 An overlay loaded into instruction memory and ready for use is called a
12669 @dfn{mapped} overlay; its @dfn{mapped address} is its address in the
12670 instruction memory. An overlay not present (or only partially present)
12671 in instruction memory is called @dfn{unmapped}; its @dfn{load address}
12672 is its address in the larger memory. The mapped address is also called
12673 the @dfn{virtual memory address}, or @dfn{VMA}; the load address is also
12674 called the @dfn{load memory address}, or @dfn{LMA}.
12676 Unfortunately, overlays are not a completely transparent way to adapt a
12677 program to limited instruction memory. They introduce a new set of
12678 global constraints you must keep in mind as you design your program:
12683 Before calling or returning to a function in an overlay, your program
12684 must make sure that overlay is actually mapped. Otherwise, the call or
12685 return will transfer control to the right address, but in the wrong
12686 overlay, and your program will probably crash.
12689 If the process of mapping an overlay is expensive on your system, you
12690 will need to choose your overlays carefully to minimize their effect on
12691 your program's performance.
12694 The executable file you load onto your system must contain each
12695 overlay's instructions, appearing at the overlay's load address, not its
12696 mapped address. However, each overlay's instructions must be relocated
12697 and its symbols defined as if the overlay were at its mapped address.
12698 You can use GNU linker scripts to specify different load and relocation
12699 addresses for pieces of your program; see @ref{Overlay Description,,,
12700 ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}.
12703 The procedure for loading executable files onto your system must be able
12704 to load their contents into the larger address space as well as the
12705 instruction and data spaces.
12709 The overlay system described above is rather simple, and could be
12710 improved in many ways:
12715 If your system has suitable bank switch registers or memory management
12716 hardware, you could use those facilities to make an overlay's load area
12717 contents simply appear at their mapped address in instruction space.
12718 This would probably be faster than copying the overlay to its mapped
12719 area in the usual way.
12722 If your overlays are small enough, you could set aside more than one
12723 overlay area, and have more than one overlay mapped at a time.
12726 You can use overlays to manage data, as well as instructions. In
12727 general, data overlays are even less transparent to your design than
12728 code overlays: whereas code overlays only require care when you call or
12729 return to functions, data overlays require care every time you access
12730 the data. Also, if you change the contents of a data overlay, you
12731 must copy its contents back out to its load address before you can copy a
12732 different data overlay into the same mapped area.
12737 @node Overlay Commands
12738 @section Overlay Commands
12740 To use @value{GDBN}'s overlay support, each overlay in your program must
12741 correspond to a separate section of the executable file. The section's
12742 virtual memory address and load memory address must be the overlay's
12743 mapped and load addresses. Identifying overlays with sections allows
12744 @value{GDBN} to determine the appropriate address of a function or
12745 variable, depending on whether the overlay is mapped or not.
12747 @value{GDBN}'s overlay commands all start with the word @code{overlay};
12748 you can abbreviate this as @code{ov} or @code{ovly}. The commands are:
12753 Disable @value{GDBN}'s overlay support. When overlay support is
12754 disabled, @value{GDBN} assumes that all functions and variables are
12755 always present at their mapped addresses. By default, @value{GDBN}'s
12756 overlay support is disabled.
12758 @item overlay manual
12759 @cindex manual overlay debugging
12760 Enable @dfn{manual} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
12761 relies on you to tell it which overlays are mapped, and which are not,
12762 using the @code{overlay map-overlay} and @code{overlay unmap-overlay}
12763 commands described below.
12765 @item overlay map-overlay @var{overlay}
12766 @itemx overlay map @var{overlay}
12767 @cindex map an overlay
12768 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is now mapped; @var{overlay} must
12769 be the name of the object file section containing the overlay. When an
12770 overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the overlay's
12771 functions and variables at their mapped addresses. @value{GDBN} assumes
12772 that any other overlays whose mapped ranges overlap that of
12773 @var{overlay} are now unmapped.
12775 @item overlay unmap-overlay @var{overlay}
12776 @itemx overlay unmap @var{overlay}
12777 @cindex unmap an overlay
12778 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is no longer mapped; @var{overlay}
12779 must be the name of the object file section containing the overlay.
12780 When an overlay is unmapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the
12781 overlay's functions and variables at their load addresses.
12784 Enable @dfn{automatic} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
12785 consults a data structure the overlay manager maintains in the inferior
12786 to see which overlays are mapped. For details, see @ref{Automatic
12787 Overlay Debugging}.
12789 @item overlay load-target
12790 @itemx overlay load
12791 @cindex reloading the overlay table
12792 Re-read the overlay table from the inferior. Normally, @value{GDBN}
12793 re-reads the table @value{GDBN} automatically each time the inferior
12794 stops, so this command should only be necessary if you have changed the
12795 overlay mapping yourself using @value{GDBN}. This command is only
12796 useful when using automatic overlay debugging.
12798 @item overlay list-overlays
12799 @itemx overlay list
12800 @cindex listing mapped overlays
12801 Display a list of the overlays currently mapped, along with their mapped
12802 addresses, load addresses, and sizes.
12806 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a code address, it includes the name
12807 of the function the address falls in:
12810 (@value{GDBP}) print main
12811 $3 = @{int ()@} 0x11a0 <main>
12814 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} recognizes code in
12815 unmapped overlays, and prints the names of unmapped functions with
12816 asterisks around them. For example, if @code{foo} is a function in an
12817 unmapped overlay, @value{GDBN} prints it this way:
12820 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
12821 No sections are mapped.
12822 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
12823 $5 = @{int (int)@} 0x100000 <*foo*>
12826 When @code{foo}'s overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} prints the function's
12830 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
12831 Section .ov.foo.text, loaded at 0x100000 - 0x100034,
12832 mapped at 0x1016 - 0x104a
12833 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
12834 $6 = @{int (int)@} 0x1016 <foo>
12837 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} can find the correct
12838 address for functions and variables in an overlay, whether or not the
12839 overlay is mapped. This allows most @value{GDBN} commands, like
12840 @code{break} and @code{disassemble}, to work normally, even on unmapped
12841 code. However, @value{GDBN}'s breakpoint support has some limitations:
12845 @cindex breakpoints in overlays
12846 @cindex overlays, setting breakpoints in
12847 You can set breakpoints in functions in unmapped overlays, as long as
12848 @value{GDBN} can write to the overlay at its load address.
12850 @value{GDBN} can not set hardware or simulator-based breakpoints in
12851 unmapped overlays. However, if you set a breakpoint at the end of your
12852 overlay manager (and tell @value{GDBN} which overlays are now mapped, if
12853 you are using manual overlay management), @value{GDBN} will re-set its
12854 breakpoints properly.
12858 @node Automatic Overlay Debugging
12859 @section Automatic Overlay Debugging
12860 @cindex automatic overlay debugging
12862 @value{GDBN} can automatically track which overlays are mapped and which
12863 are not, given some simple co-operation from the overlay manager in the
12864 inferior. If you enable automatic overlay debugging with the
12865 @code{overlay auto} command (@pxref{Overlay Commands}), @value{GDBN}
12866 looks in the inferior's memory for certain variables describing the
12867 current state of the overlays.
12869 Here are the variables your overlay manager must define to support
12870 @value{GDBN}'s automatic overlay debugging:
12874 @item @code{_ovly_table}:
12875 This variable must be an array of the following structures:
12880 /* The overlay's mapped address. */
12883 /* The size of the overlay, in bytes. */
12884 unsigned long size;
12886 /* The overlay's load address. */
12889 /* Non-zero if the overlay is currently mapped;
12891 unsigned long mapped;
12895 @item @code{_novlys}:
12896 This variable must be a four-byte signed integer, holding the total
12897 number of elements in @code{_ovly_table}.
12901 To decide whether a particular overlay is mapped or not, @value{GDBN}
12902 looks for an entry in @w{@code{_ovly_table}} whose @code{vma} and
12903 @code{lma} members equal the VMA and LMA of the overlay's section in the
12904 executable file. When @value{GDBN} finds a matching entry, it consults
12905 the entry's @code{mapped} member to determine whether the overlay is
12908 In addition, your overlay manager may define a function called
12909 @code{_ovly_debug_event}. If this function is defined, @value{GDBN}
12910 will silently set a breakpoint there. If the overlay manager then
12911 calls this function whenever it has changed the overlay table, this
12912 will enable @value{GDBN} to accurately keep track of which overlays
12913 are in program memory, and update any breakpoints that may be set
12914 in overlays. This will allow breakpoints to work even if the
12915 overlays are kept in ROM or other non-writable memory while they
12916 are not being executed.
12918 @node Overlay Sample Program
12919 @section Overlay Sample Program
12920 @cindex overlay example program
12922 When linking a program which uses overlays, you must place the overlays
12923 at their load addresses, while relocating them to run at their mapped
12924 addresses. To do this, you must write a linker script (@pxref{Overlay
12925 Description,,, ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}). Unfortunately,
12926 since linker scripts are specific to a particular host system, target
12927 architecture, and target memory layout, this manual cannot provide
12928 portable sample code demonstrating @value{GDBN}'s overlay support.
12930 However, the @value{GDBN} source distribution does contain an overlaid
12931 program, with linker scripts for a few systems, as part of its test
12932 suite. The program consists of the following files from
12933 @file{gdb/testsuite/gdb.base}:
12937 The main program file.
12939 A simple overlay manager, used by @file{overlays.c}.
12944 Overlay modules, loaded and used by @file{overlays.c}.
12947 Linker scripts for linking the test program on the @code{d10v-elf}
12948 and @code{m32r-elf} targets.
12951 You can build the test program using the @code{d10v-elf} GCC
12952 cross-compiler like this:
12955 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c overlays.c
12956 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c ovlymgr.c
12957 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c foo.c
12958 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c bar.c
12959 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c baz.c
12960 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c grbx.c
12961 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g overlays.o ovlymgr.o foo.o bar.o \
12962 baz.o grbx.o -Wl,-Td10v.ld -o overlays
12965 The build process is identical for any other architecture, except that
12966 you must substitute the appropriate compiler and linker script for the
12967 target system for @code{d10v-elf-gcc} and @code{d10v.ld}.
12971 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages
12974 Although programming languages generally have common aspects, they are
12975 rarely expressed in the same manner. For instance, in ANSI C,
12976 dereferencing a pointer @code{p} is accomplished by @code{*p}, but in
12977 Modula-2, it is accomplished by @code{p^}. Values can also be
12978 represented (and displayed) differently. Hex numbers in C appear as
12979 @samp{0x1ae}, while in Modula-2 they appear as @samp{1AEH}.
12981 @cindex working language
12982 Language-specific information is built into @value{GDBN} for some languages,
12983 allowing you to express operations like the above in your program's
12984 native language, and allowing @value{GDBN} to output values in a manner
12985 consistent with the syntax of your program's native language. The
12986 language you use to build expressions is called the @dfn{working
12990 * Setting:: Switching between source languages
12991 * Show:: Displaying the language
12992 * Checks:: Type and range checks
12993 * Supported Languages:: Supported languages
12994 * Unsupported Languages:: Unsupported languages
12998 @section Switching Between Source Languages
13000 There are two ways to control the working language---either have @value{GDBN}
13001 set it automatically, or select it manually yourself. You can use the
13002 @code{set language} command for either purpose. On startup, @value{GDBN}
13003 defaults to setting the language automatically. The working language is
13004 used to determine how expressions you type are interpreted, how values
13007 In addition to the working language, every source file that
13008 @value{GDBN} knows about has its own working language. For some object
13009 file formats, the compiler might indicate which language a particular
13010 source file is in. However, most of the time @value{GDBN} infers the
13011 language from the name of the file. The language of a source file
13012 controls whether C@t{++} names are demangled---this way @code{backtrace} can
13013 show each frame appropriately for its own language. There is no way to
13014 set the language of a source file from within @value{GDBN}, but you can
13015 set the language associated with a filename extension. @xref{Show, ,
13016 Displaying the Language}.
13018 This is most commonly a problem when you use a program, such
13019 as @code{cfront} or @code{f2c}, that generates C but is written in
13020 another language. In that case, make the
13021 program use @code{#line} directives in its C output; that way
13022 @value{GDBN} will know the correct language of the source code of the original
13023 program, and will display that source code, not the generated C code.
13026 * Filenames:: Filename extensions and languages.
13027 * Manually:: Setting the working language manually
13028 * Automatically:: Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
13032 @subsection List of Filename Extensions and Languages
13034 If a source file name ends in one of the following extensions, then
13035 @value{GDBN} infers that its language is the one indicated.
13053 C@t{++} source file
13059 Objective-C source file
13063 Fortran source file
13066 Modula-2 source file
13070 Assembler source file. This actually behaves almost like C, but
13071 @value{GDBN} does not skip over function prologues when stepping.
13074 In addition, you may set the language associated with a filename
13075 extension. @xref{Show, , Displaying the Language}.
13078 @subsection Setting the Working Language
13080 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically,
13081 expressions are interpreted the same way in your debugging session and
13084 @kindex set language
13085 If you wish, you may set the language manually. To do this, issue the
13086 command @samp{set language @var{lang}}, where @var{lang} is the name of
13087 a language, such as
13088 @code{c} or @code{modula-2}.
13089 For a list of the supported languages, type @samp{set language}.
13091 Setting the language manually prevents @value{GDBN} from updating the working
13092 language automatically. This can lead to confusion if you try
13093 to debug a program when the working language is not the same as the
13094 source language, when an expression is acceptable to both
13095 languages---but means different things. For instance, if the current
13096 source file were written in C, and @value{GDBN} was parsing Modula-2, a
13104 might not have the effect you intended. In C, this means to add
13105 @code{b} and @code{c} and place the result in @code{a}. The result
13106 printed would be the value of @code{a}. In Modula-2, this means to compare
13107 @code{a} to the result of @code{b+c}, yielding a @code{BOOLEAN} value.
13109 @node Automatically
13110 @subsection Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language
13112 To have @value{GDBN} set the working language automatically, use
13113 @samp{set language local} or @samp{set language auto}. @value{GDBN}
13114 then infers the working language. That is, when your program stops in a
13115 frame (usually by encountering a breakpoint), @value{GDBN} sets the
13116 working language to the language recorded for the function in that
13117 frame. If the language for a frame is unknown (that is, if the function
13118 or block corresponding to the frame was defined in a source file that
13119 does not have a recognized extension), the current working language is
13120 not changed, and @value{GDBN} issues a warning.
13122 This may not seem necessary for most programs, which are written
13123 entirely in one source language. However, program modules and libraries
13124 written in one source language can be used by a main program written in
13125 a different source language. Using @samp{set language auto} in this
13126 case frees you from having to set the working language manually.
13129 @section Displaying the Language
13131 The following commands help you find out which language is the
13132 working language, and also what language source files were written in.
13135 @item show language
13136 @kindex show language
13137 Display the current working language. This is the
13138 language you can use with commands such as @code{print} to
13139 build and compute expressions that may involve variables in your program.
13142 @kindex info frame@r{, show the source language}
13143 Display the source language for this frame. This language becomes the
13144 working language if you use an identifier from this frame.
13145 @xref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}, to identify the other
13146 information listed here.
13149 @kindex info source@r{, show the source language}
13150 Display the source language of this source file.
13151 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}, to identify the other
13152 information listed here.
13155 In unusual circumstances, you may have source files with extensions
13156 not in the standard list. You can then set the extension associated
13157 with a language explicitly:
13160 @item set extension-language @var{ext} @var{language}
13161 @kindex set extension-language
13162 Tell @value{GDBN} that source files with extension @var{ext} are to be
13163 assumed as written in the source language @var{language}.
13165 @item info extensions
13166 @kindex info extensions
13167 List all the filename extensions and the associated languages.
13171 @section Type and Range Checking
13173 Some languages are designed to guard you against making seemingly common
13174 errors through a series of compile- and run-time checks. These include
13175 checking the type of arguments to functions and operators and making
13176 sure mathematical overflows are caught at run time. Checks such as
13177 these help to ensure a program's correctness once it has been compiled
13178 by eliminating type mismatches and providing active checks for range
13179 errors when your program is running.
13181 By default @value{GDBN} checks for these errors according to the
13182 rules of the current source language. Although @value{GDBN} does not check
13183 the statements in your program, it can check expressions entered directly
13184 into @value{GDBN} for evaluation via the @code{print} command, for example.
13187 * Type Checking:: An overview of type checking
13188 * Range Checking:: An overview of range checking
13191 @cindex type checking
13192 @cindex checks, type
13193 @node Type Checking
13194 @subsection An Overview of Type Checking
13196 Some languages, such as C and C@t{++}, are strongly typed, meaning that the
13197 arguments to operators and functions have to be of the correct type,
13198 otherwise an error occurs. These checks prevent type mismatch
13199 errors from ever causing any run-time problems. For example,
13202 int klass::my_method(char *b) @{ return b ? 1 : 2; @}
13204 (@value{GDBP}) print obj.my_method (0)
13207 (@value{GDBP}) print obj.my_method (0x1234)
13208 Cannot resolve method klass::my_method to any overloaded instance
13211 The second example fails because in C@t{++} the integer constant
13212 @samp{0x1234} is not type-compatible with the pointer parameter type.
13214 For the expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
13215 @value{GDBN} to not enforce strict type checking or
13216 to treat any mismatches as errors and abandon the expression;
13217 When type checking is disabled, @value{GDBN} successfully evaluates
13218 expressions like the second example above.
13220 Even if type checking is off, there may be other reasons
13221 related to type that prevent @value{GDBN} from evaluating an expression.
13222 For instance, @value{GDBN} does not know how to add an @code{int} and
13223 a @code{struct foo}. These particular type errors have nothing to do
13224 with the language in use and usually arise from expressions which make
13225 little sense to evaluate anyway.
13227 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling type checking:
13229 @kindex set check type
13230 @kindex show check type
13232 @item set check type on
13233 @itemx set check type off
13234 Set strict type checking on or off. If any type mismatches occur in
13235 evaluating an expression while type checking is on, @value{GDBN} prints a
13236 message and aborts evaluation of the expression.
13238 @item show check type
13239 Show the current setting of type checking and whether @value{GDBN}
13240 is enforcing strict type checking rules.
13243 @cindex range checking
13244 @cindex checks, range
13245 @node Range Checking
13246 @subsection An Overview of Range Checking
13248 In some languages (such as Modula-2), it is an error to exceed the
13249 bounds of a type; this is enforced with run-time checks. Such range
13250 checking is meant to ensure program correctness by making sure
13251 computations do not overflow, or indices on an array element access do
13252 not exceed the bounds of the array.
13254 For expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
13255 @value{GDBN} to treat range errors in one of three ways: ignore them,
13256 always treat them as errors and abandon the expression, or issue
13257 warnings but evaluate the expression anyway.
13259 A range error can result from numerical overflow, from exceeding an
13260 array index bound, or when you type a constant that is not a member
13261 of any type. Some languages, however, do not treat overflows as an
13262 error. In many implementations of C, mathematical overflow causes the
13263 result to ``wrap around'' to lower values---for example, if @var{m} is
13264 the largest integer value, and @var{s} is the smallest, then
13267 @var{m} + 1 @result{} @var{s}
13270 This, too, is specific to individual languages, and in some cases
13271 specific to individual compilers or machines. @xref{Supported Languages, ,
13272 Supported Languages}, for further details on specific languages.
13274 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the range checker:
13276 @kindex set check range
13277 @kindex show check range
13279 @item set check range auto
13280 Set range checking on or off based on the current working language.
13281 @xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for the default settings for
13284 @item set check range on
13285 @itemx set check range off
13286 Set range checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
13287 current working language. A warning is issued if the setting does not
13288 match the language default. If a range error occurs and range checking is on,
13289 then a message is printed and evaluation of the expression is aborted.
13291 @item set check range warn
13292 Output messages when the @value{GDBN} range checker detects a range error,
13293 but attempt to evaluate the expression anyway. Evaluating the
13294 expression may still be impossible for other reasons, such as accessing
13295 memory that the process does not own (a typical example from many Unix
13299 Show the current setting of the range checker, and whether or not it is
13300 being set automatically by @value{GDBN}.
13303 @node Supported Languages
13304 @section Supported Languages
13306 @value{GDBN} supports C, C@t{++}, D, Go, Objective-C, Fortran, Java,
13307 OpenCL C, Pascal, assembly, Modula-2, and Ada.
13308 @c This is false ...
13309 Some @value{GDBN} features may be used in expressions regardless of the
13310 language you use: the @value{GDBN} @code{@@} and @code{::} operators,
13311 and the @samp{@{type@}addr} construct (@pxref{Expressions,
13312 ,Expressions}) can be used with the constructs of any supported
13315 The following sections detail to what degree each source language is
13316 supported by @value{GDBN}. These sections are not meant to be language
13317 tutorials or references, but serve only as a reference guide to what the
13318 @value{GDBN} expression parser accepts, and what input and output
13319 formats should look like for different languages. There are many good
13320 books written on each of these languages; please look to these for a
13321 language reference or tutorial.
13324 * C:: C and C@t{++}
13327 * Objective-C:: Objective-C
13328 * OpenCL C:: OpenCL C
13329 * Fortran:: Fortran
13331 * Modula-2:: Modula-2
13336 @subsection C and C@t{++}
13338 @cindex C and C@t{++}
13339 @cindex expressions in C or C@t{++}
13341 Since C and C@t{++} are so closely related, many features of @value{GDBN} apply
13342 to both languages. Whenever this is the case, we discuss those languages
13346 @cindex @code{g++}, @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler
13347 @cindex @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
13348 The C@t{++} debugging facilities are jointly implemented by the C@t{++}
13349 compiler and @value{GDBN}. Therefore, to debug your C@t{++} code
13350 effectively, you must compile your C@t{++} programs with a supported
13351 C@t{++} compiler, such as @sc{gnu} @code{g++}, or the HP ANSI C@t{++}
13352 compiler (@code{aCC}).
13355 * C Operators:: C and C@t{++} operators
13356 * C Constants:: C and C@t{++} constants
13357 * C Plus Plus Expressions:: C@t{++} expressions
13358 * C Defaults:: Default settings for C and C@t{++}
13359 * C Checks:: C and C@t{++} type and range checks
13360 * Debugging C:: @value{GDBN} and C
13361 * Debugging C Plus Plus:: @value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}
13362 * Decimal Floating Point:: Numbers in Decimal Floating Point format
13366 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Operators
13368 @cindex C and C@t{++} operators
13370 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
13371 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
13372 often defined on groups of types.
13374 For the purposes of C and C@t{++}, the following definitions hold:
13379 @emph{Integral types} include @code{int} with any of its storage-class
13380 specifiers; @code{char}; @code{enum}; and, for C@t{++}, @code{bool}.
13383 @emph{Floating-point types} include @code{float}, @code{double}, and
13384 @code{long double} (if supported by the target platform).
13387 @emph{Pointer types} include all types defined as @code{(@var{type} *)}.
13390 @emph{Scalar types} include all of the above.
13395 The following operators are supported. They are listed here
13396 in order of increasing precedence:
13400 The comma or sequencing operator. Expressions in a comma-separated list
13401 are evaluated from left to right, with the result of the entire
13402 expression being the last expression evaluated.
13405 Assignment. The value of an assignment expression is the value
13406 assigned. Defined on scalar types.
13409 Used in an expression of the form @w{@code{@var{a} @var{op}= @var{b}}},
13410 and translated to @w{@code{@var{a} = @var{a op b}}}.
13411 @w{@code{@var{op}=}} and @code{=} have the same precedence.
13412 @var{op} is any one of the operators @code{|}, @code{^}, @code{&},
13413 @code{<<}, @code{>>}, @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{%}.
13416 The ternary operator. @code{@var{a} ? @var{b} : @var{c}} can be thought
13417 of as: if @var{a} then @var{b} else @var{c}. @var{a} should be of an
13421 Logical @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
13424 Logical @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
13427 Bitwise @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
13430 Bitwise exclusive-@sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
13433 Bitwise @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
13436 Equality and inequality. Defined on scalar types. The value of these
13437 expressions is 0 for false and non-zero for true.
13439 @item <@r{, }>@r{, }<=@r{, }>=
13440 Less than, greater than, less than or equal, greater than or equal.
13441 Defined on scalar types. The value of these expressions is 0 for false
13442 and non-zero for true.
13445 left shift, and right shift. Defined on integral types.
13448 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
13451 Addition and subtraction. Defined on integral types, floating-point types and
13454 @item *@r{, }/@r{, }%
13455 Multiplication, division, and modulus. Multiplication and division are
13456 defined on integral and floating-point types. Modulus is defined on
13460 Increment and decrement. When appearing before a variable, the
13461 operation is performed before the variable is used in an expression;
13462 when appearing after it, the variable's value is used before the
13463 operation takes place.
13466 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types. Same precedence as
13470 Address operator. Defined on variables. Same precedence as @code{++}.
13472 For debugging C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} implements a use of @samp{&} beyond what is
13473 allowed in the C@t{++} language itself: you can use @samp{&(&@var{ref})}
13474 to examine the address
13475 where a C@t{++} reference variable (declared with @samp{&@var{ref}}) is
13479 Negative. Defined on integral and floating-point types. Same
13480 precedence as @code{++}.
13483 Logical negation. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
13487 Bitwise complement operator. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
13492 Structure member, and pointer-to-structure member. For convenience,
13493 @value{GDBN} regards the two as equivalent, choosing whether to dereference a
13494 pointer based on the stored type information.
13495 Defined on @code{struct} and @code{union} data.
13498 Dereferences of pointers to members.
13501 Array indexing. @code{@var{a}[@var{i}]} is defined as
13502 @code{*(@var{a}+@var{i})}. Same precedence as @code{->}.
13505 Function parameter list. Same precedence as @code{->}.
13508 C@t{++} scope resolution operator. Defined on @code{struct}, @code{union},
13509 and @code{class} types.
13512 Doubled colons also represent the @value{GDBN} scope operator
13513 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). Same precedence as @code{::},
13517 If an operator is redefined in the user code, @value{GDBN} usually
13518 attempts to invoke the redefined version instead of using the operator's
13519 predefined meaning.
13522 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Constants
13524 @cindex C and C@t{++} constants
13526 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of C and C@t{++} in the
13531 Integer constants are a sequence of digits. Octal constants are
13532 specified by a leading @samp{0} (i.e.@: zero), and hexadecimal constants
13533 by a leading @samp{0x} or @samp{0X}. Constants may also end with a letter
13534 @samp{l}, specifying that the constant should be treated as a
13538 Floating point constants are a sequence of digits, followed by a decimal
13539 point, followed by a sequence of digits, and optionally followed by an
13540 exponent. An exponent is of the form:
13541 @samp{@w{e@r{[[}+@r{]|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}}, where @var{nnn} is another
13542 sequence of digits. The @samp{+} is optional for positive exponents.
13543 A floating-point constant may also end with a letter @samp{f} or
13544 @samp{F}, specifying that the constant should be treated as being of
13545 the @code{float} (as opposed to the default @code{double}) type; or with
13546 a letter @samp{l} or @samp{L}, which specifies a @code{long double}
13550 Enumerated constants consist of enumerated identifiers, or their
13551 integral equivalents.
13554 Character constants are a single character surrounded by single quotes
13555 (@code{'}), or a number---the ordinal value of the corresponding character
13556 (usually its @sc{ascii} value). Within quotes, the single character may
13557 be represented by a letter or by @dfn{escape sequences}, which are of
13558 the form @samp{\@var{nnn}}, where @var{nnn} is the octal representation
13559 of the character's ordinal value; or of the form @samp{\@var{x}}, where
13560 @samp{@var{x}} is a predefined special character---for example,
13561 @samp{\n} for newline.
13563 Wide character constants can be written by prefixing a character
13564 constant with @samp{L}, as in C. For example, @samp{L'x'} is the wide
13565 form of @samp{x}. The target wide character set is used when
13566 computing the value of this constant (@pxref{Character Sets}).
13569 String constants are a sequence of character constants surrounded by
13570 double quotes (@code{"}). Any valid character constant (as described
13571 above) may appear. Double quotes within the string must be preceded by
13572 a backslash, so for instance @samp{"a\"b'c"} is a string of five
13575 Wide string constants can be written by prefixing a string constant
13576 with @samp{L}, as in C. The target wide character set is used when
13577 computing the value of this constant (@pxref{Character Sets}).
13580 Pointer constants are an integral value. You can also write pointers
13581 to constants using the C operator @samp{&}.
13584 Array constants are comma-separated lists surrounded by braces @samp{@{}
13585 and @samp{@}}; for example, @samp{@{1,2,3@}} is a three-element array of
13586 integers, @samp{@{@{1,2@}, @{3,4@}, @{5,6@}@}} is a three-by-two array,
13587 and @samp{@{&"hi", &"there", &"fred"@}} is a three-element array of pointers.
13590 @node C Plus Plus Expressions
13591 @subsubsection C@t{++} Expressions
13593 @cindex expressions in C@t{++}
13594 @value{GDBN} expression handling can interpret most C@t{++} expressions.
13596 @cindex debugging C@t{++} programs
13597 @cindex C@t{++} compilers
13598 @cindex debug formats and C@t{++}
13599 @cindex @value{NGCC} and C@t{++}
13601 @emph{Warning:} @value{GDBN} can only debug C@t{++} code if you use
13602 the proper compiler and the proper debug format. Currently,
13603 @value{GDBN} works best when debugging C@t{++} code that is compiled
13604 with the most recent version of @value{NGCC} possible. The DWARF
13605 debugging format is preferred; @value{NGCC} defaults to this on most
13606 popular platforms. Other compilers and/or debug formats are likely to
13607 work badly or not at all when using @value{GDBN} to debug C@t{++}
13608 code. @xref{Compilation}.
13613 @cindex member functions
13615 Member function calls are allowed; you can use expressions like
13618 count = aml->GetOriginal(x, y)
13621 @vindex this@r{, inside C@t{++} member functions}
13622 @cindex namespace in C@t{++}
13624 While a member function is active (in the selected stack frame), your
13625 expressions have the same namespace available as the member function;
13626 that is, @value{GDBN} allows implicit references to the class instance
13627 pointer @code{this} following the same rules as C@t{++}. @code{using}
13628 declarations in the current scope are also respected by @value{GDBN}.
13630 @cindex call overloaded functions
13631 @cindex overloaded functions, calling
13632 @cindex type conversions in C@t{++}
13634 You can call overloaded functions; @value{GDBN} resolves the function
13635 call to the right definition, with some restrictions. @value{GDBN} does not
13636 perform overload resolution involving user-defined type conversions,
13637 calls to constructors, or instantiations of templates that do not exist
13638 in the program. It also cannot handle ellipsis argument lists or
13641 It does perform integral conversions and promotions, floating-point
13642 promotions, arithmetic conversions, pointer conversions, conversions of
13643 class objects to base classes, and standard conversions such as those of
13644 functions or arrays to pointers; it requires an exact match on the
13645 number of function arguments.
13647 Overload resolution is always performed, unless you have specified
13648 @code{set overload-resolution off}. @xref{Debugging C Plus Plus,
13649 ,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
13651 You must specify @code{set overload-resolution off} in order to use an
13652 explicit function signature to call an overloaded function, as in
13654 p 'foo(char,int)'('x', 13)
13657 The @value{GDBN} command-completion facility can simplify this;
13658 see @ref{Completion, ,Command Completion}.
13660 @cindex reference declarations
13662 @value{GDBN} understands variables declared as C@t{++} references; you can use
13663 them in expressions just as you do in C@t{++} source---they are automatically
13666 In the parameter list shown when @value{GDBN} displays a frame, the values of
13667 reference variables are not displayed (unlike other variables); this
13668 avoids clutter, since references are often used for large structures.
13669 The @emph{address} of a reference variable is always shown, unless
13670 you have specified @samp{set print address off}.
13673 @value{GDBN} supports the C@t{++} name resolution operator @code{::}---your
13674 expressions can use it just as expressions in your program do. Since
13675 one scope may be defined in another, you can use @code{::} repeatedly if
13676 necessary, for example in an expression like
13677 @samp{@var{scope1}::@var{scope2}::@var{name}}. @value{GDBN} also allows
13678 resolving name scope by reference to source files, in both C and C@t{++}
13679 debugging (@pxref{Variables, ,Program Variables}).
13682 @value{GDBN} performs argument-dependent lookup, following the C@t{++}
13687 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Defaults
13689 @cindex C and C@t{++} defaults
13691 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set range checking automatically, it
13692 defaults to @code{off} whenever the working language changes to
13693 C or C@t{++}. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
13694 selects the working language.
13696 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, it
13697 recognizes source files whose names end with @file{.c}, @file{.C}, or
13698 @file{.cc}, etc, and when @value{GDBN} enters code compiled from one of
13699 these files, it sets the working language to C or C@t{++}.
13700 @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language},
13701 for further details.
13704 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Type and Range Checks
13706 @cindex C and C@t{++} checks
13708 By default, when @value{GDBN} parses C or C@t{++} expressions, strict type
13709 checking is used. However, if you turn type checking off, @value{GDBN}
13710 will allow certain non-standard conversions, such as promoting integer
13711 constants to pointers.
13713 Range checking, if turned on, is done on mathematical operations. Array
13714 indices are not checked, since they are often used to index a pointer
13715 that is not itself an array.
13718 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and C
13720 The @code{set print union} and @code{show print union} commands apply to
13721 the @code{union} type. When set to @samp{on}, any @code{union} that is
13722 inside a @code{struct} or @code{class} is also printed. Otherwise, it
13723 appears as @samp{@{...@}}.
13725 The @code{@@} operator aids in the debugging of dynamic arrays, formed
13726 with pointers and a memory allocation function. @xref{Expressions,
13729 @node Debugging C Plus Plus
13730 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}
13732 @cindex commands for C@t{++}
13734 Some @value{GDBN} commands are particularly useful with C@t{++}, and some are
13735 designed specifically for use with C@t{++}. Here is a summary:
13738 @cindex break in overloaded functions
13739 @item @r{breakpoint menus}
13740 When you want a breakpoint in a function whose name is overloaded,
13741 @value{GDBN} has the capability to display a menu of possible breakpoint
13742 locations to help you specify which function definition you want.
13743 @xref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous Expressions}.
13745 @cindex overloading in C@t{++}
13746 @item rbreak @var{regex}
13747 Setting breakpoints using regular expressions is helpful for setting
13748 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
13750 @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}.
13752 @cindex C@t{++} exception handling
13754 @itemx catch rethrow
13756 Debug C@t{++} exception handling using these commands. @xref{Set
13757 Catchpoints, , Setting Catchpoints}.
13759 @cindex inheritance
13760 @item ptype @var{typename}
13761 Print inheritance relationships as well as other information for type
13763 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}.
13765 @item info vtbl @var{expression}.
13766 The @code{info vtbl} command can be used to display the virtual
13767 method tables of the object computed by @var{expression}. This shows
13768 one entry per virtual table; there may be multiple virtual tables when
13769 multiple inheritance is in use.
13771 @cindex C@t{++} symbol display
13772 @item set print demangle
13773 @itemx show print demangle
13774 @itemx set print asm-demangle
13775 @itemx show print asm-demangle
13776 Control whether C@t{++} symbols display in their source form, both when
13777 displaying code as C@t{++} source and when displaying disassemblies.
13778 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
13780 @item set print object
13781 @itemx show print object
13782 Choose whether to print derived (actual) or declared types of objects.
13783 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
13785 @item set print vtbl
13786 @itemx show print vtbl
13787 Control the format for printing virtual function tables.
13788 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
13789 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
13790 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
13792 @kindex set overload-resolution
13793 @cindex overloaded functions, overload resolution
13794 @item set overload-resolution on
13795 Enable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. The default
13796 is on. For overloaded functions, @value{GDBN} evaluates the arguments
13797 and searches for a function whose signature matches the argument types,
13798 using the standard C@t{++} conversion rules (see @ref{C Plus Plus
13799 Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}, for details).
13800 If it cannot find a match, it emits a message.
13802 @item set overload-resolution off
13803 Disable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. For
13804 overloaded functions that are not class member functions, @value{GDBN}
13805 chooses the first function of the specified name that it finds in the
13806 symbol table, whether or not its arguments are of the correct type. For
13807 overloaded functions that are class member functions, @value{GDBN}
13808 searches for a function whose signature @emph{exactly} matches the
13811 @kindex show overload-resolution
13812 @item show overload-resolution
13813 Show the current setting of overload resolution.
13815 @item @r{Overloaded symbol names}
13816 You can specify a particular definition of an overloaded symbol, using
13817 the same notation that is used to declare such symbols in C@t{++}: type
13818 @code{@var{symbol}(@var{types})} rather than just @var{symbol}. You can
13819 also use the @value{GDBN} command-line word completion facilities to list the
13820 available choices, or to finish the type list for you.
13821 @xref{Completion,, Command Completion}, for details on how to do this.
13824 @node Decimal Floating Point
13825 @subsubsection Decimal Floating Point format
13826 @cindex decimal floating point format
13828 @value{GDBN} can examine, set and perform computations with numbers in
13829 decimal floating point format, which in the C language correspond to the
13830 @code{_Decimal32}, @code{_Decimal64} and @code{_Decimal128} types as
13831 specified by the extension to support decimal floating-point arithmetic.
13833 There are two encodings in use, depending on the architecture: BID (Binary
13834 Integer Decimal) for x86 and x86-64, and DPD (Densely Packed Decimal) for
13835 PowerPC. @value{GDBN} will use the appropriate encoding for the configured
13838 Because of a limitation in @file{libdecnumber}, the library used by @value{GDBN}
13839 to manipulate decimal floating point numbers, it is not possible to convert
13840 (using a cast, for example) integers wider than 32-bit to decimal float.
13842 In addition, in order to imitate @value{GDBN}'s behaviour with binary floating
13843 point computations, error checking in decimal float operations ignores
13844 underflow, overflow and divide by zero exceptions.
13846 In the PowerPC architecture, @value{GDBN} provides a set of pseudo-registers
13847 to inspect @code{_Decimal128} values stored in floating point registers.
13848 See @ref{PowerPC,,PowerPC} for more details.
13854 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in D and compiled with
13855 GDC, LDC or DMD compilers. Currently @value{GDBN} supports only one D
13856 specific feature --- dynamic arrays.
13861 @cindex Go (programming language)
13862 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Go and compiled with
13863 @file{gccgo} or @file{6g} compilers.
13865 Here is a summary of the Go-specific features and restrictions:
13868 @cindex current Go package
13869 @item The current Go package
13870 The name of the current package does not need to be specified when
13871 specifying global variables and functions.
13873 For example, given the program:
13877 var myglob = "Shall we?"
13883 When stopped inside @code{main} either of these work:
13887 (gdb) p main.myglob
13890 @cindex builtin Go types
13891 @item Builtin Go types
13892 The @code{string} type is recognized by @value{GDBN} and is printed
13895 @cindex builtin Go functions
13896 @item Builtin Go functions
13897 The @value{GDBN} expression parser recognizes the @code{unsafe.Sizeof}
13898 function and handles it internally.
13900 @cindex restrictions on Go expressions
13901 @item Restrictions on Go expressions
13902 All Go operators are supported except @code{&^}.
13903 The Go @code{_} ``blank identifier'' is not supported.
13904 Automatic dereferencing of pointers is not supported.
13908 @subsection Objective-C
13910 @cindex Objective-C
13911 This section provides information about some commands and command
13912 options that are useful for debugging Objective-C code. See also
13913 @ref{Symbols, info classes}, and @ref{Symbols, info selectors}, for a
13914 few more commands specific to Objective-C support.
13917 * Method Names in Commands::
13918 * The Print Command with Objective-C::
13921 @node Method Names in Commands
13922 @subsubsection Method Names in Commands
13924 The following commands have been extended to accept Objective-C method
13925 names as line specifications:
13927 @kindex clear@r{, and Objective-C}
13928 @kindex break@r{, and Objective-C}
13929 @kindex info line@r{, and Objective-C}
13930 @kindex jump@r{, and Objective-C}
13931 @kindex list@r{, and Objective-C}
13935 @item @code{info line}
13940 A fully qualified Objective-C method name is specified as
13943 -[@var{Class} @var{methodName}]
13946 where the minus sign is used to indicate an instance method and a
13947 plus sign (not shown) is used to indicate a class method. The class
13948 name @var{Class} and method name @var{methodName} are enclosed in
13949 brackets, similar to the way messages are specified in Objective-C
13950 source code. For example, to set a breakpoint at the @code{create}
13951 instance method of class @code{Fruit} in the program currently being
13955 break -[Fruit create]
13958 To list ten program lines around the @code{initialize} class method,
13962 list +[NSText initialize]
13965 In the current version of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus sign is
13966 required. In future versions of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus
13967 sign will be optional, but you can use it to narrow the search. It
13968 is also possible to specify just a method name:
13974 You must specify the complete method name, including any colons. If
13975 your program's source files contain more than one @code{create} method,
13976 you'll be presented with a numbered list of classes that implement that
13977 method. Indicate your choice by number, or type @samp{0} to exit if
13980 As another example, to clear a breakpoint established at the
13981 @code{makeKeyAndOrderFront:} method of the @code{NSWindow} class, enter:
13984 clear -[NSWindow makeKeyAndOrderFront:]
13987 @node The Print Command with Objective-C
13988 @subsubsection The Print Command With Objective-C
13989 @cindex Objective-C, print objects
13990 @kindex print-object
13991 @kindex po @r{(@code{print-object})}
13993 The print command has also been extended to accept methods. For example:
13996 print -[@var{object} hash]
13999 @cindex print an Objective-C object description
14000 @cindex @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, and printing Objective-C objects
14002 will tell @value{GDBN} to send the @code{hash} message to @var{object}
14003 and print the result. Also, an additional command has been added,
14004 @code{print-object} or @code{po} for short, which is meant to print
14005 the description of an object. However, this command may only work
14006 with certain Objective-C libraries that have a particular hook
14007 function, @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, defined.
14010 @subsection OpenCL C
14013 This section provides information about @value{GDBN}s OpenCL C support.
14016 * OpenCL C Datatypes::
14017 * OpenCL C Expressions::
14018 * OpenCL C Operators::
14021 @node OpenCL C Datatypes
14022 @subsubsection OpenCL C Datatypes
14024 @cindex OpenCL C Datatypes
14025 @value{GDBN} supports the builtin scalar and vector datatypes specified
14026 by OpenCL 1.1. In addition the half- and double-precision floating point
14027 data types of the @code{cl_khr_fp16} and @code{cl_khr_fp64} OpenCL
14028 extensions are also known to @value{GDBN}.
14030 @node OpenCL C Expressions
14031 @subsubsection OpenCL C Expressions
14033 @cindex OpenCL C Expressions
14034 @value{GDBN} supports accesses to vector components including the access as
14035 lvalue where possible. Since OpenCL C is based on C99 most C expressions
14036 supported by @value{GDBN} can be used as well.
14038 @node OpenCL C Operators
14039 @subsubsection OpenCL C Operators
14041 @cindex OpenCL C Operators
14042 @value{GDBN} supports the operators specified by OpenCL 1.1 for scalar and
14046 @subsection Fortran
14047 @cindex Fortran-specific support in @value{GDBN}
14049 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, but it
14050 currently supports only the features of Fortran 77 language.
14052 @cindex trailing underscore, in Fortran symbols
14053 Some Fortran compilers (@sc{gnu} Fortran 77 and Fortran 95 compilers
14054 among them) append an underscore to the names of variables and
14055 functions. When you debug programs compiled by those compilers, you
14056 will need to refer to variables and functions with a trailing
14060 * Fortran Operators:: Fortran operators and expressions
14061 * Fortran Defaults:: Default settings for Fortran
14062 * Special Fortran Commands:: Special @value{GDBN} commands for Fortran
14065 @node Fortran Operators
14066 @subsubsection Fortran Operators and Expressions
14068 @cindex Fortran operators and expressions
14070 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
14071 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on characters or other non-
14072 arithmetic types. Operators are often defined on groups of types.
14076 The exponentiation operator. It raises the first operand to the power
14080 The range operator. Normally used in the form of array(low:high) to
14081 represent a section of array.
14084 The access component operator. Normally used to access elements in derived
14085 types. Also suitable for unions. As unions aren't part of regular Fortran,
14086 this can only happen when accessing a register that uses a gdbarch-defined
14090 @node Fortran Defaults
14091 @subsubsection Fortran Defaults
14093 @cindex Fortran Defaults
14095 Fortran symbols are usually case-insensitive, so @value{GDBN} by
14096 default uses case-insensitive matches for Fortran symbols. You can
14097 change that with the @samp{set case-insensitive} command, see
14098 @ref{Symbols}, for the details.
14100 @node Special Fortran Commands
14101 @subsubsection Special Fortran Commands
14103 @cindex Special Fortran commands
14105 @value{GDBN} has some commands to support Fortran-specific features,
14106 such as displaying common blocks.
14109 @cindex @code{COMMON} blocks, Fortran
14110 @kindex info common
14111 @item info common @r{[}@var{common-name}@r{]}
14112 This command prints the values contained in the Fortran @code{COMMON}
14113 block whose name is @var{common-name}. With no argument, the names of
14114 all @code{COMMON} blocks visible at the current program location are
14121 @cindex Pascal support in @value{GDBN}, limitations
14122 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
14123 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
14124 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
14127 The Pascal-specific command @code{set print pascal_static-members}
14128 controls whether static members of Pascal objects are displayed.
14129 @xref{Print Settings, pascal_static-members}.
14132 @subsection Modula-2
14134 @cindex Modula-2, @value{GDBN} support
14136 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} to support Modula-2 only support
14137 output from the @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler (which is currently being
14138 developed). Other Modula-2 compilers are not currently supported, and
14139 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
14140 to give an error as @value{GDBN} reads in the executable's symbol
14143 @cindex expressions in Modula-2
14145 * M2 Operators:: Built-in operators
14146 * Built-In Func/Proc:: Built-in functions and procedures
14147 * M2 Constants:: Modula-2 constants
14148 * M2 Types:: Modula-2 types
14149 * M2 Defaults:: Default settings for Modula-2
14150 * Deviations:: Deviations from standard Modula-2
14151 * M2 Checks:: Modula-2 type and range checks
14152 * M2 Scope:: The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
14153 * GDB/M2:: @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
14157 @subsubsection Operators
14158 @cindex Modula-2 operators
14160 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
14161 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
14162 often defined on groups of types. For the purposes of Modula-2, the
14163 following definitions hold:
14168 @emph{Integral types} consist of @code{INTEGER}, @code{CARDINAL}, and
14172 @emph{Character types} consist of @code{CHAR} and its subranges.
14175 @emph{Floating-point types} consist of @code{REAL}.
14178 @emph{Pointer types} consist of anything declared as @code{POINTER TO
14182 @emph{Scalar types} consist of all of the above.
14185 @emph{Set types} consist of @code{SET} and @code{BITSET} types.
14188 @emph{Boolean types} consist of @code{BOOLEAN}.
14192 The following operators are supported, and appear in order of
14193 increasing precedence:
14197 Function argument or array index separator.
14200 Assignment. The value of @var{var} @code{:=} @var{value} is
14204 Less than, greater than on integral, floating-point, or enumerated
14208 Less than or equal to, greater than or equal to
14209 on integral, floating-point and enumerated types, or set inclusion on
14210 set types. Same precedence as @code{<}.
14212 @item =@r{, }<>@r{, }#
14213 Equality and two ways of expressing inequality, valid on scalar types.
14214 Same precedence as @code{<}. In @value{GDBN} scripts, only @code{<>} is
14215 available for inequality, since @code{#} conflicts with the script
14219 Set membership. Defined on set types and the types of their members.
14220 Same precedence as @code{<}.
14223 Boolean disjunction. Defined on boolean types.
14226 Boolean conjunction. Defined on boolean types.
14229 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
14232 Addition and subtraction on integral and floating-point types, or union
14233 and difference on set types.
14236 Multiplication on integral and floating-point types, or set intersection
14240 Division on floating-point types, or symmetric set difference on set
14241 types. Same precedence as @code{*}.
14244 Integer division and remainder. Defined on integral types. Same
14245 precedence as @code{*}.
14248 Negative. Defined on @code{INTEGER} and @code{REAL} data.
14251 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types.
14254 Boolean negation. Defined on boolean types. Same precedence as
14258 @code{RECORD} field selector. Defined on @code{RECORD} data. Same
14259 precedence as @code{^}.
14262 Array indexing. Defined on @code{ARRAY} data. Same precedence as @code{^}.
14265 Procedure argument list. Defined on @code{PROCEDURE} objects. Same precedence
14269 @value{GDBN} and Modula-2 scope operators.
14273 @emph{Warning:} Set expressions and their operations are not yet supported, so @value{GDBN}
14274 treats the use of the operator @code{IN}, or the use of operators
14275 @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{=}, , @code{<>}, @code{#},
14276 @code{<=}, and @code{>=} on sets as an error.
14280 @node Built-In Func/Proc
14281 @subsubsection Built-in Functions and Procedures
14282 @cindex Modula-2 built-ins
14284 Modula-2 also makes available several built-in procedures and functions.
14285 In describing these, the following metavariables are used:
14290 represents an @code{ARRAY} variable.
14293 represents a @code{CHAR} constant or variable.
14296 represents a variable or constant of integral type.
14299 represents an identifier that belongs to a set. Generally used in the
14300 same function with the metavariable @var{s}. The type of @var{s} should
14301 be @code{SET OF @var{mtype}} (where @var{mtype} is the type of @var{m}).
14304 represents a variable or constant of integral or floating-point type.
14307 represents a variable or constant of floating-point type.
14313 represents a variable.
14316 represents a variable or constant of one of many types. See the
14317 explanation of the function for details.
14320 All Modula-2 built-in procedures also return a result, described below.
14324 Returns the absolute value of @var{n}.
14327 If @var{c} is a lower case letter, it returns its upper case
14328 equivalent, otherwise it returns its argument.
14331 Returns the character whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
14334 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
14336 @item DEC(@var{v},@var{i})
14337 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
14340 @item EXCL(@var{m},@var{s})
14341 Removes the element @var{m} from the set @var{s}. Returns the new
14344 @item FLOAT(@var{i})
14345 Returns the floating point equivalent of the integer @var{i}.
14347 @item HIGH(@var{a})
14348 Returns the index of the last member of @var{a}.
14351 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
14353 @item INC(@var{v},@var{i})
14354 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
14357 @item INCL(@var{m},@var{s})
14358 Adds the element @var{m} to the set @var{s} if it is not already
14359 there. Returns the new set.
14362 Returns the maximum value of the type @var{t}.
14365 Returns the minimum value of the type @var{t}.
14368 Returns boolean TRUE if @var{i} is an odd number.
14371 Returns the ordinal value of its argument. For example, the ordinal
14372 value of a character is its @sc{ascii} value (on machines supporting the
14373 @sc{ascii} character set). @var{x} must be of an ordered type, which include
14374 integral, character and enumerated types.
14376 @item SIZE(@var{x})
14377 Returns the size of its argument. @var{x} can be a variable or a type.
14379 @item TRUNC(@var{r})
14380 Returns the integral part of @var{r}.
14382 @item TSIZE(@var{x})
14383 Returns the size of its argument. @var{x} can be a variable or a type.
14385 @item VAL(@var{t},@var{i})
14386 Returns the member of the type @var{t} whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
14390 @emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so
14391 @value{GDBN} treats the use of procedures @code{INCL} and @code{EXCL} as
14395 @cindex Modula-2 constants
14397 @subsubsection Constants
14399 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of Modula-2 in the following
14405 Integer constants are simply a sequence of digits. When used in an
14406 expression, a constant is interpreted to be type-compatible with the
14407 rest of the expression. Hexadecimal integers are specified by a
14408 trailing @samp{H}, and octal integers by a trailing @samp{B}.
14411 Floating point constants appear as a sequence of digits, followed by a
14412 decimal point and another sequence of digits. An optional exponent can
14413 then be specified, in the form @samp{E@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}, where
14414 @samp{@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}} is the desired exponent. All of the
14415 digits of the floating point constant must be valid decimal (base 10)
14419 Character constants consist of a single character enclosed by a pair of
14420 like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}). They may
14421 also be expressed by their ordinal value (their @sc{ascii} value, usually)
14422 followed by a @samp{C}.
14425 String constants consist of a sequence of characters enclosed by a
14426 pair of like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}).
14427 Escape sequences in the style of C are also allowed. @xref{C
14428 Constants, ,C and C@t{++} Constants}, for a brief explanation of escape
14432 Enumerated constants consist of an enumerated identifier.
14435 Boolean constants consist of the identifiers @code{TRUE} and
14439 Pointer constants consist of integral values only.
14442 Set constants are not yet supported.
14446 @subsubsection Modula-2 Types
14447 @cindex Modula-2 types
14449 Currently @value{GDBN} can print the following data types in Modula-2
14450 syntax: array types, record types, set types, pointer types, procedure
14451 types, enumerated types, subrange types and base types. You can also
14452 print the contents of variables declared using these type.
14453 This section gives a number of simple source code examples together with
14454 sample @value{GDBN} sessions.
14456 The first example contains the following section of code:
14465 and you can request @value{GDBN} to interrogate the type and value of
14466 @code{r} and @code{s}.
14469 (@value{GDBP}) print s
14471 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
14473 (@value{GDBP}) print r
14475 (@value{GDBP}) ptype r
14480 Likewise if your source code declares @code{s} as:
14484 s: SET ['A'..'Z'] ;
14488 then you may query the type of @code{s} by:
14491 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
14492 type = SET ['A'..'Z']
14496 Note that at present you cannot interactively manipulate set
14497 expressions using the debugger.
14499 The following example shows how you might declare an array in Modula-2
14500 and how you can interact with @value{GDBN} to print its type and contents:
14504 s: ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR ;
14508 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
14509 ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR
14512 Note that the array handling is not yet complete and although the type
14513 is printed correctly, expression handling still assumes that all
14514 arrays have a lower bound of zero and not @code{-10} as in the example
14517 Here are some more type related Modula-2 examples:
14521 colour = (blue, red, yellow, green) ;
14522 t = [blue..yellow] ;
14530 The @value{GDBN} interaction shows how you can query the data type
14531 and value of a variable.
14534 (@value{GDBP}) print s
14536 (@value{GDBP}) ptype t
14537 type = [blue..yellow]
14541 In this example a Modula-2 array is declared and its contents
14542 displayed. Observe that the contents are written in the same way as
14543 their @code{C} counterparts.
14547 s: ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
14553 (@value{GDBP}) print s
14554 $1 = @{1, 0, 0, 0, 0@}
14555 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
14556 type = ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
14559 The Modula-2 language interface to @value{GDBN} also understands
14560 pointer types as shown in this example:
14564 s: POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
14571 and you can request that @value{GDBN} describes the type of @code{s}.
14574 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
14575 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
14578 @value{GDBN} handles compound types as we can see in this example.
14579 Here we combine array types, record types, pointer types and subrange
14590 myarray = ARRAY myrange OF CARDINAL ;
14591 myrange = [-2..2] ;
14593 s: POINTER TO ARRAY myrange OF foo ;
14597 and you can ask @value{GDBN} to describe the type of @code{s} as shown
14601 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
14602 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [-2..2] OF foo = RECORD
14605 f3 : ARRAY [-2..2] OF CARDINAL;
14610 @subsubsection Modula-2 Defaults
14611 @cindex Modula-2 defaults
14613 If type and range checking are set automatically by @value{GDBN}, they
14614 both default to @code{on} whenever the working language changes to
14615 Modula-2. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
14616 selected the working language.
14618 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, then entering
14619 code compiled from a file whose name ends with @file{.mod} sets the
14620 working language to Modula-2. @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN}
14621 Infer the Source Language}, for further details.
14624 @subsubsection Deviations from Standard Modula-2
14625 @cindex Modula-2, deviations from
14627 A few changes have been made to make Modula-2 programs easier to debug.
14628 This is done primarily via loosening its type strictness:
14632 Unlike in standard Modula-2, pointer constants can be formed by
14633 integers. This allows you to modify pointer variables during
14634 debugging. (In standard Modula-2, the actual address contained in a
14635 pointer variable is hidden from you; it can only be modified
14636 through direct assignment to another pointer variable or expression that
14637 returned a pointer.)
14640 C escape sequences can be used in strings and characters to represent
14641 non-printable characters. @value{GDBN} prints out strings with these
14642 escape sequences embedded. Single non-printable characters are
14643 printed using the @samp{CHR(@var{nnn})} format.
14646 The assignment operator (@code{:=}) returns the value of its right-hand
14650 All built-in procedures both modify @emph{and} return their argument.
14654 @subsubsection Modula-2 Type and Range Checks
14655 @cindex Modula-2 checks
14658 @emph{Warning:} in this release, @value{GDBN} does not yet perform type or
14661 @c FIXME remove warning when type/range checks added
14663 @value{GDBN} considers two Modula-2 variables type equivalent if:
14667 They are of types that have been declared equivalent via a @code{TYPE
14668 @var{t1} = @var{t2}} statement
14671 They have been declared on the same line. (Note: This is true of the
14672 @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler, but it may not be true of other compilers.)
14675 As long as type checking is enabled, any attempt to combine variables
14676 whose types are not equivalent is an error.
14678 Range checking is done on all mathematical operations, assignment, array
14679 index bounds, and all built-in functions and procedures.
14682 @subsubsection The Scope Operators @code{::} and @code{.}
14684 @cindex @code{.}, Modula-2 scope operator
14685 @cindex colon, doubled as scope operator
14687 @vindex colon-colon@r{, in Modula-2}
14688 @c Info cannot handle :: but TeX can.
14691 @vindex ::@r{, in Modula-2}
14694 There are a few subtle differences between the Modula-2 scope operator
14695 (@code{.}) and the @value{GDBN} scope operator (@code{::}). The two have
14700 @var{module} . @var{id}
14701 @var{scope} :: @var{id}
14705 where @var{scope} is the name of a module or a procedure,
14706 @var{module} the name of a module, and @var{id} is any declared
14707 identifier within your program, except another module.
14709 Using the @code{::} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the scope
14710 specified by @var{scope} for the identifier @var{id}. If it is not
14711 found in the specified scope, then @value{GDBN} searches all scopes
14712 enclosing the one specified by @var{scope}.
14714 Using the @code{.} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the current scope for
14715 the identifier specified by @var{id} that was imported from the
14716 definition module specified by @var{module}. With this operator, it is
14717 an error if the identifier @var{id} was not imported from definition
14718 module @var{module}, or if @var{id} is not an identifier in
14722 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
14724 Some @value{GDBN} commands have little use when debugging Modula-2 programs.
14725 Five subcommands of @code{set print} and @code{show print} apply
14726 specifically to C and C@t{++}: @samp{vtbl}, @samp{demangle},
14727 @samp{asm-demangle}, @samp{object}, and @samp{union}. The first four
14728 apply to C@t{++}, and the last to the C @code{union} type, which has no direct
14729 analogue in Modula-2.
14731 The @code{@@} operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), while available
14732 with any language, is not useful with Modula-2. Its
14733 intent is to aid the debugging of @dfn{dynamic arrays}, which cannot be
14734 created in Modula-2 as they can in C or C@t{++}. However, because an
14735 address can be specified by an integral constant, the construct
14736 @samp{@{@var{type}@}@var{adrexp}} is still useful.
14738 @cindex @code{#} in Modula-2
14739 In @value{GDBN} scripts, the Modula-2 inequality operator @code{#} is
14740 interpreted as the beginning of a comment. Use @code{<>} instead.
14746 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} for Ada only support
14747 output from the @sc{gnu} Ada (GNAT) compiler.
14748 Other Ada compilers are not currently supported, and
14749 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
14753 @cindex expressions in Ada
14755 * Ada Mode Intro:: General remarks on the Ada syntax
14756 and semantics supported by Ada mode
14758 * Omissions from Ada:: Restrictions on the Ada expression syntax.
14759 * Additions to Ada:: Extensions of the Ada expression syntax.
14760 * Stopping Before Main Program:: Debugging the program during elaboration.
14761 * Ada Tasks:: Listing and setting breakpoints in tasks.
14762 * Ada Tasks and Core Files:: Tasking Support when Debugging Core Files
14763 * Ravenscar Profile:: Tasking Support when using the Ravenscar
14765 * Ada Glitches:: Known peculiarities of Ada mode.
14768 @node Ada Mode Intro
14769 @subsubsection Introduction
14770 @cindex Ada mode, general
14772 The Ada mode of @value{GDBN} supports a fairly large subset of Ada expression
14773 syntax, with some extensions.
14774 The philosophy behind the design of this subset is
14778 That @value{GDBN} should provide basic literals and access to operations for
14779 arithmetic, dereferencing, field selection, indexing, and subprogram calls,
14780 leaving more sophisticated computations to subprograms written into the
14781 program (which therefore may be called from @value{GDBN}).
14784 That type safety and strict adherence to Ada language restrictions
14785 are not particularly important to the @value{GDBN} user.
14788 That brevity is important to the @value{GDBN} user.
14791 Thus, for brevity, the debugger acts as if all names declared in
14792 user-written packages are directly visible, even if they are not visible
14793 according to Ada rules, thus making it unnecessary to fully qualify most
14794 names with their packages, regardless of context. Where this causes
14795 ambiguity, @value{GDBN} asks the user's intent.
14797 The debugger will start in Ada mode if it detects an Ada main program.
14798 As for other languages, it will enter Ada mode when stopped in a program that
14799 was translated from an Ada source file.
14801 While in Ada mode, you may use `@t{--}' for comments. This is useful
14802 mostly for documenting command files. The standard @value{GDBN} comment
14803 (@samp{#}) still works at the beginning of a line in Ada mode, but not in the
14804 middle (to allow based literals).
14806 The debugger supports limited overloading. Given a subprogram call in which
14807 the function symbol has multiple definitions, it will use the number of
14808 actual parameters and some information about their types to attempt to narrow
14809 the set of definitions. It also makes very limited use of context, preferring
14810 procedures to functions in the context of the @code{call} command, and
14811 functions to procedures elsewhere.
14813 @node Omissions from Ada
14814 @subsubsection Omissions from Ada
14815 @cindex Ada, omissions from
14817 Here are the notable omissions from the subset:
14821 Only a subset of the attributes are supported:
14825 @t{'First}, @t{'Last}, and @t{'Length}
14826 on array objects (not on types and subtypes).
14829 @t{'Min} and @t{'Max}.
14832 @t{'Pos} and @t{'Val}.
14838 @t{'Range} on array objects (not subtypes), but only as the right
14839 operand of the membership (@code{in}) operator.
14842 @t{'Access}, @t{'Unchecked_Access}, and
14843 @t{'Unrestricted_Access} (a GNAT extension).
14851 @code{Characters.Latin_1} are not available and
14852 concatenation is not implemented. Thus, escape characters in strings are
14853 not currently available.
14856 Equality tests (@samp{=} and @samp{/=}) on arrays test for bitwise
14857 equality of representations. They will generally work correctly
14858 for strings and arrays whose elements have integer or enumeration types.
14859 They may not work correctly for arrays whose element
14860 types have user-defined equality, for arrays of real values
14861 (in particular, IEEE-conformant floating point, because of negative
14862 zeroes and NaNs), and for arrays whose elements contain unused bits with
14863 indeterminate values.
14866 The other component-by-component array operations (@code{and}, @code{or},
14867 @code{xor}, @code{not}, and relational tests other than equality)
14868 are not implemented.
14871 @cindex array aggregates (Ada)
14872 @cindex record aggregates (Ada)
14873 @cindex aggregates (Ada)
14874 There is limited support for array and record aggregates. They are
14875 permitted only on the right sides of assignments, as in these examples:
14878 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6)
14879 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (1, others => 0)
14880 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (0|4 => 1, 1..3 => 2, 5 => 6)
14881 (@value{GDBP}) set A_2D_Array := ((1, 2, 3), (4, 5, 6), (7, 8, 9))
14882 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Record := (1, "Peter", True);
14883 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Record := (Name => "Peter", Id => 1, Alive => True)
14887 discriminant's value by assigning an aggregate has an
14888 undefined effect if that discriminant is used within the record.
14889 However, you can first modify discriminants by directly assigning to
14890 them (which normally would not be allowed in Ada), and then performing an
14891 aggregate assignment. For example, given a variable @code{A_Rec}
14892 declared to have a type such as:
14895 type Rec (Len : Small_Integer := 0) is record
14897 Vals : IntArray (1 .. Len);
14901 you can assign a value with a different size of @code{Vals} with two
14905 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Rec.Len := 4
14906 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Rec := (Id => 42, Vals => (1, 2, 3, 4))
14909 As this example also illustrates, @value{GDBN} is very loose about the usual
14910 rules concerning aggregates. You may leave out some of the
14911 components of an array or record aggregate (such as the @code{Len}
14912 component in the assignment to @code{A_Rec} above); they will retain their
14913 original values upon assignment. You may freely use dynamic values as
14914 indices in component associations. You may even use overlapping or
14915 redundant component associations, although which component values are
14916 assigned in such cases is not defined.
14919 Calls to dispatching subprograms are not implemented.
14922 The overloading algorithm is much more limited (i.e., less selective)
14923 than that of real Ada. It makes only limited use of the context in
14924 which a subexpression appears to resolve its meaning, and it is much
14925 looser in its rules for allowing type matches. As a result, some
14926 function calls will be ambiguous, and the user will be asked to choose
14927 the proper resolution.
14930 The @code{new} operator is not implemented.
14933 Entry calls are not implemented.
14936 Aside from printing, arithmetic operations on the native VAX floating-point
14937 formats are not supported.
14940 It is not possible to slice a packed array.
14943 The names @code{True} and @code{False}, when not part of a qualified name,
14944 are interpreted as if implicitly prefixed by @code{Standard}, regardless of
14946 Should your program
14947 redefine these names in a package or procedure (at best a dubious practice),
14948 you will have to use fully qualified names to access their new definitions.
14951 @node Additions to Ada
14952 @subsubsection Additions to Ada
14953 @cindex Ada, deviations from
14955 As it does for other languages, @value{GDBN} makes certain generic
14956 extensions to Ada (@pxref{Expressions}):
14960 If the expression @var{E} is a variable residing in memory (typically
14961 a local variable or array element) and @var{N} is a positive integer,
14962 then @code{@var{E}@@@var{N}} displays the values of @var{E} and the
14963 @var{N}-1 adjacent variables following it in memory as an array. In
14964 Ada, this operator is generally not necessary, since its prime use is
14965 in displaying parts of an array, and slicing will usually do this in
14966 Ada. However, there are occasional uses when debugging programs in
14967 which certain debugging information has been optimized away.
14970 @code{@var{B}::@var{var}} means ``the variable named @var{var} that
14971 appears in function or file @var{B}.'' When @var{B} is a file name,
14972 you must typically surround it in single quotes.
14975 The expression @code{@{@var{type}@} @var{addr}} means ``the variable of type
14976 @var{type} that appears at address @var{addr}.''
14979 A name starting with @samp{$} is a convenience variable
14980 (@pxref{Convenience Vars}) or a machine register (@pxref{Registers}).
14983 In addition, @value{GDBN} provides a few other shortcuts and outright
14984 additions specific to Ada:
14988 The assignment statement is allowed as an expression, returning
14989 its right-hand operand as its value. Thus, you may enter
14992 (@value{GDBP}) set x := y + 3
14993 (@value{GDBP}) print A(tmp := y + 1)
14997 The semicolon is allowed as an ``operator,'' returning as its value
14998 the value of its right-hand operand.
14999 This allows, for example,
15000 complex conditional breaks:
15003 (@value{GDBP}) break f
15004 (@value{GDBP}) condition 1 (report(i); k += 1; A(k) > 100)
15008 Rather than use catenation and symbolic character names to introduce special
15009 characters into strings, one may instead use a special bracket notation,
15010 which is also used to print strings. A sequence of characters of the form
15011 @samp{["@var{XX}"]} within a string or character literal denotes the
15012 (single) character whose numeric encoding is @var{XX} in hexadecimal. The
15013 sequence of characters @samp{["""]} also denotes a single quotation mark
15014 in strings. For example,
15016 "One line.["0a"]Next line.["0a"]"
15019 contains an ASCII newline character (@code{Ada.Characters.Latin_1.LF})
15023 The subtype used as a prefix for the attributes @t{'Pos}, @t{'Min}, and
15024 @t{'Max} is optional (and is ignored in any case). For example, it is valid
15028 (@value{GDBP}) print 'max(x, y)
15032 When printing arrays, @value{GDBN} uses positional notation when the
15033 array has a lower bound of 1, and uses a modified named notation otherwise.
15034 For example, a one-dimensional array of three integers with a lower bound
15035 of 3 might print as
15042 That is, in contrast to valid Ada, only the first component has a @code{=>}
15046 You may abbreviate attributes in expressions with any unique,
15047 multi-character subsequence of
15048 their names (an exact match gets preference).
15049 For example, you may use @t{a'len}, @t{a'gth}, or @t{a'lh}
15050 in place of @t{a'length}.
15053 @cindex quoting Ada internal identifiers
15054 Since Ada is case-insensitive, the debugger normally maps identifiers you type
15055 to lower case. The GNAT compiler uses upper-case characters for
15056 some of its internal identifiers, which are normally of no interest to users.
15057 For the rare occasions when you actually have to look at them,
15058 enclose them in angle brackets to avoid the lower-case mapping.
15061 (@value{GDBP}) print <JMPBUF_SAVE>[0]
15065 Printing an object of class-wide type or dereferencing an
15066 access-to-class-wide value will display all the components of the object's
15067 specific type (as indicated by its run-time tag). Likewise, component
15068 selection on such a value will operate on the specific type of the
15073 @node Stopping Before Main Program
15074 @subsubsection Stopping at the Very Beginning
15076 @cindex breakpointing Ada elaboration code
15077 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration, and
15078 before reaching the main procedure.
15079 As defined in the Ada Reference
15080 Manual, the elaboration code is invoked from a procedure called
15081 @code{adainit}. To run your program up to the beginning of
15082 elaboration, simply use the following two commands:
15083 @code{tbreak adainit} and @code{run}.
15086 @subsubsection Extensions for Ada Tasks
15087 @cindex Ada, tasking
15089 Support for Ada tasks is analogous to that for threads (@pxref{Threads}).
15090 @value{GDBN} provides the following task-related commands:
15095 This command shows a list of current Ada tasks, as in the following example:
15102 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
15103 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
15104 1 8088000 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
15105 2 80a4000 1 15 Accept Statement b
15106 3 809a800 1 15 Child Activation Wait a
15107 * 4 80ae800 3 15 Runnable c
15112 In this listing, the asterisk before the last task indicates it to be the
15113 task currently being inspected.
15117 Represents @value{GDBN}'s internal task number.
15123 The parent's task ID (@value{GDBN}'s internal task number).
15126 The base priority of the task.
15129 Current state of the task.
15133 The task has been created but has not been activated. It cannot be
15137 The task is not blocked for any reason known to Ada. (It may be waiting
15138 for a mutex, though.) It is conceptually "executing" in normal mode.
15141 The task is terminated, in the sense of ARM 9.3 (5). Any dependents
15142 that were waiting on terminate alternatives have been awakened and have
15143 terminated themselves.
15145 @item Child Activation Wait
15146 The task is waiting for created tasks to complete activation.
15148 @item Accept Statement
15149 The task is waiting on an accept or selective wait statement.
15151 @item Waiting on entry call
15152 The task is waiting on an entry call.
15154 @item Async Select Wait
15155 The task is waiting to start the abortable part of an asynchronous
15159 The task is waiting on a select statement with only a delay
15162 @item Child Termination Wait
15163 The task is sleeping having completed a master within itself, and is
15164 waiting for the tasks dependent on that master to become terminated or
15165 waiting on a terminate Phase.
15167 @item Wait Child in Term Alt
15168 The task is sleeping waiting for tasks on terminate alternatives to
15169 finish terminating.
15171 @item Accepting RV with @var{taskno}
15172 The task is accepting a rendez-vous with the task @var{taskno}.
15176 Name of the task in the program.
15180 @kindex info task @var{taskno}
15181 @item info task @var{taskno}
15182 This command shows detailled informations on the specified task, as in
15183 the following example:
15188 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
15189 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
15190 1 8077880 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
15191 * 2 807c468 1 15 Runnable task_1
15192 (@value{GDBP}) info task 2
15193 Ada Task: 0x807c468
15196 Parent: 1 (main_task)
15202 @kindex task@r{ (Ada)}
15203 @cindex current Ada task ID
15204 This command prints the ID of the current task.
15210 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
15211 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
15212 1 8077870 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
15213 * 2 807c458 1 15 Runnable t
15214 (@value{GDBP}) task
15215 [Current task is 2]
15218 @item task @var{taskno}
15219 @cindex Ada task switching
15220 This command is like the @code{thread @var{threadno}}
15221 command (@pxref{Threads}). It switches the context of debugging
15222 from the current task to the given task.
15228 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
15229 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
15230 1 8077870 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
15231 * 2 807c458 1 15 Runnable t
15232 (@value{GDBP}) task 1
15233 [Switching to task 1]
15234 #0 0x8067726 in pthread_cond_wait ()
15236 #0 0x8067726 in pthread_cond_wait ()
15237 #1 0x8056714 in system.os_interface.pthread_cond_wait ()
15238 #2 0x805cb63 in system.task_primitives.operations.sleep ()
15239 #3 0x806153e in system.tasking.stages.activate_tasks ()
15240 #4 0x804aacc in un () at un.adb:5
15243 @item break @var{linespec} task @var{taskno}
15244 @itemx break @var{linespec} task @var{taskno} if @dots{}
15245 @cindex breakpoints and tasks, in Ada
15246 @cindex task breakpoints, in Ada
15247 @kindex break @dots{} task @var{taskno}@r{ (Ada)}
15248 These commands are like the @code{break @dots{} thread @dots{}}
15249 command (@pxref{Thread Stops}).
15250 @var{linespec} specifies source lines, as described
15251 in @ref{Specify Location}.
15253 Use the qualifier @samp{task @var{taskno}} with a breakpoint command
15254 to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
15255 particular Ada task reaches this breakpoint. @var{taskno} is one of the
15256 numeric task identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown in the first
15257 column of the @samp{info tasks} display.
15259 If you do not specify @samp{task @var{taskno}} when you set a
15260 breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} tasks of your
15263 You can use the @code{task} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
15264 well; in this case, place @samp{task @var{taskno}} before the
15265 breakpoint condition (before the @code{if}).
15273 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
15274 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
15275 1 140022020 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
15276 2 140045060 1 15 Accept/Select Wait t2
15277 3 140044840 1 15 Runnable t1
15278 * 4 140056040 1 15 Runnable t3
15279 (@value{GDBP}) b 15 task 2
15280 Breakpoint 5 at 0x120044cb0: file test_task_debug.adb, line 15.
15281 (@value{GDBP}) cont
15286 Breakpoint 5, test_task_debug () at test_task_debug.adb:15
15288 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
15289 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
15290 1 140022020 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
15291 * 2 140045060 1 15 Runnable t2
15292 3 140044840 1 15 Runnable t1
15293 4 140056040 1 15 Delay Sleep t3
15297 @node Ada Tasks and Core Files
15298 @subsubsection Tasking Support when Debugging Core Files
15299 @cindex Ada tasking and core file debugging
15301 When inspecting a core file, as opposed to debugging a live program,
15302 tasking support may be limited or even unavailable, depending on
15303 the platform being used.
15304 For instance, on x86-linux, the list of tasks is available, but task
15305 switching is not supported. On Tru64, however, task switching will work
15308 On certain platforms, including Tru64, the debugger needs to perform some
15309 memory writes in order to provide Ada tasking support. When inspecting
15310 a core file, this means that the core file must be opened with read-write
15311 privileges, using the command @samp{"set write on"} (@pxref{Patching}).
15312 Under these circumstances, you should make a backup copy of the core
15313 file before inspecting it with @value{GDBN}.
15315 @node Ravenscar Profile
15316 @subsubsection Tasking Support when using the Ravenscar Profile
15317 @cindex Ravenscar Profile
15319 The @dfn{Ravenscar Profile} is a subset of the Ada tasking features,
15320 specifically designed for systems with safety-critical real-time
15324 @kindex set ravenscar task-switching on
15325 @cindex task switching with program using Ravenscar Profile
15326 @item set ravenscar task-switching on
15327 Allows task switching when debugging a program that uses the Ravenscar
15328 Profile. This is the default.
15330 @kindex set ravenscar task-switching off
15331 @item set ravenscar task-switching off
15332 Turn off task switching when debugging a program that uses the Ravenscar
15333 Profile. This is mostly intended to disable the code that adds support
15334 for the Ravenscar Profile, in case a bug in either @value{GDBN} or in
15335 the Ravenscar runtime is preventing @value{GDBN} from working properly.
15336 To be effective, this command should be run before the program is started.
15338 @kindex show ravenscar task-switching
15339 @item show ravenscar task-switching
15340 Show whether it is possible to switch from task to task in a program
15341 using the Ravenscar Profile.
15346 @subsubsection Known Peculiarities of Ada Mode
15347 @cindex Ada, problems
15349 Besides the omissions listed previously (@pxref{Omissions from Ada}),
15350 we know of several problems with and limitations of Ada mode in
15352 some of which will be fixed with planned future releases of the debugger
15353 and the GNU Ada compiler.
15357 Static constants that the compiler chooses not to materialize as objects in
15358 storage are invisible to the debugger.
15361 Named parameter associations in function argument lists are ignored (the
15362 argument lists are treated as positional).
15365 Many useful library packages are currently invisible to the debugger.
15368 Fixed-point arithmetic, conversions, input, and output is carried out using
15369 floating-point arithmetic, and may give results that only approximate those on
15373 The GNAT compiler never generates the prefix @code{Standard} for any of
15374 the standard symbols defined by the Ada language. @value{GDBN} knows about
15375 this: it will strip the prefix from names when you use it, and will never
15376 look for a name you have so qualified among local symbols, nor match against
15377 symbols in other packages or subprograms. If you have
15378 defined entities anywhere in your program other than parameters and
15379 local variables whose simple names match names in @code{Standard},
15380 GNAT's lack of qualification here can cause confusion. When this happens,
15381 you can usually resolve the confusion
15382 by qualifying the problematic names with package
15383 @code{Standard} explicitly.
15386 Older versions of the compiler sometimes generate erroneous debugging
15387 information, resulting in the debugger incorrectly printing the value
15388 of affected entities. In some cases, the debugger is able to work
15389 around an issue automatically. In other cases, the debugger is able
15390 to work around the issue, but the work-around has to be specifically
15393 @kindex set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS
15394 @kindex show ada trust-PAD-over-XVS
15397 @item set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS on
15398 Configure GDB to strictly follow the GNAT encoding when computing the
15399 value of Ada entities, particularly when @code{PAD} and @code{PAD___XVS}
15400 types are involved (see @code{ada/exp_dbug.ads} in the GCC sources for
15401 a complete description of the encoding used by the GNAT compiler).
15402 This is the default.
15404 @item set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS off
15405 This is related to the encoding using by the GNAT compiler. If @value{GDBN}
15406 sometimes prints the wrong value for certain entities, changing @code{ada
15407 trust-PAD-over-XVS} to @code{off} activates a work-around which may fix
15408 the issue. It is always safe to set @code{ada trust-PAD-over-XVS} to
15409 @code{off}, but this incurs a slight performance penalty, so it is
15410 recommended to leave this setting to @code{on} unless necessary.
15414 @node Unsupported Languages
15415 @section Unsupported Languages
15417 @cindex unsupported languages
15418 @cindex minimal language
15419 In addition to the other fully-supported programming languages,
15420 @value{GDBN} also provides a pseudo-language, called @code{minimal}.
15421 It does not represent a real programming language, but provides a set
15422 of capabilities close to what the C or assembly languages provide.
15423 This should allow most simple operations to be performed while debugging
15424 an application that uses a language currently not supported by @value{GDBN}.
15426 If the language is set to @code{auto}, @value{GDBN} will automatically
15427 select this language if the current frame corresponds to an unsupported
15431 @chapter Examining the Symbol Table
15433 The commands described in this chapter allow you to inquire about the
15434 symbols (names of variables, functions and types) defined in your
15435 program. This information is inherent in the text of your program and
15436 does not change as your program executes. @value{GDBN} finds it in your
15437 program's symbol table, in the file indicated when you started @value{GDBN}
15438 (@pxref{File Options, ,Choosing Files}), or by one of the
15439 file-management commands (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
15441 @cindex symbol names
15442 @cindex names of symbols
15443 @cindex quoting names
15444 Occasionally, you may need to refer to symbols that contain unusual
15445 characters, which @value{GDBN} ordinarily treats as word delimiters. The
15446 most frequent case is in referring to static variables in other
15447 source files (@pxref{Variables,,Program Variables}). File names
15448 are recorded in object files as debugging symbols, but @value{GDBN} would
15449 ordinarily parse a typical file name, like @file{foo.c}, as the three words
15450 @samp{foo} @samp{.} @samp{c}. To allow @value{GDBN} to recognize
15451 @samp{foo.c} as a single symbol, enclose it in single quotes; for example,
15458 looks up the value of @code{x} in the scope of the file @file{foo.c}.
15461 @cindex case-insensitive symbol names
15462 @cindex case sensitivity in symbol names
15463 @kindex set case-sensitive
15464 @item set case-sensitive on
15465 @itemx set case-sensitive off
15466 @itemx set case-sensitive auto
15467 Normally, when @value{GDBN} looks up symbols, it matches their names
15468 with case sensitivity determined by the current source language.
15469 Occasionally, you may wish to control that. The command @code{set
15470 case-sensitive} lets you do that by specifying @code{on} for
15471 case-sensitive matches or @code{off} for case-insensitive ones. If
15472 you specify @code{auto}, case sensitivity is reset to the default
15473 suitable for the source language. The default is case-sensitive
15474 matches for all languages except for Fortran, for which the default is
15475 case-insensitive matches.
15477 @kindex show case-sensitive
15478 @item show case-sensitive
15479 This command shows the current setting of case sensitivity for symbols
15482 @kindex set print type methods
15483 @item set print type methods
15484 @itemx set print type methods on
15485 @itemx set print type methods off
15486 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a class, it displays any methods
15487 declared in that class. You can control this behavior either by
15488 passing the appropriate flag to @code{ptype}, or using @command{set
15489 print type methods}. Specifying @code{on} will cause @value{GDBN} to
15490 display the methods; this is the default. Specifying @code{off} will
15491 cause @value{GDBN} to omit the methods.
15493 @kindex show print type methods
15494 @item show print type methods
15495 This command shows the current setting of method display when printing
15498 @kindex set print type typedefs
15499 @item set print type typedefs
15500 @itemx set print type typedefs on
15501 @itemx set print type typedefs off
15503 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a class, it displays any typedefs
15504 defined in that class. You can control this behavior either by
15505 passing the appropriate flag to @code{ptype}, or using @command{set
15506 print type typedefs}. Specifying @code{on} will cause @value{GDBN} to
15507 display the typedef definitions; this is the default. Specifying
15508 @code{off} will cause @value{GDBN} to omit the typedef definitions.
15509 Note that this controls whether the typedef definition itself is
15510 printed, not whether typedef names are substituted when printing other
15513 @kindex show print type typedefs
15514 @item show print type typedefs
15515 This command shows the current setting of typedef display when
15518 @kindex info address
15519 @cindex address of a symbol
15520 @item info address @var{symbol}
15521 Describe where the data for @var{symbol} is stored. For a register
15522 variable, this says which register it is kept in. For a non-register
15523 local variable, this prints the stack-frame offset at which the variable
15526 Note the contrast with @samp{print &@var{symbol}}, which does not work
15527 at all for a register variable, and for a stack local variable prints
15528 the exact address of the current instantiation of the variable.
15530 @kindex info symbol
15531 @cindex symbol from address
15532 @cindex closest symbol and offset for an address
15533 @item info symbol @var{addr}
15534 Print the name of a symbol which is stored at the address @var{addr}.
15535 If no symbol is stored exactly at @var{addr}, @value{GDBN} prints the
15536 nearest symbol and an offset from it:
15539 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x54320
15540 _initialize_vx + 396 in section .text
15544 This is the opposite of the @code{info address} command. You can use
15545 it to find out the name of a variable or a function given its address.
15547 For dynamically linked executables, the name of executable or shared
15548 library containing the symbol is also printed:
15551 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x400225
15552 _start + 5 in section .text of /tmp/a.out
15553 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x2aaaac2811cf
15554 __read_nocancel + 6 in section .text of /usr/lib64/libc.so.6
15558 @item whatis[/@var{flags}] [@var{arg}]
15559 Print the data type of @var{arg}, which can be either an expression
15560 or a name of a data type. With no argument, print the data type of
15561 @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
15563 If @var{arg} is an expression (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), it
15564 is not actually evaluated, and any side-effecting operations (such as
15565 assignments or function calls) inside it do not take place.
15567 If @var{arg} is a variable or an expression, @code{whatis} prints its
15568 literal type as it is used in the source code. If the type was
15569 defined using a @code{typedef}, @code{whatis} will @emph{not} print
15570 the data type underlying the @code{typedef}. If the type of the
15571 variable or the expression is a compound data type, such as
15572 @code{struct} or @code{class}, @code{whatis} never prints their
15573 fields or methods. It just prints the @code{struct}/@code{class}
15574 name (a.k.a.@: its @dfn{tag}). If you want to see the members of
15575 such a compound data type, use @code{ptype}.
15577 If @var{arg} is a type name that was defined using @code{typedef},
15578 @code{whatis} @dfn{unrolls} only one level of that @code{typedef}.
15579 Unrolling means that @code{whatis} will show the underlying type used
15580 in the @code{typedef} declaration of @var{arg}. However, if that
15581 underlying type is also a @code{typedef}, @code{whatis} will not
15584 For C code, the type names may also have the form @samp{class
15585 @var{class-name}}, @samp{struct @var{struct-tag}}, @samp{union
15586 @var{union-tag}} or @samp{enum @var{enum-tag}}.
15588 @var{flags} can be used to modify how the type is displayed.
15589 Available flags are:
15593 Display in ``raw'' form. Normally, @value{GDBN} substitutes template
15594 parameters and typedefs defined in a class when printing the class'
15595 members. The @code{/r} flag disables this.
15598 Do not print methods defined in the class.
15601 Print methods defined in the class. This is the default, but the flag
15602 exists in case you change the default with @command{set print type methods}.
15605 Do not print typedefs defined in the class. Note that this controls
15606 whether the typedef definition itself is printed, not whether typedef
15607 names are substituted when printing other types.
15610 Print typedefs defined in the class. This is the default, but the flag
15611 exists in case you change the default with @command{set print type typedefs}.
15615 @item ptype[/@var{flags}] [@var{arg}]
15616 @code{ptype} accepts the same arguments as @code{whatis}, but prints a
15617 detailed description of the type, instead of just the name of the type.
15618 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
15620 Contrary to @code{whatis}, @code{ptype} always unrolls any
15621 @code{typedef}s in its argument declaration, whether the argument is
15622 a variable, expression, or a data type. This means that @code{ptype}
15623 of a variable or an expression will not print literally its type as
15624 present in the source code---use @code{whatis} for that. @code{typedef}s at
15625 the pointer or reference targets are also unrolled. Only @code{typedef}s of
15626 fields, methods and inner @code{class typedef}s of @code{struct}s,
15627 @code{class}es and @code{union}s are not unrolled even with @code{ptype}.
15629 For example, for this variable declaration:
15632 typedef double real_t;
15633 struct complex @{ real_t real; double imag; @};
15634 typedef struct complex complex_t;
15636 real_t *real_pointer_var;
15640 the two commands give this output:
15644 (@value{GDBP}) whatis var
15646 (@value{GDBP}) ptype var
15647 type = struct complex @{
15651 (@value{GDBP}) whatis complex_t
15652 type = struct complex
15653 (@value{GDBP}) whatis struct complex
15654 type = struct complex
15655 (@value{GDBP}) ptype struct complex
15656 type = struct complex @{
15660 (@value{GDBP}) whatis real_pointer_var
15662 (@value{GDBP}) ptype real_pointer_var
15668 As with @code{whatis}, using @code{ptype} without an argument refers to
15669 the type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
15671 @cindex incomplete type
15672 Sometimes, programs use opaque data types or incomplete specifications
15673 of complex data structure. If the debug information included in the
15674 program does not allow @value{GDBN} to display a full declaration of
15675 the data type, it will say @samp{<incomplete type>}. For example,
15676 given these declarations:
15680 struct foo *fooptr;
15684 but no definition for @code{struct foo} itself, @value{GDBN} will say:
15687 (@value{GDBP}) ptype foo
15688 $1 = <incomplete type>
15692 ``Incomplete type'' is C terminology for data types that are not
15693 completely specified.
15696 @item info types @var{regexp}
15698 Print a brief description of all types whose names match the regular
15699 expression @var{regexp} (or all types in your program, if you supply
15700 no argument). Each complete typename is matched as though it were a
15701 complete line; thus, @samp{i type value} gives information on all
15702 types in your program whose names include the string @code{value}, but
15703 @samp{i type ^value$} gives information only on types whose complete
15704 name is @code{value}.
15706 This command differs from @code{ptype} in two ways: first, like
15707 @code{whatis}, it does not print a detailed description; second, it
15708 lists all source files where a type is defined.
15710 @kindex info type-printers
15711 @item info type-printers
15712 Versions of @value{GDBN} that ship with Python scripting enabled may
15713 have ``type printers'' available. When using @command{ptype} or
15714 @command{whatis}, these printers are consulted when the name of a type
15715 is needed. @xref{Type Printing API}, for more information on writing
15718 @code{info type-printers} displays all the available type printers.
15720 @kindex enable type-printer
15721 @kindex disable type-printer
15722 @item enable type-printer @var{name}@dots{}
15723 @item disable type-printer @var{name}@dots{}
15724 These commands can be used to enable or disable type printers.
15727 @cindex local variables
15728 @item info scope @var{location}
15729 List all the variables local to a particular scope. This command
15730 accepts a @var{location} argument---a function name, a source line, or
15731 an address preceded by a @samp{*}, and prints all the variables local
15732 to the scope defined by that location. (@xref{Specify Location}, for
15733 details about supported forms of @var{location}.) For example:
15736 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info scope command_line_handler}
15737 Scope for command_line_handler:
15738 Symbol rl is an argument at stack/frame offset 8, length 4.
15739 Symbol linebuffer is in static storage at address 0x150a18, length 4.
15740 Symbol linelength is in static storage at address 0x150a1c, length 4.
15741 Symbol p is a local variable in register $esi, length 4.
15742 Symbol p1 is a local variable in register $ebx, length 4.
15743 Symbol nline is a local variable in register $edx, length 4.
15744 Symbol repeat is a local variable at frame offset -8, length 4.
15748 This command is especially useful for determining what data to collect
15749 during a @dfn{trace experiment}, see @ref{Tracepoint Actions,
15752 @kindex info source
15754 Show information about the current source file---that is, the source file for
15755 the function containing the current point of execution:
15758 the name of the source file, and the directory containing it,
15760 the directory it was compiled in,
15762 its length, in lines,
15764 which programming language it is written in,
15766 whether the executable includes debugging information for that file, and
15767 if so, what format the information is in (e.g., STABS, Dwarf 2, etc.), and
15769 whether the debugging information includes information about
15770 preprocessor macros.
15774 @kindex info sources
15776 Print the names of all source files in your program for which there is
15777 debugging information, organized into two lists: files whose symbols
15778 have already been read, and files whose symbols will be read when needed.
15780 @kindex info functions
15781 @item info functions
15782 Print the names and data types of all defined functions.
15784 @item info functions @var{regexp}
15785 Print the names and data types of all defined functions
15786 whose names contain a match for regular expression @var{regexp}.
15787 Thus, @samp{info fun step} finds all functions whose names
15788 include @code{step}; @samp{info fun ^step} finds those whose names
15789 start with @code{step}. If a function name contains characters
15790 that conflict with the regular expression language (e.g.@:
15791 @samp{operator*()}), they may be quoted with a backslash.
15793 @kindex info variables
15794 @item info variables
15795 Print the names and data types of all variables that are defined
15796 outside of functions (i.e.@: excluding local variables).
15798 @item info variables @var{regexp}
15799 Print the names and data types of all variables (except for local
15800 variables) whose names contain a match for regular expression
15803 @kindex info classes
15804 @cindex Objective-C, classes and selectors
15806 @itemx info classes @var{regexp}
15807 Display all Objective-C classes in your program, or
15808 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
15811 @kindex info selectors
15812 @item info selectors
15813 @itemx info selectors @var{regexp}
15814 Display all Objective-C selectors in your program, or
15815 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
15819 This was never implemented.
15820 @kindex info methods
15822 @itemx info methods @var{regexp}
15823 The @code{info methods} command permits the user to examine all defined
15824 methods within C@t{++} program, or (with the @var{regexp} argument) a
15825 specific set of methods found in the various C@t{++} classes. Many
15826 C@t{++} classes provide a large number of methods. Thus, the output
15827 from the @code{ptype} command can be overwhelming and hard to use. The
15828 @code{info-methods} command filters the methods, printing only those
15829 which match the regular-expression @var{regexp}.
15832 @cindex opaque data types
15833 @kindex set opaque-type-resolution
15834 @item set opaque-type-resolution on
15835 Tell @value{GDBN} to resolve opaque types. An opaque type is a type
15836 declared as a pointer to a @code{struct}, @code{class}, or
15837 @code{union}---for example, @code{struct MyType *}---that is used in one
15838 source file although the full declaration of @code{struct MyType} is in
15839 another source file. The default is on.
15841 A change in the setting of this subcommand will not take effect until
15842 the next time symbols for a file are loaded.
15844 @item set opaque-type-resolution off
15845 Tell @value{GDBN} not to resolve opaque types. In this case, the type
15846 is printed as follows:
15848 @{<no data fields>@}
15851 @kindex show opaque-type-resolution
15852 @item show opaque-type-resolution
15853 Show whether opaque types are resolved or not.
15855 @kindex maint print symbols
15856 @cindex symbol dump
15857 @kindex maint print psymbols
15858 @cindex partial symbol dump
15859 @item maint print symbols @var{filename}
15860 @itemx maint print psymbols @var{filename}
15861 @itemx maint print msymbols @var{filename}
15862 Write a dump of debugging symbol data into the file @var{filename}.
15863 These commands are used to debug the @value{GDBN} symbol-reading code. Only
15864 symbols with debugging data are included. If you use @samp{maint print
15865 symbols}, @value{GDBN} includes all the symbols for which it has already
15866 collected full details: that is, @var{filename} reflects symbols for
15867 only those files whose symbols @value{GDBN} has read. You can use the
15868 command @code{info sources} to find out which files these are. If you
15869 use @samp{maint print psymbols} instead, the dump shows information about
15870 symbols that @value{GDBN} only knows partially---that is, symbols defined in
15871 files that @value{GDBN} has skimmed, but not yet read completely. Finally,
15872 @samp{maint print msymbols} dumps just the minimal symbol information
15873 required for each object file from which @value{GDBN} has read some symbols.
15874 @xref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}, for a discussion of how
15875 @value{GDBN} reads symbols (in the description of @code{symbol-file}).
15877 @kindex maint info symtabs
15878 @kindex maint info psymtabs
15879 @cindex listing @value{GDBN}'s internal symbol tables
15880 @cindex symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
15881 @cindex full symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
15882 @cindex partial symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
15883 @item maint info symtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
15884 @itemx maint info psymtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
15886 List the @code{struct symtab} or @code{struct partial_symtab}
15887 structures whose names match @var{regexp}. If @var{regexp} is not
15888 given, list them all. The output includes expressions which you can
15889 copy into a @value{GDBN} debugging this one to examine a particular
15890 structure in more detail. For example:
15893 (@value{GDBP}) maint info psymtabs dwarf2read
15894 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
15895 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
15896 @{ psymtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
15897 ((struct partial_symtab *) 0x8474b10)
15900 text addresses 0x814d3c8 -- 0x8158074
15901 globals (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x8507a08 @@ 9)
15902 statics (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x40e95b78 @@ 2882)
15903 dependencies (none)
15906 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
15910 We see that there is one partial symbol table whose filename contains
15911 the string @samp{dwarf2read}, belonging to the @samp{gdb} executable;
15912 and we see that @value{GDBN} has not read in any symtabs yet at all.
15913 If we set a breakpoint on a function, that will cause @value{GDBN} to
15914 read the symtab for the compilation unit containing that function:
15917 (@value{GDBP}) break dwarf2_psymtab_to_symtab
15918 Breakpoint 1 at 0x814e5da: file /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c,
15920 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
15921 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
15922 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
15923 @{ symtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
15924 ((struct symtab *) 0x86c1f38)
15927 blockvector ((struct blockvector *) 0x86c1bd0) (primary)
15928 linetable ((struct linetable *) 0x8370fa0)
15929 debugformat DWARF 2
15938 @chapter Altering Execution
15940 Once you think you have found an error in your program, you might want to
15941 find out for certain whether correcting the apparent error would lead to
15942 correct results in the rest of the run. You can find the answer by
15943 experiment, using the @value{GDBN} features for altering execution of the
15946 For example, you can store new values into variables or memory
15947 locations, give your program a signal, restart it at a different
15948 address, or even return prematurely from a function.
15951 * Assignment:: Assignment to variables
15952 * Jumping:: Continuing at a different address
15953 * Signaling:: Giving your program a signal
15954 * Returning:: Returning from a function
15955 * Calling:: Calling your program's functions
15956 * Patching:: Patching your program
15960 @section Assignment to Variables
15963 @cindex setting variables
15964 To alter the value of a variable, evaluate an assignment expression.
15965 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}. For example,
15972 stores the value 4 into the variable @code{x}, and then prints the
15973 value of the assignment expression (which is 4).
15974 @xref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages}, for more
15975 information on operators in supported languages.
15977 @kindex set variable
15978 @cindex variables, setting
15979 If you are not interested in seeing the value of the assignment, use the
15980 @code{set} command instead of the @code{print} command. @code{set} is
15981 really the same as @code{print} except that the expression's value is
15982 not printed and is not put in the value history (@pxref{Value History,
15983 ,Value History}). The expression is evaluated only for its effects.
15985 If the beginning of the argument string of the @code{set} command
15986 appears identical to a @code{set} subcommand, use the @code{set
15987 variable} command instead of just @code{set}. This command is identical
15988 to @code{set} except for its lack of subcommands. For example, if your
15989 program has a variable @code{width}, you get an error if you try to set
15990 a new value with just @samp{set width=13}, because @value{GDBN} has the
15991 command @code{set width}:
15994 (@value{GDBP}) whatis width
15996 (@value{GDBP}) p width
15998 (@value{GDBP}) set width=47
15999 Invalid syntax in expression.
16003 The invalid expression, of course, is @samp{=47}. In
16004 order to actually set the program's variable @code{width}, use
16007 (@value{GDBP}) set var width=47
16010 Because the @code{set} command has many subcommands that can conflict
16011 with the names of program variables, it is a good idea to use the
16012 @code{set variable} command instead of just @code{set}. For example, if
16013 your program has a variable @code{g}, you run into problems if you try
16014 to set a new value with just @samp{set g=4}, because @value{GDBN} has
16015 the command @code{set gnutarget}, abbreviated @code{set g}:
16019 (@value{GDBP}) whatis g
16023 (@value{GDBP}) set g=4
16027 The program being debugged has been started already.
16028 Start it from the beginning? (y or n) y
16029 Starting program: /home/smith/cc_progs/a.out
16030 "/home/smith/cc_progs/a.out": can't open to read symbols:
16031 Invalid bfd target.
16032 (@value{GDBP}) show g
16033 The current BFD target is "=4".
16038 The program variable @code{g} did not change, and you silently set the
16039 @code{gnutarget} to an invalid value. In order to set the variable
16043 (@value{GDBP}) set var g=4
16046 @value{GDBN} allows more implicit conversions in assignments than C; you can
16047 freely store an integer value into a pointer variable or vice versa,
16048 and you can convert any structure to any other structure that is the
16049 same length or shorter.
16050 @comment FIXME: how do structs align/pad in these conversions?
16051 @comment /doc@cygnus.com 18dec1990
16053 To store values into arbitrary places in memory, use the @samp{@{@dots{}@}}
16054 construct to generate a value of specified type at a specified address
16055 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). For example, @code{@{int@}0x83040} refers
16056 to memory location @code{0x83040} as an integer (which implies a certain size
16057 and representation in memory), and
16060 set @{int@}0x83040 = 4
16064 stores the value 4 into that memory location.
16067 @section Continuing at a Different Address
16069 Ordinarily, when you continue your program, you do so at the place where
16070 it stopped, with the @code{continue} command. You can instead continue at
16071 an address of your own choosing, with the following commands:
16075 @kindex j @r{(@code{jump})}
16076 @item jump @var{linespec}
16077 @itemx j @var{linespec}
16078 @itemx jump @var{location}
16079 @itemx j @var{location}
16080 Resume execution at line @var{linespec} or at address given by
16081 @var{location}. Execution stops again immediately if there is a
16082 breakpoint there. @xref{Specify Location}, for a description of the
16083 different forms of @var{linespec} and @var{location}. It is common
16084 practice to use the @code{tbreak} command in conjunction with
16085 @code{jump}. @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}.
16087 The @code{jump} command does not change the current stack frame, or
16088 the stack pointer, or the contents of any memory location or any
16089 register other than the program counter. If line @var{linespec} is in
16090 a different function from the one currently executing, the results may
16091 be bizarre if the two functions expect different patterns of arguments or
16092 of local variables. For this reason, the @code{jump} command requests
16093 confirmation if the specified line is not in the function currently
16094 executing. However, even bizarre results are predictable if you are
16095 well acquainted with the machine-language code of your program.
16098 @c Doesn't work on HP-UX; have to set $pcoqh and $pcoqt.
16099 On many systems, you can get much the same effect as the @code{jump}
16100 command by storing a new value into the register @code{$pc}. The
16101 difference is that this does not start your program running; it only
16102 changes the address of where it @emph{will} run when you continue. For
16110 makes the next @code{continue} command or stepping command execute at
16111 address @code{0x485}, rather than at the address where your program stopped.
16112 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}.
16114 The most common occasion to use the @code{jump} command is to back
16115 up---perhaps with more breakpoints set---over a portion of a program
16116 that has already executed, in order to examine its execution in more
16121 @section Giving your Program a Signal
16122 @cindex deliver a signal to a program
16126 @item signal @var{signal}
16127 Resume execution where your program stopped, but immediately give it the
16128 signal @var{signal}. @var{signal} can be the name or the number of a
16129 signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and @code{signal
16130 SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
16132 Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, continue execution without
16133 giving a signal. This is useful when your program stopped on account of
16134 a signal and would ordinarily see the signal when resumed with the
16135 @code{continue} command; @samp{signal 0} causes it to resume without a
16138 @code{signal} does not repeat when you press @key{RET} a second time
16139 after executing the command.
16143 Invoking the @code{signal} command is not the same as invoking the
16144 @code{kill} utility from the shell. Sending a signal with @code{kill}
16145 causes @value{GDBN} to decide what to do with the signal depending on
16146 the signal handling tables (@pxref{Signals}). The @code{signal} command
16147 passes the signal directly to your program.
16151 @section Returning from a Function
16154 @cindex returning from a function
16157 @itemx return @var{expression}
16158 You can cancel execution of a function call with the @code{return}
16159 command. If you give an
16160 @var{expression} argument, its value is used as the function's return
16164 When you use @code{return}, @value{GDBN} discards the selected stack frame
16165 (and all frames within it). You can think of this as making the
16166 discarded frame return prematurely. If you wish to specify a value to
16167 be returned, give that value as the argument to @code{return}.
16169 This pops the selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a
16170 Frame}), and any other frames inside of it, leaving its caller as the
16171 innermost remaining frame. That frame becomes selected. The
16172 specified value is stored in the registers used for returning values
16175 The @code{return} command does not resume execution; it leaves the
16176 program stopped in the state that would exist if the function had just
16177 returned. In contrast, the @code{finish} command (@pxref{Continuing
16178 and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}) resumes execution until the
16179 selected stack frame returns naturally.
16181 @value{GDBN} needs to know how the @var{expression} argument should be set for
16182 the inferior. The concrete registers assignment depends on the OS ABI and the
16183 type being returned by the selected stack frame. For example it is common for
16184 OS ABI to return floating point values in FPU registers while integer values in
16185 CPU registers. Still some ABIs return even floating point values in CPU
16186 registers. Larger integer widths (such as @code{long long int}) also have
16187 specific placement rules. @value{GDBN} already knows the OS ABI from its
16188 current target so it needs to find out also the type being returned to make the
16189 assignment into the right register(s).
16191 Normally, the selected stack frame has debug info. @value{GDBN} will always
16192 use the debug info instead of the implicit type of @var{expression} when the
16193 debug info is available. For example, if you type @kbd{return -1}, and the
16194 function in the current stack frame is declared to return a @code{long long
16195 int}, @value{GDBN} transparently converts the implicit @code{int} value of -1
16196 into a @code{long long int}:
16199 Breakpoint 1, func () at gdb.base/return-nodebug.c:29
16201 (@value{GDBP}) return -1
16202 Make func return now? (y or n) y
16203 #0 0x004004f6 in main () at gdb.base/return-nodebug.c:43
16204 43 printf ("result=%lld\n", func ());
16208 However, if the selected stack frame does not have a debug info, e.g., if the
16209 function was compiled without debug info, @value{GDBN} has to find out the type
16210 to return from user. Specifying a different type by mistake may set the value
16211 in different inferior registers than the caller code expects. For example,
16212 typing @kbd{return -1} with its implicit type @code{int} would set only a part
16213 of a @code{long long int} result for a debug info less function (on 32-bit
16214 architectures). Therefore the user is required to specify the return type by
16215 an appropriate cast explicitly:
16218 Breakpoint 2, 0x0040050b in func ()
16219 (@value{GDBP}) return -1
16220 Return value type not available for selected stack frame.
16221 Please use an explicit cast of the value to return.
16222 (@value{GDBP}) return (long long int) -1
16223 Make selected stack frame return now? (y or n) y
16224 #0 0x00400526 in main ()
16229 @section Calling Program Functions
16232 @cindex calling functions
16233 @cindex inferior functions, calling
16234 @item print @var{expr}
16235 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} and display the resulting value.
16236 @var{expr} may include calls to functions in the program being
16240 @item call @var{expr}
16241 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} without displaying @code{void}
16244 You can use this variant of the @code{print} command if you want to
16245 execute a function from your program that does not return anything
16246 (a.k.a.@: @dfn{a void function}), but without cluttering the output
16247 with @code{void} returned values that @value{GDBN} will otherwise
16248 print. If the result is not void, it is printed and saved in the
16252 It is possible for the function you call via the @code{print} or
16253 @code{call} command to generate a signal (e.g., if there's a bug in
16254 the function, or if you passed it incorrect arguments). What happens
16255 in that case is controlled by the @code{set unwindonsignal} command.
16257 Similarly, with a C@t{++} program it is possible for the function you
16258 call via the @code{print} or @code{call} command to generate an
16259 exception that is not handled due to the constraints of the dummy
16260 frame. In this case, any exception that is raised in the frame, but has
16261 an out-of-frame exception handler will not be found. GDB builds a
16262 dummy-frame for the inferior function call, and the unwinder cannot
16263 seek for exception handlers outside of this dummy-frame. What happens
16264 in that case is controlled by the
16265 @code{set unwind-on-terminating-exception} command.
16268 @item set unwindonsignal
16269 @kindex set unwindonsignal
16270 @cindex unwind stack in called functions
16271 @cindex call dummy stack unwinding
16272 Set unwinding of the stack if a signal is received while in a function
16273 that @value{GDBN} called in the program being debugged. If set to on,
16274 @value{GDBN} unwinds the stack it created for the call and restores
16275 the context to what it was before the call. If set to off (the
16276 default), @value{GDBN} stops in the frame where the signal was
16279 @item show unwindonsignal
16280 @kindex show unwindonsignal
16281 Show the current setting of stack unwinding in the functions called by
16284 @item set unwind-on-terminating-exception
16285 @kindex set unwind-on-terminating-exception
16286 @cindex unwind stack in called functions with unhandled exceptions
16287 @cindex call dummy stack unwinding on unhandled exception.
16288 Set unwinding of the stack if a C@t{++} exception is raised, but left
16289 unhandled while in a function that @value{GDBN} called in the program being
16290 debugged. If set to on (the default), @value{GDBN} unwinds the stack
16291 it created for the call and restores the context to what it was before
16292 the call. If set to off, @value{GDBN} the exception is delivered to
16293 the default C@t{++} exception handler and the inferior terminated.
16295 @item show unwind-on-terminating-exception
16296 @kindex show unwind-on-terminating-exception
16297 Show the current setting of stack unwinding in the functions called by
16302 @cindex weak alias functions
16303 Sometimes, a function you wish to call is actually a @dfn{weak alias}
16304 for another function. In such case, @value{GDBN} might not pick up
16305 the type information, including the types of the function arguments,
16306 which causes @value{GDBN} to call the inferior function incorrectly.
16307 As a result, the called function will function erroneously and may
16308 even crash. A solution to that is to use the name of the aliased
16312 @section Patching Programs
16314 @cindex patching binaries
16315 @cindex writing into executables
16316 @cindex writing into corefiles
16318 By default, @value{GDBN} opens the file containing your program's
16319 executable code (or the corefile) read-only. This prevents accidental
16320 alterations to machine code; but it also prevents you from intentionally
16321 patching your program's binary.
16323 If you'd like to be able to patch the binary, you can specify that
16324 explicitly with the @code{set write} command. For example, you might
16325 want to turn on internal debugging flags, or even to make emergency
16331 @itemx set write off
16332 If you specify @samp{set write on}, @value{GDBN} opens executable and
16333 core files for both reading and writing; if you specify @kbd{set write
16334 off} (the default), @value{GDBN} opens them read-only.
16336 If you have already loaded a file, you must load it again (using the
16337 @code{exec-file} or @code{core-file} command) after changing @code{set
16338 write}, for your new setting to take effect.
16342 Display whether executable files and core files are opened for writing
16343 as well as reading.
16347 @chapter @value{GDBN} Files
16349 @value{GDBN} needs to know the file name of the program to be debugged,
16350 both in order to read its symbol table and in order to start your
16351 program. To debug a core dump of a previous run, you must also tell
16352 @value{GDBN} the name of the core dump file.
16355 * Files:: Commands to specify files
16356 * Separate Debug Files:: Debugging information in separate files
16357 * MiniDebugInfo:: Debugging information in a special section
16358 * Index Files:: Index files speed up GDB
16359 * Symbol Errors:: Errors reading symbol files
16360 * Data Files:: GDB data files
16364 @section Commands to Specify Files
16366 @cindex symbol table
16367 @cindex core dump file
16369 You may want to specify executable and core dump file names. The usual
16370 way to do this is at start-up time, using the arguments to
16371 @value{GDBN}'s start-up commands (@pxref{Invocation, , Getting In and
16372 Out of @value{GDBN}}).
16374 Occasionally it is necessary to change to a different file during a
16375 @value{GDBN} session. Or you may run @value{GDBN} and forget to
16376 specify a file you want to use. Or you are debugging a remote target
16377 via @code{gdbserver} (@pxref{Server, file, Using the @code{gdbserver}
16378 Program}). In these situations the @value{GDBN} commands to specify
16379 new files are useful.
16382 @cindex executable file
16384 @item file @var{filename}
16385 Use @var{filename} as the program to be debugged. It is read for its
16386 symbols and for the contents of pure memory. It is also the program
16387 executed when you use the @code{run} command. If you do not specify a
16388 directory and the file is not found in the @value{GDBN} working directory,
16389 @value{GDBN} uses the environment variable @code{PATH} as a list of
16390 directories to search, just as the shell does when looking for a program
16391 to run. You can change the value of this variable, for both @value{GDBN}
16392 and your program, using the @code{path} command.
16394 @cindex unlinked object files
16395 @cindex patching object files
16396 You can load unlinked object @file{.o} files into @value{GDBN} using
16397 the @code{file} command. You will not be able to ``run'' an object
16398 file, but you can disassemble functions and inspect variables. Also,
16399 if the underlying BFD functionality supports it, you could use
16400 @kbd{gdb -write} to patch object files using this technique. Note
16401 that @value{GDBN} can neither interpret nor modify relocations in this
16402 case, so branches and some initialized variables will appear to go to
16403 the wrong place. But this feature is still handy from time to time.
16406 @code{file} with no argument makes @value{GDBN} discard any information it
16407 has on both executable file and the symbol table.
16410 @item exec-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
16411 Specify that the program to be run (but not the symbol table) is found
16412 in @var{filename}. @value{GDBN} searches the environment variable @code{PATH}
16413 if necessary to locate your program. Omitting @var{filename} means to
16414 discard information on the executable file.
16416 @kindex symbol-file
16417 @item symbol-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
16418 Read symbol table information from file @var{filename}. @code{PATH} is
16419 searched when necessary. Use the @code{file} command to get both symbol
16420 table and program to run from the same file.
16422 @code{symbol-file} with no argument clears out @value{GDBN} information on your
16423 program's symbol table.
16425 The @code{symbol-file} command causes @value{GDBN} to forget the contents of
16426 some breakpoints and auto-display expressions. This is because they may
16427 contain pointers to the internal data recording symbols and data types,
16428 which are part of the old symbol table data being discarded inside
16431 @code{symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
16434 When @value{GDBN} is configured for a particular environment, it
16435 understands debugging information in whatever format is the standard
16436 generated for that environment; you may use either a @sc{gnu} compiler, or
16437 other compilers that adhere to the local conventions.
16438 Best results are usually obtained from @sc{gnu} compilers; for example,
16439 using @code{@value{NGCC}} you can generate debugging information for
16442 For most kinds of object files, with the exception of old SVR3 systems
16443 using COFF, the @code{symbol-file} command does not normally read the
16444 symbol table in full right away. Instead, it scans the symbol table
16445 quickly to find which source files and which symbols are present. The
16446 details are read later, one source file at a time, as they are needed.
16448 The purpose of this two-stage reading strategy is to make @value{GDBN}
16449 start up faster. For the most part, it is invisible except for
16450 occasional pauses while the symbol table details for a particular source
16451 file are being read. (The @code{set verbose} command can turn these
16452 pauses into messages if desired. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional
16453 Warnings and Messages}.)
16455 We have not implemented the two-stage strategy for COFF yet. When the
16456 symbol table is stored in COFF format, @code{symbol-file} reads the
16457 symbol table data in full right away. Note that ``stabs-in-COFF''
16458 still does the two-stage strategy, since the debug info is actually
16462 @cindex reading symbols immediately
16463 @cindex symbols, reading immediately
16464 @item symbol-file @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @var{filename}
16465 @itemx file @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @var{filename}
16466 You can override the @value{GDBN} two-stage strategy for reading symbol
16467 tables by using the @samp{-readnow} option with any of the commands that
16468 load symbol table information, if you want to be sure @value{GDBN} has the
16469 entire symbol table available.
16471 @c FIXME: for now no mention of directories, since this seems to be in
16472 @c flux. 13mar1992 status is that in theory GDB would look either in
16473 @c current dir or in same dir as myprog; but issues like competing
16474 @c GDB's, or clutter in system dirs, mean that in practice right now
16475 @c only current dir is used. FFish says maybe a special GDB hierarchy
16476 @c (eg rooted in val of env var GDBSYMS) could exist for mappable symbol
16480 @item core-file @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
16482 Specify the whereabouts of a core dump file to be used as the ``contents
16483 of memory''. Traditionally, core files contain only some parts of the
16484 address space of the process that generated them; @value{GDBN} can access the
16485 executable file itself for other parts.
16487 @code{core-file} with no argument specifies that no core file is
16490 Note that the core file is ignored when your program is actually running
16491 under @value{GDBN}. So, if you have been running your program and you
16492 wish to debug a core file instead, you must kill the subprocess in which
16493 the program is running. To do this, use the @code{kill} command
16494 (@pxref{Kill Process, ,Killing the Child Process}).
16496 @kindex add-symbol-file
16497 @cindex dynamic linking
16498 @item add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address}
16499 @itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address} @r{[} -readnow @r{]}
16500 @itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address} -s @var{section} @var{address} @dots{}
16501 The @code{add-symbol-file} command reads additional symbol table
16502 information from the file @var{filename}. You would use this command
16503 when @var{filename} has been dynamically loaded (by some other means)
16504 into the program that is running. @var{address} should be the memory
16505 address at which the file has been loaded; @value{GDBN} cannot figure
16506 this out for itself. You can additionally specify an arbitrary number
16507 of @samp{-s @var{section} @var{address}} pairs, to give an explicit
16508 section name and base address for that section. You can specify any
16509 @var{address} as an expression.
16511 The symbol table of the file @var{filename} is added to the symbol table
16512 originally read with the @code{symbol-file} command. You can use the
16513 @code{add-symbol-file} command any number of times; the new symbol data
16514 thus read keeps adding to the old. To discard all old symbol data
16515 instead, use the @code{symbol-file} command without any arguments.
16517 @cindex relocatable object files, reading symbols from
16518 @cindex object files, relocatable, reading symbols from
16519 @cindex reading symbols from relocatable object files
16520 @cindex symbols, reading from relocatable object files
16521 @cindex @file{.o} files, reading symbols from
16522 Although @var{filename} is typically a shared library file, an
16523 executable file, or some other object file which has been fully
16524 relocated for loading into a process, you can also load symbolic
16525 information from relocatable @file{.o} files, as long as:
16529 the file's symbolic information refers only to linker symbols defined in
16530 that file, not to symbols defined by other object files,
16532 every section the file's symbolic information refers to has actually
16533 been loaded into the inferior, as it appears in the file, and
16535 you can determine the address at which every section was loaded, and
16536 provide these to the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
16540 Some embedded operating systems, like Sun Chorus and VxWorks, can load
16541 relocatable files into an already running program; such systems
16542 typically make the requirements above easy to meet. However, it's
16543 important to recognize that many native systems use complex link
16544 procedures (@code{.linkonce} section factoring and C@t{++} constructor table
16545 assembly, for example) that make the requirements difficult to meet. In
16546 general, one cannot assume that using @code{add-symbol-file} to read a
16547 relocatable object file's symbolic information will have the same effect
16548 as linking the relocatable object file into the program in the normal
16551 @code{add-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
16553 @kindex add-symbol-file-from-memory
16554 @cindex @code{syscall DSO}
16555 @cindex load symbols from memory
16556 @item add-symbol-file-from-memory @var{address}
16557 Load symbols from the given @var{address} in a dynamically loaded
16558 object file whose image is mapped directly into the inferior's memory.
16559 For example, the Linux kernel maps a @code{syscall DSO} into each
16560 process's address space; this DSO provides kernel-specific code for
16561 some system calls. The argument can be any expression whose
16562 evaluation yields the address of the file's shared object file header.
16563 For this command to work, you must have used @code{symbol-file} or
16564 @code{exec-file} commands in advance.
16566 @kindex add-shared-symbol-files
16568 @item add-shared-symbol-files @var{library-file}
16569 @itemx assf @var{library-file}
16570 The @code{add-shared-symbol-files} command can currently be used only
16571 in the Cygwin build of @value{GDBN} on MS-Windows OS, where it is an
16572 alias for the @code{dll-symbols} command (@pxref{Cygwin Native}).
16573 @value{GDBN} automatically looks for shared libraries, however if
16574 @value{GDBN} does not find yours, you can invoke
16575 @code{add-shared-symbol-files}. It takes one argument: the shared
16576 library's file name. @code{assf} is a shorthand alias for
16577 @code{add-shared-symbol-files}.
16580 @item section @var{section} @var{addr}
16581 The @code{section} command changes the base address of the named
16582 @var{section} of the exec file to @var{addr}. This can be used if the
16583 exec file does not contain section addresses, (such as in the
16584 @code{a.out} format), or when the addresses specified in the file
16585 itself are wrong. Each section must be changed separately. The
16586 @code{info files} command, described below, lists all the sections and
16590 @kindex info target
16593 @code{info files} and @code{info target} are synonymous; both print the
16594 current target (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}),
16595 including the names of the executable and core dump files currently in
16596 use by @value{GDBN}, and the files from which symbols were loaded. The
16597 command @code{help target} lists all possible targets rather than
16600 @kindex maint info sections
16601 @item maint info sections
16602 Another command that can give you extra information about program sections
16603 is @code{maint info sections}. In addition to the section information
16604 displayed by @code{info files}, this command displays the flags and file
16605 offset of each section in the executable and core dump files. In addition,
16606 @code{maint info sections} provides the following command options (which
16607 may be arbitrarily combined):
16611 Display sections for all loaded object files, including shared libraries.
16612 @item @var{sections}
16613 Display info only for named @var{sections}.
16614 @item @var{section-flags}
16615 Display info only for sections for which @var{section-flags} are true.
16616 The section flags that @value{GDBN} currently knows about are:
16619 Section will have space allocated in the process when loaded.
16620 Set for all sections except those containing debug information.
16622 Section will be loaded from the file into the child process memory.
16623 Set for pre-initialized code and data, clear for @code{.bss} sections.
16625 Section needs to be relocated before loading.
16627 Section cannot be modified by the child process.
16629 Section contains executable code only.
16631 Section contains data only (no executable code).
16633 Section will reside in ROM.
16635 Section contains data for constructor/destructor lists.
16637 Section is not empty.
16639 An instruction to the linker to not output the section.
16640 @item COFF_SHARED_LIBRARY
16641 A notification to the linker that the section contains
16642 COFF shared library information.
16644 Section contains common symbols.
16647 @kindex set trust-readonly-sections
16648 @cindex read-only sections
16649 @item set trust-readonly-sections on
16650 Tell @value{GDBN} that readonly sections in your object file
16651 really are read-only (i.e.@: that their contents will not change).
16652 In that case, @value{GDBN} can fetch values from these sections
16653 out of the object file, rather than from the target program.
16654 For some targets (notably embedded ones), this can be a significant
16655 enhancement to debugging performance.
16657 The default is off.
16659 @item set trust-readonly-sections off
16660 Tell @value{GDBN} not to trust readonly sections. This means that
16661 the contents of the section might change while the program is running,
16662 and must therefore be fetched from the target when needed.
16664 @item show trust-readonly-sections
16665 Show the current setting of trusting readonly sections.
16668 All file-specifying commands allow both absolute and relative file names
16669 as arguments. @value{GDBN} always converts the file name to an absolute file
16670 name and remembers it that way.
16672 @cindex shared libraries
16673 @anchor{Shared Libraries}
16674 @value{GDBN} supports @sc{gnu}/Linux, MS-Windows, HP-UX, SunOS, SVr4, Irix,
16675 and IBM RS/6000 AIX shared libraries.
16677 On MS-Windows @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support
16678 shared libraries. @xref{Expat}.
16680 @value{GDBN} automatically loads symbol definitions from shared libraries
16681 when you use the @code{run} command, or when you examine a core file.
16682 (Before you issue the @code{run} command, @value{GDBN} does not understand
16683 references to a function in a shared library, however---unless you are
16684 debugging a core file).
16686 On HP-UX, if the program loads a library explicitly, @value{GDBN}
16687 automatically loads the symbols at the time of the @code{shl_load} call.
16689 @c FIXME: some @value{GDBN} release may permit some refs to undef
16690 @c FIXME...symbols---eg in a break cmd---assuming they are from a shared
16691 @c FIXME...lib; check this from time to time when updating manual
16693 There are times, however, when you may wish to not automatically load
16694 symbol definitions from shared libraries, such as when they are
16695 particularly large or there are many of them.
16697 To control the automatic loading of shared library symbols, use the
16701 @kindex set auto-solib-add
16702 @item set auto-solib-add @var{mode}
16703 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, symbols from all shared object libraries
16704 will be loaded automatically when the inferior begins execution, you
16705 attach to an independently started inferior, or when the dynamic linker
16706 informs @value{GDBN} that a new library has been loaded. If @var{mode}
16707 is @code{off}, symbols must be loaded manually, using the
16708 @code{sharedlibrary} command. The default value is @code{on}.
16710 @cindex memory used for symbol tables
16711 If your program uses lots of shared libraries with debug info that
16712 takes large amounts of memory, you can decrease the @value{GDBN}
16713 memory footprint by preventing it from automatically loading the
16714 symbols from shared libraries. To that end, type @kbd{set
16715 auto-solib-add off} before running the inferior, then load each
16716 library whose debug symbols you do need with @kbd{sharedlibrary
16717 @var{regexp}}, where @var{regexp} is a regular expression that matches
16718 the libraries whose symbols you want to be loaded.
16720 @kindex show auto-solib-add
16721 @item show auto-solib-add
16722 Display the current autoloading mode.
16725 @cindex load shared library
16726 To explicitly load shared library symbols, use the @code{sharedlibrary}
16730 @kindex info sharedlibrary
16732 @item info share @var{regex}
16733 @itemx info sharedlibrary @var{regex}
16734 Print the names of the shared libraries which are currently loaded
16735 that match @var{regex}. If @var{regex} is omitted then print
16736 all shared libraries that are loaded.
16738 @kindex sharedlibrary
16740 @item sharedlibrary @var{regex}
16741 @itemx share @var{regex}
16742 Load shared object library symbols for files matching a
16743 Unix regular expression.
16744 As with files loaded automatically, it only loads shared libraries
16745 required by your program for a core file or after typing @code{run}. If
16746 @var{regex} is omitted all shared libraries required by your program are
16749 @item nosharedlibrary
16750 @kindex nosharedlibrary
16751 @cindex unload symbols from shared libraries
16752 Unload all shared object library symbols. This discards all symbols
16753 that have been loaded from all shared libraries. Symbols from shared
16754 libraries that were loaded by explicit user requests are not
16758 Sometimes you may wish that @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control
16759 when any of shared library events happen. The best way to do this is
16760 to use @code{catch load} and @code{catch unload} (@pxref{Set
16763 @value{GDBN} also supports the the @code{set stop-on-solib-events}
16764 command for this. This command exists for historical reasons. It is
16765 less useful than setting a catchpoint, because it does not allow for
16766 conditions or commands as a catchpoint does.
16769 @item set stop-on-solib-events
16770 @kindex set stop-on-solib-events
16771 This command controls whether @value{GDBN} should give you control
16772 when the dynamic linker notifies it about some shared library event.
16773 The most common event of interest is loading or unloading of a new
16776 @item show stop-on-solib-events
16777 @kindex show stop-on-solib-events
16778 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control when shared
16779 library events happen.
16782 Shared libraries are also supported in many cross or remote debugging
16783 configurations. @value{GDBN} needs to have access to the target's libraries;
16784 this can be accomplished either by providing copies of the libraries
16785 on the host system, or by asking @value{GDBN} to automatically retrieve the
16786 libraries from the target. If copies of the target libraries are
16787 provided, they need to be the same as the target libraries, although the
16788 copies on the target can be stripped as long as the copies on the host are
16791 @cindex where to look for shared libraries
16792 For remote debugging, you need to tell @value{GDBN} where the target
16793 libraries are, so that it can load the correct copies---otherwise, it
16794 may try to load the host's libraries. @value{GDBN} has two variables
16795 to specify the search directories for target libraries.
16798 @cindex prefix for shared library file names
16799 @cindex system root, alternate
16800 @kindex set solib-absolute-prefix
16801 @kindex set sysroot
16802 @item set sysroot @var{path}
16803 Use @var{path} as the system root for the program being debugged. Any
16804 absolute shared library paths will be prefixed with @var{path}; many
16805 runtime loaders store the absolute paths to the shared library in the
16806 target program's memory. If you use @code{set sysroot} to find shared
16807 libraries, they need to be laid out in the same way that they are on
16808 the target, with e.g.@: a @file{/lib} and @file{/usr/lib} hierarchy
16811 If @var{path} starts with the sequence @file{remote:}, @value{GDBN} will
16812 retrieve the target libraries from the remote system. This is only
16813 supported when using a remote target that supports the @code{remote get}
16814 command (@pxref{File Transfer,,Sending files to a remote system}).
16815 The part of @var{path} following the initial @file{remote:}
16816 (if present) is used as system root prefix on the remote file system.
16817 @footnote{If you want to specify a local system root using a directory
16818 that happens to be named @file{remote:}, you need to use some equivalent
16819 variant of the name like @file{./remote:}.}
16821 For targets with an MS-DOS based filesystem, such as MS-Windows and
16822 SymbianOS, @value{GDBN} tries prefixing a few variants of the target
16823 absolute file name with @var{path}. But first, on Unix hosts,
16824 @value{GDBN} converts all backslash directory separators into forward
16825 slashes, because the backslash is not a directory separator on Unix:
16828 c:\foo\bar.dll @result{} c:/foo/bar.dll
16831 Then, @value{GDBN} attempts prefixing the target file name with
16832 @var{path}, and looks for the resulting file name in the host file
16836 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/c:/foo/bar.dll
16839 If that does not find the shared library, @value{GDBN} tries removing
16840 the @samp{:} character from the drive spec, both for convenience, and,
16841 for the case of the host file system not supporting file names with
16845 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/c/foo/bar.dll
16848 This makes it possible to have a system root that mirrors a target
16849 with more than one drive. E.g., you may want to setup your local
16850 copies of the target system shared libraries like so (note @samp{c} vs
16854 @file{/path/to/sysroot/c/sys/bin/foo.dll}
16855 @file{/path/to/sysroot/c/sys/bin/bar.dll}
16856 @file{/path/to/sysroot/z/sys/bin/bar.dll}
16860 and point the system root at @file{/path/to/sysroot}, so that
16861 @value{GDBN} can find the correct copies of both
16862 @file{c:\sys\bin\foo.dll}, and @file{z:\sys\bin\bar.dll}.
16864 If that still does not find the shared library, @value{GDBN} tries
16865 removing the whole drive spec from the target file name:
16868 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/foo/bar.dll
16871 This last lookup makes it possible to not care about the drive name,
16872 if you don't want or need to.
16874 The @code{set solib-absolute-prefix} command is an alias for @code{set
16877 @cindex default system root
16878 @cindex @samp{--with-sysroot}
16879 You can set the default system root by using the configure-time
16880 @samp{--with-sysroot} option. If the system root is inside
16881 @value{GDBN}'s configured binary prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or
16882 @samp{--exec-prefix}), then the default system root will be updated
16883 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
16886 @kindex show sysroot
16888 Display the current shared library prefix.
16890 @kindex set solib-search-path
16891 @item set solib-search-path @var{path}
16892 If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
16893 directories to search for shared libraries. @samp{solib-search-path}
16894 is used after @samp{sysroot} fails to locate the library, or if the
16895 path to the library is relative instead of absolute. If you want to
16896 use @samp{solib-search-path} instead of @samp{sysroot}, be sure to set
16897 @samp{sysroot} to a nonexistent directory to prevent @value{GDBN} from
16898 finding your host's libraries. @samp{sysroot} is preferred; setting
16899 it to a nonexistent directory may interfere with automatic loading
16900 of shared library symbols.
16902 @kindex show solib-search-path
16903 @item show solib-search-path
16904 Display the current shared library search path.
16906 @cindex DOS file-name semantics of file names.
16907 @kindex set target-file-system-kind (unix|dos-based|auto)
16908 @kindex show target-file-system-kind
16909 @item set target-file-system-kind @var{kind}
16910 Set assumed file system kind for target reported file names.
16912 Shared library file names as reported by the target system may not
16913 make sense as is on the system @value{GDBN} is running on. For
16914 example, when remote debugging a target that has MS-DOS based file
16915 system semantics, from a Unix host, the target may be reporting to
16916 @value{GDBN} a list of loaded shared libraries with file names such as
16917 @file{c:\Windows\kernel32.dll}. On Unix hosts, there's no concept of
16918 drive letters, so the @samp{c:\} prefix is not normally understood as
16919 indicating an absolute file name, and neither is the backslash
16920 normally considered a directory separator character. In that case,
16921 the native file system would interpret this whole absolute file name
16922 as a relative file name with no directory components. This would make
16923 it impossible to point @value{GDBN} at a copy of the remote target's
16924 shared libraries on the host using @code{set sysroot}, and impractical
16925 with @code{set solib-search-path}. Setting
16926 @code{target-file-system-kind} to @code{dos-based} tells @value{GDBN}
16927 to interpret such file names similarly to how the target would, and to
16928 map them to file names valid on @value{GDBN}'s native file system
16929 semantics. The value of @var{kind} can be @code{"auto"}, in addition
16930 to one of the supported file system kinds. In that case, @value{GDBN}
16931 tries to determine the appropriate file system variant based on the
16932 current target's operating system (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the
16933 Current ABI}). The supported file system settings are:
16937 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target file system is of Unix
16938 kind. Only file names starting the forward slash (@samp{/}) character
16939 are considered absolute, and the directory separator character is also
16943 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target file system is DOS based.
16944 File names starting with either a forward slash, or a drive letter
16945 followed by a colon (e.g., @samp{c:}), are considered absolute, and
16946 both the slash (@samp{/}) and the backslash (@samp{\\}) characters are
16947 considered directory separators.
16950 Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the file system kind associated with the
16951 target operating system (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the Current ABI}).
16952 This is the default.
16956 @cindex file name canonicalization
16957 @cindex base name differences
16958 When processing file names provided by the user, @value{GDBN}
16959 frequently needs to compare them to the file names recorded in the
16960 program's debug info. Normally, @value{GDBN} compares just the
16961 @dfn{base names} of the files as strings, which is reasonably fast
16962 even for very large programs. (The base name of a file is the last
16963 portion of its name, after stripping all the leading directories.)
16964 This shortcut in comparison is based upon the assumption that files
16965 cannot have more than one base name. This is usually true, but
16966 references to files that use symlinks or similar filesystem
16967 facilities violate that assumption. If your program records files
16968 using such facilities, or if you provide file names to @value{GDBN}
16969 using symlinks etc., you can set @code{basenames-may-differ} to
16970 @code{true} to instruct @value{GDBN} to completely canonicalize each
16971 pair of file names it needs to compare. This will make file-name
16972 comparisons accurate, but at a price of a significant slowdown.
16975 @item set basenames-may-differ
16976 @kindex set basenames-may-differ
16977 Set whether a source file may have multiple base names.
16979 @item show basenames-may-differ
16980 @kindex show basenames-may-differ
16981 Show whether a source file may have multiple base names.
16984 @node Separate Debug Files
16985 @section Debugging Information in Separate Files
16986 @cindex separate debugging information files
16987 @cindex debugging information in separate files
16988 @cindex @file{.debug} subdirectories
16989 @cindex debugging information directory, global
16990 @cindex global debugging information directories
16991 @cindex build ID, and separate debugging files
16992 @cindex @file{.build-id} directory
16994 @value{GDBN} allows you to put a program's debugging information in a
16995 file separate from the executable itself, in a way that allows
16996 @value{GDBN} to find and load the debugging information automatically.
16997 Since debugging information can be very large---sometimes larger
16998 than the executable code itself---some systems distribute debugging
16999 information for their executables in separate files, which users can
17000 install only when they need to debug a problem.
17002 @value{GDBN} supports two ways of specifying the separate debug info
17007 The executable contains a @dfn{debug link} that specifies the name of
17008 the separate debug info file. The separate debug file's name is
17009 usually @file{@var{executable}.debug}, where @var{executable} is the
17010 name of the corresponding executable file without leading directories
17011 (e.g., @file{ls.debug} for @file{/usr/bin/ls}). In addition, the
17012 debug link specifies a 32-bit @dfn{Cyclic Redundancy Check} (CRC)
17013 checksum for the debug file, which @value{GDBN} uses to validate that
17014 the executable and the debug file came from the same build.
17017 The executable contains a @dfn{build ID}, a unique bit string that is
17018 also present in the corresponding debug info file. (This is supported
17019 only on some operating systems, notably those which use the ELF format
17020 for binary files and the @sc{gnu} Binutils.) For more details about
17021 this feature, see the description of the @option{--build-id}
17022 command-line option in @ref{Options, , Command Line Options, ld.info,
17023 The GNU Linker}. The debug info file's name is not specified
17024 explicitly by the build ID, but can be computed from the build ID, see
17028 Depending on the way the debug info file is specified, @value{GDBN}
17029 uses two different methods of looking for the debug file:
17033 For the ``debug link'' method, @value{GDBN} looks up the named file in
17034 the directory of the executable file, then in a subdirectory of that
17035 directory named @file{.debug}, and finally under each one of the global debug
17036 directories, in a subdirectory whose name is identical to the leading
17037 directories of the executable's absolute file name.
17040 For the ``build ID'' method, @value{GDBN} looks in the
17041 @file{.build-id} subdirectory of each one of the global debug directories for
17042 a file named @file{@var{nn}/@var{nnnnnnnn}.debug}, where @var{nn} are the
17043 first 2 hex characters of the build ID bit string, and @var{nnnnnnnn}
17044 are the rest of the bit string. (Real build ID strings are 32 or more
17045 hex characters, not 10.)
17048 So, for example, suppose you ask @value{GDBN} to debug
17049 @file{/usr/bin/ls}, which has a debug link that specifies the
17050 file @file{ls.debug}, and a build ID whose value in hex is
17051 @code{abcdef1234}. If the list of the global debug directories includes
17052 @file{/usr/lib/debug}, then @value{GDBN} will look for the following
17053 debug information files, in the indicated order:
17057 @file{/usr/lib/debug/.build-id/ab/cdef1234.debug}
17059 @file{/usr/bin/ls.debug}
17061 @file{/usr/bin/.debug/ls.debug}
17063 @file{/usr/lib/debug/usr/bin/ls.debug}.
17066 @anchor{debug-file-directory}
17067 Global debugging info directories default to what is set by @value{GDBN}
17068 configure option @option{--with-separate-debug-dir}. During @value{GDBN} run
17069 you can also set the global debugging info directories, and view the list
17070 @value{GDBN} is currently using.
17074 @kindex set debug-file-directory
17075 @item set debug-file-directory @var{directories}
17076 Set the directories which @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
17077 information files to @var{directory}. Multiple path components can be set
17078 concatenating them by a path separator.
17080 @kindex show debug-file-directory
17081 @item show debug-file-directory
17082 Show the directories @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
17087 @cindex @code{.gnu_debuglink} sections
17088 @cindex debug link sections
17089 A debug link is a special section of the executable file named
17090 @code{.gnu_debuglink}. The section must contain:
17094 A filename, with any leading directory components removed, followed by
17097 zero to three bytes of padding, as needed to reach the next four-byte
17098 boundary within the section, and
17100 a four-byte CRC checksum, stored in the same endianness used for the
17101 executable file itself. The checksum is computed on the debugging
17102 information file's full contents by the function given below, passing
17103 zero as the @var{crc} argument.
17106 Any executable file format can carry a debug link, as long as it can
17107 contain a section named @code{.gnu_debuglink} with the contents
17110 @cindex @code{.note.gnu.build-id} sections
17111 @cindex build ID sections
17112 The build ID is a special section in the executable file (and in other
17113 ELF binary files that @value{GDBN} may consider). This section is
17114 often named @code{.note.gnu.build-id}, but that name is not mandatory.
17115 It contains unique identification for the built files---the ID remains
17116 the same across multiple builds of the same build tree. The default
17117 algorithm SHA1 produces 160 bits (40 hexadecimal characters) of the
17118 content for the build ID string. The same section with an identical
17119 value is present in the original built binary with symbols, in its
17120 stripped variant, and in the separate debugging information file.
17122 The debugging information file itself should be an ordinary
17123 executable, containing a full set of linker symbols, sections, and
17124 debugging information. The sections of the debugging information file
17125 should have the same names, addresses, and sizes as the original file,
17126 but they need not contain any data---much like a @code{.bss} section
17127 in an ordinary executable.
17129 The @sc{gnu} binary utilities (Binutils) package includes the
17130 @samp{objcopy} utility that can produce
17131 the separated executable / debugging information file pairs using the
17132 following commands:
17135 @kbd{objcopy --only-keep-debug foo foo.debug}
17140 These commands remove the debugging
17141 information from the executable file @file{foo} and place it in the file
17142 @file{foo.debug}. You can use the first, second or both methods to link the
17147 The debug link method needs the following additional command to also leave
17148 behind a debug link in @file{foo}:
17151 @kbd{objcopy --add-gnu-debuglink=foo.debug foo}
17154 Ulrich Drepper's @file{elfutils} package, starting with version 0.53, contains
17155 a version of the @code{strip} command such that the command @kbd{strip foo -f
17156 foo.debug} has the same functionality as the two @code{objcopy} commands and
17157 the @code{ln -s} command above, together.
17160 Build ID gets embedded into the main executable using @code{ld --build-id} or
17161 the @value{NGCC} counterpart @code{gcc -Wl,--build-id}. Build ID support plus
17162 compatibility fixes for debug files separation are present in @sc{gnu} binary
17163 utilities (Binutils) package since version 2.18.
17168 @cindex CRC algorithm definition
17169 The CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink} is the CRC-32 defined in
17170 IEEE 802.3 using the polynomial:
17172 @c TexInfo requires naked braces for multi-digit exponents for Tex
17173 @c output, but this causes HTML output to barf. HTML has to be set using
17174 @c raw commands. So we end up having to specify this equation in 2
17179 <em>x</em><sup>32</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>26</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>23</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>22</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>16</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>12</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>11</sup>
17180 + <em>x</em><sup>10</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>8</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>7</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>5</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>4</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>2</sup> + <em>x</em> + 1
17186 @math{x^{32} + x^{26} + x^{23} + x^{22} + x^{16} + x^{12} + x^{11}}
17187 @math{+ x^{10} + x^8 + x^7 + x^5 + x^4 + x^2 + x + 1}
17191 The function is computed byte at a time, taking the least
17192 significant bit of each byte first. The initial pattern
17193 @code{0xffffffff} is used, to ensure leading zeros affect the CRC and
17194 the final result is inverted to ensure trailing zeros also affect the
17197 @emph{Note:} This is the same CRC polynomial as used in handling the
17198 @dfn{Remote Serial Protocol} @code{qCRC} packet (@pxref{Remote Protocol,
17199 , @value{GDBN} Remote Serial Protocol}). However in the
17200 case of the Remote Serial Protocol, the CRC is computed @emph{most}
17201 significant bit first, and the result is not inverted, so trailing
17202 zeros have no effect on the CRC value.
17204 To complete the description, we show below the code of the function
17205 which produces the CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink}. Inverting the
17206 initially supplied @code{crc} argument means that an initial call to
17207 this function passing in zero will start computing the CRC using
17210 @kindex gnu_debuglink_crc32
17213 gnu_debuglink_crc32 (unsigned long crc,
17214 unsigned char *buf, size_t len)
17216 static const unsigned long crc32_table[256] =
17218 0x00000000, 0x77073096, 0xee0e612c, 0x990951ba, 0x076dc419,
17219 0x706af48f, 0xe963a535, 0x9e6495a3, 0x0edb8832, 0x79dcb8a4,
17220 0xe0d5e91e, 0x97d2d988, 0x09b64c2b, 0x7eb17cbd, 0xe7b82d07,
17221 0x90bf1d91, 0x1db71064, 0x6ab020f2, 0xf3b97148, 0x84be41de,
17222 0x1adad47d, 0x6ddde4eb, 0xf4d4b551, 0x83d385c7, 0x136c9856,
17223 0x646ba8c0, 0xfd62f97a, 0x8a65c9ec, 0x14015c4f, 0x63066cd9,
17224 0xfa0f3d63, 0x8d080df5, 0x3b6e20c8, 0x4c69105e, 0xd56041e4,
17225 0xa2677172, 0x3c03e4d1, 0x4b04d447, 0xd20d85fd, 0xa50ab56b,
17226 0x35b5a8fa, 0x42b2986c, 0xdbbbc9d6, 0xacbcf940, 0x32d86ce3,
17227 0x45df5c75, 0xdcd60dcf, 0xabd13d59, 0x26d930ac, 0x51de003a,
17228 0xc8d75180, 0xbfd06116, 0x21b4f4b5, 0x56b3c423, 0xcfba9599,
17229 0xb8bda50f, 0x2802b89e, 0x5f058808, 0xc60cd9b2, 0xb10be924,
17230 0x2f6f7c87, 0x58684c11, 0xc1611dab, 0xb6662d3d, 0x76dc4190,
17231 0x01db7106, 0x98d220bc, 0xefd5102a, 0x71b18589, 0x06b6b51f,
17232 0x9fbfe4a5, 0xe8b8d433, 0x7807c9a2, 0x0f00f934, 0x9609a88e,
17233 0xe10e9818, 0x7f6a0dbb, 0x086d3d2d, 0x91646c97, 0xe6635c01,
17234 0x6b6b51f4, 0x1c6c6162, 0x856530d8, 0xf262004e, 0x6c0695ed,
17235 0x1b01a57b, 0x8208f4c1, 0xf50fc457, 0x65b0d9c6, 0x12b7e950,
17236 0x8bbeb8ea, 0xfcb9887c, 0x62dd1ddf, 0x15da2d49, 0x8cd37cf3,
17237 0xfbd44c65, 0x4db26158, 0x3ab551ce, 0xa3bc0074, 0xd4bb30e2,
17238 0x4adfa541, 0x3dd895d7, 0xa4d1c46d, 0xd3d6f4fb, 0x4369e96a,
17239 0x346ed9fc, 0xad678846, 0xda60b8d0, 0x44042d73, 0x33031de5,
17240 0xaa0a4c5f, 0xdd0d7cc9, 0x5005713c, 0x270241aa, 0xbe0b1010,
17241 0xc90c2086, 0x5768b525, 0x206f85b3, 0xb966d409, 0xce61e49f,
17242 0x5edef90e, 0x29d9c998, 0xb0d09822, 0xc7d7a8b4, 0x59b33d17,
17243 0x2eb40d81, 0xb7bd5c3b, 0xc0ba6cad, 0xedb88320, 0x9abfb3b6,
17244 0x03b6e20c, 0x74b1d29a, 0xead54739, 0x9dd277af, 0x04db2615,
17245 0x73dc1683, 0xe3630b12, 0x94643b84, 0x0d6d6a3e, 0x7a6a5aa8,
17246 0xe40ecf0b, 0x9309ff9d, 0x0a00ae27, 0x7d079eb1, 0xf00f9344,
17247 0x8708a3d2, 0x1e01f268, 0x6906c2fe, 0xf762575d, 0x806567cb,
17248 0x196c3671, 0x6e6b06e7, 0xfed41b76, 0x89d32be0, 0x10da7a5a,
17249 0x67dd4acc, 0xf9b9df6f, 0x8ebeeff9, 0x17b7be43, 0x60b08ed5,
17250 0xd6d6a3e8, 0xa1d1937e, 0x38d8c2c4, 0x4fdff252, 0xd1bb67f1,
17251 0xa6bc5767, 0x3fb506dd, 0x48b2364b, 0xd80d2bda, 0xaf0a1b4c,
17252 0x36034af6, 0x41047a60, 0xdf60efc3, 0xa867df55, 0x316e8eef,
17253 0x4669be79, 0xcb61b38c, 0xbc66831a, 0x256fd2a0, 0x5268e236,
17254 0xcc0c7795, 0xbb0b4703, 0x220216b9, 0x5505262f, 0xc5ba3bbe,
17255 0xb2bd0b28, 0x2bb45a92, 0x5cb36a04, 0xc2d7ffa7, 0xb5d0cf31,
17256 0x2cd99e8b, 0x5bdeae1d, 0x9b64c2b0, 0xec63f226, 0x756aa39c,
17257 0x026d930a, 0x9c0906a9, 0xeb0e363f, 0x72076785, 0x05005713,
17258 0x95bf4a82, 0xe2b87a14, 0x7bb12bae, 0x0cb61b38, 0x92d28e9b,
17259 0xe5d5be0d, 0x7cdcefb7, 0x0bdbdf21, 0x86d3d2d4, 0xf1d4e242,
17260 0x68ddb3f8, 0x1fda836e, 0x81be16cd, 0xf6b9265b, 0x6fb077e1,
17261 0x18b74777, 0x88085ae6, 0xff0f6a70, 0x66063bca, 0x11010b5c,
17262 0x8f659eff, 0xf862ae69, 0x616bffd3, 0x166ccf45, 0xa00ae278,
17263 0xd70dd2ee, 0x4e048354, 0x3903b3c2, 0xa7672661, 0xd06016f7,
17264 0x4969474d, 0x3e6e77db, 0xaed16a4a, 0xd9d65adc, 0x40df0b66,
17265 0x37d83bf0, 0xa9bcae53, 0xdebb9ec5, 0x47b2cf7f, 0x30b5ffe9,
17266 0xbdbdf21c, 0xcabac28a, 0x53b39330, 0x24b4a3a6, 0xbad03605,
17267 0xcdd70693, 0x54de5729, 0x23d967bf, 0xb3667a2e, 0xc4614ab8,
17268 0x5d681b02, 0x2a6f2b94, 0xb40bbe37, 0xc30c8ea1, 0x5a05df1b,
17271 unsigned char *end;
17273 crc = ~crc & 0xffffffff;
17274 for (end = buf + len; buf < end; ++buf)
17275 crc = crc32_table[(crc ^ *buf) & 0xff] ^ (crc >> 8);
17276 return ~crc & 0xffffffff;
17281 This computation does not apply to the ``build ID'' method.
17283 @node MiniDebugInfo
17284 @section Debugging information in a special section
17285 @cindex separate debug sections
17286 @cindex @samp{.gnu_debugdata} section
17288 Some systems ship pre-built executables and libraries that have a
17289 special @samp{.gnu_debugdata} section. This feature is called
17290 @dfn{MiniDebugInfo}. This section holds an LZMA-compressed object and
17291 is used to supply extra symbols for backtraces.
17293 The intent of this section is to provide extra minimal debugging
17294 information for use in simple backtraces. It is not intended to be a
17295 replacement for full separate debugging information (@pxref{Separate
17296 Debug Files}). The example below shows the intended use; however,
17297 @value{GDBN} does not currently put restrictions on what sort of
17298 debugging information might be included in the section.
17300 @value{GDBN} has support for this extension. If the section exists,
17301 then it is used provided that no other source of debugging information
17302 can be found, and that @value{GDBN} was configured with LZMA support.
17304 This section can be easily created using @command{objcopy} and other
17305 standard utilities:
17308 # Extract the dynamic symbols from the main binary, there is no need
17309 # to also have these in the normal symbol table
17310 nm -D @var{binary} --format=posix --defined-only \
17311 | awk '@{ print $1 @}' | sort > dynsyms
17313 # Extract all the text (i.e. function) symbols from the debuginfo .
17314 nm @var{binary} --format=posix --defined-only \
17315 | awk '@{ if ($2 == "T" || $2 == "t") print $1 @}' \
17318 # Keep all the function symbols not already in the dynamic symbol
17320 comm -13 dynsyms funcsyms > keep_symbols
17322 # Copy the full debuginfo, keeping only a minimal set of symbols and
17323 # removing some unnecessary sections.
17324 objcopy -S --remove-section .gdb_index --remove-section .comment \
17325 --keep-symbols=keep_symbols @var{binary} mini_debuginfo
17327 # Inject the compressed data into the .gnu_debugdata section of the
17330 objcopy --add-section .gnu_debugdata=mini_debuginfo.xz @var{binary}
17334 @section Index Files Speed Up @value{GDBN}
17335 @cindex index files
17336 @cindex @samp{.gdb_index} section
17338 When @value{GDBN} finds a symbol file, it scans the symbols in the
17339 file in order to construct an internal symbol table. This lets most
17340 @value{GDBN} operations work quickly---at the cost of a delay early
17341 on. For large programs, this delay can be quite lengthy, so
17342 @value{GDBN} provides a way to build an index, which speeds up
17345 The index is stored as a section in the symbol file. @value{GDBN} can
17346 write the index to a file, then you can put it into the symbol file
17347 using @command{objcopy}.
17349 To create an index file, use the @code{save gdb-index} command:
17352 @item save gdb-index @var{directory}
17353 @kindex save gdb-index
17354 Create an index file for each symbol file currently known by
17355 @value{GDBN}. Each file is named after its corresponding symbol file,
17356 with @samp{.gdb-index} appended, and is written into the given
17360 Once you have created an index file you can merge it into your symbol
17361 file, here named @file{symfile}, using @command{objcopy}:
17364 $ objcopy --add-section .gdb_index=symfile.gdb-index \
17365 --set-section-flags .gdb_index=readonly symfile symfile
17368 @value{GDBN} will normally ignore older versions of @file{.gdb_index}
17369 sections that have been deprecated. Usually they are deprecated because
17370 they are missing a new feature or have performance issues.
17371 To tell @value{GDBN} to use a deprecated index section anyway
17372 specify @code{set use-deprecated-index-sections on}.
17373 The default is @code{off}.
17374 This can speed up startup, but may result in some functionality being lost.
17375 @xref{Index Section Format}.
17377 @emph{Warning:} Setting @code{use-deprecated-index-sections} to @code{on}
17378 must be done before gdb reads the file. The following will not work:
17381 $ gdb -ex "set use-deprecated-index-sections on" <program>
17384 Instead you must do, for example,
17387 $ gdb -iex "set use-deprecated-index-sections on" <program>
17390 There are currently some limitation on indices. They only work when
17391 for DWARF debugging information, not stabs. And, they do not
17392 currently work for programs using Ada.
17394 @node Symbol Errors
17395 @section Errors Reading Symbol Files
17397 While reading a symbol file, @value{GDBN} occasionally encounters problems,
17398 such as symbol types it does not recognize, or known bugs in compiler
17399 output. By default, @value{GDBN} does not notify you of such problems, since
17400 they are relatively common and primarily of interest to people
17401 debugging compilers. If you are interested in seeing information
17402 about ill-constructed symbol tables, you can either ask @value{GDBN} to print
17403 only one message about each such type of problem, no matter how many
17404 times the problem occurs; or you can ask @value{GDBN} to print more messages,
17405 to see how many times the problems occur, with the @code{set
17406 complaints} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
17409 The messages currently printed, and their meanings, include:
17412 @item inner block not inside outer block in @var{symbol}
17414 The symbol information shows where symbol scopes begin and end
17415 (such as at the start of a function or a block of statements). This
17416 error indicates that an inner scope block is not fully contained
17417 in its outer scope blocks.
17419 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the inner block as if it had
17420 the same scope as the outer block. In the error message, @var{symbol}
17421 may be shown as ``@code{(don't know)}'' if the outer block is not a
17424 @item block at @var{address} out of order
17426 The symbol information for symbol scope blocks should occur in
17427 order of increasing addresses. This error indicates that it does not
17430 @value{GDBN} does not circumvent this problem, and has trouble
17431 locating symbols in the source file whose symbols it is reading. (You
17432 can often determine what source file is affected by specifying
17433 @code{set verbose on}. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
17436 @item bad block start address patched
17438 The symbol information for a symbol scope block has a start address
17439 smaller than the address of the preceding source line. This is known
17440 to occur in the SunOS 4.1.1 (and earlier) C compiler.
17442 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the symbol scope block as
17443 starting on the previous source line.
17445 @item bad string table offset in symbol @var{n}
17448 Symbol number @var{n} contains a pointer into the string table which is
17449 larger than the size of the string table.
17451 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by considering the symbol to have the
17452 name @code{foo}, which may cause other problems if many symbols end up
17455 @item unknown symbol type @code{0x@var{nn}}
17457 The symbol information contains new data types that @value{GDBN} does
17458 not yet know how to read. @code{0x@var{nn}} is the symbol type of the
17459 uncomprehended information, in hexadecimal.
17461 @value{GDBN} circumvents the error by ignoring this symbol information.
17462 This usually allows you to debug your program, though certain symbols
17463 are not accessible. If you encounter such a problem and feel like
17464 debugging it, you can debug @code{@value{GDBP}} with itself, breakpoint
17465 on @code{complain}, then go up to the function @code{read_dbx_symtab}
17466 and examine @code{*bufp} to see the symbol.
17468 @item stub type has NULL name
17470 @value{GDBN} could not find the full definition for a struct or class.
17472 @item const/volatile indicator missing (ok if using g++ v1.x), got@dots{}
17473 The symbol information for a C@t{++} member function is missing some
17474 information that recent versions of the compiler should have output for
17477 @item info mismatch between compiler and debugger
17479 @value{GDBN} could not parse a type specification output by the compiler.
17484 @section GDB Data Files
17486 @cindex prefix for data files
17487 @value{GDBN} will sometimes read an auxiliary data file. These files
17488 are kept in a directory known as the @dfn{data directory}.
17490 You can set the data directory's name, and view the name @value{GDBN}
17491 is currently using.
17494 @kindex set data-directory
17495 @item set data-directory @var{directory}
17496 Set the directory which @value{GDBN} searches for auxiliary data files
17497 to @var{directory}.
17499 @kindex show data-directory
17500 @item show data-directory
17501 Show the directory @value{GDBN} searches for auxiliary data files.
17504 @cindex default data directory
17505 @cindex @samp{--with-gdb-datadir}
17506 You can set the default data directory by using the configure-time
17507 @samp{--with-gdb-datadir} option. If the data directory is inside
17508 @value{GDBN}'s configured binary prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or
17509 @samp{--exec-prefix}), then the default data directory will be updated
17510 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
17513 The data directory may also be specified with the
17514 @code{--data-directory} command line option.
17515 @xref{Mode Options}.
17518 @chapter Specifying a Debugging Target
17520 @cindex debugging target
17521 A @dfn{target} is the execution environment occupied by your program.
17523 Often, @value{GDBN} runs in the same host environment as your program;
17524 in that case, the debugging target is specified as a side effect when
17525 you use the @code{file} or @code{core} commands. When you need more
17526 flexibility---for example, running @value{GDBN} on a physically separate
17527 host, or controlling a standalone system over a serial port or a
17528 realtime system over a TCP/IP connection---you can use the @code{target}
17529 command to specify one of the target types configured for @value{GDBN}
17530 (@pxref{Target Commands, ,Commands for Managing Targets}).
17532 @cindex target architecture
17533 It is possible to build @value{GDBN} for several different @dfn{target
17534 architectures}. When @value{GDBN} is built like that, you can choose
17535 one of the available architectures with the @kbd{set architecture}
17539 @kindex set architecture
17540 @kindex show architecture
17541 @item set architecture @var{arch}
17542 This command sets the current target architecture to @var{arch}. The
17543 value of @var{arch} can be @code{"auto"}, in addition to one of the
17544 supported architectures.
17546 @item show architecture
17547 Show the current target architecture.
17549 @item set processor
17551 @kindex set processor
17552 @kindex show processor
17553 These are alias commands for, respectively, @code{set architecture}
17554 and @code{show architecture}.
17558 * Active Targets:: Active targets
17559 * Target Commands:: Commands for managing targets
17560 * Byte Order:: Choosing target byte order
17563 @node Active Targets
17564 @section Active Targets
17566 @cindex stacking targets
17567 @cindex active targets
17568 @cindex multiple targets
17570 There are multiple classes of targets such as: processes, executable files or
17571 recording sessions. Core files belong to the process class, making core file
17572 and process mutually exclusive. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} can work concurrently
17573 on multiple active targets, one in each class. This allows you to (for
17574 example) start a process and inspect its activity, while still having access to
17575 the executable file after the process finishes. Or if you start process
17576 recording (@pxref{Reverse Execution}) and @code{reverse-step} there, you are
17577 presented a virtual layer of the recording target, while the process target
17578 remains stopped at the chronologically last point of the process execution.
17580 Use the @code{core-file} and @code{exec-file} commands to select a new core
17581 file or executable target (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}). To
17582 specify as a target a process that is already running, use the @code{attach}
17583 command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running Process}).
17585 @node Target Commands
17586 @section Commands for Managing Targets
17589 @item target @var{type} @var{parameters}
17590 Connects the @value{GDBN} host environment to a target machine or
17591 process. A target is typically a protocol for talking to debugging
17592 facilities. You use the argument @var{type} to specify the type or
17593 protocol of the target machine.
17595 Further @var{parameters} are interpreted by the target protocol, but
17596 typically include things like device names or host names to connect
17597 with, process numbers, and baud rates.
17599 The @code{target} command does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again
17600 after executing the command.
17602 @kindex help target
17604 Displays the names of all targets available. To display targets
17605 currently selected, use either @code{info target} or @code{info files}
17606 (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
17608 @item help target @var{name}
17609 Describe a particular target, including any parameters necessary to
17612 @kindex set gnutarget
17613 @item set gnutarget @var{args}
17614 @value{GDBN} uses its own library BFD to read your files. @value{GDBN}
17615 knows whether it is reading an @dfn{executable},
17616 a @dfn{core}, or a @dfn{.o} file; however, you can specify the file format
17617 with the @code{set gnutarget} command. Unlike most @code{target} commands,
17618 with @code{gnutarget} the @code{target} refers to a program, not a machine.
17621 @emph{Warning:} To specify a file format with @code{set gnutarget},
17622 you must know the actual BFD name.
17626 @xref{Files, , Commands to Specify Files}.
17628 @kindex show gnutarget
17629 @item show gnutarget
17630 Use the @code{show gnutarget} command to display what file format
17631 @code{gnutarget} is set to read. If you have not set @code{gnutarget},
17632 @value{GDBN} will determine the file format for each file automatically,
17633 and @code{show gnutarget} displays @samp{The current BFD target is "auto"}.
17636 @cindex common targets
17637 Here are some common targets (available, or not, depending on the GDB
17642 @item target exec @var{program}
17643 @cindex executable file target
17644 An executable file. @samp{target exec @var{program}} is the same as
17645 @samp{exec-file @var{program}}.
17647 @item target core @var{filename}
17648 @cindex core dump file target
17649 A core dump file. @samp{target core @var{filename}} is the same as
17650 @samp{core-file @var{filename}}.
17652 @item target remote @var{medium}
17653 @cindex remote target
17654 A remote system connected to @value{GDBN} via a serial line or network
17655 connection. This command tells @value{GDBN} to use its own remote
17656 protocol over @var{medium} for debugging. @xref{Remote Debugging}.
17658 For example, if you have a board connected to @file{/dev/ttya} on the
17659 machine running @value{GDBN}, you could say:
17662 target remote /dev/ttya
17665 @code{target remote} supports the @code{load} command. This is only
17666 useful if you have some other way of getting the stub to the target
17667 system, and you can put it somewhere in memory where it won't get
17668 clobbered by the download.
17670 @item target sim @r{[}@var{simargs}@r{]} @dots{}
17671 @cindex built-in simulator target
17672 Builtin CPU simulator. @value{GDBN} includes simulators for most architectures.
17680 works; however, you cannot assume that a specific memory map, device
17681 drivers, or even basic I/O is available, although some simulators do
17682 provide these. For info about any processor-specific simulator details,
17683 see the appropriate section in @ref{Embedded Processors, ,Embedded
17688 Some configurations may include these targets as well:
17692 @item target nrom @var{dev}
17693 @cindex NetROM ROM emulator target
17694 NetROM ROM emulator. This target only supports downloading.
17698 Different targets are available on different configurations of @value{GDBN};
17699 your configuration may have more or fewer targets.
17701 Many remote targets require you to download the executable's code once
17702 you've successfully established a connection. You may wish to control
17703 various aspects of this process.
17708 @kindex set hash@r{, for remote monitors}
17709 @cindex hash mark while downloading
17710 This command controls whether a hash mark @samp{#} is displayed while
17711 downloading a file to the remote monitor. If on, a hash mark is
17712 displayed after each S-record is successfully downloaded to the
17716 @kindex show hash@r{, for remote monitors}
17717 Show the current status of displaying the hash mark.
17719 @item set debug monitor
17720 @kindex set debug monitor
17721 @cindex display remote monitor communications
17722 Enable or disable display of communications messages between
17723 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
17725 @item show debug monitor
17726 @kindex show debug monitor
17727 Show the current status of displaying communications between
17728 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
17733 @kindex load @var{filename}
17734 @item load @var{filename}
17736 Depending on what remote debugging facilities are configured into
17737 @value{GDBN}, the @code{load} command may be available. Where it exists, it
17738 is meant to make @var{filename} (an executable) available for debugging
17739 on the remote system---by downloading, or dynamic linking, for example.
17740 @code{load} also records the @var{filename} symbol table in @value{GDBN}, like
17741 the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
17743 If your @value{GDBN} does not have a @code{load} command, attempting to
17744 execute it gets the error message ``@code{You can't do that when your
17745 target is @dots{}}''
17747 The file is loaded at whatever address is specified in the executable.
17748 For some object file formats, you can specify the load address when you
17749 link the program; for other formats, like a.out, the object file format
17750 specifies a fixed address.
17751 @c FIXME! This would be a good place for an xref to the GNU linker doc.
17753 Depending on the remote side capabilities, @value{GDBN} may be able to
17754 load programs into flash memory.
17756 @code{load} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
17760 @section Choosing Target Byte Order
17762 @cindex choosing target byte order
17763 @cindex target byte order
17765 Some types of processors, such as the @acronym{MIPS}, PowerPC, and Renesas SH,
17766 offer the ability to run either big-endian or little-endian byte
17767 orders. Usually the executable or symbol will include a bit to
17768 designate the endian-ness, and you will not need to worry about
17769 which to use. However, you may still find it useful to adjust
17770 @value{GDBN}'s idea of processor endian-ness manually.
17774 @item set endian big
17775 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is big-endian.
17777 @item set endian little
17778 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is little-endian.
17780 @item set endian auto
17781 Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the byte order associated with the
17785 Display @value{GDBN}'s current idea of the target byte order.
17789 Note that these commands merely adjust interpretation of symbolic
17790 data on the host, and that they have absolutely no effect on the
17794 @node Remote Debugging
17795 @chapter Debugging Remote Programs
17796 @cindex remote debugging
17798 If you are trying to debug a program running on a machine that cannot run
17799 @value{GDBN} in the usual way, it is often useful to use remote debugging.
17800 For example, you might use remote debugging on an operating system kernel,
17801 or on a small system which does not have a general purpose operating system
17802 powerful enough to run a full-featured debugger.
17804 Some configurations of @value{GDBN} have special serial or TCP/IP interfaces
17805 to make this work with particular debugging targets. In addition,
17806 @value{GDBN} comes with a generic serial protocol (specific to @value{GDBN},
17807 but not specific to any particular target system) which you can use if you
17808 write the remote stubs---the code that runs on the remote system to
17809 communicate with @value{GDBN}.
17811 Other remote targets may be available in your
17812 configuration of @value{GDBN}; use @code{help target} to list them.
17815 * Connecting:: Connecting to a remote target
17816 * File Transfer:: Sending files to a remote system
17817 * Server:: Using the gdbserver program
17818 * Remote Configuration:: Remote configuration
17819 * Remote Stub:: Implementing a remote stub
17823 @section Connecting to a Remote Target
17825 On the @value{GDBN} host machine, you will need an unstripped copy of
17826 your program, since @value{GDBN} needs symbol and debugging information.
17827 Start up @value{GDBN} as usual, using the name of the local copy of your
17828 program as the first argument.
17830 @cindex @code{target remote}
17831 @value{GDBN} can communicate with the target over a serial line, or
17832 over an @acronym{IP} network using @acronym{TCP} or @acronym{UDP}. In
17833 each case, @value{GDBN} uses the same protocol for debugging your
17834 program; only the medium carrying the debugging packets varies. The
17835 @code{target remote} command establishes a connection to the target.
17836 Its arguments indicate which medium to use:
17840 @item target remote @var{serial-device}
17841 @cindex serial line, @code{target remote}
17842 Use @var{serial-device} to communicate with the target. For example,
17843 to use a serial line connected to the device named @file{/dev/ttyb}:
17846 target remote /dev/ttyb
17849 If you're using a serial line, you may want to give @value{GDBN} the
17850 @w{@samp{--baud}} option, or use the @code{set remotebaud} command
17851 (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remotebaud}) before the
17852 @code{target} command.
17854 @item target remote @code{@var{host}:@var{port}}
17855 @itemx target remote @code{tcp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
17856 @cindex @acronym{TCP} port, @code{target remote}
17857 Debug using a @acronym{TCP} connection to @var{port} on @var{host}.
17858 The @var{host} may be either a host name or a numeric @acronym{IP}
17859 address; @var{port} must be a decimal number. The @var{host} could be
17860 the target machine itself, if it is directly connected to the net, or
17861 it might be a terminal server which in turn has a serial line to the
17864 For example, to connect to port 2828 on a terminal server named
17868 target remote manyfarms:2828
17871 If your remote target is actually running on the same machine as your
17872 debugger session (e.g.@: a simulator for your target running on the
17873 same host), you can omit the hostname. For example, to connect to
17874 port 1234 on your local machine:
17877 target remote :1234
17881 Note that the colon is still required here.
17883 @item target remote @code{udp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
17884 @cindex @acronym{UDP} port, @code{target remote}
17885 Debug using @acronym{UDP} packets to @var{port} on @var{host}. For example, to
17886 connect to @acronym{UDP} port 2828 on a terminal server named @code{manyfarms}:
17889 target remote udp:manyfarms:2828
17892 When using a @acronym{UDP} connection for remote debugging, you should
17893 keep in mind that the `U' stands for ``Unreliable''. @acronym{UDP}
17894 can silently drop packets on busy or unreliable networks, which will
17895 cause havoc with your debugging session.
17897 @item target remote | @var{command}
17898 @cindex pipe, @code{target remote} to
17899 Run @var{command} in the background and communicate with it using a
17900 pipe. The @var{command} is a shell command, to be parsed and expanded
17901 by the system's command shell, @code{/bin/sh}; it should expect remote
17902 protocol packets on its standard input, and send replies on its
17903 standard output. You could use this to run a stand-alone simulator
17904 that speaks the remote debugging protocol, to make net connections
17905 using programs like @code{ssh}, or for other similar tricks.
17907 If @var{command} closes its standard output (perhaps by exiting),
17908 @value{GDBN} will try to send it a @code{SIGTERM} signal. (If the
17909 program has already exited, this will have no effect.)
17913 Once the connection has been established, you can use all the usual
17914 commands to examine and change data. The remote program is already
17915 running; you can use @kbd{step} and @kbd{continue}, and you do not
17916 need to use @kbd{run}.
17918 @cindex interrupting remote programs
17919 @cindex remote programs, interrupting
17920 Whenever @value{GDBN} is waiting for the remote program, if you type the
17921 interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}), @value{GDBN} attempts to stop the
17922 program. This may or may not succeed, depending in part on the hardware
17923 and the serial drivers the remote system uses. If you type the
17924 interrupt character once again, @value{GDBN} displays this prompt:
17927 Interrupted while waiting for the program.
17928 Give up (and stop debugging it)? (y or n)
17931 If you type @kbd{y}, @value{GDBN} abandons the remote debugging session.
17932 (If you decide you want to try again later, you can use @samp{target
17933 remote} again to connect once more.) If you type @kbd{n}, @value{GDBN}
17934 goes back to waiting.
17937 @kindex detach (remote)
17939 When you have finished debugging the remote program, you can use the
17940 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control.
17941 Detaching from the target normally resumes its execution, but the results
17942 will depend on your particular remote stub. After the @code{detach}
17943 command, @value{GDBN} is free to connect to another target.
17947 The @code{disconnect} command behaves like @code{detach}, except that
17948 the target is generally not resumed. It will wait for @value{GDBN}
17949 (this instance or another one) to connect and continue debugging. After
17950 the @code{disconnect} command, @value{GDBN} is again free to connect to
17953 @cindex send command to remote monitor
17954 @cindex extend @value{GDBN} for remote targets
17955 @cindex add new commands for external monitor
17957 @item monitor @var{cmd}
17958 This command allows you to send arbitrary commands directly to the
17959 remote monitor. Since @value{GDBN} doesn't care about the commands it
17960 sends like this, this command is the way to extend @value{GDBN}---you
17961 can add new commands that only the external monitor will understand
17965 @node File Transfer
17966 @section Sending files to a remote system
17967 @cindex remote target, file transfer
17968 @cindex file transfer
17969 @cindex sending files to remote systems
17971 Some remote targets offer the ability to transfer files over the same
17972 connection used to communicate with @value{GDBN}. This is convenient
17973 for targets accessible through other means, e.g.@: @sc{gnu}/Linux systems
17974 running @code{gdbserver} over a network interface. For other targets,
17975 e.g.@: embedded devices with only a single serial port, this may be
17976 the only way to upload or download files.
17978 Not all remote targets support these commands.
17982 @item remote put @var{hostfile} @var{targetfile}
17983 Copy file @var{hostfile} from the host system (the machine running
17984 @value{GDBN}) to @var{targetfile} on the target system.
17987 @item remote get @var{targetfile} @var{hostfile}
17988 Copy file @var{targetfile} from the target system to @var{hostfile}
17989 on the host system.
17991 @kindex remote delete
17992 @item remote delete @var{targetfile}
17993 Delete @var{targetfile} from the target system.
17998 @section Using the @code{gdbserver} Program
18001 @cindex remote connection without stubs
18002 @code{gdbserver} is a control program for Unix-like systems, which
18003 allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
18004 @code{target remote}---but without linking in the usual debugging stub.
18006 @code{gdbserver} is not a complete replacement for the debugging stubs,
18007 because it requires essentially the same operating-system facilities
18008 that @value{GDBN} itself does. In fact, a system that can run
18009 @code{gdbserver} to connect to a remote @value{GDBN} could also run
18010 @value{GDBN} locally! @code{gdbserver} is sometimes useful nevertheless,
18011 because it is a much smaller program than @value{GDBN} itself. It is
18012 also easier to port than all of @value{GDBN}, so you may be able to get
18013 started more quickly on a new system by using @code{gdbserver}.
18014 Finally, if you develop code for real-time systems, you may find that
18015 the tradeoffs involved in real-time operation make it more convenient to
18016 do as much development work as possible on another system, for example
18017 by cross-compiling. You can use @code{gdbserver} to make a similar
18018 choice for debugging.
18020 @value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserver} communicate via either a serial line
18021 or a TCP connection, using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial
18025 @emph{Warning:} @code{gdbserver} does not have any built-in security.
18026 Do not run @code{gdbserver} connected to any public network; a
18027 @value{GDBN} connection to @code{gdbserver} provides access to the
18028 target system with the same privileges as the user running
18032 @subsection Running @code{gdbserver}
18033 @cindex arguments, to @code{gdbserver}
18034 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, command-line arguments
18036 Run @code{gdbserver} on the target system. You need a copy of the
18037 program you want to debug, including any libraries it requires.
18038 @code{gdbserver} does not need your program's symbol table, so you can
18039 strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the host
18040 system does all the symbol handling.
18042 To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with @value{GDBN};
18043 the name of your program; and the arguments for your program. The usual
18047 target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
18050 @var{comm} is either a device name (to use a serial line), or a TCP
18051 hostname and portnumber, or @code{-} or @code{stdio} to use
18052 stdin/stdout of @code{gdbserver}.
18053 For example, to debug Emacs with the argument
18054 @samp{foo.txt} and communicate with @value{GDBN} over the serial port
18058 target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
18061 @code{gdbserver} waits passively for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate
18064 To use a TCP connection instead of a serial line:
18067 target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
18070 The only difference from the previous example is the first argument,
18071 specifying that you are communicating with the host @value{GDBN} via
18072 TCP. The @samp{host:2345} argument means that @code{gdbserver} is to
18073 expect a TCP connection from machine @samp{host} to local TCP port 2345.
18074 (Currently, the @samp{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number
18075 you want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any
18076 TCP ports already in use on the target system (for example, @code{23} is
18077 reserved for @code{telnet}).@footnote{If you choose a port number that
18078 conflicts with another service, @code{gdbserver} prints an error message
18079 and exits.} You must use the same port number with the host @value{GDBN}
18080 @code{target remote} command.
18082 The @code{stdio} connection is useful when starting @code{gdbserver}
18086 (gdb) target remote | ssh -T hostname gdbserver - hello
18089 The @samp{-T} option to ssh is provided because we don't need a remote pty,
18090 and we don't want escape-character handling. Ssh does this by default when
18091 a command is provided, the flag is provided to make it explicit.
18092 You could elide it if you want to.
18094 Programs started with stdio-connected gdbserver have @file{/dev/null} for
18095 @code{stdin}, and @code{stdout},@code{stderr} are sent back to gdb for
18096 display through a pipe connected to gdbserver.
18097 Both @code{stdout} and @code{stderr} use the same pipe.
18099 @subsubsection Attaching to a Running Program
18100 @cindex attach to a program, @code{gdbserver}
18101 @cindex @option{--attach}, @code{gdbserver} option
18103 On some targets, @code{gdbserver} can also attach to running programs.
18104 This is accomplished via the @code{--attach} argument. The syntax is:
18107 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
18110 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't necessary
18111 to point @code{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
18114 You can debug processes by name instead of process ID if your target has the
18115 @code{pidof} utility:
18118 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} `pidof @var{program}`
18121 In case more than one copy of @var{program} is running, or @var{program}
18122 has multiple threads, most versions of @code{pidof} support the
18123 @code{-s} option to only return the first process ID.
18125 @subsubsection Multi-Process Mode for @code{gdbserver}
18126 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, multiple processes
18127 @cindex multiple processes with @code{gdbserver}
18129 When you connect to @code{gdbserver} using @code{target remote},
18130 @code{gdbserver} debugs the specified program only once. When the
18131 program exits, or you detach from it, @value{GDBN} closes the connection
18132 and @code{gdbserver} exits.
18134 If you connect using @kbd{target extended-remote}, @code{gdbserver}
18135 enters multi-process mode. When the debugged program exits, or you
18136 detach from it, @value{GDBN} stays connected to @code{gdbserver} even
18137 though no program is running. The @code{run} and @code{attach}
18138 commands instruct @code{gdbserver} to run or attach to a new program.
18139 The @code{run} command uses @code{set remote exec-file} (@pxref{set
18140 remote exec-file}) to select the program to run. Command line
18141 arguments are supported, except for wildcard expansion and I/O
18142 redirection (@pxref{Arguments}).
18144 @cindex @option{--multi}, @code{gdbserver} option
18145 To start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
18146 or process ID to attach, use the @option{--multi} command line option.
18147 Then you can connect using @kbd{target extended-remote} and start
18148 the program you want to debug.
18150 In multi-process mode @code{gdbserver} does not automatically exit unless you
18151 use the option @option{--once}. You can terminate it by using
18152 @code{monitor exit} (@pxref{Monitor Commands for gdbserver}). Note that the
18153 conditions under which @code{gdbserver} terminates depend on how @value{GDBN}
18154 connects to it (@kbd{target remote} or @kbd{target extended-remote}). The
18155 @option{--multi} option to @code{gdbserver} has no influence on that.
18157 @subsubsection TCP port allocation lifecycle of @code{gdbserver}
18159 This section applies only when @code{gdbserver} is run to listen on a TCP port.
18161 @code{gdbserver} normally terminates after all of its debugged processes have
18162 terminated in @kbd{target remote} mode. On the other hand, for @kbd{target
18163 extended-remote}, @code{gdbserver} stays running even with no processes left.
18164 @value{GDBN} normally terminates the spawned debugged process on its exit,
18165 which normally also terminates @code{gdbserver} in the @kbd{target remote}
18166 mode. Therefore, when the connection drops unexpectedly, and @value{GDBN}
18167 cannot ask @code{gdbserver} to kill its debugged processes, @code{gdbserver}
18168 stays running even in the @kbd{target remote} mode.
18170 When @code{gdbserver} stays running, @value{GDBN} can connect to it again later.
18171 Such reconnecting is useful for features like @ref{disconnected tracing}. For
18172 completeness, at most one @value{GDBN} can be connected at a time.
18174 @cindex @option{--once}, @code{gdbserver} option
18175 By default, @code{gdbserver} keeps the listening TCP port open, so that
18176 additional connections are possible. However, if you start @code{gdbserver}
18177 with the @option{--once} option, it will stop listening for any further
18178 connection attempts after connecting to the first @value{GDBN} session. This
18179 means no further connections to @code{gdbserver} will be possible after the
18180 first one. It also means @code{gdbserver} will terminate after the first
18181 connection with remote @value{GDBN} has closed, even for unexpectedly closed
18182 connections and even in the @kbd{target extended-remote} mode. The
18183 @option{--once} option allows reusing the same port number for connecting to
18184 multiple instances of @code{gdbserver} running on the same host, since each
18185 instance closes its port after the first connection.
18187 @subsubsection Other Command-Line Arguments for @code{gdbserver}
18189 @cindex @option{--debug}, @code{gdbserver} option
18190 The @option{--debug} option tells @code{gdbserver} to display extra
18191 status information about the debugging process.
18192 @cindex @option{--remote-debug}, @code{gdbserver} option
18193 The @option{--remote-debug} option tells @code{gdbserver} to display
18194 remote protocol debug output. These options are intended for
18195 @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to the developers.
18197 @cindex @option{--wrapper}, @code{gdbserver} option
18198 The @option{--wrapper} option specifies a wrapper to launch programs
18199 for debugging. The option should be followed by the name of the
18200 wrapper, then any command-line arguments to pass to the wrapper, then
18201 @kbd{--} indicating the end of the wrapper arguments.
18203 @code{gdbserver} runs the specified wrapper program with a combined
18204 command line including the wrapper arguments, then the name of the
18205 program to debug, then any arguments to the program. The wrapper
18206 runs until it executes your program, and then @value{GDBN} gains control.
18208 You can use any program that eventually calls @code{execve} with
18209 its arguments as a wrapper. Several standard Unix utilities do
18210 this, e.g.@: @code{env} and @code{nohup}. Any Unix shell script ending
18211 with @code{exec "$@@"} will also work.
18213 For example, you can use @code{env} to pass an environment variable to
18214 the debugged program, without setting the variable in @code{gdbserver}'s
18218 $ gdbserver --wrapper env LD_PRELOAD=libtest.so -- :2222 ./testprog
18221 @subsection Connecting to @code{gdbserver}
18223 Run @value{GDBN} on the host system.
18225 First make sure you have the necessary symbol files. Load symbols for
18226 your application using the @code{file} command before you connect. Use
18227 @code{set sysroot} to locate target libraries (unless your @value{GDBN}
18228 was compiled with the correct sysroot using @code{--with-sysroot}).
18230 The symbol file and target libraries must exactly match the executable
18231 and libraries on the target, with one exception: the files on the host
18232 system should not be stripped, even if the files on the target system
18233 are. Mismatched or missing files will lead to confusing results
18234 during debugging. On @sc{gnu}/Linux targets, mismatched or missing
18235 files may also prevent @code{gdbserver} from debugging multi-threaded
18238 Connect to your target (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
18239 For TCP connections, you must start up @code{gdbserver} prior to using
18240 the @code{target remote} command. Otherwise you may get an error whose
18241 text depends on the host system, but which usually looks something like
18242 @samp{Connection refused}. Don't use the @code{load}
18243 command in @value{GDBN} when using @code{gdbserver}, since the program is
18244 already on the target.
18246 @subsection Monitor Commands for @code{gdbserver}
18247 @cindex monitor commands, for @code{gdbserver}
18248 @anchor{Monitor Commands for gdbserver}
18250 During a @value{GDBN} session using @code{gdbserver}, you can use the
18251 @code{monitor} command to send special requests to @code{gdbserver}.
18252 Here are the available commands.
18256 List the available monitor commands.
18258 @item monitor set debug 0
18259 @itemx monitor set debug 1
18260 Disable or enable general debugging messages.
18262 @item monitor set remote-debug 0
18263 @itemx monitor set remote-debug 1
18264 Disable or enable specific debugging messages associated with the remote
18265 protocol (@pxref{Remote Protocol}).
18267 @item monitor set libthread-db-search-path [PATH]
18268 @cindex gdbserver, search path for @code{libthread_db}
18269 When this command is issued, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
18270 directories to search for @code{libthread_db} (@pxref{Threads,,set
18271 libthread-db-search-path}). If you omit @var{path},
18272 @samp{libthread-db-search-path} will be reset to its default value.
18274 The special entry @samp{$pdir} for @samp{libthread-db-search-path} is
18275 not supported in @code{gdbserver}.
18278 Tell gdbserver to exit immediately. This command should be followed by
18279 @code{disconnect} to close the debugging session. @code{gdbserver} will
18280 detach from any attached processes and kill any processes it created.
18281 Use @code{monitor exit} to terminate @code{gdbserver} at the end
18282 of a multi-process mode debug session.
18286 @subsection Tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}
18287 @cindex tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}
18289 On some targets, @code{gdbserver} supports tracepoints, fast
18290 tracepoints and static tracepoints.
18292 For fast or static tracepoints to work, a special library called the
18293 @dfn{in-process agent} (IPA), must be loaded in the inferior process.
18294 This library is built and distributed as an integral part of
18295 @code{gdbserver}. In addition, support for static tracepoints
18296 requires building the in-process agent library with static tracepoints
18297 support. At present, the UST (LTTng Userspace Tracer,
18298 @url{http://lttng.org/ust}) tracing engine is supported. This support
18299 is automatically available if UST development headers are found in the
18300 standard include path when @code{gdbserver} is built, or if
18301 @code{gdbserver} was explicitly configured using @option{--with-ust}
18302 to point at such headers. You can explicitly disable the support
18303 using @option{--with-ust=no}.
18305 There are several ways to load the in-process agent in your program:
18308 @item Specifying it as dependency at link time
18310 You can link your program dynamically with the in-process agent
18311 library. On most systems, this is accomplished by adding
18312 @code{-linproctrace} to the link command.
18314 @item Using the system's preloading mechanisms
18316 You can force loading the in-process agent at startup time by using
18317 your system's support for preloading shared libraries. Many Unixes
18318 support the concept of preloading user defined libraries. In most
18319 cases, you do that by specifying @code{LD_PRELOAD=libinproctrace.so}
18320 in the environment. See also the description of @code{gdbserver}'s
18321 @option{--wrapper} command line option.
18323 @item Using @value{GDBN} to force loading the agent at run time
18325 On some systems, you can force the inferior to load a shared library,
18326 by calling a dynamic loader function in the inferior that takes care
18327 of dynamically looking up and loading a shared library. On most Unix
18328 systems, the function is @code{dlopen}. You'll use the @code{call}
18329 command for that. For example:
18332 (@value{GDBP}) call dlopen ("libinproctrace.so", ...)
18335 Note that on most Unix systems, for the @code{dlopen} function to be
18336 available, the program needs to be linked with @code{-ldl}.
18339 On systems that have a userspace dynamic loader, like most Unix
18340 systems, when you connect to @code{gdbserver} using @code{target
18341 remote}, you'll find that the program is stopped at the dynamic
18342 loader's entry point, and no shared library has been loaded in the
18343 program's address space yet, including the in-process agent. In that
18344 case, before being able to use any of the fast or static tracepoints
18345 features, you need to let the loader run and load the shared
18346 libraries. The simplest way to do that is to run the program to the
18347 main procedure. E.g., if debugging a C or C@t{++} program, start
18348 @code{gdbserver} like so:
18351 $ gdbserver :9999 myprogram
18354 Start GDB and connect to @code{gdbserver} like so, and run to main:
18358 (@value{GDBP}) target remote myhost:9999
18359 0x00007f215893ba60 in ?? () from /lib64/ld-linux-x86-64.so.2
18360 (@value{GDBP}) b main
18361 (@value{GDBP}) continue
18364 The in-process tracing agent library should now be loaded into the
18365 process; you can confirm it with the @code{info sharedlibrary}
18366 command, which will list @file{libinproctrace.so} as loaded in the
18367 process. You are now ready to install fast tracepoints, list static
18368 tracepoint markers, probe static tracepoints markers, and start
18371 @node Remote Configuration
18372 @section Remote Configuration
18375 @kindex show remote
18376 This section documents the configuration options available when
18377 debugging remote programs. For the options related to the File I/O
18378 extensions of the remote protocol, see @ref{system,
18379 system-call-allowed}.
18382 @item set remoteaddresssize @var{bits}
18383 @cindex address size for remote targets
18384 @cindex bits in remote address
18385 Set the maximum size of address in a memory packet to the specified
18386 number of bits. @value{GDBN} will mask off the address bits above
18387 that number, when it passes addresses to the remote target. The
18388 default value is the number of bits in the target's address.
18390 @item show remoteaddresssize
18391 Show the current value of remote address size in bits.
18393 @item set remotebaud @var{n}
18394 @cindex baud rate for remote targets
18395 Set the baud rate for the remote serial I/O to @var{n} baud. The
18396 value is used to set the speed of the serial port used for debugging
18399 @item show remotebaud
18400 Show the current speed of the remote connection.
18402 @item set remotebreak
18403 @cindex interrupt remote programs
18404 @cindex BREAK signal instead of Ctrl-C
18405 @anchor{set remotebreak}
18406 If set to on, @value{GDBN} sends a @code{BREAK} signal to the remote
18407 when you type @kbd{Ctrl-c} to interrupt the program running
18408 on the remote. If set to off, @value{GDBN} sends the @samp{Ctrl-C}
18409 character instead. The default is off, since most remote systems
18410 expect to see @samp{Ctrl-C} as the interrupt signal.
18412 @item show remotebreak
18413 Show whether @value{GDBN} sends @code{BREAK} or @samp{Ctrl-C} to
18414 interrupt the remote program.
18416 @item set remoteflow on
18417 @itemx set remoteflow off
18418 @kindex set remoteflow
18419 Enable or disable hardware flow control (@code{RTS}/@code{CTS})
18420 on the serial port used to communicate to the remote target.
18422 @item show remoteflow
18423 @kindex show remoteflow
18424 Show the current setting of hardware flow control.
18426 @item set remotelogbase @var{base}
18427 Set the base (a.k.a.@: radix) of logging serial protocol
18428 communications to @var{base}. Supported values of @var{base} are:
18429 @code{ascii}, @code{octal}, and @code{hex}. The default is
18432 @item show remotelogbase
18433 Show the current setting of the radix for logging remote serial
18436 @item set remotelogfile @var{file}
18437 @cindex record serial communications on file
18438 Record remote serial communications on the named @var{file}. The
18439 default is not to record at all.
18441 @item show remotelogfile.
18442 Show the current setting of the file name on which to record the
18443 serial communications.
18445 @item set remotetimeout @var{num}
18446 @cindex timeout for serial communications
18447 @cindex remote timeout
18448 Set the timeout limit to wait for the remote target to respond to
18449 @var{num} seconds. The default is 2 seconds.
18451 @item show remotetimeout
18452 Show the current number of seconds to wait for the remote target
18455 @cindex limit hardware breakpoints and watchpoints
18456 @cindex remote target, limit break- and watchpoints
18457 @anchor{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}
18458 @anchor{set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit}
18459 @item set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit @var{limit}
18460 @itemx set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit @var{limit}
18461 Restrict @value{GDBN} to using @var{limit} remote hardware breakpoint or
18462 watchpoints. A limit of -1, the default, is treated as unlimited.
18464 @cindex limit hardware watchpoints length
18465 @cindex remote target, limit watchpoints length
18466 @anchor{set remote hardware-watchpoint-length-limit}
18467 @item set remote hardware-watchpoint-length-limit @var{limit}
18468 Restrict @value{GDBN} to using @var{limit} bytes for the maximum length of
18469 a remote hardware watchpoint. A limit of -1, the default, is treated
18472 @item show remote hardware-watchpoint-length-limit
18473 Show the current limit (in bytes) of the maximum length of
18474 a remote hardware watchpoint.
18476 @item set remote exec-file @var{filename}
18477 @itemx show remote exec-file
18478 @anchor{set remote exec-file}
18479 @cindex executable file, for remote target
18480 Select the file used for @code{run} with @code{target
18481 extended-remote}. This should be set to a filename valid on the
18482 target system. If it is not set, the target will use a default
18483 filename (e.g.@: the last program run).
18485 @item set remote interrupt-sequence
18486 @cindex interrupt remote programs
18487 @cindex select Ctrl-C, BREAK or BREAK-g
18488 Allow the user to select one of @samp{Ctrl-C}, a @code{BREAK} or
18489 @samp{BREAK-g} as the
18490 sequence to the remote target in order to interrupt the execution.
18491 @samp{Ctrl-C} is a default. Some system prefers @code{BREAK} which
18492 is high level of serial line for some certain time.
18493 Linux kernel prefers @samp{BREAK-g}, a.k.a Magic SysRq g.
18494 It is @code{BREAK} signal followed by character @code{g}.
18496 @item show interrupt-sequence
18497 Show which of @samp{Ctrl-C}, @code{BREAK} or @code{BREAK-g}
18498 is sent by @value{GDBN} to interrupt the remote program.
18499 @code{BREAK-g} is BREAK signal followed by @code{g} and
18500 also known as Magic SysRq g.
18502 @item set remote interrupt-on-connect
18503 @cindex send interrupt-sequence on start
18504 Specify whether interrupt-sequence is sent to remote target when
18505 @value{GDBN} connects to it. This is mostly needed when you debug
18506 Linux kernel. Linux kernel expects @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g}
18507 which is known as Magic SysRq g in order to connect @value{GDBN}.
18509 @item show interrupt-on-connect
18510 Show whether interrupt-sequence is sent
18511 to remote target when @value{GDBN} connects to it.
18515 @item set tcp auto-retry on
18516 @cindex auto-retry, for remote TCP target
18517 Enable auto-retry for remote TCP connections. This is useful if the remote
18518 debugging agent is launched in parallel with @value{GDBN}; there is a race
18519 condition because the agent may not become ready to accept the connection
18520 before @value{GDBN} attempts to connect. When auto-retry is
18521 enabled, if the initial attempt to connect fails, @value{GDBN} reattempts
18522 to establish the connection using the timeout specified by
18523 @code{set tcp connect-timeout}.
18525 @item set tcp auto-retry off
18526 Do not auto-retry failed TCP connections.
18528 @item show tcp auto-retry
18529 Show the current auto-retry setting.
18531 @item set tcp connect-timeout @var{seconds}
18532 @itemx set tcp connect-timeout unlimited
18533 @cindex connection timeout, for remote TCP target
18534 @cindex timeout, for remote target connection
18535 Set the timeout for establishing a TCP connection to the remote target to
18536 @var{seconds}. The timeout affects both polling to retry failed connections
18537 (enabled by @code{set tcp auto-retry on}) and waiting for connections
18538 that are merely slow to complete, and represents an approximate cumulative
18539 value. If @var{seconds} is @code{unlimited}, there is no timeout and
18540 @value{GDBN} will keep attempting to establish a connection forever,
18541 unless interrupted with @kbd{Ctrl-c}. The default is 15 seconds.
18543 @item show tcp connect-timeout
18544 Show the current connection timeout setting.
18547 @cindex remote packets, enabling and disabling
18548 The @value{GDBN} remote protocol autodetects the packets supported by
18549 your debugging stub. If you need to override the autodetection, you
18550 can use these commands to enable or disable individual packets. Each
18551 packet can be set to @samp{on} (the remote target supports this
18552 packet), @samp{off} (the remote target does not support this packet),
18553 or @samp{auto} (detect remote target support for this packet). They
18554 all default to @samp{auto}. For more information about each packet,
18555 see @ref{Remote Protocol}.
18557 During normal use, you should not have to use any of these commands.
18558 If you do, that may be a bug in your remote debugging stub, or a bug
18559 in @value{GDBN}. You may want to report the problem to the
18560 @value{GDBN} developers.
18562 For each packet @var{name}, the command to enable or disable the
18563 packet is @code{set remote @var{name}-packet}. The available settings
18566 @multitable @columnfractions 0.28 0.32 0.25
18569 @tab Related Features
18571 @item @code{fetch-register}
18573 @tab @code{info registers}
18575 @item @code{set-register}
18579 @item @code{binary-download}
18581 @tab @code{load}, @code{set}
18583 @item @code{read-aux-vector}
18584 @tab @code{qXfer:auxv:read}
18585 @tab @code{info auxv}
18587 @item @code{symbol-lookup}
18588 @tab @code{qSymbol}
18589 @tab Detecting multiple threads
18591 @item @code{attach}
18592 @tab @code{vAttach}
18595 @item @code{verbose-resume}
18597 @tab Stepping or resuming multiple threads
18603 @item @code{software-breakpoint}
18607 @item @code{hardware-breakpoint}
18611 @item @code{write-watchpoint}
18615 @item @code{read-watchpoint}
18619 @item @code{access-watchpoint}
18623 @item @code{target-features}
18624 @tab @code{qXfer:features:read}
18625 @tab @code{set architecture}
18627 @item @code{library-info}
18628 @tab @code{qXfer:libraries:read}
18629 @tab @code{info sharedlibrary}
18631 @item @code{memory-map}
18632 @tab @code{qXfer:memory-map:read}
18633 @tab @code{info mem}
18635 @item @code{read-sdata-object}
18636 @tab @code{qXfer:sdata:read}
18637 @tab @code{print $_sdata}
18639 @item @code{read-spu-object}
18640 @tab @code{qXfer:spu:read}
18641 @tab @code{info spu}
18643 @item @code{write-spu-object}
18644 @tab @code{qXfer:spu:write}
18645 @tab @code{info spu}
18647 @item @code{read-siginfo-object}
18648 @tab @code{qXfer:siginfo:read}
18649 @tab @code{print $_siginfo}
18651 @item @code{write-siginfo-object}
18652 @tab @code{qXfer:siginfo:write}
18653 @tab @code{set $_siginfo}
18655 @item @code{threads}
18656 @tab @code{qXfer:threads:read}
18657 @tab @code{info threads}
18659 @item @code{get-thread-local-@*storage-address}
18660 @tab @code{qGetTLSAddr}
18661 @tab Displaying @code{__thread} variables
18663 @item @code{get-thread-information-block-address}
18664 @tab @code{qGetTIBAddr}
18665 @tab Display MS-Windows Thread Information Block.
18667 @item @code{search-memory}
18668 @tab @code{qSearch:memory}
18671 @item @code{supported-packets}
18672 @tab @code{qSupported}
18673 @tab Remote communications parameters
18675 @item @code{pass-signals}
18676 @tab @code{QPassSignals}
18677 @tab @code{handle @var{signal}}
18679 @item @code{program-signals}
18680 @tab @code{QProgramSignals}
18681 @tab @code{handle @var{signal}}
18683 @item @code{hostio-close-packet}
18684 @tab @code{vFile:close}
18685 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
18687 @item @code{hostio-open-packet}
18688 @tab @code{vFile:open}
18689 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
18691 @item @code{hostio-pread-packet}
18692 @tab @code{vFile:pread}
18693 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
18695 @item @code{hostio-pwrite-packet}
18696 @tab @code{vFile:pwrite}
18697 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
18699 @item @code{hostio-unlink-packet}
18700 @tab @code{vFile:unlink}
18701 @tab @code{remote delete}
18703 @item @code{hostio-readlink-packet}
18704 @tab @code{vFile:readlink}
18707 @item @code{noack-packet}
18708 @tab @code{QStartNoAckMode}
18709 @tab Packet acknowledgment
18711 @item @code{osdata}
18712 @tab @code{qXfer:osdata:read}
18713 @tab @code{info os}
18715 @item @code{query-attached}
18716 @tab @code{qAttached}
18717 @tab Querying remote process attach state.
18719 @item @code{trace-buffer-size}
18720 @tab @code{QTBuffer:size}
18721 @tab @code{set trace-buffer-size}
18723 @item @code{trace-status}
18724 @tab @code{qTStatus}
18725 @tab @code{tstatus}
18727 @item @code{traceframe-info}
18728 @tab @code{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
18729 @tab Traceframe info
18731 @item @code{install-in-trace}
18732 @tab @code{InstallInTrace}
18733 @tab Install tracepoint in tracing
18735 @item @code{disable-randomization}
18736 @tab @code{QDisableRandomization}
18737 @tab @code{set disable-randomization}
18739 @item @code{conditional-breakpoints-packet}
18740 @tab @code{Z0 and Z1}
18741 @tab @code{Support for target-side breakpoint condition evaluation}
18745 @section Implementing a Remote Stub
18747 @cindex debugging stub, example
18748 @cindex remote stub, example
18749 @cindex stub example, remote debugging
18750 The stub files provided with @value{GDBN} implement the target side of the
18751 communication protocol, and the @value{GDBN} side is implemented in the
18752 @value{GDBN} source file @file{remote.c}. Normally, you can simply allow
18753 these subroutines to communicate, and ignore the details. (If you're
18754 implementing your own stub file, you can still ignore the details: start
18755 with one of the existing stub files. @file{sparc-stub.c} is the best
18756 organized, and therefore the easiest to read.)
18758 @cindex remote serial debugging, overview
18759 To debug a program running on another machine (the debugging
18760 @dfn{target} machine), you must first arrange for all the usual
18761 prerequisites for the program to run by itself. For example, for a C
18766 A startup routine to set up the C runtime environment; these usually
18767 have a name like @file{crt0}. The startup routine may be supplied by
18768 your hardware supplier, or you may have to write your own.
18771 A C subroutine library to support your program's
18772 subroutine calls, notably managing input and output.
18775 A way of getting your program to the other machine---for example, a
18776 download program. These are often supplied by the hardware
18777 manufacturer, but you may have to write your own from hardware
18781 The next step is to arrange for your program to use a serial port to
18782 communicate with the machine where @value{GDBN} is running (the @dfn{host}
18783 machine). In general terms, the scheme looks like this:
18787 @value{GDBN} already understands how to use this protocol; when everything
18788 else is set up, you can simply use the @samp{target remote} command
18789 (@pxref{Targets,,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
18791 @item On the target,
18792 you must link with your program a few special-purpose subroutines that
18793 implement the @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol. The file containing these
18794 subroutines is called a @dfn{debugging stub}.
18796 On certain remote targets, you can use an auxiliary program
18797 @code{gdbserver} instead of linking a stub into your program.
18798 @xref{Server,,Using the @code{gdbserver} Program}, for details.
18801 The debugging stub is specific to the architecture of the remote
18802 machine; for example, use @file{sparc-stub.c} to debug programs on
18805 @cindex remote serial stub list
18806 These working remote stubs are distributed with @value{GDBN}:
18811 @cindex @file{i386-stub.c}
18814 For Intel 386 and compatible architectures.
18817 @cindex @file{m68k-stub.c}
18818 @cindex Motorola 680x0
18820 For Motorola 680x0 architectures.
18823 @cindex @file{sh-stub.c}
18826 For Renesas SH architectures.
18829 @cindex @file{sparc-stub.c}
18831 For @sc{sparc} architectures.
18833 @item sparcl-stub.c
18834 @cindex @file{sparcl-stub.c}
18837 For Fujitsu @sc{sparclite} architectures.
18841 The @file{README} file in the @value{GDBN} distribution may list other
18842 recently added stubs.
18845 * Stub Contents:: What the stub can do for you
18846 * Bootstrapping:: What you must do for the stub
18847 * Debug Session:: Putting it all together
18850 @node Stub Contents
18851 @subsection What the Stub Can Do for You
18853 @cindex remote serial stub
18854 The debugging stub for your architecture supplies these three
18858 @item set_debug_traps
18859 @findex set_debug_traps
18860 @cindex remote serial stub, initialization
18861 This routine arranges for @code{handle_exception} to run when your
18862 program stops. You must call this subroutine explicitly in your
18863 program's startup code.
18865 @item handle_exception
18866 @findex handle_exception
18867 @cindex remote serial stub, main routine
18868 This is the central workhorse, but your program never calls it
18869 explicitly---the setup code arranges for @code{handle_exception} to
18870 run when a trap is triggered.
18872 @code{handle_exception} takes control when your program stops during
18873 execution (for example, on a breakpoint), and mediates communications
18874 with @value{GDBN} on the host machine. This is where the communications
18875 protocol is implemented; @code{handle_exception} acts as the @value{GDBN}
18876 representative on the target machine. It begins by sending summary
18877 information on the state of your program, then continues to execute,
18878 retrieving and transmitting any information @value{GDBN} needs, until you
18879 execute a @value{GDBN} command that makes your program resume; at that point,
18880 @code{handle_exception} returns control to your own code on the target
18884 @cindex @code{breakpoint} subroutine, remote
18885 Use this auxiliary subroutine to make your program contain a
18886 breakpoint. Depending on the particular situation, this may be the only
18887 way for @value{GDBN} to get control. For instance, if your target
18888 machine has some sort of interrupt button, you won't need to call this;
18889 pressing the interrupt button transfers control to
18890 @code{handle_exception}---in effect, to @value{GDBN}. On some machines,
18891 simply receiving characters on the serial port may also trigger a trap;
18892 again, in that situation, you don't need to call @code{breakpoint} from
18893 your own program---simply running @samp{target remote} from the host
18894 @value{GDBN} session gets control.
18896 Call @code{breakpoint} if none of these is true, or if you simply want
18897 to make certain your program stops at a predetermined point for the
18898 start of your debugging session.
18901 @node Bootstrapping
18902 @subsection What You Must Do for the Stub
18904 @cindex remote stub, support routines
18905 The debugging stubs that come with @value{GDBN} are set up for a particular
18906 chip architecture, but they have no information about the rest of your
18907 debugging target machine.
18909 First of all you need to tell the stub how to communicate with the
18913 @item int getDebugChar()
18914 @findex getDebugChar
18915 Write this subroutine to read a single character from the serial port.
18916 It may be identical to @code{getchar} for your target system; a
18917 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
18919 @item void putDebugChar(int)
18920 @findex putDebugChar
18921 Write this subroutine to write a single character to the serial port.
18922 It may be identical to @code{putchar} for your target system; a
18923 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
18926 @cindex control C, and remote debugging
18927 @cindex interrupting remote targets
18928 If you want @value{GDBN} to be able to stop your program while it is
18929 running, you need to use an interrupt-driven serial driver, and arrange
18930 for it to stop when it receives a @code{^C} (@samp{\003}, the control-C
18931 character). That is the character which @value{GDBN} uses to tell the
18932 remote system to stop.
18934 Getting the debugging target to return the proper status to @value{GDBN}
18935 probably requires changes to the standard stub; one quick and dirty way
18936 is to just execute a breakpoint instruction (the ``dirty'' part is that
18937 @value{GDBN} reports a @code{SIGTRAP} instead of a @code{SIGINT}).
18939 Other routines you need to supply are:
18942 @item void exceptionHandler (int @var{exception_number}, void *@var{exception_address})
18943 @findex exceptionHandler
18944 Write this function to install @var{exception_address} in the exception
18945 handling tables. You need to do this because the stub does not have any
18946 way of knowing what the exception handling tables on your target system
18947 are like (for example, the processor's table might be in @sc{rom},
18948 containing entries which point to a table in @sc{ram}).
18949 @var{exception_number} is the exception number which should be changed;
18950 its meaning is architecture-dependent (for example, different numbers
18951 might represent divide by zero, misaligned access, etc). When this
18952 exception occurs, control should be transferred directly to
18953 @var{exception_address}, and the processor state (stack, registers,
18954 and so on) should be just as it is when a processor exception occurs. So if
18955 you want to use a jump instruction to reach @var{exception_address}, it
18956 should be a simple jump, not a jump to subroutine.
18958 For the 386, @var{exception_address} should be installed as an interrupt
18959 gate so that interrupts are masked while the handler runs. The gate
18960 should be at privilege level 0 (the most privileged level). The
18961 @sc{sparc} and 68k stubs are able to mask interrupts themselves without
18962 help from @code{exceptionHandler}.
18964 @item void flush_i_cache()
18965 @findex flush_i_cache
18966 On @sc{sparc} and @sc{sparclite} only, write this subroutine to flush the
18967 instruction cache, if any, on your target machine. If there is no
18968 instruction cache, this subroutine may be a no-op.
18970 On target machines that have instruction caches, @value{GDBN} requires this
18971 function to make certain that the state of your program is stable.
18975 You must also make sure this library routine is available:
18978 @item void *memset(void *, int, int)
18980 This is the standard library function @code{memset} that sets an area of
18981 memory to a known value. If you have one of the free versions of
18982 @code{libc.a}, @code{memset} can be found there; otherwise, you must
18983 either obtain it from your hardware manufacturer, or write your own.
18986 If you do not use the GNU C compiler, you may need other standard
18987 library subroutines as well; this varies from one stub to another,
18988 but in general the stubs are likely to use any of the common library
18989 subroutines which @code{@value{NGCC}} generates as inline code.
18992 @node Debug Session
18993 @subsection Putting it All Together
18995 @cindex remote serial debugging summary
18996 In summary, when your program is ready to debug, you must follow these
19001 Make sure you have defined the supporting low-level routines
19002 (@pxref{Bootstrapping,,What You Must Do for the Stub}):
19004 @code{getDebugChar}, @code{putDebugChar},
19005 @code{flush_i_cache}, @code{memset}, @code{exceptionHandler}.
19009 Insert these lines in your program's startup code, before the main
19010 procedure is called:
19017 On some machines, when a breakpoint trap is raised, the hardware
19018 automatically makes the PC point to the instruction after the
19019 breakpoint. If your machine doesn't do that, you may need to adjust
19020 @code{handle_exception} to arrange for it to return to the instruction
19021 after the breakpoint on this first invocation, so that your program
19022 doesn't keep hitting the initial breakpoint instead of making
19026 For the 680x0 stub only, you need to provide a variable called
19027 @code{exceptionHook}. Normally you just use:
19030 void (*exceptionHook)() = 0;
19034 but if before calling @code{set_debug_traps}, you set it to point to a
19035 function in your program, that function is called when
19036 @code{@value{GDBN}} continues after stopping on a trap (for example, bus
19037 error). The function indicated by @code{exceptionHook} is called with
19038 one parameter: an @code{int} which is the exception number.
19041 Compile and link together: your program, the @value{GDBN} debugging stub for
19042 your target architecture, and the supporting subroutines.
19045 Make sure you have a serial connection between your target machine and
19046 the @value{GDBN} host, and identify the serial port on the host.
19049 @c The "remote" target now provides a `load' command, so we should
19050 @c document that. FIXME.
19051 Download your program to your target machine (or get it there by
19052 whatever means the manufacturer provides), and start it.
19055 Start @value{GDBN} on the host, and connect to the target
19056 (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
19060 @node Configurations
19061 @chapter Configuration-Specific Information
19063 While nearly all @value{GDBN} commands are available for all native and
19064 cross versions of the debugger, there are some exceptions. This chapter
19065 describes things that are only available in certain configurations.
19067 There are three major categories of configurations: native
19068 configurations, where the host and target are the same, embedded
19069 operating system configurations, which are usually the same for several
19070 different processor architectures, and bare embedded processors, which
19071 are quite different from each other.
19076 * Embedded Processors::
19083 This section describes details specific to particular native
19088 * BSD libkvm Interface:: Debugging BSD kernel memory images
19089 * SVR4 Process Information:: SVR4 process information
19090 * DJGPP Native:: Features specific to the DJGPP port
19091 * Cygwin Native:: Features specific to the Cygwin port
19092 * Hurd Native:: Features specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd
19093 * Darwin:: Features specific to Darwin
19099 On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
19100 begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
19101 name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
19104 @node BSD libkvm Interface
19105 @subsection BSD libkvm Interface
19108 @cindex kernel memory image
19109 @cindex kernel crash dump
19111 BSD-derived systems (FreeBSD/NetBSD/OpenBSD) have a kernel memory
19112 interface that provides a uniform interface for accessing kernel virtual
19113 memory images, including live systems and crash dumps. @value{GDBN}
19114 uses this interface to allow you to debug live kernels and kernel crash
19115 dumps on many native BSD configurations. This is implemented as a
19116 special @code{kvm} debugging target. For debugging a live system, load
19117 the currently running kernel into @value{GDBN} and connect to the
19121 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm}
19124 For debugging crash dumps, provide the file name of the crash dump as an
19128 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm /var/crash/bsd.0}
19131 Once connected to the @code{kvm} target, the following commands are
19137 Set current context from the @dfn{Process Control Block} (PCB) address.
19140 Set current context from proc address. This command isn't available on
19141 modern FreeBSD systems.
19144 @node SVR4 Process Information
19145 @subsection SVR4 Process Information
19147 @cindex examine process image
19148 @cindex process info via @file{/proc}
19150 Many versions of SVR4 and compatible systems provide a facility called
19151 @samp{/proc} that can be used to examine the image of a running
19152 process using file-system subroutines.
19154 If @value{GDBN} is configured for an operating system with this
19155 facility, the command @code{info proc} is available to report
19156 information about the process running your program, or about any
19157 process running on your system. This includes, as of this writing,
19158 @sc{gnu}/Linux, OSF/1 (Digital Unix), Solaris, and Irix, but
19159 not HP-UX, for example.
19161 This command may also work on core files that were created on a system
19162 that has the @samp{/proc} facility.
19168 @itemx info proc @var{process-id}
19169 Summarize available information about any running process. If a
19170 process ID is specified by @var{process-id}, display information about
19171 that process; otherwise display information about the program being
19172 debugged. The summary includes the debugged process ID, the command
19173 line used to invoke it, its current working directory, and its
19174 executable file's absolute file name.
19176 On some systems, @var{process-id} can be of the form
19177 @samp{[@var{pid}]/@var{tid}} which specifies a certain thread ID
19178 within a process. If the optional @var{pid} part is missing, it means
19179 a thread from the process being debugged (the leading @samp{/} still
19180 needs to be present, or else @value{GDBN} will interpret the number as
19181 a process ID rather than a thread ID).
19183 @item info proc cmdline
19184 @cindex info proc cmdline
19185 Show the original command line of the process. This command is
19186 specific to @sc{gnu}/Linux.
19188 @item info proc cwd
19189 @cindex info proc cwd
19190 Show the current working directory of the process. This command is
19191 specific to @sc{gnu}/Linux.
19193 @item info proc exe
19194 @cindex info proc exe
19195 Show the name of executable of the process. This command is specific
19198 @item info proc mappings
19199 @cindex memory address space mappings
19200 Report the memory address space ranges accessible in the program, with
19201 information on whether the process has read, write, or execute access
19202 rights to each range. On @sc{gnu}/Linux systems, each memory range
19203 includes the object file which is mapped to that range, instead of the
19204 memory access rights to that range.
19206 @item info proc stat
19207 @itemx info proc status
19208 @cindex process detailed status information
19209 These subcommands are specific to @sc{gnu}/Linux systems. They show
19210 the process-related information, including the user ID and group ID;
19211 how many threads are there in the process; its virtual memory usage;
19212 the signals that are pending, blocked, and ignored; its TTY; its
19213 consumption of system and user time; its stack size; its @samp{nice}
19214 value; etc. For more information, see the @samp{proc} man page
19215 (type @kbd{man 5 proc} from your shell prompt).
19217 @item info proc all
19218 Show all the information about the process described under all of the
19219 above @code{info proc} subcommands.
19222 @comment These sub-options of 'info proc' were not included when
19223 @comment procfs.c was re-written. Keep their descriptions around
19224 @comment against the day when someone finds the time to put them back in.
19225 @kindex info proc times
19226 @item info proc times
19227 Starting time, user CPU time, and system CPU time for your program and
19230 @kindex info proc id
19232 Report on the process IDs related to your program: its own process ID,
19233 the ID of its parent, the process group ID, and the session ID.
19236 @item set procfs-trace
19237 @kindex set procfs-trace
19238 @cindex @code{procfs} API calls
19239 This command enables and disables tracing of @code{procfs} API calls.
19241 @item show procfs-trace
19242 @kindex show procfs-trace
19243 Show the current state of @code{procfs} API call tracing.
19245 @item set procfs-file @var{file}
19246 @kindex set procfs-file
19247 Tell @value{GDBN} to write @code{procfs} API trace to the named
19248 @var{file}. @value{GDBN} appends the trace info to the previous
19249 contents of the file. The default is to display the trace on the
19252 @item show procfs-file
19253 @kindex show procfs-file
19254 Show the file to which @code{procfs} API trace is written.
19256 @item proc-trace-entry
19257 @itemx proc-trace-exit
19258 @itemx proc-untrace-entry
19259 @itemx proc-untrace-exit
19260 @kindex proc-trace-entry
19261 @kindex proc-trace-exit
19262 @kindex proc-untrace-entry
19263 @kindex proc-untrace-exit
19264 These commands enable and disable tracing of entries into and exits
19265 from the @code{syscall} interface.
19268 @kindex info pidlist
19269 @cindex process list, QNX Neutrino
19270 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all the
19271 processes and all the threads within each process.
19274 @kindex info meminfo
19275 @cindex mapinfo list, QNX Neutrino
19276 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all mapinfos.
19280 @subsection Features for Debugging @sc{djgpp} Programs
19281 @cindex @sc{djgpp} debugging
19282 @cindex native @sc{djgpp} debugging
19283 @cindex MS-DOS-specific commands
19286 @sc{djgpp} is a port of the @sc{gnu} development tools to MS-DOS and
19287 MS-Windows. @sc{djgpp} programs are 32-bit protected-mode programs
19288 that use the @dfn{DPMI} (DOS Protected-Mode Interface) API to run on
19289 top of real-mode DOS systems and their emulations.
19291 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of @sc{djgpp} programs, and
19292 defines a few commands specific to the @sc{djgpp} port. This
19293 subsection describes those commands.
19298 This is a prefix of @sc{djgpp}-specific commands which print
19299 information about the target system and important OS structures.
19302 @cindex MS-DOS system info
19303 @cindex free memory information (MS-DOS)
19304 @item info dos sysinfo
19305 This command displays assorted information about the underlying
19306 platform: the CPU type and features, the OS version and flavor, the
19307 DPMI version, and the available conventional and DPMI memory.
19312 @cindex segment descriptor tables
19313 @cindex descriptor tables display
19315 @itemx info dos ldt
19316 @itemx info dos idt
19317 These 3 commands display entries from, respectively, Global, Local,
19318 and Interrupt Descriptor Tables (GDT, LDT, and IDT). The descriptor
19319 tables are data structures which store a descriptor for each segment
19320 that is currently in use. The segment's selector is an index into a
19321 descriptor table; the table entry for that index holds the
19322 descriptor's base address and limit, and its attributes and access
19325 A typical @sc{djgpp} program uses 3 segments: a code segment, a data
19326 segment (used for both data and the stack), and a DOS segment (which
19327 allows access to DOS/BIOS data structures and absolute addresses in
19328 conventional memory). However, the DPMI host will usually define
19329 additional segments in order to support the DPMI environment.
19331 @cindex garbled pointers
19332 These commands allow to display entries from the descriptor tables.
19333 Without an argument, all entries from the specified table are
19334 displayed. An argument, which should be an integer expression, means
19335 display a single entry whose index is given by the argument. For
19336 example, here's a convenient way to display information about the
19337 debugged program's data segment:
19340 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos ldt $ds}
19341 @exdent @code{0x13f: base=0x11970000 limit=0x0009ffff 32-Bit Data (Read/Write, Exp-up)}
19345 This comes in handy when you want to see whether a pointer is outside
19346 the data segment's limit (i.e.@: @dfn{garbled}).
19348 @cindex page tables display (MS-DOS)
19350 @itemx info dos pte
19351 These two commands display entries from, respectively, the Page
19352 Directory and the Page Tables. Page Directories and Page Tables are
19353 data structures which control how virtual memory addresses are mapped
19354 into physical addresses. A Page Table includes an entry for every
19355 page of memory that is mapped into the program's address space; there
19356 may be several Page Tables, each one holding up to 4096 entries. A
19357 Page Directory has up to 4096 entries, one each for every Page Table
19358 that is currently in use.
19360 Without an argument, @kbd{info dos pde} displays the entire Page
19361 Directory, and @kbd{info dos pte} displays all the entries in all of
19362 the Page Tables. An argument, an integer expression, given to the
19363 @kbd{info dos pde} command means display only that entry from the Page
19364 Directory table. An argument given to the @kbd{info dos pte} command
19365 means display entries from a single Page Table, the one pointed to by
19366 the specified entry in the Page Directory.
19368 @cindex direct memory access (DMA) on MS-DOS
19369 These commands are useful when your program uses @dfn{DMA} (Direct
19370 Memory Access), which needs physical addresses to program the DMA
19373 These commands are supported only with some DPMI servers.
19375 @cindex physical address from linear address
19376 @item info dos address-pte @var{addr}
19377 This command displays the Page Table entry for a specified linear
19378 address. The argument @var{addr} is a linear address which should
19379 already have the appropriate segment's base address added to it,
19380 because this command accepts addresses which may belong to @emph{any}
19381 segment. For example, here's how to display the Page Table entry for
19382 the page where a variable @code{i} is stored:
19385 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte __djgpp_base_address + (char *)&i}
19386 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x11a00d30:}
19387 @exdent @code{Base=0x02698000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0xd30}
19391 This says that @code{i} is stored at offset @code{0xd30} from the page
19392 whose physical base address is @code{0x02698000}, and shows all the
19393 attributes of that page.
19395 Note that you must cast the addresses of variables to a @code{char *},
19396 since otherwise the value of @code{__djgpp_base_address}, the base
19397 address of all variables and functions in a @sc{djgpp} program, will
19398 be added using the rules of C pointer arithmetics: if @code{i} is
19399 declared an @code{int}, @value{GDBN} will add 4 times the value of
19400 @code{__djgpp_base_address} to the address of @code{i}.
19402 Here's another example, it displays the Page Table entry for the
19406 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte *((unsigned *)&_go32_info_block + 3)}
19407 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x29110:}
19408 @exdent @code{Base=0x00029000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0x110}
19412 (The @code{+ 3} offset is because the transfer buffer's address is the
19413 3rd member of the @code{_go32_info_block} structure.) The output
19414 clearly shows that this DPMI server maps the addresses in conventional
19415 memory 1:1, i.e.@: the physical (@code{0x00029000} + @code{0x110}) and
19416 linear (@code{0x29110}) addresses are identical.
19418 This command is supported only with some DPMI servers.
19421 @cindex DOS serial data link, remote debugging
19422 In addition to native debugging, the DJGPP port supports remote
19423 debugging via a serial data link. The following commands are specific
19424 to remote serial debugging in the DJGPP port of @value{GDBN}.
19427 @kindex set com1base
19428 @kindex set com1irq
19429 @kindex set com2base
19430 @kindex set com2irq
19431 @kindex set com3base
19432 @kindex set com3irq
19433 @kindex set com4base
19434 @kindex set com4irq
19435 @item set com1base @var{addr}
19436 This command sets the base I/O port address of the @file{COM1} serial
19439 @item set com1irq @var{irq}
19440 This command sets the @dfn{Interrupt Request} (@code{IRQ}) line to use
19441 for the @file{COM1} serial port.
19443 There are similar commands @samp{set com2base}, @samp{set com3irq},
19444 etc.@: for setting the port address and the @code{IRQ} lines for the
19447 @kindex show com1base
19448 @kindex show com1irq
19449 @kindex show com2base
19450 @kindex show com2irq
19451 @kindex show com3base
19452 @kindex show com3irq
19453 @kindex show com4base
19454 @kindex show com4irq
19455 The related commands @samp{show com1base}, @samp{show com1irq} etc.@:
19456 display the current settings of the base address and the @code{IRQ}
19457 lines used by the COM ports.
19460 @kindex info serial
19461 @cindex DOS serial port status
19462 This command prints the status of the 4 DOS serial ports. For each
19463 port, it prints whether it's active or not, its I/O base address and
19464 IRQ number, whether it uses a 16550-style FIFO, its baudrate, and the
19465 counts of various errors encountered so far.
19469 @node Cygwin Native
19470 @subsection Features for Debugging MS Windows PE Executables
19471 @cindex MS Windows debugging
19472 @cindex native Cygwin debugging
19473 @cindex Cygwin-specific commands
19475 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of MS Windows programs, including
19476 DLLs with and without symbolic debugging information.
19478 @cindex Ctrl-BREAK, MS-Windows
19479 @cindex interrupt debuggee on MS-Windows
19480 MS-Windows programs that call @code{SetConsoleMode} to switch off the
19481 special meaning of the @samp{Ctrl-C} keystroke cannot be interrupted
19482 by typing @kbd{C-c}. For this reason, @value{GDBN} on MS-Windows
19483 supports @kbd{C-@key{BREAK}} as an alternative interrupt key
19484 sequence, which can be used to interrupt the debuggee even if it
19487 There are various additional Cygwin-specific commands, described in
19488 this section. Working with DLLs that have no debugging symbols is
19489 described in @ref{Non-debug DLL Symbols}.
19494 This is a prefix of MS Windows-specific commands which print
19495 information about the target system and important OS structures.
19497 @item info w32 selector
19498 This command displays information returned by
19499 the Win32 API @code{GetThreadSelectorEntry} function.
19500 It takes an optional argument that is evaluated to
19501 a long value to give the information about this given selector.
19502 Without argument, this command displays information
19503 about the six segment registers.
19505 @item info w32 thread-information-block
19506 This command displays thread specific information stored in the
19507 Thread Information Block (readable on the X86 CPU family using @code{$fs}
19508 selector for 32-bit programs and @code{$gs} for 64-bit programs).
19512 This is a Cygwin-specific alias of @code{info shared}.
19514 @kindex dll-symbols
19516 This command loads symbols from a dll similarly to
19517 add-sym command but without the need to specify a base address.
19519 @kindex set cygwin-exceptions
19520 @cindex debugging the Cygwin DLL
19521 @cindex Cygwin DLL, debugging
19522 @item set cygwin-exceptions @var{mode}
19523 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that
19524 happen inside the Cygwin DLL. If @var{mode} is @code{off},
19525 @value{GDBN} will delay recognition of exceptions, and may ignore some
19526 exceptions which seem to be caused by internal Cygwin DLL
19527 ``bookkeeping''. This option is meant primarily for debugging the
19528 Cygwin DLL itself; the default value is @code{off} to avoid annoying
19529 @value{GDBN} users with false @code{SIGSEGV} signals.
19531 @kindex show cygwin-exceptions
19532 @item show cygwin-exceptions
19533 Displays whether @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that happen
19534 inside the Cygwin DLL itself.
19536 @kindex set new-console
19537 @item set new-console @var{mode}
19538 If @var{mode} is @code{on} the debuggee will
19539 be started in a new console on next start.
19540 If @var{mode} is @code{off}, the debuggee will
19541 be started in the same console as the debugger.
19543 @kindex show new-console
19544 @item show new-console
19545 Displays whether a new console is used
19546 when the debuggee is started.
19548 @kindex set new-group
19549 @item set new-group @var{mode}
19550 This boolean value controls whether the debuggee should
19551 start a new group or stay in the same group as the debugger.
19552 This affects the way the Windows OS handles
19555 @kindex show new-group
19556 @item show new-group
19557 Displays current value of new-group boolean.
19559 @kindex set debugevents
19560 @item set debugevents
19561 This boolean value adds debug output concerning kernel events related
19562 to the debuggee seen by the debugger. This includes events that
19563 signal thread and process creation and exit, DLL loading and
19564 unloading, console interrupts, and debugging messages produced by the
19565 Windows @code{OutputDebugString} API call.
19567 @kindex set debugexec
19568 @item set debugexec
19569 This boolean value adds debug output concerning execute events
19570 (such as resume thread) seen by the debugger.
19572 @kindex set debugexceptions
19573 @item set debugexceptions
19574 This boolean value adds debug output concerning exceptions in the
19575 debuggee seen by the debugger.
19577 @kindex set debugmemory
19578 @item set debugmemory
19579 This boolean value adds debug output concerning debuggee memory reads
19580 and writes by the debugger.
19584 This boolean values specifies whether the debuggee is called
19585 via a shell or directly (default value is on).
19589 Displays if the debuggee will be started with a shell.
19594 * Non-debug DLL Symbols:: Support for DLLs without debugging symbols
19597 @node Non-debug DLL Symbols
19598 @subsubsection Support for DLLs without Debugging Symbols
19599 @cindex DLLs with no debugging symbols
19600 @cindex Minimal symbols and DLLs
19602 Very often on windows, some of the DLLs that your program relies on do
19603 not include symbolic debugging information (for example,
19604 @file{kernel32.dll}). When @value{GDBN} doesn't recognize any debugging
19605 symbols in a DLL, it relies on the minimal amount of symbolic
19606 information contained in the DLL's export table. This section
19607 describes working with such symbols, known internally to @value{GDBN} as
19608 ``minimal symbols''.
19610 Note that before the debugged program has started execution, no DLLs
19611 will have been loaded. The easiest way around this problem is simply to
19612 start the program --- either by setting a breakpoint or letting the
19613 program run once to completion. It is also possible to force
19614 @value{GDBN} to load a particular DLL before starting the executable ---
19615 see the shared library information in @ref{Files}, or the
19616 @code{dll-symbols} command in @ref{Cygwin Native}. Currently,
19617 explicitly loading symbols from a DLL with no debugging information will
19618 cause the symbol names to be duplicated in @value{GDBN}'s lookup table,
19619 which may adversely affect symbol lookup performance.
19621 @subsubsection DLL Name Prefixes
19623 In keeping with the naming conventions used by the Microsoft debugging
19624 tools, DLL export symbols are made available with a prefix based on the
19625 DLL name, for instance @code{KERNEL32!CreateFileA}. The plain name is
19626 also entered into the symbol table, so @code{CreateFileA} is often
19627 sufficient. In some cases there will be name clashes within a program
19628 (particularly if the executable itself includes full debugging symbols)
19629 necessitating the use of the fully qualified name when referring to the
19630 contents of the DLL. Use single-quotes around the name to avoid the
19631 exclamation mark (``!'') being interpreted as a language operator.
19633 Note that the internal name of the DLL may be all upper-case, even
19634 though the file name of the DLL is lower-case, or vice-versa. Since
19635 symbols within @value{GDBN} are @emph{case-sensitive} this may cause
19636 some confusion. If in doubt, try the @code{info functions} and
19637 @code{info variables} commands or even @code{maint print msymbols}
19638 (@pxref{Symbols}). Here's an example:
19641 (@value{GDBP}) info function CreateFileA
19642 All functions matching regular expression "CreateFileA":
19644 Non-debugging symbols:
19645 0x77e885f4 CreateFileA
19646 0x77e885f4 KERNEL32!CreateFileA
19650 (@value{GDBP}) info function !
19651 All functions matching regular expression "!":
19653 Non-debugging symbols:
19654 0x6100114c cygwin1!__assert
19655 0x61004034 cygwin1!_dll_crt0@@0
19656 0x61004240 cygwin1!dll_crt0(per_process *)
19660 @subsubsection Working with Minimal Symbols
19662 Symbols extracted from a DLL's export table do not contain very much
19663 type information. All that @value{GDBN} can do is guess whether a symbol
19664 refers to a function or variable depending on the linker section that
19665 contains the symbol. Also note that the actual contents of the memory
19666 contained in a DLL are not available unless the program is running. This
19667 means that you cannot examine the contents of a variable or disassemble
19668 a function within a DLL without a running program.
19670 Variables are generally treated as pointers and dereferenced
19671 automatically. For this reason, it is often necessary to prefix a
19672 variable name with the address-of operator (``&'') and provide explicit
19673 type information in the command. Here's an example of the type of
19677 (@value{GDBP}) print 'cygwin1!__argv'
19682 (@value{GDBP}) x 'cygwin1!__argv'
19683 0x10021610: "\230y\""
19686 And two possible solutions:
19689 (@value{GDBP}) print ((char **)'cygwin1!__argv')[0]
19690 $2 = 0x22fd98 "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
19694 (@value{GDBP}) x/2x &'cygwin1!__argv'
19695 0x610c0aa8 <cygwin1!__argv>: 0x10021608 0x00000000
19696 (@value{GDBP}) x/x 0x10021608
19697 0x10021608: 0x0022fd98
19698 (@value{GDBP}) x/s 0x0022fd98
19699 0x22fd98: "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
19702 Setting a break point within a DLL is possible even before the program
19703 starts execution. However, under these circumstances, @value{GDBN} can't
19704 examine the initial instructions of the function in order to skip the
19705 function's frame set-up code. You can work around this by using ``*&''
19706 to set the breakpoint at a raw memory address:
19709 (@value{GDBP}) break *&'python22!PyOS_Readline'
19710 Breakpoint 1 at 0x1e04eff0
19713 The author of these extensions is not entirely convinced that setting a
19714 break point within a shared DLL like @file{kernel32.dll} is completely
19718 @subsection Commands Specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd Systems
19719 @cindex @sc{gnu} Hurd debugging
19721 This subsection describes @value{GDBN} commands specific to the
19722 @sc{gnu} Hurd native debugging.
19727 @kindex set signals@r{, Hurd command}
19728 @kindex set sigs@r{, Hurd command}
19729 This command toggles the state of inferior signal interception by
19730 @value{GDBN}. Mach exceptions, such as breakpoint traps, are not
19731 affected by this command. @code{sigs} is a shorthand alias for
19736 @kindex show signals@r{, Hurd command}
19737 @kindex show sigs@r{, Hurd command}
19738 Show the current state of intercepting inferior's signals.
19740 @item set signal-thread
19741 @itemx set sigthread
19742 @kindex set signal-thread
19743 @kindex set sigthread
19744 This command tells @value{GDBN} which thread is the @code{libc} signal
19745 thread. That thread is run when a signal is delivered to a running
19746 process. @code{set sigthread} is the shorthand alias of @code{set
19749 @item show signal-thread
19750 @itemx show sigthread
19751 @kindex show signal-thread
19752 @kindex show sigthread
19753 These two commands show which thread will run when the inferior is
19754 delivered a signal.
19757 @kindex set stopped@r{, Hurd command}
19758 This commands tells @value{GDBN} that the inferior process is stopped,
19759 as with the @code{SIGSTOP} signal. The stopped process can be
19760 continued by delivering a signal to it.
19763 @kindex show stopped@r{, Hurd command}
19764 This command shows whether @value{GDBN} thinks the debuggee is
19767 @item set exceptions
19768 @kindex set exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
19769 Use this command to turn off trapping of exceptions in the inferior.
19770 When exception trapping is off, neither breakpoints nor
19771 single-stepping will work. To restore the default, set exception
19774 @item show exceptions
19775 @kindex show exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
19776 Show the current state of trapping exceptions in the inferior.
19778 @item set task pause
19779 @kindex set task@r{, Hurd commands}
19780 @cindex task attributes (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
19781 @cindex pause current task (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
19782 This command toggles task suspension when @value{GDBN} has control.
19783 Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the task is suspended
19784 whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to off will take
19785 effect the next time the inferior is continued. If this option is set
19786 to off, you can use @code{set thread default pause on} or @code{set
19787 thread pause on} (see below) to pause individual threads.
19789 @item show task pause
19790 @kindex show task@r{, Hurd commands}
19791 Show the current state of task suspension.
19793 @item set task detach-suspend-count
19794 @cindex task suspend count
19795 @cindex detach from task, @sc{gnu} Hurd
19796 This command sets the suspend count the task will be left with when
19797 @value{GDBN} detaches from it.
19799 @item show task detach-suspend-count
19800 Show the suspend count the task will be left with when detaching.
19802 @item set task exception-port
19803 @itemx set task excp
19804 @cindex task exception port, @sc{gnu} Hurd
19805 This command sets the task exception port to which @value{GDBN} will
19806 forward exceptions. The argument should be the value of the @dfn{send
19807 rights} of the task. @code{set task excp} is a shorthand alias.
19809 @item set noninvasive
19810 @cindex noninvasive task options
19811 This command switches @value{GDBN} to a mode that is the least
19812 invasive as far as interfering with the inferior is concerned. This
19813 is the same as using @code{set task pause}, @code{set exceptions}, and
19814 @code{set signals} to values opposite to the defaults.
19816 @item info send-rights
19817 @itemx info receive-rights
19818 @itemx info port-rights
19819 @itemx info port-sets
19820 @itemx info dead-names
19823 @cindex send rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
19824 @cindex receive rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
19825 @cindex port rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
19826 @cindex port sets, @sc{gnu} Hurd
19827 @cindex dead names, @sc{gnu} Hurd
19828 These commands display information about, respectively, send rights,
19829 receive rights, port rights, port sets, and dead names of a task.
19830 There are also shorthand aliases: @code{info ports} for @code{info
19831 port-rights} and @code{info psets} for @code{info port-sets}.
19833 @item set thread pause
19834 @kindex set thread@r{, Hurd command}
19835 @cindex thread properties, @sc{gnu} Hurd
19836 @cindex pause current thread (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
19837 This command toggles current thread suspension when @value{GDBN} has
19838 control. Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the current
19839 thread is suspended whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to
19840 off will take effect the next time the inferior is continued.
19841 Normally, this command has no effect, since when @value{GDBN} has
19842 control, the whole task is suspended. However, if you used @code{set
19843 task pause off} (see above), this command comes in handy to suspend
19844 only the current thread.
19846 @item show thread pause
19847 @kindex show thread@r{, Hurd command}
19848 This command shows the state of current thread suspension.
19850 @item set thread run
19851 This command sets whether the current thread is allowed to run.
19853 @item show thread run
19854 Show whether the current thread is allowed to run.
19856 @item set thread detach-suspend-count
19857 @cindex thread suspend count, @sc{gnu} Hurd
19858 @cindex detach from thread, @sc{gnu} Hurd
19859 This command sets the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on a
19860 thread when detaching. This number is relative to the suspend count
19861 found by @value{GDBN} when it notices the thread; use @code{set thread
19862 takeover-suspend-count} to force it to an absolute value.
19864 @item show thread detach-suspend-count
19865 Show the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on the thread when
19868 @item set thread exception-port
19869 @itemx set thread excp
19870 Set the thread exception port to which to forward exceptions. This
19871 overrides the port set by @code{set task exception-port} (see above).
19872 @code{set thread excp} is the shorthand alias.
19874 @item set thread takeover-suspend-count
19875 Normally, @value{GDBN}'s thread suspend counts are relative to the
19876 value @value{GDBN} finds when it notices each thread. This command
19877 changes the suspend counts to be absolute instead.
19879 @item set thread default
19880 @itemx show thread default
19881 @cindex thread default settings, @sc{gnu} Hurd
19882 Each of the above @code{set thread} commands has a @code{set thread
19883 default} counterpart (e.g., @code{set thread default pause}, @code{set
19884 thread default exception-port}, etc.). The @code{thread default}
19885 variety of commands sets the default thread properties for all
19886 threads; you can then change the properties of individual threads with
19887 the non-default commands.
19894 @value{GDBN} provides the following commands specific to the Darwin target:
19897 @item set debug darwin @var{num}
19898 @kindex set debug darwin
19899 When set to a non zero value, enables debugging messages specific to
19900 the Darwin support. Higher values produce more verbose output.
19902 @item show debug darwin
19903 @kindex show debug darwin
19904 Show the current state of Darwin messages.
19906 @item set debug mach-o @var{num}
19907 @kindex set debug mach-o
19908 When set to a non zero value, enables debugging messages while
19909 @value{GDBN} is reading Darwin object files. (@dfn{Mach-O} is the
19910 file format used on Darwin for object and executable files.) Higher
19911 values produce more verbose output. This is a command to diagnose
19912 problems internal to @value{GDBN} and should not be needed in normal
19915 @item show debug mach-o
19916 @kindex show debug mach-o
19917 Show the current state of Mach-O file messages.
19919 @item set mach-exceptions on
19920 @itemx set mach-exceptions off
19921 @kindex set mach-exceptions
19922 On Darwin, faults are first reported as a Mach exception and are then
19923 mapped to a Posix signal. Use this command to turn on trapping of
19924 Mach exceptions in the inferior. This might be sometimes useful to
19925 better understand the cause of a fault. The default is off.
19927 @item show mach-exceptions
19928 @kindex show mach-exceptions
19929 Show the current state of exceptions trapping.
19934 @section Embedded Operating Systems
19936 This section describes configurations involving the debugging of
19937 embedded operating systems that are available for several different
19941 * VxWorks:: Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
19944 @value{GDBN} includes the ability to debug programs running on
19945 various real-time operating systems.
19948 @subsection Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
19954 @kindex target vxworks
19955 @item target vxworks @var{machinename}
19956 A VxWorks system, attached via TCP/IP. The argument @var{machinename}
19957 is the target system's machine name or IP address.
19961 On VxWorks, @code{load} links @var{filename} dynamically on the
19962 current target system as well as adding its symbols in @value{GDBN}.
19964 @value{GDBN} enables developers to spawn and debug tasks running on networked
19965 VxWorks targets from a Unix host. Already-running tasks spawned from
19966 the VxWorks shell can also be debugged. @value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
19967 both the Unix host and on the VxWorks target. The program
19968 @code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host. (It may be
19969 installed with the name @code{vxgdb}, to distinguish it from a
19970 @value{GDBN} for debugging programs on the host itself.)
19973 @item VxWorks-timeout @var{args}
19974 @kindex vxworks-timeout
19975 All VxWorks-based targets now support the option @code{vxworks-timeout}.
19976 This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
19977 seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses to rpc's. You might use this if
19978 your VxWorks target is a slow software simulator or is on the far side
19979 of a thin network line.
19982 The following information on connecting to VxWorks was current when
19983 this manual was produced; newer releases of VxWorks may use revised
19986 @findex INCLUDE_RDB
19987 To use @value{GDBN} with VxWorks, you must rebuild your VxWorks kernel
19988 to include the remote debugging interface routines in the VxWorks
19989 library @file{rdb.a}. To do this, define @code{INCLUDE_RDB} in the
19990 VxWorks configuration file @file{configAll.h} and rebuild your VxWorks
19991 kernel. The resulting kernel contains @file{rdb.a}, and spawns the
19992 source debugging task @code{tRdbTask} when VxWorks is booted. For more
19993 information on configuring and remaking VxWorks, see the manufacturer's
19995 @c VxWorks, see the @cite{VxWorks Programmer's Guide}.
19997 Once you have included @file{rdb.a} in your VxWorks system image and set
19998 your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
19999 run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}} (or
20000 @code{vxgdb}, depending on your installation).
20002 @value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
20009 * VxWorks Connection:: Connecting to VxWorks
20010 * VxWorks Download:: VxWorks download
20011 * VxWorks Attach:: Running tasks
20014 @node VxWorks Connection
20015 @subsubsection Connecting to VxWorks
20017 The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a VxWorks target on the
20018 network. To connect to a target whose host name is ``@code{tt}'', type:
20021 (vxgdb) target vxworks tt
20025 @value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
20028 Attaching remote machine across net...
20033 @value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol tables of any object modules
20034 loaded into the VxWorks target since it was last booted. @value{GDBN} locates
20035 these files by searching the directories listed in the command search
20036 path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}); if it fails
20037 to find an object file, it displays a message such as:
20040 prog.o: No such file or directory.
20043 When this happens, add the appropriate directory to the search path with
20044 the @value{GDBN} command @code{path}, and execute the @code{target}
20047 @node VxWorks Download
20048 @subsubsection VxWorks Download
20050 @cindex download to VxWorks
20051 If you have connected to the VxWorks target and you want to debug an
20052 object that has not yet been loaded, you can use the @value{GDBN}
20053 @code{load} command to download a file from Unix to VxWorks
20054 incrementally. The object file given as an argument to the @code{load}
20055 command is actually opened twice: first by the VxWorks target in order
20056 to download the code, then by @value{GDBN} in order to read the symbol
20057 table. This can lead to problems if the current working directories on
20058 the two systems differ. If both systems have NFS mounted the same
20059 filesystems, you can avoid these problems by using absolute paths.
20060 Otherwise, it is simplest to set the working directory on both systems
20061 to the directory in which the object file resides, and then to reference
20062 the file by its name, without any path. For instance, a program
20063 @file{prog.o} may reside in @file{@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb} in VxWorks
20064 and in @file{@var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb} on the host. To load this
20065 program, type this on VxWorks:
20068 -> cd "@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb"
20072 Then, in @value{GDBN}, type:
20075 (vxgdb) cd @var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb
20076 (vxgdb) load prog.o
20079 @value{GDBN} displays a response similar to this:
20082 Reading symbol data from wherever/vw/demo/rdb/prog.o... done.
20085 You can also use the @code{load} command to reload an object module
20086 after editing and recompiling the corresponding source file. Note that
20087 this makes @value{GDBN} delete all currently-defined breakpoints,
20088 auto-displays, and convenience variables, and to clear the value
20089 history. (This is necessary in order to preserve the integrity of
20090 debugger's data structures that reference the target system's symbol
20093 @node VxWorks Attach
20094 @subsubsection Running Tasks
20096 @cindex running VxWorks tasks
20097 You can also attach to an existing task using the @code{attach} command as
20101 (vxgdb) attach @var{task}
20105 where @var{task} is the VxWorks hexadecimal task ID. The task can be running
20106 or suspended when you attach to it. Running tasks are suspended at
20107 the time of attachment.
20109 @node Embedded Processors
20110 @section Embedded Processors
20112 This section goes into details specific to particular embedded
20115 @cindex send command to simulator
20116 Whenever a specific embedded processor has a simulator, @value{GDBN}
20117 allows to send an arbitrary command to the simulator.
20120 @item sim @var{command}
20121 @kindex sim@r{, a command}
20122 Send an arbitrary @var{command} string to the simulator. Consult the
20123 documentation for the specific simulator in use for information about
20124 acceptable commands.
20130 * M32R/D:: Renesas M32R/D
20131 * M68K:: Motorola M68K
20132 * MicroBlaze:: Xilinx MicroBlaze
20133 * MIPS Embedded:: MIPS Embedded
20134 * PowerPC Embedded:: PowerPC Embedded
20135 * PA:: HP PA Embedded
20136 * Sparclet:: Tsqware Sparclet
20137 * Sparclite:: Fujitsu Sparclite
20138 * Z8000:: Zilog Z8000
20141 * Super-H:: Renesas Super-H
20150 @item target rdi @var{dev}
20151 ARM Angel monitor, via RDI library interface to ADP protocol. You may
20152 use this target to communicate with both boards running the Angel
20153 monitor, or with the EmbeddedICE JTAG debug device.
20156 @item target rdp @var{dev}
20161 @value{GDBN} provides the following ARM-specific commands:
20164 @item set arm disassembler
20166 This commands selects from a list of disassembly styles. The
20167 @code{"std"} style is the standard style.
20169 @item show arm disassembler
20171 Show the current disassembly style.
20173 @item set arm apcs32
20174 @cindex ARM 32-bit mode
20175 This command toggles ARM operation mode between 32-bit and 26-bit.
20177 @item show arm apcs32
20178 Display the current usage of the ARM 32-bit mode.
20180 @item set arm fpu @var{fputype}
20181 This command sets the ARM floating-point unit (FPU) type. The
20182 argument @var{fputype} can be one of these:
20186 Determine the FPU type by querying the OS ABI.
20188 Software FPU, with mixed-endian doubles on little-endian ARM
20191 GCC-compiled FPA co-processor.
20193 Software FPU with pure-endian doubles.
20199 Show the current type of the FPU.
20202 This command forces @value{GDBN} to use the specified ABI.
20205 Show the currently used ABI.
20207 @item set arm fallback-mode (arm|thumb|auto)
20208 @value{GDBN} uses the symbol table, when available, to determine
20209 whether instructions are ARM or Thumb. This command controls
20210 @value{GDBN}'s default behavior when the symbol table is not
20211 available. The default is @samp{auto}, which causes @value{GDBN} to
20212 use the current execution mode (from the @code{T} bit in the @code{CPSR}
20215 @item show arm fallback-mode
20216 Show the current fallback instruction mode.
20218 @item set arm force-mode (arm|thumb|auto)
20219 This command overrides use of the symbol table to determine whether
20220 instructions are ARM or Thumb. The default is @samp{auto}, which
20221 causes @value{GDBN} to use the symbol table and then the setting
20222 of @samp{set arm fallback-mode}.
20224 @item show arm force-mode
20225 Show the current forced instruction mode.
20227 @item set debug arm
20228 Toggle whether to display ARM-specific debugging messages from the ARM
20229 target support subsystem.
20231 @item show debug arm
20232 Show whether ARM-specific debugging messages are enabled.
20235 The following commands are available when an ARM target is debugged
20236 using the RDI interface:
20239 @item rdilogfile @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
20241 @cindex ADP (Angel Debugger Protocol) logging
20242 Set the filename for the ADP (Angel Debugger Protocol) packet log.
20243 With an argument, sets the log file to the specified @var{file}. With
20244 no argument, show the current log file name. The default log file is
20247 @item rdilogenable @r{[}@var{arg}@r{]}
20248 @kindex rdilogenable
20249 Control logging of ADP packets. With an argument of 1 or @code{"yes"}
20250 enables logging, with an argument 0 or @code{"no"} disables it. With
20251 no arguments displays the current setting. When logging is enabled,
20252 ADP packets exchanged between @value{GDBN} and the RDI target device
20253 are logged to a file.
20255 @item set rdiromatzero
20256 @kindex set rdiromatzero
20257 @cindex ROM at zero address, RDI
20258 Tell @value{GDBN} whether the target has ROM at address 0. If on,
20259 vector catching is disabled, so that zero address can be used. If off
20260 (the default), vector catching is enabled. For this command to take
20261 effect, it needs to be invoked prior to the @code{target rdi} command.
20263 @item show rdiromatzero
20264 @kindex show rdiromatzero
20265 Show the current setting of ROM at zero address.
20267 @item set rdiheartbeat
20268 @kindex set rdiheartbeat
20269 @cindex RDI heartbeat
20270 Enable or disable RDI heartbeat packets. It is not recommended to
20271 turn on this option, since it confuses ARM and EPI JTAG interface, as
20272 well as the Angel monitor.
20274 @item show rdiheartbeat
20275 @kindex show rdiheartbeat
20276 Show the setting of RDI heartbeat packets.
20280 @item target sim @r{[}@var{simargs}@r{]} @dots{}
20281 The @value{GDBN} ARM simulator accepts the following optional arguments.
20284 @item --swi-support=@var{type}
20285 Tell the simulator which SWI interfaces to support.
20286 @var{type} may be a comma separated list of the following values.
20287 The default value is @code{all}.
20300 @subsection Renesas M32R/D and M32R/SDI
20303 @kindex target m32r
20304 @item target m32r @var{dev}
20305 Renesas M32R/D ROM monitor.
20307 @kindex target m32rsdi
20308 @item target m32rsdi @var{dev}
20309 Renesas M32R SDI server, connected via parallel port to the board.
20312 The following @value{GDBN} commands are specific to the M32R monitor:
20315 @item set download-path @var{path}
20316 @kindex set download-path
20317 @cindex find downloadable @sc{srec} files (M32R)
20318 Set the default path for finding downloadable @sc{srec} files.
20320 @item show download-path
20321 @kindex show download-path
20322 Show the default path for downloadable @sc{srec} files.
20324 @item set board-address @var{addr}
20325 @kindex set board-address
20326 @cindex M32-EVA target board address
20327 Set the IP address for the M32R-EVA target board.
20329 @item show board-address
20330 @kindex show board-address
20331 Show the current IP address of the target board.
20333 @item set server-address @var{addr}
20334 @kindex set server-address
20335 @cindex download server address (M32R)
20336 Set the IP address for the download server, which is the @value{GDBN}'s
20339 @item show server-address
20340 @kindex show server-address
20341 Display the IP address of the download server.
20343 @item upload @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
20344 @kindex upload@r{, M32R}
20345 Upload the specified @sc{srec} @var{file} via the monitor's Ethernet
20346 upload capability. If no @var{file} argument is given, the current
20347 executable file is uploaded.
20349 @item tload @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
20350 @kindex tload@r{, M32R}
20351 Test the @code{upload} command.
20354 The following commands are available for M32R/SDI:
20359 @cindex reset SDI connection, M32R
20360 This command resets the SDI connection.
20364 This command shows the SDI connection status.
20367 @kindex debug_chaos
20368 @cindex M32R/Chaos debugging
20369 Instructs the remote that M32R/Chaos debugging is to be used.
20371 @item use_debug_dma
20372 @kindex use_debug_dma
20373 Instructs the remote to use the DEBUG_DMA method of accessing memory.
20376 @kindex use_mon_code
20377 Instructs the remote to use the MON_CODE method of accessing memory.
20380 @kindex use_ib_break
20381 Instructs the remote to set breakpoints by IB break.
20383 @item use_dbt_break
20384 @kindex use_dbt_break
20385 Instructs the remote to set breakpoints by DBT.
20391 The Motorola m68k configuration includes ColdFire support, and a
20392 target command for the following ROM monitor.
20396 @kindex target dbug
20397 @item target dbug @var{dev}
20398 dBUG ROM monitor for Motorola ColdFire.
20403 @subsection MicroBlaze
20404 @cindex Xilinx MicroBlaze
20405 @cindex XMD, Xilinx Microprocessor Debugger
20407 The MicroBlaze is a soft-core processor supported on various Xilinx
20408 FPGAs, such as Spartan or Virtex series. Boards with these processors
20409 usually have JTAG ports which connect to a host system running the Xilinx
20410 Embedded Development Kit (EDK) or Software Development Kit (SDK).
20411 This host system is used to download the configuration bitstream to
20412 the target FPGA. The Xilinx Microprocessor Debugger (XMD) program
20413 communicates with the target board using the JTAG interface and
20414 presents a @code{gdbserver} interface to the board. By default
20415 @code{xmd} uses port @code{1234}. (While it is possible to change
20416 this default port, it requires the use of undocumented @code{xmd}
20417 commands. Contact Xilinx support if you need to do this.)
20419 Use these GDB commands to connect to the MicroBlaze target processor.
20422 @item target remote :1234
20423 Use this command to connect to the target if you are running @value{GDBN}
20424 on the same system as @code{xmd}.
20426 @item target remote @var{xmd-host}:1234
20427 Use this command to connect to the target if it is connected to @code{xmd}
20428 running on a different system named @var{xmd-host}.
20431 Use this command to download a program to the MicroBlaze target.
20433 @item set debug microblaze @var{n}
20434 Enable MicroBlaze-specific debugging messages if non-zero.
20436 @item show debug microblaze @var{n}
20437 Show MicroBlaze-specific debugging level.
20440 @node MIPS Embedded
20441 @subsection @acronym{MIPS} Embedded
20443 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} boards
20444 @value{GDBN} can use the @acronym{MIPS} remote debugging protocol to talk to a
20445 @acronym{MIPS} board attached to a serial line. This is available when
20446 you configure @value{GDBN} with @samp{--target=mips-elf}.
20449 Use these @value{GDBN} commands to specify the connection to your target board:
20452 @item target mips @var{port}
20453 @kindex target mips @var{port}
20454 To run a program on the board, start up @code{@value{GDBP}} with the
20455 name of your program as the argument. To connect to the board, use the
20456 command @samp{target mips @var{port}}, where @var{port} is the name of
20457 the serial port connected to the board. If the program has not already
20458 been downloaded to the board, you may use the @code{load} command to
20459 download it. You can then use all the usual @value{GDBN} commands.
20461 For example, this sequence connects to the target board through a serial
20462 port, and loads and runs a program called @var{prog} through the
20466 host$ @value{GDBP} @var{prog}
20467 @value{GDBN} is free software and @dots{}
20468 (@value{GDBP}) target mips /dev/ttyb
20469 (@value{GDBP}) load @var{prog}
20473 @item target mips @var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}
20474 On some @value{GDBN} host configurations, you can specify a TCP
20475 connection (for instance, to a serial line managed by a terminal
20476 concentrator) instead of a serial port, using the syntax
20477 @samp{@var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}}.
20479 @item target pmon @var{port}
20480 @kindex target pmon @var{port}
20483 @item target ddb @var{port}
20484 @kindex target ddb @var{port}
20485 NEC's DDB variant of PMON for Vr4300.
20487 @item target lsi @var{port}
20488 @kindex target lsi @var{port}
20489 LSI variant of PMON.
20491 @kindex target r3900
20492 @item target r3900 @var{dev}
20493 Densan DVE-R3900 ROM monitor for Toshiba R3900 Mips.
20495 @kindex target array
20496 @item target array @var{dev}
20497 Array Tech LSI33K RAID controller board.
20503 @value{GDBN} also supports these special commands for @acronym{MIPS} targets:
20506 @item set mipsfpu double
20507 @itemx set mipsfpu single
20508 @itemx set mipsfpu none
20509 @itemx set mipsfpu auto
20510 @itemx show mipsfpu
20511 @kindex set mipsfpu
20512 @kindex show mipsfpu
20513 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} remote floating point
20514 @cindex floating point, @acronym{MIPS} remote
20515 If your target board does not support the @acronym{MIPS} floating point
20516 coprocessor, you should use the command @samp{set mipsfpu none} (if you
20517 need this, you may wish to put the command in your @value{GDBN} init
20518 file). This tells @value{GDBN} how to find the return value of
20519 functions which return floating point values. It also allows
20520 @value{GDBN} to avoid saving the floating point registers when calling
20521 functions on the board. If you are using a floating point coprocessor
20522 with only single precision floating point support, as on the @sc{r4650}
20523 processor, use the command @samp{set mipsfpu single}. The default
20524 double precision floating point coprocessor may be selected using
20525 @samp{set mipsfpu double}.
20527 In previous versions the only choices were double precision or no
20528 floating point, so @samp{set mipsfpu on} will select double precision
20529 and @samp{set mipsfpu off} will select no floating point.
20531 As usual, you can inquire about the @code{mipsfpu} variable with
20532 @samp{show mipsfpu}.
20534 @item set timeout @var{seconds}
20535 @itemx set retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}
20536 @itemx show timeout
20537 @itemx show retransmit-timeout
20538 @cindex @code{timeout}, @acronym{MIPS} protocol
20539 @cindex @code{retransmit-timeout}, @acronym{MIPS} protocol
20540 @kindex set timeout
20541 @kindex show timeout
20542 @kindex set retransmit-timeout
20543 @kindex show retransmit-timeout
20544 You can control the timeout used while waiting for a packet, in the @acronym{MIPS}
20545 remote protocol, with the @code{set timeout @var{seconds}} command. The
20546 default is 5 seconds. Similarly, you can control the timeout used while
20547 waiting for an acknowledgment of a packet with the @code{set
20548 retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}} command. The default is 3 seconds.
20549 You can inspect both values with @code{show timeout} and @code{show
20550 retransmit-timeout}. (These commands are @emph{only} available when
20551 @value{GDBN} is configured for @samp{--target=mips-elf}.)
20553 The timeout set by @code{set timeout} does not apply when @value{GDBN}
20554 is waiting for your program to stop. In that case, @value{GDBN} waits
20555 forever because it has no way of knowing how long the program is going
20556 to run before stopping.
20558 @item set syn-garbage-limit @var{num}
20559 @kindex set syn-garbage-limit@r{, @acronym{MIPS} remote}
20560 @cindex synchronize with remote @acronym{MIPS} target
20561 Limit the maximum number of characters @value{GDBN} should ignore when
20562 it tries to synchronize with the remote target. The default is 10
20563 characters. Setting the limit to -1 means there's no limit.
20565 @item show syn-garbage-limit
20566 @kindex show syn-garbage-limit@r{, @acronym{MIPS} remote}
20567 Show the current limit on the number of characters to ignore when
20568 trying to synchronize with the remote system.
20570 @item set monitor-prompt @var{prompt}
20571 @kindex set monitor-prompt@r{, @acronym{MIPS} remote}
20572 @cindex remote monitor prompt
20573 Tell @value{GDBN} to expect the specified @var{prompt} string from the
20574 remote monitor. The default depends on the target:
20584 @item show monitor-prompt
20585 @kindex show monitor-prompt@r{, @acronym{MIPS} remote}
20586 Show the current strings @value{GDBN} expects as the prompt from the
20589 @item set monitor-warnings
20590 @kindex set monitor-warnings@r{, @acronym{MIPS} remote}
20591 Enable or disable monitor warnings about hardware breakpoints. This
20592 has effect only for the @code{lsi} target. When on, @value{GDBN} will
20593 display warning messages whose codes are returned by the @code{lsi}
20594 PMON monitor for breakpoint commands.
20596 @item show monitor-warnings
20597 @kindex show monitor-warnings@r{, @acronym{MIPS} remote}
20598 Show the current setting of printing monitor warnings.
20600 @item pmon @var{command}
20601 @kindex pmon@r{, @acronym{MIPS} remote}
20602 @cindex send PMON command
20603 This command allows sending an arbitrary @var{command} string to the
20604 monitor. The monitor must be in debug mode for this to work.
20607 @node PowerPC Embedded
20608 @subsection PowerPC Embedded
20610 @cindex DVC register
20611 @value{GDBN} supports using the DVC (Data Value Compare) register to
20612 implement in hardware simple hardware watchpoint conditions of the form:
20615 (@value{GDBP}) watch @var{ADDRESS|VARIABLE} \
20616 if @var{ADDRESS|VARIABLE} == @var{CONSTANT EXPRESSION}
20619 The DVC register will be automatically used when @value{GDBN} detects
20620 such pattern in a condition expression, and the created watchpoint uses one
20621 debug register (either the @code{exact-watchpoints} option is on and the
20622 variable is scalar, or the variable has a length of one byte). This feature
20623 is available in native @value{GDBN} running on a Linux kernel version 2.6.34
20626 When running on PowerPC embedded processors, @value{GDBN} automatically uses
20627 ranged hardware watchpoints, unless the @code{exact-watchpoints} option is on,
20628 in which case watchpoints using only one debug register are created when
20629 watching variables of scalar types.
20631 You can create an artificial array to watch an arbitrary memory
20632 region using one of the following commands (@pxref{Expressions}):
20635 (@value{GDBP}) watch *((char *) @var{address})@@@var{length}
20636 (@value{GDBP}) watch @{char[@var{length}]@} @var{address}
20639 PowerPC embedded processors support masked watchpoints. See the discussion
20640 about the @code{mask} argument in @ref{Set Watchpoints}.
20642 @cindex ranged breakpoint
20643 PowerPC embedded processors support hardware accelerated
20644 @dfn{ranged breakpoints}. A ranged breakpoint stops execution of
20645 the inferior whenever it executes an instruction at any address within
20646 the range it specifies. To set a ranged breakpoint in @value{GDBN},
20647 use the @code{break-range} command.
20649 @value{GDBN} provides the following PowerPC-specific commands:
20652 @kindex break-range
20653 @item break-range @var{start-location}, @var{end-location}
20654 Set a breakpoint for an address range.
20655 @var{start-location} and @var{end-location} can specify a function name,
20656 a line number, an offset of lines from the current line or from the start
20657 location, or an address of an instruction (see @ref{Specify Location},
20658 for a list of all the possible ways to specify a @var{location}.)
20659 The breakpoint will stop execution of the inferior whenever it
20660 executes an instruction at any address within the specified range,
20661 (including @var{start-location} and @var{end-location}.)
20663 @kindex set powerpc
20664 @item set powerpc soft-float
20665 @itemx show powerpc soft-float
20666 Force @value{GDBN} to use (or not use) a software floating point calling
20667 convention. By default, @value{GDBN} selects the calling convention based
20668 on the selected architecture and the provided executable file.
20670 @item set powerpc vector-abi
20671 @itemx show powerpc vector-abi
20672 Force @value{GDBN} to use the specified calling convention for vector
20673 arguments and return values. The valid options are @samp{auto};
20674 @samp{generic}, to avoid vector registers even if they are present;
20675 @samp{altivec}, to use AltiVec registers; and @samp{spe} to use SPE
20676 registers. By default, @value{GDBN} selects the calling convention
20677 based on the selected architecture and the provided executable file.
20679 @item set powerpc exact-watchpoints
20680 @itemx show powerpc exact-watchpoints
20681 Allow @value{GDBN} to use only one debug register when watching a variable
20682 of scalar type, thus assuming that the variable is accessed through the
20683 address of its first byte.
20685 @kindex target dink32
20686 @item target dink32 @var{dev}
20687 DINK32 ROM monitor.
20689 @kindex target ppcbug
20690 @item target ppcbug @var{dev}
20691 @kindex target ppcbug1
20692 @item target ppcbug1 @var{dev}
20693 PPCBUG ROM monitor for PowerPC.
20696 @item target sds @var{dev}
20697 SDS monitor, running on a PowerPC board (such as Motorola's ADS).
20700 @cindex SDS protocol
20701 The following commands specific to the SDS protocol are supported
20705 @item set sdstimeout @var{nsec}
20706 @kindex set sdstimeout
20707 Set the timeout for SDS protocol reads to be @var{nsec} seconds. The
20708 default is 2 seconds.
20710 @item show sdstimeout
20711 @kindex show sdstimeout
20712 Show the current value of the SDS timeout.
20714 @item sds @var{command}
20715 @kindex sds@r{, a command}
20716 Send the specified @var{command} string to the SDS monitor.
20721 @subsection HP PA Embedded
20725 @kindex target op50n
20726 @item target op50n @var{dev}
20727 OP50N monitor, running on an OKI HPPA board.
20729 @kindex target w89k
20730 @item target w89k @var{dev}
20731 W89K monitor, running on a Winbond HPPA board.
20736 @subsection Tsqware Sparclet
20740 @value{GDBN} enables developers to debug tasks running on
20741 Sparclet targets from a Unix host.
20742 @value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
20743 both the Unix host and on the Sparclet target. The program
20744 @code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host.
20747 @item remotetimeout @var{args}
20748 @kindex remotetimeout
20749 @value{GDBN} supports the option @code{remotetimeout}.
20750 This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
20751 seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses.
20754 @cindex compiling, on Sparclet
20755 When compiling for debugging, include the options @samp{-g} to get debug
20756 information and @samp{-Ttext} to relocate the program to where you wish to
20757 load it on the target. You may also want to add the options @samp{-n} or
20758 @samp{-N} in order to reduce the size of the sections. Example:
20761 sparclet-aout-gcc prog.c -Ttext 0x12010000 -g -o prog -N
20764 You can use @code{objdump} to verify that the addresses are what you intended:
20767 sparclet-aout-objdump --headers --syms prog
20770 @cindex running, on Sparclet
20772 your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
20773 run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}}
20774 (or @code{sparclet-aout-gdb}, depending on your installation).
20776 @value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
20783 * Sparclet File:: Setting the file to debug
20784 * Sparclet Connection:: Connecting to Sparclet
20785 * Sparclet Download:: Sparclet download
20786 * Sparclet Execution:: Running and debugging
20789 @node Sparclet File
20790 @subsubsection Setting File to Debug
20792 The @value{GDBN} command @code{file} lets you choose with program to debug.
20795 (gdbslet) file prog
20799 @value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol table of @file{prog}.
20800 @value{GDBN} locates
20801 the file by searching the directories listed in the command search
20803 If the file was compiled with debug information (option @samp{-g}), source
20804 files will be searched as well.
20805 @value{GDBN} locates
20806 the source files by searching the directories listed in the directory search
20807 path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}).
20809 to find a file, it displays a message such as:
20812 prog: No such file or directory.
20815 When this happens, add the appropriate directories to the search paths with
20816 the @value{GDBN} commands @code{path} and @code{dir}, and execute the
20817 @code{target} command again.
20819 @node Sparclet Connection
20820 @subsubsection Connecting to Sparclet
20822 The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a Sparclet target.
20823 To connect to a target on serial port ``@code{ttya}'', type:
20826 (gdbslet) target sparclet /dev/ttya
20827 Remote target sparclet connected to /dev/ttya
20828 main () at ../prog.c:3
20832 @value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
20838 @node Sparclet Download
20839 @subsubsection Sparclet Download
20841 @cindex download to Sparclet
20842 Once connected to the Sparclet target,
20843 you can use the @value{GDBN}
20844 @code{load} command to download the file from the host to the target.
20845 The file name and load offset should be given as arguments to the @code{load}
20847 Since the file format is aout, the program must be loaded to the starting
20848 address. You can use @code{objdump} to find out what this value is. The load
20849 offset is an offset which is added to the VMA (virtual memory address)
20850 of each of the file's sections.
20851 For instance, if the program
20852 @file{prog} was linked to text address 0x1201000, with data at 0x12010160
20853 and bss at 0x12010170, in @value{GDBN}, type:
20856 (gdbslet) load prog 0x12010000
20857 Loading section .text, size 0xdb0 vma 0x12010000
20860 If the code is loaded at a different address then what the program was linked
20861 to, you may need to use the @code{section} and @code{add-symbol-file} commands
20862 to tell @value{GDBN} where to map the symbol table.
20864 @node Sparclet Execution
20865 @subsubsection Running and Debugging
20867 @cindex running and debugging Sparclet programs
20868 You can now begin debugging the task using @value{GDBN}'s execution control
20869 commands, @code{b}, @code{step}, @code{run}, etc. See the @value{GDBN}
20870 manual for the list of commands.
20874 Breakpoint 1 at 0x12010000: file prog.c, line 3.
20876 Starting program: prog
20877 Breakpoint 1, main (argc=1, argv=0xeffff21c) at prog.c:3
20878 3 char *symarg = 0;
20880 4 char *execarg = "hello!";
20885 @subsection Fujitsu Sparclite
20889 @kindex target sparclite
20890 @item target sparclite @var{dev}
20891 Fujitsu sparclite boards, used only for the purpose of loading.
20892 You must use an additional command to debug the program.
20893 For example: target remote @var{dev} using @value{GDBN} standard
20899 @subsection Zilog Z8000
20902 @cindex simulator, Z8000
20903 @cindex Zilog Z8000 simulator
20905 When configured for debugging Zilog Z8000 targets, @value{GDBN} includes
20908 For the Z8000 family, @samp{target sim} simulates either the Z8002 (the
20909 unsegmented variant of the Z8000 architecture) or the Z8001 (the
20910 segmented variant). The simulator recognizes which architecture is
20911 appropriate by inspecting the object code.
20914 @item target sim @var{args}
20916 @kindex target sim@r{, with Z8000}
20917 Debug programs on a simulated CPU. If the simulator supports setup
20918 options, specify them via @var{args}.
20922 After specifying this target, you can debug programs for the simulated
20923 CPU in the same style as programs for your host computer; use the
20924 @code{file} command to load a new program image, the @code{run} command
20925 to run your program, and so on.
20927 As well as making available all the usual machine registers
20928 (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}), the Z8000 simulator provides three
20929 additional items of information as specially named registers:
20934 Counts clock-ticks in the simulator.
20937 Counts instructions run in the simulator.
20940 Execution time in 60ths of a second.
20944 You can refer to these values in @value{GDBN} expressions with the usual
20945 conventions; for example, @w{@samp{b fputc if $cycles>5000}} sets a
20946 conditional breakpoint that suspends only after at least 5000
20947 simulated clock ticks.
20950 @subsection Atmel AVR
20953 When configured for debugging the Atmel AVR, @value{GDBN} supports the
20954 following AVR-specific commands:
20957 @item info io_registers
20958 @kindex info io_registers@r{, AVR}
20959 @cindex I/O registers (Atmel AVR)
20960 This command displays information about the AVR I/O registers. For
20961 each register, @value{GDBN} prints its number and value.
20968 When configured for debugging CRIS, @value{GDBN} provides the
20969 following CRIS-specific commands:
20972 @item set cris-version @var{ver}
20973 @cindex CRIS version
20974 Set the current CRIS version to @var{ver}, either @samp{10} or @samp{32}.
20975 The CRIS version affects register names and sizes. This command is useful in
20976 case autodetection of the CRIS version fails.
20978 @item show cris-version
20979 Show the current CRIS version.
20981 @item set cris-dwarf2-cfi
20982 @cindex DWARF-2 CFI and CRIS
20983 Set the usage of DWARF-2 CFI for CRIS debugging. The default is @samp{on}.
20984 Change to @samp{off} when using @code{gcc-cris} whose version is below
20987 @item show cris-dwarf2-cfi
20988 Show the current state of using DWARF-2 CFI.
20990 @item set cris-mode @var{mode}
20992 Set the current CRIS mode to @var{mode}. It should only be changed when
20993 debugging in guru mode, in which case it should be set to
20994 @samp{guru} (the default is @samp{normal}).
20996 @item show cris-mode
20997 Show the current CRIS mode.
21001 @subsection Renesas Super-H
21004 For the Renesas Super-H processor, @value{GDBN} provides these
21008 @item set sh calling-convention @var{convention}
21009 @kindex set sh calling-convention
21010 Set the calling-convention used when calling functions from @value{GDBN}.
21011 Allowed values are @samp{gcc}, which is the default setting, and @samp{renesas}.
21012 With the @samp{gcc} setting, functions are called using the @value{NGCC} calling
21013 convention. If the DWARF-2 information of the called function specifies
21014 that the function follows the Renesas calling convention, the function
21015 is called using the Renesas calling convention. If the calling convention
21016 is set to @samp{renesas}, the Renesas calling convention is always used,
21017 regardless of the DWARF-2 information. This can be used to override the
21018 default of @samp{gcc} if debug information is missing, or the compiler
21019 does not emit the DWARF-2 calling convention entry for a function.
21021 @item show sh calling-convention
21022 @kindex show sh calling-convention
21023 Show the current calling convention setting.
21028 @node Architectures
21029 @section Architectures
21031 This section describes characteristics of architectures that affect
21032 all uses of @value{GDBN} with the architecture, both native and cross.
21039 * HPPA:: HP PA architecture
21040 * SPU:: Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture
21046 @subsection AArch64
21047 @cindex AArch64 support
21049 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the AArch64 architecture, it provides the
21050 following special commands:
21053 @item set debug aarch64
21054 @kindex set debug aarch64
21055 This command determines whether AArch64 architecture-specific debugging
21056 messages are to be displayed.
21058 @item show debug aarch64
21059 Show whether AArch64 debugging messages are displayed.
21064 @subsection x86 Architecture-specific Issues
21067 @item set struct-convention @var{mode}
21068 @kindex set struct-convention
21069 @cindex struct return convention
21070 @cindex struct/union returned in registers
21071 Set the convention used by the inferior to return @code{struct}s and
21072 @code{union}s from functions to @var{mode}. Possible values of
21073 @var{mode} are @code{"pcc"}, @code{"reg"}, and @code{"default"} (the
21074 default). @code{"default"} or @code{"pcc"} means that @code{struct}s
21075 are returned on the stack, while @code{"reg"} means that a
21076 @code{struct} or a @code{union} whose size is 1, 2, 4, or 8 bytes will
21077 be returned in a register.
21079 @item show struct-convention
21080 @kindex show struct-convention
21081 Show the current setting of the convention to return @code{struct}s
21088 See the following section.
21091 @subsection @acronym{MIPS}
21093 @cindex stack on Alpha
21094 @cindex stack on @acronym{MIPS}
21095 @cindex Alpha stack
21096 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} stack
21097 Alpha- and @acronym{MIPS}-based computers use an unusual stack frame, which
21098 sometimes requires @value{GDBN} to search backward in the object code to
21099 find the beginning of a function.
21101 @cindex response time, @acronym{MIPS} debugging
21102 To improve response time (especially for embedded applications, where
21103 @value{GDBN} may be restricted to a slow serial line for this search)
21104 you may want to limit the size of this search, using one of these
21108 @cindex @code{heuristic-fence-post} (Alpha, @acronym{MIPS})
21109 @item set heuristic-fence-post @var{limit}
21110 Restrict @value{GDBN} to examining at most @var{limit} bytes in its
21111 search for the beginning of a function. A value of @var{0} (the
21112 default) means there is no limit. However, except for @var{0}, the
21113 larger the limit the more bytes @code{heuristic-fence-post} must search
21114 and therefore the longer it takes to run. You should only need to use
21115 this command when debugging a stripped executable.
21117 @item show heuristic-fence-post
21118 Display the current limit.
21122 These commands are available @emph{only} when @value{GDBN} is configured
21123 for debugging programs on Alpha or @acronym{MIPS} processors.
21125 Several @acronym{MIPS}-specific commands are available when debugging @acronym{MIPS}
21129 @item set mips abi @var{arg}
21130 @kindex set mips abi
21131 @cindex set ABI for @acronym{MIPS}
21132 Tell @value{GDBN} which @acronym{MIPS} ABI is used by the inferior. Possible
21133 values of @var{arg} are:
21137 The default ABI associated with the current binary (this is the
21147 @item show mips abi
21148 @kindex show mips abi
21149 Show the @acronym{MIPS} ABI used by @value{GDBN} to debug the inferior.
21151 @item set mips compression @var{arg}
21152 @kindex set mips compression
21153 @cindex code compression, @acronym{MIPS}
21154 Tell @value{GDBN} which @acronym{MIPS} compressed
21155 @acronym{ISA, Instruction Set Architecture} encoding is used by the
21156 inferior. @value{GDBN} uses this for code disassembly and other
21157 internal interpretation purposes. This setting is only referred to
21158 when no executable has been associated with the debugging session or
21159 the executable does not provide information about the encoding it uses.
21160 Otherwise this setting is automatically updated from information
21161 provided by the executable.
21163 Possible values of @var{arg} are @samp{mips16} and @samp{micromips}.
21164 The default compressed @acronym{ISA} encoding is @samp{mips16}, as
21165 executables containing @acronym{MIPS16} code frequently are not
21166 identified as such.
21168 This setting is ``sticky''; that is, it retains its value across
21169 debugging sessions until reset either explicitly with this command or
21170 implicitly from an executable.
21172 The compiler and/or assembler typically add symbol table annotations to
21173 identify functions compiled for the @acronym{MIPS16} or
21174 @acronym{microMIPS} @acronym{ISA}s. If these function-scope annotations
21175 are present, @value{GDBN} uses them in preference to the global
21176 compressed @acronym{ISA} encoding setting.
21178 @item show mips compression
21179 @kindex show mips compression
21180 Show the @acronym{MIPS} compressed @acronym{ISA} encoding used by
21181 @value{GDBN} to debug the inferior.
21184 @itemx show mipsfpu
21185 @xref{MIPS Embedded, set mipsfpu}.
21187 @item set mips mask-address @var{arg}
21188 @kindex set mips mask-address
21189 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} addresses, masking
21190 This command determines whether the most-significant 32 bits of 64-bit
21191 @acronym{MIPS} addresses are masked off. The argument @var{arg} can be
21192 @samp{on}, @samp{off}, or @samp{auto}. The latter is the default
21193 setting, which lets @value{GDBN} determine the correct value.
21195 @item show mips mask-address
21196 @kindex show mips mask-address
21197 Show whether the upper 32 bits of @acronym{MIPS} addresses are masked off or
21200 @item set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
21201 @kindex set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
21202 This command controls compatibility with 64-bit @acronym{MIPS} targets that
21203 transfer data in 32-bit quantities. If you have an old @acronym{MIPS} 64 target
21204 that transfers 32 bits for some registers, like @sc{sr} and @sc{fsr},
21205 and 64 bits for other registers, set this option to @samp{on}.
21207 @item show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
21208 @kindex show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
21209 Show the current setting of compatibility with older @acronym{MIPS} 64 targets.
21211 @item set debug mips
21212 @kindex set debug mips
21213 This command turns on and off debugging messages for the @acronym{MIPS}-specific
21214 target code in @value{GDBN}.
21216 @item show debug mips
21217 @kindex show debug mips
21218 Show the current setting of @acronym{MIPS} debugging messages.
21224 @cindex HPPA support
21226 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the HP PA architecture, it provides the
21227 following special commands:
21230 @item set debug hppa
21231 @kindex set debug hppa
21232 This command determines whether HPPA architecture-specific debugging
21233 messages are to be displayed.
21235 @item show debug hppa
21236 Show whether HPPA debugging messages are displayed.
21238 @item maint print unwind @var{address}
21239 @kindex maint print unwind@r{, HPPA}
21240 This command displays the contents of the unwind table entry at the
21241 given @var{address}.
21247 @subsection Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture
21248 @cindex Cell Broadband Engine
21251 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture,
21252 it provides the following special commands:
21255 @item info spu event
21257 Display SPU event facility status. Shows current event mask
21258 and pending event status.
21260 @item info spu signal
21261 Display SPU signal notification facility status. Shows pending
21262 signal-control word and signal notification mode of both signal
21263 notification channels.
21265 @item info spu mailbox
21266 Display SPU mailbox facility status. Shows all pending entries,
21267 in order of processing, in each of the SPU Write Outbound,
21268 SPU Write Outbound Interrupt, and SPU Read Inbound mailboxes.
21271 Display MFC DMA status. Shows all pending commands in the MFC
21272 DMA queue. For each entry, opcode, tag, class IDs, effective
21273 and local store addresses and transfer size are shown.
21275 @item info spu proxydma
21276 Display MFC Proxy-DMA status. Shows all pending commands in the MFC
21277 Proxy-DMA queue. For each entry, opcode, tag, class IDs, effective
21278 and local store addresses and transfer size are shown.
21282 When @value{GDBN} is debugging a combined PowerPC/SPU application
21283 on the Cell Broadband Engine, it provides in addition the following
21287 @item set spu stop-on-load @var{arg}
21289 Set whether to stop for new SPE threads. When set to @code{on}, @value{GDBN}
21290 will give control to the user when a new SPE thread enters its @code{main}
21291 function. The default is @code{off}.
21293 @item show spu stop-on-load
21295 Show whether to stop for new SPE threads.
21297 @item set spu auto-flush-cache @var{arg}
21298 Set whether to automatically flush the software-managed cache. When set to
21299 @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will automatically cause the SPE software-managed
21300 cache to be flushed whenever SPE execution stops. This provides a consistent
21301 view of PowerPC memory that is accessed via the cache. If an application
21302 does not use the software-managed cache, this option has no effect.
21304 @item show spu auto-flush-cache
21305 Show whether to automatically flush the software-managed cache.
21310 @subsection PowerPC
21311 @cindex PowerPC architecture
21313 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the PowerPC architecture, it provides a set of
21314 pseudo-registers to enable inspection of 128-bit wide Decimal Floating Point
21315 numbers stored in the floating point registers. These values must be stored
21316 in two consecutive registers, always starting at an even register like
21317 @code{f0} or @code{f2}.
21319 The pseudo-registers go from @code{$dl0} through @code{$dl15}, and are formed
21320 by joining the even/odd register pairs @code{f0} and @code{f1} for @code{$dl0},
21321 @code{f2} and @code{f3} for @code{$dl1} and so on.
21323 For POWER7 processors, @value{GDBN} provides a set of pseudo-registers, the 64-bit
21324 wide Extended Floating Point Registers (@samp{f32} through @samp{f63}).
21327 @subsection Nios II
21328 @cindex Nios II architecture
21330 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the Nios II architecture,
21331 it provides the following special commands:
21335 @item set debug nios2
21336 @kindex set debug nios2
21337 This command turns on and off debugging messages for the Nios II
21338 target code in @value{GDBN}.
21340 @item show debug nios2
21341 @kindex show debug nios2
21342 Show the current setting of Nios II debugging messages.
21345 @node Controlling GDB
21346 @chapter Controlling @value{GDBN}
21348 You can alter the way @value{GDBN} interacts with you by using the
21349 @code{set} command. For commands controlling how @value{GDBN} displays
21350 data, see @ref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}. Other settings are
21355 * Editing:: Command editing
21356 * Command History:: Command history
21357 * Screen Size:: Screen size
21358 * Numbers:: Numbers
21359 * ABI:: Configuring the current ABI
21360 * Auto-loading:: Automatically loading associated files
21361 * Messages/Warnings:: Optional warnings and messages
21362 * Debugging Output:: Optional messages about internal happenings
21363 * Other Misc Settings:: Other Miscellaneous Settings
21371 @value{GDBN} indicates its readiness to read a command by printing a string
21372 called the @dfn{prompt}. This string is normally @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. You
21373 can change the prompt string with the @code{set prompt} command. For
21374 instance, when debugging @value{GDBN} with @value{GDBN}, it is useful to change
21375 the prompt in one of the @value{GDBN} sessions so that you can always tell
21376 which one you are talking to.
21378 @emph{Note:} @code{set prompt} does not add a space for you after the
21379 prompt you set. This allows you to set a prompt which ends in a space
21380 or a prompt that does not.
21384 @item set prompt @var{newprompt}
21385 Directs @value{GDBN} to use @var{newprompt} as its prompt string henceforth.
21387 @kindex show prompt
21389 Prints a line of the form: @samp{Gdb's prompt is: @var{your-prompt}}
21392 Versions of @value{GDBN} that ship with Python scripting enabled have
21393 prompt extensions. The commands for interacting with these extensions
21397 @kindex set extended-prompt
21398 @item set extended-prompt @var{prompt}
21399 Set an extended prompt that allows for substitutions.
21400 @xref{gdb.prompt}, for a list of escape sequences that can be used for
21401 substitution. Any escape sequences specified as part of the prompt
21402 string are replaced with the corresponding strings each time the prompt
21408 set extended-prompt Current working directory: \w (gdb)
21411 Note that when an extended-prompt is set, it takes control of the
21412 @var{prompt_hook} hook. @xref{prompt_hook}, for further information.
21414 @kindex show extended-prompt
21415 @item show extended-prompt
21416 Prints the extended prompt. Any escape sequences specified as part of
21417 the prompt string with @code{set extended-prompt}, are replaced with the
21418 corresponding strings each time the prompt is displayed.
21422 @section Command Editing
21424 @cindex command line editing
21426 @value{GDBN} reads its input commands via the @dfn{Readline} interface. This
21427 @sc{gnu} library provides consistent behavior for programs which provide a
21428 command line interface to the user. Advantages are @sc{gnu} Emacs-style
21429 or @dfn{vi}-style inline editing of commands, @code{csh}-like history
21430 substitution, and a storage and recall of command history across
21431 debugging sessions.
21433 You may control the behavior of command line editing in @value{GDBN} with the
21434 command @code{set}.
21437 @kindex set editing
21440 @itemx set editing on
21441 Enable command line editing (enabled by default).
21443 @item set editing off
21444 Disable command line editing.
21446 @kindex show editing
21448 Show whether command line editing is enabled.
21451 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
21452 @xref{Command Line Editing, , , rluserman, GNU Readline Library},
21454 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
21455 @xref{Command Line Editing},
21457 for more details about the Readline
21458 interface. Users unfamiliar with @sc{gnu} Emacs or @code{vi} are
21459 encouraged to read that chapter.
21461 @node Command History
21462 @section Command History
21463 @cindex command history
21465 @value{GDBN} can keep track of the commands you type during your
21466 debugging sessions, so that you can be certain of precisely what
21467 happened. Use these commands to manage the @value{GDBN} command
21470 @value{GDBN} uses the @sc{gnu} History library, a part of the Readline
21471 package, to provide the history facility.
21472 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
21473 @xref{Using History Interactively, , , history, GNU History Library},
21475 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
21476 @xref{Using History Interactively},
21478 for the detailed description of the History library.
21480 To issue a command to @value{GDBN} without affecting certain aspects of
21481 the state which is seen by users, prefix it with @samp{server }
21482 (@pxref{Server Prefix}). This
21483 means that this command will not affect the command history, nor will it
21484 affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which command to repeat if @key{RET} is
21485 pressed on a line by itself.
21487 @cindex @code{server}, command prefix
21488 The server prefix does not affect the recording of values into the value
21489 history; to print a value without recording it into the value history,
21490 use the @code{output} command instead of the @code{print} command.
21492 Here is the description of @value{GDBN} commands related to command
21496 @cindex history substitution
21497 @cindex history file
21498 @kindex set history filename
21499 @cindex @env{GDBHISTFILE}, environment variable
21500 @item set history filename @var{fname}
21501 Set the name of the @value{GDBN} command history file to @var{fname}.
21502 This is the file where @value{GDBN} reads an initial command history
21503 list, and where it writes the command history from this session when it
21504 exits. You can access this list through history expansion or through
21505 the history command editing characters listed below. This file defaults
21506 to the value of the environment variable @code{GDBHISTFILE}, or to
21507 @file{./.gdb_history} (@file{./_gdb_history} on MS-DOS) if this variable
21510 @cindex save command history
21511 @kindex set history save
21512 @item set history save
21513 @itemx set history save on
21514 Record command history in a file, whose name may be specified with the
21515 @code{set history filename} command. By default, this option is disabled.
21517 @item set history save off
21518 Stop recording command history in a file.
21520 @cindex history size
21521 @kindex set history size
21522 @cindex @env{HISTSIZE}, environment variable
21523 @item set history size @var{size}
21524 @itemx set history size unlimited
21525 Set the number of commands which @value{GDBN} keeps in its history list.
21526 This defaults to the value of the environment variable
21527 @code{HISTSIZE}, or to 256 if this variable is not set. If @var{size}
21528 is @code{unlimited}, the number of commands @value{GDBN} keeps in the
21529 history list is unlimited.
21532 History expansion assigns special meaning to the character @kbd{!}.
21533 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
21534 @xref{Event Designators, , , history, GNU History Library},
21536 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
21537 @xref{Event Designators},
21541 @cindex history expansion, turn on/off
21542 Since @kbd{!} is also the logical not operator in C, history expansion
21543 is off by default. If you decide to enable history expansion with the
21544 @code{set history expansion on} command, you may sometimes need to
21545 follow @kbd{!} (when it is used as logical not, in an expression) with
21546 a space or a tab to prevent it from being expanded. The readline
21547 history facilities do not attempt substitution on the strings
21548 @kbd{!=} and @kbd{!(}, even when history expansion is enabled.
21550 The commands to control history expansion are:
21553 @item set history expansion on
21554 @itemx set history expansion
21555 @kindex set history expansion
21556 Enable history expansion. History expansion is off by default.
21558 @item set history expansion off
21559 Disable history expansion.
21562 @kindex show history
21564 @itemx show history filename
21565 @itemx show history save
21566 @itemx show history size
21567 @itemx show history expansion
21568 These commands display the state of the @value{GDBN} history parameters.
21569 @code{show history} by itself displays all four states.
21574 @kindex show commands
21575 @cindex show last commands
21576 @cindex display command history
21577 @item show commands
21578 Display the last ten commands in the command history.
21580 @item show commands @var{n}
21581 Print ten commands centered on command number @var{n}.
21583 @item show commands +
21584 Print ten commands just after the commands last printed.
21588 @section Screen Size
21589 @cindex size of screen
21590 @cindex pauses in output
21592 Certain commands to @value{GDBN} may produce large amounts of
21593 information output to the screen. To help you read all of it,
21594 @value{GDBN} pauses and asks you for input at the end of each page of
21595 output. Type @key{RET} when you want to continue the output, or @kbd{q}
21596 to discard the remaining output. Also, the screen width setting
21597 determines when to wrap lines of output. Depending on what is being
21598 printed, @value{GDBN} tries to break the line at a readable place,
21599 rather than simply letting it overflow onto the following line.
21601 Normally @value{GDBN} knows the size of the screen from the terminal
21602 driver software. For example, on Unix @value{GDBN} uses the termcap data base
21603 together with the value of the @code{TERM} environment variable and the
21604 @code{stty rows} and @code{stty cols} settings. If this is not correct,
21605 you can override it with the @code{set height} and @code{set
21612 @kindex show height
21613 @item set height @var{lpp}
21614 @itemx set height unlimited
21616 @itemx set width @var{cpl}
21617 @itemx set width unlimited
21619 These @code{set} commands specify a screen height of @var{lpp} lines and
21620 a screen width of @var{cpl} characters. The associated @code{show}
21621 commands display the current settings.
21623 If you specify a height of either @code{unlimited} or zero lines,
21624 @value{GDBN} does not pause during output no matter how long the
21625 output is. This is useful if output is to a file or to an editor
21628 Likewise, you can specify @samp{set width unlimited} or @samp{set
21629 width 0} to prevent @value{GDBN} from wrapping its output.
21631 @item set pagination on
21632 @itemx set pagination off
21633 @kindex set pagination
21634 Turn the output pagination on or off; the default is on. Turning
21635 pagination off is the alternative to @code{set height unlimited}. Note that
21636 running @value{GDBN} with the @option{--batch} option (@pxref{Mode
21637 Options, -batch}) also automatically disables pagination.
21639 @item show pagination
21640 @kindex show pagination
21641 Show the current pagination mode.
21646 @cindex number representation
21647 @cindex entering numbers
21649 You can always enter numbers in octal, decimal, or hexadecimal in
21650 @value{GDBN} by the usual conventions: octal numbers begin with
21651 @samp{0}, decimal numbers end with @samp{.}, and hexadecimal numbers
21652 begin with @samp{0x}. Numbers that neither begin with @samp{0} or
21653 @samp{0x}, nor end with a @samp{.} are, by default, entered in base
21654 10; likewise, the default display for numbers---when no particular
21655 format is specified---is base 10. You can change the default base for
21656 both input and output with the commands described below.
21659 @kindex set input-radix
21660 @item set input-radix @var{base}
21661 Set the default base for numeric input. Supported choices
21662 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
21663 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix; for
21667 set input-radix 012
21668 set input-radix 10.
21669 set input-radix 0xa
21673 sets the input base to decimal. On the other hand, @samp{set input-radix 10}
21674 leaves the input radix unchanged, no matter what it was, since
21675 @samp{10}, being without any leading or trailing signs of its base, is
21676 interpreted in the current radix. Thus, if the current radix is 16,
21677 @samp{10} is interpreted in hex, i.e.@: as 16 decimal, which doesn't
21680 @kindex set output-radix
21681 @item set output-radix @var{base}
21682 Set the default base for numeric display. Supported choices
21683 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
21684 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix.
21686 @kindex show input-radix
21687 @item show input-radix
21688 Display the current default base for numeric input.
21690 @kindex show output-radix
21691 @item show output-radix
21692 Display the current default base for numeric display.
21694 @item set radix @r{[}@var{base}@r{]}
21698 These commands set and show the default base for both input and output
21699 of numbers. @code{set radix} sets the radix of input and output to
21700 the same base; without an argument, it resets the radix back to its
21701 default value of 10.
21706 @section Configuring the Current ABI
21708 @value{GDBN} can determine the @dfn{ABI} (Application Binary Interface) of your
21709 application automatically. However, sometimes you need to override its
21710 conclusions. Use these commands to manage @value{GDBN}'s view of the
21716 @cindex Newlib OS ABI and its influence on the longjmp handling
21718 One @value{GDBN} configuration can debug binaries for multiple operating
21719 system targets, either via remote debugging or native emulation.
21720 @value{GDBN} will autodetect the @dfn{OS ABI} (Operating System ABI) in use,
21721 but you can override its conclusion using the @code{set osabi} command.
21722 One example where this is useful is in debugging of binaries which use
21723 an alternate C library (e.g.@: @sc{uClibc} for @sc{gnu}/Linux) which does
21724 not have the same identifying marks that the standard C library for your
21727 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the AArch64 architecture, it provides a
21728 ``Newlib'' OS ABI. This is useful for handling @code{setjmp} and
21729 @code{longjmp} when debugging binaries that use the @sc{newlib} C library.
21730 The ``Newlib'' OS ABI can be selected by @code{set osabi Newlib}.
21734 Show the OS ABI currently in use.
21737 With no argument, show the list of registered available OS ABI's.
21739 @item set osabi @var{abi}
21740 Set the current OS ABI to @var{abi}.
21743 @cindex float promotion
21745 Generally, the way that an argument of type @code{float} is passed to a
21746 function depends on whether the function is prototyped. For a prototyped
21747 (i.e.@: ANSI/ISO style) function, @code{float} arguments are passed unchanged,
21748 according to the architecture's convention for @code{float}. For unprototyped
21749 (i.e.@: K&R style) functions, @code{float} arguments are first promoted to type
21750 @code{double} and then passed.
21752 Unfortunately, some forms of debug information do not reliably indicate whether
21753 a function is prototyped. If @value{GDBN} calls a function that is not marked
21754 as prototyped, it consults @kbd{set coerce-float-to-double}.
21757 @kindex set coerce-float-to-double
21758 @item set coerce-float-to-double
21759 @itemx set coerce-float-to-double on
21760 Arguments of type @code{float} will be promoted to @code{double} when passed
21761 to an unprototyped function. This is the default setting.
21763 @item set coerce-float-to-double off
21764 Arguments of type @code{float} will be passed directly to unprototyped
21767 @kindex show coerce-float-to-double
21768 @item show coerce-float-to-double
21769 Show the current setting of promoting @code{float} to @code{double}.
21773 @kindex show cp-abi
21774 @value{GDBN} needs to know the ABI used for your program's C@t{++}
21775 objects. The correct C@t{++} ABI depends on which C@t{++} compiler was
21776 used to build your application. @value{GDBN} only fully supports
21777 programs with a single C@t{++} ABI; if your program contains code using
21778 multiple C@t{++} ABI's or if @value{GDBN} can not identify your
21779 program's ABI correctly, you can tell @value{GDBN} which ABI to use.
21780 Currently supported ABI's include ``gnu-v2'', for @code{g++} versions
21781 before 3.0, ``gnu-v3'', for @code{g++} versions 3.0 and later, and
21782 ``hpaCC'' for the HP ANSI C@t{++} compiler. Other C@t{++} compilers may
21783 use the ``gnu-v2'' or ``gnu-v3'' ABI's as well. The default setting is
21788 Show the C@t{++} ABI currently in use.
21791 With no argument, show the list of supported C@t{++} ABI's.
21793 @item set cp-abi @var{abi}
21794 @itemx set cp-abi auto
21795 Set the current C@t{++} ABI to @var{abi}, or return to automatic detection.
21799 @section Automatically loading associated files
21800 @cindex auto-loading
21802 @value{GDBN} sometimes reads files with commands and settings automatically,
21803 without being explicitly told so by the user. We call this feature
21804 @dfn{auto-loading}. While auto-loading is useful for automatically adapting
21805 @value{GDBN} to the needs of your project, it can sometimes produce unexpected
21806 results or introduce security risks (e.g., if the file comes from untrusted
21809 Note that loading of these associated files (including the local @file{.gdbinit}
21810 file) requires accordingly configured @code{auto-load safe-path}
21811 (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
21813 For these reasons, @value{GDBN} includes commands and options to let you
21814 control when to auto-load files and which files should be auto-loaded.
21817 @anchor{set auto-load off}
21818 @kindex set auto-load off
21819 @item set auto-load off
21820 Globally disable loading of all auto-loaded files.
21821 You may want to use this command with the @samp{-iex} option
21822 (@pxref{Option -init-eval-command}) such as:
21824 $ @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load off" untrusted-executable corefile}
21827 Be aware that system init file (@pxref{System-wide configuration})
21828 and init files from your home directory (@pxref{Home Directory Init File})
21829 still get read (as they come from generally trusted directories).
21830 To prevent @value{GDBN} from auto-loading even those init files, use the
21831 @option{-nx} option (@pxref{Mode Options}), in addition to
21832 @code{set auto-load no}.
21834 @anchor{show auto-load}
21835 @kindex show auto-load
21836 @item show auto-load
21837 Show whether auto-loading of each specific @samp{auto-load} file(s) is enabled
21841 (gdb) show auto-load
21842 gdb-scripts: Auto-loading of canned sequences of commands scripts is on.
21843 libthread-db: Auto-loading of inferior specific libthread_db is on.
21844 local-gdbinit: Auto-loading of .gdbinit script from current directory
21846 python-scripts: Auto-loading of Python scripts is on.
21847 safe-path: List of directories from which it is safe to auto-load files
21848 is $debugdir:$datadir/auto-load.
21849 scripts-directory: List of directories from which to load auto-loaded scripts
21850 is $debugdir:$datadir/auto-load.
21853 @anchor{info auto-load}
21854 @kindex info auto-load
21855 @item info auto-load
21856 Print whether each specific @samp{auto-load} file(s) have been auto-loaded or
21860 (gdb) info auto-load
21863 Yes /home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.gdb
21864 libthread-db: No auto-loaded libthread-db.
21865 local-gdbinit: Local .gdbinit file "/home/user/gdb/.gdbinit" has been
21869 Yes /home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.py
21873 These are various kinds of files @value{GDBN} can automatically load:
21877 @xref{objfile-gdb.py file}, controlled by @ref{set auto-load python-scripts}.
21879 @xref{objfile-gdb.gdb file}, controlled by @ref{set auto-load gdb-scripts}.
21881 @xref{dotdebug_gdb_scripts section},
21882 controlled by @ref{set auto-load python-scripts}.
21884 @xref{Init File in the Current Directory},
21885 controlled by @ref{set auto-load local-gdbinit}.
21887 @xref{libthread_db.so.1 file}, controlled by @ref{set auto-load libthread-db}.
21890 These are @value{GDBN} control commands for the auto-loading:
21892 @multitable @columnfractions .5 .5
21893 @item @xref{set auto-load off}.
21894 @tab Disable auto-loading globally.
21895 @item @xref{show auto-load}.
21896 @tab Show setting of all kinds of files.
21897 @item @xref{info auto-load}.
21898 @tab Show state of all kinds of files.
21899 @item @xref{set auto-load gdb-scripts}.
21900 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} command scripts.
21901 @item @xref{show auto-load gdb-scripts}.
21902 @tab Show setting of @value{GDBN} command scripts.
21903 @item @xref{info auto-load gdb-scripts}.
21904 @tab Show state of @value{GDBN} command scripts.
21905 @item @xref{set auto-load python-scripts}.
21906 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} Python scripts.
21907 @item @xref{show auto-load python-scripts}.
21908 @tab Show setting of @value{GDBN} Python scripts.
21909 @item @xref{info auto-load python-scripts}.
21910 @tab Show state of @value{GDBN} Python scripts.
21911 @item @xref{set auto-load scripts-directory}.
21912 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location.
21913 @item @xref{show auto-load scripts-directory}.
21914 @tab Show @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location.
21915 @item @xref{set auto-load local-gdbinit}.
21916 @tab Control for init file in the current directory.
21917 @item @xref{show auto-load local-gdbinit}.
21918 @tab Show setting of init file in the current directory.
21919 @item @xref{info auto-load local-gdbinit}.
21920 @tab Show state of init file in the current directory.
21921 @item @xref{set auto-load libthread-db}.
21922 @tab Control for thread debugging library.
21923 @item @xref{show auto-load libthread-db}.
21924 @tab Show setting of thread debugging library.
21925 @item @xref{info auto-load libthread-db}.
21926 @tab Show state of thread debugging library.
21927 @item @xref{set auto-load safe-path}.
21928 @tab Control directories trusted for automatic loading.
21929 @item @xref{show auto-load safe-path}.
21930 @tab Show directories trusted for automatic loading.
21931 @item @xref{add-auto-load-safe-path}.
21932 @tab Add directory trusted for automatic loading.
21936 * Init File in the Current Directory:: @samp{set/show/info auto-load local-gdbinit}
21937 * libthread_db.so.1 file:: @samp{set/show/info auto-load libthread-db}
21938 * objfile-gdb.gdb file:: @samp{set/show/info auto-load gdb-script}
21939 * Auto-loading safe path:: @samp{set/show/info auto-load safe-path}
21940 * Auto-loading verbose mode:: @samp{set/show debug auto-load}
21941 @xref{Python Auto-loading}.
21944 @node Init File in the Current Directory
21945 @subsection Automatically loading init file in the current directory
21946 @cindex auto-loading init file in the current directory
21948 By default, @value{GDBN} reads and executes the canned sequences of commands
21949 from init file (if any) in the current working directory,
21950 see @ref{Init File in the Current Directory during Startup}.
21952 Note that loading of this local @file{.gdbinit} file also requires accordingly
21953 configured @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
21956 @anchor{set auto-load local-gdbinit}
21957 @kindex set auto-load local-gdbinit
21958 @item set auto-load local-gdbinit [on|off]
21959 Enable or disable the auto-loading of canned sequences of commands
21960 (@pxref{Sequences}) found in init file in the current directory.
21962 @anchor{show auto-load local-gdbinit}
21963 @kindex show auto-load local-gdbinit
21964 @item show auto-load local-gdbinit
21965 Show whether auto-loading of canned sequences of commands from init file in the
21966 current directory is enabled or disabled.
21968 @anchor{info auto-load local-gdbinit}
21969 @kindex info auto-load local-gdbinit
21970 @item info auto-load local-gdbinit
21971 Print whether canned sequences of commands from init file in the
21972 current directory have been auto-loaded.
21975 @node libthread_db.so.1 file
21976 @subsection Automatically loading thread debugging library
21977 @cindex auto-loading libthread_db.so.1
21979 This feature is currently present only on @sc{gnu}/Linux native hosts.
21981 @value{GDBN} reads in some cases thread debugging library from places specific
21982 to the inferior (@pxref{set libthread-db-search-path}).
21984 The special @samp{libthread-db-search-path} entry @samp{$sdir} is processed
21985 without checking this @samp{set auto-load libthread-db} switch as system
21986 libraries have to be trusted in general. In all other cases of
21987 @samp{libthread-db-search-path} entries @value{GDBN} checks first if @samp{set
21988 auto-load libthread-db} is enabled before trying to open such thread debugging
21991 Note that loading of this debugging library also requires accordingly configured
21992 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
21995 @anchor{set auto-load libthread-db}
21996 @kindex set auto-load libthread-db
21997 @item set auto-load libthread-db [on|off]
21998 Enable or disable the auto-loading of inferior specific thread debugging library.
22000 @anchor{show auto-load libthread-db}
22001 @kindex show auto-load libthread-db
22002 @item show auto-load libthread-db
22003 Show whether auto-loading of inferior specific thread debugging library is
22004 enabled or disabled.
22006 @anchor{info auto-load libthread-db}
22007 @kindex info auto-load libthread-db
22008 @item info auto-load libthread-db
22009 Print the list of all loaded inferior specific thread debugging libraries and
22010 for each such library print list of inferior @var{pid}s using it.
22013 @node objfile-gdb.gdb file
22014 @subsection The @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.gdb} file
22015 @cindex auto-loading @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.gdb}
22017 @value{GDBN} tries to load an @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.gdb} file containing
22018 canned sequences of commands (@pxref{Sequences}), as long as @samp{set
22019 auto-load gdb-scripts} is set to @samp{on}.
22021 Note that loading of this script file also requires accordingly configured
22022 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
22024 For more background refer to the similar Python scripts auto-loading
22025 description (@pxref{objfile-gdb.py file}).
22028 @anchor{set auto-load gdb-scripts}
22029 @kindex set auto-load gdb-scripts
22030 @item set auto-load gdb-scripts [on|off]
22031 Enable or disable the auto-loading of canned sequences of commands scripts.
22033 @anchor{show auto-load gdb-scripts}
22034 @kindex show auto-load gdb-scripts
22035 @item show auto-load gdb-scripts
22036 Show whether auto-loading of canned sequences of commands scripts is enabled or
22039 @anchor{info auto-load gdb-scripts}
22040 @kindex info auto-load gdb-scripts
22041 @cindex print list of auto-loaded canned sequences of commands scripts
22042 @item info auto-load gdb-scripts [@var{regexp}]
22043 Print the list of all canned sequences of commands scripts that @value{GDBN}
22047 If @var{regexp} is supplied only canned sequences of commands scripts with
22048 matching names are printed.
22050 @node Auto-loading safe path
22051 @subsection Security restriction for auto-loading
22052 @cindex auto-loading safe-path
22054 As the files of inferior can come from untrusted source (such as submitted by
22055 an application user) @value{GDBN} does not always load any files automatically.
22056 @value{GDBN} provides the @samp{set auto-load safe-path} setting to list
22057 directories trusted for loading files not explicitly requested by user.
22058 Each directory can also be a shell wildcard pattern.
22060 If the path is not set properly you will see a warning and the file will not
22065 Reading symbols from /home/user/gdb/gdb...done.
22066 warning: File "/home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.gdb" auto-loading has been
22067 declined by your `auto-load safe-path' set
22068 to "$debugdir:$datadir/auto-load".
22069 warning: File "/home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.py" auto-loading has been
22070 declined by your `auto-load safe-path' set
22071 to "$debugdir:$datadir/auto-load".
22075 To instruct @value{GDBN} to go ahead and use the init files anyway,
22076 invoke @value{GDBN} like this:
22079 $ gdb -q -iex "set auto-load safe-path /home/user/gdb" ./gdb
22082 The list of trusted directories is controlled by the following commands:
22085 @anchor{set auto-load safe-path}
22086 @kindex set auto-load safe-path
22087 @item set auto-load safe-path @r{[}@var{directories}@r{]}
22088 Set the list of directories (and their subdirectories) trusted for automatic
22089 loading and execution of scripts. You can also enter a specific trusted file.
22090 Each directory can also be a shell wildcard pattern; wildcards do not match
22091 directory separator - see @code{FNM_PATHNAME} for system function @code{fnmatch}
22092 (@pxref{Wildcard Matching, fnmatch, , libc, GNU C Library Reference Manual}).
22093 If you omit @var{directories}, @samp{auto-load safe-path} will be reset to
22094 its default value as specified during @value{GDBN} compilation.
22096 The list of directories uses path separator (@samp{:} on GNU and Unix
22097 systems, @samp{;} on MS-Windows and MS-DOS) to separate directories, similarly
22098 to the @env{PATH} environment variable.
22100 @anchor{show auto-load safe-path}
22101 @kindex show auto-load safe-path
22102 @item show auto-load safe-path
22103 Show the list of directories trusted for automatic loading and execution of
22106 @anchor{add-auto-load-safe-path}
22107 @kindex add-auto-load-safe-path
22108 @item add-auto-load-safe-path
22109 Add an entry (or list of entries) the list of directories trusted for automatic
22110 loading and execution of scripts. Multiple entries may be delimited by the
22111 host platform path separator in use.
22114 This variable defaults to what @code{--with-auto-load-dir} has been configured
22115 to (@pxref{with-auto-load-dir}). @file{$debugdir} and @file{$datadir}
22116 substitution applies the same as for @ref{set auto-load scripts-directory}.
22117 The default @code{set auto-load safe-path} value can be also overriden by
22118 @value{GDBN} configuration option @option{--with-auto-load-safe-path}.
22120 Setting this variable to @file{/} disables this security protection,
22121 corresponding @value{GDBN} configuration option is
22122 @option{--without-auto-load-safe-path}.
22123 This variable is supposed to be set to the system directories writable by the
22124 system superuser only. Users can add their source directories in init files in
22125 their home directories (@pxref{Home Directory Init File}). See also deprecated
22126 init file in the current directory
22127 (@pxref{Init File in the Current Directory during Startup}).
22129 To force @value{GDBN} to load the files it declined to load in the previous
22130 example, you could use one of the following ways:
22133 @item @file{~/.gdbinit}: @samp{add-auto-load-safe-path ~/src/gdb}
22134 Specify this trusted directory (or a file) as additional component of the list.
22135 You have to specify also any existing directories displayed by
22136 by @samp{show auto-load safe-path} (such as @samp{/usr:/bin} in this example).
22138 @item @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load safe-path /usr:/bin:~/src/gdb" @dots{}}
22139 Specify this directory as in the previous case but just for a single
22140 @value{GDBN} session.
22142 @item @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load safe-path /" @dots{}}
22143 Disable auto-loading safety for a single @value{GDBN} session.
22144 This assumes all the files you debug during this @value{GDBN} session will come
22145 from trusted sources.
22147 @item @kbd{./configure --without-auto-load-safe-path}
22148 During compilation of @value{GDBN} you may disable any auto-loading safety.
22149 This assumes all the files you will ever debug with this @value{GDBN} come from
22153 On the other hand you can also explicitly forbid automatic files loading which
22154 also suppresses any such warning messages:
22157 @item @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load no" @dots{}}
22158 You can use @value{GDBN} command-line option for a single @value{GDBN} session.
22160 @item @file{~/.gdbinit}: @samp{set auto-load no}
22161 Disable auto-loading globally for the user
22162 (@pxref{Home Directory Init File}). While it is improbable, you could also
22163 use system init file instead (@pxref{System-wide configuration}).
22166 This setting applies to the file names as entered by user. If no entry matches
22167 @value{GDBN} tries as a last resort to also resolve all the file names into
22168 their canonical form (typically resolving symbolic links) and compare the
22169 entries again. @value{GDBN} already canonicalizes most of the filenames on its
22170 own before starting the comparison so a canonical form of directories is
22171 recommended to be entered.
22173 @node Auto-loading verbose mode
22174 @subsection Displaying files tried for auto-load
22175 @cindex auto-loading verbose mode
22177 For better visibility of all the file locations where you can place scripts to
22178 be auto-loaded with inferior --- or to protect yourself against accidental
22179 execution of untrusted scripts --- @value{GDBN} provides a feature for printing
22180 all the files attempted to be loaded. Both existing and non-existing files may
22183 For example the list of directories from which it is safe to auto-load files
22184 (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}) applies also to canonicalized filenames which
22185 may not be too obvious while setting it up.
22188 (gdb) set debug auto-load on
22189 (gdb) file ~/src/t/true
22190 auto-load: Loading canned sequences of commands script "/tmp/true-gdb.gdb"
22191 for objfile "/tmp/true".
22192 auto-load: Updating directories of "/usr:/opt".
22193 auto-load: Using directory "/usr".
22194 auto-load: Using directory "/opt".
22195 warning: File "/tmp/true-gdb.gdb" auto-loading has been declined
22196 by your `auto-load safe-path' set to "/usr:/opt".
22200 @anchor{set debug auto-load}
22201 @kindex set debug auto-load
22202 @item set debug auto-load [on|off]
22203 Set whether to print the filenames attempted to be auto-loaded.
22205 @anchor{show debug auto-load}
22206 @kindex show debug auto-load
22207 @item show debug auto-load
22208 Show whether printing of the filenames attempted to be auto-loaded is turned
22212 @node Messages/Warnings
22213 @section Optional Warnings and Messages
22215 @cindex verbose operation
22216 @cindex optional warnings
22217 By default, @value{GDBN} is silent about its inner workings. If you are
22218 running on a slow machine, you may want to use the @code{set verbose}
22219 command. This makes @value{GDBN} tell you when it does a lengthy
22220 internal operation, so you will not think it has crashed.
22222 Currently, the messages controlled by @code{set verbose} are those
22223 which announce that the symbol table for a source file is being read;
22224 see @code{symbol-file} in @ref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}.
22227 @kindex set verbose
22228 @item set verbose on
22229 Enables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
22231 @item set verbose off
22232 Disables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
22234 @kindex show verbose
22236 Displays whether @code{set verbose} is on or off.
22239 By default, if @value{GDBN} encounters bugs in the symbol table of an
22240 object file, it is silent; but if you are debugging a compiler, you may
22241 find this information useful (@pxref{Symbol Errors, ,Errors Reading
22246 @kindex set complaints
22247 @item set complaints @var{limit}
22248 Permits @value{GDBN} to output @var{limit} complaints about each type of
22249 unusual symbols before becoming silent about the problem. Set
22250 @var{limit} to zero to suppress all complaints; set it to a large number
22251 to prevent complaints from being suppressed.
22253 @kindex show complaints
22254 @item show complaints
22255 Displays how many symbol complaints @value{GDBN} is permitted to produce.
22259 @anchor{confirmation requests}
22260 By default, @value{GDBN} is cautious, and asks what sometimes seems to be a
22261 lot of stupid questions to confirm certain commands. For example, if
22262 you try to run a program which is already running:
22266 The program being debugged has been started already.
22267 Start it from the beginning? (y or n)
22270 If you are willing to unflinchingly face the consequences of your own
22271 commands, you can disable this ``feature'':
22275 @kindex set confirm
22277 @cindex confirmation
22278 @cindex stupid questions
22279 @item set confirm off
22280 Disables confirmation requests. Note that running @value{GDBN} with
22281 the @option{--batch} option (@pxref{Mode Options, -batch}) also
22282 automatically disables confirmation requests.
22284 @item set confirm on
22285 Enables confirmation requests (the default).
22287 @kindex show confirm
22289 Displays state of confirmation requests.
22293 @cindex command tracing
22294 If you need to debug user-defined commands or sourced files you may find it
22295 useful to enable @dfn{command tracing}. In this mode each command will be
22296 printed as it is executed, prefixed with one or more @samp{+} symbols, the
22297 quantity denoting the call depth of each command.
22300 @kindex set trace-commands
22301 @cindex command scripts, debugging
22302 @item set trace-commands on
22303 Enable command tracing.
22304 @item set trace-commands off
22305 Disable command tracing.
22306 @item show trace-commands
22307 Display the current state of command tracing.
22310 @node Debugging Output
22311 @section Optional Messages about Internal Happenings
22312 @cindex optional debugging messages
22314 @value{GDBN} has commands that enable optional debugging messages from
22315 various @value{GDBN} subsystems; normally these commands are of
22316 interest to @value{GDBN} maintainers, or when reporting a bug. This
22317 section documents those commands.
22320 @kindex set exec-done-display
22321 @item set exec-done-display
22322 Turns on or off the notification of asynchronous commands'
22323 completion. When on, @value{GDBN} will print a message when an
22324 asynchronous command finishes its execution. The default is off.
22325 @kindex show exec-done-display
22326 @item show exec-done-display
22327 Displays the current setting of asynchronous command completion
22330 @cindex ARM AArch64
22331 @item set debug aarch64
22332 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to ARM AArch64.
22333 The default is off.
22335 @item show debug aarch64
22336 Displays the current state of displaying debugging messages related to
22338 @cindex gdbarch debugging info
22339 @cindex architecture debugging info
22340 @item set debug arch
22341 Turns on or off display of gdbarch debugging info. The default is off
22342 @item show debug arch
22343 Displays the current state of displaying gdbarch debugging info.
22344 @item set debug aix-solib
22345 @cindex AIX shared library debugging
22346 Control display of debugging messages from the AIX shared library
22347 support module. The default is off.
22348 @item show debug aix-thread
22349 Show the current state of displaying AIX shared library debugging messages.
22350 @item set debug aix-thread
22351 @cindex AIX threads
22352 Display debugging messages about inner workings of the AIX thread
22354 @item show debug aix-thread
22355 Show the current state of AIX thread debugging info display.
22356 @item set debug check-physname
22358 Check the results of the ``physname'' computation. When reading DWARF
22359 debugging information for C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} attempts to compute
22360 each entity's name. @value{GDBN} can do this computation in two
22361 different ways, depending on exactly what information is present.
22362 When enabled, this setting causes @value{GDBN} to compute the names
22363 both ways and display any discrepancies.
22364 @item show debug check-physname
22365 Show the current state of ``physname'' checking.
22366 @item set debug coff-pe-read
22367 @cindex COFF/PE exported symbols
22368 Control display of debugging messages related to reading of COFF/PE
22369 exported symbols. The default is off.
22370 @item show debug coff-pe-read
22371 Displays the current state of displaying debugging messages related to
22372 reading of COFF/PE exported symbols.
22373 @item set debug dwarf2-die
22374 @cindex DWARF2 DIEs
22375 Dump DWARF2 DIEs after they are read in.
22376 The value is the number of nesting levels to print.
22377 A value of zero turns off the display.
22378 @item show debug dwarf2-die
22379 Show the current state of DWARF2 DIE debugging.
22380 @item set debug dwarf2-read
22381 @cindex DWARF2 Reading
22382 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to reading
22383 DWARF debug info. The default is off.
22384 @item show debug dwarf2-read
22385 Show the current state of DWARF2 reader debugging.
22386 @item set debug displaced
22387 @cindex displaced stepping debugging info
22388 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for the
22389 displaced stepping support. The default is off.
22390 @item show debug displaced
22391 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} debugging info
22392 related to displaced stepping.
22393 @item set debug event
22394 @cindex event debugging info
22395 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} event debugging info. The
22397 @item show debug event
22398 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} event debugging
22400 @item set debug expression
22401 @cindex expression debugging info
22402 Turns on or off display of debugging info about @value{GDBN}
22403 expression parsing. The default is off.
22404 @item show debug expression
22405 Displays the current state of displaying debugging info about
22406 @value{GDBN} expression parsing.
22407 @item set debug frame
22408 @cindex frame debugging info
22409 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} frame debugging info. The
22411 @item show debug frame
22412 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} frame debugging
22414 @item set debug gnu-nat
22415 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Hurd debug messages
22416 Turns on or off debugging messages from the @sc{gnu}/Hurd debug support.
22417 @item show debug gnu-nat
22418 Show the current state of @sc{gnu}/Hurd debugging messages.
22419 @item set debug infrun
22420 @cindex inferior debugging info
22421 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for running the inferior.
22422 The default is off. @file{infrun.c} contains GDB's runtime state machine used
22423 for implementing operations such as single-stepping the inferior.
22424 @item show debug infrun
22425 Displays the current state of @value{GDBN} inferior debugging.
22426 @item set debug jit
22427 @cindex just-in-time compilation, debugging messages
22428 Turns on or off debugging messages from JIT debug support.
22429 @item show debug jit
22430 Displays the current state of @value{GDBN} JIT debugging.
22431 @item set debug lin-lwp
22432 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Linux LWP debug messages
22433 @cindex Linux lightweight processes
22434 Turns on or off debugging messages from the Linux LWP debug support.
22435 @item show debug lin-lwp
22436 Show the current state of Linux LWP debugging messages.
22437 @item set debug mach-o
22438 @cindex Mach-O symbols processing
22439 Control display of debugging messages related to Mach-O symbols
22440 processing. The default is off.
22441 @item show debug mach-o
22442 Displays the current state of displaying debugging messages related to
22443 reading of COFF/PE exported symbols.
22444 @item set debug notification
22445 @cindex remote async notification debugging info
22446 Turns on or off debugging messages about remote async notification.
22447 The default is off.
22448 @item show debug notification
22449 Displays the current state of remote async notification debugging messages.
22450 @item set debug observer
22451 @cindex observer debugging info
22452 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} observer debugging. This
22453 includes info such as the notification of observable events.
22454 @item show debug observer
22455 Displays the current state of observer debugging.
22456 @item set debug overload
22457 @cindex C@t{++} overload debugging info
22458 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload debugging
22459 info. This includes info such as ranking of functions, etc. The default
22461 @item show debug overload
22462 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload
22464 @cindex expression parser, debugging info
22465 @cindex debug expression parser
22466 @item set debug parser
22467 Turns on or off the display of expression parser debugging output.
22468 Internally, this sets the @code{yydebug} variable in the expression
22469 parser. @xref{Tracing, , Tracing Your Parser, bison, Bison}, for
22470 details. The default is off.
22471 @item show debug parser
22472 Show the current state of expression parser debugging.
22473 @cindex packets, reporting on stdout
22474 @cindex serial connections, debugging
22475 @cindex debug remote protocol
22476 @cindex remote protocol debugging
22477 @cindex display remote packets
22478 @item set debug remote
22479 Turns on or off display of reports on all packets sent back and forth across
22480 the serial line to the remote machine. The info is printed on the
22481 @value{GDBN} standard output stream. The default is off.
22482 @item show debug remote
22483 Displays the state of display of remote packets.
22484 @item set debug serial
22485 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} serial debugging info. The
22487 @item show debug serial
22488 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} serial debugging
22490 @item set debug solib-frv
22491 @cindex FR-V shared-library debugging
22492 Turns on or off debugging messages for FR-V shared-library code.
22493 @item show debug solib-frv
22494 Display the current state of FR-V shared-library code debugging
22496 @item set debug symtab-create
22497 @cindex symbol table creation
22498 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to symbol table creation.
22499 The default is off.
22500 @item show debug symtab-create
22501 Show the current state of symbol table creation debugging.
22502 @item set debug target
22503 @cindex target debugging info
22504 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} target debugging info. This info
22505 includes what is going on at the target level of GDB, as it happens. The
22506 default is 0. Set it to 1 to track events, and to 2 to also track the
22507 value of large memory transfers. Changes to this flag do not take effect
22508 until the next time you connect to a target or use the @code{run} command.
22509 @item show debug target
22510 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} target debugging
22512 @item set debug timestamp
22513 @cindex timestampping debugging info
22514 Turns on or off display of timestamps with @value{GDBN} debugging info.
22515 When enabled, seconds and microseconds are displayed before each debugging
22517 @item show debug timestamp
22518 Displays the current state of displaying timestamps with @value{GDBN}
22520 @item set debugvarobj
22521 @cindex variable object debugging info
22522 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} variable object debugging
22523 info. The default is off.
22524 @item show debugvarobj
22525 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} variable object
22527 @item set debug xml
22528 @cindex XML parser debugging
22529 Turns on or off debugging messages for built-in XML parsers.
22530 @item show debug xml
22531 Displays the current state of XML debugging messages.
22534 @node Other Misc Settings
22535 @section Other Miscellaneous Settings
22536 @cindex miscellaneous settings
22539 @kindex set interactive-mode
22540 @item set interactive-mode
22541 If @code{on}, forces @value{GDBN} to assume that GDB was started
22542 in a terminal. In practice, this means that @value{GDBN} should wait
22543 for the user to answer queries generated by commands entered at
22544 the command prompt. If @code{off}, forces @value{GDBN} to operate
22545 in the opposite mode, and it uses the default answers to all queries.
22546 If @code{auto} (the default), @value{GDBN} tries to determine whether
22547 its standard input is a terminal, and works in interactive-mode if it
22548 is, non-interactively otherwise.
22550 In the vast majority of cases, the debugger should be able to guess
22551 correctly which mode should be used. But this setting can be useful
22552 in certain specific cases, such as running a MinGW @value{GDBN}
22553 inside a cygwin window.
22555 @kindex show interactive-mode
22556 @item show interactive-mode
22557 Displays whether the debugger is operating in interactive mode or not.
22560 @node Extending GDB
22561 @chapter Extending @value{GDBN}
22562 @cindex extending GDB
22564 @value{GDBN} provides three mechanisms for extension. The first is based
22565 on composition of @value{GDBN} commands, the second is based on the
22566 Python scripting language, and the third is for defining new aliases of
22569 To facilitate the use of the first two extensions, @value{GDBN} is capable
22570 of evaluating the contents of a file. When doing so, @value{GDBN}
22571 can recognize which scripting language is being used by looking at
22572 the filename extension. Files with an unrecognized filename extension
22573 are always treated as a @value{GDBN} Command Files.
22574 @xref{Command Files,, Command files}.
22576 You can control how @value{GDBN} evaluates these files with the following
22580 @kindex set script-extension
22581 @kindex show script-extension
22582 @item set script-extension off
22583 All scripts are always evaluated as @value{GDBN} Command Files.
22585 @item set script-extension soft
22586 The debugger determines the scripting language based on filename
22587 extension. If this scripting language is supported, @value{GDBN}
22588 evaluates the script using that language. Otherwise, it evaluates
22589 the file as a @value{GDBN} Command File.
22591 @item set script-extension strict
22592 The debugger determines the scripting language based on filename
22593 extension, and evaluates the script using that language. If the
22594 language is not supported, then the evaluation fails.
22596 @item show script-extension
22597 Display the current value of the @code{script-extension} option.
22602 * Sequences:: Canned Sequences of Commands
22603 * Python:: Scripting @value{GDBN} using Python
22604 * Aliases:: Creating new spellings of existing commands
22608 @section Canned Sequences of Commands
22610 Aside from breakpoint commands (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint
22611 Command Lists}), @value{GDBN} provides two ways to store sequences of
22612 commands for execution as a unit: user-defined commands and command
22616 * Define:: How to define your own commands
22617 * Hooks:: Hooks for user-defined commands
22618 * Command Files:: How to write scripts of commands to be stored in a file
22619 * Output:: Commands for controlled output
22623 @subsection User-defined Commands
22625 @cindex user-defined command
22626 @cindex arguments, to user-defined commands
22627 A @dfn{user-defined command} is a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands to
22628 which you assign a new name as a command. This is done with the
22629 @code{define} command. User commands may accept up to 10 arguments
22630 separated by whitespace. Arguments are accessed within the user command
22631 via @code{$arg0@dots{}$arg9}. A trivial example:
22635 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
22640 To execute the command use:
22647 This defines the command @code{adder}, which prints the sum of
22648 its three arguments. Note the arguments are text substitutions, so they may
22649 reference variables, use complex expressions, or even perform inferior
22652 @cindex argument count in user-defined commands
22653 @cindex how many arguments (user-defined commands)
22654 In addition, @code{$argc} may be used to find out how many arguments have
22655 been passed. This expands to a number in the range 0@dots{}10.
22660 print $arg0 + $arg1
22663 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
22671 @item define @var{commandname}
22672 Define a command named @var{commandname}. If there is already a command
22673 by that name, you are asked to confirm that you want to redefine it.
22674 @var{commandname} may be a bare command name consisting of letters,
22675 numbers, dashes, and underscores. It may also start with any predefined
22676 prefix command. For example, @samp{define target my-target} creates
22677 a user-defined @samp{target my-target} command.
22679 The definition of the command is made up of other @value{GDBN} command lines,
22680 which are given following the @code{define} command. The end of these
22681 commands is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
22684 @kindex end@r{ (user-defined commands)}
22685 @item document @var{commandname}
22686 Document the user-defined command @var{commandname}, so that it can be
22687 accessed by @code{help}. The command @var{commandname} must already be
22688 defined. This command reads lines of documentation just as @code{define}
22689 reads the lines of the command definition, ending with @code{end}.
22690 After the @code{document} command is finished, @code{help} on command
22691 @var{commandname} displays the documentation you have written.
22693 You may use the @code{document} command again to change the
22694 documentation of a command. Redefining the command with @code{define}
22695 does not change the documentation.
22697 @kindex dont-repeat
22698 @cindex don't repeat command
22700 Used inside a user-defined command, this tells @value{GDBN} that this
22701 command should not be repeated when the user hits @key{RET}
22702 (@pxref{Command Syntax, repeat last command}).
22704 @kindex help user-defined
22705 @item help user-defined
22706 List all user-defined commands and all python commands defined in class
22707 COMAND_USER. The first line of the documentation or docstring is
22712 @itemx show user @var{commandname}
22713 Display the @value{GDBN} commands used to define @var{commandname} (but
22714 not its documentation). If no @var{commandname} is given, display the
22715 definitions for all user-defined commands.
22716 This does not work for user-defined python commands.
22718 @cindex infinite recursion in user-defined commands
22719 @kindex show max-user-call-depth
22720 @kindex set max-user-call-depth
22721 @item show max-user-call-depth
22722 @itemx set max-user-call-depth
22723 The value of @code{max-user-call-depth} controls how many recursion
22724 levels are allowed in user-defined commands before @value{GDBN} suspects an
22725 infinite recursion and aborts the command.
22726 This does not apply to user-defined python commands.
22729 In addition to the above commands, user-defined commands frequently
22730 use control flow commands, described in @ref{Command Files}.
22732 When user-defined commands are executed, the
22733 commands of the definition are not printed. An error in any command
22734 stops execution of the user-defined command.
22736 If used interactively, commands that would ask for confirmation proceed
22737 without asking when used inside a user-defined command. Many @value{GDBN}
22738 commands that normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the
22739 messages when used in a user-defined command.
22742 @subsection User-defined Command Hooks
22743 @cindex command hooks
22744 @cindex hooks, for commands
22745 @cindex hooks, pre-command
22748 You may define @dfn{hooks}, which are a special kind of user-defined
22749 command. Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined
22750 command @samp{hook-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments)
22751 before that command.
22753 @cindex hooks, post-command
22755 A hook may also be defined which is run after the command you executed.
22756 Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined command
22757 @samp{hookpost-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments) after
22758 that command. Post-execution hooks may exist simultaneously with
22759 pre-execution hooks, for the same command.
22761 It is valid for a hook to call the command which it hooks. If this
22762 occurs, the hook is not re-executed, thereby avoiding infinite recursion.
22764 @c It would be nice if hookpost could be passed a parameter indicating
22765 @c if the command it hooks executed properly or not. FIXME!
22767 @kindex stop@r{, a pseudo-command}
22768 In addition, a pseudo-command, @samp{stop} exists. Defining
22769 (@samp{hook-stop}) makes the associated commands execute every time
22770 execution stops in your program: before breakpoint commands are run,
22771 displays are printed, or the stack frame is printed.
22773 For example, to ignore @code{SIGALRM} signals while
22774 single-stepping, but treat them normally during normal execution,
22779 handle SIGALRM nopass
22783 handle SIGALRM pass
22786 define hook-continue
22787 handle SIGALRM pass
22791 As a further example, to hook at the beginning and end of the @code{echo}
22792 command, and to add extra text to the beginning and end of the message,
22800 define hookpost-echo
22804 (@value{GDBP}) echo Hello World
22805 <<<---Hello World--->>>
22810 You can define a hook for any single-word command in @value{GDBN}, but
22811 not for command aliases; you should define a hook for the basic command
22812 name, e.g.@: @code{backtrace} rather than @code{bt}.
22813 @c FIXME! So how does Joe User discover whether a command is an alias
22815 You can hook a multi-word command by adding @code{hook-} or
22816 @code{hookpost-} to the last word of the command, e.g.@:
22817 @samp{define target hook-remote} to add a hook to @samp{target remote}.
22819 If an error occurs during the execution of your hook, execution of
22820 @value{GDBN} commands stops and @value{GDBN} issues a prompt
22821 (before the command that you actually typed had a chance to run).
22823 If you try to define a hook which does not match any known command, you
22824 get a warning from the @code{define} command.
22826 @node Command Files
22827 @subsection Command Files
22829 @cindex command files
22830 @cindex scripting commands
22831 A command file for @value{GDBN} is a text file made of lines that are
22832 @value{GDBN} commands. Comments (lines starting with @kbd{#}) may
22833 also be included. An empty line in a command file does nothing; it
22834 does not mean to repeat the last command, as it would from the
22837 You can request the execution of a command file with the @code{source}
22838 command. Note that the @code{source} command is also used to evaluate
22839 scripts that are not Command Files. The exact behavior can be configured
22840 using the @code{script-extension} setting.
22841 @xref{Extending GDB,, Extending GDB}.
22845 @cindex execute commands from a file
22846 @item source [-s] [-v] @var{filename}
22847 Execute the command file @var{filename}.
22850 The lines in a command file are generally executed sequentially,
22851 unless the order of execution is changed by one of the
22852 @emph{flow-control commands} described below. The commands are not
22853 printed as they are executed. An error in any command terminates
22854 execution of the command file and control is returned to the console.
22856 @value{GDBN} first searches for @var{filename} in the current directory.
22857 If the file is not found there, and @var{filename} does not specify a
22858 directory, then @value{GDBN} also looks for the file on the source search path
22859 (specified with the @samp{directory} command);
22860 except that @file{$cdir} is not searched because the compilation directory
22861 is not relevant to scripts.
22863 If @code{-s} is specified, then @value{GDBN} searches for @var{filename}
22864 on the search path even if @var{filename} specifies a directory.
22865 The search is done by appending @var{filename} to each element of the
22866 search path. So, for example, if @var{filename} is @file{mylib/myscript}
22867 and the search path contains @file{/home/user} then @value{GDBN} will
22868 look for the script @file{/home/user/mylib/myscript}.
22869 The search is also done if @var{filename} is an absolute path.
22870 For example, if @var{filename} is @file{/tmp/myscript} and
22871 the search path contains @file{/home/user} then @value{GDBN} will
22872 look for the script @file{/home/user/tmp/myscript}.
22873 For DOS-like systems, if @var{filename} contains a drive specification,
22874 it is stripped before concatenation. For example, if @var{filename} is
22875 @file{d:myscript} and the search path contains @file{c:/tmp} then @value{GDBN}
22876 will look for the script @file{c:/tmp/myscript}.
22878 If @code{-v}, for verbose mode, is given then @value{GDBN} displays
22879 each command as it is executed. The option must be given before
22880 @var{filename}, and is interpreted as part of the filename anywhere else.
22882 Commands that would ask for confirmation if used interactively proceed
22883 without asking when used in a command file. Many @value{GDBN} commands that
22884 normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the messages
22885 when called from command files.
22887 @value{GDBN} also accepts command input from standard input. In this
22888 mode, normal output goes to standard output and error output goes to
22889 standard error. Errors in a command file supplied on standard input do
22890 not terminate execution of the command file---execution continues with
22894 gdb < cmds > log 2>&1
22897 (The syntax above will vary depending on the shell used.) This example
22898 will execute commands from the file @file{cmds}. All output and errors
22899 would be directed to @file{log}.
22901 Since commands stored on command files tend to be more general than
22902 commands typed interactively, they frequently need to deal with
22903 complicated situations, such as different or unexpected values of
22904 variables and symbols, changes in how the program being debugged is
22905 built, etc. @value{GDBN} provides a set of flow-control commands to
22906 deal with these complexities. Using these commands, you can write
22907 complex scripts that loop over data structures, execute commands
22908 conditionally, etc.
22915 This command allows to include in your script conditionally executed
22916 commands. The @code{if} command takes a single argument, which is an
22917 expression to evaluate. It is followed by a series of commands that
22918 are executed only if the expression is true (its value is nonzero).
22919 There can then optionally be an @code{else} line, followed by a series
22920 of commands that are only executed if the expression was false. The
22921 end of the list is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
22925 This command allows to write loops. Its syntax is similar to
22926 @code{if}: the command takes a single argument, which is an expression
22927 to evaluate, and must be followed by the commands to execute, one per
22928 line, terminated by an @code{end}. These commands are called the
22929 @dfn{body} of the loop. The commands in the body of @code{while} are
22930 executed repeatedly as long as the expression evaluates to true.
22934 This command exits the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included.
22935 Execution of the script continues after that @code{while}s @code{end}
22938 @kindex loop_continue
22939 @item loop_continue
22940 This command skips the execution of the rest of the body of commands
22941 in the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included. Execution
22942 branches to the beginning of the @code{while} loop, where it evaluates
22943 the controlling expression.
22945 @kindex end@r{ (if/else/while commands)}
22947 Terminate the block of commands that are the body of @code{if},
22948 @code{else}, or @code{while} flow-control commands.
22953 @subsection Commands for Controlled Output
22955 During the execution of a command file or a user-defined command, normal
22956 @value{GDBN} output is suppressed; the only output that appears is what is
22957 explicitly printed by the commands in the definition. This section
22958 describes three commands useful for generating exactly the output you
22963 @item echo @var{text}
22964 @c I do not consider backslash-space a standard C escape sequence
22965 @c because it is not in ANSI.
22966 Print @var{text}. Nonprinting characters can be included in
22967 @var{text} using C escape sequences, such as @samp{\n} to print a
22968 newline. @strong{No newline is printed unless you specify one.}
22969 In addition to the standard C escape sequences, a backslash followed
22970 by a space stands for a space. This is useful for displaying a
22971 string with spaces at the beginning or the end, since leading and
22972 trailing spaces are otherwise trimmed from all arguments.
22973 To print @samp{@w{ }and foo =@w{ }}, use the command
22974 @samp{echo \@w{ }and foo = \@w{ }}.
22976 A backslash at the end of @var{text} can be used, as in C, to continue
22977 the command onto subsequent lines. For example,
22980 echo This is some text\n\
22981 which is continued\n\
22982 onto several lines.\n
22985 produces the same output as
22988 echo This is some text\n
22989 echo which is continued\n
22990 echo onto several lines.\n
22994 @item output @var{expression}
22995 Print the value of @var{expression} and nothing but that value: no
22996 newlines, no @samp{$@var{nn} = }. The value is not entered in the
22997 value history either. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information
23000 @item output/@var{fmt} @var{expression}
23001 Print the value of @var{expression} in format @var{fmt}. You can use
23002 the same formats as for @code{print}. @xref{Output Formats,,Output
23003 Formats}, for more information.
23006 @item printf @var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
23007 Print the values of one or more @var{expressions} under the control of
23008 the string @var{template}. To print several values, make
23009 @var{expressions} be a comma-separated list of individual expressions,
23010 which may be either numbers or pointers. Their values are printed as
23011 specified by @var{template}, exactly as a C program would do by
23012 executing the code below:
23015 printf (@var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{});
23018 As in @code{C} @code{printf}, ordinary characters in @var{template}
23019 are printed verbatim, while @dfn{conversion specification} introduced
23020 by the @samp{%} character cause subsequent @var{expressions} to be
23021 evaluated, their values converted and formatted according to type and
23022 style information encoded in the conversion specifications, and then
23025 For example, you can print two values in hex like this:
23028 printf "foo, bar-foo = 0x%x, 0x%x\n", foo, bar-foo
23031 @code{printf} supports all the standard @code{C} conversion
23032 specifications, including the flags and modifiers between the @samp{%}
23033 character and the conversion letter, with the following exceptions:
23037 The argument-ordering modifiers, such as @samp{2$}, are not supported.
23040 The modifier @samp{*} is not supported for specifying precision or
23044 The @samp{'} flag (for separation of digits into groups according to
23045 @code{LC_NUMERIC'}) is not supported.
23048 The type modifiers @samp{hh}, @samp{j}, @samp{t}, and @samp{z} are not
23052 The conversion letter @samp{n} (as in @samp{%n}) is not supported.
23055 The conversion letters @samp{a} and @samp{A} are not supported.
23059 Note that the @samp{ll} type modifier is supported only if the
23060 underlying @code{C} implementation used to build @value{GDBN} supports
23061 the @code{long long int} type, and the @samp{L} type modifier is
23062 supported only if @code{long double} type is available.
23064 As in @code{C}, @code{printf} supports simple backslash-escape
23065 sequences, such as @code{\n}, @samp{\t}, @samp{\\}, @samp{\"},
23066 @samp{\a}, and @samp{\f}, that consist of backslash followed by a
23067 single character. Octal and hexadecimal escape sequences are not
23070 Additionally, @code{printf} supports conversion specifications for DFP
23071 (@dfn{Decimal Floating Point}) types using the following length modifiers
23072 together with a floating point specifier.
23077 @samp{H} for printing @code{Decimal32} types.
23080 @samp{D} for printing @code{Decimal64} types.
23083 @samp{DD} for printing @code{Decimal128} types.
23086 If the underlying @code{C} implementation used to build @value{GDBN} has
23087 support for the three length modifiers for DFP types, other modifiers
23088 such as width and precision will also be available for @value{GDBN} to use.
23090 In case there is no such @code{C} support, no additional modifiers will be
23091 available and the value will be printed in the standard way.
23093 Here's an example of printing DFP types using the above conversion letters:
23095 printf "D32: %Hf - D64: %Df - D128: %DDf\n",1.2345df,1.2E10dd,1.2E1dl
23099 @item eval @var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
23100 Convert the values of one or more @var{expressions} under the control of
23101 the string @var{template} to a command line, and call it.
23106 @section Scripting @value{GDBN} using Python
23107 @cindex python scripting
23108 @cindex scripting with python
23110 You can script @value{GDBN} using the @uref{http://www.python.org/,
23111 Python programming language}. This feature is available only if
23112 @value{GDBN} was configured using @option{--with-python}.
23114 @cindex python directory
23115 Python scripts used by @value{GDBN} should be installed in
23116 @file{@var{data-directory}/python}, where @var{data-directory} is
23117 the data directory as determined at @value{GDBN} startup (@pxref{Data Files}).
23118 This directory, known as the @dfn{python directory},
23119 is automatically added to the Python Search Path in order to allow
23120 the Python interpreter to locate all scripts installed at this location.
23122 Additionally, @value{GDBN} commands and convenience functions which
23123 are written in Python and are located in the
23124 @file{@var{data-directory}/python/gdb/command} or
23125 @file{@var{data-directory}/python/gdb/function} directories are
23126 automatically imported when @value{GDBN} starts.
23129 * Python Commands:: Accessing Python from @value{GDBN}.
23130 * Python API:: Accessing @value{GDBN} from Python.
23131 * Python Auto-loading:: Automatically loading Python code.
23132 * Python modules:: Python modules provided by @value{GDBN}.
23135 @node Python Commands
23136 @subsection Python Commands
23137 @cindex python commands
23138 @cindex commands to access python
23140 @value{GDBN} provides two commands for accessing the Python interpreter,
23141 and one related setting:
23144 @kindex python-interactive
23146 @item python-interactive @r{[}@var{command}@r{]}
23147 @itemx pi @r{[}@var{command}@r{]}
23148 Without an argument, the @code{python-interactive} command can be used
23149 to start an interactive Python prompt. To return to @value{GDBN},
23150 type the @code{EOF} character (e.g., @kbd{Ctrl-D} on an empty prompt).
23152 Alternatively, a single-line Python command can be given as an
23153 argument and evaluated. If the command is an expression, the result
23154 will be printed; otherwise, nothing will be printed. For example:
23157 (@value{GDBP}) python-interactive 2 + 3
23163 @item python @r{[}@var{command}@r{]}
23164 @itemx py @r{[}@var{command}@r{]}
23165 The @code{python} command can be used to evaluate Python code.
23167 If given an argument, the @code{python} command will evaluate the
23168 argument as a Python command. For example:
23171 (@value{GDBP}) python print 23
23175 If you do not provide an argument to @code{python}, it will act as a
23176 multi-line command, like @code{define}. In this case, the Python
23177 script is made up of subsequent command lines, given after the
23178 @code{python} command. This command list is terminated using a line
23179 containing @code{end}. For example:
23182 (@value{GDBP}) python
23184 End with a line saying just "end".
23190 @kindex set python print-stack
23191 @item set python print-stack
23192 By default, @value{GDBN} will print only the message component of a
23193 Python exception when an error occurs in a Python script. This can be
23194 controlled using @code{set python print-stack}: if @code{full}, then
23195 full Python stack printing is enabled; if @code{none}, then Python stack
23196 and message printing is disabled; if @code{message}, the default, only
23197 the message component of the error is printed.
23200 It is also possible to execute a Python script from the @value{GDBN}
23204 @item source @file{script-name}
23205 The script name must end with @samp{.py} and @value{GDBN} must be configured
23206 to recognize the script language based on filename extension using
23207 the @code{script-extension} setting. @xref{Extending GDB, ,Extending GDB}.
23209 @item python execfile ("script-name")
23210 This method is based on the @code{execfile} Python built-in function,
23211 and thus is always available.
23215 @subsection Python API
23217 @cindex programming in python
23219 You can get quick online help for @value{GDBN}'s Python API by issuing
23220 the command @w{@kbd{python help (gdb)}}.
23222 Functions and methods which have two or more optional arguments allow
23223 them to be specified using keyword syntax. This allows passing some
23224 optional arguments while skipping others. Example:
23225 @w{@code{gdb.some_function ('foo', bar = 1, baz = 2)}}.
23228 * Basic Python:: Basic Python Functions.
23229 * Exception Handling:: How Python exceptions are translated.
23230 * Values From Inferior:: Python representation of values.
23231 * Types In Python:: Python representation of types.
23232 * Pretty Printing API:: Pretty-printing values.
23233 * Selecting Pretty-Printers:: How GDB chooses a pretty-printer.
23234 * Writing a Pretty-Printer:: Writing a Pretty-Printer.
23235 * Type Printing API:: Pretty-printing types.
23236 * Frame Filter API:: Filtering Frames.
23237 * Frame Decorator API:: Decorating Frames.
23238 * Writing a Frame Filter:: Writing a Frame Filter.
23239 * Inferiors In Python:: Python representation of inferiors (processes)
23240 * Events In Python:: Listening for events from @value{GDBN}.
23241 * Threads In Python:: Accessing inferior threads from Python.
23242 * Commands In Python:: Implementing new commands in Python.
23243 * Parameters In Python:: Adding new @value{GDBN} parameters.
23244 * Functions In Python:: Writing new convenience functions.
23245 * Progspaces In Python:: Program spaces.
23246 * Objfiles In Python:: Object files.
23247 * Frames In Python:: Accessing inferior stack frames from Python.
23248 * Blocks In Python:: Accessing blocks from Python.
23249 * Symbols In Python:: Python representation of symbols.
23250 * Symbol Tables In Python:: Python representation of symbol tables.
23251 * Breakpoints In Python:: Manipulating breakpoints using Python.
23252 * Finish Breakpoints in Python:: Setting Breakpoints on function return
23254 * Lazy Strings In Python:: Python representation of lazy strings.
23255 * Architectures In Python:: Python representation of architectures.
23259 @subsubsection Basic Python
23261 @cindex python stdout
23262 @cindex python pagination
23263 At startup, @value{GDBN} overrides Python's @code{sys.stdout} and
23264 @code{sys.stderr} to print using @value{GDBN}'s output-paging streams.
23265 A Python program which outputs to one of these streams may have its
23266 output interrupted by the user (@pxref{Screen Size}). In this
23267 situation, a Python @code{KeyboardInterrupt} exception is thrown.
23269 Some care must be taken when writing Python code to run in
23270 @value{GDBN}. Two things worth noting in particular:
23274 @value{GDBN} install handlers for @code{SIGCHLD} and @code{SIGINT}.
23275 Python code must not override these, or even change the options using
23276 @code{sigaction}. If your program changes the handling of these
23277 signals, @value{GDBN} will most likely stop working correctly. Note
23278 that it is unfortunately common for GUI toolkits to install a
23279 @code{SIGCHLD} handler.
23282 @value{GDBN} takes care to mark its internal file descriptors as
23283 close-on-exec. However, this cannot be done in a thread-safe way on
23284 all platforms. Your Python programs should be aware of this and
23285 should both create new file descriptors with the close-on-exec flag
23286 set and arrange to close unneeded file descriptors before starting a
23290 @cindex python functions
23291 @cindex python module
23293 @value{GDBN} introduces a new Python module, named @code{gdb}. All
23294 methods and classes added by @value{GDBN} are placed in this module.
23295 @value{GDBN} automatically @code{import}s the @code{gdb} module for
23296 use in all scripts evaluated by the @code{python} command.
23298 @findex gdb.PYTHONDIR
23299 @defvar gdb.PYTHONDIR
23300 A string containing the python directory (@pxref{Python}).
23303 @findex gdb.execute
23304 @defun gdb.execute (command @r{[}, from_tty @r{[}, to_string@r{]]})
23305 Evaluate @var{command}, a string, as a @value{GDBN} CLI command.
23306 If a GDB exception happens while @var{command} runs, it is
23307 translated as described in @ref{Exception Handling,,Exception Handling}.
23309 @var{from_tty} specifies whether @value{GDBN} ought to consider this
23310 command as having originated from the user invoking it interactively.
23311 It must be a boolean value. If omitted, it defaults to @code{False}.
23313 By default, any output produced by @var{command} is sent to
23314 @value{GDBN}'s standard output. If the @var{to_string} parameter is
23315 @code{True}, then output will be collected by @code{gdb.execute} and
23316 returned as a string. The default is @code{False}, in which case the
23317 return value is @code{None}. If @var{to_string} is @code{True}, the
23318 @value{GDBN} virtual terminal will be temporarily set to unlimited width
23319 and height, and its pagination will be disabled; @pxref{Screen Size}.
23322 @findex gdb.breakpoints
23323 @defun gdb.breakpoints ()
23324 Return a sequence holding all of @value{GDBN}'s breakpoints.
23325 @xref{Breakpoints In Python}, for more information.
23328 @findex gdb.parameter
23329 @defun gdb.parameter (parameter)
23330 Return the value of a @value{GDBN} parameter. @var{parameter} is a
23331 string naming the parameter to look up; @var{parameter} may contain
23332 spaces if the parameter has a multi-part name. For example,
23333 @samp{print object} is a valid parameter name.
23335 If the named parameter does not exist, this function throws a
23336 @code{gdb.error} (@pxref{Exception Handling}). Otherwise, the
23337 parameter's value is converted to a Python value of the appropriate
23338 type, and returned.
23341 @findex gdb.history
23342 @defun gdb.history (number)
23343 Return a value from @value{GDBN}'s value history (@pxref{Value
23344 History}). @var{number} indicates which history element to return.
23345 If @var{number} is negative, then @value{GDBN} will take its absolute value
23346 and count backward from the last element (i.e., the most recent element) to
23347 find the value to return. If @var{number} is zero, then @value{GDBN} will
23348 return the most recent element. If the element specified by @var{number}
23349 doesn't exist in the value history, a @code{gdb.error} exception will be
23352 If no exception is raised, the return value is always an instance of
23353 @code{gdb.Value} (@pxref{Values From Inferior}).
23356 @findex gdb.parse_and_eval
23357 @defun gdb.parse_and_eval (expression)
23358 Parse @var{expression} as an expression in the current language,
23359 evaluate it, and return the result as a @code{gdb.Value}.
23360 @var{expression} must be a string.
23362 This function can be useful when implementing a new command
23363 (@pxref{Commands In Python}), as it provides a way to parse the
23364 command's argument as an expression. It is also useful simply to
23365 compute values, for example, it is the only way to get the value of a
23366 convenience variable (@pxref{Convenience Vars}) as a @code{gdb.Value}.
23369 @findex gdb.find_pc_line
23370 @defun gdb.find_pc_line (pc)
23371 Return the @code{gdb.Symtab_and_line} object corresponding to the
23372 @var{pc} value. @xref{Symbol Tables In Python}. If an invalid
23373 value of @var{pc} is passed as an argument, then the @code{symtab} and
23374 @code{line} attributes of the returned @code{gdb.Symtab_and_line} object
23375 will be @code{None} and 0 respectively.
23378 @findex gdb.post_event
23379 @defun gdb.post_event (event)
23380 Put @var{event}, a callable object taking no arguments, into
23381 @value{GDBN}'s internal event queue. This callable will be invoked at
23382 some later point, during @value{GDBN}'s event processing. Events
23383 posted using @code{post_event} will be run in the order in which they
23384 were posted; however, there is no way to know when they will be
23385 processed relative to other events inside @value{GDBN}.
23387 @value{GDBN} is not thread-safe. If your Python program uses multiple
23388 threads, you must be careful to only call @value{GDBN}-specific
23389 functions in the main @value{GDBN} thread. @code{post_event} ensures
23393 (@value{GDBP}) python
23397 > def __init__(self, message):
23398 > self.message = message;
23399 > def __call__(self):
23400 > gdb.write(self.message)
23402 >class MyThread1 (threading.Thread):
23404 > gdb.post_event(Writer("Hello "))
23406 >class MyThread2 (threading.Thread):
23408 > gdb.post_event(Writer("World\n"))
23410 >MyThread1().start()
23411 >MyThread2().start()
23413 (@value{GDBP}) Hello World
23418 @defun gdb.write (string @r{[}, stream{]})
23419 Print a string to @value{GDBN}'s paginated output stream. The
23420 optional @var{stream} determines the stream to print to. The default
23421 stream is @value{GDBN}'s standard output stream. Possible stream
23428 @value{GDBN}'s standard output stream.
23433 @value{GDBN}'s standard error stream.
23438 @value{GDBN}'s log stream (@pxref{Logging Output}).
23441 Writing to @code{sys.stdout} or @code{sys.stderr} will automatically
23442 call this function and will automatically direct the output to the
23447 @defun gdb.flush ()
23448 Flush the buffer of a @value{GDBN} paginated stream so that the
23449 contents are displayed immediately. @value{GDBN} will flush the
23450 contents of a stream automatically when it encounters a newline in the
23451 buffer. The optional @var{stream} determines the stream to flush. The
23452 default stream is @value{GDBN}'s standard output stream. Possible
23459 @value{GDBN}'s standard output stream.
23464 @value{GDBN}'s standard error stream.
23469 @value{GDBN}'s log stream (@pxref{Logging Output}).
23473 Flushing @code{sys.stdout} or @code{sys.stderr} will automatically
23474 call this function for the relevant stream.
23477 @findex gdb.target_charset
23478 @defun gdb.target_charset ()
23479 Return the name of the current target character set (@pxref{Character
23480 Sets}). This differs from @code{gdb.parameter('target-charset')} in
23481 that @samp{auto} is never returned.
23484 @findex gdb.target_wide_charset
23485 @defun gdb.target_wide_charset ()
23486 Return the name of the current target wide character set
23487 (@pxref{Character Sets}). This differs from
23488 @code{gdb.parameter('target-wide-charset')} in that @samp{auto} is
23492 @findex gdb.solib_name
23493 @defun gdb.solib_name (address)
23494 Return the name of the shared library holding the given @var{address}
23495 as a string, or @code{None}.
23498 @findex gdb.decode_line
23499 @defun gdb.decode_line @r{[}expression@r{]}
23500 Return locations of the line specified by @var{expression}, or of the
23501 current line if no argument was given. This function returns a Python
23502 tuple containing two elements. The first element contains a string
23503 holding any unparsed section of @var{expression} (or @code{None} if
23504 the expression has been fully parsed). The second element contains
23505 either @code{None} or another tuple that contains all the locations
23506 that match the expression represented as @code{gdb.Symtab_and_line}
23507 objects (@pxref{Symbol Tables In Python}). If @var{expression} is
23508 provided, it is decoded the way that @value{GDBN}'s inbuilt
23509 @code{break} or @code{edit} commands do (@pxref{Specify Location}).
23512 @defun gdb.prompt_hook (current_prompt)
23513 @anchor{prompt_hook}
23515 If @var{prompt_hook} is callable, @value{GDBN} will call the method
23516 assigned to this operation before a prompt is displayed by
23519 The parameter @code{current_prompt} contains the current @value{GDBN}
23520 prompt. This method must return a Python string, or @code{None}. If
23521 a string is returned, the @value{GDBN} prompt will be set to that
23522 string. If @code{None} is returned, @value{GDBN} will continue to use
23523 the current prompt.
23525 Some prompts cannot be substituted in @value{GDBN}. Secondary prompts
23526 such as those used by readline for command input, and annotation
23527 related prompts are prohibited from being changed.
23530 @node Exception Handling
23531 @subsubsection Exception Handling
23532 @cindex python exceptions
23533 @cindex exceptions, python
23535 When executing the @code{python} command, Python exceptions
23536 uncaught within the Python code are translated to calls to
23537 @value{GDBN} error-reporting mechanism. If the command that called
23538 @code{python} does not handle the error, @value{GDBN} will
23539 terminate it and print an error message containing the Python
23540 exception name, the associated value, and the Python call stack
23541 backtrace at the point where the exception was raised. Example:
23544 (@value{GDBP}) python print foo
23545 Traceback (most recent call last):
23546 File "<string>", line 1, in <module>
23547 NameError: name 'foo' is not defined
23550 @value{GDBN} errors that happen in @value{GDBN} commands invoked by
23551 Python code are converted to Python exceptions. The type of the
23552 Python exception depends on the error.
23556 This is the base class for most exceptions generated by @value{GDBN}.
23557 It is derived from @code{RuntimeError}, for compatibility with earlier
23558 versions of @value{GDBN}.
23560 If an error occurring in @value{GDBN} does not fit into some more
23561 specific category, then the generated exception will have this type.
23563 @item gdb.MemoryError
23564 This is a subclass of @code{gdb.error} which is thrown when an
23565 operation tried to access invalid memory in the inferior.
23567 @item KeyboardInterrupt
23568 User interrupt (via @kbd{C-c} or by typing @kbd{q} at a pagination
23569 prompt) is translated to a Python @code{KeyboardInterrupt} exception.
23572 In all cases, your exception handler will see the @value{GDBN} error
23573 message as its value and the Python call stack backtrace at the Python
23574 statement closest to where the @value{GDBN} error occured as the
23577 @findex gdb.GdbError
23578 When implementing @value{GDBN} commands in Python via @code{gdb.Command},
23579 it is useful to be able to throw an exception that doesn't cause a
23580 traceback to be printed. For example, the user may have invoked the
23581 command incorrectly. Use the @code{gdb.GdbError} exception
23582 to handle this case. Example:
23586 >class HelloWorld (gdb.Command):
23587 > """Greet the whole world."""
23588 > def __init__ (self):
23589 > super (HelloWorld, self).__init__ ("hello-world", gdb.COMMAND_USER)
23590 > def invoke (self, args, from_tty):
23591 > argv = gdb.string_to_argv (args)
23592 > if len (argv) != 0:
23593 > raise gdb.GdbError ("hello-world takes no arguments")
23594 > print "Hello, World!"
23597 (gdb) hello-world 42
23598 hello-world takes no arguments
23601 @node Values From Inferior
23602 @subsubsection Values From Inferior
23603 @cindex values from inferior, with Python
23604 @cindex python, working with values from inferior
23606 @cindex @code{gdb.Value}
23607 @value{GDBN} provides values it obtains from the inferior program in
23608 an object of type @code{gdb.Value}. @value{GDBN} uses this object
23609 for its internal bookkeeping of the inferior's values, and for
23610 fetching values when necessary.
23612 Inferior values that are simple scalars can be used directly in
23613 Python expressions that are valid for the value's data type. Here's
23614 an example for an integer or floating-point value @code{some_val}:
23621 As result of this, @code{bar} will also be a @code{gdb.Value} object
23622 whose values are of the same type as those of @code{some_val}.
23624 Inferior values that are structures or instances of some class can
23625 be accessed using the Python @dfn{dictionary syntax}. For example, if
23626 @code{some_val} is a @code{gdb.Value} instance holding a structure, you
23627 can access its @code{foo} element with:
23630 bar = some_val['foo']
23633 Again, @code{bar} will also be a @code{gdb.Value} object.
23635 A @code{gdb.Value} that represents a function can be executed via
23636 inferior function call. Any arguments provided to the call must match
23637 the function's prototype, and must be provided in the order specified
23640 For example, @code{some_val} is a @code{gdb.Value} instance
23641 representing a function that takes two integers as arguments. To
23642 execute this function, call it like so:
23645 result = some_val (10,20)
23648 Any values returned from a function call will be stored as a
23651 The following attributes are provided:
23653 @defvar Value.address
23654 If this object is addressable, this read-only attribute holds a
23655 @code{gdb.Value} object representing the address. Otherwise,
23656 this attribute holds @code{None}.
23659 @cindex optimized out value in Python
23660 @defvar Value.is_optimized_out
23661 This read-only boolean attribute is true if the compiler optimized out
23662 this value, thus it is not available for fetching from the inferior.
23666 The type of this @code{gdb.Value}. The value of this attribute is a
23667 @code{gdb.Type} object (@pxref{Types In Python}).
23670 @defvar Value.dynamic_type
23671 The dynamic type of this @code{gdb.Value}. This uses C@t{++} run-time
23672 type information (@acronym{RTTI}) to determine the dynamic type of the
23673 value. If this value is of class type, it will return the class in
23674 which the value is embedded, if any. If this value is of pointer or
23675 reference to a class type, it will compute the dynamic type of the
23676 referenced object, and return a pointer or reference to that type,
23677 respectively. In all other cases, it will return the value's static
23680 Note that this feature will only work when debugging a C@t{++} program
23681 that includes @acronym{RTTI} for the object in question. Otherwise,
23682 it will just return the static type of the value as in @kbd{ptype foo}
23683 (@pxref{Symbols, ptype}).
23686 @defvar Value.is_lazy
23687 The value of this read-only boolean attribute is @code{True} if this
23688 @code{gdb.Value} has not yet been fetched from the inferior.
23689 @value{GDBN} does not fetch values until necessary, for efficiency.
23693 myval = gdb.parse_and_eval ('somevar')
23696 The value of @code{somevar} is not fetched at this time. It will be
23697 fetched when the value is needed, or when the @code{fetch_lazy}
23701 The following methods are provided:
23703 @defun Value.__init__ (@var{val})
23704 Many Python values can be converted directly to a @code{gdb.Value} via
23705 this object initializer. Specifically:
23708 @item Python boolean
23709 A Python boolean is converted to the boolean type from the current
23712 @item Python integer
23713 A Python integer is converted to the C @code{long} type for the
23714 current architecture.
23717 A Python long is converted to the C @code{long long} type for the
23718 current architecture.
23721 A Python float is converted to the C @code{double} type for the
23722 current architecture.
23724 @item Python string
23725 A Python string is converted to a target string, using the current
23728 @item @code{gdb.Value}
23729 If @code{val} is a @code{gdb.Value}, then a copy of the value is made.
23731 @item @code{gdb.LazyString}
23732 If @code{val} is a @code{gdb.LazyString} (@pxref{Lazy Strings In
23733 Python}), then the lazy string's @code{value} method is called, and
23734 its result is used.
23738 @defun Value.cast (type)
23739 Return a new instance of @code{gdb.Value} that is the result of
23740 casting this instance to the type described by @var{type}, which must
23741 be a @code{gdb.Type} object. If the cast cannot be performed for some
23742 reason, this method throws an exception.
23745 @defun Value.dereference ()
23746 For pointer data types, this method returns a new @code{gdb.Value} object
23747 whose contents is the object pointed to by the pointer. For example, if
23748 @code{foo} is a C pointer to an @code{int}, declared in your C program as
23755 then you can use the corresponding @code{gdb.Value} to access what
23756 @code{foo} points to like this:
23759 bar = foo.dereference ()
23762 The result @code{bar} will be a @code{gdb.Value} object holding the
23763 value pointed to by @code{foo}.
23765 A similar function @code{Value.referenced_value} exists which also
23766 returns @code{gdb.Value} objects corresonding to the values pointed to
23767 by pointer values (and additionally, values referenced by reference
23768 values). However, the behavior of @code{Value.dereference}
23769 differs from @code{Value.referenced_value} by the fact that the
23770 behavior of @code{Value.dereference} is identical to applying the C
23771 unary operator @code{*} on a given value. For example, consider a
23772 reference to a pointer @code{ptrref}, declared in your C@t{++} program
23776 typedef int *intptr;
23780 intptr &ptrref = ptr;
23783 Though @code{ptrref} is a reference value, one can apply the method
23784 @code{Value.dereference} to the @code{gdb.Value} object corresponding
23785 to it and obtain a @code{gdb.Value} which is identical to that
23786 corresponding to @code{val}. However, if you apply the method
23787 @code{Value.referenced_value}, the result would be a @code{gdb.Value}
23788 object identical to that corresponding to @code{ptr}.
23791 py_ptrref = gdb.parse_and_eval ("ptrref")
23792 py_val = py_ptrref.dereference ()
23793 py_ptr = py_ptrref.referenced_value ()
23796 The @code{gdb.Value} object @code{py_val} is identical to that
23797 corresponding to @code{val}, and @code{py_ptr} is identical to that
23798 corresponding to @code{ptr}. In general, @code{Value.dereference} can
23799 be applied whenever the C unary operator @code{*} can be applied
23800 to the corresponding C value. For those cases where applying both
23801 @code{Value.dereference} and @code{Value.referenced_value} is allowed,
23802 the results obtained need not be identical (as we have seen in the above
23803 example). The results are however identical when applied on
23804 @code{gdb.Value} objects corresponding to pointers (@code{gdb.Value}
23805 objects with type code @code{TYPE_CODE_PTR}) in a C/C@t{++} program.
23808 @defun Value.referenced_value ()
23809 For pointer or reference data types, this method returns a new
23810 @code{gdb.Value} object corresponding to the value referenced by the
23811 pointer/reference value. For pointer data types,
23812 @code{Value.dereference} and @code{Value.referenced_value} produce
23813 identical results. The difference between these methods is that
23814 @code{Value.dereference} cannot get the values referenced by reference
23815 values. For example, consider a reference to an @code{int}, declared
23816 in your C@t{++} program as
23824 then applying @code{Value.dereference} to the @code{gdb.Value} object
23825 corresponding to @code{ref} will result in an error, while applying
23826 @code{Value.referenced_value} will result in a @code{gdb.Value} object
23827 identical to that corresponding to @code{val}.
23830 py_ref = gdb.parse_and_eval ("ref")
23831 er_ref = py_ref.dereference () # Results in error
23832 py_val = py_ref.referenced_value () # Returns the referenced value
23835 The @code{gdb.Value} object @code{py_val} is identical to that
23836 corresponding to @code{val}.
23839 @defun Value.dynamic_cast (type)
23840 Like @code{Value.cast}, but works as if the C@t{++} @code{dynamic_cast}
23841 operator were used. Consult a C@t{++} reference for details.
23844 @defun Value.reinterpret_cast (type)
23845 Like @code{Value.cast}, but works as if the C@t{++} @code{reinterpret_cast}
23846 operator were used. Consult a C@t{++} reference for details.
23849 @defun Value.string (@r{[}encoding@r{[}, errors@r{[}, length@r{]]]})
23850 If this @code{gdb.Value} represents a string, then this method
23851 converts the contents to a Python string. Otherwise, this method will
23852 throw an exception.
23854 Strings are recognized in a language-specific way; whether a given
23855 @code{gdb.Value} represents a string is determined by the current
23858 For C-like languages, a value is a string if it is a pointer to or an
23859 array of characters or ints. The string is assumed to be terminated
23860 by a zero of the appropriate width. However if the optional length
23861 argument is given, the string will be converted to that given length,
23862 ignoring any embedded zeros that the string may contain.
23864 If the optional @var{encoding} argument is given, it must be a string
23865 naming the encoding of the string in the @code{gdb.Value}, such as
23866 @code{"ascii"}, @code{"iso-8859-6"} or @code{"utf-8"}. It accepts
23867 the same encodings as the corresponding argument to Python's
23868 @code{string.decode} method, and the Python codec machinery will be used
23869 to convert the string. If @var{encoding} is not given, or if
23870 @var{encoding} is the empty string, then either the @code{target-charset}
23871 (@pxref{Character Sets}) will be used, or a language-specific encoding
23872 will be used, if the current language is able to supply one.
23874 The optional @var{errors} argument is the same as the corresponding
23875 argument to Python's @code{string.decode} method.
23877 If the optional @var{length} argument is given, the string will be
23878 fetched and converted to the given length.
23881 @defun Value.lazy_string (@r{[}encoding @r{[}, length@r{]]})
23882 If this @code{gdb.Value} represents a string, then this method
23883 converts the contents to a @code{gdb.LazyString} (@pxref{Lazy Strings
23884 In Python}). Otherwise, this method will throw an exception.
23886 If the optional @var{encoding} argument is given, it must be a string
23887 naming the encoding of the @code{gdb.LazyString}. Some examples are:
23888 @samp{ascii}, @samp{iso-8859-6} or @samp{utf-8}. If the
23889 @var{encoding} argument is an encoding that @value{GDBN} does
23890 recognize, @value{GDBN} will raise an error.
23892 When a lazy string is printed, the @value{GDBN} encoding machinery is
23893 used to convert the string during printing. If the optional
23894 @var{encoding} argument is not provided, or is an empty string,
23895 @value{GDBN} will automatically select the encoding most suitable for
23896 the string type. For further information on encoding in @value{GDBN}
23897 please see @ref{Character Sets}.
23899 If the optional @var{length} argument is given, the string will be
23900 fetched and encoded to the length of characters specified. If
23901 the @var{length} argument is not provided, the string will be fetched
23902 and encoded until a null of appropriate width is found.
23905 @defun Value.fetch_lazy ()
23906 If the @code{gdb.Value} object is currently a lazy value
23907 (@code{gdb.Value.is_lazy} is @code{True}), then the value is
23908 fetched from the inferior. Any errors that occur in the process
23909 will produce a Python exception.
23911 If the @code{gdb.Value} object is not a lazy value, this method
23914 This method does not return a value.
23918 @node Types In Python
23919 @subsubsection Types In Python
23920 @cindex types in Python
23921 @cindex Python, working with types
23924 @value{GDBN} represents types from the inferior using the class
23927 The following type-related functions are available in the @code{gdb}
23930 @findex gdb.lookup_type
23931 @defun gdb.lookup_type (name @r{[}, block@r{]})
23932 This function looks up a type by name. @var{name} is the name of the
23933 type to look up. It must be a string.
23935 If @var{block} is given, then @var{name} is looked up in that scope.
23936 Otherwise, it is searched for globally.
23938 Ordinarily, this function will return an instance of @code{gdb.Type}.
23939 If the named type cannot be found, it will throw an exception.
23942 If the type is a structure or class type, or an enum type, the fields
23943 of that type can be accessed using the Python @dfn{dictionary syntax}.
23944 For example, if @code{some_type} is a @code{gdb.Type} instance holding
23945 a structure type, you can access its @code{foo} field with:
23948 bar = some_type['foo']
23951 @code{bar} will be a @code{gdb.Field} object; see below under the
23952 description of the @code{Type.fields} method for a description of the
23953 @code{gdb.Field} class.
23955 An instance of @code{Type} has the following attributes:
23958 The type code for this type. The type code will be one of the
23959 @code{TYPE_CODE_} constants defined below.
23962 @defvar Type.sizeof
23963 The size of this type, in target @code{char} units. Usually, a
23964 target's @code{char} type will be an 8-bit byte. However, on some
23965 unusual platforms, this type may have a different size.
23969 The tag name for this type. The tag name is the name after
23970 @code{struct}, @code{union}, or @code{enum} in C and C@t{++}; not all
23971 languages have this concept. If this type has no tag name, then
23972 @code{None} is returned.
23975 The following methods are provided:
23977 @defun Type.fields ()
23978 For structure and union types, this method returns the fields. Range
23979 types have two fields, the minimum and maximum values. Enum types
23980 have one field per enum constant. Function and method types have one
23981 field per parameter. The base types of C@t{++} classes are also
23982 represented as fields. If the type has no fields, or does not fit
23983 into one of these categories, an empty sequence will be returned.
23985 Each field is a @code{gdb.Field} object, with some pre-defined attributes:
23988 This attribute is not available for @code{static} fields (as in
23989 C@t{++} or Java). For non-@code{static} fields, the value is the bit
23990 position of the field. For @code{enum} fields, the value is the
23991 enumeration member's integer representation.
23994 The name of the field, or @code{None} for anonymous fields.
23997 This is @code{True} if the field is artificial, usually meaning that
23998 it was provided by the compiler and not the user. This attribute is
23999 always provided, and is @code{False} if the field is not artificial.
24001 @item is_base_class
24002 This is @code{True} if the field represents a base class of a C@t{++}
24003 structure. This attribute is always provided, and is @code{False}
24004 if the field is not a base class of the type that is the argument of
24005 @code{fields}, or if that type was not a C@t{++} class.
24008 If the field is packed, or is a bitfield, then this will have a
24009 non-zero value, which is the size of the field in bits. Otherwise,
24010 this will be zero; in this case the field's size is given by its type.
24013 The type of the field. This is usually an instance of @code{Type},
24014 but it can be @code{None} in some situations.
24018 @defun Type.array (@var{n1} @r{[}, @var{n2}@r{]})
24019 Return a new @code{gdb.Type} object which represents an array of this
24020 type. If one argument is given, it is the inclusive upper bound of
24021 the array; in this case the lower bound is zero. If two arguments are
24022 given, the first argument is the lower bound of the array, and the
24023 second argument is the upper bound of the array. An array's length
24024 must not be negative, but the bounds can be.
24027 @defun Type.vector (@var{n1} @r{[}, @var{n2}@r{]})
24028 Return a new @code{gdb.Type} object which represents a vector of this
24029 type. If one argument is given, it is the inclusive upper bound of
24030 the vector; in this case the lower bound is zero. If two arguments are
24031 given, the first argument is the lower bound of the vector, and the
24032 second argument is the upper bound of the vector. A vector's length
24033 must not be negative, but the bounds can be.
24035 The difference between an @code{array} and a @code{vector} is that
24036 arrays behave like in C: when used in expressions they decay to a pointer
24037 to the first element whereas vectors are treated as first class values.
24040 @defun Type.const ()
24041 Return a new @code{gdb.Type} object which represents a
24042 @code{const}-qualified variant of this type.
24045 @defun Type.volatile ()
24046 Return a new @code{gdb.Type} object which represents a
24047 @code{volatile}-qualified variant of this type.
24050 @defun Type.unqualified ()
24051 Return a new @code{gdb.Type} object which represents an unqualified
24052 variant of this type. That is, the result is neither @code{const} nor
24056 @defun Type.range ()
24057 Return a Python @code{Tuple} object that contains two elements: the
24058 low bound of the argument type and the high bound of that type. If
24059 the type does not have a range, @value{GDBN} will raise a
24060 @code{gdb.error} exception (@pxref{Exception Handling}).
24063 @defun Type.reference ()
24064 Return a new @code{gdb.Type} object which represents a reference to this
24068 @defun Type.pointer ()
24069 Return a new @code{gdb.Type} object which represents a pointer to this
24073 @defun Type.strip_typedefs ()
24074 Return a new @code{gdb.Type} that represents the real type,
24075 after removing all layers of typedefs.
24078 @defun Type.target ()
24079 Return a new @code{gdb.Type} object which represents the target type
24082 For a pointer type, the target type is the type of the pointed-to
24083 object. For an array type (meaning C-like arrays), the target type is
24084 the type of the elements of the array. For a function or method type,
24085 the target type is the type of the return value. For a complex type,
24086 the target type is the type of the elements. For a typedef, the
24087 target type is the aliased type.
24089 If the type does not have a target, this method will throw an
24093 @defun Type.template_argument (n @r{[}, block@r{]})
24094 If this @code{gdb.Type} is an instantiation of a template, this will
24095 return a new @code{gdb.Type} which represents the type of the
24096 @var{n}th template argument.
24098 If this @code{gdb.Type} is not a template type, this will throw an
24099 exception. Ordinarily, only C@t{++} code will have template types.
24101 If @var{block} is given, then @var{name} is looked up in that scope.
24102 Otherwise, it is searched for globally.
24106 Each type has a code, which indicates what category this type falls
24107 into. The available type categories are represented by constants
24108 defined in the @code{gdb} module:
24111 @findex TYPE_CODE_PTR
24112 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_PTR
24113 @item gdb.TYPE_CODE_PTR
24114 The type is a pointer.
24116 @findex TYPE_CODE_ARRAY
24117 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_ARRAY
24118 @item gdb.TYPE_CODE_ARRAY
24119 The type is an array.
24121 @findex TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
24122 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
24123 @item gdb.TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
24124 The type is a structure.
24126 @findex TYPE_CODE_UNION
24127 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_UNION
24128 @item gdb.TYPE_CODE_UNION
24129 The type is a union.
24131 @findex TYPE_CODE_ENUM
24132 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_ENUM
24133 @item gdb.TYPE_CODE_ENUM
24134 The type is an enum.
24136 @findex TYPE_CODE_FLAGS
24137 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_FLAGS
24138 @item gdb.TYPE_CODE_FLAGS
24139 A bit flags type, used for things such as status registers.
24141 @findex TYPE_CODE_FUNC
24142 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_FUNC
24143 @item gdb.TYPE_CODE_FUNC
24144 The type is a function.
24146 @findex TYPE_CODE_INT
24147 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_INT
24148 @item gdb.TYPE_CODE_INT
24149 The type is an integer type.
24151 @findex TYPE_CODE_FLT
24152 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_FLT
24153 @item gdb.TYPE_CODE_FLT
24154 A floating point type.
24156 @findex TYPE_CODE_VOID
24157 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_VOID
24158 @item gdb.TYPE_CODE_VOID
24159 The special type @code{void}.
24161 @findex TYPE_CODE_SET
24162 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_SET
24163 @item gdb.TYPE_CODE_SET
24166 @findex TYPE_CODE_RANGE
24167 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_RANGE
24168 @item gdb.TYPE_CODE_RANGE
24169 A range type, that is, an integer type with bounds.
24171 @findex TYPE_CODE_STRING
24172 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_STRING
24173 @item gdb.TYPE_CODE_STRING
24174 A string type. Note that this is only used for certain languages with
24175 language-defined string types; C strings are not represented this way.
24177 @findex TYPE_CODE_BITSTRING
24178 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_BITSTRING
24179 @item gdb.TYPE_CODE_BITSTRING
24180 A string of bits. It is deprecated.
24182 @findex TYPE_CODE_ERROR
24183 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_ERROR
24184 @item gdb.TYPE_CODE_ERROR
24185 An unknown or erroneous type.
24187 @findex TYPE_CODE_METHOD
24188 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_METHOD
24189 @item gdb.TYPE_CODE_METHOD
24190 A method type, as found in C@t{++} or Java.
24192 @findex TYPE_CODE_METHODPTR
24193 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_METHODPTR
24194 @item gdb.TYPE_CODE_METHODPTR
24195 A pointer-to-member-function.
24197 @findex TYPE_CODE_MEMBERPTR
24198 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_MEMBERPTR
24199 @item gdb.TYPE_CODE_MEMBERPTR
24200 A pointer-to-member.
24202 @findex TYPE_CODE_REF
24203 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_REF
24204 @item gdb.TYPE_CODE_REF
24207 @findex TYPE_CODE_CHAR
24208 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_CHAR
24209 @item gdb.TYPE_CODE_CHAR
24212 @findex TYPE_CODE_BOOL
24213 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_BOOL
24214 @item gdb.TYPE_CODE_BOOL
24217 @findex TYPE_CODE_COMPLEX
24218 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_COMPLEX
24219 @item gdb.TYPE_CODE_COMPLEX
24220 A complex float type.
24222 @findex TYPE_CODE_TYPEDEF
24223 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_TYPEDEF
24224 @item gdb.TYPE_CODE_TYPEDEF
24225 A typedef to some other type.
24227 @findex TYPE_CODE_NAMESPACE
24228 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_NAMESPACE
24229 @item gdb.TYPE_CODE_NAMESPACE
24230 A C@t{++} namespace.
24232 @findex TYPE_CODE_DECFLOAT
24233 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_DECFLOAT
24234 @item gdb.TYPE_CODE_DECFLOAT
24235 A decimal floating point type.
24237 @findex TYPE_CODE_INTERNAL_FUNCTION
24238 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_INTERNAL_FUNCTION
24239 @item gdb.TYPE_CODE_INTERNAL_FUNCTION
24240 A function internal to @value{GDBN}. This is the type used to represent
24241 convenience functions.
24244 Further support for types is provided in the @code{gdb.types}
24245 Python module (@pxref{gdb.types}).
24247 @node Pretty Printing API
24248 @subsubsection Pretty Printing API
24250 An example output is provided (@pxref{Pretty Printing}).
24252 A pretty-printer is just an object that holds a value and implements a
24253 specific interface, defined here.
24255 @defun pretty_printer.children (self)
24256 @value{GDBN} will call this method on a pretty-printer to compute the
24257 children of the pretty-printer's value.
24259 This method must return an object conforming to the Python iterator
24260 protocol. Each item returned by the iterator must be a tuple holding
24261 two elements. The first element is the ``name'' of the child; the
24262 second element is the child's value. The value can be any Python
24263 object which is convertible to a @value{GDBN} value.
24265 This method is optional. If it does not exist, @value{GDBN} will act
24266 as though the value has no children.
24269 @defun pretty_printer.display_hint (self)
24270 The CLI may call this method and use its result to change the
24271 formatting of a value. The result will also be supplied to an MI
24272 consumer as a @samp{displayhint} attribute of the variable being
24275 This method is optional. If it does exist, this method must return a
24278 Some display hints are predefined by @value{GDBN}:
24282 Indicate that the object being printed is ``array-like''. The CLI
24283 uses this to respect parameters such as @code{set print elements} and
24284 @code{set print array}.
24287 Indicate that the object being printed is ``map-like'', and that the
24288 children of this value can be assumed to alternate between keys and
24292 Indicate that the object being printed is ``string-like''. If the
24293 printer's @code{to_string} method returns a Python string of some
24294 kind, then @value{GDBN} will call its internal language-specific
24295 string-printing function to format the string. For the CLI this means
24296 adding quotation marks, possibly escaping some characters, respecting
24297 @code{set print elements}, and the like.
24301 @defun pretty_printer.to_string (self)
24302 @value{GDBN} will call this method to display the string
24303 representation of the value passed to the object's constructor.
24305 When printing from the CLI, if the @code{to_string} method exists,
24306 then @value{GDBN} will prepend its result to the values returned by
24307 @code{children}. Exactly how this formatting is done is dependent on
24308 the display hint, and may change as more hints are added. Also,
24309 depending on the print settings (@pxref{Print Settings}), the CLI may
24310 print just the result of @code{to_string} in a stack trace, omitting
24311 the result of @code{children}.
24313 If this method returns a string, it is printed verbatim.
24315 Otherwise, if this method returns an instance of @code{gdb.Value},
24316 then @value{GDBN} prints this value. This may result in a call to
24317 another pretty-printer.
24319 If instead the method returns a Python value which is convertible to a
24320 @code{gdb.Value}, then @value{GDBN} performs the conversion and prints
24321 the resulting value. Again, this may result in a call to another
24322 pretty-printer. Python scalars (integers, floats, and booleans) and
24323 strings are convertible to @code{gdb.Value}; other types are not.
24325 Finally, if this method returns @code{None} then no further operations
24326 are peformed in this method and nothing is printed.
24328 If the result is not one of these types, an exception is raised.
24331 @value{GDBN} provides a function which can be used to look up the
24332 default pretty-printer for a @code{gdb.Value}:
24334 @findex gdb.default_visualizer
24335 @defun gdb.default_visualizer (value)
24336 This function takes a @code{gdb.Value} object as an argument. If a
24337 pretty-printer for this value exists, then it is returned. If no such
24338 printer exists, then this returns @code{None}.
24341 @node Selecting Pretty-Printers
24342 @subsubsection Selecting Pretty-Printers
24344 The Python list @code{gdb.pretty_printers} contains an array of
24345 functions or callable objects that have been registered via addition
24346 as a pretty-printer. Printers in this list are called @code{global}
24347 printers, they're available when debugging all inferiors.
24348 Each @code{gdb.Progspace} contains a @code{pretty_printers} attribute.
24349 Each @code{gdb.Objfile} also contains a @code{pretty_printers}
24352 Each function on these lists is passed a single @code{gdb.Value}
24353 argument and should return a pretty-printer object conforming to the
24354 interface definition above (@pxref{Pretty Printing API}). If a function
24355 cannot create a pretty-printer for the value, it should return
24358 @value{GDBN} first checks the @code{pretty_printers} attribute of each
24359 @code{gdb.Objfile} in the current program space and iteratively calls
24360 each enabled lookup routine in the list for that @code{gdb.Objfile}
24361 until it receives a pretty-printer object.
24362 If no pretty-printer is found in the objfile lists, @value{GDBN} then
24363 searches the pretty-printer list of the current program space,
24364 calling each enabled function until an object is returned.
24365 After these lists have been exhausted, it tries the global
24366 @code{gdb.pretty_printers} list, again calling each enabled function until an
24367 object is returned.
24369 The order in which the objfiles are searched is not specified. For a
24370 given list, functions are always invoked from the head of the list,
24371 and iterated over sequentially until the end of the list, or a printer
24372 object is returned.
24374 For various reasons a pretty-printer may not work.
24375 For example, the underlying data structure may have changed and
24376 the pretty-printer is out of date.
24378 The consequences of a broken pretty-printer are severe enough that
24379 @value{GDBN} provides support for enabling and disabling individual
24380 printers. For example, if @code{print frame-arguments} is on,
24381 a backtrace can become highly illegible if any argument is printed
24382 with a broken printer.
24384 Pretty-printers are enabled and disabled by attaching an @code{enabled}
24385 attribute to the registered function or callable object. If this attribute
24386 is present and its value is @code{False}, the printer is disabled, otherwise
24387 the printer is enabled.
24389 @node Writing a Pretty-Printer
24390 @subsubsection Writing a Pretty-Printer
24391 @cindex writing a pretty-printer
24393 A pretty-printer consists of two parts: a lookup function to detect
24394 if the type is supported, and the printer itself.
24396 Here is an example showing how a @code{std::string} printer might be
24397 written. @xref{Pretty Printing API}, for details on the API this class
24401 class StdStringPrinter(object):
24402 "Print a std::string"
24404 def __init__(self, val):
24407 def to_string(self):
24408 return self.val['_M_dataplus']['_M_p']
24410 def display_hint(self):
24414 And here is an example showing how a lookup function for the printer
24415 example above might be written.
24418 def str_lookup_function(val):
24419 lookup_tag = val.type.tag
24420 if lookup_tag == None:
24422 regex = re.compile("^std::basic_string<char,.*>$")
24423 if regex.match(lookup_tag):
24424 return StdStringPrinter(val)
24428 The example lookup function extracts the value's type, and attempts to
24429 match it to a type that it can pretty-print. If it is a type the
24430 printer can pretty-print, it will return a printer object. If not, it
24431 returns @code{None}.
24433 We recommend that you put your core pretty-printers into a Python
24434 package. If your pretty-printers are for use with a library, we
24435 further recommend embedding a version number into the package name.
24436 This practice will enable @value{GDBN} to load multiple versions of
24437 your pretty-printers at the same time, because they will have
24440 You should write auto-loaded code (@pxref{Python Auto-loading}) such that it
24441 can be evaluated multiple times without changing its meaning. An
24442 ideal auto-load file will consist solely of @code{import}s of your
24443 printer modules, followed by a call to a register pretty-printers with
24444 the current objfile.
24446 Taken as a whole, this approach will scale nicely to multiple
24447 inferiors, each potentially using a different library version.
24448 Embedding a version number in the Python package name will ensure that
24449 @value{GDBN} is able to load both sets of printers simultaneously.
24450 Then, because the search for pretty-printers is done by objfile, and
24451 because your auto-loaded code took care to register your library's
24452 printers with a specific objfile, @value{GDBN} will find the correct
24453 printers for the specific version of the library used by each
24456 To continue the @code{std::string} example (@pxref{Pretty Printing API}),
24457 this code might appear in @code{gdb.libstdcxx.v6}:
24460 def register_printers(objfile):
24461 objfile.pretty_printers.append(str_lookup_function)
24465 And then the corresponding contents of the auto-load file would be:
24468 import gdb.libstdcxx.v6
24469 gdb.libstdcxx.v6.register_printers(gdb.current_objfile())
24472 The previous example illustrates a basic pretty-printer.
24473 There are a few things that can be improved on.
24474 The printer doesn't have a name, making it hard to identify in a
24475 list of installed printers. The lookup function has a name, but
24476 lookup functions can have arbitrary, even identical, names.
24478 Second, the printer only handles one type, whereas a library typically has
24479 several types. One could install a lookup function for each desired type
24480 in the library, but one could also have a single lookup function recognize
24481 several types. The latter is the conventional way this is handled.
24482 If a pretty-printer can handle multiple data types, then its
24483 @dfn{subprinters} are the printers for the individual data types.
24485 The @code{gdb.printing} module provides a formal way of solving these
24486 problems (@pxref{gdb.printing}).
24487 Here is another example that handles multiple types.
24489 These are the types we are going to pretty-print:
24492 struct foo @{ int a, b; @};
24493 struct bar @{ struct foo x, y; @};
24496 Here are the printers:
24500 """Print a foo object."""
24502 def __init__(self, val):
24505 def to_string(self):
24506 return ("a=<" + str(self.val["a"]) +
24507 "> b=<" + str(self.val["b"]) + ">")
24510 """Print a bar object."""
24512 def __init__(self, val):
24515 def to_string(self):
24516 return ("x=<" + str(self.val["x"]) +
24517 "> y=<" + str(self.val["y"]) + ">")
24520 This example doesn't need a lookup function, that is handled by the
24521 @code{gdb.printing} module. Instead a function is provided to build up
24522 the object that handles the lookup.
24525 import gdb.printing
24527 def build_pretty_printer():
24528 pp = gdb.printing.RegexpCollectionPrettyPrinter(
24530 pp.add_printer('foo', '^foo$', fooPrinter)
24531 pp.add_printer('bar', '^bar$', barPrinter)
24535 And here is the autoload support:
24538 import gdb.printing
24540 gdb.printing.register_pretty_printer(
24541 gdb.current_objfile(),
24542 my_library.build_pretty_printer())
24545 Finally, when this printer is loaded into @value{GDBN}, here is the
24546 corresponding output of @samp{info pretty-printer}:
24549 (gdb) info pretty-printer
24556 @node Type Printing API
24557 @subsubsection Type Printing API
24558 @cindex type printing API for Python
24560 @value{GDBN} provides a way for Python code to customize type display.
24561 This is mainly useful for substituting canonical typedef names for
24564 @cindex type printer
24565 A @dfn{type printer} is just a Python object conforming to a certain
24566 protocol. A simple base class implementing the protocol is provided;
24567 see @ref{gdb.types}. A type printer must supply at least:
24569 @defivar type_printer enabled
24570 A boolean which is True if the printer is enabled, and False
24571 otherwise. This is manipulated by the @code{enable type-printer}
24572 and @code{disable type-printer} commands.
24575 @defivar type_printer name
24576 The name of the type printer. This must be a string. This is used by
24577 the @code{enable type-printer} and @code{disable type-printer}
24581 @defmethod type_printer instantiate (self)
24582 This is called by @value{GDBN} at the start of type-printing. It is
24583 only called if the type printer is enabled. This method must return a
24584 new object that supplies a @code{recognize} method, as described below.
24588 When displaying a type, say via the @code{ptype} command, @value{GDBN}
24589 will compute a list of type recognizers. This is done by iterating
24590 first over the per-objfile type printers (@pxref{Objfiles In Python}),
24591 followed by the per-progspace type printers (@pxref{Progspaces In
24592 Python}), and finally the global type printers.
24594 @value{GDBN} will call the @code{instantiate} method of each enabled
24595 type printer. If this method returns @code{None}, then the result is
24596 ignored; otherwise, it is appended to the list of recognizers.
24598 Then, when @value{GDBN} is going to display a type name, it iterates
24599 over the list of recognizers. For each one, it calls the recognition
24600 function, stopping if the function returns a non-@code{None} value.
24601 The recognition function is defined as:
24603 @defmethod type_recognizer recognize (self, type)
24604 If @var{type} is not recognized, return @code{None}. Otherwise,
24605 return a string which is to be printed as the name of @var{type}.
24606 @var{type} will be an instance of @code{gdb.Type} (@pxref{Types In
24610 @value{GDBN} uses this two-pass approach so that type printers can
24611 efficiently cache information without holding on to it too long. For
24612 example, it can be convenient to look up type information in a type
24613 printer and hold it for a recognizer's lifetime; if a single pass were
24614 done then type printers would have to make use of the event system in
24615 order to avoid holding information that could become stale as the
24618 @node Frame Filter API
24619 @subsubsection Filtering Frames.
24620 @cindex frame filters api
24622 Frame filters are Python objects that manipulate the visibility of a
24623 frame or frames when a backtrace (@pxref{Backtrace}) is printed by
24626 Only commands that print a backtrace, or, in the case of @sc{gdb/mi}
24627 commands (@pxref{GDB/MI}), those that return a collection of frames
24628 are affected. The commands that work with frame filters are:
24630 @code{backtrace} (@pxref{backtrace-command,, The backtrace command}),
24631 @code{-stack-list-frames}
24632 (@pxref{-stack-list-frames,, The -stack-list-frames command}),
24633 @code{-stack-list-variables} (@pxref{-stack-list-variables,, The
24634 -stack-list-variables command}), @code{-stack-list-arguments}
24635 @pxref{-stack-list-arguments,, The -stack-list-arguments command}) and
24636 @code{-stack-list-locals} (@pxref{-stack-list-locals,, The
24637 -stack-list-locals command}).
24639 A frame filter works by taking an iterator as an argument, applying
24640 actions to the contents of that iterator, and returning another
24641 iterator (or, possibly, the same iterator it was provided in the case
24642 where the filter does not perform any operations). Typically, frame
24643 filters utilize tools such as the Python's @code{itertools} module to
24644 work with and create new iterators from the source iterator.
24645 Regardless of how a filter chooses to apply actions, it must not alter
24646 the underlying @value{GDBN} frame or frames, or attempt to alter the
24647 call-stack within @value{GDBN}. This preserves data integrity within
24648 @value{GDBN}. Frame filters are executed on a priority basis and care
24649 should be taken that some frame filters may have been executed before,
24650 and that some frame filters will be executed after.
24652 An important consideration when designing frame filters, and well
24653 worth reflecting upon, is that frame filters should avoid unwinding
24654 the call stack if possible. Some stacks can run very deep, into the
24655 tens of thousands in some cases. To search every frame when a frame
24656 filter executes may be too expensive at that step. The frame filter
24657 cannot know how many frames it has to iterate over, and it may have to
24658 iterate through them all. This ends up duplicating effort as
24659 @value{GDBN} performs this iteration when it prints the frames. If
24660 the filter can defer unwinding frames until frame decorators are
24661 executed, after the last filter has executed, it should. @xref{Frame
24662 Decorator API}, for more information on decorators. Also, there are
24663 examples for both frame decorators and filters in later chapters.
24664 @xref{Writing a Frame Filter}, for more information.
24666 The Python dictionary @code{gdb.frame_filters} contains key/object
24667 pairings that comprise a frame filter. Frame filters in this
24668 dictionary are called @code{global} frame filters, and they are
24669 available when debugging all inferiors. These frame filters must
24670 register with the dictionary directly. In addition to the
24671 @code{global} dictionary, there are other dictionaries that are loaded
24672 with different inferiors via auto-loading (@pxref{Python
24673 Auto-loading}). The two other areas where frame filter dictionaries
24674 can be found are: @code{gdb.Progspace} which contains a
24675 @code{frame_filters} dictionary attribute, and each @code{gdb.Objfile}
24676 object which also contains a @code{frame_filters} dictionary
24679 When a command is executed from @value{GDBN} that is compatible with
24680 frame filters, @value{GDBN} combines the @code{global},
24681 @code{gdb.Progspace} and all @code{gdb.Objfile} dictionaries currently
24682 loaded. All of the @code{gdb.Objfile} dictionaries are combined, as
24683 several frames, and thus several object files, might be in use.
24684 @value{GDBN} then prunes any frame filter whose @code{enabled}
24685 attribute is @code{False}. This pruned list is then sorted according
24686 to the @code{priority} attribute in each filter.
24688 Once the dictionaries are combined, pruned and sorted, @value{GDBN}
24689 creates an iterator which wraps each frame in the call stack in a
24690 @code{FrameDecorator} object, and calls each filter in order. The
24691 output from the previous filter will always be the input to the next
24694 Frame filters have a mandatory interface which each frame filter must
24695 implement, defined here:
24697 @defun FrameFilter.filter (iterator)
24698 @value{GDBN} will call this method on a frame filter when it has
24699 reached the order in the priority list for that filter.
24701 For example, if there are four frame filters:
24712 The order that the frame filters will be called is:
24715 Filter3 -> Filter2 -> Filter1 -> Filter4
24718 Note that the output from @code{Filter3} is passed to the input of
24719 @code{Filter2}, and so on.
24721 This @code{filter} method is passed a Python iterator. This iterator
24722 contains a sequence of frame decorators that wrap each
24723 @code{gdb.Frame}, or a frame decorator that wraps another frame
24724 decorator. The first filter that is executed in the sequence of frame
24725 filters will receive an iterator entirely comprised of default
24726 @code{FrameDecorator} objects. However, after each frame filter is
24727 executed, the previous frame filter may have wrapped some or all of
24728 the frame decorators with their own frame decorator. As frame
24729 decorators must also conform to a mandatory interface, these
24730 decorators can be assumed to act in a uniform manner (@pxref{Frame
24733 This method must return an object conforming to the Python iterator
24734 protocol. Each item in the iterator must be an object conforming to
24735 the frame decorator interface. If a frame filter does not wish to
24736 perform any operations on this iterator, it should return that
24737 iterator untouched.
24739 This method is not optional. If it does not exist, @value{GDBN} will
24740 raise and print an error.
24743 @defvar FrameFilter.name
24744 The @code{name} attribute must be Python string which contains the
24745 name of the filter displayed by @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Frame Filter
24746 Management}). This attribute may contain any combination of letters
24747 or numbers. Care should be taken to ensure that it is unique. This
24748 attribute is mandatory.
24751 @defvar FrameFilter.enabled
24752 The @code{enabled} attribute must be Python boolean. This attribute
24753 indicates to @value{GDBN} whether the frame filter is enabled, and
24754 should be considered when frame filters are executed. If
24755 @code{enabled} is @code{True}, then the frame filter will be executed
24756 when any of the backtrace commands detailed earlier in this chapter
24757 are executed. If @code{enabled} is @code{False}, then the frame
24758 filter will not be executed. This attribute is mandatory.
24761 @defvar FrameFilter.priority
24762 The @code{priority} attribute must be Python integer. This attribute
24763 controls the order of execution in relation to other frame filters.
24764 There are no imposed limits on the range of @code{priority} other than
24765 it must be a valid integer. The higher the @code{priority} attribute,
24766 the sooner the frame filter will be executed in relation to other
24767 frame filters. Although @code{priority} can be negative, it is
24768 recommended practice to assume zero is the lowest priority that a
24769 frame filter can be assigned. Frame filters that have the same
24770 priority are executed in unsorted order in that priority slot. This
24771 attribute is mandatory.
24774 @node Frame Decorator API
24775 @subsubsection Decorating Frames.
24776 @cindex frame decorator api
24778 Frame decorators are sister objects to frame filters (@pxref{Frame
24779 Filter API}). Frame decorators are applied by a frame filter and can
24780 only be used in conjunction with frame filters.
24782 The purpose of a frame decorator is to customize the printed content
24783 of each @code{gdb.Frame} in commands where frame filters are executed.
24784 This concept is called decorating a frame. Frame decorators decorate
24785 a @code{gdb.Frame} with Python code contained within each API call.
24786 This separates the actual data contained in a @code{gdb.Frame} from
24787 the decorated data produced by a frame decorator. This abstraction is
24788 necessary to maintain integrity of the data contained in each
24791 Frame decorators have a mandatory interface, defined below.
24793 @value{GDBN} already contains a frame decorator called
24794 @code{FrameDecorator}. This contains substantial amounts of
24795 boilerplate code to decorate the content of a @code{gdb.Frame}. It is
24796 recommended that other frame decorators inherit and extend this
24797 object, and only to override the methods needed.
24799 @defun FrameDecorator.elided (self)
24801 The @code{elided} method groups frames together in a hierarchical
24802 system. An example would be an interpreter, where multiple low-level
24803 frames make up a single call in the interpreted language. In this
24804 example, the frame filter would elide the low-level frames and present
24805 a single high-level frame, representing the call in the interpreted
24806 language, to the user.
24808 The @code{elided} function must return an iterable and this iterable
24809 must contain the frames that are being elided wrapped in a suitable
24810 frame decorator. If no frames are being elided this function may
24811 return an empty iterable, or @code{None}. Elided frames are indented
24812 from normal frames in a @code{CLI} backtrace, or in the case of
24813 @code{GDB/MI}, are placed in the @code{children} field of the eliding
24816 It is the frame filter's task to also filter out the elided frames from
24817 the source iterator. This will avoid printing the frame twice.
24820 @defun FrameDecorator.function (self)
24822 This method returns the name of the function in the frame that is to
24825 This method must return a Python string describing the function, or
24828 If this function returns @code{None}, @value{GDBN} will not print any
24829 data for this field.
24832 @defun FrameDecorator.address (self)
24834 This method returns the address of the frame that is to be printed.
24836 This method must return a Python numeric integer type of sufficient
24837 size to describe the address of the frame, or @code{None}.
24839 If this function returns a @code{None}, @value{GDBN} will not print
24840 any data for this field.
24843 @defun FrameDecorator.filename (self)
24845 This method returns the filename and path associated with this frame.
24847 This method must return a Python string containing the filename and
24848 the path to the object file backing the frame, or @code{None}.
24850 If this function returns a @code{None}, @value{GDBN} will not print
24851 any data for this field.
24854 @defun FrameDecorator.line (self):
24856 This method returns the line number associated with the current
24857 position within the function addressed by this frame.
24859 This method must return a Python integer type, or @code{None}.
24861 If this function returns a @code{None}, @value{GDBN} will not print
24862 any data for this field.
24865 @defun FrameDecorator.frame_args (self)
24866 @anchor{frame_args}
24868 This method must return an iterable, or @code{None}. Returning an
24869 empty iterable, or @code{None} means frame arguments will not be
24870 printed for this frame. This iterable must contain objects that
24871 implement two methods, described here.
24873 This object must implement a @code{argument} method which takes a
24874 single @code{self} parameter and must return a @code{gdb.Symbol}
24875 (@pxref{Symbols In Python}), or a Python string. The object must also
24876 implement a @code{value} method which takes a single @code{self}
24877 parameter and must return a @code{gdb.Value} (@pxref{Values From
24878 Inferior}), a Python value, or @code{None}. If the @code{value}
24879 method returns @code{None}, and the @code{argument} method returns a
24880 @code{gdb.Symbol}, @value{GDBN} will look-up and print the value of
24881 the @code{gdb.Symbol} automatically.
24886 class SymValueWrapper():
24888 def __init__(self, symbol, value):
24898 class SomeFrameDecorator()
24901 def frame_args(self):
24904 block = self.inferior_frame.block()
24908 # Iterate over all symbols in a block. Only add
24909 # symbols that are arguments.
24911 if not sym.is_argument:
24913 args.append(SymValueWrapper(sym,None))
24915 # Add example synthetic argument.
24916 args.append(SymValueWrapper(``foo'', 42))
24922 @defun FrameDecorator.frame_locals (self)
24924 This method must return an iterable or @code{None}. Returning an
24925 empty iterable, or @code{None} means frame local arguments will not be
24926 printed for this frame.
24928 The object interface, the description of the various strategies for
24929 reading frame locals, and the example are largely similar to those
24930 described in the @code{frame_args} function, (@pxref{frame_args,,The
24931 frame filter frame_args function}). Below is a modified example:
24934 class SomeFrameDecorator()
24937 def frame_locals(self):
24940 block = self.inferior_frame.block()
24944 # Iterate over all symbols in a block. Add all
24945 # symbols, except arguments.
24947 if sym.is_argument:
24949 vars.append(SymValueWrapper(sym,None))
24951 # Add an example of a synthetic local variable.
24952 vars.append(SymValueWrapper(``bar'', 99))
24958 @defun FrameDecorator.inferior_frame (self):
24960 This method must return the underlying @code{gdb.Frame} that this
24961 frame decorator is decorating. @value{GDBN} requires the underlying
24962 frame for internal frame information to determine how to print certain
24963 values when printing a frame.
24966 @node Writing a Frame Filter
24967 @subsubsection Writing a Frame Filter
24968 @cindex writing a frame filter
24970 There are three basic elements that a frame filter must implement: it
24971 must correctly implement the documented interface (@pxref{Frame Filter
24972 API}), it must register itself with @value{GDBN}, and finally, it must
24973 decide if it is to work on the data provided by @value{GDBN}. In all
24974 cases, whether it works on the iterator or not, each frame filter must
24975 return an iterator. A bare-bones frame filter follows the pattern in
24976 the following example.
24981 class FrameFilter():
24983 def __init__(self):
24984 # Frame filter attribute creation.
24986 # 'name' is the name of the filter that GDB will display.
24988 # 'priority' is the priority of the filter relative to other
24991 # 'enabled' is a boolean that indicates whether this filter is
24992 # enabled and should be executed.
24995 self.priority = 100
24996 self.enabled = True
24998 # Register this frame filter with the global frame_filters
25000 gdb.frame_filters[self.name] = self
25002 def filter(self, frame_iter):
25003 # Just return the iterator.
25007 The frame filter in the example above implements the three
25008 requirements for all frame filters. It implements the API, self
25009 registers, and makes a decision on the iterator (in this case, it just
25010 returns the iterator untouched).
25012 The first step is attribute creation and assignment, and as shown in
25013 the comments the filter assigns the following attributes: @code{name},
25014 @code{priority} and whether the filter should be enabled with the
25015 @code{enabled} attribute.
25017 The second step is registering the frame filter with the dictionary or
25018 dictionaries that the frame filter has interest in. As shown in the
25019 comments, this filter just registers itself with the global dictionary
25020 @code{gdb.frame_filters}. As noted earlier, @code{gdb.frame_filters}
25021 is a dictionary that is initialized in the @code{gdb} module when
25022 @value{GDBN} starts. What dictionary a filter registers with is an
25023 important consideration. Generally, if a filter is specific to a set
25024 of code, it should be registered either in the @code{objfile} or
25025 @code{progspace} dictionaries as they are specific to the program
25026 currently loaded in @value{GDBN}. The global dictionary is always
25027 present in @value{GDBN} and is never unloaded. Any filters registered
25028 with the global dictionary will exist until @value{GDBN} exits. To
25029 avoid filters that may conflict, it is generally better to register
25030 frame filters against the dictionaries that more closely align with
25031 the usage of the filter currently in question. @xref{Python
25032 Auto-loading}, for further information on auto-loading Python scripts.
25034 @value{GDBN} takes a hands-off approach to frame filter registration,
25035 therefore it is the frame filter's responsibility to ensure
25036 registration has occurred, and that any exceptions are handled
25037 appropriately. In particular, you may wish to handle exceptions
25038 relating to Python dictionary key uniqueness. It is mandatory that
25039 the dictionary key is the same as frame filter's @code{name}
25040 attribute. When a user manages frame filters (@pxref{Frame Filter
25041 Management}), the names @value{GDBN} will display are those contained
25042 in the @code{name} attribute.
25044 The final step of this example is the implementation of the
25045 @code{filter} method. As shown in the example comments, we define the
25046 @code{filter} method and note that the method must take an iterator,
25047 and also must return an iterator. In this bare-bones example, the
25048 frame filter is not very useful as it just returns the iterator
25049 untouched. However this is a valid operation for frame filters that
25050 have the @code{enabled} attribute set, but decide not to operate on
25053 In the next example, the frame filter operates on all frames and
25054 utilizes a frame decorator to perform some work on the frames.
25055 @xref{Frame Decorator API}, for further information on the frame
25056 decorator interface.
25058 This example works on inlined frames. It highlights frames which are
25059 inlined by tagging them with an ``[inlined]'' tag. By applying a
25060 frame decorator to all frames with the Python @code{itertools imap}
25061 method, the example defers actions to the frame decorator. Frame
25062 decorators are only processed when @value{GDBN} prints the backtrace.
25064 This introduces a new decision making topic: whether to perform
25065 decision making operations at the filtering step, or at the printing
25066 step. In this example's approach, it does not perform any filtering
25067 decisions at the filtering step beyond mapping a frame decorator to
25068 each frame. This allows the actual decision making to be performed
25069 when each frame is printed. This is an important consideration, and
25070 well worth reflecting upon when designing a frame filter. An issue
25071 that frame filters should avoid is unwinding the stack if possible.
25072 Some stacks can run very deep, into the tens of thousands in some
25073 cases. To search every frame to determine if it is inlined ahead of
25074 time may be too expensive at the filtering step. The frame filter
25075 cannot know how many frames it has to iterate over, and it would have
25076 to iterate through them all. This ends up duplicating effort as
25077 @value{GDBN} performs this iteration when it prints the frames.
25079 In this example decision making can be deferred to the printing step.
25080 As each frame is printed, the frame decorator can examine each frame
25081 in turn when @value{GDBN} iterates. From a performance viewpoint,
25082 this is the most appropriate decision to make as it avoids duplicating
25083 the effort that the printing step would undertake anyway. Also, if
25084 there are many frame filters unwinding the stack during filtering, it
25085 can substantially delay the printing of the backtrace which will
25086 result in large memory usage, and a poor user experience.
25089 class InlineFilter():
25091 def __init__(self):
25092 self.name = "InlinedFrameFilter"
25093 self.priority = 100
25094 self.enabled = True
25095 gdb.frame_filters[self.name] = self
25097 def filter(self, frame_iter):
25098 frame_iter = itertools.imap(InlinedFrameDecorator,
25103 This frame filter is somewhat similar to the earlier example, except
25104 that the @code{filter} method applies a frame decorator object called
25105 @code{InlinedFrameDecorator} to each element in the iterator. The
25106 @code{imap} Python method is light-weight. It does not proactively
25107 iterate over the iterator, but rather creates a new iterator which
25108 wraps the existing one.
25110 Below is the frame decorator for this example.
25113 class InlinedFrameDecorator(FrameDecorator):
25115 def __init__(self, fobj):
25116 super(InlinedFrameDecorator, self).__init__(fobj)
25118 def function(self):
25119 frame = fobj.inferior_frame()
25120 name = str(frame.name())
25122 if frame.type() == gdb.INLINE_FRAME:
25123 name = name + " [inlined]"
25128 This frame decorator only defines and overrides the @code{function}
25129 method. It lets the supplied @code{FrameDecorator}, which is shipped
25130 with @value{GDBN}, perform the other work associated with printing
25133 The combination of these two objects create this output from a
25137 #0 0x004004e0 in bar () at inline.c:11
25138 #1 0x00400566 in max [inlined] (b=6, a=12) at inline.c:21
25139 #2 0x00400566 in main () at inline.c:31
25142 So in the case of this example, a frame decorator is applied to all
25143 frames, regardless of whether they may be inlined or not. As
25144 @value{GDBN} iterates over the iterator produced by the frame filters,
25145 @value{GDBN} executes each frame decorator which then makes a decision
25146 on what to print in the @code{function} callback. Using a strategy
25147 like this is a way to defer decisions on the frame content to printing
25150 @subheading Eliding Frames
25152 It might be that the above example is not desirable for representing
25153 inlined frames, and a hierarchical approach may be preferred. If we
25154 want to hierarchically represent frames, the @code{elided} frame
25155 decorator interface might be preferable.
25157 This example approaches the issue with the @code{elided} method. This
25158 example is quite long, but very simplistic. It is out-of-scope for
25159 this section to write a complete example that comprehensively covers
25160 all approaches of finding and printing inlined frames. However, this
25161 example illustrates the approach an author might use.
25163 This example comprises of three sections.
25166 class InlineFrameFilter():
25168 def __init__(self):
25169 self.name = "InlinedFrameFilter"
25170 self.priority = 100
25171 self.enabled = True
25172 gdb.frame_filters[self.name] = self
25174 def filter(self, frame_iter):
25175 return ElidingInlineIterator(frame_iter)
25178 This frame filter is very similar to the other examples. The only
25179 difference is this frame filter is wrapping the iterator provided to
25180 it (@code{frame_iter}) with a custom iterator called
25181 @code{ElidingInlineIterator}. This again defers actions to when
25182 @value{GDBN} prints the backtrace, as the iterator is not traversed
25185 The iterator for this example is as follows. It is in this section of
25186 the example where decisions are made on the content of the backtrace.
25189 class ElidingInlineIterator:
25190 def __init__(self, ii):
25191 self.input_iterator = ii
25193 def __iter__(self):
25197 frame = next(self.input_iterator)
25199 if frame.inferior_frame().type() != gdb.INLINE_FRAME:
25203 eliding_frame = next(self.input_iterator)
25204 except StopIteration:
25206 return ElidingFrameDecorator(eliding_frame, [frame])
25209 This iterator implements the Python iterator protocol. When the
25210 @code{next} function is called (when @value{GDBN} prints each frame),
25211 the iterator checks if this frame decorator, @code{frame}, is wrapping
25212 an inlined frame. If it is not, it returns the existing frame decorator
25213 untouched. If it is wrapping an inlined frame, it assumes that the
25214 inlined frame was contained within the next oldest frame,
25215 @code{eliding_frame}, which it fetches. It then creates and returns a
25216 frame decorator, @code{ElidingFrameDecorator}, which contains both the
25217 elided frame, and the eliding frame.
25220 class ElidingInlineDecorator(FrameDecorator):
25222 def __init__(self, frame, elided_frames):
25223 super(ElidingInlineDecorator, self).__init__(frame)
25225 self.elided_frames = elided_frames
25228 return iter(self.elided_frames)
25231 This frame decorator overrides one function and returns the inlined
25232 frame in the @code{elided} method. As before it lets
25233 @code{FrameDecorator} do the rest of the work involved in printing
25234 this frame. This produces the following output.
25237 #0 0x004004e0 in bar () at inline.c:11
25238 #2 0x00400529 in main () at inline.c:25
25239 #1 0x00400529 in max (b=6, a=12) at inline.c:15
25242 In that output, @code{max} which has been inlined into @code{main} is
25243 printed hierarchically. Another approach would be to combine the
25244 @code{function} method, and the @code{elided} method to both print a
25245 marker in the inlined frame, and also show the hierarchical
25248 @node Inferiors In Python
25249 @subsubsection Inferiors In Python
25250 @cindex inferiors in Python
25252 @findex gdb.Inferior
25253 Programs which are being run under @value{GDBN} are called inferiors
25254 (@pxref{Inferiors and Programs}). Python scripts can access
25255 information about and manipulate inferiors controlled by @value{GDBN}
25256 via objects of the @code{gdb.Inferior} class.
25258 The following inferior-related functions are available in the @code{gdb}
25261 @defun gdb.inferiors ()
25262 Return a tuple containing all inferior objects.
25265 @defun gdb.selected_inferior ()
25266 Return an object representing the current inferior.
25269 A @code{gdb.Inferior} object has the following attributes:
25271 @defvar Inferior.num
25272 ID of inferior, as assigned by GDB.
25275 @defvar Inferior.pid
25276 Process ID of the inferior, as assigned by the underlying operating
25280 @defvar Inferior.was_attached
25281 Boolean signaling whether the inferior was created using `attach', or
25282 started by @value{GDBN} itself.
25285 A @code{gdb.Inferior} object has the following methods:
25287 @defun Inferior.is_valid ()
25288 Returns @code{True} if the @code{gdb.Inferior} object is valid,
25289 @code{False} if not. A @code{gdb.Inferior} object will become invalid
25290 if the inferior no longer exists within @value{GDBN}. All other
25291 @code{gdb.Inferior} methods will throw an exception if it is invalid
25292 at the time the method is called.
25295 @defun Inferior.threads ()
25296 This method returns a tuple holding all the threads which are valid
25297 when it is called. If there are no valid threads, the method will
25298 return an empty tuple.
25301 @findex Inferior.read_memory
25302 @defun Inferior.read_memory (address, length)
25303 Read @var{length} bytes of memory from the inferior, starting at
25304 @var{address}. Returns a buffer object, which behaves much like an array
25305 or a string. It can be modified and given to the
25306 @code{Inferior.write_memory} function. In @code{Python} 3, the return
25307 value is a @code{memoryview} object.
25310 @findex Inferior.write_memory
25311 @defun Inferior.write_memory (address, buffer @r{[}, length@r{]})
25312 Write the contents of @var{buffer} to the inferior, starting at
25313 @var{address}. The @var{buffer} parameter must be a Python object
25314 which supports the buffer protocol, i.e., a string, an array or the
25315 object returned from @code{Inferior.read_memory}. If given, @var{length}
25316 determines the number of bytes from @var{buffer} to be written.
25319 @findex gdb.search_memory
25320 @defun Inferior.search_memory (address, length, pattern)
25321 Search a region of the inferior memory starting at @var{address} with
25322 the given @var{length} using the search pattern supplied in
25323 @var{pattern}. The @var{pattern} parameter must be a Python object
25324 which supports the buffer protocol, i.e., a string, an array or the
25325 object returned from @code{gdb.read_memory}. Returns a Python @code{Long}
25326 containing the address where the pattern was found, or @code{None} if
25327 the pattern could not be found.
25330 @node Events In Python
25331 @subsubsection Events In Python
25332 @cindex inferior events in Python
25334 @value{GDBN} provides a general event facility so that Python code can be
25335 notified of various state changes, particularly changes that occur in
25338 An @dfn{event} is just an object that describes some state change. The
25339 type of the object and its attributes will vary depending on the details
25340 of the change. All the existing events are described below.
25342 In order to be notified of an event, you must register an event handler
25343 with an @dfn{event registry}. An event registry is an object in the
25344 @code{gdb.events} module which dispatches particular events. A registry
25345 provides methods to register and unregister event handlers:
25347 @defun EventRegistry.connect (object)
25348 Add the given callable @var{object} to the registry. This object will be
25349 called when an event corresponding to this registry occurs.
25352 @defun EventRegistry.disconnect (object)
25353 Remove the given @var{object} from the registry. Once removed, the object
25354 will no longer receive notifications of events.
25357 Here is an example:
25360 def exit_handler (event):
25361 print "event type: exit"
25362 print "exit code: %d" % (event.exit_code)
25364 gdb.events.exited.connect (exit_handler)
25367 In the above example we connect our handler @code{exit_handler} to the
25368 registry @code{events.exited}. Once connected, @code{exit_handler} gets
25369 called when the inferior exits. The argument @dfn{event} in this example is
25370 of type @code{gdb.ExitedEvent}. As you can see in the example the
25371 @code{ExitedEvent} object has an attribute which indicates the exit code of
25374 The following is a listing of the event registries that are available and
25375 details of the events they emit:
25380 Emits @code{gdb.ThreadEvent}.
25382 Some events can be thread specific when @value{GDBN} is running in non-stop
25383 mode. When represented in Python, these events all extend
25384 @code{gdb.ThreadEvent}. Note, this event is not emitted directly; instead,
25385 events which are emitted by this or other modules might extend this event.
25386 Examples of these events are @code{gdb.BreakpointEvent} and
25387 @code{gdb.ContinueEvent}.
25389 @defvar ThreadEvent.inferior_thread
25390 In non-stop mode this attribute will be set to the specific thread which was
25391 involved in the emitted event. Otherwise, it will be set to @code{None}.
25394 Emits @code{gdb.ContinueEvent} which extends @code{gdb.ThreadEvent}.
25396 This event indicates that the inferior has been continued after a stop. For
25397 inherited attribute refer to @code{gdb.ThreadEvent} above.
25399 @item events.exited
25400 Emits @code{events.ExitedEvent} which indicates that the inferior has exited.
25401 @code{events.ExitedEvent} has two attributes:
25402 @defvar ExitedEvent.exit_code
25403 An integer representing the exit code, if available, which the inferior
25404 has returned. (The exit code could be unavailable if, for example,
25405 @value{GDBN} detaches from the inferior.) If the exit code is unavailable,
25406 the attribute does not exist.
25408 @defvar ExitedEvent inferior
25409 A reference to the inferior which triggered the @code{exited} event.
25413 Emits @code{gdb.StopEvent} which extends @code{gdb.ThreadEvent}.
25415 Indicates that the inferior has stopped. All events emitted by this registry
25416 extend StopEvent. As a child of @code{gdb.ThreadEvent}, @code{gdb.StopEvent}
25417 will indicate the stopped thread when @value{GDBN} is running in non-stop
25418 mode. Refer to @code{gdb.ThreadEvent} above for more details.
25420 Emits @code{gdb.SignalEvent} which extends @code{gdb.StopEvent}.
25422 This event indicates that the inferior or one of its threads has received as
25423 signal. @code{gdb.SignalEvent} has the following attributes:
25425 @defvar SignalEvent.stop_signal
25426 A string representing the signal received by the inferior. A list of possible
25427 signal values can be obtained by running the command @code{info signals} in
25428 the @value{GDBN} command prompt.
25431 Also emits @code{gdb.BreakpointEvent} which extends @code{gdb.StopEvent}.
25433 @code{gdb.BreakpointEvent} event indicates that one or more breakpoints have
25434 been hit, and has the following attributes:
25436 @defvar BreakpointEvent.breakpoints
25437 A sequence containing references to all the breakpoints (type
25438 @code{gdb.Breakpoint}) that were hit.
25439 @xref{Breakpoints In Python}, for details of the @code{gdb.Breakpoint} object.
25441 @defvar BreakpointEvent.breakpoint
25442 A reference to the first breakpoint that was hit.
25443 This function is maintained for backward compatibility and is now deprecated
25444 in favor of the @code{gdb.BreakpointEvent.breakpoints} attribute.
25447 @item events.new_objfile
25448 Emits @code{gdb.NewObjFileEvent} which indicates that a new object file has
25449 been loaded by @value{GDBN}. @code{gdb.NewObjFileEvent} has one attribute:
25451 @defvar NewObjFileEvent.new_objfile
25452 A reference to the object file (@code{gdb.Objfile}) which has been loaded.
25453 @xref{Objfiles In Python}, for details of the @code{gdb.Objfile} object.
25458 @node Threads In Python
25459 @subsubsection Threads In Python
25460 @cindex threads in python
25462 @findex gdb.InferiorThread
25463 Python scripts can access information about, and manipulate inferior threads
25464 controlled by @value{GDBN}, via objects of the @code{gdb.InferiorThread} class.
25466 The following thread-related functions are available in the @code{gdb}
25469 @findex gdb.selected_thread
25470 @defun gdb.selected_thread ()
25471 This function returns the thread object for the selected thread. If there
25472 is no selected thread, this will return @code{None}.
25475 A @code{gdb.InferiorThread} object has the following attributes:
25477 @defvar InferiorThread.name
25478 The name of the thread. If the user specified a name using
25479 @code{thread name}, then this returns that name. Otherwise, if an
25480 OS-supplied name is available, then it is returned. Otherwise, this
25481 returns @code{None}.
25483 This attribute can be assigned to. The new value must be a string
25484 object, which sets the new name, or @code{None}, which removes any
25485 user-specified thread name.
25488 @defvar InferiorThread.num
25489 ID of the thread, as assigned by GDB.
25492 @defvar InferiorThread.ptid
25493 ID of the thread, as assigned by the operating system. This attribute is a
25494 tuple containing three integers. The first is the Process ID (PID); the second
25495 is the Lightweight Process ID (LWPID), and the third is the Thread ID (TID).
25496 Either the LWPID or TID may be 0, which indicates that the operating system
25497 does not use that identifier.
25500 A @code{gdb.InferiorThread} object has the following methods:
25502 @defun InferiorThread.is_valid ()
25503 Returns @code{True} if the @code{gdb.InferiorThread} object is valid,
25504 @code{False} if not. A @code{gdb.InferiorThread} object will become
25505 invalid if the thread exits, or the inferior that the thread belongs
25506 is deleted. All other @code{gdb.InferiorThread} methods will throw an
25507 exception if it is invalid at the time the method is called.
25510 @defun InferiorThread.switch ()
25511 This changes @value{GDBN}'s currently selected thread to the one represented
25515 @defun InferiorThread.is_stopped ()
25516 Return a Boolean indicating whether the thread is stopped.
25519 @defun InferiorThread.is_running ()
25520 Return a Boolean indicating whether the thread is running.
25523 @defun InferiorThread.is_exited ()
25524 Return a Boolean indicating whether the thread is exited.
25527 @node Commands In Python
25528 @subsubsection Commands In Python
25530 @cindex commands in python
25531 @cindex python commands
25532 You can implement new @value{GDBN} CLI commands in Python. A CLI
25533 command is implemented using an instance of the @code{gdb.Command}
25534 class, most commonly using a subclass.
25536 @defun Command.__init__ (name, @var{command_class} @r{[}, @var{completer_class} @r{[}, @var{prefix}@r{]]})
25537 The object initializer for @code{Command} registers the new command
25538 with @value{GDBN}. This initializer is normally invoked from the
25539 subclass' own @code{__init__} method.
25541 @var{name} is the name of the command. If @var{name} consists of
25542 multiple words, then the initial words are looked for as prefix
25543 commands. In this case, if one of the prefix commands does not exist,
25544 an exception is raised.
25546 There is no support for multi-line commands.
25548 @var{command_class} should be one of the @samp{COMMAND_} constants
25549 defined below. This argument tells @value{GDBN} how to categorize the
25550 new command in the help system.
25552 @var{completer_class} is an optional argument. If given, it should be
25553 one of the @samp{COMPLETE_} constants defined below. This argument
25554 tells @value{GDBN} how to perform completion for this command. If not
25555 given, @value{GDBN} will attempt to complete using the object's
25556 @code{complete} method (see below); if no such method is found, an
25557 error will occur when completion is attempted.
25559 @var{prefix} is an optional argument. If @code{True}, then the new
25560 command is a prefix command; sub-commands of this command may be
25563 The help text for the new command is taken from the Python
25564 documentation string for the command's class, if there is one. If no
25565 documentation string is provided, the default value ``This command is
25566 not documented.'' is used.
25569 @cindex don't repeat Python command
25570 @defun Command.dont_repeat ()
25571 By default, a @value{GDBN} command is repeated when the user enters a
25572 blank line at the command prompt. A command can suppress this
25573 behavior by invoking the @code{dont_repeat} method. This is similar
25574 to the user command @code{dont-repeat}, see @ref{Define, dont-repeat}.
25577 @defun Command.invoke (argument, from_tty)
25578 This method is called by @value{GDBN} when this command is invoked.
25580 @var{argument} is a string. It is the argument to the command, after
25581 leading and trailing whitespace has been stripped.
25583 @var{from_tty} is a boolean argument. When true, this means that the
25584 command was entered by the user at the terminal; when false it means
25585 that the command came from elsewhere.
25587 If this method throws an exception, it is turned into a @value{GDBN}
25588 @code{error} call. Otherwise, the return value is ignored.
25590 @findex gdb.string_to_argv
25591 To break @var{argument} up into an argv-like string use
25592 @code{gdb.string_to_argv}. This function behaves identically to
25593 @value{GDBN}'s internal argument lexer @code{buildargv}.
25594 It is recommended to use this for consistency.
25595 Arguments are separated by spaces and may be quoted.
25599 print gdb.string_to_argv ("1 2\ \\\"3 '4 \"5' \"6 '7\"")
25600 ['1', '2 "3', '4 "5', "6 '7"]
25605 @cindex completion of Python commands
25606 @defun Command.complete (text, word)
25607 This method is called by @value{GDBN} when the user attempts
25608 completion on this command. All forms of completion are handled by
25609 this method, that is, the @key{TAB} and @key{M-?} key bindings
25610 (@pxref{Completion}), and the @code{complete} command (@pxref{Help,
25613 The arguments @var{text} and @var{word} are both strings. @var{text}
25614 holds the complete command line up to the cursor's location.
25615 @var{word} holds the last word of the command line; this is computed
25616 using a word-breaking heuristic.
25618 The @code{complete} method can return several values:
25621 If the return value is a sequence, the contents of the sequence are
25622 used as the completions. It is up to @code{complete} to ensure that the
25623 contents actually do complete the word. A zero-length sequence is
25624 allowed, it means that there were no completions available. Only
25625 string elements of the sequence are used; other elements in the
25626 sequence are ignored.
25629 If the return value is one of the @samp{COMPLETE_} constants defined
25630 below, then the corresponding @value{GDBN}-internal completion
25631 function is invoked, and its result is used.
25634 All other results are treated as though there were no available
25639 When a new command is registered, it must be declared as a member of
25640 some general class of commands. This is used to classify top-level
25641 commands in the on-line help system; note that prefix commands are not
25642 listed under their own category but rather that of their top-level
25643 command. The available classifications are represented by constants
25644 defined in the @code{gdb} module:
25647 @findex COMMAND_NONE
25648 @findex gdb.COMMAND_NONE
25649 @item gdb.COMMAND_NONE
25650 The command does not belong to any particular class. A command in
25651 this category will not be displayed in any of the help categories.
25653 @findex COMMAND_RUNNING
25654 @findex gdb.COMMAND_RUNNING
25655 @item gdb.COMMAND_RUNNING
25656 The command is related to running the inferior. For example,
25657 @code{start}, @code{step}, and @code{continue} are in this category.
25658 Type @kbd{help running} at the @value{GDBN} prompt to see a list of
25659 commands in this category.
25661 @findex COMMAND_DATA
25662 @findex gdb.COMMAND_DATA
25663 @item gdb.COMMAND_DATA
25664 The command is related to data or variables. For example,
25665 @code{call}, @code{find}, and @code{print} are in this category. Type
25666 @kbd{help data} at the @value{GDBN} prompt to see a list of commands
25669 @findex COMMAND_STACK
25670 @findex gdb.COMMAND_STACK
25671 @item gdb.COMMAND_STACK
25672 The command has to do with manipulation of the stack. For example,
25673 @code{backtrace}, @code{frame}, and @code{return} are in this
25674 category. Type @kbd{help stack} at the @value{GDBN} prompt to see a
25675 list of commands in this category.
25677 @findex COMMAND_FILES
25678 @findex gdb.COMMAND_FILES
25679 @item gdb.COMMAND_FILES
25680 This class is used for file-related commands. For example,
25681 @code{file}, @code{list} and @code{section} are in this category.
25682 Type @kbd{help files} at the @value{GDBN} prompt to see a list of
25683 commands in this category.
25685 @findex COMMAND_SUPPORT
25686 @findex gdb.COMMAND_SUPPORT
25687 @item gdb.COMMAND_SUPPORT
25688 This should be used for ``support facilities'', generally meaning
25689 things that are useful to the user when interacting with @value{GDBN},
25690 but not related to the state of the inferior. For example,
25691 @code{help}, @code{make}, and @code{shell} are in this category. Type
25692 @kbd{help support} at the @value{GDBN} prompt to see a list of
25693 commands in this category.
25695 @findex COMMAND_STATUS
25696 @findex gdb.COMMAND_STATUS
25697 @item gdb.COMMAND_STATUS
25698 The command is an @samp{info}-related command, that is, related to the
25699 state of @value{GDBN} itself. For example, @code{info}, @code{macro},
25700 and @code{show} are in this category. Type @kbd{help status} at the
25701 @value{GDBN} prompt to see a list of commands in this category.
25703 @findex COMMAND_BREAKPOINTS
25704 @findex gdb.COMMAND_BREAKPOINTS
25705 @item gdb.COMMAND_BREAKPOINTS
25706 The command has to do with breakpoints. For example, @code{break},
25707 @code{clear}, and @code{delete} are in this category. Type @kbd{help
25708 breakpoints} at the @value{GDBN} prompt to see a list of commands in
25711 @findex COMMAND_TRACEPOINTS
25712 @findex gdb.COMMAND_TRACEPOINTS
25713 @item gdb.COMMAND_TRACEPOINTS
25714 The command has to do with tracepoints. For example, @code{trace},
25715 @code{actions}, and @code{tfind} are in this category. Type
25716 @kbd{help tracepoints} at the @value{GDBN} prompt to see a list of
25717 commands in this category.
25719 @findex COMMAND_USER
25720 @findex gdb.COMMAND_USER
25721 @item gdb.COMMAND_USER
25722 The command is a general purpose command for the user, and typically
25723 does not fit in one of the other categories.
25724 Type @kbd{help user-defined} at the @value{GDBN} prompt to see
25725 a list of commands in this category, as well as the list of gdb macros
25726 (@pxref{Sequences}).
25728 @findex COMMAND_OBSCURE
25729 @findex gdb.COMMAND_OBSCURE
25730 @item gdb.COMMAND_OBSCURE
25731 The command is only used in unusual circumstances, or is not of
25732 general interest to users. For example, @code{checkpoint},
25733 @code{fork}, and @code{stop} are in this category. Type @kbd{help
25734 obscure} at the @value{GDBN} prompt to see a list of commands in this
25737 @findex COMMAND_MAINTENANCE
25738 @findex gdb.COMMAND_MAINTENANCE
25739 @item gdb.COMMAND_MAINTENANCE
25740 The command is only useful to @value{GDBN} maintainers. The
25741 @code{maintenance} and @code{flushregs} commands are in this category.
25742 Type @kbd{help internals} at the @value{GDBN} prompt to see a list of
25743 commands in this category.
25746 A new command can use a predefined completion function, either by
25747 specifying it via an argument at initialization, or by returning it
25748 from the @code{complete} method. These predefined completion
25749 constants are all defined in the @code{gdb} module:
25752 @findex COMPLETE_NONE
25753 @findex gdb.COMPLETE_NONE
25754 @item gdb.COMPLETE_NONE
25755 This constant means that no completion should be done.
25757 @findex COMPLETE_FILENAME
25758 @findex gdb.COMPLETE_FILENAME
25759 @item gdb.COMPLETE_FILENAME
25760 This constant means that filename completion should be performed.
25762 @findex COMPLETE_LOCATION
25763 @findex gdb.COMPLETE_LOCATION
25764 @item gdb.COMPLETE_LOCATION
25765 This constant means that location completion should be done.
25766 @xref{Specify Location}.
25768 @findex COMPLETE_COMMAND
25769 @findex gdb.COMPLETE_COMMAND
25770 @item gdb.COMPLETE_COMMAND
25771 This constant means that completion should examine @value{GDBN}
25774 @findex COMPLETE_SYMBOL
25775 @findex gdb.COMPLETE_SYMBOL
25776 @item gdb.COMPLETE_SYMBOL
25777 This constant means that completion should be done using symbol names
25781 The following code snippet shows how a trivial CLI command can be
25782 implemented in Python:
25785 class HelloWorld (gdb.Command):
25786 """Greet the whole world."""
25788 def __init__ (self):
25789 super (HelloWorld, self).__init__ ("hello-world", gdb.COMMAND_USER)
25791 def invoke (self, arg, from_tty):
25792 print "Hello, World!"
25797 The last line instantiates the class, and is necessary to trigger the
25798 registration of the command with @value{GDBN}. Depending on how the
25799 Python code is read into @value{GDBN}, you may need to import the
25800 @code{gdb} module explicitly.
25802 @node Parameters In Python
25803 @subsubsection Parameters In Python
25805 @cindex parameters in python
25806 @cindex python parameters
25807 @tindex gdb.Parameter
25809 You can implement new @value{GDBN} parameters using Python. A new
25810 parameter is implemented as an instance of the @code{gdb.Parameter}
25813 Parameters are exposed to the user via the @code{set} and
25814 @code{show} commands. @xref{Help}.
25816 There are many parameters that already exist and can be set in
25817 @value{GDBN}. Two examples are: @code{set follow fork} and
25818 @code{set charset}. Setting these parameters influences certain
25819 behavior in @value{GDBN}. Similarly, you can define parameters that
25820 can be used to influence behavior in custom Python scripts and commands.
25822 @defun Parameter.__init__ (name, @var{command-class}, @var{parameter-class} @r{[}, @var{enum-sequence}@r{]})
25823 The object initializer for @code{Parameter} registers the new
25824 parameter with @value{GDBN}. This initializer is normally invoked
25825 from the subclass' own @code{__init__} method.
25827 @var{name} is the name of the new parameter. If @var{name} consists
25828 of multiple words, then the initial words are looked for as prefix
25829 parameters. An example of this can be illustrated with the
25830 @code{set print} set of parameters. If @var{name} is
25831 @code{print foo}, then @code{print} will be searched as the prefix
25832 parameter. In this case the parameter can subsequently be accessed in
25833 @value{GDBN} as @code{set print foo}.
25835 If @var{name} consists of multiple words, and no prefix parameter group
25836 can be found, an exception is raised.
25838 @var{command-class} should be one of the @samp{COMMAND_} constants
25839 (@pxref{Commands In Python}). This argument tells @value{GDBN} how to
25840 categorize the new parameter in the help system.
25842 @var{parameter-class} should be one of the @samp{PARAM_} constants
25843 defined below. This argument tells @value{GDBN} the type of the new
25844 parameter; this information is used for input validation and
25847 If @var{parameter-class} is @code{PARAM_ENUM}, then
25848 @var{enum-sequence} must be a sequence of strings. These strings
25849 represent the possible values for the parameter.
25851 If @var{parameter-class} is not @code{PARAM_ENUM}, then the presence
25852 of a fourth argument will cause an exception to be thrown.
25854 The help text for the new parameter is taken from the Python
25855 documentation string for the parameter's class, if there is one. If
25856 there is no documentation string, a default value is used.
25859 @defvar Parameter.set_doc
25860 If this attribute exists, and is a string, then its value is used as
25861 the help text for this parameter's @code{set} command. The value is
25862 examined when @code{Parameter.__init__} is invoked; subsequent changes
25866 @defvar Parameter.show_doc
25867 If this attribute exists, and is a string, then its value is used as
25868 the help text for this parameter's @code{show} command. The value is
25869 examined when @code{Parameter.__init__} is invoked; subsequent changes
25873 @defvar Parameter.value
25874 The @code{value} attribute holds the underlying value of the
25875 parameter. It can be read and assigned to just as any other
25876 attribute. @value{GDBN} does validation when assignments are made.
25879 There are two methods that should be implemented in any
25880 @code{Parameter} class. These are:
25882 @defun Parameter.get_set_string (self)
25883 @value{GDBN} will call this method when a @var{parameter}'s value has
25884 been changed via the @code{set} API (for example, @kbd{set foo off}).
25885 The @code{value} attribute has already been populated with the new
25886 value and may be used in output. This method must return a string.
25889 @defun Parameter.get_show_string (self, svalue)
25890 @value{GDBN} will call this method when a @var{parameter}'s
25891 @code{show} API has been invoked (for example, @kbd{show foo}). The
25892 argument @code{svalue} receives the string representation of the
25893 current value. This method must return a string.
25896 When a new parameter is defined, its type must be specified. The
25897 available types are represented by constants defined in the @code{gdb}
25901 @findex PARAM_BOOLEAN
25902 @findex gdb.PARAM_BOOLEAN
25903 @item gdb.PARAM_BOOLEAN
25904 The value is a plain boolean. The Python boolean values, @code{True}
25905 and @code{False} are the only valid values.
25907 @findex PARAM_AUTO_BOOLEAN
25908 @findex gdb.PARAM_AUTO_BOOLEAN
25909 @item gdb.PARAM_AUTO_BOOLEAN
25910 The value has three possible states: true, false, and @samp{auto}. In
25911 Python, true and false are represented using boolean constants, and
25912 @samp{auto} is represented using @code{None}.
25914 @findex PARAM_UINTEGER
25915 @findex gdb.PARAM_UINTEGER
25916 @item gdb.PARAM_UINTEGER
25917 The value is an unsigned integer. The value of 0 should be
25918 interpreted to mean ``unlimited''.
25920 @findex PARAM_INTEGER
25921 @findex gdb.PARAM_INTEGER
25922 @item gdb.PARAM_INTEGER
25923 The value is a signed integer. The value of 0 should be interpreted
25924 to mean ``unlimited''.
25926 @findex PARAM_STRING
25927 @findex gdb.PARAM_STRING
25928 @item gdb.PARAM_STRING
25929 The value is a string. When the user modifies the string, any escape
25930 sequences, such as @samp{\t}, @samp{\f}, and octal escapes, are
25931 translated into corresponding characters and encoded into the current
25934 @findex PARAM_STRING_NOESCAPE
25935 @findex gdb.PARAM_STRING_NOESCAPE
25936 @item gdb.PARAM_STRING_NOESCAPE
25937 The value is a string. When the user modifies the string, escapes are
25938 passed through untranslated.
25940 @findex PARAM_OPTIONAL_FILENAME
25941 @findex gdb.PARAM_OPTIONAL_FILENAME
25942 @item gdb.PARAM_OPTIONAL_FILENAME
25943 The value is a either a filename (a string), or @code{None}.
25945 @findex PARAM_FILENAME
25946 @findex gdb.PARAM_FILENAME
25947 @item gdb.PARAM_FILENAME
25948 The value is a filename. This is just like
25949 @code{PARAM_STRING_NOESCAPE}, but uses file names for completion.
25951 @findex PARAM_ZINTEGER
25952 @findex gdb.PARAM_ZINTEGER
25953 @item gdb.PARAM_ZINTEGER
25954 The value is an integer. This is like @code{PARAM_INTEGER}, except 0
25955 is interpreted as itself.
25958 @findex gdb.PARAM_ENUM
25959 @item gdb.PARAM_ENUM
25960 The value is a string, which must be one of a collection string
25961 constants provided when the parameter is created.
25964 @node Functions In Python
25965 @subsubsection Writing new convenience functions
25967 @cindex writing convenience functions
25968 @cindex convenience functions in python
25969 @cindex python convenience functions
25970 @tindex gdb.Function
25972 You can implement new convenience functions (@pxref{Convenience Vars})
25973 in Python. A convenience function is an instance of a subclass of the
25974 class @code{gdb.Function}.
25976 @defun Function.__init__ (name)
25977 The initializer for @code{Function} registers the new function with
25978 @value{GDBN}. The argument @var{name} is the name of the function,
25979 a string. The function will be visible to the user as a convenience
25980 variable of type @code{internal function}, whose name is the same as
25981 the given @var{name}.
25983 The documentation for the new function is taken from the documentation
25984 string for the new class.
25987 @defun Function.invoke (@var{*args})
25988 When a convenience function is evaluated, its arguments are converted
25989 to instances of @code{gdb.Value}, and then the function's
25990 @code{invoke} method is called. Note that @value{GDBN} does not
25991 predetermine the arity of convenience functions. Instead, all
25992 available arguments are passed to @code{invoke}, following the
25993 standard Python calling convention. In particular, a convenience
25994 function can have default values for parameters without ill effect.
25996 The return value of this method is used as its value in the enclosing
25997 expression. If an ordinary Python value is returned, it is converted
25998 to a @code{gdb.Value} following the usual rules.
26001 The following code snippet shows how a trivial convenience function can
26002 be implemented in Python:
26005 class Greet (gdb.Function):
26006 """Return string to greet someone.
26007 Takes a name as argument."""
26009 def __init__ (self):
26010 super (Greet, self).__init__ ("greet")
26012 def invoke (self, name):
26013 return "Hello, %s!" % name.string ()
26018 The last line instantiates the class, and is necessary to trigger the
26019 registration of the function with @value{GDBN}. Depending on how the
26020 Python code is read into @value{GDBN}, you may need to import the
26021 @code{gdb} module explicitly.
26023 Now you can use the function in an expression:
26026 (gdb) print $greet("Bob")
26030 @node Progspaces In Python
26031 @subsubsection Program Spaces In Python
26033 @cindex progspaces in python
26034 @tindex gdb.Progspace
26036 A program space, or @dfn{progspace}, represents a symbolic view
26037 of an address space.
26038 It consists of all of the objfiles of the program.
26039 @xref{Objfiles In Python}.
26040 @xref{Inferiors and Programs, program spaces}, for more details
26041 about program spaces.
26043 The following progspace-related functions are available in the
26046 @findex gdb.current_progspace
26047 @defun gdb.current_progspace ()
26048 This function returns the program space of the currently selected inferior.
26049 @xref{Inferiors and Programs}.
26052 @findex gdb.progspaces
26053 @defun gdb.progspaces ()
26054 Return a sequence of all the progspaces currently known to @value{GDBN}.
26057 Each progspace is represented by an instance of the @code{gdb.Progspace}
26060 @defvar Progspace.filename
26061 The file name of the progspace as a string.
26064 @defvar Progspace.pretty_printers
26065 The @code{pretty_printers} attribute is a list of functions. It is
26066 used to look up pretty-printers. A @code{Value} is passed to each
26067 function in order; if the function returns @code{None}, then the
26068 search continues. Otherwise, the return value should be an object
26069 which is used to format the value. @xref{Pretty Printing API}, for more
26073 @defvar Progspace.type_printers
26074 The @code{type_printers} attribute is a list of type printer objects.
26075 @xref{Type Printing API}, for more information.
26078 @defvar Progspace.frame_filters
26079 The @code{frame_filters} attribute is a dictionary of frame filter
26080 objects. @xref{Frame Filter API}, for more information.
26083 @node Objfiles In Python
26084 @subsubsection Objfiles In Python
26086 @cindex objfiles in python
26087 @tindex gdb.Objfile
26089 @value{GDBN} loads symbols for an inferior from various
26090 symbol-containing files (@pxref{Files}). These include the primary
26091 executable file, any shared libraries used by the inferior, and any
26092 separate debug info files (@pxref{Separate Debug Files}).
26093 @value{GDBN} calls these symbol-containing files @dfn{objfiles}.
26095 The following objfile-related functions are available in the
26098 @findex gdb.current_objfile
26099 @defun gdb.current_objfile ()
26100 When auto-loading a Python script (@pxref{Python Auto-loading}), @value{GDBN}
26101 sets the ``current objfile'' to the corresponding objfile. This
26102 function returns the current objfile. If there is no current objfile,
26103 this function returns @code{None}.
26106 @findex gdb.objfiles
26107 @defun gdb.objfiles ()
26108 Return a sequence of all the objfiles current known to @value{GDBN}.
26109 @xref{Objfiles In Python}.
26112 Each objfile is represented by an instance of the @code{gdb.Objfile}
26115 @defvar Objfile.filename
26116 The file name of the objfile as a string.
26119 @defvar Objfile.pretty_printers
26120 The @code{pretty_printers} attribute is a list of functions. It is
26121 used to look up pretty-printers. A @code{Value} is passed to each
26122 function in order; if the function returns @code{None}, then the
26123 search continues. Otherwise, the return value should be an object
26124 which is used to format the value. @xref{Pretty Printing API}, for more
26128 @defvar Objfile.type_printers
26129 The @code{type_printers} attribute is a list of type printer objects.
26130 @xref{Type Printing API}, for more information.
26133 @defvar Objfile.frame_filters
26134 The @code{frame_filters} attribute is a dictionary of frame filter
26135 objects. @xref{Frame Filter API}, for more information.
26138 A @code{gdb.Objfile} object has the following methods:
26140 @defun Objfile.is_valid ()
26141 Returns @code{True} if the @code{gdb.Objfile} object is valid,
26142 @code{False} if not. A @code{gdb.Objfile} object can become invalid
26143 if the object file it refers to is not loaded in @value{GDBN} any
26144 longer. All other @code{gdb.Objfile} methods will throw an exception
26145 if it is invalid at the time the method is called.
26148 @node Frames In Python
26149 @subsubsection Accessing inferior stack frames from Python.
26151 @cindex frames in python
26152 When the debugged program stops, @value{GDBN} is able to analyze its call
26153 stack (@pxref{Frames,,Stack frames}). The @code{gdb.Frame} class
26154 represents a frame in the stack. A @code{gdb.Frame} object is only valid
26155 while its corresponding frame exists in the inferior's stack. If you try
26156 to use an invalid frame object, @value{GDBN} will throw a @code{gdb.error}
26157 exception (@pxref{Exception Handling}).
26159 Two @code{gdb.Frame} objects can be compared for equality with the @code{==}
26163 (@value{GDBP}) python print gdb.newest_frame() == gdb.selected_frame ()
26167 The following frame-related functions are available in the @code{gdb} module:
26169 @findex gdb.selected_frame
26170 @defun gdb.selected_frame ()
26171 Return the selected frame object. (@pxref{Selection,,Selecting a Frame}).
26174 @findex gdb.newest_frame
26175 @defun gdb.newest_frame ()
26176 Return the newest frame object for the selected thread.
26179 @defun gdb.frame_stop_reason_string (reason)
26180 Return a string explaining the reason why @value{GDBN} stopped unwinding
26181 frames, as expressed by the given @var{reason} code (an integer, see the
26182 @code{unwind_stop_reason} method further down in this section).
26185 A @code{gdb.Frame} object has the following methods:
26187 @defun Frame.is_valid ()
26188 Returns true if the @code{gdb.Frame} object is valid, false if not.
26189 A frame object can become invalid if the frame it refers to doesn't
26190 exist anymore in the inferior. All @code{gdb.Frame} methods will throw
26191 an exception if it is invalid at the time the method is called.
26194 @defun Frame.name ()
26195 Returns the function name of the frame, or @code{None} if it can't be
26199 @defun Frame.architecture ()
26200 Returns the @code{gdb.Architecture} object corresponding to the frame's
26201 architecture. @xref{Architectures In Python}.
26204 @defun Frame.type ()
26205 Returns the type of the frame. The value can be one of:
26207 @item gdb.NORMAL_FRAME
26208 An ordinary stack frame.
26210 @item gdb.DUMMY_FRAME
26211 A fake stack frame that was created by @value{GDBN} when performing an
26212 inferior function call.
26214 @item gdb.INLINE_FRAME
26215 A frame representing an inlined function. The function was inlined
26216 into a @code{gdb.NORMAL_FRAME} that is older than this one.
26218 @item gdb.TAILCALL_FRAME
26219 A frame representing a tail call. @xref{Tail Call Frames}.
26221 @item gdb.SIGTRAMP_FRAME
26222 A signal trampoline frame. This is the frame created by the OS when
26223 it calls into a signal handler.
26225 @item gdb.ARCH_FRAME
26226 A fake stack frame representing a cross-architecture call.
26228 @item gdb.SENTINEL_FRAME
26229 This is like @code{gdb.NORMAL_FRAME}, but it is only used for the
26234 @defun Frame.unwind_stop_reason ()
26235 Return an integer representing the reason why it's not possible to find
26236 more frames toward the outermost frame. Use
26237 @code{gdb.frame_stop_reason_string} to convert the value returned by this
26238 function to a string. The value can be one of:
26241 @item gdb.FRAME_UNWIND_NO_REASON
26242 No particular reason (older frames should be available).
26244 @item gdb.FRAME_UNWIND_NULL_ID
26245 The previous frame's analyzer returns an invalid result.
26247 @item gdb.FRAME_UNWIND_OUTERMOST
26248 This frame is the outermost.
26250 @item gdb.FRAME_UNWIND_UNAVAILABLE
26251 Cannot unwind further, because that would require knowing the
26252 values of registers or memory that have not been collected.
26254 @item gdb.FRAME_UNWIND_INNER_ID
26255 This frame ID looks like it ought to belong to a NEXT frame,
26256 but we got it for a PREV frame. Normally, this is a sign of
26257 unwinder failure. It could also indicate stack corruption.
26259 @item gdb.FRAME_UNWIND_SAME_ID
26260 This frame has the same ID as the previous one. That means
26261 that unwinding further would almost certainly give us another
26262 frame with exactly the same ID, so break the chain. Normally,
26263 this is a sign of unwinder failure. It could also indicate
26266 @item gdb.FRAME_UNWIND_NO_SAVED_PC
26267 The frame unwinder did not find any saved PC, but we needed
26268 one to unwind further.
26270 @item gdb.FRAME_UNWIND_FIRST_ERROR
26271 Any stop reason greater or equal to this value indicates some kind
26272 of error. This special value facilitates writing code that tests
26273 for errors in unwinding in a way that will work correctly even if
26274 the list of the other values is modified in future @value{GDBN}
26275 versions. Using it, you could write:
26277 reason = gdb.selected_frame().unwind_stop_reason ()
26278 reason_str = gdb.frame_stop_reason_string (reason)
26279 if reason >= gdb.FRAME_UNWIND_FIRST_ERROR:
26280 print "An error occured: %s" % reason_str
26287 Returns the frame's resume address.
26290 @defun Frame.block ()
26291 Return the frame's code block. @xref{Blocks In Python}.
26294 @defun Frame.function ()
26295 Return the symbol for the function corresponding to this frame.
26296 @xref{Symbols In Python}.
26299 @defun Frame.older ()
26300 Return the frame that called this frame.
26303 @defun Frame.newer ()
26304 Return the frame called by this frame.
26307 @defun Frame.find_sal ()
26308 Return the frame's symtab and line object.
26309 @xref{Symbol Tables In Python}.
26312 @defun Frame.read_var (variable @r{[}, block@r{]})
26313 Return the value of @var{variable} in this frame. If the optional
26314 argument @var{block} is provided, search for the variable from that
26315 block; otherwise start at the frame's current block (which is
26316 determined by the frame's current program counter). @var{variable}
26317 must be a string or a @code{gdb.Symbol} object. @var{block} must be a
26318 @code{gdb.Block} object.
26321 @defun Frame.select ()
26322 Set this frame to be the selected frame. @xref{Stack, ,Examining the
26326 @node Blocks In Python
26327 @subsubsection Accessing blocks from Python.
26329 @cindex blocks in python
26332 In @value{GDBN}, symbols are stored in blocks. A block corresponds
26333 roughly to a scope in the source code. Blocks are organized
26334 hierarchically, and are represented individually in Python as a
26335 @code{gdb.Block}. Blocks rely on debugging information being
26338 A frame has a block. Please see @ref{Frames In Python}, for a more
26339 in-depth discussion of frames.
26341 The outermost block is known as the @dfn{global block}. The global
26342 block typically holds public global variables and functions.
26344 The block nested just inside the global block is the @dfn{static
26345 block}. The static block typically holds file-scoped variables and
26348 @value{GDBN} provides a method to get a block's superblock, but there
26349 is currently no way to examine the sub-blocks of a block, or to
26350 iterate over all the blocks in a symbol table (@pxref{Symbol Tables In
26353 Here is a short example that should help explain blocks:
26356 /* This is in the global block. */
26359 /* This is in the static block. */
26360 static int file_scope;
26362 /* 'function' is in the global block, and 'argument' is
26363 in a block nested inside of 'function'. */
26364 int function (int argument)
26366 /* 'local' is in a block inside 'function'. It may or may
26367 not be in the same block as 'argument'. */
26371 /* 'inner' is in a block whose superblock is the one holding
26375 /* If this call is expanded by the compiler, you may see
26376 a nested block here whose function is 'inline_function'
26377 and whose superblock is the one holding 'inner'. */
26378 inline_function ();
26383 A @code{gdb.Block} is iterable. The iterator returns the symbols
26384 (@pxref{Symbols In Python}) local to the block. Python programs
26385 should not assume that a specific block object will always contain a
26386 given symbol, since changes in @value{GDBN} features and
26387 infrastructure may cause symbols move across blocks in a symbol
26390 The following block-related functions are available in the @code{gdb}
26393 @findex gdb.block_for_pc
26394 @defun gdb.block_for_pc (pc)
26395 Return the innermost @code{gdb.Block} containing the given @var{pc}
26396 value. If the block cannot be found for the @var{pc} value specified,
26397 the function will return @code{None}.
26400 A @code{gdb.Block} object has the following methods:
26402 @defun Block.is_valid ()
26403 Returns @code{True} if the @code{gdb.Block} object is valid,
26404 @code{False} if not. A block object can become invalid if the block it
26405 refers to doesn't exist anymore in the inferior. All other
26406 @code{gdb.Block} methods will throw an exception if it is invalid at
26407 the time the method is called. The block's validity is also checked
26408 during iteration over symbols of the block.
26411 A @code{gdb.Block} object has the following attributes:
26413 @defvar Block.start
26414 The start address of the block. This attribute is not writable.
26418 The end address of the block. This attribute is not writable.
26421 @defvar Block.function
26422 The name of the block represented as a @code{gdb.Symbol}. If the
26423 block is not named, then this attribute holds @code{None}. This
26424 attribute is not writable.
26426 For ordinary function blocks, the superblock is the static block.
26427 However, you should note that it is possible for a function block to
26428 have a superblock that is not the static block -- for instance this
26429 happens for an inlined function.
26432 @defvar Block.superblock
26433 The block containing this block. If this parent block does not exist,
26434 this attribute holds @code{None}. This attribute is not writable.
26437 @defvar Block.global_block
26438 The global block associated with this block. This attribute is not
26442 @defvar Block.static_block
26443 The static block associated with this block. This attribute is not
26447 @defvar Block.is_global
26448 @code{True} if the @code{gdb.Block} object is a global block,
26449 @code{False} if not. This attribute is not
26453 @defvar Block.is_static
26454 @code{True} if the @code{gdb.Block} object is a static block,
26455 @code{False} if not. This attribute is not writable.
26458 @node Symbols In Python
26459 @subsubsection Python representation of Symbols.
26461 @cindex symbols in python
26464 @value{GDBN} represents every variable, function and type as an
26465 entry in a symbol table. @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}.
26466 Similarly, Python represents these symbols in @value{GDBN} with the
26467 @code{gdb.Symbol} object.
26469 The following symbol-related functions are available in the @code{gdb}
26472 @findex gdb.lookup_symbol
26473 @defun gdb.lookup_symbol (name @r{[}, block @r{[}, domain@r{]]})
26474 This function searches for a symbol by name. The search scope can be
26475 restricted to the parameters defined in the optional domain and block
26478 @var{name} is the name of the symbol. It must be a string. The
26479 optional @var{block} argument restricts the search to symbols visible
26480 in that @var{block}. The @var{block} argument must be a
26481 @code{gdb.Block} object. If omitted, the block for the current frame
26482 is used. The optional @var{domain} argument restricts
26483 the search to the domain type. The @var{domain} argument must be a
26484 domain constant defined in the @code{gdb} module and described later
26487 The result is a tuple of two elements.
26488 The first element is a @code{gdb.Symbol} object or @code{None} if the symbol
26490 If the symbol is found, the second element is @code{True} if the symbol
26491 is a field of a method's object (e.g., @code{this} in C@t{++}),
26492 otherwise it is @code{False}.
26493 If the symbol is not found, the second element is @code{False}.
26496 @findex gdb.lookup_global_symbol
26497 @defun gdb.lookup_global_symbol (name @r{[}, domain@r{]})
26498 This function searches for a global symbol by name.
26499 The search scope can be restricted to by the domain argument.
26501 @var{name} is the name of the symbol. It must be a string.
26502 The optional @var{domain} argument restricts the search to the domain type.
26503 The @var{domain} argument must be a domain constant defined in the @code{gdb}
26504 module and described later in this chapter.
26506 The result is a @code{gdb.Symbol} object or @code{None} if the symbol
26510 A @code{gdb.Symbol} object has the following attributes:
26512 @defvar Symbol.type
26513 The type of the symbol or @code{None} if no type is recorded.
26514 This attribute is represented as a @code{gdb.Type} object.
26515 @xref{Types In Python}. This attribute is not writable.
26518 @defvar Symbol.symtab
26519 The symbol table in which the symbol appears. This attribute is
26520 represented as a @code{gdb.Symtab} object. @xref{Symbol Tables In
26521 Python}. This attribute is not writable.
26524 @defvar Symbol.line
26525 The line number in the source code at which the symbol was defined.
26526 This is an integer.
26529 @defvar Symbol.name
26530 The name of the symbol as a string. This attribute is not writable.
26533 @defvar Symbol.linkage_name
26534 The name of the symbol, as used by the linker (i.e., may be mangled).
26535 This attribute is not writable.
26538 @defvar Symbol.print_name
26539 The name of the symbol in a form suitable for output. This is either
26540 @code{name} or @code{linkage_name}, depending on whether the user
26541 asked @value{GDBN} to display demangled or mangled names.
26544 @defvar Symbol.addr_class
26545 The address class of the symbol. This classifies how to find the value
26546 of a symbol. Each address class is a constant defined in the
26547 @code{gdb} module and described later in this chapter.
26550 @defvar Symbol.needs_frame
26551 This is @code{True} if evaluating this symbol's value requires a frame
26552 (@pxref{Frames In Python}) and @code{False} otherwise. Typically,
26553 local variables will require a frame, but other symbols will not.
26556 @defvar Symbol.is_argument
26557 @code{True} if the symbol is an argument of a function.
26560 @defvar Symbol.is_constant
26561 @code{True} if the symbol is a constant.
26564 @defvar Symbol.is_function
26565 @code{True} if the symbol is a function or a method.
26568 @defvar Symbol.is_variable
26569 @code{True} if the symbol is a variable.
26572 A @code{gdb.Symbol} object has the following methods:
26574 @defun Symbol.is_valid ()
26575 Returns @code{True} if the @code{gdb.Symbol} object is valid,
26576 @code{False} if not. A @code{gdb.Symbol} object can become invalid if
26577 the symbol it refers to does not exist in @value{GDBN} any longer.
26578 All other @code{gdb.Symbol} methods will throw an exception if it is
26579 invalid at the time the method is called.
26582 @defun Symbol.value (@r{[}frame@r{]})
26583 Compute the value of the symbol, as a @code{gdb.Value}. For
26584 functions, this computes the address of the function, cast to the
26585 appropriate type. If the symbol requires a frame in order to compute
26586 its value, then @var{frame} must be given. If @var{frame} is not
26587 given, or if @var{frame} is invalid, then this method will throw an
26591 The available domain categories in @code{gdb.Symbol} are represented
26592 as constants in the @code{gdb} module:
26595 @findex SYMBOL_UNDEF_DOMAIN
26596 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_UNDEF_DOMAIN
26597 @item gdb.SYMBOL_UNDEF_DOMAIN
26598 This is used when a domain has not been discovered or none of the
26599 following domains apply. This usually indicates an error either
26600 in the symbol information or in @value{GDBN}'s handling of symbols.
26601 @findex SYMBOL_VAR_DOMAIN
26602 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_VAR_DOMAIN
26603 @item gdb.SYMBOL_VAR_DOMAIN
26604 This domain contains variables, function names, typedef names and enum
26606 @findex SYMBOL_STRUCT_DOMAIN
26607 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_STRUCT_DOMAIN
26608 @item gdb.SYMBOL_STRUCT_DOMAIN
26609 This domain holds struct, union and enum type names.
26610 @findex SYMBOL_LABEL_DOMAIN
26611 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_LABEL_DOMAIN
26612 @item gdb.SYMBOL_LABEL_DOMAIN
26613 This domain contains names of labels (for gotos).
26614 @findex SYMBOL_VARIABLES_DOMAIN
26615 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_VARIABLES_DOMAIN
26616 @item gdb.SYMBOL_VARIABLES_DOMAIN
26617 This domain holds a subset of the @code{SYMBOLS_VAR_DOMAIN}; it
26618 contains everything minus functions and types.
26619 @findex SYMBOL_FUNCTIONS_DOMAIN
26620 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_FUNCTIONS_DOMAIN
26621 @item gdb.SYMBOL_FUNCTION_DOMAIN
26622 This domain contains all functions.
26623 @findex SYMBOL_TYPES_DOMAIN
26624 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_TYPES_DOMAIN
26625 @item gdb.SYMBOL_TYPES_DOMAIN
26626 This domain contains all types.
26629 The available address class categories in @code{gdb.Symbol} are represented
26630 as constants in the @code{gdb} module:
26633 @findex SYMBOL_LOC_UNDEF
26634 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_UNDEF
26635 @item gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_UNDEF
26636 If this is returned by address class, it indicates an error either in
26637 the symbol information or in @value{GDBN}'s handling of symbols.
26638 @findex SYMBOL_LOC_CONST
26639 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_CONST
26640 @item gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_CONST
26641 Value is constant int.
26642 @findex SYMBOL_LOC_STATIC
26643 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_STATIC
26644 @item gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_STATIC
26645 Value is at a fixed address.
26646 @findex SYMBOL_LOC_REGISTER
26647 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_REGISTER
26648 @item gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_REGISTER
26649 Value is in a register.
26650 @findex SYMBOL_LOC_ARG
26651 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_ARG
26652 @item gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_ARG
26653 Value is an argument. This value is at the offset stored within the
26654 symbol inside the frame's argument list.
26655 @findex SYMBOL_LOC_REF_ARG
26656 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_REF_ARG
26657 @item gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_REF_ARG
26658 Value address is stored in the frame's argument list. Just like
26659 @code{LOC_ARG} except that the value's address is stored at the
26660 offset, not the value itself.
26661 @findex SYMBOL_LOC_REGPARM_ADDR
26662 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_REGPARM_ADDR
26663 @item gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_REGPARM_ADDR
26664 Value is a specified register. Just like @code{LOC_REGISTER} except
26665 the register holds the address of the argument instead of the argument
26667 @findex SYMBOL_LOC_LOCAL
26668 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_LOCAL
26669 @item gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_LOCAL
26670 Value is a local variable.
26671 @findex SYMBOL_LOC_TYPEDEF
26672 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_TYPEDEF
26673 @item gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_TYPEDEF
26674 Value not used. Symbols in the domain @code{SYMBOL_STRUCT_DOMAIN} all
26676 @findex SYMBOL_LOC_BLOCK
26677 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_BLOCK
26678 @item gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_BLOCK
26680 @findex SYMBOL_LOC_CONST_BYTES
26681 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_CONST_BYTES
26682 @item gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_CONST_BYTES
26683 Value is a byte-sequence.
26684 @findex SYMBOL_LOC_UNRESOLVED
26685 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_UNRESOLVED
26686 @item gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_UNRESOLVED
26687 Value is at a fixed address, but the address of the variable has to be
26688 determined from the minimal symbol table whenever the variable is
26690 @findex SYMBOL_LOC_OPTIMIZED_OUT
26691 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_OPTIMIZED_OUT
26692 @item gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_OPTIMIZED_OUT
26693 The value does not actually exist in the program.
26694 @findex SYMBOL_LOC_COMPUTED
26695 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_COMPUTED
26696 @item gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_COMPUTED
26697 The value's address is a computed location.
26700 @node Symbol Tables In Python
26701 @subsubsection Symbol table representation in Python.
26703 @cindex symbol tables in python
26705 @tindex gdb.Symtab_and_line
26707 Access to symbol table data maintained by @value{GDBN} on the inferior
26708 is exposed to Python via two objects: @code{gdb.Symtab_and_line} and
26709 @code{gdb.Symtab}. Symbol table and line data for a frame is returned
26710 from the @code{find_sal} method in @code{gdb.Frame} object.
26711 @xref{Frames In Python}.
26713 For more information on @value{GDBN}'s symbol table management, see
26714 @ref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}, for more information.
26716 A @code{gdb.Symtab_and_line} object has the following attributes:
26718 @defvar Symtab_and_line.symtab
26719 The symbol table object (@code{gdb.Symtab}) for this frame.
26720 This attribute is not writable.
26723 @defvar Symtab_and_line.pc
26724 Indicates the start of the address range occupied by code for the
26725 current source line. This attribute is not writable.
26728 @defvar Symtab_and_line.last
26729 Indicates the end of the address range occupied by code for the current
26730 source line. This attribute is not writable.
26733 @defvar Symtab_and_line.line
26734 Indicates the current line number for this object. This
26735 attribute is not writable.
26738 A @code{gdb.Symtab_and_line} object has the following methods:
26740 @defun Symtab_and_line.is_valid ()
26741 Returns @code{True} if the @code{gdb.Symtab_and_line} object is valid,
26742 @code{False} if not. A @code{gdb.Symtab_and_line} object can become
26743 invalid if the Symbol table and line object it refers to does not
26744 exist in @value{GDBN} any longer. All other
26745 @code{gdb.Symtab_and_line} methods will throw an exception if it is
26746 invalid at the time the method is called.
26749 A @code{gdb.Symtab} object has the following attributes:
26751 @defvar Symtab.filename
26752 The symbol table's source filename. This attribute is not writable.
26755 @defvar Symtab.objfile
26756 The symbol table's backing object file. @xref{Objfiles In Python}.
26757 This attribute is not writable.
26760 A @code{gdb.Symtab} object has the following methods:
26762 @defun Symtab.is_valid ()
26763 Returns @code{True} if the @code{gdb.Symtab} object is valid,
26764 @code{False} if not. A @code{gdb.Symtab} object can become invalid if
26765 the symbol table it refers to does not exist in @value{GDBN} any
26766 longer. All other @code{gdb.Symtab} methods will throw an exception
26767 if it is invalid at the time the method is called.
26770 @defun Symtab.fullname ()
26771 Return the symbol table's source absolute file name.
26774 @defun Symtab.global_block ()
26775 Return the global block of the underlying symbol table.
26776 @xref{Blocks In Python}.
26779 @defun Symtab.static_block ()
26780 Return the static block of the underlying symbol table.
26781 @xref{Blocks In Python}.
26784 @node Breakpoints In Python
26785 @subsubsection Manipulating breakpoints using Python
26787 @cindex breakpoints in python
26788 @tindex gdb.Breakpoint
26790 Python code can manipulate breakpoints via the @code{gdb.Breakpoint}
26793 @defun Breakpoint.__init__ (spec @r{[}, type @r{[}, wp_class @r{[},internal@r{]]]})
26794 Create a new breakpoint. @var{spec} is a string naming the
26795 location of the breakpoint, or an expression that defines a
26796 watchpoint. The contents can be any location recognized by the
26797 @code{break} command, or in the case of a watchpoint, by the @code{watch}
26798 command. The optional @var{type} denotes the breakpoint to create
26799 from the types defined later in this chapter. This argument can be
26800 either: @code{gdb.BP_BREAKPOINT} or @code{gdb.BP_WATCHPOINT}. @var{type}
26801 defaults to @code{gdb.BP_BREAKPOINT}. The optional @var{internal} argument
26802 allows the breakpoint to become invisible to the user. The breakpoint
26803 will neither be reported when created, nor will it be listed in the
26804 output from @code{info breakpoints} (but will be listed with the
26805 @code{maint info breakpoints} command). The optional @var{wp_class}
26806 argument defines the class of watchpoint to create, if @var{type} is
26807 @code{gdb.BP_WATCHPOINT}. If a watchpoint class is not provided, it is
26808 assumed to be a @code{gdb.WP_WRITE} class.
26811 @defun Breakpoint.stop (self)
26812 The @code{gdb.Breakpoint} class can be sub-classed and, in
26813 particular, you may choose to implement the @code{stop} method.
26814 If this method is defined as a sub-class of @code{gdb.Breakpoint},
26815 it will be called when the inferior reaches any location of a
26816 breakpoint which instantiates that sub-class. If the method returns
26817 @code{True}, the inferior will be stopped at the location of the
26818 breakpoint, otherwise the inferior will continue.
26820 If there are multiple breakpoints at the same location with a
26821 @code{stop} method, each one will be called regardless of the
26822 return status of the previous. This ensures that all @code{stop}
26823 methods have a chance to execute at that location. In this scenario
26824 if one of the methods returns @code{True} but the others return
26825 @code{False}, the inferior will still be stopped.
26827 You should not alter the execution state of the inferior (i.e.@:, step,
26828 next, etc.), alter the current frame context (i.e.@:, change the current
26829 active frame), or alter, add or delete any breakpoint. As a general
26830 rule, you should not alter any data within @value{GDBN} or the inferior
26833 Example @code{stop} implementation:
26836 class MyBreakpoint (gdb.Breakpoint):
26838 inf_val = gdb.parse_and_eval("foo")
26845 The available watchpoint types represented by constants are defined in the
26850 @findex gdb.WP_READ
26852 Read only watchpoint.
26855 @findex gdb.WP_WRITE
26857 Write only watchpoint.
26860 @findex gdb.WP_ACCESS
26861 @item gdb.WP_ACCESS
26862 Read/Write watchpoint.
26865 @defun Breakpoint.is_valid ()
26866 Return @code{True} if this @code{Breakpoint} object is valid,
26867 @code{False} otherwise. A @code{Breakpoint} object can become invalid
26868 if the user deletes the breakpoint. In this case, the object still
26869 exists, but the underlying breakpoint does not. In the cases of
26870 watchpoint scope, the watchpoint remains valid even if execution of the
26871 inferior leaves the scope of that watchpoint.
26874 @defun Breakpoint.delete
26875 Permanently deletes the @value{GDBN} breakpoint. This also
26876 invalidates the Python @code{Breakpoint} object. Any further access
26877 to this object's attributes or methods will raise an error.
26880 @defvar Breakpoint.enabled
26881 This attribute is @code{True} if the breakpoint is enabled, and
26882 @code{False} otherwise. This attribute is writable.
26885 @defvar Breakpoint.silent
26886 This attribute is @code{True} if the breakpoint is silent, and
26887 @code{False} otherwise. This attribute is writable.
26889 Note that a breakpoint can also be silent if it has commands and the
26890 first command is @code{silent}. This is not reported by the
26891 @code{silent} attribute.
26894 @defvar Breakpoint.thread
26895 If the breakpoint is thread-specific, this attribute holds the thread
26896 id. If the breakpoint is not thread-specific, this attribute is
26897 @code{None}. This attribute is writable.
26900 @defvar Breakpoint.task
26901 If the breakpoint is Ada task-specific, this attribute holds the Ada task
26902 id. If the breakpoint is not task-specific (or the underlying
26903 language is not Ada), this attribute is @code{None}. This attribute
26907 @defvar Breakpoint.ignore_count
26908 This attribute holds the ignore count for the breakpoint, an integer.
26909 This attribute is writable.
26912 @defvar Breakpoint.number
26913 This attribute holds the breakpoint's number --- the identifier used by
26914 the user to manipulate the breakpoint. This attribute is not writable.
26917 @defvar Breakpoint.type
26918 This attribute holds the breakpoint's type --- the identifier used to
26919 determine the actual breakpoint type or use-case. This attribute is not
26923 @defvar Breakpoint.visible
26924 This attribute tells whether the breakpoint is visible to the user
26925 when set, or when the @samp{info breakpoints} command is run. This
26926 attribute is not writable.
26929 The available types are represented by constants defined in the @code{gdb}
26933 @findex BP_BREAKPOINT
26934 @findex gdb.BP_BREAKPOINT
26935 @item gdb.BP_BREAKPOINT
26936 Normal code breakpoint.
26938 @findex BP_WATCHPOINT
26939 @findex gdb.BP_WATCHPOINT
26940 @item gdb.BP_WATCHPOINT
26941 Watchpoint breakpoint.
26943 @findex BP_HARDWARE_WATCHPOINT
26944 @findex gdb.BP_HARDWARE_WATCHPOINT
26945 @item gdb.BP_HARDWARE_WATCHPOINT
26946 Hardware assisted watchpoint.
26948 @findex BP_READ_WATCHPOINT
26949 @findex gdb.BP_READ_WATCHPOINT
26950 @item gdb.BP_READ_WATCHPOINT
26951 Hardware assisted read watchpoint.
26953 @findex BP_ACCESS_WATCHPOINT
26954 @findex gdb.BP_ACCESS_WATCHPOINT
26955 @item gdb.BP_ACCESS_WATCHPOINT
26956 Hardware assisted access watchpoint.
26959 @defvar Breakpoint.hit_count
26960 This attribute holds the hit count for the breakpoint, an integer.
26961 This attribute is writable, but currently it can only be set to zero.
26964 @defvar Breakpoint.location
26965 This attribute holds the location of the breakpoint, as specified by
26966 the user. It is a string. If the breakpoint does not have a location
26967 (that is, it is a watchpoint) the attribute's value is @code{None}. This
26968 attribute is not writable.
26971 @defvar Breakpoint.expression
26972 This attribute holds a breakpoint expression, as specified by
26973 the user. It is a string. If the breakpoint does not have an
26974 expression (the breakpoint is not a watchpoint) the attribute's value
26975 is @code{None}. This attribute is not writable.
26978 @defvar Breakpoint.condition
26979 This attribute holds the condition of the breakpoint, as specified by
26980 the user. It is a string. If there is no condition, this attribute's
26981 value is @code{None}. This attribute is writable.
26984 @defvar Breakpoint.commands
26985 This attribute holds the commands attached to the breakpoint. If
26986 there are commands, this attribute's value is a string holding all the
26987 commands, separated by newlines. If there are no commands, this
26988 attribute is @code{None}. This attribute is not writable.
26991 @node Finish Breakpoints in Python
26992 @subsubsection Finish Breakpoints
26994 @cindex python finish breakpoints
26995 @tindex gdb.FinishBreakpoint
26997 A finish breakpoint is a temporary breakpoint set at the return address of
26998 a frame, based on the @code{finish} command. @code{gdb.FinishBreakpoint}
26999 extends @code{gdb.Breakpoint}. The underlying breakpoint will be disabled
27000 and deleted when the execution will run out of the breakpoint scope (i.e.@:
27001 @code{Breakpoint.stop} or @code{FinishBreakpoint.out_of_scope} triggered).
27002 Finish breakpoints are thread specific and must be create with the right
27005 @defun FinishBreakpoint.__init__ (@r{[}frame@r{]} @r{[}, internal@r{]})
27006 Create a finish breakpoint at the return address of the @code{gdb.Frame}
27007 object @var{frame}. If @var{frame} is not provided, this defaults to the
27008 newest frame. The optional @var{internal} argument allows the breakpoint to
27009 become invisible to the user. @xref{Breakpoints In Python}, for further
27010 details about this argument.
27013 @defun FinishBreakpoint.out_of_scope (self)
27014 In some circumstances (e.g.@: @code{longjmp}, C@t{++} exceptions, @value{GDBN}
27015 @code{return} command, @dots{}), a function may not properly terminate, and
27016 thus never hit the finish breakpoint. When @value{GDBN} notices such a
27017 situation, the @code{out_of_scope} callback will be triggered.
27019 You may want to sub-class @code{gdb.FinishBreakpoint} and override this
27023 class MyFinishBreakpoint (gdb.FinishBreakpoint)
27025 print "normal finish"
27028 def out_of_scope ():
27029 print "abnormal finish"
27033 @defvar FinishBreakpoint.return_value
27034 When @value{GDBN} is stopped at a finish breakpoint and the frame
27035 used to build the @code{gdb.FinishBreakpoint} object had debug symbols, this
27036 attribute will contain a @code{gdb.Value} object corresponding to the return
27037 value of the function. The value will be @code{None} if the function return
27038 type is @code{void} or if the return value was not computable. This attribute
27042 @node Lazy Strings In Python
27043 @subsubsection Python representation of lazy strings.
27045 @cindex lazy strings in python
27046 @tindex gdb.LazyString
27048 A @dfn{lazy string} is a string whose contents is not retrieved or
27049 encoded until it is needed.
27051 A @code{gdb.LazyString} is represented in @value{GDBN} as an
27052 @code{address} that points to a region of memory, an @code{encoding}
27053 that will be used to encode that region of memory, and a @code{length}
27054 to delimit the region of memory that represents the string. The
27055 difference between a @code{gdb.LazyString} and a string wrapped within
27056 a @code{gdb.Value} is that a @code{gdb.LazyString} will be treated
27057 differently by @value{GDBN} when printing. A @code{gdb.LazyString} is
27058 retrieved and encoded during printing, while a @code{gdb.Value}
27059 wrapping a string is immediately retrieved and encoded on creation.
27061 A @code{gdb.LazyString} object has the following functions:
27063 @defun LazyString.value ()
27064 Convert the @code{gdb.LazyString} to a @code{gdb.Value}. This value
27065 will point to the string in memory, but will lose all the delayed
27066 retrieval, encoding and handling that @value{GDBN} applies to a
27067 @code{gdb.LazyString}.
27070 @defvar LazyString.address
27071 This attribute holds the address of the string. This attribute is not
27075 @defvar LazyString.length
27076 This attribute holds the length of the string in characters. If the
27077 length is -1, then the string will be fetched and encoded up to the
27078 first null of appropriate width. This attribute is not writable.
27081 @defvar LazyString.encoding
27082 This attribute holds the encoding that will be applied to the string
27083 when the string is printed by @value{GDBN}. If the encoding is not
27084 set, or contains an empty string, then @value{GDBN} will select the
27085 most appropriate encoding when the string is printed. This attribute
27089 @defvar LazyString.type
27090 This attribute holds the type that is represented by the lazy string's
27091 type. For a lazy string this will always be a pointer type. To
27092 resolve this to the lazy string's character type, use the type's
27093 @code{target} method. @xref{Types In Python}. This attribute is not
27097 @node Architectures In Python
27098 @subsubsection Python representation of architectures
27099 @cindex Python architectures
27101 @value{GDBN} uses architecture specific parameters and artifacts in a
27102 number of its various computations. An architecture is represented
27103 by an instance of the @code{gdb.Architecture} class.
27105 A @code{gdb.Architecture} class has the following methods:
27107 @defun Architecture.name ()
27108 Return the name (string value) of the architecture.
27111 @defun Architecture.disassemble (@var{start_pc} @r{[}, @var{end_pc} @r{[}, @var{count}@r{]]})
27112 Return a list of disassembled instructions starting from the memory
27113 address @var{start_pc}. The optional arguments @var{end_pc} and
27114 @var{count} determine the number of instructions in the returned list.
27115 If both the optional arguments @var{end_pc} and @var{count} are
27116 specified, then a list of at most @var{count} disassembled instructions
27117 whose start address falls in the closed memory address interval from
27118 @var{start_pc} to @var{end_pc} are returned. If @var{end_pc} is not
27119 specified, but @var{count} is specified, then @var{count} number of
27120 instructions starting from the address @var{start_pc} are returned. If
27121 @var{count} is not specified but @var{end_pc} is specified, then all
27122 instructions whose start address falls in the closed memory address
27123 interval from @var{start_pc} to @var{end_pc} are returned. If neither
27124 @var{end_pc} nor @var{count} are specified, then a single instruction at
27125 @var{start_pc} is returned. For all of these cases, each element of the
27126 returned list is a Python @code{dict} with the following string keys:
27131 The value corresponding to this key is a Python long integer capturing
27132 the memory address of the instruction.
27135 The value corresponding to this key is a string value which represents
27136 the instruction with assembly language mnemonics. The assembly
27137 language flavor used is the same as that specified by the current CLI
27138 variable @code{disassembly-flavor}. @xref{Machine Code}.
27141 The value corresponding to this key is the length (integer value) of the
27142 instruction in bytes.
27147 @node Python Auto-loading
27148 @subsection Python Auto-loading
27149 @cindex Python auto-loading
27151 When a new object file is read (for example, due to the @code{file}
27152 command, or because the inferior has loaded a shared library),
27153 @value{GDBN} will look for Python support scripts in several ways:
27154 @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.py} (@pxref{objfile-gdb.py file})
27155 and @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
27156 (@pxref{dotdebug_gdb_scripts section}).
27158 The auto-loading feature is useful for supplying application-specific
27159 debugging commands and scripts.
27161 Auto-loading can be enabled or disabled,
27162 and the list of auto-loaded scripts can be printed.
27165 @anchor{set auto-load python-scripts}
27166 @kindex set auto-load python-scripts
27167 @item set auto-load python-scripts [on|off]
27168 Enable or disable the auto-loading of Python scripts.
27170 @anchor{show auto-load python-scripts}
27171 @kindex show auto-load python-scripts
27172 @item show auto-load python-scripts
27173 Show whether auto-loading of Python scripts is enabled or disabled.
27175 @anchor{info auto-load python-scripts}
27176 @kindex info auto-load python-scripts
27177 @cindex print list of auto-loaded Python scripts
27178 @item info auto-load python-scripts [@var{regexp}]
27179 Print the list of all Python scripts that @value{GDBN} auto-loaded.
27181 Also printed is the list of Python scripts that were mentioned in
27182 the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section and were not found
27183 (@pxref{dotdebug_gdb_scripts section}).
27184 This is useful because their names are not printed when @value{GDBN}
27185 tries to load them and fails. There may be many of them, and printing
27186 an error message for each one is problematic.
27188 If @var{regexp} is supplied only Python scripts with matching names are printed.
27193 (gdb) info auto-load python-scripts
27195 Yes py-section-script.py
27196 full name: /tmp/py-section-script.py
27197 No my-foo-pretty-printers.py
27201 When reading an auto-loaded file, @value{GDBN} sets the
27202 @dfn{current objfile}. This is available via the @code{gdb.current_objfile}
27203 function (@pxref{Objfiles In Python}). This can be useful for
27204 registering objfile-specific pretty-printers and frame-filters.
27207 * objfile-gdb.py file:: The @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.py} file
27208 * dotdebug_gdb_scripts section:: The @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
27209 * Which flavor to choose?::
27212 @node objfile-gdb.py file
27213 @subsubsection The @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.py} file
27214 @cindex @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.py}
27216 When a new object file is read, @value{GDBN} looks for
27217 a file named @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.py} (we call it @var{script-name} below),
27218 where @var{objfile} is the object file's real name, formed by ensuring
27219 that the file name is absolute, following all symlinks, and resolving
27220 @code{.} and @code{..} components. If this file exists and is
27221 readable, @value{GDBN} will evaluate it as a Python script.
27223 If this file does not exist, then @value{GDBN} will look for
27224 @var{script-name} file in all of the directories as specified below.
27226 Note that loading of this script file also requires accordingly configured
27227 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
27229 For object files using @file{.exe} suffix @value{GDBN} tries to load first the
27230 scripts normally according to its @file{.exe} filename. But if no scripts are
27231 found @value{GDBN} also tries script filenames matching the object file without
27232 its @file{.exe} suffix. This @file{.exe} stripping is case insensitive and it
27233 is attempted on any platform. This makes the script filenames compatible
27234 between Unix and MS-Windows hosts.
27237 @anchor{set auto-load scripts-directory}
27238 @kindex set auto-load scripts-directory
27239 @item set auto-load scripts-directory @r{[}@var{directories}@r{]}
27240 Control @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location. Multiple directory entries
27241 may be delimited by the host platform path separator in use
27242 (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on MS-Windows and MS-DOS).
27244 Each entry here needs to be covered also by the security setting
27245 @code{set auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{set auto-load safe-path}).
27247 @anchor{with-auto-load-dir}
27248 This variable defaults to @file{$debugdir:$datadir/auto-load}. The default
27249 @code{set auto-load safe-path} value can be also overriden by @value{GDBN}
27250 configuration option @option{--with-auto-load-dir}.
27252 Any reference to @file{$debugdir} will get replaced by
27253 @var{debug-file-directory} value (@pxref{Separate Debug Files}) and any
27254 reference to @file{$datadir} will get replaced by @var{data-directory} which is
27255 determined at @value{GDBN} startup (@pxref{Data Files}). @file{$debugdir} and
27256 @file{$datadir} must be placed as a directory component --- either alone or
27257 delimited by @file{/} or @file{\} directory separators, depending on the host
27260 The list of directories uses path separator (@samp{:} on GNU and Unix
27261 systems, @samp{;} on MS-Windows and MS-DOS) to separate directories, similarly
27262 to the @env{PATH} environment variable.
27264 @anchor{show auto-load scripts-directory}
27265 @kindex show auto-load scripts-directory
27266 @item show auto-load scripts-directory
27267 Show @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location.
27270 @value{GDBN} does not track which files it has already auto-loaded this way.
27271 @value{GDBN} will load the associated script every time the corresponding
27272 @var{objfile} is opened.
27273 So your @file{-gdb.py} file should be careful to avoid errors if it
27274 is evaluated more than once.
27276 @node dotdebug_gdb_scripts section
27277 @subsubsection The @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
27278 @cindex @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
27280 For systems using file formats like ELF and COFF,
27281 when @value{GDBN} loads a new object file
27282 it will look for a special section named @samp{.debug_gdb_scripts}.
27283 If this section exists, its contents is a list of names of scripts to load.
27285 @value{GDBN} will look for each specified script file first in the
27286 current directory and then along the source search path
27287 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories}),
27288 except that @file{$cdir} is not searched, since the compilation
27289 directory is not relevant to scripts.
27291 Entries can be placed in section @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} with,
27292 for example, this GCC macro:
27295 /* Note: The "MS" section flags are to remove duplicates. */
27296 #define DEFINE_GDB_SCRIPT(script_name) \
27298 .pushsection \".debug_gdb_scripts\", \"MS\",@@progbits,1\n\
27300 .asciz \"" script_name "\"\n\
27306 Then one can reference the macro in a header or source file like this:
27309 DEFINE_GDB_SCRIPT ("my-app-scripts.py")
27312 The script name may include directories if desired.
27314 Note that loading of this script file also requires accordingly configured
27315 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
27317 If the macro is put in a header, any application or library
27318 using this header will get a reference to the specified script.
27320 @node Which flavor to choose?
27321 @subsubsection Which flavor to choose?
27323 Given the multiple ways of auto-loading Python scripts, it might not always
27324 be clear which one to choose. This section provides some guidance.
27326 Benefits of the @file{-gdb.py} way:
27330 Can be used with file formats that don't support multiple sections.
27333 Ease of finding scripts for public libraries.
27335 Scripts specified in the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section are searched for
27336 in the source search path.
27337 For publicly installed libraries, e.g., @file{libstdc++}, there typically
27338 isn't a source directory in which to find the script.
27341 Doesn't require source code additions.
27344 Benefits of the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} way:
27348 Works with static linking.
27350 Scripts for libraries done the @file{-gdb.py} way require an objfile to
27351 trigger their loading. When an application is statically linked the only
27352 objfile available is the executable, and it is cumbersome to attach all the
27353 scripts from all the input libraries to the executable's @file{-gdb.py} script.
27356 Works with classes that are entirely inlined.
27358 Some classes can be entirely inlined, and thus there may not be an associated
27359 shared library to attach a @file{-gdb.py} script to.
27362 Scripts needn't be copied out of the source tree.
27364 In some circumstances, apps can be built out of large collections of internal
27365 libraries, and the build infrastructure necessary to install the
27366 @file{-gdb.py} scripts in a place where @value{GDBN} can find them is
27367 cumbersome. It may be easier to specify the scripts in the
27368 @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section as relative paths, and add a path to the
27369 top of the source tree to the source search path.
27372 @node Python modules
27373 @subsection Python modules
27374 @cindex python modules
27376 @value{GDBN} comes with several modules to assist writing Python code.
27379 * gdb.printing:: Building and registering pretty-printers.
27380 * gdb.types:: Utilities for working with types.
27381 * gdb.prompt:: Utilities for prompt value substitution.
27385 @subsubsection gdb.printing
27386 @cindex gdb.printing
27388 This module provides a collection of utilities for working with
27392 @item PrettyPrinter (@var{name}, @var{subprinters}=None)
27393 This class specifies the API that makes @samp{info pretty-printer},
27394 @samp{enable pretty-printer} and @samp{disable pretty-printer} work.
27395 Pretty-printers should generally inherit from this class.
27397 @item SubPrettyPrinter (@var{name})
27398 For printers that handle multiple types, this class specifies the
27399 corresponding API for the subprinters.
27401 @item RegexpCollectionPrettyPrinter (@var{name})
27402 Utility class for handling multiple printers, all recognized via
27403 regular expressions.
27404 @xref{Writing a Pretty-Printer}, for an example.
27406 @item FlagEnumerationPrinter (@var{name})
27407 A pretty-printer which handles printing of @code{enum} values. Unlike
27408 @value{GDBN}'s built-in @code{enum} printing, this printer attempts to
27409 work properly when there is some overlap between the enumeration
27410 constants. @var{name} is the name of the printer and also the name of
27411 the @code{enum} type to look up.
27413 @item register_pretty_printer (@var{obj}, @var{printer}, @var{replace}=False)
27414 Register @var{printer} with the pretty-printer list of @var{obj}.
27415 If @var{replace} is @code{True} then any existing copy of the printer
27416 is replaced. Otherwise a @code{RuntimeError} exception is raised
27417 if a printer with the same name already exists.
27421 @subsubsection gdb.types
27424 This module provides a collection of utilities for working with
27425 @code{gdb.Type} objects.
27428 @item get_basic_type (@var{type})
27429 Return @var{type} with const and volatile qualifiers stripped,
27430 and with typedefs and C@t{++} references converted to the underlying type.
27435 typedef const int const_int;
27437 const_int& foo_ref (foo);
27438 int main () @{ return 0; @}
27445 (gdb) python import gdb.types
27446 (gdb) python foo_ref = gdb.parse_and_eval("foo_ref")
27447 (gdb) python print gdb.types.get_basic_type(foo_ref.type)
27451 @item has_field (@var{type}, @var{field})
27452 Return @code{True} if @var{type}, assumed to be a type with fields
27453 (e.g., a structure or union), has field @var{field}.
27455 @item make_enum_dict (@var{enum_type})
27456 Return a Python @code{dictionary} type produced from @var{enum_type}.
27458 @item deep_items (@var{type})
27459 Returns a Python iterator similar to the standard
27460 @code{gdb.Type.iteritems} method, except that the iterator returned
27461 by @code{deep_items} will recursively traverse anonymous struct or
27462 union fields. For example:
27476 Then in @value{GDBN}:
27478 (@value{GDBP}) python import gdb.types
27479 (@value{GDBP}) python struct_a = gdb.lookup_type("struct A")
27480 (@value{GDBP}) python print struct_a.keys ()
27482 (@value{GDBP}) python print [k for k,v in gdb.types.deep_items(struct_a)]
27483 @{['a', 'b0', 'b1']@}
27486 @item get_type_recognizers ()
27487 Return a list of the enabled type recognizers for the current context.
27488 This is called by @value{GDBN} during the type-printing process
27489 (@pxref{Type Printing API}).
27491 @item apply_type_recognizers (recognizers, type_obj)
27492 Apply the type recognizers, @var{recognizers}, to the type object
27493 @var{type_obj}. If any recognizer returns a string, return that
27494 string. Otherwise, return @code{None}. This is called by
27495 @value{GDBN} during the type-printing process (@pxref{Type Printing
27498 @item register_type_printer (locus, printer)
27499 This is a convenience function to register a type printer.
27500 @var{printer} is the type printer to register. It must implement the
27501 type printer protocol. @var{locus} is either a @code{gdb.Objfile}, in
27502 which case the printer is registered with that objfile; a
27503 @code{gdb.Progspace}, in which case the printer is registered with
27504 that progspace; or @code{None}, in which case the printer is
27505 registered globally.
27508 This is a base class that implements the type printer protocol. Type
27509 printers are encouraged, but not required, to derive from this class.
27510 It defines a constructor:
27512 @defmethod TypePrinter __init__ (self, name)
27513 Initialize the type printer with the given name. The new printer
27514 starts in the enabled state.
27520 @subsubsection gdb.prompt
27523 This module provides a method for prompt value-substitution.
27526 @item substitute_prompt (@var{string})
27527 Return @var{string} with escape sequences substituted by values. Some
27528 escape sequences take arguments. You can specify arguments inside
27529 ``@{@}'' immediately following the escape sequence.
27531 The escape sequences you can pass to this function are:
27535 Substitute a backslash.
27537 Substitute an ESC character.
27539 Substitute the selected frame; an argument names a frame parameter.
27541 Substitute a newline.
27543 Substitute a parameter's value; the argument names the parameter.
27545 Substitute a carriage return.
27547 Substitute the selected thread; an argument names a thread parameter.
27549 Substitute the version of GDB.
27551 Substitute the current working directory.
27553 Begin a sequence of non-printing characters. These sequences are
27554 typically used with the ESC character, and are not counted in the string
27555 length. Example: ``\[\e[0;34m\](gdb)\[\e[0m\]'' will return a
27556 blue-colored ``(gdb)'' prompt where the length is five.
27558 End a sequence of non-printing characters.
27564 substitute_prompt (``frame: \f,
27565 print arguments: \p@{print frame-arguments@}'')
27568 @exdent will return the string:
27571 "frame: main, print arguments: scalars"
27576 @section Creating new spellings of existing commands
27577 @cindex aliases for commands
27579 It is often useful to define alternate spellings of existing commands.
27580 For example, if a new @value{GDBN} command defined in Python has
27581 a long name to type, it is handy to have an abbreviated version of it
27582 that involves less typing.
27584 @value{GDBN} itself uses aliases. For example @samp{s} is an alias
27585 of the @samp{step} command even though it is otherwise an ambiguous
27586 abbreviation of other commands like @samp{set} and @samp{show}.
27588 Aliases are also used to provide shortened or more common versions
27589 of multi-word commands. For example, @value{GDBN} provides the
27590 @samp{tty} alias of the @samp{set inferior-tty} command.
27592 You can define a new alias with the @samp{alias} command.
27597 @item alias [-a] [--] @var{ALIAS} = @var{COMMAND}
27601 @var{ALIAS} specifies the name of the new alias.
27602 Each word of @var{ALIAS} must consist of letters, numbers, dashes and
27605 @var{COMMAND} specifies the name of an existing command
27606 that is being aliased.
27608 The @samp{-a} option specifies that the new alias is an abbreviation
27609 of the command. Abbreviations are not shown in command
27610 lists displayed by the @samp{help} command.
27612 The @samp{--} option specifies the end of options,
27613 and is useful when @var{ALIAS} begins with a dash.
27615 Here is a simple example showing how to make an abbreviation
27616 of a command so that there is less to type.
27617 Suppose you were tired of typing @samp{disas}, the current
27618 shortest unambiguous abbreviation of the @samp{disassemble} command
27619 and you wanted an even shorter version named @samp{di}.
27620 The following will accomplish this.
27623 (gdb) alias -a di = disas
27626 Note that aliases are different from user-defined commands.
27627 With a user-defined command, you also need to write documentation
27628 for it with the @samp{document} command.
27629 An alias automatically picks up the documentation of the existing command.
27631 Here is an example where we make @samp{elms} an abbreviation of
27632 @samp{elements} in the @samp{set print elements} command.
27633 This is to show that you can make an abbreviation of any part
27637 (gdb) alias -a set print elms = set print elements
27638 (gdb) alias -a show print elms = show print elements
27639 (gdb) set p elms 20
27641 Limit on string chars or array elements to print is 200.
27644 Note that if you are defining an alias of a @samp{set} command,
27645 and you want to have an alias for the corresponding @samp{show}
27646 command, then you need to define the latter separately.
27648 Unambiguously abbreviated commands are allowed in @var{COMMAND} and
27649 @var{ALIAS}, just as they are normally.
27652 (gdb) alias -a set pr elms = set p ele
27655 Finally, here is an example showing the creation of a one word
27656 alias for a more complex command.
27657 This creates alias @samp{spe} of the command @samp{set print elements}.
27660 (gdb) alias spe = set print elements
27665 @chapter Command Interpreters
27666 @cindex command interpreters
27668 @value{GDBN} supports multiple command interpreters, and some command
27669 infrastructure to allow users or user interface writers to switch
27670 between interpreters or run commands in other interpreters.
27672 @value{GDBN} currently supports two command interpreters, the console
27673 interpreter (sometimes called the command-line interpreter or @sc{cli})
27674 and the machine interface interpreter (or @sc{gdb/mi}). This manual
27675 describes both of these interfaces in great detail.
27677 By default, @value{GDBN} will start with the console interpreter.
27678 However, the user may choose to start @value{GDBN} with another
27679 interpreter by specifying the @option{-i} or @option{--interpreter}
27680 startup options. Defined interpreters include:
27684 @cindex console interpreter
27685 The traditional console or command-line interpreter. This is the most often
27686 used interpreter with @value{GDBN}. With no interpreter specified at runtime,
27687 @value{GDBN} will use this interpreter.
27690 @cindex mi interpreter
27691 The newest @sc{gdb/mi} interface (currently @code{mi2}). Used primarily
27692 by programs wishing to use @value{GDBN} as a backend for a debugger GUI
27693 or an IDE. For more information, see @ref{GDB/MI, ,The @sc{gdb/mi}
27697 @cindex mi2 interpreter
27698 The current @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
27701 @cindex mi1 interpreter
27702 The @sc{gdb/mi} interface included in @value{GDBN} 5.1, 5.2, and 5.3.
27706 @cindex invoke another interpreter
27707 The interpreter being used by @value{GDBN} may not be dynamically
27708 switched at runtime. Although possible, this could lead to a very
27709 precarious situation. Consider an IDE using @sc{gdb/mi}. If a user
27710 enters the command "interpreter-set console" in a console view,
27711 @value{GDBN} would switch to using the console interpreter, rendering
27712 the IDE inoperable!
27714 @kindex interpreter-exec
27715 Although you may only choose a single interpreter at startup, you may execute
27716 commands in any interpreter from the current interpreter using the appropriate
27717 command. If you are running the console interpreter, simply use the
27718 @code{interpreter-exec} command:
27721 interpreter-exec mi "-data-list-register-names"
27724 @sc{gdb/mi} has a similar command, although it is only available in versions of
27725 @value{GDBN} which support @sc{gdb/mi} version 2 (or greater).
27728 @chapter @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
27730 @cindex Text User Interface
27733 * TUI Overview:: TUI overview
27734 * TUI Keys:: TUI key bindings
27735 * TUI Single Key Mode:: TUI single key mode
27736 * TUI Commands:: TUI-specific commands
27737 * TUI Configuration:: TUI configuration variables
27740 The @value{GDBN} Text User Interface (TUI) is a terminal
27741 interface which uses the @code{curses} library to show the source
27742 file, the assembly output, the program registers and @value{GDBN}
27743 commands in separate text windows. The TUI mode is supported only
27744 on platforms where a suitable version of the @code{curses} library
27747 The TUI mode is enabled by default when you invoke @value{GDBN} as
27748 @samp{@value{GDBP} -tui}.
27749 You can also switch in and out of TUI mode while @value{GDBN} runs by
27750 using various TUI commands and key bindings, such as @kbd{C-x C-a}.
27751 @xref{TUI Keys, ,TUI Key Bindings}.
27754 @section TUI Overview
27756 In TUI mode, @value{GDBN} can display several text windows:
27760 This window is the @value{GDBN} command window with the @value{GDBN}
27761 prompt and the @value{GDBN} output. The @value{GDBN} input is still
27762 managed using readline.
27765 The source window shows the source file of the program. The current
27766 line and active breakpoints are displayed in this window.
27769 The assembly window shows the disassembly output of the program.
27772 This window shows the processor registers. Registers are highlighted
27773 when their values change.
27776 The source and assembly windows show the current program position
27777 by highlighting the current line and marking it with a @samp{>} marker.
27778 Breakpoints are indicated with two markers. The first marker
27779 indicates the breakpoint type:
27783 Breakpoint which was hit at least once.
27786 Breakpoint which was never hit.
27789 Hardware breakpoint which was hit at least once.
27792 Hardware breakpoint which was never hit.
27795 The second marker indicates whether the breakpoint is enabled or not:
27799 Breakpoint is enabled.
27802 Breakpoint is disabled.
27805 The source, assembly and register windows are updated when the current
27806 thread changes, when the frame changes, or when the program counter
27809 These windows are not all visible at the same time. The command
27810 window is always visible. The others can be arranged in several
27821 source and assembly,
27824 source and registers, or
27827 assembly and registers.
27830 A status line above the command window shows the following information:
27834 Indicates the current @value{GDBN} target.
27835 (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
27838 Gives the current process or thread number.
27839 When no process is being debugged, this field is set to @code{No process}.
27842 Gives the current function name for the selected frame.
27843 The name is demangled if demangling is turned on (@pxref{Print Settings}).
27844 When there is no symbol corresponding to the current program counter,
27845 the string @code{??} is displayed.
27848 Indicates the current line number for the selected frame.
27849 When the current line number is not known, the string @code{??} is displayed.
27852 Indicates the current program counter address.
27856 @section TUI Key Bindings
27857 @cindex TUI key bindings
27859 The TUI installs several key bindings in the readline keymaps
27860 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
27861 (@pxref{Command Line Editing, , , rluserman, GNU Readline Library}).
27863 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
27864 (@pxref{Command Line Editing}).
27866 The following key bindings are installed for both TUI mode and the
27867 @value{GDBN} standard mode.
27876 Enter or leave the TUI mode. When leaving the TUI mode,
27877 the curses window management stops and @value{GDBN} operates using
27878 its standard mode, writing on the terminal directly. When reentering
27879 the TUI mode, control is given back to the curses windows.
27880 The screen is then refreshed.
27884 Use a TUI layout with only one window. The layout will
27885 either be @samp{source} or @samp{assembly}. When the TUI mode
27886 is not active, it will switch to the TUI mode.
27888 Think of this key binding as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 1} binding.
27892 Use a TUI layout with at least two windows. When the current
27893 layout already has two windows, the next layout with two windows is used.
27894 When a new layout is chosen, one window will always be common to the
27895 previous layout and the new one.
27897 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 2} binding.
27901 Change the active window. The TUI associates several key bindings
27902 (like scrolling and arrow keys) with the active window. This command
27903 gives the focus to the next TUI window.
27905 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x o} binding.
27909 Switch in and out of the TUI SingleKey mode that binds single
27910 keys to @value{GDBN} commands (@pxref{TUI Single Key Mode}).
27913 The following key bindings only work in the TUI mode:
27918 Scroll the active window one page up.
27922 Scroll the active window one page down.
27926 Scroll the active window one line up.
27930 Scroll the active window one line down.
27934 Scroll the active window one column left.
27938 Scroll the active window one column right.
27942 Refresh the screen.
27945 Because the arrow keys scroll the active window in the TUI mode, they
27946 are not available for their normal use by readline unless the command
27947 window has the focus. When another window is active, you must use
27948 other readline key bindings such as @kbd{C-p}, @kbd{C-n}, @kbd{C-b}
27949 and @kbd{C-f} to control the command window.
27951 @node TUI Single Key Mode
27952 @section TUI Single Key Mode
27953 @cindex TUI single key mode
27955 The TUI also provides a @dfn{SingleKey} mode, which binds several
27956 frequently used @value{GDBN} commands to single keys. Type @kbd{C-x s} to
27957 switch into this mode, where the following key bindings are used:
27960 @kindex c @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
27964 @kindex d @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
27968 @kindex f @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
27972 @kindex n @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
27976 @kindex q @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
27978 exit the SingleKey mode.
27980 @kindex r @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
27984 @kindex s @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
27988 @kindex u @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
27992 @kindex v @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
27996 @kindex w @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
28001 Other keys temporarily switch to the @value{GDBN} command prompt.
28002 The key that was pressed is inserted in the editing buffer so that
28003 it is possible to type most @value{GDBN} commands without interaction
28004 with the TUI SingleKey mode. Once the command is entered the TUI
28005 SingleKey mode is restored. The only way to permanently leave
28006 this mode is by typing @kbd{q} or @kbd{C-x s}.
28010 @section TUI-specific Commands
28011 @cindex TUI commands
28013 The TUI has specific commands to control the text windows.
28014 These commands are always available, even when @value{GDBN} is not in
28015 the TUI mode. When @value{GDBN} is in the standard mode, most
28016 of these commands will automatically switch to the TUI mode.
28018 Note that if @value{GDBN}'s @code{stdout} is not connected to a
28019 terminal, or @value{GDBN} has been started with the machine interface
28020 interpreter (@pxref{GDB/MI, ,The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}), most of
28021 these commands will fail with an error, because it would not be
28022 possible or desirable to enable curses window management.
28027 List and give the size of all displayed windows.
28031 Display the next layout.
28034 Display the previous layout.
28037 Display the source window only.
28040 Display the assembly window only.
28043 Display the source and assembly window.
28046 Display the register window together with the source or assembly window.
28050 Make the next window active for scrolling.
28053 Make the previous window active for scrolling.
28056 Make the source window active for scrolling.
28059 Make the assembly window active for scrolling.
28062 Make the register window active for scrolling.
28065 Make the command window active for scrolling.
28069 Refresh the screen. This is similar to typing @kbd{C-L}.
28071 @item tui reg float
28073 Show the floating point registers in the register window.
28075 @item tui reg general
28076 Show the general registers in the register window.
28079 Show the next register group. The list of register groups as well as
28080 their order is target specific. The predefined register groups are the
28081 following: @code{general}, @code{float}, @code{system}, @code{vector},
28082 @code{all}, @code{save}, @code{restore}.
28084 @item tui reg system
28085 Show the system registers in the register window.
28089 Update the source window and the current execution point.
28091 @item winheight @var{name} +@var{count}
28092 @itemx winheight @var{name} -@var{count}
28094 Change the height of the window @var{name} by @var{count}
28095 lines. Positive counts increase the height, while negative counts
28098 @item tabset @var{nchars}
28100 Set the width of tab stops to be @var{nchars} characters.
28103 @node TUI Configuration
28104 @section TUI Configuration Variables
28105 @cindex TUI configuration variables
28107 Several configuration variables control the appearance of TUI windows.
28110 @item set tui border-kind @var{kind}
28111 @kindex set tui border-kind
28112 Select the border appearance for the source, assembly and register windows.
28113 The possible values are the following:
28116 Use a space character to draw the border.
28119 Use @sc{ascii} characters @samp{+}, @samp{-} and @samp{|} to draw the border.
28122 Use the Alternate Character Set to draw the border. The border is
28123 drawn using character line graphics if the terminal supports them.
28126 @item set tui border-mode @var{mode}
28127 @kindex set tui border-mode
28128 @itemx set tui active-border-mode @var{mode}
28129 @kindex set tui active-border-mode
28130 Select the display attributes for the borders of the inactive windows
28131 or the active window. The @var{mode} can be one of the following:
28134 Use normal attributes to display the border.
28140 Use reverse video mode.
28143 Use half bright mode.
28145 @item half-standout
28146 Use half bright and standout mode.
28149 Use extra bright or bold mode.
28151 @item bold-standout
28152 Use extra bright or bold and standout mode.
28157 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
28160 @cindex @sc{gnu} Emacs
28161 A special interface allows you to use @sc{gnu} Emacs to view (and
28162 edit) the source files for the program you are debugging with
28165 To use this interface, use the command @kbd{M-x gdb} in Emacs. Give the
28166 executable file you want to debug as an argument. This command starts
28167 @value{GDBN} as a subprocess of Emacs, with input and output through a newly
28168 created Emacs buffer.
28169 @c (Do not use the @code{-tui} option to run @value{GDBN} from Emacs.)
28171 Running @value{GDBN} under Emacs can be just like running @value{GDBN} normally except for two
28176 All ``terminal'' input and output goes through an Emacs buffer, called
28179 This applies both to @value{GDBN} commands and their output, and to the input
28180 and output done by the program you are debugging.
28182 This is useful because it means that you can copy the text of previous
28183 commands and input them again; you can even use parts of the output
28186 All the facilities of Emacs' Shell mode are available for interacting
28187 with your program. In particular, you can send signals the usual
28188 way---for example, @kbd{C-c C-c} for an interrupt, @kbd{C-c C-z} for a
28192 @value{GDBN} displays source code through Emacs.
28194 Each time @value{GDBN} displays a stack frame, Emacs automatically finds the
28195 source file for that frame and puts an arrow (@samp{=>}) at the
28196 left margin of the current line. Emacs uses a separate buffer for
28197 source display, and splits the screen to show both your @value{GDBN} session
28200 Explicit @value{GDBN} @code{list} or search commands still produce output as
28201 usual, but you probably have no reason to use them from Emacs.
28204 We call this @dfn{text command mode}. Emacs 22.1, and later, also uses
28205 a graphical mode, enabled by default, which provides further buffers
28206 that can control the execution and describe the state of your program.
28207 @xref{GDB Graphical Interface,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}.
28209 If you specify an absolute file name when prompted for the @kbd{M-x
28210 gdb} argument, then Emacs sets your current working directory to where
28211 your program resides. If you only specify the file name, then Emacs
28212 sets your current working directory to the directory associated
28213 with the previous buffer. In this case, @value{GDBN} may find your
28214 program by searching your environment's @code{PATH} variable, but on
28215 some operating systems it might not find the source. So, although the
28216 @value{GDBN} input and output session proceeds normally, the auxiliary
28217 buffer does not display the current source and line of execution.
28219 The initial working directory of @value{GDBN} is printed on the top
28220 line of the GUD buffer and this serves as a default for the commands
28221 that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files,
28222 ,Commands to Specify Files}.
28224 By default, @kbd{M-x gdb} calls the program called @file{gdb}. If you
28225 need to call @value{GDBN} by a different name (for example, if you
28226 keep several configurations around, with different names) you can
28227 customize the Emacs variable @code{gud-gdb-command-name} to run the
28230 In the GUD buffer, you can use these special Emacs commands in
28231 addition to the standard Shell mode commands:
28235 Describe the features of Emacs' GUD Mode.
28238 Execute to another source line, like the @value{GDBN} @code{step} command; also
28239 update the display window to show the current file and location.
28242 Execute to next source line in this function, skipping all function
28243 calls, like the @value{GDBN} @code{next} command. Then update the display window
28244 to show the current file and location.
28247 Execute one instruction, like the @value{GDBN} @code{stepi} command; update
28248 display window accordingly.
28251 Execute until exit from the selected stack frame, like the @value{GDBN}
28252 @code{finish} command.
28255 Continue execution of your program, like the @value{GDBN} @code{continue}
28259 Go up the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument
28260 (@pxref{Arguments, , Numeric Arguments, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}),
28261 like the @value{GDBN} @code{up} command.
28264 Go down the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument, like the
28265 @value{GDBN} @code{down} command.
28268 In any source file, the Emacs command @kbd{C-x @key{SPC}} (@code{gud-break})
28269 tells @value{GDBN} to set a breakpoint on the source line point is on.
28271 In text command mode, if you type @kbd{M-x speedbar}, Emacs displays a
28272 separate frame which shows a backtrace when the GUD buffer is current.
28273 Move point to any frame in the stack and type @key{RET} to make it
28274 become the current frame and display the associated source in the
28275 source buffer. Alternatively, click @kbd{Mouse-2} to make the
28276 selected frame become the current one. In graphical mode, the
28277 speedbar displays watch expressions.
28279 If you accidentally delete the source-display buffer, an easy way to get
28280 it back is to type the command @code{f} in the @value{GDBN} buffer, to
28281 request a frame display; when you run under Emacs, this recreates
28282 the source buffer if necessary to show you the context of the current
28285 The source files displayed in Emacs are in ordinary Emacs buffers
28286 which are visiting the source files in the usual way. You can edit
28287 the files with these buffers if you wish; but keep in mind that @value{GDBN}
28288 communicates with Emacs in terms of line numbers. If you add or
28289 delete lines from the text, the line numbers that @value{GDBN} knows cease
28290 to correspond properly with the code.
28292 A more detailed description of Emacs' interaction with @value{GDBN} is
28293 given in the Emacs manual (@pxref{Debuggers,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu}
28297 @chapter The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface
28299 @unnumberedsec Function and Purpose
28301 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, its purpose
28302 @sc{gdb/mi} is a line based machine oriented text interface to
28303 @value{GDBN} and is activated by specifying using the
28304 @option{--interpreter} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}). It
28305 is specifically intended to support the development of systems which
28306 use the debugger as just one small component of a larger system.
28308 This chapter is a specification of the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. It is written
28309 in the form of a reference manual.
28311 Note that @sc{gdb/mi} is still under construction, so some of the
28312 features described below are incomplete and subject to change
28313 (@pxref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, , @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends}).
28315 @unnumberedsec Notation and Terminology
28317 @cindex notational conventions, for @sc{gdb/mi}
28318 This chapter uses the following notation:
28322 @code{|} separates two alternatives.
28325 @code{[ @var{something} ]} indicates that @var{something} is optional:
28326 it may or may not be given.
28329 @code{( @var{group} )*} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
28330 may repeat zero or more times.
28333 @code{( @var{group} )+} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
28334 may repeat one or more times.
28337 @code{"@var{string}"} means a literal @var{string}.
28341 @heading Dependencies
28345 * GDB/MI General Design::
28346 * GDB/MI Command Syntax::
28347 * GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI::
28348 * GDB/MI Development and Front Ends::
28349 * GDB/MI Output Records::
28350 * GDB/MI Simple Examples::
28351 * GDB/MI Command Description Format::
28352 * GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands::
28353 * GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands::
28354 * GDB/MI Program Context::
28355 * GDB/MI Thread Commands::
28356 * GDB/MI Ada Tasking Commands::
28357 * GDB/MI Program Execution::
28358 * GDB/MI Stack Manipulation::
28359 * GDB/MI Variable Objects::
28360 * GDB/MI Data Manipulation::
28361 * GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands::
28362 * GDB/MI Symbol Query::
28363 * GDB/MI File Commands::
28365 * GDB/MI Kod Commands::
28366 * GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands::
28367 * GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands::
28369 * GDB/MI Target Manipulation::
28370 * GDB/MI File Transfer Commands::
28371 * GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands::
28374 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28375 @node GDB/MI General Design
28376 @section @sc{gdb/mi} General Design
28377 @cindex GDB/MI General Design
28379 Interaction of a @sc{GDB/MI} frontend with @value{GDBN} involves three
28380 parts---commands sent to @value{GDBN}, responses to those commands
28381 and notifications. Each command results in exactly one response,
28382 indicating either successful completion of the command, or an error.
28383 For the commands that do not resume the target, the response contains the
28384 requested information. For the commands that resume the target, the
28385 response only indicates whether the target was successfully resumed.
28386 Notifications is the mechanism for reporting changes in the state of the
28387 target, or in @value{GDBN} state, that cannot conveniently be associated with
28388 a command and reported as part of that command response.
28390 The important examples of notifications are:
28394 Exec notifications. These are used to report changes in
28395 target state---when a target is resumed, or stopped. It would not
28396 be feasible to include this information in response of resuming
28397 commands, because one resume commands can result in multiple events in
28398 different threads. Also, quite some time may pass before any event
28399 happens in the target, while a frontend needs to know whether the resuming
28400 command itself was successfully executed.
28403 Console output, and status notifications. Console output
28404 notifications are used to report output of CLI commands, as well as
28405 diagnostics for other commands. Status notifications are used to
28406 report the progress of a long-running operation. Naturally, including
28407 this information in command response would mean no output is produced
28408 until the command is finished, which is undesirable.
28411 General notifications. Commands may have various side effects on
28412 the @value{GDBN} or target state beyond their official purpose. For example,
28413 a command may change the selected thread. Although such changes can
28414 be included in command response, using notification allows for more
28415 orthogonal frontend design.
28419 There's no guarantee that whenever an MI command reports an error,
28420 @value{GDBN} or the target are in any specific state, and especially,
28421 the state is not reverted to the state before the MI command was
28422 processed. Therefore, whenever an MI command results in an error,
28423 we recommend that the frontend refreshes all the information shown in
28424 the user interface.
28428 * Context management::
28429 * Asynchronous and non-stop modes::
28433 @node Context management
28434 @subsection Context management
28436 In most cases when @value{GDBN} accesses the target, this access is
28437 done in context of a specific thread and frame (@pxref{Frames}).
28438 Often, even when accessing global data, the target requires that a thread
28439 be specified. The CLI interface maintains the selected thread and frame,
28440 and supplies them to target on each command. This is convenient,
28441 because a command line user would not want to specify that information
28442 explicitly on each command, and because user interacts with
28443 @value{GDBN} via a single terminal, so no confusion is possible as
28444 to what thread and frame are the current ones.
28446 In the case of MI, the concept of selected thread and frame is less
28447 useful. First, a frontend can easily remember this information
28448 itself. Second, a graphical frontend can have more than one window,
28449 each one used for debugging a different thread, and the frontend might
28450 want to access additional threads for internal purposes. This
28451 increases the risk that by relying on implicitly selected thread, the
28452 frontend may be operating on a wrong one. Therefore, each MI command
28453 should explicitly specify which thread and frame to operate on. To
28454 make it possible, each MI command accepts the @samp{--thread} and
28455 @samp{--frame} options, the value to each is @value{GDBN} identifier
28456 for thread and frame to operate on.
28458 Usually, each top-level window in a frontend allows the user to select
28459 a thread and a frame, and remembers the user selection for further
28460 operations. However, in some cases @value{GDBN} may suggest that the
28461 current thread be changed. For example, when stopping on a breakpoint
28462 it is reasonable to switch to the thread where breakpoint is hit. For
28463 another example, if the user issues the CLI @samp{thread} command via
28464 the frontend, it is desirable to change the frontend's selected thread to the
28465 one specified by user. @value{GDBN} communicates the suggestion to
28466 change current thread using the @samp{=thread-selected} notification.
28467 No such notification is available for the selected frame at the moment.
28469 Note that historically, MI shares the selected thread with CLI, so
28470 frontends used the @code{-thread-select} to execute commands in the
28471 right context. However, getting this to work right is cumbersome. The
28472 simplest way is for frontend to emit @code{-thread-select} command
28473 before every command. This doubles the number of commands that need
28474 to be sent. The alternative approach is to suppress @code{-thread-select}
28475 if the selected thread in @value{GDBN} is supposed to be identical to the
28476 thread the frontend wants to operate on. However, getting this
28477 optimization right can be tricky. In particular, if the frontend
28478 sends several commands to @value{GDBN}, and one of the commands changes the
28479 selected thread, then the behaviour of subsequent commands will
28480 change. So, a frontend should either wait for response from such
28481 problematic commands, or explicitly add @code{-thread-select} for
28482 all subsequent commands. No frontend is known to do this exactly
28483 right, so it is suggested to just always pass the @samp{--thread} and
28484 @samp{--frame} options.
28486 @node Asynchronous and non-stop modes
28487 @subsection Asynchronous command execution and non-stop mode
28489 On some targets, @value{GDBN} is capable of processing MI commands
28490 even while the target is running. This is called @dfn{asynchronous
28491 command execution} (@pxref{Background Execution}). The frontend may
28492 specify a preferrence for asynchronous execution using the
28493 @code{-gdb-set target-async 1} command, which should be emitted before
28494 either running the executable or attaching to the target. After the
28495 frontend has started the executable or attached to the target, it can
28496 find if asynchronous execution is enabled using the
28497 @code{-list-target-features} command.
28499 Even if @value{GDBN} can accept a command while target is running,
28500 many commands that access the target do not work when the target is
28501 running. Therefore, asynchronous command execution is most useful
28502 when combined with non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}). Then,
28503 it is possible to examine the state of one thread, while other threads
28506 When a given thread is running, MI commands that try to access the
28507 target in the context of that thread may not work, or may work only on
28508 some targets. In particular, commands that try to operate on thread's
28509 stack will not work, on any target. Commands that read memory, or
28510 modify breakpoints, may work or not work, depending on the target. Note
28511 that even commands that operate on global state, such as @code{print},
28512 @code{set}, and breakpoint commands, still access the target in the
28513 context of a specific thread, so frontend should try to find a
28514 stopped thread and perform the operation on that thread (using the
28515 @samp{--thread} option).
28517 Which commands will work in the context of a running thread is
28518 highly target dependent. However, the two commands
28519 @code{-exec-interrupt}, to stop a thread, and @code{-thread-info},
28520 to find the state of a thread, will always work.
28522 @node Thread groups
28523 @subsection Thread groups
28524 @value{GDBN} may be used to debug several processes at the same time.
28525 On some platfroms, @value{GDBN} may support debugging of several
28526 hardware systems, each one having several cores with several different
28527 processes running on each core. This section describes the MI
28528 mechanism to support such debugging scenarios.
28530 The key observation is that regardless of the structure of the
28531 target, MI can have a global list of threads, because most commands that
28532 accept the @samp{--thread} option do not need to know what process that
28533 thread belongs to. Therefore, it is not necessary to introduce
28534 neither additional @samp{--process} option, nor an notion of the
28535 current process in the MI interface. The only strictly new feature
28536 that is required is the ability to find how the threads are grouped
28539 To allow the user to discover such grouping, and to support arbitrary
28540 hierarchy of machines/cores/processes, MI introduces the concept of a
28541 @dfn{thread group}. Thread group is a collection of threads and other
28542 thread groups. A thread group always has a string identifier, a type,
28543 and may have additional attributes specific to the type. A new
28544 command, @code{-list-thread-groups}, returns the list of top-level
28545 thread groups, which correspond to processes that @value{GDBN} is
28546 debugging at the moment. By passing an identifier of a thread group
28547 to the @code{-list-thread-groups} command, it is possible to obtain
28548 the members of specific thread group.
28550 To allow the user to easily discover processes, and other objects, he
28551 wishes to debug, a concept of @dfn{available thread group} is
28552 introduced. Available thread group is an thread group that
28553 @value{GDBN} is not debugging, but that can be attached to, using the
28554 @code{-target-attach} command. The list of available top-level thread
28555 groups can be obtained using @samp{-list-thread-groups --available}.
28556 In general, the content of a thread group may be only retrieved only
28557 after attaching to that thread group.
28559 Thread groups are related to inferiors (@pxref{Inferiors and
28560 Programs}). Each inferior corresponds to a thread group of a special
28561 type @samp{process}, and some additional operations are permitted on
28562 such thread groups.
28564 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28565 @node GDB/MI Command Syntax
28566 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Syntax
28569 * GDB/MI Input Syntax::
28570 * GDB/MI Output Syntax::
28573 @node GDB/MI Input Syntax
28574 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Input Syntax
28576 @cindex input syntax for @sc{gdb/mi}
28577 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, input syntax
28579 @item @var{command} @expansion{}
28580 @code{@var{cli-command} | @var{mi-command}}
28582 @item @var{cli-command} @expansion{}
28583 @code{[ @var{token} ] @var{cli-command} @var{nl}}, where
28584 @var{cli-command} is any existing @value{GDBN} CLI command.
28586 @item @var{mi-command} @expansion{}
28587 @code{[ @var{token} ] "-" @var{operation} ( " " @var{option} )*
28588 @code{[} " --" @code{]} ( " " @var{parameter} )* @var{nl}}
28590 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
28591 "any sequence of digits"
28593 @item @var{option} @expansion{}
28594 @code{"-" @var{parameter} [ " " @var{parameter} ]}
28596 @item @var{parameter} @expansion{}
28597 @code{@var{non-blank-sequence} | @var{c-string}}
28599 @item @var{operation} @expansion{}
28600 @emph{any of the operations described in this chapter}
28602 @item @var{non-blank-sequence} @expansion{}
28603 @emph{anything, provided it doesn't contain special characters such as
28604 "-", @var{nl}, """ and of course " "}
28606 @item @var{c-string} @expansion{}
28607 @code{""" @var{seven-bit-iso-c-string-content} """}
28609 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
28618 The CLI commands are still handled by the @sc{mi} interpreter; their
28619 output is described below.
28622 The @code{@var{token}}, when present, is passed back when the command
28626 Some @sc{mi} commands accept optional arguments as part of the parameter
28627 list. Each option is identified by a leading @samp{-} (dash) and may be
28628 followed by an optional argument parameter. Options occur first in the
28629 parameter list and can be delimited from normal parameters using
28630 @samp{--} (this is useful when some parameters begin with a dash).
28637 We want easy access to the existing CLI syntax (for debugging).
28640 We want it to be easy to spot a @sc{mi} operation.
28643 @node GDB/MI Output Syntax
28644 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax
28646 @cindex output syntax of @sc{gdb/mi}
28647 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, output syntax
28648 The output from @sc{gdb/mi} consists of zero or more out-of-band records
28649 followed, optionally, by a single result record. This result record
28650 is for the most recent command. The sequence of output records is
28651 terminated by @samp{(gdb)}.
28653 If an input command was prefixed with a @code{@var{token}} then the
28654 corresponding output for that command will also be prefixed by that same
28658 @item @var{output} @expansion{}
28659 @code{( @var{out-of-band-record} )* [ @var{result-record} ] "(gdb)" @var{nl}}
28661 @item @var{result-record} @expansion{}
28662 @code{ [ @var{token} ] "^" @var{result-class} ( "," @var{result} )* @var{nl}}
28664 @item @var{out-of-band-record} @expansion{}
28665 @code{@var{async-record} | @var{stream-record}}
28667 @item @var{async-record} @expansion{}
28668 @code{@var{exec-async-output} | @var{status-async-output} | @var{notify-async-output}}
28670 @item @var{exec-async-output} @expansion{}
28671 @code{[ @var{token} ] "*" @var{async-output}}
28673 @item @var{status-async-output} @expansion{}
28674 @code{[ @var{token} ] "+" @var{async-output}}
28676 @item @var{notify-async-output} @expansion{}
28677 @code{[ @var{token} ] "=" @var{async-output}}
28679 @item @var{async-output} @expansion{}
28680 @code{@var{async-class} ( "," @var{result} )* @var{nl}}
28682 @item @var{result-class} @expansion{}
28683 @code{"done" | "running" | "connected" | "error" | "exit"}
28685 @item @var{async-class} @expansion{}
28686 @code{"stopped" | @var{others}} (where @var{others} will be added
28687 depending on the needs---this is still in development).
28689 @item @var{result} @expansion{}
28690 @code{ @var{variable} "=" @var{value}}
28692 @item @var{variable} @expansion{}
28693 @code{ @var{string} }
28695 @item @var{value} @expansion{}
28696 @code{ @var{const} | @var{tuple} | @var{list} }
28698 @item @var{const} @expansion{}
28699 @code{@var{c-string}}
28701 @item @var{tuple} @expansion{}
28702 @code{ "@{@}" | "@{" @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "@}" }
28704 @item @var{list} @expansion{}
28705 @code{ "[]" | "[" @var{value} ( "," @var{value} )* "]" | "["
28706 @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "]" }
28708 @item @var{stream-record} @expansion{}
28709 @code{@var{console-stream-output} | @var{target-stream-output} | @var{log-stream-output}}
28711 @item @var{console-stream-output} @expansion{}
28712 @code{"~" @var{c-string}}
28714 @item @var{target-stream-output} @expansion{}
28715 @code{"@@" @var{c-string}}
28717 @item @var{log-stream-output} @expansion{}
28718 @code{"&" @var{c-string}}
28720 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
28723 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
28724 @emph{any sequence of digits}.
28732 All output sequences end in a single line containing a period.
28735 The @code{@var{token}} is from the corresponding request. Note that
28736 for all async output, while the token is allowed by the grammar and
28737 may be output by future versions of @value{GDBN} for select async
28738 output messages, it is generally omitted. Frontends should treat
28739 all async output as reporting general changes in the state of the
28740 target and there should be no need to associate async output to any
28744 @cindex status output in @sc{gdb/mi}
28745 @var{status-async-output} contains on-going status information about the
28746 progress of a slow operation. It can be discarded. All status output is
28747 prefixed by @samp{+}.
28750 @cindex async output in @sc{gdb/mi}
28751 @var{exec-async-output} contains asynchronous state change on the target
28752 (stopped, started, disappeared). All async output is prefixed by
28756 @cindex notify output in @sc{gdb/mi}
28757 @var{notify-async-output} contains supplementary information that the
28758 client should handle (e.g., a new breakpoint information). All notify
28759 output is prefixed by @samp{=}.
28762 @cindex console output in @sc{gdb/mi}
28763 @var{console-stream-output} is output that should be displayed as is in the
28764 console. It is the textual response to a CLI command. All the console
28765 output is prefixed by @samp{~}.
28768 @cindex target output in @sc{gdb/mi}
28769 @var{target-stream-output} is the output produced by the target program.
28770 All the target output is prefixed by @samp{@@}.
28773 @cindex log output in @sc{gdb/mi}
28774 @var{log-stream-output} is output text coming from @value{GDBN}'s internals, for
28775 instance messages that should be displayed as part of an error log. All
28776 the log output is prefixed by @samp{&}.
28779 @cindex list output in @sc{gdb/mi}
28780 New @sc{gdb/mi} commands should only output @var{lists} containing
28786 @xref{GDB/MI Stream Records, , @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records}, for more
28787 details about the various output records.
28789 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28790 @node GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI
28791 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Compatibility with CLI
28793 @cindex compatibility, @sc{gdb/mi} and CLI
28794 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, compatibility with CLI
28796 For the developers convenience CLI commands can be entered directly,
28797 but there may be some unexpected behaviour. For example, commands
28798 that query the user will behave as if the user replied yes, breakpoint
28799 command lists are not executed and some CLI commands, such as
28800 @code{if}, @code{when} and @code{define}, prompt for further input with
28801 @samp{>}, which is not valid MI output.
28803 This feature may be removed at some stage in the future and it is
28804 recommended that front ends use the @code{-interpreter-exec} command
28805 (@pxref{-interpreter-exec}).
28807 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28808 @node GDB/MI Development and Front Ends
28809 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends
28810 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi} development
28812 The application which takes the MI output and presents the state of the
28813 program being debugged to the user is called a @dfn{front end}.
28815 Although @sc{gdb/mi} is still incomplete, it is currently being used
28816 by a variety of front ends to @value{GDBN}. This makes it difficult
28817 to introduce new functionality without breaking existing usage. This
28818 section tries to minimize the problems by describing how the protocol
28821 Some changes in MI need not break a carefully designed front end, and
28822 for these the MI version will remain unchanged. The following is a
28823 list of changes that may occur within one level, so front ends should
28824 parse MI output in a way that can handle them:
28828 New MI commands may be added.
28831 New fields may be added to the output of any MI command.
28834 The range of values for fields with specified values, e.g.,
28835 @code{in_scope} (@pxref{-var-update}) may be extended.
28837 @c The format of field's content e.g type prefix, may change so parse it
28838 @c at your own risk. Yes, in general?
28840 @c The order of fields may change? Shouldn't really matter but it might
28841 @c resolve inconsistencies.
28844 If the changes are likely to break front ends, the MI version level
28845 will be increased by one. This will allow the front end to parse the
28846 output according to the MI version. Apart from mi0, new versions of
28847 @value{GDBN} will not support old versions of MI and it will be the
28848 responsibility of the front end to work with the new one.
28850 @c Starting with mi3, add a new command -mi-version that prints the MI
28853 The best way to avoid unexpected changes in MI that might break your front
28854 end is to make your project known to @value{GDBN} developers and
28855 follow development on @email{gdb@@sourceware.org} and
28856 @email{gdb-patches@@sourceware.org}.
28857 @cindex mailing lists
28859 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28860 @node GDB/MI Output Records
28861 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Output Records
28864 * GDB/MI Result Records::
28865 * GDB/MI Stream Records::
28866 * GDB/MI Async Records::
28867 * GDB/MI Breakpoint Information::
28868 * GDB/MI Frame Information::
28869 * GDB/MI Thread Information::
28870 * GDB/MI Ada Exception Information::
28873 @node GDB/MI Result Records
28874 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Result Records
28876 @cindex result records in @sc{gdb/mi}
28877 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, result records
28878 In addition to a number of out-of-band notifications, the response to a
28879 @sc{gdb/mi} command includes one of the following result indications:
28883 @item "^done" [ "," @var{results} ]
28884 The synchronous operation was successful, @code{@var{results}} are the return
28889 This result record is equivalent to @samp{^done}. Historically, it
28890 was output instead of @samp{^done} if the command has resumed the
28891 target. This behaviour is maintained for backward compatibility, but
28892 all frontends should treat @samp{^done} and @samp{^running}
28893 identically and rely on the @samp{*running} output record to determine
28894 which threads are resumed.
28898 @value{GDBN} has connected to a remote target.
28900 @item "^error" "," @var{c-string}
28902 The operation failed. The @code{@var{c-string}} contains the corresponding
28907 @value{GDBN} has terminated.
28911 @node GDB/MI Stream Records
28912 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records
28914 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, stream records
28915 @cindex stream records in @sc{gdb/mi}
28916 @value{GDBN} internally maintains a number of output streams: the console, the
28917 target, and the log. The output intended for each of these streams is
28918 funneled through the @sc{gdb/mi} interface using @dfn{stream records}.
28920 Each stream record begins with a unique @dfn{prefix character} which
28921 identifies its stream (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, , @sc{gdb/mi} Output
28922 Syntax}). In addition to the prefix, each stream record contains a
28923 @code{@var{string-output}}. This is either raw text (with an implicit new
28924 line) or a quoted C string (which does not contain an implicit newline).
28927 @item "~" @var{string-output}
28928 The console output stream contains text that should be displayed in the
28929 CLI console window. It contains the textual responses to CLI commands.
28931 @item "@@" @var{string-output}
28932 The target output stream contains any textual output from the running
28933 target. This is only present when GDB's event loop is truly
28934 asynchronous, which is currently only the case for remote targets.
28936 @item "&" @var{string-output}
28937 The log stream contains debugging messages being produced by @value{GDBN}'s
28941 @node GDB/MI Async Records
28942 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Async Records
28944 @cindex async records in @sc{gdb/mi}
28945 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, async records
28946 @dfn{Async} records are used to notify the @sc{gdb/mi} client of
28947 additional changes that have occurred. Those changes can either be a
28948 consequence of @sc{gdb/mi} commands (e.g., a breakpoint modified) or a result of
28949 target activity (e.g., target stopped).
28951 The following is the list of possible async records:
28955 @item *running,thread-id="@var{thread}"
28956 The target is now running. The @var{thread} field tells which
28957 specific thread is now running, and can be @samp{all} if all threads
28958 are running. The frontend should assume that no interaction with a
28959 running thread is possible after this notification is produced.
28960 The frontend should not assume that this notification is output
28961 only once for any command. @value{GDBN} may emit this notification
28962 several times, either for different threads, because it cannot resume
28963 all threads together, or even for a single thread, if the thread must
28964 be stepped though some code before letting it run freely.
28966 @item *stopped,reason="@var{reason}",thread-id="@var{id}",stopped-threads="@var{stopped}",core="@var{core}"
28967 The target has stopped. The @var{reason} field can have one of the
28971 @item breakpoint-hit
28972 A breakpoint was reached.
28973 @item watchpoint-trigger
28974 A watchpoint was triggered.
28975 @item read-watchpoint-trigger
28976 A read watchpoint was triggered.
28977 @item access-watchpoint-trigger
28978 An access watchpoint was triggered.
28979 @item function-finished
28980 An -exec-finish or similar CLI command was accomplished.
28981 @item location-reached
28982 An -exec-until or similar CLI command was accomplished.
28983 @item watchpoint-scope
28984 A watchpoint has gone out of scope.
28985 @item end-stepping-range
28986 An -exec-next, -exec-next-instruction, -exec-step, -exec-step-instruction or
28987 similar CLI command was accomplished.
28988 @item exited-signalled
28989 The inferior exited because of a signal.
28991 The inferior exited.
28992 @item exited-normally
28993 The inferior exited normally.
28994 @item signal-received
28995 A signal was received by the inferior.
28997 The inferior has stopped due to a library being loaded or unloaded.
28998 This can happen when @code{stop-on-solib-events} (@pxref{Files}) is
28999 set or when a @code{catch load} or @code{catch unload} catchpoint is
29000 in use (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}).
29002 The inferior has forked. This is reported when @code{catch fork}
29003 (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
29005 The inferior has vforked. This is reported in when @code{catch vfork}
29006 (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
29007 @item syscall-entry
29008 The inferior entered a system call. This is reported when @code{catch
29009 syscall} (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
29010 @item syscall-entry
29011 The inferior returned from a system call. This is reported when
29012 @code{catch syscall} (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
29014 The inferior called @code{exec}. This is reported when @code{catch exec}
29015 (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
29018 The @var{id} field identifies the thread that directly caused the stop
29019 -- for example by hitting a breakpoint. Depending on whether all-stop
29020 mode is in effect (@pxref{All-Stop Mode}), @value{GDBN} may either
29021 stop all threads, or only the thread that directly triggered the stop.
29022 If all threads are stopped, the @var{stopped} field will have the
29023 value of @code{"all"}. Otherwise, the value of the @var{stopped}
29024 field will be a list of thread identifiers. Presently, this list will
29025 always include a single thread, but frontend should be prepared to see
29026 several threads in the list. The @var{core} field reports the
29027 processor core on which the stop event has happened. This field may be absent
29028 if such information is not available.
29030 @item =thread-group-added,id="@var{id}"
29031 @itemx =thread-group-removed,id="@var{id}"
29032 A thread group was either added or removed. The @var{id} field
29033 contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread group. When a thread
29034 group is added, it generally might not be associated with a running
29035 process. When a thread group is removed, its id becomes invalid and
29036 cannot be used in any way.
29038 @item =thread-group-started,id="@var{id}",pid="@var{pid}"
29039 A thread group became associated with a running program,
29040 either because the program was just started or the thread group
29041 was attached to a program. The @var{id} field contains the
29042 @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread group. The @var{pid} field
29043 contains process identifier, specific to the operating system.
29045 @item =thread-group-exited,id="@var{id}"[,exit-code="@var{code}"]
29046 A thread group is no longer associated with a running program,
29047 either because the program has exited, or because it was detached
29048 from. The @var{id} field contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the
29049 thread group. @var{code} is the exit code of the inferior; it exists
29050 only when the inferior exited with some code.
29052 @item =thread-created,id="@var{id}",group-id="@var{gid}"
29053 @itemx =thread-exited,id="@var{id}",group-id="@var{gid}"
29054 A thread either was created, or has exited. The @var{id} field
29055 contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread. The @var{gid}
29056 field identifies the thread group this thread belongs to.
29058 @item =thread-selected,id="@var{id}"
29059 Informs that the selected thread was changed as result of the last
29060 command. This notification is not emitted as result of @code{-thread-select}
29061 command but is emitted whenever an MI command that is not documented
29062 to change the selected thread actually changes it. In particular,
29063 invoking, directly or indirectly (via user-defined command), the CLI
29064 @code{thread} command, will generate this notification.
29066 We suggest that in response to this notification, front ends
29067 highlight the selected thread and cause subsequent commands to apply to
29070 @item =library-loaded,...
29071 Reports that a new library file was loaded by the program. This
29072 notification has 4 fields---@var{id}, @var{target-name},
29073 @var{host-name}, and @var{symbols-loaded}. The @var{id} field is an
29074 opaque identifier of the library. For remote debugging case,
29075 @var{target-name} and @var{host-name} fields give the name of the
29076 library file on the target, and on the host respectively. For native
29077 debugging, both those fields have the same value. The
29078 @var{symbols-loaded} field is emitted only for backward compatibility
29079 and should not be relied on to convey any useful information. The
29080 @var{thread-group} field, if present, specifies the id of the thread
29081 group in whose context the library was loaded. If the field is
29082 absent, it means the library was loaded in the context of all present
29085 @item =library-unloaded,...
29086 Reports that a library was unloaded by the program. This notification
29087 has 3 fields---@var{id}, @var{target-name} and @var{host-name} with
29088 the same meaning as for the @code{=library-loaded} notification.
29089 The @var{thread-group} field, if present, specifies the id of the
29090 thread group in whose context the library was unloaded. If the field is
29091 absent, it means the library was unloaded in the context of all present
29094 @item =traceframe-changed,num=@var{tfnum},tracepoint=@var{tpnum}
29095 @itemx =traceframe-changed,end
29096 Reports that the trace frame was changed and its new number is
29097 @var{tfnum}. The number of the tracepoint associated with this trace
29098 frame is @var{tpnum}.
29100 @item =tsv-created,name=@var{name},initial=@var{initial}
29101 Reports that the new trace state variable @var{name} is created with
29102 initial value @var{initial}.
29104 @item =tsv-deleted,name=@var{name}
29105 @itemx =tsv-deleted
29106 Reports that the trace state variable @var{name} is deleted or all
29107 trace state variables are deleted.
29109 @item =tsv-modified,name=@var{name},initial=@var{initial}[,current=@var{current}]
29110 Reports that the trace state variable @var{name} is modified with
29111 the initial value @var{initial}. The current value @var{current} of
29112 trace state variable is optional and is reported if the current
29113 value of trace state variable is known.
29115 @item =breakpoint-created,bkpt=@{...@}
29116 @itemx =breakpoint-modified,bkpt=@{...@}
29117 @itemx =breakpoint-deleted,id=@var{number}
29118 Reports that a breakpoint was created, modified, or deleted,
29119 respectively. Only user-visible breakpoints are reported to the MI
29122 The @var{bkpt} argument is of the same form as returned by the various
29123 breakpoint commands; @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands}. The
29124 @var{number} is the ordinal number of the breakpoint.
29126 Note that if a breakpoint is emitted in the result record of a
29127 command, then it will not also be emitted in an async record.
29129 @item =record-started,thread-group="@var{id}"
29130 @itemx =record-stopped,thread-group="@var{id}"
29131 Execution log recording was either started or stopped on an
29132 inferior. The @var{id} is the @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread
29133 group corresponding to the affected inferior.
29135 @item =cmd-param-changed,param=@var{param},value=@var{value}
29136 Reports that a parameter of the command @code{set @var{param}} is
29137 changed to @var{value}. In the multi-word @code{set} command,
29138 the @var{param} is the whole parameter list to @code{set} command.
29139 For example, In command @code{set check type on}, @var{param}
29140 is @code{check type} and @var{value} is @code{on}.
29142 @item =memory-changed,thread-group=@var{id},addr=@var{addr},len=@var{len}[,type="code"]
29143 Reports that bytes from @var{addr} to @var{data} + @var{len} were
29144 written in an inferior. The @var{id} is the identifier of the
29145 thread group corresponding to the affected inferior. The optional
29146 @code{type="code"} part is reported if the memory written to holds
29150 @node GDB/MI Breakpoint Information
29151 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Breakpoint Information
29153 When @value{GDBN} reports information about a breakpoint, a
29154 tracepoint, a watchpoint, or a catchpoint, it uses a tuple with the
29159 The breakpoint number. For a breakpoint that represents one location
29160 of a multi-location breakpoint, this will be a dotted pair, like
29164 The type of the breakpoint. For ordinary breakpoints this will be
29165 @samp{breakpoint}, but many values are possible.
29168 If the type of the breakpoint is @samp{catchpoint}, then this
29169 indicates the exact type of catchpoint.
29172 This is the breakpoint disposition---either @samp{del}, meaning that
29173 the breakpoint will be deleted at the next stop, or @samp{keep},
29174 meaning that the breakpoint will not be deleted.
29177 This indicates whether the breakpoint is enabled, in which case the
29178 value is @samp{y}, or disabled, in which case the value is @samp{n}.
29179 Note that this is not the same as the field @code{enable}.
29182 The address of the breakpoint. This may be a hexidecimal number,
29183 giving the address; or the string @samp{<PENDING>}, for a pending
29184 breakpoint; or the string @samp{<MULTIPLE>}, for a breakpoint with
29185 multiple locations. This field will not be present if no address can
29186 be determined. For example, a watchpoint does not have an address.
29189 If known, the function in which the breakpoint appears.
29190 If not known, this field is not present.
29193 The name of the source file which contains this function, if known.
29194 If not known, this field is not present.
29197 The full file name of the source file which contains this function, if
29198 known. If not known, this field is not present.
29201 The line number at which this breakpoint appears, if known.
29202 If not known, this field is not present.
29205 If the source file is not known, this field may be provided. If
29206 provided, this holds the address of the breakpoint, possibly followed
29210 If this breakpoint is pending, this field is present and holds the
29211 text used to set the breakpoint, as entered by the user.
29214 Where this breakpoint's condition is evaluated, either @samp{host} or
29218 If this is a thread-specific breakpoint, then this identifies the
29219 thread in which the breakpoint can trigger.
29222 If this breakpoint is restricted to a particular Ada task, then this
29223 field will hold the task identifier.
29226 If the breakpoint is conditional, this is the condition expression.
29229 The ignore count of the breakpoint.
29232 The enable count of the breakpoint.
29234 @item traceframe-usage
29237 @item static-tracepoint-marker-string-id
29238 For a static tracepoint, the name of the static tracepoint marker.
29241 For a masked watchpoint, this is the mask.
29244 A tracepoint's pass count.
29246 @item original-location
29247 The location of the breakpoint as originally specified by the user.
29248 This field is optional.
29251 The number of times the breakpoint has been hit.
29254 This field is only given for tracepoints. This is either @samp{y},
29255 meaning that the tracepoint is installed, or @samp{n}, meaning that it
29259 Some extra data, the exact contents of which are type-dependent.
29263 For example, here is what the output of @code{-break-insert}
29264 (@pxref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands}) might be:
29267 -> -break-insert main
29268 <- ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
29269 enabled="y",addr="0x08048564",func="main",file="myprog.c",
29270 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68",thread-groups=["i1"],
29275 @node GDB/MI Frame Information
29276 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Frame Information
29278 Response from many MI commands includes an information about stack
29279 frame. This information is a tuple that may have the following
29284 The level of the stack frame. The innermost frame has the level of
29285 zero. This field is always present.
29288 The name of the function corresponding to the frame. This field may
29289 be absent if @value{GDBN} is unable to determine the function name.
29292 The code address for the frame. This field is always present.
29295 The name of the source files that correspond to the frame's code
29296 address. This field may be absent.
29299 The source line corresponding to the frames' code address. This field
29303 The name of the binary file (either executable or shared library) the
29304 corresponds to the frame's code address. This field may be absent.
29308 @node GDB/MI Thread Information
29309 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Thread Information
29311 Whenever @value{GDBN} has to report an information about a thread, it
29312 uses a tuple with the following fields:
29316 The numeric id assigned to the thread by @value{GDBN}. This field is
29320 Target-specific string identifying the thread. This field is always present.
29323 Additional information about the thread provided by the target.
29324 It is supposed to be human-readable and not interpreted by the
29325 frontend. This field is optional.
29328 Either @samp{stopped} or @samp{running}, depending on whether the
29329 thread is presently running. This field is always present.
29332 The value of this field is an integer number of the processor core the
29333 thread was last seen on. This field is optional.
29336 @node GDB/MI Ada Exception Information
29337 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Ada Exception Information
29339 Whenever a @code{*stopped} record is emitted because the program
29340 stopped after hitting an exception catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}),
29341 @value{GDBN} provides the name of the exception that was raised via
29342 the @code{exception-name} field.
29344 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
29345 @node GDB/MI Simple Examples
29346 @section Simple Examples of @sc{gdb/mi} Interaction
29347 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, simple examples
29349 This subsection presents several simple examples of interaction using
29350 the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. In these examples, @samp{->} means that the
29351 following line is passed to @sc{gdb/mi} as input, while @samp{<-} means
29352 the output received from @sc{gdb/mi}.
29354 Note the line breaks shown in the examples are here only for
29355 readability, they don't appear in the real output.
29357 @subheading Setting a Breakpoint
29359 Setting a breakpoint generates synchronous output which contains detailed
29360 information of the breakpoint.
29363 -> -break-insert main
29364 <- ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
29365 enabled="y",addr="0x08048564",func="main",file="myprog.c",
29366 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68",thread-groups=["i1"],
29371 @subheading Program Execution
29373 Program execution generates asynchronous records and MI gives the
29374 reason that execution stopped.
29380 <- *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
29381 frame=@{addr="0x08048564",func="main",
29382 args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},@{name="argv",value="0xbfc4d4d4"@}],
29383 file="myprog.c",fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68"@}
29388 <- *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
29392 @subheading Quitting @value{GDBN}
29394 Quitting @value{GDBN} just prints the result class @samp{^exit}.
29402 Please note that @samp{^exit} is printed immediately, but it might
29403 take some time for @value{GDBN} to actually exit. During that time, @value{GDBN}
29404 performs necessary cleanups, including killing programs being debugged
29405 or disconnecting from debug hardware, so the frontend should wait till
29406 @value{GDBN} exits and should only forcibly kill @value{GDBN} if it
29407 fails to exit in reasonable time.
29409 @subheading A Bad Command
29411 Here's what happens if you pass a non-existent command:
29415 <- ^error,msg="Undefined MI command: rubbish"
29420 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
29421 @node GDB/MI Command Description Format
29422 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Description Format
29424 The remaining sections describe blocks of commands. Each block of
29425 commands is laid out in a fashion similar to this section.
29427 @subheading Motivation
29429 The motivation for this collection of commands.
29431 @subheading Introduction
29433 A brief introduction to this collection of commands as a whole.
29435 @subheading Commands
29437 For each command in the block, the following is described:
29439 @subsubheading Synopsis
29442 -command @var{args}@dots{}
29445 @subsubheading Result
29447 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29449 The corresponding @value{GDBN} CLI command(s), if any.
29451 @subsubheading Example
29453 Example(s) formatted for readability. Some of the described commands have
29454 not been implemented yet and these are labeled N.A.@: (not available).
29457 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
29458 @node GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands
29459 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Breakpoint Commands
29461 @cindex breakpoint commands for @sc{gdb/mi}
29462 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, breakpoint commands
29463 This section documents @sc{gdb/mi} commands for manipulating
29466 @subheading The @code{-break-after} Command
29467 @findex -break-after
29469 @subsubheading Synopsis
29472 -break-after @var{number} @var{count}
29475 The breakpoint number @var{number} is not in effect until it has been
29476 hit @var{count} times. To see how this is reflected in the output of
29477 the @samp{-break-list} command, see the description of the
29478 @samp{-break-list} command below.
29480 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29482 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ignore}.
29484 @subsubheading Example
29489 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
29490 enabled="y",addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",
29491 fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],
29499 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
29500 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
29501 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
29502 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
29503 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
29504 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
29505 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
29506 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
29507 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
29508 line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
29513 @subheading The @code{-break-catch} Command
29514 @findex -break-catch
29517 @subheading The @code{-break-commands} Command
29518 @findex -break-commands
29520 @subsubheading Synopsis
29523 -break-commands @var{number} [ @var{command1} ... @var{commandN} ]
29526 Specifies the CLI commands that should be executed when breakpoint
29527 @var{number} is hit. The parameters @var{command1} to @var{commandN}
29528 are the commands. If no command is specified, any previously-set
29529 commands are cleared. @xref{Break Commands}. Typical use of this
29530 functionality is tracing a program, that is, printing of values of
29531 some variables whenever breakpoint is hit and then continuing.
29533 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29535 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{commands}.
29537 @subsubheading Example
29542 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
29543 enabled="y",addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",
29544 fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],
29547 -break-commands 1 "print v" "continue"
29552 @subheading The @code{-break-condition} Command
29553 @findex -break-condition
29555 @subsubheading Synopsis
29558 -break-condition @var{number} @var{expr}
29561 Breakpoint @var{number} will stop the program only if the condition in
29562 @var{expr} is true. The condition becomes part of the
29563 @samp{-break-list} output (see the description of the @samp{-break-list}
29566 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29568 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{condition}.
29570 @subsubheading Example
29574 -break-condition 1 1
29578 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
29579 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
29580 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
29581 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
29582 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
29583 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
29584 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
29585 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
29586 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
29587 line="5",cond="1",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
29591 @subheading The @code{-break-delete} Command
29592 @findex -break-delete
29594 @subsubheading Synopsis
29597 -break-delete ( @var{breakpoint} )+
29600 Delete the breakpoint(s) whose number(s) are specified in the argument
29601 list. This is obviously reflected in the breakpoint list.
29603 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29605 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{delete}.
29607 @subsubheading Example
29615 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
29616 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
29617 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
29618 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
29619 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
29620 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
29621 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
29626 @subheading The @code{-break-disable} Command
29627 @findex -break-disable
29629 @subsubheading Synopsis
29632 -break-disable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
29635 Disable the named @var{breakpoint}(s). The field @samp{enabled} in the
29636 break list is now set to @samp{n} for the named @var{breakpoint}(s).
29638 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29640 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disable}.
29642 @subsubheading Example
29650 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
29651 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
29652 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
29653 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
29654 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
29655 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
29656 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
29657 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="n",
29658 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
29659 line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
29663 @subheading The @code{-break-enable} Command
29664 @findex -break-enable
29666 @subsubheading Synopsis
29669 -break-enable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
29672 Enable (previously disabled) @var{breakpoint}(s).
29674 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29676 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{enable}.
29678 @subsubheading Example
29686 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
29687 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
29688 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
29689 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
29690 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
29691 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
29692 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
29693 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
29694 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
29695 line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
29699 @subheading The @code{-break-info} Command
29700 @findex -break-info
29702 @subsubheading Synopsis
29705 -break-info @var{breakpoint}
29709 Get information about a single breakpoint.
29711 The result is a table of breakpoints. @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint
29712 Information}, for details on the format of each breakpoint in the
29715 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29717 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break @var{breakpoint}}.
29719 @subsubheading Example
29722 @subheading The @code{-break-insert} Command
29723 @findex -break-insert
29725 @subsubheading Synopsis
29728 -break-insert [ -t ] [ -h ] [ -f ] [ -d ] [ -a ]
29729 [ -c @var{condition} ] [ -i @var{ignore-count} ]
29730 [ -p @var{thread-id} ] [ @var{location} ]
29734 If specified, @var{location}, can be one of:
29741 @item filename:linenum
29742 @item filename:function
29746 The possible optional parameters of this command are:
29750 Insert a temporary breakpoint.
29752 Insert a hardware breakpoint.
29754 If @var{location} cannot be parsed (for example if it
29755 refers to unknown files or functions), create a pending
29756 breakpoint. Without this flag, @value{GDBN} will report
29757 an error, and won't create a breakpoint, if @var{location}
29760 Create a disabled breakpoint.
29762 Create a tracepoint. @xref{Tracepoints}. When this parameter
29763 is used together with @samp{-h}, a fast tracepoint is created.
29764 @item -c @var{condition}
29765 Make the breakpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
29766 @item -i @var{ignore-count}
29767 Initialize the @var{ignore-count}.
29768 @item -p @var{thread-id}
29769 Restrict the breakpoint to the specified @var{thread-id}.
29772 @subsubheading Result
29774 @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Information}, for details on the format of the
29775 resulting breakpoint.
29777 Note: this format is open to change.
29778 @c An out-of-band breakpoint instead of part of the result?
29780 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29782 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{break}, @samp{tbreak},
29783 @samp{hbreak}, and @samp{thbreak}. @c and @samp{rbreak}.
29785 @subsubheading Example
29790 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",
29791 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="4",thread-groups=["i1"],
29794 -break-insert -t foo
29795 ^done,bkpt=@{number="2",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c",
29796 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="11",thread-groups=["i1"],
29800 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
29801 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
29802 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
29803 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
29804 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
29805 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
29806 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
29807 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
29808 addr="0x0001072c", func="main",file="recursive2.c",
29809 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,"line="4",thread-groups=["i1"],
29811 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="del",enabled="y",
29812 addr="0x00010774",func="foo",file="recursive2.c",
29813 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",thread-groups=["i1"],
29816 @c -break-insert -r foo.*
29817 @c ~int foo(int, int);
29818 @c ^done,bkpt=@{number="3",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c,
29819 @c "fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",thread-groups=["i1"],
29824 @subheading The @code{-dprintf-insert} Command
29825 @findex -dprintf-insert
29827 @subsubheading Synopsis
29830 -dprintf-insert [ -t ] [ -f ] [ -d ]
29831 [ -c @var{condition} ] [ -i @var{ignore-count} ]
29832 [ -p @var{thread-id} ] [ @var{location} ] [ @var{format} ]
29837 If specified, @var{location}, can be one of:
29840 @item @var{function}
29843 @c @item @var{linenum}
29844 @item @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
29845 @item @var{filename}:function
29846 @item *@var{address}
29849 The possible optional parameters of this command are:
29853 Insert a temporary breakpoint.
29855 If @var{location} cannot be parsed (for example, if it
29856 refers to unknown files or functions), create a pending
29857 breakpoint. Without this flag, @value{GDBN} will report
29858 an error, and won't create a breakpoint, if @var{location}
29861 Create a disabled breakpoint.
29862 @item -c @var{condition}
29863 Make the breakpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
29864 @item -i @var{ignore-count}
29865 Set the ignore count of the breakpoint (@pxref{Conditions, ignore count})
29866 to @var{ignore-count}.
29867 @item -p @var{thread-id}
29868 Restrict the breakpoint to the specified @var{thread-id}.
29871 @subsubheading Result
29873 @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Information}, for details on the format of the
29874 resulting breakpoint.
29876 @c An out-of-band breakpoint instead of part of the result?
29878 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29880 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{dprintf}.
29882 @subsubheading Example
29886 4-dprintf-insert foo "At foo entry\n"
29887 4^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="dprintf",disp="keep",enabled="y",
29888 addr="0x000000000040061b",func="foo",file="mi-dprintf.c",
29889 fullname="mi-dprintf.c",line="25",thread-groups=["i1"],
29890 times="0",script=@{"printf \"At foo entry\\n\"","continue"@},
29891 original-location="foo"@}
29893 5-dprintf-insert 26 "arg=%d, g=%d\n" arg g
29894 5^done,bkpt=@{number="2",type="dprintf",disp="keep",enabled="y",
29895 addr="0x000000000040062a",func="foo",file="mi-dprintf.c",
29896 fullname="mi-dprintf.c",line="26",thread-groups=["i1"],
29897 times="0",script=@{"printf \"arg=%d, g=%d\\n\", arg, g","continue"@},
29898 original-location="mi-dprintf.c:26"@}
29902 @subheading The @code{-break-list} Command
29903 @findex -break-list
29905 @subsubheading Synopsis
29911 Displays the list of inserted breakpoints, showing the following fields:
29915 number of the breakpoint
29917 type of the breakpoint: @samp{breakpoint} or @samp{watchpoint}
29919 should the breakpoint be deleted or disabled when it is hit: @samp{keep}
29922 is the breakpoint enabled or no: @samp{y} or @samp{n}
29924 memory location at which the breakpoint is set
29926 logical location of the breakpoint, expressed by function name, file
29928 @item Thread-groups
29929 list of thread groups to which this breakpoint applies
29931 number of times the breakpoint has been hit
29934 If there are no breakpoints or watchpoints, the @code{BreakpointTable}
29935 @code{body} field is an empty list.
29937 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29939 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break}.
29941 @subsubheading Example
29946 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
29947 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
29948 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
29949 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
29950 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
29951 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
29952 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
29953 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
29954 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],
29956 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
29957 addr="0x00010114",func="foo",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
29958 line="13",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
29962 Here's an example of the result when there are no breakpoints:
29967 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
29968 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
29969 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
29970 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
29971 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
29972 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
29973 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
29978 @subheading The @code{-break-passcount} Command
29979 @findex -break-passcount
29981 @subsubheading Synopsis
29984 -break-passcount @var{tracepoint-number} @var{passcount}
29987 Set the passcount for tracepoint @var{tracepoint-number} to
29988 @var{passcount}. If the breakpoint referred to by @var{tracepoint-number}
29989 is not a tracepoint, error is emitted. This corresponds to CLI
29990 command @samp{passcount}.
29992 @subheading The @code{-break-watch} Command
29993 @findex -break-watch
29995 @subsubheading Synopsis
29998 -break-watch [ -a | -r ]
30001 Create a watchpoint. With the @samp{-a} option it will create an
30002 @dfn{access} watchpoint, i.e., a watchpoint that triggers either on a
30003 read from or on a write to the memory location. With the @samp{-r}
30004 option, the watchpoint created is a @dfn{read} watchpoint, i.e., it will
30005 trigger only when the memory location is accessed for reading. Without
30006 either of the options, the watchpoint created is a regular watchpoint,
30007 i.e., it will trigger when the memory location is accessed for writing.
30008 @xref{Set Watchpoints, , Setting Watchpoints}.
30010 Note that @samp{-break-list} will report a single list of watchpoints and
30011 breakpoints inserted.
30013 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30015 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{watch}, @samp{awatch}, and
30018 @subsubheading Example
30020 Setting a watchpoint on a variable in the @code{main} function:
30025 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@}
30030 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@},
30031 value=@{old="-268439212",new="55"@},
30032 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
30033 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="5"@}
30037 Setting a watchpoint on a variable local to a function. @value{GDBN} will stop
30038 the program execution twice: first for the variable changing value, then
30039 for the watchpoint going out of scope.
30044 ^done,wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@}
30049 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",
30050 wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@},value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
30051 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
30052 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30053 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
30058 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="5",
30059 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
30060 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
30061 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30062 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
30066 Listing breakpoints and watchpoints, at different points in the program
30067 execution. Note that once the watchpoint goes out of scope, it is
30073 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@}
30076 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
30077 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
30078 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
30079 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
30080 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
30081 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
30082 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
30083 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
30084 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
30085 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30086 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c"line="8",thread-groups=["i1"],
30088 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
30089 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
30094 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@},
30095 value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
30096 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
30097 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30098 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
30101 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
30102 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
30103 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
30104 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
30105 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
30106 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
30107 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
30108 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
30109 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
30110 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30111 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",thread-groups=["i1"],
30113 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
30114 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",thread-groups=["i1"],times="-5"@}]@}
30118 ^done,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="2",
30119 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
30120 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
30121 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30122 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
30125 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
30126 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
30127 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
30128 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
30129 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
30130 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
30131 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
30132 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
30133 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
30134 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30135 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",
30136 thread-groups=["i1"],times="1"@}]@}
30141 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30142 @node GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands
30143 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Catchpoint Commands
30145 This section documents @sc{gdb/mi} commands for manipulating
30148 @subheading The @code{-catch-load} Command
30149 @findex -catch-load
30151 @subsubheading Synopsis
30154 -catch-load [ -t ] [ -d ] @var{regexp}
30157 Add a catchpoint for library load events. If the @samp{-t} option is used,
30158 the catchpoint is a temporary one (@pxref{Set Breaks, ,Setting
30159 Breakpoints}). If the @samp{-d} option is used, the catchpoint is created
30160 in a disabled state. The @samp{regexp} argument is a regular
30161 expression used to match the name of the loaded library.
30164 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30166 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch load}.
30168 @subsubheading Example
30171 -catch-load -t foo.so
30172 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="catchpoint",disp="del",enabled="y",
30173 what="load of library matching foo.so",catch-type="load",times="0"@}
30178 @subheading The @code{-catch-unload} Command
30179 @findex -catch-unload
30181 @subsubheading Synopsis
30184 -catch-unload [ -t ] [ -d ] @var{regexp}
30187 Add a catchpoint for library unload events. If the @samp{-t} option is
30188 used, the catchpoint is a temporary one (@pxref{Set Breaks, ,Setting
30189 Breakpoints}). If the @samp{-d} option is used, the catchpoint is
30190 created in a disabled state. The @samp{regexp} argument is a regular
30191 expression used to match the name of the unloaded library.
30193 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30195 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch unload}.
30197 @subsubheading Example
30200 -catch-unload -d bar.so
30201 ^done,bkpt=@{number="2",type="catchpoint",disp="keep",enabled="n",
30202 what="load of library matching bar.so",catch-type="unload",times="0"@}
30207 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30208 @node GDB/MI Program Context
30209 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Context
30211 @subheading The @code{-exec-arguments} Command
30212 @findex -exec-arguments
30215 @subsubheading Synopsis
30218 -exec-arguments @var{args}
30221 Set the inferior program arguments, to be used in the next
30224 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30226 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set args}.
30228 @subsubheading Example
30232 -exec-arguments -v word
30239 @subheading The @code{-exec-show-arguments} Command
30240 @findex -exec-show-arguments
30242 @subsubheading Synopsis
30245 -exec-show-arguments
30248 Print the arguments of the program.
30250 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30252 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show args}.
30254 @subsubheading Example
30259 @subheading The @code{-environment-cd} Command
30260 @findex -environment-cd
30262 @subsubheading Synopsis
30265 -environment-cd @var{pathdir}
30268 Set @value{GDBN}'s working directory.
30270 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30272 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{cd}.
30274 @subsubheading Example
30278 -environment-cd /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
30284 @subheading The @code{-environment-directory} Command
30285 @findex -environment-directory
30287 @subsubheading Synopsis
30290 -environment-directory [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
30293 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for source files.
30294 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the default
30295 search path. If directories @var{pathdir} are supplied in addition to the
30296 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
30298 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
30299 multiple directories in a single command
30300 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
30301 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
30302 If blanks are needed as
30303 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
30304 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
30305 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator
30306 character must not be used
30307 in any directory name.
30308 If no directories are specified, the current search path is displayed.
30310 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30312 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{dir}.
30314 @subsubheading Example
30318 -environment-directory /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
30319 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
30321 -environment-directory ""
30322 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
30324 -environment-directory -r /home/jjohnstn/src/gdb /usr/src
30325 ^done,source-path="/home/jjohnstn/src/gdb:/usr/src:$cdir:$cwd"
30327 -environment-directory -r
30328 ^done,source-path="$cdir:$cwd"
30333 @subheading The @code{-environment-path} Command
30334 @findex -environment-path
30336 @subsubheading Synopsis
30339 -environment-path [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
30342 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for object files.
30343 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the original
30344 search path that existed at gdb start-up. If directories @var{pathdir} are
30345 supplied in addition to the
30346 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
30348 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
30349 multiple directories in a single command
30350 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
30351 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
30352 If blanks are needed as
30353 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
30354 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
30355 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator
30356 character must not be used
30357 in any directory name.
30358 If no directories are specified, the current path is displayed.
30361 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30363 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{path}.
30365 @subsubheading Example
30370 ^done,path="/usr/bin"
30372 -environment-path /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb /bin
30373 ^done,path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb:/bin:/usr/bin"
30375 -environment-path -r /usr/local/bin
30376 ^done,path="/usr/local/bin:/usr/bin"
30381 @subheading The @code{-environment-pwd} Command
30382 @findex -environment-pwd
30384 @subsubheading Synopsis
30390 Show the current working directory.
30392 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30394 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{pwd}.
30396 @subsubheading Example
30401 ^done,cwd="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb"
30405 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30406 @node GDB/MI Thread Commands
30407 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Thread Commands
30410 @subheading The @code{-thread-info} Command
30411 @findex -thread-info
30413 @subsubheading Synopsis
30416 -thread-info [ @var{thread-id} ]
30419 Reports information about either a specific thread, if
30420 the @var{thread-id} parameter is present, or about all
30421 threads. When printing information about all threads,
30422 also reports the current thread.
30424 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30426 The @samp{info thread} command prints the same information
30429 @subsubheading Result
30431 The result is a list of threads. The following attributes are
30432 defined for a given thread:
30436 This field exists only for the current thread. It has the value @samp{*}.
30439 The identifier that @value{GDBN} uses to refer to the thread.
30442 The identifier that the target uses to refer to the thread.
30445 Extra information about the thread, in a target-specific format. This
30449 The name of the thread. If the user specified a name using the
30450 @code{thread name} command, then this name is given. Otherwise, if
30451 @value{GDBN} can extract the thread name from the target, then that
30452 name is given. If @value{GDBN} cannot find the thread name, then this
30456 The stack frame currently executing in the thread.
30459 The thread's state. The @samp{state} field may have the following
30464 The thread is stopped. Frame information is available for stopped
30468 The thread is running. There's no frame information for running
30474 If @value{GDBN} can find the CPU core on which this thread is running,
30475 then this field is the core identifier. This field is optional.
30479 @subsubheading Example
30484 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90 (LWP 21257)",
30485 frame=@{level="0",addr="0xffffe410",func="__kernel_vsyscall",
30486 args=[]@},state="running"@},
30487 @{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e156b0 (LWP 21254)",
30488 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0804891f",func="foo",
30489 args=[@{name="i",value="10"@}],
30490 file="/tmp/a.c",fullname="/tmp/a.c",line="158"@},
30491 state="running"@}],
30492 current-thread-id="1"
30496 @subheading The @code{-thread-list-ids} Command
30497 @findex -thread-list-ids
30499 @subsubheading Synopsis
30505 Produces a list of the currently known @value{GDBN} thread ids. At the
30506 end of the list it also prints the total number of such threads.
30508 This command is retained for historical reasons, the
30509 @code{-thread-info} command should be used instead.
30511 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30513 Part of @samp{info threads} supplies the same information.
30515 @subsubheading Example
30520 ^done,thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
30521 current-thread-id="1",number-of-threads="3"
30526 @subheading The @code{-thread-select} Command
30527 @findex -thread-select
30529 @subsubheading Synopsis
30532 -thread-select @var{threadnum}
30535 Make @var{threadnum} the current thread. It prints the number of the new
30536 current thread, and the topmost frame for that thread.
30538 This command is deprecated in favor of explicitly using the
30539 @samp{--thread} option to each command.
30541 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30543 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{thread}.
30545 @subsubheading Example
30552 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",thread-id="2",line="187",
30553 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.threads/linux-dp.c"
30557 thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
30558 number-of-threads="3"
30561 ^done,new-thread-id="3",
30562 frame=@{level="0",func="vprintf",
30563 args=[@{name="format",value="0x8048e9c \"%*s%c %d %c\\n\""@},
30564 @{name="arg",value="0x2"@}],file="vprintf.c",line="31"@}
30568 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30569 @node GDB/MI Ada Tasking Commands
30570 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Ada Tasking Commands
30572 @subheading The @code{-ada-task-info} Command
30573 @findex -ada-task-info
30575 @subsubheading Synopsis
30578 -ada-task-info [ @var{task-id} ]
30581 Reports information about either a specific Ada task, if the
30582 @var{task-id} parameter is present, or about all Ada tasks.
30584 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30586 The @samp{info tasks} command prints the same information
30587 about all Ada tasks (@pxref{Ada Tasks}).
30589 @subsubheading Result
30591 The result is a table of Ada tasks. The following columns are
30592 defined for each Ada task:
30596 This field exists only for the current thread. It has the value @samp{*}.
30599 The identifier that @value{GDBN} uses to refer to the Ada task.
30602 The identifier that the target uses to refer to the Ada task.
30605 The identifier of the thread corresponding to the Ada task.
30607 This field should always exist, as Ada tasks are always implemented
30608 on top of a thread. But if @value{GDBN} cannot find this corresponding
30609 thread for any reason, the field is omitted.
30612 This field exists only when the task was created by another task.
30613 In this case, it provides the ID of the parent task.
30616 The base priority of the task.
30619 The current state of the task. For a detailed description of the
30620 possible states, see @ref{Ada Tasks}.
30623 The name of the task.
30627 @subsubheading Example
30631 ^done,tasks=@{nr_rows="3",nr_cols="8",
30632 hdr=[@{width="1",alignment="-1",col_name="current",colhdr=""@},
30633 @{width="3",alignment="1",col_name="id",colhdr="ID"@},
30634 @{width="9",alignment="1",col_name="task-id",colhdr="TID"@},
30635 @{width="4",alignment="1",col_name="thread-id",colhdr=""@},
30636 @{width="4",alignment="1",col_name="parent-id",colhdr="P-ID"@},
30637 @{width="3",alignment="1",col_name="priority",colhdr="Pri"@},
30638 @{width="22",alignment="-1",col_name="state",colhdr="State"@},
30639 @{width="1",alignment="2",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@}],
30640 body=[@{current="*",id="1",task-id=" 644010",thread-id="1",priority="48",
30641 state="Child Termination Wait",name="main_task"@}]@}
30645 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30646 @node GDB/MI Program Execution
30647 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Execution
30649 These are the asynchronous commands which generate the out-of-band
30650 record @samp{*stopped}. Currently @value{GDBN} only really executes
30651 asynchronously with remote targets and this interaction is mimicked in
30654 @subheading The @code{-exec-continue} Command
30655 @findex -exec-continue
30657 @subsubheading Synopsis
30660 -exec-continue [--reverse] [--all|--thread-group N]
30663 Resumes the execution of the inferior program, which will continue
30664 to execute until it reaches a debugger stop event. If the
30665 @samp{--reverse} option is specified, execution resumes in reverse until
30666 it reaches a stop event. Stop events may include
30669 breakpoints or watchpoints
30671 signals or exceptions
30673 the end of the process (or its beginning under @samp{--reverse})
30675 the end or beginning of a replay log if one is being used.
30677 In all-stop mode (@pxref{All-Stop
30678 Mode}), may resume only one thread, or all threads, depending on the
30679 value of the @samp{scheduler-locking} variable. If @samp{--all} is
30680 specified, all threads (in all inferiors) will be resumed. The @samp{--all} option is
30681 ignored in all-stop mode. If the @samp{--thread-group} options is
30682 specified, then all threads in that thread group are resumed.
30684 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30686 The corresponding @value{GDBN} corresponding is @samp{continue}.
30688 @subsubheading Example
30695 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="2",frame=@{
30696 func="foo",args=[],file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",
30702 @subheading The @code{-exec-finish} Command
30703 @findex -exec-finish
30705 @subsubheading Synopsis
30708 -exec-finish [--reverse]
30711 Resumes the execution of the inferior program until the current
30712 function is exited. Displays the results returned by the function.
30713 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes the reverse
30714 execution of the inferior program until the point where current
30715 function was called.
30717 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30719 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{finish}.
30721 @subsubheading Example
30723 Function returning @code{void}.
30730 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
30731 file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",line="7"@}
30735 Function returning other than @code{void}. The name of the internal
30736 @value{GDBN} variable storing the result is printed, together with the
30743 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{addr="0x000107b0",func="foo",
30744 args=[@{name="a",value="1"],@{name="b",value="9"@}@},
30745 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
30746 gdb-result-var="$1",return-value="0"
30751 @subheading The @code{-exec-interrupt} Command
30752 @findex -exec-interrupt
30754 @subsubheading Synopsis
30757 -exec-interrupt [--all|--thread-group N]
30760 Interrupts the background execution of the target. Note how the token
30761 associated with the stop message is the one for the execution command
30762 that has been interrupted. The token for the interrupt itself only
30763 appears in the @samp{^done} output. If the user is trying to
30764 interrupt a non-running program, an error message will be printed.
30766 Note that when asynchronous execution is enabled, this command is
30767 asynchronous just like other execution commands. That is, first the
30768 @samp{^done} response will be printed, and the target stop will be
30769 reported after that using the @samp{*stopped} notification.
30771 In non-stop mode, only the context thread is interrupted by default.
30772 All threads (in all inferiors) will be interrupted if the
30773 @samp{--all} option is specified. If the @samp{--thread-group}
30774 option is specified, all threads in that group will be interrupted.
30776 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30778 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interrupt}.
30780 @subsubheading Example
30791 111*stopped,signal-name="SIGINT",signal-meaning="Interrupt",
30792 frame=@{addr="0x00010140",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
30793 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="13"@}
30798 ^error,msg="mi_cmd_exec_interrupt: Inferior not executing."
30802 @subheading The @code{-exec-jump} Command
30805 @subsubheading Synopsis
30808 -exec-jump @var{location}
30811 Resumes execution of the inferior program at the location specified by
30812 parameter. @xref{Specify Location}, for a description of the
30813 different forms of @var{location}.
30815 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30817 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{jump}.
30819 @subsubheading Example
30822 -exec-jump foo.c:10
30823 *running,thread-id="all"
30828 @subheading The @code{-exec-next} Command
30831 @subsubheading Synopsis
30834 -exec-next [--reverse]
30837 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
30838 of the next source line is reached.
30840 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution
30841 of the inferior program, stopping at the beginning of the previous
30842 source line. If you issue this command on the first line of a
30843 function, it will take you back to the caller of that function, to the
30844 source line where the function was called.
30847 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30849 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{next}.
30851 @subsubheading Example
30857 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="8",file="hello.c"
30862 @subheading The @code{-exec-next-instruction} Command
30863 @findex -exec-next-instruction
30865 @subsubheading Synopsis
30868 -exec-next-instruction [--reverse]
30871 Executes one machine instruction. If the instruction is a function
30872 call, continues until the function returns. If the program stops at an
30873 instruction in the middle of a source line, the address will be
30876 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution
30877 of the inferior program, stopping at the previous instruction. If the
30878 previously executed instruction was a return from another function,
30879 it will continue to execute in reverse until the call to that function
30880 (from the current stack frame) is reached.
30882 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30884 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{nexti}.
30886 @subsubheading Example
30890 -exec-next-instruction
30894 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
30895 addr="0x000100d4",line="5",file="hello.c"
30900 @subheading The @code{-exec-return} Command
30901 @findex -exec-return
30903 @subsubheading Synopsis
30909 Makes current function return immediately. Doesn't execute the inferior.
30910 Displays the new current frame.
30912 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30914 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{return}.
30916 @subsubheading Example
30920 200-break-insert callee4
30921 200^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x00010734",
30922 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
30927 000*stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",
30928 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
30929 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30930 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
30936 111^done,frame=@{level="0",func="callee3",
30937 args=[@{name="strarg",
30938 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
30939 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30940 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
30945 @subheading The @code{-exec-run} Command
30948 @subsubheading Synopsis
30951 -exec-run [--all | --thread-group N]
30954 Starts execution of the inferior from the beginning. The inferior
30955 executes until either a breakpoint is encountered or the program
30956 exits. In the latter case the output will include an exit code, if
30957 the program has exited exceptionally.
30959 When no option is specified, the current inferior is started. If the
30960 @samp{--thread-group} option is specified, it should refer to a thread
30961 group of type @samp{process}, and that thread group will be started.
30962 If the @samp{--all} option is specified, then all inferiors will be started.
30964 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30966 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{run}.
30968 @subsubheading Examples
30973 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",line="4"@}
30978 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",
30979 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
30980 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4"@}
30985 Program exited normally:
30993 *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
30998 Program exited exceptionally:
31006 *stopped,reason="exited",exit-code="01"
31010 Another way the program can terminate is if it receives a signal such as
31011 @code{SIGINT}. In this case, @sc{gdb/mi} displays this:
31015 *stopped,reason="exited-signalled",signal-name="SIGINT",
31016 signal-meaning="Interrupt"
31020 @c @subheading -exec-signal
31023 @subheading The @code{-exec-step} Command
31026 @subsubheading Synopsis
31029 -exec-step [--reverse]
31032 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
31033 of the next source line is reached, if the next source line is not a
31034 function call. If it is, stop at the first instruction of the called
31035 function. If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse
31036 execution of the inferior program, stopping at the beginning of the
31037 previously executed source line.
31039 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31041 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{step}.
31043 @subsubheading Example
31045 Stepping into a function:
31051 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
31052 frame=@{func="foo",args=[@{name="a",value="10"@},
31053 @{name="b",value="0"@}],file="recursive2.c",
31054 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11"@}
31064 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="14",file="recursive2.c"
31069 @subheading The @code{-exec-step-instruction} Command
31070 @findex -exec-step-instruction
31072 @subsubheading Synopsis
31075 -exec-step-instruction [--reverse]
31078 Resumes the inferior which executes one machine instruction. If the
31079 @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution of the
31080 inferior program, stopping at the previously executed instruction.
31081 The output, once @value{GDBN} has stopped, will vary depending on
31082 whether we have stopped in the middle of a source line or not. In the
31083 former case, the address at which the program stopped will be printed
31086 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31088 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{stepi}.
31090 @subsubheading Example
31094 -exec-step-instruction
31098 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
31099 frame=@{func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
31100 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10"@}
31102 -exec-step-instruction
31106 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
31107 frame=@{addr="0x000100f4",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
31108 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10"@}
31113 @subheading The @code{-exec-until} Command
31114 @findex -exec-until
31116 @subsubheading Synopsis
31119 -exec-until [ @var{location} ]
31122 Executes the inferior until the @var{location} specified in the
31123 argument is reached. If there is no argument, the inferior executes
31124 until a source line greater than the current one is reached. The
31125 reason for stopping in this case will be @samp{location-reached}.
31127 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31129 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{until}.
31131 @subsubheading Example
31135 -exec-until recursive2.c:6
31139 *stopped,reason="location-reached",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
31140 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="6"@}
31145 @subheading -file-clear
31146 Is this going away????
31149 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31150 @node GDB/MI Stack Manipulation
31151 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Stack Manipulation Commands
31153 @subheading The @code{-enable-frame-filters} Command
31154 @findex -enable-frame-filters
31157 -enable-frame-filters
31160 @value{GDBN} allows Python-based frame filters to affect the output of
31161 the MI commands relating to stack traces. As there is no way to
31162 implement this in a fully backward-compatible way, a front end must
31163 request that this functionality be enabled.
31165 Once enabled, this feature cannot be disabled.
31167 Note that if Python support has not been compiled into @value{GDBN},
31168 this command will still succeed (and do nothing).
31170 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-frame} Command
31171 @findex -stack-info-frame
31173 @subsubheading Synopsis
31179 Get info on the selected frame.
31181 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31183 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info frame} or @samp{frame}
31184 (without arguments).
31186 @subsubheading Example
31191 ^done,frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
31192 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
31193 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17"@}
31197 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-depth} Command
31198 @findex -stack-info-depth
31200 @subsubheading Synopsis
31203 -stack-info-depth [ @var{max-depth} ]
31206 Return the depth of the stack. If the integer argument @var{max-depth}
31207 is specified, do not count beyond @var{max-depth} frames.
31209 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31211 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
31213 @subsubheading Example
31215 For a stack with frame levels 0 through 11:
31222 -stack-info-depth 4
31225 -stack-info-depth 12
31228 -stack-info-depth 11
31231 -stack-info-depth 13
31236 @anchor{-stack-list-arguments}
31237 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-arguments} Command
31238 @findex -stack-list-arguments
31240 @subsubheading Synopsis
31243 -stack-list-arguments [ --no-frame-filters ] @var{print-values}
31244 [ @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
31247 Display a list of the arguments for the frames between @var{low-frame}
31248 and @var{high-frame} (inclusive). If @var{low-frame} and
31249 @var{high-frame} are not provided, list the arguments for the whole
31250 call stack. If the two arguments are equal, show the single frame
31251 at the corresponding level. It is an error if @var{low-frame} is
31252 larger than the actual number of frames. On the other hand,
31253 @var{high-frame} may be larger than the actual number of frames, in
31254 which case only existing frames will be returned.
31256 If @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
31257 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
31258 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
31259 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
31260 structures and unions. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is
31261 supplied, then Python frame filters will not be executed.
31264 Use of this command to obtain arguments in a single frame is
31265 deprecated in favor of the @samp{-stack-list-variables} command.
31267 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31269 @value{GDBN} does not have an equivalent command. @code{gdbtk} has a
31270 @samp{gdb_get_args} command which partially overlaps with the
31271 functionality of @samp{-stack-list-arguments}.
31273 @subsubheading Example
31280 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
31281 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
31282 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@},
31283 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
31284 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
31285 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17"@},
31286 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x0001078c",func="callee2",
31287 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
31288 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="22"@},
31289 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107b4",func="callee1",
31290 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
31291 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="27"@},
31292 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107e0",func="main",
31293 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
31294 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="32"@}]
31296 -stack-list-arguments 0
31299 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
31300 frame=@{level="1",args=[name="strarg"]@},
31301 frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@},
31302 frame=@{level="3",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg",name="fltarg"]@},
31303 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
31305 -stack-list-arguments 1
31308 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
31310 args=[@{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
31311 frame=@{level="2",args=[
31312 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
31313 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
31314 @{frame=@{level="3",args=[
31315 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
31316 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@},
31317 @{name="fltarg",value="3.5"@}]@},
31318 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
31320 -stack-list-arguments 0 2 2
31321 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@}]
31323 -stack-list-arguments 1 2 2
31324 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",
31325 args=[@{name="intarg",value="2"@},
31326 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@}]
31330 @c @subheading -stack-list-exception-handlers
31333 @anchor{-stack-list-frames}
31334 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-frames} Command
31335 @findex -stack-list-frames
31337 @subsubheading Synopsis
31340 -stack-list-frames [ --no-frame-filters @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
31343 List the frames currently on the stack. For each frame it displays the
31348 The frame number, 0 being the topmost frame, i.e., the innermost function.
31350 The @code{$pc} value for that frame.
31354 File name of the source file where the function lives.
31355 @item @var{fullname}
31356 The full file name of the source file where the function lives.
31358 Line number corresponding to the @code{$pc}.
31360 The shared library where this function is defined. This is only given
31361 if the frame's function is not known.
31364 If invoked without arguments, this command prints a backtrace for the
31365 whole stack. If given two integer arguments, it shows the frames whose
31366 levels are between the two arguments (inclusive). If the two arguments
31367 are equal, it shows the single frame at the corresponding level. It is
31368 an error if @var{low-frame} is larger than the actual number of
31369 frames. On the other hand, @var{high-frame} may be larger than the
31370 actual number of frames, in which case only existing frames will be
31371 returned. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is supplied, then
31372 Python frame filters will not be executed.
31374 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31376 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{backtrace} and @samp{where}.
31378 @subsubheading Example
31380 Full stack backtrace:
31386 [frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0001076c",func="foo",
31387 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11"@},
31388 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
31389 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
31390 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
31391 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
31392 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
31393 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
31394 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
31395 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
31396 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
31397 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
31398 frame=@{level="6",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
31399 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
31400 frame=@{level="7",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
31401 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
31402 frame=@{level="8",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
31403 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
31404 frame=@{level="9",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
31405 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
31406 frame=@{level="10",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
31407 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
31408 frame=@{level="11",addr="0x00010738",func="main",
31409 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4"@}]
31413 Show frames between @var{low_frame} and @var{high_frame}:
31417 -stack-list-frames 3 5
31419 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
31420 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
31421 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
31422 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
31423 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
31424 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
31428 Show a single frame:
31432 -stack-list-frames 3 3
31434 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
31435 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
31440 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-locals} Command
31441 @findex -stack-list-locals
31442 @anchor{-stack-list-locals}
31444 @subsubheading Synopsis
31447 -stack-list-locals [ --no-frame-filters ] @var{print-values}
31450 Display the local variable names for the selected frame. If
31451 @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
31452 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
31453 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
31454 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
31455 structures and unions. In this last case, a frontend can immediately
31456 display the value of simple data types and create variable objects for
31457 other data types when the user wishes to explore their values in
31458 more detail. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is supplied, then
31459 Python frame filters will not be executed.
31461 This command is deprecated in favor of the
31462 @samp{-stack-list-variables} command.
31464 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31466 @samp{info locals} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_get_locals} in @code{gdbtk}.
31468 @subsubheading Example
31472 -stack-list-locals 0
31473 ^done,locals=[name="A",name="B",name="C"]
31475 -stack-list-locals --all-values
31476 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",value="1"@},@{name="B",value="2"@},
31477 @{name="C",value="@{1, 2, 3@}"@}]
31478 -stack-list-locals --simple-values
31479 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",type="int",value="1"@},
31480 @{name="B",type="int",value="2"@},@{name="C",type="int [3]"@}]
31484 @anchor{-stack-list-variables}
31485 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-variables} Command
31486 @findex -stack-list-variables
31488 @subsubheading Synopsis
31491 -stack-list-variables [ --no-frame-filters ] @var{print-values}
31494 Display the names of local variables and function arguments for the selected frame. If
31495 @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
31496 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
31497 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
31498 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
31499 structures and unions. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is
31500 supplied, then Python frame filters will not be executed.
31502 @subsubheading Example
31506 -stack-list-variables --thread 1 --frame 0 --all-values
31507 ^done,variables=[@{name="x",value="11"@},@{name="s",value="@{a = 1, b = 2@}"@}]
31512 @subheading The @code{-stack-select-frame} Command
31513 @findex -stack-select-frame
31515 @subsubheading Synopsis
31518 -stack-select-frame @var{framenum}
31521 Change the selected frame. Select a different frame @var{framenum} on
31524 This command in deprecated in favor of passing the @samp{--frame}
31525 option to every command.
31527 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31529 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{frame}, @samp{up},
31530 @samp{down}, @samp{select-frame}, @samp{up-silent}, and @samp{down-silent}.
31532 @subsubheading Example
31536 -stack-select-frame 2
31541 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31542 @node GDB/MI Variable Objects
31543 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Variable Objects
31547 @subheading Motivation for Variable Objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
31549 For the implementation of a variable debugger window (locals, watched
31550 expressions, etc.), we are proposing the adaptation of the existing code
31551 used by @code{Insight}.
31553 The two main reasons for that are:
31557 It has been proven in practice (it is already on its second generation).
31560 It will shorten development time (needless to say how important it is
31564 The original interface was designed to be used by Tcl code, so it was
31565 slightly changed so it could be used through @sc{gdb/mi}. This section
31566 describes the @sc{gdb/mi} operations that will be available and gives some
31567 hints about their use.
31569 @emph{Note}: In addition to the set of operations described here, we
31570 expect the @sc{gui} implementation of a variable window to require, at
31571 least, the following operations:
31574 @item @code{-gdb-show} @code{output-radix}
31575 @item @code{-stack-list-arguments}
31576 @item @code{-stack-list-locals}
31577 @item @code{-stack-select-frame}
31582 @subheading Introduction to Variable Objects
31584 @cindex variable objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
31586 Variable objects are "object-oriented" MI interface for examining and
31587 changing values of expressions. Unlike some other MI interfaces that
31588 work with expressions, variable objects are specifically designed for
31589 simple and efficient presentation in the frontend. A variable object
31590 is identified by string name. When a variable object is created, the
31591 frontend specifies the expression for that variable object. The
31592 expression can be a simple variable, or it can be an arbitrary complex
31593 expression, and can even involve CPU registers. After creating a
31594 variable object, the frontend can invoke other variable object
31595 operations---for example to obtain or change the value of a variable
31596 object, or to change display format.
31598 Variable objects have hierarchical tree structure. Any variable object
31599 that corresponds to a composite type, such as structure in C, has
31600 a number of child variable objects, for example corresponding to each
31601 element of a structure. A child variable object can itself have
31602 children, recursively. Recursion ends when we reach
31603 leaf variable objects, which always have built-in types. Child variable
31604 objects are created only by explicit request, so if a frontend
31605 is not interested in the children of a particular variable object, no
31606 child will be created.
31608 For a leaf variable object it is possible to obtain its value as a
31609 string, or set the value from a string. String value can be also
31610 obtained for a non-leaf variable object, but it's generally a string
31611 that only indicates the type of the object, and does not list its
31612 contents. Assignment to a non-leaf variable object is not allowed.
31614 A frontend does not need to read the values of all variable objects each time
31615 the program stops. Instead, MI provides an update command that lists all
31616 variable objects whose values has changed since the last update
31617 operation. This considerably reduces the amount of data that must
31618 be transferred to the frontend. As noted above, children variable
31619 objects are created on demand, and only leaf variable objects have a
31620 real value. As result, gdb will read target memory only for leaf
31621 variables that frontend has created.
31623 The automatic update is not always desirable. For example, a frontend
31624 might want to keep a value of some expression for future reference,
31625 and never update it. For another example, fetching memory is
31626 relatively slow for embedded targets, so a frontend might want
31627 to disable automatic update for the variables that are either not
31628 visible on the screen, or ``closed''. This is possible using so
31629 called ``frozen variable objects''. Such variable objects are never
31630 implicitly updated.
31632 Variable objects can be either @dfn{fixed} or @dfn{floating}. For the
31633 fixed variable object, the expression is parsed when the variable
31634 object is created, including associating identifiers to specific
31635 variables. The meaning of expression never changes. For a floating
31636 variable object the values of variables whose names appear in the
31637 expressions are re-evaluated every time in the context of the current
31638 frame. Consider this example:
31643 struct work_state state;
31650 If a fixed variable object for the @code{state} variable is created in
31651 this function, and we enter the recursive call, the variable
31652 object will report the value of @code{state} in the top-level
31653 @code{do_work} invocation. On the other hand, a floating variable
31654 object will report the value of @code{state} in the current frame.
31656 If an expression specified when creating a fixed variable object
31657 refers to a local variable, the variable object becomes bound to the
31658 thread and frame in which the variable object is created. When such
31659 variable object is updated, @value{GDBN} makes sure that the
31660 thread/frame combination the variable object is bound to still exists,
31661 and re-evaluates the variable object in context of that thread/frame.
31663 The following is the complete set of @sc{gdb/mi} operations defined to
31664 access this functionality:
31666 @multitable @columnfractions .4 .6
31667 @item @strong{Operation}
31668 @tab @strong{Description}
31670 @item @code{-enable-pretty-printing}
31671 @tab enable Python-based pretty-printing
31672 @item @code{-var-create}
31673 @tab create a variable object
31674 @item @code{-var-delete}
31675 @tab delete the variable object and/or its children
31676 @item @code{-var-set-format}
31677 @tab set the display format of this variable
31678 @item @code{-var-show-format}
31679 @tab show the display format of this variable
31680 @item @code{-var-info-num-children}
31681 @tab tells how many children this object has
31682 @item @code{-var-list-children}
31683 @tab return a list of the object's children
31684 @item @code{-var-info-type}
31685 @tab show the type of this variable object
31686 @item @code{-var-info-expression}
31687 @tab print parent-relative expression that this variable object represents
31688 @item @code{-var-info-path-expression}
31689 @tab print full expression that this variable object represents
31690 @item @code{-var-show-attributes}
31691 @tab is this variable editable? does it exist here?
31692 @item @code{-var-evaluate-expression}
31693 @tab get the value of this variable
31694 @item @code{-var-assign}
31695 @tab set the value of this variable
31696 @item @code{-var-update}
31697 @tab update the variable and its children
31698 @item @code{-var-set-frozen}
31699 @tab set frozeness attribute
31700 @item @code{-var-set-update-range}
31701 @tab set range of children to display on update
31704 In the next subsection we describe each operation in detail and suggest
31705 how it can be used.
31707 @subheading Description And Use of Operations on Variable Objects
31709 @subheading The @code{-enable-pretty-printing} Command
31710 @findex -enable-pretty-printing
31713 -enable-pretty-printing
31716 @value{GDBN} allows Python-based visualizers to affect the output of the
31717 MI variable object commands. However, because there was no way to
31718 implement this in a fully backward-compatible way, a front end must
31719 request that this functionality be enabled.
31721 Once enabled, this feature cannot be disabled.
31723 Note that if Python support has not been compiled into @value{GDBN},
31724 this command will still succeed (and do nothing).
31726 This feature is currently (as of @value{GDBN} 7.0) experimental, and
31727 may work differently in future versions of @value{GDBN}.
31729 @subheading The @code{-var-create} Command
31730 @findex -var-create
31732 @subsubheading Synopsis
31735 -var-create @{@var{name} | "-"@}
31736 @{@var{frame-addr} | "*" | "@@"@} @var{expression}
31739 This operation creates a variable object, which allows the monitoring of
31740 a variable, the result of an expression, a memory cell or a CPU
31743 The @var{name} parameter is the string by which the object can be
31744 referenced. It must be unique. If @samp{-} is specified, the varobj
31745 system will generate a string ``varNNNNNN'' automatically. It will be
31746 unique provided that one does not specify @var{name} of that format.
31747 The command fails if a duplicate name is found.
31749 The frame under which the expression should be evaluated can be
31750 specified by @var{frame-addr}. A @samp{*} indicates that the current
31751 frame should be used. A @samp{@@} indicates that a floating variable
31752 object must be created.
31754 @var{expression} is any expression valid on the current language set (must not
31755 begin with a @samp{*}), or one of the following:
31759 @samp{*@var{addr}}, where @var{addr} is the address of a memory cell
31762 @samp{*@var{addr}-@var{addr}} --- a memory address range (TBD)
31765 @samp{$@var{regname}} --- a CPU register name
31768 @cindex dynamic varobj
31769 A varobj's contents may be provided by a Python-based pretty-printer. In this
31770 case the varobj is known as a @dfn{dynamic varobj}. Dynamic varobjs
31771 have slightly different semantics in some cases. If the
31772 @code{-enable-pretty-printing} command is not sent, then @value{GDBN}
31773 will never create a dynamic varobj. This ensures backward
31774 compatibility for existing clients.
31776 @subsubheading Result
31778 This operation returns attributes of the newly-created varobj. These
31783 The name of the varobj.
31786 The number of children of the varobj. This number is not necessarily
31787 reliable for a dynamic varobj. Instead, you must examine the
31788 @samp{has_more} attribute.
31791 The varobj's scalar value. For a varobj whose type is some sort of
31792 aggregate (e.g., a @code{struct}), or for a dynamic varobj, this value
31793 will not be interesting.
31796 The varobj's type. This is a string representation of the type, as
31797 would be printed by the @value{GDBN} CLI. If @samp{print object}
31798 (@pxref{Print Settings, set print object}) is set to @code{on}, the
31799 @emph{actual} (derived) type of the object is shown rather than the
31800 @emph{declared} one.
31803 If a variable object is bound to a specific thread, then this is the
31804 thread's identifier.
31807 For a dynamic varobj, this indicates whether there appear to be any
31808 children available. For a non-dynamic varobj, this will be 0.
31811 This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
31812 varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
31813 then this attribute will not be present.
31816 A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
31817 value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
31818 @code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
31821 Typical output will look like this:
31824 name="@var{name}",numchild="@var{N}",type="@var{type}",thread-id="@var{M}",
31825 has_more="@var{has_more}"
31829 @subheading The @code{-var-delete} Command
31830 @findex -var-delete
31832 @subsubheading Synopsis
31835 -var-delete [ -c ] @var{name}
31838 Deletes a previously created variable object and all of its children.
31839 With the @samp{-c} option, just deletes the children.
31841 Returns an error if the object @var{name} is not found.
31844 @subheading The @code{-var-set-format} Command
31845 @findex -var-set-format
31847 @subsubheading Synopsis
31850 -var-set-format @var{name} @var{format-spec}
31853 Sets the output format for the value of the object @var{name} to be
31856 @anchor{-var-set-format}
31857 The syntax for the @var{format-spec} is as follows:
31860 @var{format-spec} @expansion{}
31861 @{binary | decimal | hexadecimal | octal | natural@}
31864 The natural format is the default format choosen automatically
31865 based on the variable type (like decimal for an @code{int}, hex
31866 for pointers, etc.).
31868 For a variable with children, the format is set only on the
31869 variable itself, and the children are not affected.
31871 @subheading The @code{-var-show-format} Command
31872 @findex -var-show-format
31874 @subsubheading Synopsis
31877 -var-show-format @var{name}
31880 Returns the format used to display the value of the object @var{name}.
31883 @var{format} @expansion{}
31888 @subheading The @code{-var-info-num-children} Command
31889 @findex -var-info-num-children
31891 @subsubheading Synopsis
31894 -var-info-num-children @var{name}
31897 Returns the number of children of a variable object @var{name}:
31903 Note that this number is not completely reliable for a dynamic varobj.
31904 It will return the current number of children, but more children may
31908 @subheading The @code{-var-list-children} Command
31909 @findex -var-list-children
31911 @subsubheading Synopsis
31914 -var-list-children [@var{print-values}] @var{name} [@var{from} @var{to}]
31916 @anchor{-var-list-children}
31918 Return a list of the children of the specified variable object and
31919 create variable objects for them, if they do not already exist. With
31920 a single argument or if @var{print-values} has a value of 0 or
31921 @code{--no-values}, print only the names of the variables; if
31922 @var{print-values} is 1 or @code{--all-values}, also print their
31923 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values} print the name and
31924 value for simple data types and just the name for arrays, structures
31927 @var{from} and @var{to}, if specified, indicate the range of children
31928 to report. If @var{from} or @var{to} is less than zero, the range is
31929 reset and all children will be reported. Otherwise, children starting
31930 at @var{from} (zero-based) and up to and excluding @var{to} will be
31933 If a child range is requested, it will only affect the current call to
31934 @code{-var-list-children}, but not future calls to @code{-var-update}.
31935 For this, you must instead use @code{-var-set-update-range}. The
31936 intent of this approach is to enable a front end to implement any
31937 update approach it likes; for example, scrolling a view may cause the
31938 front end to request more children with @code{-var-list-children}, and
31939 then the front end could call @code{-var-set-update-range} with a
31940 different range to ensure that future updates are restricted to just
31943 For each child the following results are returned:
31948 Name of the variable object created for this child.
31951 The expression to be shown to the user by the front end to designate this child.
31952 For example this may be the name of a structure member.
31954 For a dynamic varobj, this value cannot be used to form an
31955 expression. There is no way to do this at all with a dynamic varobj.
31957 For C/C@t{++} structures there are several pseudo children returned to
31958 designate access qualifiers. For these pseudo children @var{exp} is
31959 @samp{public}, @samp{private}, or @samp{protected}. In this case the
31960 type and value are not present.
31962 A dynamic varobj will not report the access qualifying
31963 pseudo-children, regardless of the language. This information is not
31964 available at all with a dynamic varobj.
31967 Number of children this child has. For a dynamic varobj, this will be
31971 The type of the child. If @samp{print object}
31972 (@pxref{Print Settings, set print object}) is set to @code{on}, the
31973 @emph{actual} (derived) type of the object is shown rather than the
31974 @emph{declared} one.
31977 If values were requested, this is the value.
31980 If this variable object is associated with a thread, this is the thread id.
31981 Otherwise this result is not present.
31984 If the variable object is frozen, this variable will be present with a value of 1.
31987 The result may have its own attributes:
31991 A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
31992 value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
31993 @code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
31996 This is an integer attribute which is nonzero if there are children
31997 remaining after the end of the selected range.
32000 @subsubheading Example
32004 -var-list-children n
32005 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[child=@{name=@var{name},exp=@var{exp},
32006 numchild=@var{n},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
32008 -var-list-children --all-values n
32009 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[child=@{name=@var{name},exp=@var{exp},
32010 numchild=@var{n},value=@var{value},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
32014 @subheading The @code{-var-info-type} Command
32015 @findex -var-info-type
32017 @subsubheading Synopsis
32020 -var-info-type @var{name}
32023 Returns the type of the specified variable @var{name}. The type is
32024 returned as a string in the same format as it is output by the
32028 type=@var{typename}
32032 @subheading The @code{-var-info-expression} Command
32033 @findex -var-info-expression
32035 @subsubheading Synopsis
32038 -var-info-expression @var{name}
32041 Returns a string that is suitable for presenting this
32042 variable object in user interface. The string is generally
32043 not valid expression in the current language, and cannot be evaluated.
32045 For example, if @code{a} is an array, and variable object
32046 @code{A} was created for @code{a}, then we'll get this output:
32049 (gdb) -var-info-expression A.1
32050 ^done,lang="C",exp="1"
32054 Here, the values of @code{lang} can be @code{@{"C" | "C++" | "Java"@}}.
32056 Note that the output of the @code{-var-list-children} command also
32057 includes those expressions, so the @code{-var-info-expression} command
32060 @subheading The @code{-var-info-path-expression} Command
32061 @findex -var-info-path-expression
32063 @subsubheading Synopsis
32066 -var-info-path-expression @var{name}
32069 Returns an expression that can be evaluated in the current
32070 context and will yield the same value that a variable object has.
32071 Compare this with the @code{-var-info-expression} command, which
32072 result can be used only for UI presentation. Typical use of
32073 the @code{-var-info-path-expression} command is creating a
32074 watchpoint from a variable object.
32076 This command is currently not valid for children of a dynamic varobj,
32077 and will give an error when invoked on one.
32079 For example, suppose @code{C} is a C@t{++} class, derived from class
32080 @code{Base}, and that the @code{Base} class has a member called
32081 @code{m_size}. Assume a variable @code{c} is has the type of
32082 @code{C} and a variable object @code{C} was created for variable
32083 @code{c}. Then, we'll get this output:
32085 (gdb) -var-info-path-expression C.Base.public.m_size
32086 ^done,path_expr=((Base)c).m_size)
32089 @subheading The @code{-var-show-attributes} Command
32090 @findex -var-show-attributes
32092 @subsubheading Synopsis
32095 -var-show-attributes @var{name}
32098 List attributes of the specified variable object @var{name}:
32101 status=@var{attr} [ ( ,@var{attr} )* ]
32105 where @var{attr} is @code{@{ @{ editable | noneditable @} | TBD @}}.
32107 @subheading The @code{-var-evaluate-expression} Command
32108 @findex -var-evaluate-expression
32110 @subsubheading Synopsis
32113 -var-evaluate-expression [-f @var{format-spec}] @var{name}
32116 Evaluates the expression that is represented by the specified variable
32117 object and returns its value as a string. The format of the string
32118 can be specified with the @samp{-f} option. The possible values of
32119 this option are the same as for @code{-var-set-format}
32120 (@pxref{-var-set-format}). If the @samp{-f} option is not specified,
32121 the current display format will be used. The current display format
32122 can be changed using the @code{-var-set-format} command.
32128 Note that one must invoke @code{-var-list-children} for a variable
32129 before the value of a child variable can be evaluated.
32131 @subheading The @code{-var-assign} Command
32132 @findex -var-assign
32134 @subsubheading Synopsis
32137 -var-assign @var{name} @var{expression}
32140 Assigns the value of @var{expression} to the variable object specified
32141 by @var{name}. The object must be @samp{editable}. If the variable's
32142 value is altered by the assign, the variable will show up in any
32143 subsequent @code{-var-update} list.
32145 @subsubheading Example
32153 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",in_scope="true",type_changed="false"@}]
32157 @subheading The @code{-var-update} Command
32158 @findex -var-update
32160 @subsubheading Synopsis
32163 -var-update [@var{print-values}] @{@var{name} | "*"@}
32166 Reevaluate the expressions corresponding to the variable object
32167 @var{name} and all its direct and indirect children, and return the
32168 list of variable objects whose values have changed; @var{name} must
32169 be a root variable object. Here, ``changed'' means that the result of
32170 @code{-var-evaluate-expression} before and after the
32171 @code{-var-update} is different. If @samp{*} is used as the variable
32172 object names, all existing variable objects are updated, except
32173 for frozen ones (@pxref{-var-set-frozen}). The option
32174 @var{print-values} determines whether both names and values, or just
32175 names are printed. The possible values of this option are the same
32176 as for @code{-var-list-children} (@pxref{-var-list-children}). It is
32177 recommended to use the @samp{--all-values} option, to reduce the
32178 number of MI commands needed on each program stop.
32180 With the @samp{*} parameter, if a variable object is bound to a
32181 currently running thread, it will not be updated, without any
32184 If @code{-var-set-update-range} was previously used on a varobj, then
32185 only the selected range of children will be reported.
32187 @code{-var-update} reports all the changed varobjs in a tuple named
32190 Each item in the change list is itself a tuple holding:
32194 The name of the varobj.
32197 If values were requested for this update, then this field will be
32198 present and will hold the value of the varobj.
32201 @anchor{-var-update}
32202 This field is a string which may take one of three values:
32206 The variable object's current value is valid.
32209 The variable object does not currently hold a valid value but it may
32210 hold one in the future if its associated expression comes back into
32214 The variable object no longer holds a valid value.
32215 This can occur when the executable file being debugged has changed,
32216 either through recompilation or by using the @value{GDBN} @code{file}
32217 command. The front end should normally choose to delete these variable
32221 In the future new values may be added to this list so the front should
32222 be prepared for this possibility. @xref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, ,@sc{GDB/MI} Development and Front Ends}.
32225 This is only present if the varobj is still valid. If the type
32226 changed, then this will be the string @samp{true}; otherwise it will
32229 When a varobj's type changes, its children are also likely to have
32230 become incorrect. Therefore, the varobj's children are automatically
32231 deleted when this attribute is @samp{true}. Also, the varobj's update
32232 range, when set using the @code{-var-set-update-range} command, is
32236 If the varobj's type changed, then this field will be present and will
32239 @item new_num_children
32240 For a dynamic varobj, if the number of children changed, or if the
32241 type changed, this will be the new number of children.
32243 The @samp{numchild} field in other varobj responses is generally not
32244 valid for a dynamic varobj -- it will show the number of children that
32245 @value{GDBN} knows about, but because dynamic varobjs lazily
32246 instantiate their children, this will not reflect the number of
32247 children which may be available.
32249 The @samp{new_num_children} attribute only reports changes to the
32250 number of children known by @value{GDBN}. This is the only way to
32251 detect whether an update has removed children (which necessarily can
32252 only happen at the end of the update range).
32255 The display hint, if any.
32258 This is an integer value, which will be 1 if there are more children
32259 available outside the varobj's update range.
32262 This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
32263 varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
32264 then this attribute will not be present.
32267 If new children were added to a dynamic varobj within the selected
32268 update range (as set by @code{-var-set-update-range}), then they will
32269 be listed in this attribute.
32272 @subsubheading Example
32279 -var-update --all-values var1
32280 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",value="3",in_scope="true",
32281 type_changed="false"@}]
32285 @subheading The @code{-var-set-frozen} Command
32286 @findex -var-set-frozen
32287 @anchor{-var-set-frozen}
32289 @subsubheading Synopsis
32292 -var-set-frozen @var{name} @var{flag}
32295 Set the frozenness flag on the variable object @var{name}. The
32296 @var{flag} parameter should be either @samp{1} to make the variable
32297 frozen or @samp{0} to make it unfrozen. If a variable object is
32298 frozen, then neither itself, nor any of its children, are
32299 implicitly updated by @code{-var-update} of
32300 a parent variable or by @code{-var-update *}. Only
32301 @code{-var-update} of the variable itself will update its value and
32302 values of its children. After a variable object is unfrozen, it is
32303 implicitly updated by all subsequent @code{-var-update} operations.
32304 Unfreezing a variable does not update it, only subsequent
32305 @code{-var-update} does.
32307 @subsubheading Example
32311 -var-set-frozen V 1
32316 @subheading The @code{-var-set-update-range} command
32317 @findex -var-set-update-range
32318 @anchor{-var-set-update-range}
32320 @subsubheading Synopsis
32323 -var-set-update-range @var{name} @var{from} @var{to}
32326 Set the range of children to be returned by future invocations of
32327 @code{-var-update}.
32329 @var{from} and @var{to} indicate the range of children to report. If
32330 @var{from} or @var{to} is less than zero, the range is reset and all
32331 children will be reported. Otherwise, children starting at @var{from}
32332 (zero-based) and up to and excluding @var{to} will be reported.
32334 @subsubheading Example
32338 -var-set-update-range V 1 2
32342 @subheading The @code{-var-set-visualizer} command
32343 @findex -var-set-visualizer
32344 @anchor{-var-set-visualizer}
32346 @subsubheading Synopsis
32349 -var-set-visualizer @var{name} @var{visualizer}
32352 Set a visualizer for the variable object @var{name}.
32354 @var{visualizer} is the visualizer to use. The special value
32355 @samp{None} means to disable any visualizer in use.
32357 If not @samp{None}, @var{visualizer} must be a Python expression.
32358 This expression must evaluate to a callable object which accepts a
32359 single argument. @value{GDBN} will call this object with the value of
32360 the varobj @var{name} as an argument (this is done so that the same
32361 Python pretty-printing code can be used for both the CLI and MI).
32362 When called, this object must return an object which conforms to the
32363 pretty-printing interface (@pxref{Pretty Printing API}).
32365 The pre-defined function @code{gdb.default_visualizer} may be used to
32366 select a visualizer by following the built-in process
32367 (@pxref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}). This is done automatically when
32368 a varobj is created, and so ordinarily is not needed.
32370 This feature is only available if Python support is enabled. The MI
32371 command @code{-list-features} (@pxref{GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands})
32372 can be used to check this.
32374 @subsubheading Example
32376 Resetting the visualizer:
32380 -var-set-visualizer V None
32384 Reselecting the default (type-based) visualizer:
32388 -var-set-visualizer V gdb.default_visualizer
32392 Suppose @code{SomeClass} is a visualizer class. A lambda expression
32393 can be used to instantiate this class for a varobj:
32397 -var-set-visualizer V "lambda val: SomeClass()"
32401 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
32402 @node GDB/MI Data Manipulation
32403 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Data Manipulation
32405 @cindex data manipulation, in @sc{gdb/mi}
32406 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, data manipulation
32407 This section describes the @sc{gdb/mi} commands that manipulate data:
32408 examine memory and registers, evaluate expressions, etc.
32410 @c REMOVED FROM THE INTERFACE.
32411 @c @subheading -data-assign
32412 @c Change the value of a program variable. Plenty of side effects.
32413 @c @subsubheading GDB Command
32415 @c @subsubheading Example
32418 @subheading The @code{-data-disassemble} Command
32419 @findex -data-disassemble
32421 @subsubheading Synopsis
32425 [ -s @var{start-addr} -e @var{end-addr} ]
32426 | [ -f @var{filename} -l @var{linenum} [ -n @var{lines} ] ]
32434 @item @var{start-addr}
32435 is the beginning address (or @code{$pc})
32436 @item @var{end-addr}
32438 @item @var{filename}
32439 is the name of the file to disassemble
32440 @item @var{linenum}
32441 is the line number to disassemble around
32443 is the number of disassembly lines to be produced. If it is -1,
32444 the whole function will be disassembled, in case no @var{end-addr} is
32445 specified. If @var{end-addr} is specified as a non-zero value, and
32446 @var{lines} is lower than the number of disassembly lines between
32447 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only @var{lines} lines are
32448 displayed; if @var{lines} is higher than the number of lines between
32449 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only the lines up to @var{end-addr}
32452 is either 0 (meaning only disassembly), 1 (meaning mixed source and
32453 disassembly), 2 (meaning disassembly with raw opcodes), or 3 (meaning
32454 mixed source and disassembly with raw opcodes).
32457 @subsubheading Result
32459 The result of the @code{-data-disassemble} command will be a list named
32460 @samp{asm_insns}, the contents of this list depend on the @var{mode}
32461 used with the @code{-data-disassemble} command.
32463 For modes 0 and 2 the @samp{asm_insns} list contains tuples with the
32468 The address at which this instruction was disassembled.
32471 The name of the function this instruction is within.
32474 The decimal offset in bytes from the start of @samp{func-name}.
32477 The text disassembly for this @samp{address}.
32480 This field is only present for mode 2. This contains the raw opcode
32481 bytes for the @samp{inst} field.
32485 For modes 1 and 3 the @samp{asm_insns} list contains tuples named
32486 @samp{src_and_asm_line}, each of which has the following fields:
32490 The line number within @samp{file}.
32493 The file name from the compilation unit. This might be an absolute
32494 file name or a relative file name depending on the compile command
32498 Absolute file name of @samp{file}. It is converted to a canonical form
32499 using the source file search path
32500 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories})
32501 and after resolving all the symbolic links.
32503 If the source file is not found this field will contain the path as
32504 present in the debug information.
32506 @item line_asm_insn
32507 This is a list of tuples containing the disassembly for @samp{line} in
32508 @samp{file}. The fields of each tuple are the same as for
32509 @code{-data-disassemble} in @var{mode} 0 and 2, so @samp{address},
32510 @samp{func-name}, @samp{offset}, @samp{inst}, and optionally
32515 Note that whatever included in the @samp{inst} field, is not
32516 manipulated directly by @sc{gdb/mi}, i.e., it is not possible to
32519 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32521 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disassemble}.
32523 @subsubheading Example
32525 Disassemble from the current value of @code{$pc} to @code{$pc + 20}:
32529 -data-disassemble -s $pc -e "$pc + 20" -- 0
32532 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
32533 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
32534 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
32535 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
32536 @{address="0x000107c8",func-name="main",offset="12",
32537 inst="or %o2, 0x140, %o1\t! 0x11940 <_lib_version+8>"@},
32538 @{address="0x000107cc",func-name="main",offset="16",
32539 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
32540 @{address="0x000107d0",func-name="main",offset="20",
32541 inst="or %o2, 0x168, %o4\t! 0x11968 <_lib_version+48>"@}]
32545 Disassemble the whole @code{main} function. Line 32 is part of
32549 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -- 0
32551 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
32552 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
32553 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
32554 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
32555 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
32556 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
32558 @{address="0x0001081c",func-name="main",offset="96",inst="ret "@},
32559 @{address="0x00010820",func-name="main",offset="100",inst="restore "@}]
32563 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main}:
32567 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 0
32569 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
32570 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
32571 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
32572 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
32573 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
32574 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]
32578 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main} in mixed mode:
32582 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 1
32584 src_and_asm_line=@{line="31",
32585 file="../../../src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
32586 fullname="/absolute/path/to/src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
32587 line_asm_insn=[@{address="0x000107bc",
32588 func-name="main",offset="0",inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@}]@},
32589 src_and_asm_line=@{line="32",
32590 file="../../../src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
32591 fullname="/absolute/path/to/src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
32592 line_asm_insn=[@{address="0x000107c0",
32593 func-name="main",offset="4",inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
32594 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
32595 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]@}]
32600 @subheading The @code{-data-evaluate-expression} Command
32601 @findex -data-evaluate-expression
32603 @subsubheading Synopsis
32606 -data-evaluate-expression @var{expr}
32609 Evaluate @var{expr} as an expression. The expression could contain an
32610 inferior function call. The function call will execute synchronously.
32611 If the expression contains spaces, it must be enclosed in double quotes.
32613 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32615 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{print}, @samp{output}, and
32616 @samp{call}. In @code{gdbtk} only, there's a corresponding
32617 @samp{gdb_eval} command.
32619 @subsubheading Example
32621 In the following example, the numbers that precede the commands are the
32622 @dfn{tokens} described in @ref{GDB/MI Command Syntax, ,@sc{gdb/mi}
32623 Command Syntax}. Notice how @sc{gdb/mi} returns the same tokens in its
32627 211-data-evaluate-expression A
32630 311-data-evaluate-expression &A
32631 311^done,value="0xefffeb7c"
32633 411-data-evaluate-expression A+3
32636 511-data-evaluate-expression "A + 3"
32642 @subheading The @code{-data-list-changed-registers} Command
32643 @findex -data-list-changed-registers
32645 @subsubheading Synopsis
32648 -data-list-changed-registers
32651 Display a list of the registers that have changed.
32653 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32655 @value{GDBN} doesn't have a direct analog for this command; @code{gdbtk}
32656 has the corresponding command @samp{gdb_changed_register_list}.
32658 @subsubheading Example
32660 On a PPC MBX board:
32668 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",frame=@{
32669 func="main",args=[],file="try.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",
32672 -data-list-changed-registers
32673 ^done,changed-registers=["0","1","2","4","5","6","7","8","9",
32674 "10","11","13","14","15","16","17","18","19","20","21","22","23",
32675 "24","25","26","27","28","30","31","64","65","66","67","69"]
32680 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-names} Command
32681 @findex -data-list-register-names
32683 @subsubheading Synopsis
32686 -data-list-register-names [ ( @var{regno} )+ ]
32689 Show a list of register names for the current target. If no arguments
32690 are given, it shows a list of the names of all the registers. If
32691 integer numbers are given as arguments, it will print a list of the
32692 names of the registers corresponding to the arguments. To ensure
32693 consistency between a register name and its number, the output list may
32694 include empty register names.
32696 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32698 @value{GDBN} does not have a command which corresponds to
32699 @samp{-data-list-register-names}. In @code{gdbtk} there is a
32700 corresponding command @samp{gdb_regnames}.
32702 @subsubheading Example
32704 For the PPC MBX board:
32707 -data-list-register-names
32708 ^done,register-names=["r0","r1","r2","r3","r4","r5","r6","r7",
32709 "r8","r9","r10","r11","r12","r13","r14","r15","r16","r17","r18",
32710 "r19","r20","r21","r22","r23","r24","r25","r26","r27","r28","r29",
32711 "r30","r31","f0","f1","f2","f3","f4","f5","f6","f7","f8","f9",
32712 "f10","f11","f12","f13","f14","f15","f16","f17","f18","f19","f20",
32713 "f21","f22","f23","f24","f25","f26","f27","f28","f29","f30","f31",
32714 "", "pc","ps","cr","lr","ctr","xer"]
32716 -data-list-register-names 1 2 3
32717 ^done,register-names=["r1","r2","r3"]
32721 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-values} Command
32722 @findex -data-list-register-values
32724 @subsubheading Synopsis
32727 -data-list-register-values @var{fmt} [ ( @var{regno} )*]
32730 Display the registers' contents. @var{fmt} is the format according to
32731 which the registers' contents are to be returned, followed by an optional
32732 list of numbers specifying the registers to display. A missing list of
32733 numbers indicates that the contents of all the registers must be returned.
32735 Allowed formats for @var{fmt} are:
32752 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32754 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{info reg}, @samp{info
32755 all-reg}, and (in @code{gdbtk}) @samp{gdb_fetch_registers}.
32757 @subsubheading Example
32759 For a PPC MBX board (note: line breaks are for readability only, they
32760 don't appear in the actual output):
32764 -data-list-register-values r 64 65
32765 ^done,register-values=[@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
32766 @{number="65",value="0x00029002"@}]
32768 -data-list-register-values x
32769 ^done,register-values=[@{number="0",value="0xfe0043c8"@},
32770 @{number="1",value="0x3fff88"@},@{number="2",value="0xfffffffe"@},
32771 @{number="3",value="0x0"@},@{number="4",value="0xa"@},
32772 @{number="5",value="0x3fff68"@},@{number="6",value="0x3fff58"@},
32773 @{number="7",value="0xfe011e98"@},@{number="8",value="0x2"@},
32774 @{number="9",value="0xfa202820"@},@{number="10",value="0xfa202808"@},
32775 @{number="11",value="0x1"@},@{number="12",value="0x0"@},
32776 @{number="13",value="0x4544"@},@{number="14",value="0xffdfffff"@},
32777 @{number="15",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="16",value="0xfffffeff"@},
32778 @{number="17",value="0xefffffed"@},@{number="18",value="0xfffffffe"@},
32779 @{number="19",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="20",value="0xffffffff"@},
32780 @{number="21",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="22",value="0xfffffff7"@},
32781 @{number="23",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="24",value="0xffffffff"@},
32782 @{number="25",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="26",value="0xfffffffb"@},
32783 @{number="27",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="28",value="0xf7bfffff"@},
32784 @{number="29",value="0x0"@},@{number="30",value="0xfe010000"@},
32785 @{number="31",value="0x0"@},@{number="32",value="0x0"@},
32786 @{number="33",value="0x0"@},@{number="34",value="0x0"@},
32787 @{number="35",value="0x0"@},@{number="36",value="0x0"@},
32788 @{number="37",value="0x0"@},@{number="38",value="0x0"@},
32789 @{number="39",value="0x0"@},@{number="40",value="0x0"@},
32790 @{number="41",value="0x0"@},@{number="42",value="0x0"@},
32791 @{number="43",value="0x0"@},@{number="44",value="0x0"@},
32792 @{number="45",value="0x0"@},@{number="46",value="0x0"@},
32793 @{number="47",value="0x0"@},@{number="48",value="0x0"@},
32794 @{number="49",value="0x0"@},@{number="50",value="0x0"@},
32795 @{number="51",value="0x0"@},@{number="52",value="0x0"@},
32796 @{number="53",value="0x0"@},@{number="54",value="0x0"@},
32797 @{number="55",value="0x0"@},@{number="56",value="0x0"@},
32798 @{number="57",value="0x0"@},@{number="58",value="0x0"@},
32799 @{number="59",value="0x0"@},@{number="60",value="0x0"@},
32800 @{number="61",value="0x0"@},@{number="62",value="0x0"@},
32801 @{number="63",value="0x0"@},@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
32802 @{number="65",value="0x29002"@},@{number="66",value="0x202f04b5"@},
32803 @{number="67",value="0xfe0043b0"@},@{number="68",value="0xfe00b3e4"@},
32804 @{number="69",value="0x20002b03"@}]
32809 @subheading The @code{-data-read-memory} Command
32810 @findex -data-read-memory
32812 This command is deprecated, use @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} instead.
32814 @subsubheading Synopsis
32817 -data-read-memory [ -o @var{byte-offset} ]
32818 @var{address} @var{word-format} @var{word-size}
32819 @var{nr-rows} @var{nr-cols} [ @var{aschar} ]
32826 @item @var{address}
32827 An expression specifying the address of the first memory word to be
32828 read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
32829 quoted using the C convention.
32831 @item @var{word-format}
32832 The format to be used to print the memory words. The notation is the
32833 same as for @value{GDBN}'s @code{print} command (@pxref{Output Formats,
32836 @item @var{word-size}
32837 The size of each memory word in bytes.
32839 @item @var{nr-rows}
32840 The number of rows in the output table.
32842 @item @var{nr-cols}
32843 The number of columns in the output table.
32846 If present, indicates that each row should include an @sc{ascii} dump. The
32847 value of @var{aschar} is used as a padding character when a byte is not a
32848 member of the printable @sc{ascii} character set (printable @sc{ascii}
32849 characters are those whose code is between 32 and 126, inclusively).
32851 @item @var{byte-offset}
32852 An offset to add to the @var{address} before fetching memory.
32855 This command displays memory contents as a table of @var{nr-rows} by
32856 @var{nr-cols} words, each word being @var{word-size} bytes. In total,
32857 @code{@var{nr-rows} * @var{nr-cols} * @var{word-size}} bytes are read
32858 (returned as @samp{total-bytes}). Should less than the requested number
32859 of bytes be returned by the target, the missing words are identified
32860 using @samp{N/A}. The number of bytes read from the target is returned
32861 in @samp{nr-bytes} and the starting address used to read memory in
32864 The address of the next/previous row or page is available in
32865 @samp{next-row} and @samp{prev-row}, @samp{next-page} and
32868 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32870 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{x}. @code{gdbtk} has
32871 @samp{gdb_get_mem} memory read command.
32873 @subsubheading Example
32875 Read six bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+6} but then offset by
32876 @code{-6} bytes. Format as three rows of two columns. One byte per
32877 word. Display each word in hex.
32881 9-data-read-memory -o -6 -- bytes+6 x 1 3 2
32882 9^done,addr="0x00001390",nr-bytes="6",total-bytes="6",
32883 next-row="0x00001396",prev-row="0x0000138e",next-page="0x00001396",
32884 prev-page="0x0000138a",memory=[
32885 @{addr="0x00001390",data=["0x00","0x01"]@},
32886 @{addr="0x00001392",data=["0x02","0x03"]@},
32887 @{addr="0x00001394",data=["0x04","0x05"]@}]
32891 Read two bytes of memory starting at address @code{shorts + 64} and
32892 display as a single word formatted in decimal.
32896 5-data-read-memory shorts+64 d 2 1 1
32897 5^done,addr="0x00001510",nr-bytes="2",total-bytes="2",
32898 next-row="0x00001512",prev-row="0x0000150e",
32899 next-page="0x00001512",prev-page="0x0000150e",memory=[
32900 @{addr="0x00001510",data=["128"]@}]
32904 Read thirty two bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+16} and format
32905 as eight rows of four columns. Include a string encoding with @samp{x}
32906 used as the non-printable character.
32910 4-data-read-memory bytes+16 x 1 8 4 x
32911 4^done,addr="0x000013a0",nr-bytes="32",total-bytes="32",
32912 next-row="0x000013c0",prev-row="0x0000139c",
32913 next-page="0x000013c0",prev-page="0x00001380",memory=[
32914 @{addr="0x000013a0",data=["0x10","0x11","0x12","0x13"],ascii="xxxx"@},
32915 @{addr="0x000013a4",data=["0x14","0x15","0x16","0x17"],ascii="xxxx"@},
32916 @{addr="0x000013a8",data=["0x18","0x19","0x1a","0x1b"],ascii="xxxx"@},
32917 @{addr="0x000013ac",data=["0x1c","0x1d","0x1e","0x1f"],ascii="xxxx"@},
32918 @{addr="0x000013b0",data=["0x20","0x21","0x22","0x23"],ascii=" !\"#"@},
32919 @{addr="0x000013b4",data=["0x24","0x25","0x26","0x27"],ascii="$%&'"@},
32920 @{addr="0x000013b8",data=["0x28","0x29","0x2a","0x2b"],ascii="()*+"@},
32921 @{addr="0x000013bc",data=["0x2c","0x2d","0x2e","0x2f"],ascii=",-./"@}]
32925 @subheading The @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} Command
32926 @findex -data-read-memory-bytes
32928 @subsubheading Synopsis
32931 -data-read-memory-bytes [ -o @var{byte-offset} ]
32932 @var{address} @var{count}
32939 @item @var{address}
32940 An expression specifying the address of the first memory word to be
32941 read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
32942 quoted using the C convention.
32945 The number of bytes to read. This should be an integer literal.
32947 @item @var{byte-offset}
32948 The offsets in bytes relative to @var{address} at which to start
32949 reading. This should be an integer literal. This option is provided
32950 so that a frontend is not required to first evaluate address and then
32951 perform address arithmetics itself.
32955 This command attempts to read all accessible memory regions in the
32956 specified range. First, all regions marked as unreadable in the memory
32957 map (if one is defined) will be skipped. @xref{Memory Region
32958 Attributes}. Second, @value{GDBN} will attempt to read the remaining
32959 regions. For each one, if reading full region results in an errors,
32960 @value{GDBN} will try to read a subset of the region.
32962 In general, every single byte in the region may be readable or not,
32963 and the only way to read every readable byte is to try a read at
32964 every address, which is not practical. Therefore, @value{GDBN} will
32965 attempt to read all accessible bytes at either beginning or the end
32966 of the region, using a binary division scheme. This heuristic works
32967 well for reading accross a memory map boundary. Note that if a region
32968 has a readable range that is neither at the beginning or the end,
32969 @value{GDBN} will not read it.
32971 The result record (@pxref{GDB/MI Result Records}) that is output of
32972 the command includes a field named @samp{memory} whose content is a
32973 list of tuples. Each tuple represent a successfully read memory block
32974 and has the following fields:
32978 The start address of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal.
32981 The end address of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal.
32984 The offset of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal, relative to
32985 the start address passed to @code{-data-read-memory-bytes}.
32988 The contents of the memory block, in hex.
32994 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32996 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{x}.
32998 @subsubheading Example
33002 -data-read-memory-bytes &a 10
33003 ^done,memory=[@{begin="0xbffff154",offset="0x00000000",
33005 contents="01000000020000000300"@}]
33010 @subheading The @code{-data-write-memory-bytes} Command
33011 @findex -data-write-memory-bytes
33013 @subsubheading Synopsis
33016 -data-write-memory-bytes @var{address} @var{contents}
33017 -data-write-memory-bytes @var{address} @var{contents} @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
33024 @item @var{address}
33025 An expression specifying the address of the first memory word to be
33026 read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
33027 quoted using the C convention.
33029 @item @var{contents}
33030 The hex-encoded bytes to write.
33033 Optional argument indicating the number of bytes to be written. If @var{count}
33034 is greater than @var{contents}' length, @value{GDBN} will repeatedly
33035 write @var{contents} until it fills @var{count} bytes.
33039 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33041 There's no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
33043 @subsubheading Example
33047 -data-write-memory-bytes &a "aabbccdd"
33054 -data-write-memory-bytes &a "aabbccdd" 16e
33059 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
33060 @node GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands
33061 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Tracepoint Commands
33063 The commands defined in this section implement MI support for
33064 tracepoints. For detailed introduction, see @ref{Tracepoints}.
33066 @subheading The @code{-trace-find} Command
33067 @findex -trace-find
33069 @subsubheading Synopsis
33072 -trace-find @var{mode} [@var{parameters}@dots{}]
33075 Find a trace frame using criteria defined by @var{mode} and
33076 @var{parameters}. The following table lists permissible
33077 modes and their parameters. For details of operation, see @ref{tfind}.
33082 No parameters are required. Stops examining trace frames.
33085 An integer is required as parameter. Selects tracepoint frame with
33088 @item tracepoint-number
33089 An integer is required as parameter. Finds next
33090 trace frame that corresponds to tracepoint with the specified number.
33093 An address is required as parameter. Finds
33094 next trace frame that corresponds to any tracepoint at the specified
33097 @item pc-inside-range
33098 Two addresses are required as parameters. Finds next trace
33099 frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at an address inside the
33100 specified range. Both bounds are considered to be inside the range.
33102 @item pc-outside-range
33103 Two addresses are required as parameters. Finds
33104 next trace frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at an address outside
33105 the specified range. Both bounds are considered to be inside the range.
33108 Line specification is required as parameter. @xref{Specify Location}.
33109 Finds next trace frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at
33110 the specified location.
33114 If @samp{none} was passed as @var{mode}, the response does not
33115 have fields. Otherwise, the response may have the following fields:
33119 This field has either @samp{0} or @samp{1} as the value, depending
33120 on whether a matching tracepoint was found.
33123 The index of the found traceframe. This field is present iff
33124 the @samp{found} field has value of @samp{1}.
33127 The index of the found tracepoint. This field is present iff
33128 the @samp{found} field has value of @samp{1}.
33131 The information about the frame corresponding to the found trace
33132 frame. This field is present only if a trace frame was found.
33133 @xref{GDB/MI Frame Information}, for description of this field.
33137 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33139 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tfind}.
33141 @subheading -trace-define-variable
33142 @findex -trace-define-variable
33144 @subsubheading Synopsis
33147 -trace-define-variable @var{name} [ @var{value} ]
33150 Create trace variable @var{name} if it does not exist. If
33151 @var{value} is specified, sets the initial value of the specified
33152 trace variable to that value. Note that the @var{name} should start
33153 with the @samp{$} character.
33155 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33157 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tvariable}.
33159 @subheading -trace-list-variables
33160 @findex -trace-list-variables
33162 @subsubheading Synopsis
33165 -trace-list-variables
33168 Return a table of all defined trace variables. Each element of the
33169 table has the following fields:
33173 The name of the trace variable. This field is always present.
33176 The initial value. This is a 64-bit signed integer. This
33177 field is always present.
33180 The value the trace variable has at the moment. This is a 64-bit
33181 signed integer. This field is absent iff current value is
33182 not defined, for example if the trace was never run, or is
33187 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33189 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tvariables}.
33191 @subsubheading Example
33195 -trace-list-variables
33196 ^done,trace-variables=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="3",
33197 hdr=[@{width="15",alignment="-1",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@},
33198 @{width="11",alignment="-1",col_name="initial",colhdr="Initial"@},
33199 @{width="11",alignment="-1",col_name="current",colhdr="Current"@}],
33200 body=[variable=@{name="$trace_timestamp",initial="0"@}
33201 variable=@{name="$foo",initial="10",current="15"@}]@}
33205 @subheading -trace-save
33206 @findex -trace-save
33208 @subsubheading Synopsis
33211 -trace-save [-r ] @var{filename}
33214 Saves the collected trace data to @var{filename}. Without the
33215 @samp{-r} option, the data is downloaded from the target and saved
33216 in a local file. With the @samp{-r} option the target is asked
33217 to perform the save.
33219 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33221 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tsave}.
33224 @subheading -trace-start
33225 @findex -trace-start
33227 @subsubheading Synopsis
33233 Starts a tracing experiments. The result of this command does not
33236 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33238 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstart}.
33240 @subheading -trace-status
33241 @findex -trace-status
33243 @subsubheading Synopsis
33249 Obtains the status of a tracing experiment. The result may include
33250 the following fields:
33255 May have a value of either @samp{0}, when no tracing operations are
33256 supported, @samp{1}, when all tracing operations are supported, or
33257 @samp{file} when examining trace file. In the latter case, examining
33258 of trace frame is possible but new tracing experiement cannot be
33259 started. This field is always present.
33262 May have a value of either @samp{0} or @samp{1} depending on whether
33263 tracing experiement is in progress on target. This field is present
33264 if @samp{supported} field is not @samp{0}.
33267 Report the reason why the tracing was stopped last time. This field
33268 may be absent iff tracing was never stopped on target yet. The
33269 value of @samp{request} means the tracing was stopped as result of
33270 the @code{-trace-stop} command. The value of @samp{overflow} means
33271 the tracing buffer is full. The value of @samp{disconnection} means
33272 tracing was automatically stopped when @value{GDBN} has disconnected.
33273 The value of @samp{passcount} means tracing was stopped when a
33274 tracepoint was passed a maximal number of times for that tracepoint.
33275 This field is present if @samp{supported} field is not @samp{0}.
33277 @item stopping-tracepoint
33278 The number of tracepoint whose passcount as exceeded. This field is
33279 present iff the @samp{stop-reason} field has the value of
33283 @itemx frames-created
33284 The @samp{frames} field is a count of the total number of trace frames
33285 in the trace buffer, while @samp{frames-created} is the total created
33286 during the run, including ones that were discarded, such as when a
33287 circular trace buffer filled up. Both fields are optional.
33291 These fields tell the current size of the tracing buffer and the
33292 remaining space. These fields are optional.
33295 The value of the circular trace buffer flag. @code{1} means that the
33296 trace buffer is circular and old trace frames will be discarded if
33297 necessary to make room, @code{0} means that the trace buffer is linear
33301 The value of the disconnected tracing flag. @code{1} means that
33302 tracing will continue after @value{GDBN} disconnects, @code{0} means
33303 that the trace run will stop.
33306 The filename of the trace file being examined. This field is
33307 optional, and only present when examining a trace file.
33311 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33313 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstatus}.
33315 @subheading -trace-stop
33316 @findex -trace-stop
33318 @subsubheading Synopsis
33324 Stops a tracing experiment. The result of this command has the same
33325 fields as @code{-trace-status}, except that the @samp{supported} and
33326 @samp{running} fields are not output.
33328 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33330 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstop}.
33333 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
33334 @node GDB/MI Symbol Query
33335 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Symbol Query Commands
33339 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-address} Command
33340 @findex -symbol-info-address
33342 @subsubheading Synopsis
33345 -symbol-info-address @var{symbol}
33348 Describe where @var{symbol} is stored.
33350 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33352 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info address}.
33354 @subsubheading Example
33358 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-file} Command
33359 @findex -symbol-info-file
33361 @subsubheading Synopsis
33367 Show the file for the symbol.
33369 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33371 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command. @code{gdbtk} has
33372 @samp{gdb_find_file}.
33374 @subsubheading Example
33378 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-function} Command
33379 @findex -symbol-info-function
33381 @subsubheading Synopsis
33384 -symbol-info-function
33387 Show which function the symbol lives in.
33389 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33391 @samp{gdb_get_function} in @code{gdbtk}.
33393 @subsubheading Example
33397 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-line} Command
33398 @findex -symbol-info-line
33400 @subsubheading Synopsis
33406 Show the core addresses of the code for a source line.
33408 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33410 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info line}.
33411 @code{gdbtk} has the @samp{gdb_get_line} and @samp{gdb_get_file} commands.
33413 @subsubheading Example
33417 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-symbol} Command
33418 @findex -symbol-info-symbol
33420 @subsubheading Synopsis
33423 -symbol-info-symbol @var{addr}
33426 Describe what symbol is at location @var{addr}.
33428 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33430 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info symbol}.
33432 @subsubheading Example
33436 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-functions} Command
33437 @findex -symbol-list-functions
33439 @subsubheading Synopsis
33442 -symbol-list-functions
33445 List the functions in the executable.
33447 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33449 @samp{info functions} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_listfunc} and
33450 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
33452 @subsubheading Example
33457 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-lines} Command
33458 @findex -symbol-list-lines
33460 @subsubheading Synopsis
33463 -symbol-list-lines @var{filename}
33466 Print the list of lines that contain code and their associated program
33467 addresses for the given source filename. The entries are sorted in
33468 ascending PC order.
33470 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33472 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
33474 @subsubheading Example
33477 -symbol-list-lines basics.c
33478 ^done,lines=[@{pc="0x08048554",line="7"@},@{pc="0x0804855a",line="8"@}]
33484 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-types} Command
33485 @findex -symbol-list-types
33487 @subsubheading Synopsis
33493 List all the type names.
33495 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33497 The corresponding commands are @samp{info types} in @value{GDBN},
33498 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
33500 @subsubheading Example
33504 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-variables} Command
33505 @findex -symbol-list-variables
33507 @subsubheading Synopsis
33510 -symbol-list-variables
33513 List all the global and static variable names.
33515 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33517 @samp{info variables} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
33519 @subsubheading Example
33523 @subheading The @code{-symbol-locate} Command
33524 @findex -symbol-locate
33526 @subsubheading Synopsis
33532 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33534 @samp{gdb_loc} in @code{gdbtk}.
33536 @subsubheading Example
33540 @subheading The @code{-symbol-type} Command
33541 @findex -symbol-type
33543 @subsubheading Synopsis
33546 -symbol-type @var{variable}
33549 Show type of @var{variable}.
33551 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33553 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ptype}, @code{gdbtk} has
33554 @samp{gdb_obj_variable}.
33556 @subsubheading Example
33561 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
33562 @node GDB/MI File Commands
33563 @section @sc{gdb/mi} File Commands
33565 This section describes the GDB/MI commands to specify executable file names
33566 and to read in and obtain symbol table information.
33568 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-and-symbols} Command
33569 @findex -file-exec-and-symbols
33571 @subsubheading Synopsis
33574 -file-exec-and-symbols @var{file}
33577 Specify the executable file to be debugged. This file is the one from
33578 which the symbol table is also read. If no file is specified, the
33579 command clears the executable and symbol information. If breakpoints
33580 are set when using this command with no arguments, @value{GDBN} will produce
33581 error messages. Otherwise, no output is produced, except a completion
33584 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33586 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{file}.
33588 @subsubheading Example
33592 -file-exec-and-symbols /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
33598 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-file} Command
33599 @findex -file-exec-file
33601 @subsubheading Synopsis
33604 -file-exec-file @var{file}
33607 Specify the executable file to be debugged. Unlike
33608 @samp{-file-exec-and-symbols}, the symbol table is @emph{not} read
33609 from this file. If used without argument, @value{GDBN} clears the information
33610 about the executable file. No output is produced, except a completion
33613 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33615 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{exec-file}.
33617 @subsubheading Example
33621 -file-exec-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
33628 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-sections} Command
33629 @findex -file-list-exec-sections
33631 @subsubheading Synopsis
33634 -file-list-exec-sections
33637 List the sections of the current executable file.
33639 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33641 The @value{GDBN} command @samp{info file} shows, among the rest, the same
33642 information as this command. @code{gdbtk} has a corresponding command
33643 @samp{gdb_load_info}.
33645 @subsubheading Example
33650 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-file} Command
33651 @findex -file-list-exec-source-file
33653 @subsubheading Synopsis
33656 -file-list-exec-source-file
33659 List the line number, the current source file, and the absolute path
33660 to the current source file for the current executable. The macro
33661 information field has a value of @samp{1} or @samp{0} depending on
33662 whether or not the file includes preprocessor macro information.
33664 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33666 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info source}
33668 @subsubheading Example
33672 123-file-list-exec-source-file
33673 123^done,line="1",file="foo.c",fullname="/home/bar/foo.c,macro-info="1"
33678 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-files} Command
33679 @findex -file-list-exec-source-files
33681 @subsubheading Synopsis
33684 -file-list-exec-source-files
33687 List the source files for the current executable.
33689 It will always output both the filename and fullname (absolute file
33690 name) of a source file.
33692 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33694 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info sources}.
33695 @code{gdbtk} has an analogous command @samp{gdb_listfiles}.
33697 @subsubheading Example
33700 -file-list-exec-source-files
33702 @{file=foo.c,fullname=/home/foo.c@},
33703 @{file=/home/bar.c,fullname=/home/bar.c@},
33704 @{file=gdb_could_not_find_fullpath.c@}]
33709 @subheading The @code{-file-list-shared-libraries} Command
33710 @findex -file-list-shared-libraries
33712 @subsubheading Synopsis
33715 -file-list-shared-libraries
33718 List the shared libraries in the program.
33720 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33722 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info shared}.
33724 @subsubheading Example
33728 @subheading The @code{-file-list-symbol-files} Command
33729 @findex -file-list-symbol-files
33731 @subsubheading Synopsis
33734 -file-list-symbol-files
33739 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33741 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info file} (part of it).
33743 @subsubheading Example
33748 @subheading The @code{-file-symbol-file} Command
33749 @findex -file-symbol-file
33751 @subsubheading Synopsis
33754 -file-symbol-file @var{file}
33757 Read symbol table info from the specified @var{file} argument. When
33758 used without arguments, clears @value{GDBN}'s symbol table info. No output is
33759 produced, except for a completion notification.
33761 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33763 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{symbol-file}.
33765 @subsubheading Example
33769 -file-symbol-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
33775 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
33776 @node GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands
33777 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Memory Overlay Commands
33779 The memory overlay commands are not implemented.
33781 @c @subheading -overlay-auto
33783 @c @subheading -overlay-list-mapping-state
33785 @c @subheading -overlay-list-overlays
33787 @c @subheading -overlay-map
33789 @c @subheading -overlay-off
33791 @c @subheading -overlay-on
33793 @c @subheading -overlay-unmap
33795 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
33796 @node GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands
33797 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Signal Handling Commands
33799 Signal handling commands are not implemented.
33801 @c @subheading -signal-handle
33803 @c @subheading -signal-list-handle-actions
33805 @c @subheading -signal-list-signal-types
33809 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
33810 @node GDB/MI Target Manipulation
33811 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Target Manipulation Commands
33814 @subheading The @code{-target-attach} Command
33815 @findex -target-attach
33817 @subsubheading Synopsis
33820 -target-attach @var{pid} | @var{gid} | @var{file}
33823 Attach to a process @var{pid} or a file @var{file} outside of
33824 @value{GDBN}, or a thread group @var{gid}. If attaching to a thread
33825 group, the id previously returned by
33826 @samp{-list-thread-groups --available} must be used.
33828 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33830 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{attach}.
33832 @subsubheading Example
33836 =thread-created,id="1"
33837 *stopped,thread-id="1",frame=@{addr="0xb7f7e410",func="bar",args=[]@}
33843 @subheading The @code{-target-compare-sections} Command
33844 @findex -target-compare-sections
33846 @subsubheading Synopsis
33849 -target-compare-sections [ @var{section} ]
33852 Compare data of section @var{section} on target to the exec file.
33853 Without the argument, all sections are compared.
33855 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33857 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{compare-sections}.
33859 @subsubheading Example
33864 @subheading The @code{-target-detach} Command
33865 @findex -target-detach
33867 @subsubheading Synopsis
33870 -target-detach [ @var{pid} | @var{gid} ]
33873 Detach from the remote target which normally resumes its execution.
33874 If either @var{pid} or @var{gid} is specified, detaches from either
33875 the specified process, or specified thread group. There's no output.
33877 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33879 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{detach}.
33881 @subsubheading Example
33891 @subheading The @code{-target-disconnect} Command
33892 @findex -target-disconnect
33894 @subsubheading Synopsis
33900 Disconnect from the remote target. There's no output and the target is
33901 generally not resumed.
33903 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33905 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disconnect}.
33907 @subsubheading Example
33917 @subheading The @code{-target-download} Command
33918 @findex -target-download
33920 @subsubheading Synopsis
33926 Loads the executable onto the remote target.
33927 It prints out an update message every half second, which includes the fields:
33931 The name of the section.
33933 The size of what has been sent so far for that section.
33935 The size of the section.
33937 The total size of what was sent so far (the current and the previous sections).
33939 The size of the overall executable to download.
33943 Each message is sent as status record (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, ,
33944 @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax}).
33946 In addition, it prints the name and size of the sections, as they are
33947 downloaded. These messages include the following fields:
33951 The name of the section.
33953 The size of the section.
33955 The size of the overall executable to download.
33959 At the end, a summary is printed.
33961 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33963 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{load}.
33965 @subsubheading Example
33967 Note: each status message appears on a single line. Here the messages
33968 have been broken down so that they can fit onto a page.
33973 +download,@{section=".text",section-size="6668",total-size="9880"@}
33974 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="512",section-size="6668",
33975 total-sent="512",total-size="9880"@}
33976 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1024",section-size="6668",
33977 total-sent="1024",total-size="9880"@}
33978 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1536",section-size="6668",
33979 total-sent="1536",total-size="9880"@}
33980 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2048",section-size="6668",
33981 total-sent="2048",total-size="9880"@}
33982 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2560",section-size="6668",
33983 total-sent="2560",total-size="9880"@}
33984 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3072",section-size="6668",
33985 total-sent="3072",total-size="9880"@}
33986 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3584",section-size="6668",
33987 total-sent="3584",total-size="9880"@}
33988 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4096",section-size="6668",
33989 total-sent="4096",total-size="9880"@}
33990 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4608",section-size="6668",
33991 total-sent="4608",total-size="9880"@}
33992 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5120",section-size="6668",
33993 total-sent="5120",total-size="9880"@}
33994 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5632",section-size="6668",
33995 total-sent="5632",total-size="9880"@}
33996 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6144",section-size="6668",
33997 total-sent="6144",total-size="9880"@}
33998 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6656",section-size="6668",
33999 total-sent="6656",total-size="9880"@}
34000 +download,@{section=".init",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
34001 +download,@{section=".fini",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
34002 +download,@{section=".data",section-size="3156",total-size="9880"@}
34003 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="512",section-size="3156",
34004 total-sent="7236",total-size="9880"@}
34005 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1024",section-size="3156",
34006 total-sent="7748",total-size="9880"@}
34007 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1536",section-size="3156",
34008 total-sent="8260",total-size="9880"@}
34009 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2048",section-size="3156",
34010 total-sent="8772",total-size="9880"@}
34011 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2560",section-size="3156",
34012 total-sent="9284",total-size="9880"@}
34013 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="3072",section-size="3156",
34014 total-sent="9796",total-size="9880"@}
34015 ^done,address="0x10004",load-size="9880",transfer-rate="6586",
34022 @subheading The @code{-target-exec-status} Command
34023 @findex -target-exec-status
34025 @subsubheading Synopsis
34028 -target-exec-status
34031 Provide information on the state of the target (whether it is running or
34032 not, for instance).
34034 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
34036 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
34038 @subsubheading Example
34042 @subheading The @code{-target-list-available-targets} Command
34043 @findex -target-list-available-targets
34045 @subsubheading Synopsis
34048 -target-list-available-targets
34051 List the possible targets to connect to.
34053 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
34055 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{help target}.
34057 @subsubheading Example
34061 @subheading The @code{-target-list-current-targets} Command
34062 @findex -target-list-current-targets
34064 @subsubheading Synopsis
34067 -target-list-current-targets
34070 Describe the current target.
34072 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
34074 The corresponding information is printed by @samp{info file} (among
34077 @subsubheading Example
34081 @subheading The @code{-target-list-parameters} Command
34082 @findex -target-list-parameters
34084 @subsubheading Synopsis
34087 -target-list-parameters
34093 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
34097 @subsubheading Example
34101 @subheading The @code{-target-select} Command
34102 @findex -target-select
34104 @subsubheading Synopsis
34107 -target-select @var{type} @var{parameters @dots{}}
34110 Connect @value{GDBN} to the remote target. This command takes two args:
34114 The type of target, for instance @samp{remote}, etc.
34115 @item @var{parameters}
34116 Device names, host names and the like. @xref{Target Commands, ,
34117 Commands for Managing Targets}, for more details.
34120 The output is a connection notification, followed by the address at
34121 which the target program is, in the following form:
34124 ^connected,addr="@var{address}",func="@var{function name}",
34125 args=[@var{arg list}]
34128 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
34130 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{target}.
34132 @subsubheading Example
34136 -target-select remote /dev/ttya
34137 ^connected,addr="0xfe00a300",func="??",args=[]
34141 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
34142 @node GDB/MI File Transfer Commands
34143 @section @sc{gdb/mi} File Transfer Commands
34146 @subheading The @code{-target-file-put} Command
34147 @findex -target-file-put
34149 @subsubheading Synopsis
34152 -target-file-put @var{hostfile} @var{targetfile}
34155 Copy file @var{hostfile} from the host system (the machine running
34156 @value{GDBN}) to @var{targetfile} on the target system.
34158 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
34160 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote put}.
34162 @subsubheading Example
34166 -target-file-put localfile remotefile
34172 @subheading The @code{-target-file-get} Command
34173 @findex -target-file-get
34175 @subsubheading Synopsis
34178 -target-file-get @var{targetfile} @var{hostfile}
34181 Copy file @var{targetfile} from the target system to @var{hostfile}
34182 on the host system.
34184 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
34186 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote get}.
34188 @subsubheading Example
34192 -target-file-get remotefile localfile
34198 @subheading The @code{-target-file-delete} Command
34199 @findex -target-file-delete
34201 @subsubheading Synopsis
34204 -target-file-delete @var{targetfile}
34207 Delete @var{targetfile} from the target system.
34209 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
34211 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote delete}.
34213 @subsubheading Example
34217 -target-file-delete remotefile
34223 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
34224 @node GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands
34225 @section Miscellaneous @sc{gdb/mi} Commands
34227 @c @subheading -gdb-complete
34229 @subheading The @code{-gdb-exit} Command
34232 @subsubheading Synopsis
34238 Exit @value{GDBN} immediately.
34240 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
34242 Approximately corresponds to @samp{quit}.
34244 @subsubheading Example
34254 @subheading The @code{-exec-abort} Command
34255 @findex -exec-abort
34257 @subsubheading Synopsis
34263 Kill the inferior running program.
34265 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
34267 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{kill}.
34269 @subsubheading Example
34274 @subheading The @code{-gdb-set} Command
34277 @subsubheading Synopsis
34283 Set an internal @value{GDBN} variable.
34284 @c IS THIS A DOLLAR VARIABLE? OR SOMETHING LIKE ANNOTATE ?????
34286 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
34288 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set}.
34290 @subsubheading Example
34300 @subheading The @code{-gdb-show} Command
34303 @subsubheading Synopsis
34309 Show the current value of a @value{GDBN} variable.
34311 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
34313 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show}.
34315 @subsubheading Example
34324 @c @subheading -gdb-source
34327 @subheading The @code{-gdb-version} Command
34328 @findex -gdb-version
34330 @subsubheading Synopsis
34336 Show version information for @value{GDBN}. Used mostly in testing.
34338 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
34340 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{show version}. @value{GDBN} by
34341 default shows this information when you start an interactive session.
34343 @subsubheading Example
34345 @c This example modifies the actual output from GDB to avoid overfull
34351 ~Copyright 2000 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
34352 ~GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License, and
34353 ~you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it under
34354 ~ certain conditions.
34355 ~Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
34356 ~There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty" for
34358 ~This GDB was configured as
34359 "--host=sparc-sun-solaris2.5.1 --target=ppc-eabi".
34364 @subheading The @code{-list-features} Command
34365 @findex -list-features
34367 Returns a list of particular features of the MI protocol that
34368 this version of gdb implements. A feature can be a command,
34369 or a new field in an output of some command, or even an
34370 important bugfix. While a frontend can sometimes detect presence
34371 of a feature at runtime, it is easier to perform detection at debugger
34374 The command returns a list of strings, with each string naming an
34375 available feature. Each returned string is just a name, it does not
34376 have any internal structure. The list of possible feature names
34382 (gdb) -list-features
34383 ^done,result=["feature1","feature2"]
34386 The current list of features is:
34389 @item frozen-varobjs
34390 Indicates support for the @code{-var-set-frozen} command, as well
34391 as possible presense of the @code{frozen} field in the output
34392 of @code{-varobj-create}.
34393 @item pending-breakpoints
34394 Indicates support for the @option{-f} option to the @code{-break-insert}
34397 Indicates Python scripting support, Python-based
34398 pretty-printing commands, and possible presence of the
34399 @samp{display_hint} field in the output of @code{-var-list-children}
34401 Indicates support for the @code{-thread-info} command.
34402 @item data-read-memory-bytes
34403 Indicates support for the @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} and the
34404 @code{-data-write-memory-bytes} commands.
34405 @item breakpoint-notifications
34406 Indicates that changes to breakpoints and breakpoints created via the
34407 CLI will be announced via async records.
34408 @item ada-task-info
34409 Indicates support for the @code{-ada-task-info} command.
34412 @subheading The @code{-list-target-features} Command
34413 @findex -list-target-features
34415 Returns a list of particular features that are supported by the
34416 target. Those features affect the permitted MI commands, but
34417 unlike the features reported by the @code{-list-features} command, the
34418 features depend on which target GDB is using at the moment. Whenever
34419 a target can change, due to commands such as @code{-target-select},
34420 @code{-target-attach} or @code{-exec-run}, the list of target features
34421 may change, and the frontend should obtain it again.
34425 (gdb) -list-features
34426 ^done,result=["async"]
34429 The current list of features is:
34433 Indicates that the target is capable of asynchronous command
34434 execution, which means that @value{GDBN} will accept further commands
34435 while the target is running.
34438 Indicates that the target is capable of reverse execution.
34439 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
34443 @subheading The @code{-list-thread-groups} Command
34444 @findex -list-thread-groups
34446 @subheading Synopsis
34449 -list-thread-groups [ --available ] [ --recurse 1 ] [ @var{group} ... ]
34452 Lists thread groups (@pxref{Thread groups}). When a single thread
34453 group is passed as the argument, lists the children of that group.
34454 When several thread group are passed, lists information about those
34455 thread groups. Without any parameters, lists information about all
34456 top-level thread groups.
34458 Normally, thread groups that are being debugged are reported.
34459 With the @samp{--available} option, @value{GDBN} reports thread groups
34460 available on the target.
34462 The output of this command may have either a @samp{threads} result or
34463 a @samp{groups} result. The @samp{thread} result has a list of tuples
34464 as value, with each tuple describing a thread (@pxref{GDB/MI Thread
34465 Information}). The @samp{groups} result has a list of tuples as value,
34466 each tuple describing a thread group. If top-level groups are
34467 requested (that is, no parameter is passed), or when several groups
34468 are passed, the output always has a @samp{groups} result. The format
34469 of the @samp{group} result is described below.
34471 To reduce the number of roundtrips it's possible to list thread groups
34472 together with their children, by passing the @samp{--recurse} option
34473 and the recursion depth. Presently, only recursion depth of 1 is
34474 permitted. If this option is present, then every reported thread group
34475 will also include its children, either as @samp{group} or
34476 @samp{threads} field.
34478 In general, any combination of option and parameters is permitted, with
34479 the following caveats:
34483 When a single thread group is passed, the output will typically
34484 be the @samp{threads} result. Because threads may not contain
34485 anything, the @samp{recurse} option will be ignored.
34488 When the @samp{--available} option is passed, limited information may
34489 be available. In particular, the list of threads of a process might
34490 be inaccessible. Further, specifying specific thread groups might
34491 not give any performance advantage over listing all thread groups.
34492 The frontend should assume that @samp{-list-thread-groups --available}
34493 is always an expensive operation and cache the results.
34497 The @samp{groups} result is a list of tuples, where each tuple may
34498 have the following fields:
34502 Identifier of the thread group. This field is always present.
34503 The identifier is an opaque string; frontends should not try to
34504 convert it to an integer, even though it might look like one.
34507 The type of the thread group. At present, only @samp{process} is a
34511 The target-specific process identifier. This field is only present
34512 for thread groups of type @samp{process} and only if the process exists.
34515 The number of children this thread group has. This field may be
34516 absent for an available thread group.
34519 This field has a list of tuples as value, each tuple describing a
34520 thread. It may be present if the @samp{--recurse} option is
34521 specified, and it's actually possible to obtain the threads.
34524 This field is a list of integers, each identifying a core that one
34525 thread of the group is running on. This field may be absent if
34526 such information is not available.
34529 The name of the executable file that corresponds to this thread group.
34530 The field is only present for thread groups of type @samp{process},
34531 and only if there is a corresponding executable file.
34535 @subheading Example
34539 -list-thread-groups
34540 ^done,groups=[@{id="17",type="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2"@}]
34541 -list-thread-groups 17
34542 ^done,threads=[@{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90 (LWP 21257)",
34543 frame=@{level="0",addr="0xffffe410",func="__kernel_vsyscall",args=[]@},state="running"@},
34544 @{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e156b0 (LWP 21254)",
34545 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0804891f",func="foo",args=[@{name="i",value="10"@}],
34546 file="/tmp/a.c",fullname="/tmp/a.c",line="158"@},state="running"@}]]
34547 -list-thread-groups --available
34548 ^done,groups=[@{id="17",type="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2]@}]
34549 -list-thread-groups --available --recurse 1
34550 ^done,groups=[@{id="17", types="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2],
34551 threads=[@{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[1]@},
34552 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[2]@}]@},..]
34553 -list-thread-groups --available --recurse 1 17 18
34554 ^done,groups=[@{id="17", types="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2],
34555 threads=[@{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[1]@},
34556 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[2]@}]@},...]
34559 @subheading The @code{-info-os} Command
34562 @subsubheading Synopsis
34565 -info-os [ @var{type} ]
34568 If no argument is supplied, the command returns a table of available
34569 operating-system-specific information types. If one of these types is
34570 supplied as an argument @var{type}, then the command returns a table
34571 of data of that type.
34573 The types of information available depend on the target operating
34576 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
34578 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info os}.
34580 @subsubheading Example
34582 When run on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, the output will look something
34588 ^done,OSDataTable=@{nr_rows="9",nr_cols="3",
34589 hdr=[@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col0",colhdr="Type"@},
34590 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col1",colhdr="Description"@},
34591 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col2",colhdr="Title"@}],
34592 body=[item=@{col0="processes",col1="Listing of all processes",
34593 col2="Processes"@},
34594 item=@{col0="procgroups",col1="Listing of all process groups",
34595 col2="Process groups"@},
34596 item=@{col0="threads",col1="Listing of all threads",
34598 item=@{col0="files",col1="Listing of all file descriptors",
34599 col2="File descriptors"@},
34600 item=@{col0="sockets",col1="Listing of all internet-domain sockets",
34602 item=@{col0="shm",col1="Listing of all shared-memory regions",
34603 col2="Shared-memory regions"@},
34604 item=@{col0="semaphores",col1="Listing of all semaphores",
34605 col2="Semaphores"@},
34606 item=@{col0="msg",col1="Listing of all message queues",
34607 col2="Message queues"@},
34608 item=@{col0="modules",col1="Listing of all loaded kernel modules",
34609 col2="Kernel modules"@}]@}
34612 ^done,OSDataTable=@{nr_rows="190",nr_cols="4",
34613 hdr=[@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col0",colhdr="pid"@},
34614 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col1",colhdr="user"@},
34615 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col2",colhdr="command"@},
34616 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col3",colhdr="cores"@}],
34617 body=[item=@{col0="1",col1="root",col2="/sbin/init",col3="0"@},
34618 item=@{col0="2",col1="root",col2="[kthreadd]",col3="1"@},
34619 item=@{col0="3",col1="root",col2="[ksoftirqd/0]",col3="0"@},
34621 item=@{col0="26446",col1="stan",col2="bash",col3="0"@},
34622 item=@{col0="28152",col1="stan",col2="bash",col3="1"@}]@}
34626 (Note that the MI output here includes a @code{"Title"} column that
34627 does not appear in command-line @code{info os}; this column is useful
34628 for MI clients that want to enumerate the types of data, such as in a
34629 popup menu, but is needless clutter on the command line, and
34630 @code{info os} omits it.)
34632 @subheading The @code{-add-inferior} Command
34633 @findex -add-inferior
34635 @subheading Synopsis
34641 Creates a new inferior (@pxref{Inferiors and Programs}). The created
34642 inferior is not associated with any executable. Such association may
34643 be established with the @samp{-file-exec-and-symbols} command
34644 (@pxref{GDB/MI File Commands}). The command response has a single
34645 field, @samp{thread-group}, whose value is the identifier of the
34646 thread group corresponding to the new inferior.
34648 @subheading Example
34653 ^done,thread-group="i3"
34656 @subheading The @code{-interpreter-exec} Command
34657 @findex -interpreter-exec
34659 @subheading Synopsis
34662 -interpreter-exec @var{interpreter} @var{command}
34664 @anchor{-interpreter-exec}
34666 Execute the specified @var{command} in the given @var{interpreter}.
34668 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
34670 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interpreter-exec}.
34672 @subheading Example
34676 -interpreter-exec console "break main"
34677 &"During symbol reading, couldn't parse type; debugger out of date?.\n"
34678 &"During symbol reading, bad structure-type format.\n"
34679 ~"Breakpoint 1 at 0x8074fc6: file ../../src/gdb/main.c, line 743.\n"
34684 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-set} Command
34685 @findex -inferior-tty-set
34687 @subheading Synopsis
34690 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
34693 Set terminal for future runs of the program being debugged.
34695 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
34697 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set inferior-tty} /dev/pts/1.
34699 @subheading Example
34703 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
34708 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-show} Command
34709 @findex -inferior-tty-show
34711 @subheading Synopsis
34717 Show terminal for future runs of program being debugged.
34719 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
34721 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show inferior-tty}.
34723 @subheading Example
34727 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
34731 ^done,inferior_tty_terminal="/dev/pts/1"
34735 @subheading The @code{-enable-timings} Command
34736 @findex -enable-timings
34738 @subheading Synopsis
34741 -enable-timings [yes | no]
34744 Toggle the printing of the wallclock, user and system times for an MI
34745 command as a field in its output. This command is to help frontend
34746 developers optimize the performance of their code. No argument is
34747 equivalent to @samp{yes}.
34749 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
34753 @subheading Example
34761 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
34762 addr="0x080484ed",func="main",file="myprog.c",
34763 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73",thread-groups=["i1"],
34765 time=@{wallclock="0.05185",user="0.00800",system="0.00000"@}
34773 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
34774 frame=@{addr="0x080484ed",func="main",args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},
34775 @{name="argv",value="0xbfb60364"@}],file="myprog.c",
34776 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73"@}
34781 @chapter @value{GDBN} Annotations
34783 This chapter describes annotations in @value{GDBN}. Annotations were
34784 designed to interface @value{GDBN} to graphical user interfaces or other
34785 similar programs which want to interact with @value{GDBN} at a
34786 relatively high level.
34788 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
34792 This is Edition @value{EDITION}, @value{DATE}.
34796 * Annotations Overview:: What annotations are; the general syntax.
34797 * Server Prefix:: Issuing a command without affecting user state.
34798 * Prompting:: Annotations marking @value{GDBN}'s need for input.
34799 * Errors:: Annotations for error messages.
34800 * Invalidation:: Some annotations describe things now invalid.
34801 * Annotations for Running::
34802 Whether the program is running, how it stopped, etc.
34803 * Source Annotations:: Annotations describing source code.
34806 @node Annotations Overview
34807 @section What is an Annotation?
34808 @cindex annotations
34810 Annotations start with a newline character, two @samp{control-z}
34811 characters, and the name of the annotation. If there is no additional
34812 information associated with this annotation, the name of the annotation
34813 is followed immediately by a newline. If there is additional
34814 information, the name of the annotation is followed by a space, the
34815 additional information, and a newline. The additional information
34816 cannot contain newline characters.
34818 Any output not beginning with a newline and two @samp{control-z}
34819 characters denotes literal output from @value{GDBN}. Currently there is
34820 no need for @value{GDBN} to output a newline followed by two
34821 @samp{control-z} characters, but if there was such a need, the
34822 annotations could be extended with an @samp{escape} annotation which
34823 means those three characters as output.
34825 The annotation @var{level}, which is specified using the
34826 @option{--annotate} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}), controls
34827 how much information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt,
34828 values of expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0
34829 is for no annotations, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a
34830 subprocess of @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable
34831 for programs that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 annotations have
34832 been made obsolete (@pxref{Limitations, , Limitations of the Annotation
34833 Interface, annotate, GDB's Obsolete Annotations}).
34836 @kindex set annotate
34837 @item set annotate @var{level}
34838 The @value{GDBN} command @code{set annotate} sets the level of
34839 annotations to the specified @var{level}.
34841 @item show annotate
34842 @kindex show annotate
34843 Show the current annotation level.
34846 This chapter describes level 3 annotations.
34848 A simple example of starting up @value{GDBN} with annotations is:
34851 $ @kbd{gdb --annotate=3}
34853 Copyright 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
34854 GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License,
34855 and you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it
34856 under certain conditions.
34857 Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
34858 There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty"
34860 This GDB was configured as "i386-pc-linux-gnu"
34871 Here @samp{quit} is input to @value{GDBN}; the rest is output from
34872 @value{GDBN}. The three lines beginning @samp{^Z^Z} (where @samp{^Z}
34873 denotes a @samp{control-z} character) are annotations; the rest is
34874 output from @value{GDBN}.
34876 @node Server Prefix
34877 @section The Server Prefix
34878 @cindex server prefix
34880 If you prefix a command with @samp{server } then it will not affect
34881 the command history, nor will it affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which
34882 command to repeat if @key{RET} is pressed on a line by itself. This
34883 means that commands can be run behind a user's back by a front-end in
34884 a transparent manner.
34886 The @code{server } prefix does not affect the recording of values into
34887 the value history; to print a value without recording it into the
34888 value history, use the @code{output} command instead of the
34889 @code{print} command.
34891 Using this prefix also disables confirmation requests
34892 (@pxref{confirmation requests}).
34895 @section Annotation for @value{GDBN} Input
34897 @cindex annotations for prompts
34898 When @value{GDBN} prompts for input, it annotates this fact so it is possible
34899 to know when to send output, when the output from a given command is
34902 Different kinds of input each have a different @dfn{input type}. Each
34903 input type has three annotations: a @code{pre-} annotation, which
34904 denotes the beginning of any prompt which is being output, a plain
34905 annotation, which denotes the end of the prompt, and then a @code{post-}
34906 annotation which denotes the end of any echo which may (or may not) be
34907 associated with the input. For example, the @code{prompt} input type
34908 features the following annotations:
34916 The input types are
34919 @findex pre-prompt annotation
34920 @findex prompt annotation
34921 @findex post-prompt annotation
34923 When @value{GDBN} is prompting for a command (the main @value{GDBN} prompt).
34925 @findex pre-commands annotation
34926 @findex commands annotation
34927 @findex post-commands annotation
34929 When @value{GDBN} prompts for a set of commands, like in the @code{commands}
34930 command. The annotations are repeated for each command which is input.
34932 @findex pre-overload-choice annotation
34933 @findex overload-choice annotation
34934 @findex post-overload-choice annotation
34935 @item overload-choice
34936 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to select between various overloaded functions.
34938 @findex pre-query annotation
34939 @findex query annotation
34940 @findex post-query annotation
34942 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to confirm a potentially dangerous operation.
34944 @findex pre-prompt-for-continue annotation
34945 @findex prompt-for-continue annotation
34946 @findex post-prompt-for-continue annotation
34947 @item prompt-for-continue
34948 When @value{GDBN} is asking the user to press return to continue. Note: Don't
34949 expect this to work well; instead use @code{set height 0} to disable
34950 prompting. This is because the counting of lines is buggy in the
34951 presence of annotations.
34956 @cindex annotations for errors, warnings and interrupts
34958 @findex quit annotation
34963 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an interrupt.
34965 @findex error annotation
34970 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an error.
34972 Quit and error annotations indicate that any annotations which @value{GDBN} was
34973 in the middle of may end abruptly. For example, if a
34974 @code{value-history-begin} annotation is followed by a @code{error}, one
34975 cannot expect to receive the matching @code{value-history-end}. One
34976 cannot expect not to receive it either, however; an error annotation
34977 does not necessarily mean that @value{GDBN} is immediately returning all the way
34980 @findex error-begin annotation
34981 A quit or error annotation may be preceded by
34987 Any output between that and the quit or error annotation is the error
34990 Warning messages are not yet annotated.
34991 @c If we want to change that, need to fix warning(), type_error(),
34992 @c range_error(), and possibly other places.
34995 @section Invalidation Notices
34997 @cindex annotations for invalidation messages
34998 The following annotations say that certain pieces of state may have
35002 @findex frames-invalid annotation
35003 @item ^Z^Zframes-invalid
35005 The frames (for example, output from the @code{backtrace} command) may
35008 @findex breakpoints-invalid annotation
35009 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoints-invalid
35011 The breakpoints may have changed. For example, the user just added or
35012 deleted a breakpoint.
35015 @node Annotations for Running
35016 @section Running the Program
35017 @cindex annotations for running programs
35019 @findex starting annotation
35020 @findex stopping annotation
35021 When the program starts executing due to a @value{GDBN} command such as
35022 @code{step} or @code{continue},
35028 is output. When the program stops,
35034 is output. Before the @code{stopped} annotation, a variety of
35035 annotations describe how the program stopped.
35038 @findex exited annotation
35039 @item ^Z^Zexited @var{exit-status}
35040 The program exited, and @var{exit-status} is the exit status (zero for
35041 successful exit, otherwise nonzero).
35043 @findex signalled annotation
35044 @findex signal-name annotation
35045 @findex signal-name-end annotation
35046 @findex signal-string annotation
35047 @findex signal-string-end annotation
35048 @item ^Z^Zsignalled
35049 The program exited with a signal. After the @code{^Z^Zsignalled}, the
35050 annotation continues:
35056 ^Z^Zsignal-name-end
35060 ^Z^Zsignal-string-end
35065 where @var{name} is the name of the signal, such as @code{SIGILL} or
35066 @code{SIGSEGV}, and @var{string} is the explanation of the signal, such
35067 as @code{Illegal Instruction} or @code{Segmentation fault}.
35068 @var{intro-text}, @var{middle-text}, and @var{end-text} are for the
35069 user's benefit and have no particular format.
35071 @findex signal annotation
35073 The syntax of this annotation is just like @code{signalled}, but @value{GDBN} is
35074 just saying that the program received the signal, not that it was
35075 terminated with it.
35077 @findex breakpoint annotation
35078 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoint @var{number}
35079 The program hit breakpoint number @var{number}.
35081 @findex watchpoint annotation
35082 @item ^Z^Zwatchpoint @var{number}
35083 The program hit watchpoint number @var{number}.
35086 @node Source Annotations
35087 @section Displaying Source
35088 @cindex annotations for source display
35090 @findex source annotation
35091 The following annotation is used instead of displaying source code:
35094 ^Z^Zsource @var{filename}:@var{line}:@var{character}:@var{middle}:@var{addr}
35097 where @var{filename} is an absolute file name indicating which source
35098 file, @var{line} is the line number within that file (where 1 is the
35099 first line in the file), @var{character} is the character position
35100 within the file (where 0 is the first character in the file) (for most
35101 debug formats this will necessarily point to the beginning of a line),
35102 @var{middle} is @samp{middle} if @var{addr} is in the middle of the
35103 line, or @samp{beg} if @var{addr} is at the beginning of the line, and
35104 @var{addr} is the address in the target program associated with the
35105 source which is being displayed. @var{addr} is in the form @samp{0x}
35106 followed by one or more lowercase hex digits (note that this does not
35107 depend on the language).
35109 @node JIT Interface
35110 @chapter JIT Compilation Interface
35111 @cindex just-in-time compilation
35112 @cindex JIT compilation interface
35114 This chapter documents @value{GDBN}'s @dfn{just-in-time} (JIT) compilation
35115 interface. A JIT compiler is a program or library that generates native
35116 executable code at runtime and executes it, usually in order to achieve good
35117 performance while maintaining platform independence.
35119 Programs that use JIT compilation are normally difficult to debug because
35120 portions of their code are generated at runtime, instead of being loaded from
35121 object files, which is where @value{GDBN} normally finds the program's symbols
35122 and debug information. In order to debug programs that use JIT compilation,
35123 @value{GDBN} has an interface that allows the program to register in-memory
35124 symbol files with @value{GDBN} at runtime.
35126 If you are using @value{GDBN} to debug a program that uses this interface, then
35127 it should work transparently so long as you have not stripped the binary. If
35128 you are developing a JIT compiler, then the interface is documented in the rest
35129 of this chapter. At this time, the only known client of this interface is the
35132 Broadly speaking, the JIT interface mirrors the dynamic loader interface. The
35133 JIT compiler communicates with @value{GDBN} by writing data into a global
35134 variable and calling a fuction at a well-known symbol. When @value{GDBN}
35135 attaches, it reads a linked list of symbol files from the global variable to
35136 find existing code, and puts a breakpoint in the function so that it can find
35137 out about additional code.
35140 * Declarations:: Relevant C struct declarations
35141 * Registering Code:: Steps to register code
35142 * Unregistering Code:: Steps to unregister code
35143 * Custom Debug Info:: Emit debug information in a custom format
35147 @section JIT Declarations
35149 These are the relevant struct declarations that a C program should include to
35150 implement the interface:
35160 struct jit_code_entry
35162 struct jit_code_entry *next_entry;
35163 struct jit_code_entry *prev_entry;
35164 const char *symfile_addr;
35165 uint64_t symfile_size;
35168 struct jit_descriptor
35171 /* This type should be jit_actions_t, but we use uint32_t
35172 to be explicit about the bitwidth. */
35173 uint32_t action_flag;
35174 struct jit_code_entry *relevant_entry;
35175 struct jit_code_entry *first_entry;
35178 /* GDB puts a breakpoint in this function. */
35179 void __attribute__((noinline)) __jit_debug_register_code() @{ @};
35181 /* Make sure to specify the version statically, because the
35182 debugger may check the version before we can set it. */
35183 struct jit_descriptor __jit_debug_descriptor = @{ 1, 0, 0, 0 @};
35186 If the JIT is multi-threaded, then it is important that the JIT synchronize any
35187 modifications to this global data properly, which can easily be done by putting
35188 a global mutex around modifications to these structures.
35190 @node Registering Code
35191 @section Registering Code
35193 To register code with @value{GDBN}, the JIT should follow this protocol:
35197 Generate an object file in memory with symbols and other desired debug
35198 information. The file must include the virtual addresses of the sections.
35201 Create a code entry for the file, which gives the start and size of the symbol
35205 Add it to the linked list in the JIT descriptor.
35208 Point the relevant_entry field of the descriptor at the entry.
35211 Set @code{action_flag} to @code{JIT_REGISTER} and call
35212 @code{__jit_debug_register_code}.
35215 When @value{GDBN} is attached and the breakpoint fires, @value{GDBN} uses the
35216 @code{relevant_entry} pointer so it doesn't have to walk the list looking for
35217 new code. However, the linked list must still be maintained in order to allow
35218 @value{GDBN} to attach to a running process and still find the symbol files.
35220 @node Unregistering Code
35221 @section Unregistering Code
35223 If code is freed, then the JIT should use the following protocol:
35227 Remove the code entry corresponding to the code from the linked list.
35230 Point the @code{relevant_entry} field of the descriptor at the code entry.
35233 Set @code{action_flag} to @code{JIT_UNREGISTER} and call
35234 @code{__jit_debug_register_code}.
35237 If the JIT frees or recompiles code without unregistering it, then @value{GDBN}
35238 and the JIT will leak the memory used for the associated symbol files.
35240 @node Custom Debug Info
35241 @section Custom Debug Info
35242 @cindex custom JIT debug info
35243 @cindex JIT debug info reader
35245 Generating debug information in platform-native file formats (like ELF
35246 or COFF) may be an overkill for JIT compilers; especially if all the
35247 debug info is used for is displaying a meaningful backtrace. The
35248 issue can be resolved by having the JIT writers decide on a debug info
35249 format and also provide a reader that parses the debug info generated
35250 by the JIT compiler. This section gives a brief overview on writing
35251 such a parser. More specific details can be found in the source file
35252 @file{gdb/jit-reader.in}, which is also installed as a header at
35253 @file{@var{includedir}/gdb/jit-reader.h} for easy inclusion.
35255 The reader is implemented as a shared object (so this functionality is
35256 not available on platforms which don't allow loading shared objects at
35257 runtime). Two @value{GDBN} commands, @code{jit-reader-load} and
35258 @code{jit-reader-unload} are provided, to be used to load and unload
35259 the readers from a preconfigured directory. Once loaded, the shared
35260 object is used the parse the debug information emitted by the JIT
35264 * Using JIT Debug Info Readers:: How to use supplied readers correctly
35265 * Writing JIT Debug Info Readers:: Creating a debug-info reader
35268 @node Using JIT Debug Info Readers
35269 @subsection Using JIT Debug Info Readers
35270 @kindex jit-reader-load
35271 @kindex jit-reader-unload
35273 Readers can be loaded and unloaded using the @code{jit-reader-load}
35274 and @code{jit-reader-unload} commands.
35277 @item jit-reader-load @var{reader}
35278 Load the JIT reader named @var{reader}. @var{reader} is a shared
35279 object specified as either an absolute or a relative file name. In
35280 the latter case, @value{GDBN} will try to load the reader from a
35281 pre-configured directory, usually @file{@var{libdir}/gdb/} on a UNIX
35282 system (here @var{libdir} is the system library directory, often
35283 @file{/usr/local/lib}).
35285 Only one reader can be active at a time; trying to load a second
35286 reader when one is already loaded will result in @value{GDBN}
35287 reporting an error. A new JIT reader can be loaded by first unloading
35288 the current one using @code{jit-reader-unload} and then invoking
35289 @code{jit-reader-load}.
35291 @item jit-reader-unload
35292 Unload the currently loaded JIT reader.
35296 @node Writing JIT Debug Info Readers
35297 @subsection Writing JIT Debug Info Readers
35298 @cindex writing JIT debug info readers
35300 As mentioned, a reader is essentially a shared object conforming to a
35301 certain ABI. This ABI is described in @file{jit-reader.h}.
35303 @file{jit-reader.h} defines the structures, macros and functions
35304 required to write a reader. It is installed (along with
35305 @value{GDBN}), in @file{@var{includedir}/gdb} where @var{includedir} is
35306 the system include directory.
35308 Readers need to be released under a GPL compatible license. A reader
35309 can be declared as released under such a license by placing the macro
35310 @code{GDB_DECLARE_GPL_COMPATIBLE_READER} in a source file.
35312 The entry point for readers is the symbol @code{gdb_init_reader},
35313 which is expected to be a function with the prototype
35315 @findex gdb_init_reader
35317 extern struct gdb_reader_funcs *gdb_init_reader (void);
35320 @cindex @code{struct gdb_reader_funcs}
35322 @code{struct gdb_reader_funcs} contains a set of pointers to callback
35323 functions. These functions are executed to read the debug info
35324 generated by the JIT compiler (@code{read}), to unwind stack frames
35325 (@code{unwind}) and to create canonical frame IDs
35326 (@code{get_Frame_id}). It also has a callback that is called when the
35327 reader is being unloaded (@code{destroy}). The struct looks like this
35330 struct gdb_reader_funcs
35332 /* Must be set to GDB_READER_INTERFACE_VERSION. */
35333 int reader_version;
35335 /* For use by the reader. */
35338 gdb_read_debug_info *read;
35339 gdb_unwind_frame *unwind;
35340 gdb_get_frame_id *get_frame_id;
35341 gdb_destroy_reader *destroy;
35345 @cindex @code{struct gdb_symbol_callbacks}
35346 @cindex @code{struct gdb_unwind_callbacks}
35348 The callbacks are provided with another set of callbacks by
35349 @value{GDBN} to do their job. For @code{read}, these callbacks are
35350 passed in a @code{struct gdb_symbol_callbacks} and for @code{unwind}
35351 and @code{get_frame_id}, in a @code{struct gdb_unwind_callbacks}.
35352 @code{struct gdb_symbol_callbacks} has callbacks to create new object
35353 files and new symbol tables inside those object files. @code{struct
35354 gdb_unwind_callbacks} has callbacks to read registers off the current
35355 frame and to write out the values of the registers in the previous
35356 frame. Both have a callback (@code{target_read}) to read bytes off the
35357 target's address space.
35359 @node In-Process Agent
35360 @chapter In-Process Agent
35361 @cindex debugging agent
35362 The traditional debugging model is conceptually low-speed, but works fine,
35363 because most bugs can be reproduced in debugging-mode execution. However,
35364 as multi-core or many-core processors are becoming mainstream, and
35365 multi-threaded programs become more and more popular, there should be more
35366 and more bugs that only manifest themselves at normal-mode execution, for
35367 example, thread races, because debugger's interference with the program's
35368 timing may conceal the bugs. On the other hand, in some applications,
35369 it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt the program's execution
35370 long enough for the developer to learn anything helpful about its behavior.
35371 If the program's correctness depends on its real-time behavior, delays
35372 introduced by a debugger might cause the program to fail, even when the
35373 code itself is correct. It is useful to be able to observe the program's
35374 behavior without interrupting it.
35376 Therefore, traditional debugging model is too intrusive to reproduce
35377 some bugs. In order to reduce the interference with the program, we can
35378 reduce the number of operations performed by debugger. The
35379 @dfn{In-Process Agent}, a shared library, is running within the same
35380 process with inferior, and is able to perform some debugging operations
35381 itself. As a result, debugger is only involved when necessary, and
35382 performance of debugging can be improved accordingly. Note that
35383 interference with program can be reduced but can't be removed completely,
35384 because the in-process agent will still stop or slow down the program.
35386 The in-process agent can interpret and execute Agent Expressions
35387 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}) during performing debugging operations. The
35388 agent expressions can be used for different purposes, such as collecting
35389 data in tracepoints, and condition evaluation in breakpoints.
35391 @anchor{Control Agent}
35392 You can control whether the in-process agent is used as an aid for
35393 debugging with the following commands:
35396 @kindex set agent on
35398 Causes the in-process agent to perform some operations on behalf of the
35399 debugger. Just which operations requested by the user will be done
35400 by the in-process agent depends on the its capabilities. For example,
35401 if you request to evaluate breakpoint conditions in the in-process agent,
35402 and the in-process agent has such capability as well, then breakpoint
35403 conditions will be evaluated in the in-process agent.
35405 @kindex set agent off
35406 @item set agent off
35407 Disables execution of debugging operations by the in-process agent. All
35408 of the operations will be performed by @value{GDBN}.
35412 Display the current setting of execution of debugging operations by
35413 the in-process agent.
35417 * In-Process Agent Protocol::
35420 @node In-Process Agent Protocol
35421 @section In-Process Agent Protocol
35422 @cindex in-process agent protocol
35424 The in-process agent is able to communicate with both @value{GDBN} and
35425 GDBserver (@pxref{In-Process Agent}). This section documents the protocol
35426 used for communications between @value{GDBN} or GDBserver and the IPA.
35427 In general, @value{GDBN} or GDBserver sends commands
35428 (@pxref{IPA Protocol Commands}) and data to in-process agent, and then
35429 in-process agent replies back with the return result of the command, or
35430 some other information. The data sent to in-process agent is composed
35431 of primitive data types, such as 4-byte or 8-byte type, and composite
35432 types, which are called objects (@pxref{IPA Protocol Objects}).
35435 * IPA Protocol Objects::
35436 * IPA Protocol Commands::
35439 @node IPA Protocol Objects
35440 @subsection IPA Protocol Objects
35441 @cindex ipa protocol objects
35443 The commands sent to and results received from agent may contain some
35444 complex data types called @dfn{objects}.
35446 The in-process agent is running on the same machine with @value{GDBN}
35447 or GDBserver, so it doesn't have to handle as much differences between
35448 two ends as remote protocol (@pxref{Remote Protocol}) tries to handle.
35449 However, there are still some differences of two ends in two processes:
35453 word size. On some 64-bit machines, @value{GDBN} or GDBserver can be
35454 compiled as a 64-bit executable, while in-process agent is a 32-bit one.
35456 ABI. Some machines may have multiple types of ABI, @value{GDBN} or
35457 GDBserver is compiled with one, and in-process agent is compiled with
35461 Here are the IPA Protocol Objects:
35465 agent expression object. It represents an agent expression
35466 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}).
35467 @anchor{agent expression object}
35469 tracepoint action object. It represents a tracepoint action
35470 (@pxref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}) to collect registers,
35471 memory, static trace data and to evaluate expression.
35472 @anchor{tracepoint action object}
35474 tracepoint object. It represents a tracepoint (@pxref{Tracepoints}).
35475 @anchor{tracepoint object}
35479 The following table describes important attributes of each IPA protocol
35482 @multitable @columnfractions .30 .20 .50
35483 @headitem Name @tab Size @tab Description
35484 @item @emph{agent expression object} @tab @tab
35485 @item length @tab 4 @tab length of bytes code
35486 @item byte code @tab @var{length} @tab contents of byte code
35487 @item @emph{tracepoint action for collecting memory} @tab @tab
35488 @item 'M' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
35489 @item addr @tab 8 @tab if @var{basereg} is @samp{-1}, @var{addr} is the
35490 address of the lowest byte to collect, otherwise @var{addr} is the offset
35491 of @var{basereg} for memory collecting.
35492 @item len @tab 8 @tab length of memory for collecting
35493 @item basereg @tab 4 @tab the register number containing the starting
35494 memory address for collecting.
35495 @item @emph{tracepoint action for collecting registers} @tab @tab
35496 @item 'R' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
35497 @item @emph{tracepoint action for collecting static trace data} @tab @tab
35498 @item 'L' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
35499 @item @emph{tracepoint action for expression evaluation} @tab @tab
35500 @item 'X' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
35501 @item agent expression @tab length of @tab @ref{agent expression object}
35502 @item @emph{tracepoint object} @tab @tab
35503 @item number @tab 4 @tab number of tracepoint
35504 @item address @tab 8 @tab address of tracepoint inserted on
35505 @item type @tab 4 @tab type of tracepoint
35506 @item enabled @tab 1 @tab enable or disable of tracepoint
35507 @item step_count @tab 8 @tab step
35508 @item pass_count @tab 8 @tab pass
35509 @item numactions @tab 4 @tab number of tracepoint actions
35510 @item hit count @tab 8 @tab hit count
35511 @item trace frame usage @tab 8 @tab trace frame usage
35512 @item compiled_cond @tab 8 @tab compiled condition
35513 @item orig_size @tab 8 @tab orig size
35514 @item condition @tab 4 if condition is NULL otherwise length of
35515 @ref{agent expression object}
35516 @tab zero if condition is NULL, otherwise is
35517 @ref{agent expression object}
35518 @item actions @tab variable
35519 @tab numactions number of @ref{tracepoint action object}
35522 @node IPA Protocol Commands
35523 @subsection IPA Protocol Commands
35524 @cindex ipa protocol commands
35526 The spaces in each command are delimiters to ease reading this commands
35527 specification. They don't exist in real commands.
35531 @item FastTrace:@var{tracepoint_object} @var{gdb_jump_pad_head}
35532 Installs a new fast tracepoint described by @var{tracepoint_object}
35533 (@pxref{tracepoint object}). @var{gdb_jump_pad_head}, 8-byte long, is the
35534 head of @dfn{jumppad}, which is used to jump to data collection routine
35539 @item OK @var{target_address} @var{gdb_jump_pad_head} @var{fjump_size} @var{fjump}
35540 @var{target_address} is address of tracepoint in the inferior.
35541 @var{gdb_jump_pad_head} is updated head of jumppad. Both of
35542 @var{target_address} and @var{gdb_jump_pad_head} are 8-byte long.
35543 @var{fjump} contains a sequence of instructions jump to jumppad entry.
35544 @var{fjump_size}, 4-byte long, is the size of @var{fjump}.
35551 Closes the in-process agent. This command is sent when @value{GDBN} or GDBserver
35552 is about to kill inferiors.
35560 @item probe_marker_at:@var{address}
35561 Asks in-process agent to probe the marker at @var{address}.
35568 @item unprobe_marker_at:@var{address}
35569 Asks in-process agent to unprobe the marker at @var{address}.
35573 @chapter Reporting Bugs in @value{GDBN}
35574 @cindex bugs in @value{GDBN}
35575 @cindex reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
35577 Your bug reports play an essential role in making @value{GDBN} reliable.
35579 Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or it
35580 may not. But in any case the principal function of a bug report is to help
35581 the entire community by making the next version of @value{GDBN} work better. Bug
35582 reports are your contribution to the maintenance of @value{GDBN}.
35584 In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the
35585 information that enables us to fix the bug.
35588 * Bug Criteria:: Have you found a bug?
35589 * Bug Reporting:: How to report bugs
35593 @section Have You Found a Bug?
35594 @cindex bug criteria
35596 If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines:
35599 @cindex fatal signal
35600 @cindex debugger crash
35601 @cindex crash of debugger
35603 If the debugger gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a
35604 @value{GDBN} bug. Reliable debuggers never crash.
35606 @cindex error on valid input
35608 If @value{GDBN} produces an error message for valid input, that is a
35609 bug. (Note that if you're cross debugging, the problem may also be
35610 somewhere in the connection to the target.)
35612 @cindex invalid input
35614 If @value{GDBN} does not produce an error message for invalid input,
35615 that is a bug. However, you should note that your idea of
35616 ``invalid input'' might be our idea of ``an extension'' or ``support
35617 for traditional practice''.
35620 If you are an experienced user of debugging tools, your suggestions
35621 for improvement of @value{GDBN} are welcome in any case.
35624 @node Bug Reporting
35625 @section How to Report Bugs
35626 @cindex bug reports
35627 @cindex @value{GDBN} bugs, reporting
35629 A number of companies and individuals offer support for @sc{gnu} products.
35630 If you obtained @value{GDBN} from a support organization, we recommend you
35631 contact that organization first.
35633 You can find contact information for many support companies and
35634 individuals in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the @sc{gnu} Emacs
35636 @c should add a web page ref...
35639 @ifset BUGURL_DEFAULT
35640 In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
35641 @value{GDBN}. The preferred method is to submit them directly using
35642 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gdb/bugs/, @value{GDBN}'s Bugs web
35643 page}. Alternatively, the @email{bug-gdb@@gnu.org, e-mail gateway} can
35646 @strong{Do not send bug reports to @samp{info-gdb}, or to
35647 @samp{help-gdb}, or to any newsgroups.} Most users of @value{GDBN} do
35648 not want to receive bug reports. Those that do have arranged to receive
35651 The mailing list @samp{bug-gdb} has a newsgroup @samp{gnu.gdb.bug} which
35652 serves as a repeater. The mailing list and the newsgroup carry exactly
35653 the same messages. Often people think of posting bug reports to the
35654 newsgroup instead of mailing them. This appears to work, but it has one
35655 problem which can be crucial: a newsgroup posting often lacks a mail
35656 path back to the sender. Thus, if we need to ask for more information,
35657 we may be unable to reach you. For this reason, it is better to send
35658 bug reports to the mailing list.
35660 @ifclear BUGURL_DEFAULT
35661 In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
35662 @value{GDBN} to @value{BUGURL}.
35666 The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this:
35667 @strong{report all the facts}. If you are not sure whether to state a
35668 fact or leave it out, state it!
35670 Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the
35671 problem and assume that some details do not matter. Thus, you might
35672 assume that the name of the variable you use in an example does not matter.
35673 Well, probably it does not, but one cannot be sure. Perhaps the bug is a
35674 stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the location where that
35675 name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name were different, the contents
35676 of that location would fool the debugger into doing the right thing despite
35677 the bug. Play it safe and give a specific, complete example. That is the
35678 easiest thing for you to do, and the most helpful.
35680 Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix the
35681 bug. It may be that the bug has been reported previously, but neither
35682 you nor we can know that unless your bug report is complete and
35685 Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a
35686 bell?'' Those bug reports are useless, and we urge everyone to
35687 @emph{refuse to respond to them} except to chide the sender to report
35690 To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things:
35694 The version of @value{GDBN}. @value{GDBN} announces it if you start
35695 with no arguments; you can also print it at any time using @code{show
35698 Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for
35699 the bug in the current version of @value{GDBN}.
35702 The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and
35706 The details of the @value{GDBN} build-time configuration.
35707 @value{GDBN} shows these details if you invoke it with the
35708 @option{--configuration} command-line option, or if you type
35709 @code{show configuration} at @value{GDBN}'s prompt.
35712 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile @value{GDBN}---e.g.@:
35713 ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1''.
35716 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile the program you are
35717 debugging---e.g.@: ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1'', or ``HP92453-01 A.10.32.03 HP
35718 C Compiler''. For @value{NGCC}, you can say @kbd{@value{GCC} --version}
35719 to get this information; for other compilers, see the documentation for
35723 The command arguments you gave the compiler to compile your example and
35724 observe the bug. For example, did you use @samp{-O}? To guarantee
35725 you will not omit something important, list them all. A copy of the
35726 Makefile (or the output from make) is sufficient.
35728 If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong
35729 and then we might not encounter the bug.
35732 A complete input script, and all necessary source files, that will
35736 A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is
35737 incorrect. For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.''
35739 Of course, if the bug is that @value{GDBN} gets a fatal signal, then we
35740 will certainly notice it. But if the bug is incorrect output, we might
35741 not notice unless it is glaringly wrong. You might as well not give us
35742 a chance to make a mistake.
35744 Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still
35745 say so explicitly. Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your
35746 copy of @value{GDBN} is out of synch, or you have encountered a bug in
35747 the C library on your system. (This has happened!) Your copy might
35748 crash and ours would not. If you told us to expect a crash, then when
35749 ours fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not happening for
35750 us. If you had not told us to expect a crash, then we would not be able
35751 to draw any conclusion from our observations.
35754 @cindex recording a session script
35755 To collect all this information, you can use a session recording program
35756 such as @command{script}, which is available on many Unix systems.
35757 Just run your @value{GDBN} session inside @command{script} and then
35758 include the @file{typescript} file with your bug report.
35760 Another way to record a @value{GDBN} session is to run @value{GDBN}
35761 inside Emacs and then save the entire buffer to a file.
35764 If you wish to suggest changes to the @value{GDBN} source, send us context
35765 diffs. If you even discuss something in the @value{GDBN} source, refer to
35766 it by context, not by line number.
35768 The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your
35769 sources. Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us.
35773 Here are some things that are not necessary:
35777 A description of the envelope of the bug.
35779 Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating
35780 which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which
35781 changes will not affect it.
35783 This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we
35784 will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger
35785 with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples.
35786 We recommend that you save your time for something else.
35788 Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead}
35789 of the original one, that is a convenience for us. Errors in the
35790 output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take
35791 less time, and so on.
35793 However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do this,
35794 report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used.
35797 A patch for the bug.
35799 A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one. But do not omit
35800 the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that
35801 a patch is all we need. We might see problems with your patch and decide
35802 to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all.
35804 Sometimes with a program as complicated as @value{GDBN} it is very hard to
35805 construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path
35806 through the code. If you do not send us the example, we will not be able
35807 to construct one, so we will not be able to verify that the bug is fixed.
35809 And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your
35810 patch should be an improvement, we will not install it. A test case will
35811 help us to understand.
35814 A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on.
35816 Such guesses are usually wrong. Even we cannot guess right about such
35817 things without first using the debugger to find the facts.
35820 @c The readline documentation is distributed with the readline code
35821 @c and consists of the two following files:
35824 @c Use -I with makeinfo to point to the appropriate directory,
35825 @c environment var TEXINPUTS with TeX.
35826 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
35827 @include rluser.texi
35828 @include hsuser.texi
35832 @appendix In Memoriam
35834 The @value{GDBN} project mourns the loss of the following long-time
35839 Fred was a long-standing contributor to @value{GDBN} (1991-2006), and
35840 to Free Software in general. Outside of @value{GDBN}, he was known in
35841 the Amiga world for his series of Fish Disks, and the GeekGadget project.
35843 @item Michael Snyder
35844 Michael was one of the Global Maintainers of the @value{GDBN} project,
35845 with contributions recorded as early as 1996, until 2011. In addition
35846 to his day to day participation, he was a large driving force behind
35847 adding Reverse Debugging to @value{GDBN}.
35850 Beyond their technical contributions to the project, they were also
35851 enjoyable members of the Free Software Community. We will miss them.
35853 @node Formatting Documentation
35854 @appendix Formatting Documentation
35856 @cindex @value{GDBN} reference card
35857 @cindex reference card
35858 The @value{GDBN} 4 release includes an already-formatted reference card, ready
35859 for printing with PostScript or Ghostscript, in the @file{gdb}
35860 subdirectory of the main source directory@footnote{In
35861 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/refcard.ps} of the version @value{GDBVN}
35862 release.}. If you can use PostScript or Ghostscript with your printer,
35863 you can print the reference card immediately with @file{refcard.ps}.
35865 The release also includes the source for the reference card. You
35866 can format it, using @TeX{}, by typing:
35872 The @value{GDBN} reference card is designed to print in @dfn{landscape}
35873 mode on US ``letter'' size paper;
35874 that is, on a sheet 11 inches wide by 8.5 inches
35875 high. You will need to specify this form of printing as an option to
35876 your @sc{dvi} output program.
35878 @cindex documentation
35880 All the documentation for @value{GDBN} comes as part of the machine-readable
35881 distribution. The documentation is written in Texinfo format, which is
35882 a documentation system that uses a single source file to produce both
35883 on-line information and a printed manual. You can use one of the Info
35884 formatting commands to create the on-line version of the documentation
35885 and @TeX{} (or @code{texi2roff}) to typeset the printed version.
35887 @value{GDBN} includes an already formatted copy of the on-line Info
35888 version of this manual in the @file{gdb} subdirectory. The main Info
35889 file is @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/gdb.info}, and it refers to
35890 subordinate files matching @samp{gdb.info*} in the same directory. If
35891 necessary, you can print out these files, or read them with any editor;
35892 but they are easier to read using the @code{info} subsystem in @sc{gnu}
35893 Emacs or the standalone @code{info} program, available as part of the
35894 @sc{gnu} Texinfo distribution.
35896 If you want to format these Info files yourself, you need one of the
35897 Info formatting programs, such as @code{texinfo-format-buffer} or
35900 If you have @code{makeinfo} installed, and are in the top level
35901 @value{GDBN} source directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, in the case of
35902 version @value{GDBVN}), you can make the Info file by typing:
35909 If you want to typeset and print copies of this manual, you need @TeX{},
35910 a program to print its @sc{dvi} output files, and @file{texinfo.tex}, the
35911 Texinfo definitions file.
35913 @TeX{} is a typesetting program; it does not print files directly, but
35914 produces output files called @sc{dvi} files. To print a typeset
35915 document, you need a program to print @sc{dvi} files. If your system
35916 has @TeX{} installed, chances are it has such a program. The precise
35917 command to use depends on your system; @kbd{lpr -d} is common; another
35918 (for PostScript devices) is @kbd{dvips}. The @sc{dvi} print command may
35919 require a file name without any extension or a @samp{.dvi} extension.
35921 @TeX{} also requires a macro definitions file called
35922 @file{texinfo.tex}. This file tells @TeX{} how to typeset a document
35923 written in Texinfo format. On its own, @TeX{} cannot either read or
35924 typeset a Texinfo file. @file{texinfo.tex} is distributed with GDB
35925 and is located in the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}/texinfo}
35928 If you have @TeX{} and a @sc{dvi} printer program installed, you can
35929 typeset and print this manual. First switch to the @file{gdb}
35930 subdirectory of the main source directory (for example, to
35931 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb}) and type:
35937 Then give @file{gdb.dvi} to your @sc{dvi} printing program.
35939 @node Installing GDB
35940 @appendix Installing @value{GDBN}
35941 @cindex installation
35944 * Requirements:: Requirements for building @value{GDBN}
35945 * Running Configure:: Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} script
35946 * Separate Objdir:: Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
35947 * Config Names:: Specifying names for hosts and targets
35948 * Configure Options:: Summary of options for configure
35949 * System-wide configuration:: Having a system-wide init file
35953 @section Requirements for Building @value{GDBN}
35954 @cindex building @value{GDBN}, requirements for
35956 Building @value{GDBN} requires various tools and packages to be available.
35957 Other packages will be used only if they are found.
35959 @heading Tools/Packages Necessary for Building @value{GDBN}
35961 @item ISO C90 compiler
35962 @value{GDBN} is written in ISO C90. It should be buildable with any
35963 working C90 compiler, e.g.@: GCC.
35967 @heading Tools/Packages Optional for Building @value{GDBN}
35971 @value{GDBN} can use the Expat XML parsing library. This library may be
35972 included with your operating system distribution; if it is not, you
35973 can get the latest version from @url{http://expat.sourceforge.net}.
35974 The @file{configure} script will search for this library in several
35975 standard locations; if it is installed in an unusual path, you can
35976 use the @option{--with-libexpat-prefix} option to specify its location.
35982 Remote protocol memory maps (@pxref{Memory Map Format})
35984 Target descriptions (@pxref{Target Descriptions})
35986 Remote shared library lists (@xref{Library List Format},
35987 or alternatively @pxref{Library List Format for SVR4 Targets})
35989 MS-Windows shared libraries (@pxref{Shared Libraries})
35991 Traceframe info (@pxref{Traceframe Info Format})
35993 Branch trace (@pxref{Branch Trace Format})
35997 @cindex compressed debug sections
35998 @value{GDBN} will use the @samp{zlib} library, if available, to read
35999 compressed debug sections. Some linkers, such as GNU gold, are capable
36000 of producing binaries with compressed debug sections. If @value{GDBN}
36001 is compiled with @samp{zlib}, it will be able to read the debug
36002 information in such binaries.
36004 The @samp{zlib} library is likely included with your operating system
36005 distribution; if it is not, you can get the latest version from
36006 @url{http://zlib.net}.
36009 @value{GDBN}'s features related to character sets (@pxref{Character
36010 Sets}) require a functioning @code{iconv} implementation. If you are
36011 on a GNU system, then this is provided by the GNU C Library. Some
36012 other systems also provide a working @code{iconv}.
36014 If @value{GDBN} is using the @code{iconv} program which is installed
36015 in a non-standard place, you will need to tell @value{GDBN} where to find it.
36016 This is done with @option{--with-iconv-bin} which specifies the
36017 directory that contains the @code{iconv} program.
36019 On systems without @code{iconv}, you can install GNU Libiconv. If you
36020 have previously installed Libiconv, you can use the
36021 @option{--with-libiconv-prefix} option to configure.
36023 @value{GDBN}'s top-level @file{configure} and @file{Makefile} will
36024 arrange to build Libiconv if a directory named @file{libiconv} appears
36025 in the top-most source directory. If Libiconv is built this way, and
36026 if the operating system does not provide a suitable @code{iconv}
36027 implementation, then the just-built library will automatically be used
36028 by @value{GDBN}. One easy way to set this up is to download GNU
36029 Libiconv, unpack it, and then rename the directory holding the
36030 Libiconv source code to @samp{libiconv}.
36033 @node Running Configure
36034 @section Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} Script
36035 @cindex configuring @value{GDBN}
36036 @value{GDBN} comes with a @file{configure} script that automates the process
36037 of preparing @value{GDBN} for installation; you can then use @code{make} to
36038 build the @code{gdb} program.
36040 @c irrelevant in info file; it's as current as the code it lives with.
36041 @footnote{If you have a more recent version of @value{GDBN} than @value{GDBVN},
36042 look at the @file{README} file in the sources; we may have improved the
36043 installation procedures since publishing this manual.}
36046 The @value{GDBN} distribution includes all the source code you need for
36047 @value{GDBN} in a single directory, whose name is usually composed by
36048 appending the version number to @samp{gdb}.
36050 For example, the @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN} distribution is in the
36051 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory. That directory contains:
36054 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure @r{(and supporting files)}
36055 script for configuring @value{GDBN} and all its supporting libraries
36057 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb
36058 the source specific to @value{GDBN} itself
36060 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/bfd
36061 source for the Binary File Descriptor library
36063 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/include
36064 @sc{gnu} include files
36066 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/libiberty
36067 source for the @samp{-liberty} free software library
36069 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/opcodes
36070 source for the library of opcode tables and disassemblers
36072 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/readline
36073 source for the @sc{gnu} command-line interface
36075 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/glob
36076 source for the @sc{gnu} filename pattern-matching subroutine
36078 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/mmalloc
36079 source for the @sc{gnu} memory-mapped malloc package
36082 The simplest way to configure and build @value{GDBN} is to run @file{configure}
36083 from the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory, which in
36084 this example is the @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory.
36086 First switch to the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory
36087 if you are not already in it; then run @file{configure}. Pass the
36088 identifier for the platform on which @value{GDBN} will run as an
36094 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
36095 ./configure @var{host}
36100 where @var{host} is an identifier such as @samp{sun4} or
36101 @samp{decstation}, that identifies the platform where @value{GDBN} will run.
36102 (You can often leave off @var{host}; @file{configure} tries to guess the
36103 correct value by examining your system.)
36105 Running @samp{configure @var{host}} and then running @code{make} builds the
36106 @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, @file{mmalloc}, and @file{libiberty}
36107 libraries, then @code{gdb} itself. The configured source files, and the
36108 binaries, are left in the corresponding source directories.
36111 @file{configure} is a Bourne-shell (@code{/bin/sh}) script; if your
36112 system does not recognize this automatically when you run a different
36113 shell, you may need to run @code{sh} on it explicitly:
36116 sh configure @var{host}
36119 If you run @file{configure} from a directory that contains source
36120 directories for multiple libraries or programs, such as the
36121 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} source directory for version @value{GDBVN},
36123 creates configuration files for every directory level underneath (unless
36124 you tell it not to, with the @samp{--norecursion} option).
36126 You should run the @file{configure} script from the top directory in the
36127 source tree, the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory. If you run
36128 @file{configure} from one of the subdirectories, you will configure only
36129 that subdirectory. That is usually not what you want. In particular,
36130 if you run the first @file{configure} from the @file{gdb} subdirectory
36131 of the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory, you will omit the
36132 configuration of @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, and other sibling
36133 directories of the @file{gdb} subdirectory. This leads to build errors
36134 about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
36136 You can install @code{@value{GDBP}} anywhere; it has no hardwired paths.
36137 However, you should make sure that the shell on your path (named by
36138 the @samp{SHELL} environment variable) is publicly readable. Remember
36139 that @value{GDBN} uses the shell to start your program---some systems refuse to
36140 let @value{GDBN} debug child processes whose programs are not readable.
36142 @node Separate Objdir
36143 @section Compiling @value{GDBN} in Another Directory
36145 If you want to run @value{GDBN} versions for several host or target machines,
36146 you need a different @code{gdb} compiled for each combination of
36147 host and target. @file{configure} is designed to make this easy by
36148 allowing you to generate each configuration in a separate subdirectory,
36149 rather than in the source directory. If your @code{make} program
36150 handles the @samp{VPATH} feature (@sc{gnu} @code{make} does), running
36151 @code{make} in each of these directories builds the @code{gdb}
36152 program specified there.
36154 To build @code{gdb} in a separate directory, run @file{configure}
36155 with the @samp{--srcdir} option to specify where to find the source.
36156 (You also need to specify a path to find @file{configure}
36157 itself from your working directory. If the path to @file{configure}
36158 would be the same as the argument to @samp{--srcdir}, you can leave out
36159 the @samp{--srcdir} option; it is assumed.)
36161 For example, with version @value{GDBVN}, you can build @value{GDBN} in a
36162 separate directory for a Sun 4 like this:
36166 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
36169 ../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure sun4
36174 When @file{configure} builds a configuration using a remote source
36175 directory, it creates a tree for the binaries with the same structure
36176 (and using the same names) as the tree under the source directory. In
36177 the example, you'd find the Sun 4 library @file{libiberty.a} in the
36178 directory @file{gdb-sun4/libiberty}, and @value{GDBN} itself in
36179 @file{gdb-sun4/gdb}.
36181 Make sure that your path to the @file{configure} script has just one
36182 instance of @file{gdb} in it. If your path to @file{configure} looks
36183 like @file{../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/configure}, you are configuring only
36184 one subdirectory of @value{GDBN}, not the whole package. This leads to
36185 build errors about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
36187 One popular reason to build several @value{GDBN} configurations in separate
36188 directories is to configure @value{GDBN} for cross-compiling (where
36189 @value{GDBN} runs on one machine---the @dfn{host}---while debugging
36190 programs that run on another machine---the @dfn{target}).
36191 You specify a cross-debugging target by
36192 giving the @samp{--target=@var{target}} option to @file{configure}.
36194 When you run @code{make} to build a program or library, you must run
36195 it in a configured directory---whatever directory you were in when you
36196 called @file{configure} (or one of its subdirectories).
36198 The @code{Makefile} that @file{configure} generates in each source
36199 directory also runs recursively. If you type @code{make} in a source
36200 directory such as @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} (or in a separate configured
36201 directory configured with @samp{--srcdir=@var{dirname}/gdb-@value{GDBVN}}), you
36202 will build all the required libraries, and then build GDB.
36204 When you have multiple hosts or targets configured in separate
36205 directories, you can run @code{make} on them in parallel (for example,
36206 if they are NFS-mounted on each of the hosts); they will not interfere
36210 @section Specifying Names for Hosts and Targets
36212 The specifications used for hosts and targets in the @file{configure}
36213 script are based on a three-part naming scheme, but some short predefined
36214 aliases are also supported. The full naming scheme encodes three pieces
36215 of information in the following pattern:
36218 @var{architecture}-@var{vendor}-@var{os}
36221 For example, you can use the alias @code{sun4} as a @var{host} argument,
36222 or as the value for @var{target} in a @code{--target=@var{target}}
36223 option. The equivalent full name is @samp{sparc-sun-sunos4}.
36225 The @file{configure} script accompanying @value{GDBN} does not provide
36226 any query facility to list all supported host and target names or
36227 aliases. @file{configure} calls the Bourne shell script
36228 @code{config.sub} to map abbreviations to full names; you can read the
36229 script, if you wish, or you can use it to test your guesses on
36230 abbreviations---for example:
36233 % sh config.sub i386-linux
36235 % sh config.sub alpha-linux
36236 alpha-unknown-linux-gnu
36237 % sh config.sub hp9k700
36239 % sh config.sub sun4
36240 sparc-sun-sunos4.1.1
36241 % sh config.sub sun3
36242 m68k-sun-sunos4.1.1
36243 % sh config.sub i986v
36244 Invalid configuration `i986v': machine `i986v' not recognized
36248 @code{config.sub} is also distributed in the @value{GDBN} source
36249 directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, for version @value{GDBVN}).
36251 @node Configure Options
36252 @section @file{configure} Options
36254 Here is a summary of the @file{configure} options and arguments that
36255 are most often useful for building @value{GDBN}. @file{configure} also has
36256 several other options not listed here. @inforef{What Configure
36257 Does,,configure.info}, for a full explanation of @file{configure}.
36260 configure @r{[}--help@r{]}
36261 @r{[}--prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
36262 @r{[}--exec-prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
36263 @r{[}--srcdir=@var{dirname}@r{]}
36264 @r{[}--norecursion@r{]} @r{[}--rm@r{]}
36265 @r{[}--target=@var{target}@r{]}
36270 You may introduce options with a single @samp{-} rather than
36271 @samp{--} if you prefer; but you may abbreviate option names if you use
36276 Display a quick summary of how to invoke @file{configure}.
36278 @item --prefix=@var{dir}
36279 Configure the source to install programs and files under directory
36282 @item --exec-prefix=@var{dir}
36283 Configure the source to install programs under directory
36286 @c avoid splitting the warning from the explanation:
36288 @item --srcdir=@var{dirname}
36289 @strong{Warning: using this option requires @sc{gnu} @code{make}, or another
36290 @code{make} that implements the @code{VPATH} feature.}@*
36291 Use this option to make configurations in directories separate from the
36292 @value{GDBN} source directories. Among other things, you can use this to
36293 build (or maintain) several configurations simultaneously, in separate
36294 directories. @file{configure} writes configuration-specific files in
36295 the current directory, but arranges for them to use the source in the
36296 directory @var{dirname}. @file{configure} creates directories under
36297 the working directory in parallel to the source directories below
36300 @item --norecursion
36301 Configure only the directory level where @file{configure} is executed; do not
36302 propagate configuration to subdirectories.
36304 @item --target=@var{target}
36305 Configure @value{GDBN} for cross-debugging programs running on the specified
36306 @var{target}. Without this option, @value{GDBN} is configured to debug
36307 programs that run on the same machine (@var{host}) as @value{GDBN} itself.
36309 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available targets.
36311 @item @var{host} @dots{}
36312 Configure @value{GDBN} to run on the specified @var{host}.
36314 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available hosts.
36317 There are many other options available as well, but they are generally
36318 needed for special purposes only.
36320 @node System-wide configuration
36321 @section System-wide configuration and settings
36322 @cindex system-wide init file
36324 @value{GDBN} can be configured to have a system-wide init file;
36325 this file will be read and executed at startup (@pxref{Startup, , What
36326 @value{GDBN} does during startup}).
36328 Here is the corresponding configure option:
36331 @item --with-system-gdbinit=@var{file}
36332 Specify that the default location of the system-wide init file is
36336 If @value{GDBN} has been configured with the option @option{--prefix=$prefix},
36337 it may be subject to relocation. Two possible cases:
36341 If the default location of this init file contains @file{$prefix},
36342 it will be subject to relocation. Suppose that the configure options
36343 are @option{--prefix=$prefix --with-system-gdbinit=$prefix/etc/gdbinit};
36344 if @value{GDBN} is moved from @file{$prefix} to @file{$install}, the system
36345 init file is looked for as @file{$install/etc/gdbinit} instead of
36346 @file{$prefix/etc/gdbinit}.
36349 By contrast, if the default location does not contain the prefix,
36350 it will not be relocated. E.g.@: if @value{GDBN} has been configured with
36351 @option{--prefix=/usr/local --with-system-gdbinit=/usr/share/gdb/gdbinit},
36352 then @value{GDBN} will always look for @file{/usr/share/gdb/gdbinit},
36353 wherever @value{GDBN} is installed.
36356 If the configured location of the system-wide init file (as given by the
36357 @option{--with-system-gdbinit} option at configure time) is in the
36358 data-directory (as specified by @option{--with-gdb-datadir} at configure
36359 time) or in one of its subdirectories, then @value{GDBN} will look for the
36360 system-wide init file in the directory specified by the
36361 @option{--data-directory} command-line option.
36362 Note that the system-wide init file is only read once, during @value{GDBN}
36363 initialization. If the data-directory is changed after @value{GDBN} has
36364 started with the @code{set data-directory} command, the file will not be
36367 @node Installed System-wide Configuration Scripts
36368 @subsection Installed System-wide Configuration Scripts
36369 @cindex system-wide configuration scripts
36371 The @file{system-gdbinit} directory, located inside the data-directory
36372 (as specified by @option{--with-gdb-datadir} at configure time) contains
36373 a number of scripts which can be used as system-wide init files. To
36374 automatically source those scripts at startup, @value{GDBN} should be
36375 configured with @option{--with-system-gdbinit}. Otherwise, any user
36376 should be able to source them by hand as needed.
36378 The following scripts are currently available:
36381 @item @file{elinos.py}
36383 @cindex ELinOS system-wide configuration script
36384 This script is useful when debugging a program on an ELinOS target.
36385 It takes advantage of the environment variables defined in a standard
36386 ELinOS environment in order to determine the location of the system
36387 shared libraries, and then sets the @samp{solib-absolute-prefix}
36388 and @samp{solib-search-path} variables appropriately.
36390 @item @file{wrs-linux.py}
36391 @pindex wrs-linux.py
36392 @cindex Wind River Linux system-wide configuration script
36393 This script is useful when debugging a program on a target running
36394 Wind River Linux. It expects the @env{ENV_PREFIX} to be set to
36395 the host-side sysroot used by the target system.
36399 @node Maintenance Commands
36400 @appendix Maintenance Commands
36401 @cindex maintenance commands
36402 @cindex internal commands
36404 In addition to commands intended for @value{GDBN} users, @value{GDBN}
36405 includes a number of commands intended for @value{GDBN} developers,
36406 that are not documented elsewhere in this manual. These commands are
36407 provided here for reference. (For commands that turn on debugging
36408 messages, see @ref{Debugging Output}.)
36411 @kindex maint agent
36412 @kindex maint agent-eval
36413 @item maint agent @r{[}-at @var{location}@r{,}@r{]} @var{expression}
36414 @itemx maint agent-eval @r{[}-at @var{location}@r{,}@r{]} @var{expression}
36415 Translate the given @var{expression} into remote agent bytecodes.
36416 This command is useful for debugging the Agent Expression mechanism
36417 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}). The @samp{agent} version produces an
36418 expression useful for data collection, such as by tracepoints, while
36419 @samp{maint agent-eval} produces an expression that evaluates directly
36420 to a result. For instance, a collection expression for @code{globa +
36421 globb} will include bytecodes to record four bytes of memory at each
36422 of the addresses of @code{globa} and @code{globb}, while discarding
36423 the result of the addition, while an evaluation expression will do the
36424 addition and return the sum.
36425 If @code{-at} is given, generate remote agent bytecode for @var{location}.
36426 If not, generate remote agent bytecode for current frame PC address.
36428 @kindex maint agent-printf
36429 @item maint agent-printf @var{format},@var{expr},...
36430 Translate the given format string and list of argument expressions
36431 into remote agent bytecodes and display them as a disassembled list.
36432 This command is useful for debugging the agent version of dynamic
36433 printf (@pxref{Dynamic Printf}).
36435 @kindex maint info breakpoints
36436 @item @anchor{maint info breakpoints}maint info breakpoints
36437 Using the same format as @samp{info breakpoints}, display both the
36438 breakpoints you've set explicitly, and those @value{GDBN} is using for
36439 internal purposes. Internal breakpoints are shown with negative
36440 breakpoint numbers. The type column identifies what kind of breakpoint
36445 Normal, explicitly set breakpoint.
36448 Normal, explicitly set watchpoint.
36451 Internal breakpoint, used to handle correctly stepping through
36452 @code{longjmp} calls.
36454 @item longjmp resume
36455 Internal breakpoint at the target of a @code{longjmp}.
36458 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{until} command.
36461 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{finish} command.
36464 Shared library events.
36468 @kindex maint info bfds
36469 @item maint info bfds
36470 This prints information about each @code{bfd} object that is known to
36471 @value{GDBN}. @xref{Top, , BFD, bfd, The Binary File Descriptor Library}.
36473 @kindex set displaced-stepping
36474 @kindex show displaced-stepping
36475 @cindex displaced stepping support
36476 @cindex out-of-line single-stepping
36477 @item set displaced-stepping
36478 @itemx show displaced-stepping
36479 Control whether or not @value{GDBN} will do @dfn{displaced stepping}
36480 if the target supports it. Displaced stepping is a way to single-step
36481 over breakpoints without removing them from the inferior, by executing
36482 an out-of-line copy of the instruction that was originally at the
36483 breakpoint location. It is also known as out-of-line single-stepping.
36486 @item set displaced-stepping on
36487 If the target architecture supports it, @value{GDBN} will use
36488 displaced stepping to step over breakpoints.
36490 @item set displaced-stepping off
36491 @value{GDBN} will not use displaced stepping to step over breakpoints,
36492 even if such is supported by the target architecture.
36494 @cindex non-stop mode, and @samp{set displaced-stepping}
36495 @item set displaced-stepping auto
36496 This is the default mode. @value{GDBN} will use displaced stepping
36497 only if non-stop mode is active (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) and the target
36498 architecture supports displaced stepping.
36501 @kindex maint check-psymtabs
36502 @item maint check-psymtabs
36503 Check the consistency of currently expanded psymtabs versus symtabs.
36504 Use this to check, for example, whether a symbol is in one but not the other.
36506 @kindex maint check-symtabs
36507 @item maint check-symtabs
36508 Check the consistency of currently expanded symtabs.
36510 @kindex maint expand-symtabs
36511 @item maint expand-symtabs [@var{regexp}]
36512 Expand symbol tables.
36513 If @var{regexp} is specified, only expand symbol tables for file
36514 names matching @var{regexp}.
36516 @kindex maint cplus first_component
36517 @item maint cplus first_component @var{name}
36518 Print the first C@t{++} class/namespace component of @var{name}.
36520 @kindex maint cplus namespace
36521 @item maint cplus namespace
36522 Print the list of possible C@t{++} namespaces.
36524 @kindex maint demangle
36525 @item maint demangle @var{name}
36526 Demangle a C@t{++} or Objective-C mangled @var{name}.
36528 @kindex maint deprecate
36529 @kindex maint undeprecate
36530 @cindex deprecated commands
36531 @item maint deprecate @var{command} @r{[}@var{replacement}@r{]}
36532 @itemx maint undeprecate @var{command}
36533 Deprecate or undeprecate the named @var{command}. Deprecated commands
36534 cause @value{GDBN} to issue a warning when you use them. The optional
36535 argument @var{replacement} says which newer command should be used in
36536 favor of the deprecated one; if it is given, @value{GDBN} will mention
36537 the replacement as part of the warning.
36539 @kindex maint dump-me
36540 @item maint dump-me
36541 @cindex @code{SIGQUIT} signal, dump core of @value{GDBN}
36542 Cause a fatal signal in the debugger and force it to dump its core.
36543 This is supported only on systems which support aborting a program
36544 with the @code{SIGQUIT} signal.
36546 @kindex maint internal-error
36547 @kindex maint internal-warning
36548 @item maint internal-error @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
36549 @itemx maint internal-warning @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
36550 Cause @value{GDBN} to call the internal function @code{internal_error}
36551 or @code{internal_warning} and hence behave as though an internal error
36552 or internal warning has been detected. In addition to reporting the
36553 internal problem, these functions give the user the opportunity to
36554 either quit @value{GDBN} or create a core file of the current
36555 @value{GDBN} session.
36557 These commands take an optional parameter @var{message-text} that is
36558 used as the text of the error or warning message.
36560 Here's an example of using @code{internal-error}:
36563 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint internal-error testing, 1, 2}
36564 @dots{}/maint.c:121: internal-error: testing, 1, 2
36565 A problem internal to GDB has been detected. Further
36566 debugging may prove unreliable.
36567 Quit this debugging session? (y or n) @kbd{n}
36568 Create a core file? (y or n) @kbd{n}
36572 @cindex @value{GDBN} internal error
36573 @cindex internal errors, control of @value{GDBN} behavior
36575 @kindex maint set internal-error
36576 @kindex maint show internal-error
36577 @kindex maint set internal-warning
36578 @kindex maint show internal-warning
36579 @item maint set internal-error @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
36580 @itemx maint show internal-error @var{action}
36581 @itemx maint set internal-warning @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
36582 @itemx maint show internal-warning @var{action}
36583 When @value{GDBN} reports an internal problem (error or warning) it
36584 gives the user the opportunity to both quit @value{GDBN} and create a
36585 core file of the current @value{GDBN} session. These commands let you
36586 override the default behaviour for each particular @var{action},
36587 described in the table below.
36591 You can specify that @value{GDBN} should always (yes) or never (no)
36592 quit. The default is to ask the user what to do.
36595 You can specify that @value{GDBN} should always (yes) or never (no)
36596 create a core file. The default is to ask the user what to do.
36599 @kindex maint packet
36600 @item maint packet @var{text}
36601 If @value{GDBN} is talking to an inferior via the serial protocol,
36602 then this command sends the string @var{text} to the inferior, and
36603 displays the response packet. @value{GDBN} supplies the initial
36604 @samp{$} character, the terminating @samp{#} character, and the
36607 @kindex maint print architecture
36608 @item maint print architecture @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
36609 Print the entire architecture configuration. The optional argument
36610 @var{file} names the file where the output goes.
36612 @kindex maint print c-tdesc
36613 @item maint print c-tdesc
36614 Print the current target description (@pxref{Target Descriptions}) as
36615 a C source file. The created source file can be used in @value{GDBN}
36616 when an XML parser is not available to parse the description.
36618 @kindex maint print dummy-frames
36619 @item maint print dummy-frames
36620 Prints the contents of @value{GDBN}'s internal dummy-frame stack.
36623 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{b add}
36625 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{print add(2,3)}
36626 Breakpoint 2, add (a=2, b=3) at @dots{}
36628 The program being debugged stopped while in a function called from GDB.
36630 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print dummy-frames}
36631 0x1a57c80: pc=0x01014068 fp=0x0200bddc sp=0x0200bdd6
36632 top=0x0200bdd4 id=@{stack=0x200bddc,code=0x101405c@}
36633 call_lo=0x01014000 call_hi=0x01014001
36637 Takes an optional file parameter.
36639 @kindex maint print registers
36640 @kindex maint print raw-registers
36641 @kindex maint print cooked-registers
36642 @kindex maint print register-groups
36643 @kindex maint print remote-registers
36644 @item maint print registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
36645 @itemx maint print raw-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
36646 @itemx maint print cooked-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
36647 @itemx maint print register-groups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
36648 @itemx maint print remote-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
36649 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register data structures.
36651 The command @code{maint print raw-registers} includes the contents of
36652 the raw register cache; the command @code{maint print
36653 cooked-registers} includes the (cooked) value of all registers,
36654 including registers which aren't available on the target nor visible
36655 to user; the command @code{maint print register-groups} includes the
36656 groups that each register is a member of; and the command @code{maint
36657 print remote-registers} includes the remote target's register numbers
36658 and offsets in the `G' packets. @xref{Registers,, Registers, gdbint,
36659 @value{GDBN} Internals}.
36661 These commands take an optional parameter, a file name to which to
36662 write the information.
36664 @kindex maint print reggroups
36665 @item maint print reggroups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
36666 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register group data structures. The
36667 optional argument @var{file} tells to what file to write the
36670 The register groups info looks like this:
36673 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print reggroups}
36686 This command forces @value{GDBN} to flush its internal register cache.
36688 @kindex maint print objfiles
36689 @cindex info for known object files
36690 @item maint print objfiles
36691 Print a dump of all known object files. For each object file, this
36692 command prints its name, address in memory, and all of its psymtabs
36695 @kindex maint print section-scripts
36696 @cindex info for known .debug_gdb_scripts-loaded scripts
36697 @item maint print section-scripts [@var{regexp}]
36698 Print a dump of scripts specified in the @code{.debug_gdb_section} section.
36699 If @var{regexp} is specified, only print scripts loaded by object files
36700 matching @var{regexp}.
36701 For each script, this command prints its name as specified in the objfile,
36702 and the full path if known.
36703 @xref{dotdebug_gdb_scripts section}.
36705 @kindex maint print statistics
36706 @cindex bcache statistics
36707 @item maint print statistics
36708 This command prints, for each object file in the program, various data
36709 about that object file followed by the byte cache (@dfn{bcache})
36710 statistics for the object file. The objfile data includes the number
36711 of minimal, partial, full, and stabs symbols, the number of types
36712 defined by the objfile, the number of as yet unexpanded psym tables,
36713 the number of line tables and string tables, and the amount of memory
36714 used by the various tables. The bcache statistics include the counts,
36715 sizes, and counts of duplicates of all and unique objects, max,
36716 average, and median entry size, total memory used and its overhead and
36717 savings, and various measures of the hash table size and chain
36720 @kindex maint print target-stack
36721 @cindex target stack description
36722 @item maint print target-stack
36723 A @dfn{target} is an interface between the debugger and a particular
36724 kind of file or process. Targets can be stacked in @dfn{strata},
36725 so that more than one target can potentially respond to a request.
36726 In particular, memory accesses will walk down the stack of targets
36727 until they find a target that is interested in handling that particular
36730 This command prints a short description of each layer that was pushed on
36731 the @dfn{target stack}, starting from the top layer down to the bottom one.
36733 @kindex maint print type
36734 @cindex type chain of a data type
36735 @item maint print type @var{expr}
36736 Print the type chain for a type specified by @var{expr}. The argument
36737 can be either a type name or a symbol. If it is a symbol, the type of
36738 that symbol is described. The type chain produced by this command is
36739 a recursive definition of the data type as stored in @value{GDBN}'s
36740 data structures, including its flags and contained types.
36742 @kindex maint set dwarf2 always-disassemble
36743 @kindex maint show dwarf2 always-disassemble
36744 @item maint set dwarf2 always-disassemble
36745 @item maint show dwarf2 always-disassemble
36746 Control the behavior of @code{info address} when using DWARF debugging
36749 The default is @code{off}, which means that @value{GDBN} should try to
36750 describe a variable's location in an easily readable format. When
36751 @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will instead display the DWARF location
36752 expression in an assembly-like format. Note that some locations are
36753 too complex for @value{GDBN} to describe simply; in this case you will
36754 always see the disassembly form.
36756 Here is an example of the resulting disassembly:
36759 (gdb) info addr argc
36760 Symbol "argc" is a complex DWARF expression:
36764 For more information on these expressions, see
36765 @uref{http://www.dwarfstd.org/, the DWARF standard}.
36767 @kindex maint set dwarf2 max-cache-age
36768 @kindex maint show dwarf2 max-cache-age
36769 @item maint set dwarf2 max-cache-age
36770 @itemx maint show dwarf2 max-cache-age
36771 Control the DWARF 2 compilation unit cache.
36773 @cindex DWARF 2 compilation units cache
36774 In object files with inter-compilation-unit references, such as those
36775 produced by the GCC option @samp{-feliminate-dwarf2-dups}, the DWARF 2
36776 reader needs to frequently refer to previously read compilation units.
36777 This setting controls how long a compilation unit will remain in the
36778 cache if it is not referenced. A higher limit means that cached
36779 compilation units will be stored in memory longer, and more total
36780 memory will be used. Setting it to zero disables caching, which will
36781 slow down @value{GDBN} startup, but reduce memory consumption.
36783 @kindex maint set profile
36784 @kindex maint show profile
36785 @cindex profiling GDB
36786 @item maint set profile
36787 @itemx maint show profile
36788 Control profiling of @value{GDBN}.
36790 Profiling will be disabled until you use the @samp{maint set profile}
36791 command to enable it. When you enable profiling, the system will begin
36792 collecting timing and execution count data; when you disable profiling or
36793 exit @value{GDBN}, the results will be written to a log file. Remember that
36794 if you use profiling, @value{GDBN} will overwrite the profiling log file
36795 (often called @file{gmon.out}). If you have a record of important profiling
36796 data in a @file{gmon.out} file, be sure to move it to a safe location.
36798 Configuring with @samp{--enable-profiling} arranges for @value{GDBN} to be
36799 compiled with the @samp{-pg} compiler option.
36801 @kindex maint set show-debug-regs
36802 @kindex maint show show-debug-regs
36803 @cindex hardware debug registers
36804 @item maint set show-debug-regs
36805 @itemx maint show show-debug-regs
36806 Control whether to show variables that mirror the hardware debug
36807 registers. Use @code{ON} to enable, @code{OFF} to disable. If
36808 enabled, the debug registers values are shown when @value{GDBN} inserts or
36809 removes a hardware breakpoint or watchpoint, and when the inferior
36810 triggers a hardware-assisted breakpoint or watchpoint.
36812 @kindex maint set show-all-tib
36813 @kindex maint show show-all-tib
36814 @item maint set show-all-tib
36815 @itemx maint show show-all-tib
36816 Control whether to show all non zero areas within a 1k block starting
36817 at thread local base, when using the @samp{info w32 thread-information-block}
36820 @kindex maint set per-command
36821 @kindex maint show per-command
36822 @item maint set per-command
36823 @itemx maint show per-command
36824 @cindex resources used by commands
36826 @value{GDBN} can display the resources used by each command.
36827 This is useful in debugging performance problems.
36830 @item maint set per-command space [on|off]
36831 @itemx maint show per-command space
36832 Enable or disable the printing of the memory used by GDB for each command.
36833 If enabled, @value{GDBN} will display how much memory each command
36834 took, following the command's own output.
36835 This can also be requested by invoking @value{GDBN} with the
36836 @option{--statistics} command-line switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
36838 @item maint set per-command time [on|off]
36839 @itemx maint show per-command time
36840 Enable or disable the printing of the execution time of @value{GDBN}
36842 If enabled, @value{GDBN} will display how much time it
36843 took to execute each command, following the command's own output.
36844 Both CPU time and wallclock time are printed.
36845 Printing both is useful when trying to determine whether the cost is
36846 CPU or, e.g., disk/network latency.
36847 Note that the CPU time printed is for @value{GDBN} only, it does not include
36848 the execution time of the inferior because there's no mechanism currently
36849 to compute how much time was spent by @value{GDBN} and how much time was
36850 spent by the program been debugged.
36851 This can also be requested by invoking @value{GDBN} with the
36852 @option{--statistics} command-line switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
36854 @item maint set per-command symtab [on|off]
36855 @itemx maint show per-command symtab
36856 Enable or disable the printing of basic symbol table statistics
36858 If enabled, @value{GDBN} will display the following information:
36862 number of symbol tables
36864 number of primary symbol tables
36866 number of blocks in the blockvector
36870 @kindex maint space
36871 @cindex memory used by commands
36872 @item maint space @var{value}
36873 An alias for @code{maint set per-command space}.
36874 A non-zero value enables it, zero disables it.
36877 @cindex time of command execution
36878 @item maint time @var{value}
36879 An alias for @code{maint set per-command time}.
36880 A non-zero value enables it, zero disables it.
36882 @kindex maint translate-address
36883 @item maint translate-address @r{[}@var{section}@r{]} @var{addr}
36884 Find the symbol stored at the location specified by the address
36885 @var{addr} and an optional section name @var{section}. If found,
36886 @value{GDBN} prints the name of the closest symbol and an offset from
36887 the symbol's location to the specified address. This is similar to
36888 the @code{info address} command (@pxref{Symbols}), except that this
36889 command also allows to find symbols in other sections.
36891 If section was not specified, the section in which the symbol was found
36892 is also printed. For dynamically linked executables, the name of
36893 executable or shared library containing the symbol is printed as well.
36897 The following command is useful for non-interactive invocations of
36898 @value{GDBN}, such as in the test suite.
36901 @item set watchdog @var{nsec}
36902 @kindex set watchdog
36903 @cindex watchdog timer
36904 @cindex timeout for commands
36905 Set the maximum number of seconds @value{GDBN} will wait for the
36906 target operation to finish. If this time expires, @value{GDBN}
36907 reports and error and the command is aborted.
36909 @item show watchdog
36910 Show the current setting of the target wait timeout.
36913 @node Remote Protocol
36914 @appendix @value{GDBN} Remote Serial Protocol
36919 * Stop Reply Packets::
36920 * General Query Packets::
36921 * Architecture-Specific Protocol Details::
36922 * Tracepoint Packets::
36923 * Host I/O Packets::
36925 * Notification Packets::
36926 * Remote Non-Stop::
36927 * Packet Acknowledgment::
36929 * File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension::
36930 * Library List Format::
36931 * Library List Format for SVR4 Targets::
36932 * Memory Map Format::
36933 * Thread List Format::
36934 * Traceframe Info Format::
36935 * Branch Trace Format::
36941 There may be occasions when you need to know something about the
36942 protocol---for example, if there is only one serial port to your target
36943 machine, you might want your program to do something special if it
36944 recognizes a packet meant for @value{GDBN}.
36946 In the examples below, @samp{->} and @samp{<-} are used to indicate
36947 transmitted and received data, respectively.
36949 @cindex protocol, @value{GDBN} remote serial
36950 @cindex serial protocol, @value{GDBN} remote
36951 @cindex remote serial protocol
36952 All @value{GDBN} commands and responses (other than acknowledgments
36953 and notifications, see @ref{Notification Packets}) are sent as a
36954 @var{packet}. A @var{packet} is introduced with the character
36955 @samp{$}, the actual @var{packet-data}, and the terminating character
36956 @samp{#} followed by a two-digit @var{checksum}:
36959 @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
36963 @cindex checksum, for @value{GDBN} remote
36965 The two-digit @var{checksum} is computed as the modulo 256 sum of all
36966 characters between the leading @samp{$} and the trailing @samp{#} (an
36967 eight bit unsigned checksum).
36969 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0 the protocol
36970 specification also included an optional two-digit @var{sequence-id}:
36973 @code{$}@var{sequence-id}@code{:}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
36976 @cindex sequence-id, for @value{GDBN} remote
36978 That @var{sequence-id} was appended to the acknowledgment. @value{GDBN}
36979 has never output @var{sequence-id}s. Stubs that handle packets added
36980 since @value{GDBN} 5.0 must not accept @var{sequence-id}.
36982 When either the host or the target machine receives a packet, the first
36983 response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
36984 the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request
36988 -> @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
36993 The @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments can be disabled
36994 once a connection is established.
36995 @xref{Packet Acknowledgment}, for details.
36997 The host (@value{GDBN}) sends @var{command}s, and the target (the
36998 debugging stub incorporated in your program) sends a @var{response}. In
36999 the case of step and continue @var{command}s, the response is only sent
37000 when the operation has completed, and the target has again stopped all
37001 threads in all attached processes. This is the default all-stop mode
37002 behavior, but the remote protocol also supports @value{GDBN}'s non-stop
37003 execution mode; see @ref{Remote Non-Stop}, for details.
37005 @var{packet-data} consists of a sequence of characters with the
37006 exception of @samp{#} and @samp{$} (see @samp{X} packet for additional
37009 @cindex remote protocol, field separator
37010 Fields within the packet should be separated using @samp{,} @samp{;} or
37011 @samp{:}. Except where otherwise noted all numbers are represented in
37012 @sc{hex} with leading zeros suppressed.
37014 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0, the character
37015 @samp{:} could not appear as the third character in a packet (as it
37016 would potentially conflict with the @var{sequence-id}).
37018 @cindex remote protocol, binary data
37019 @anchor{Binary Data}
37020 Binary data in most packets is encoded either as two hexadecimal
37021 digits per byte of binary data. This allowed the traditional remote
37022 protocol to work over connections which were only seven-bit clean.
37023 Some packets designed more recently assume an eight-bit clean
37024 connection, and use a more efficient encoding to send and receive
37027 The binary data representation uses @code{7d} (@sc{ascii} @samp{@}})
37028 as an escape character. Any escaped byte is transmitted as the escape
37029 character followed by the original character XORed with @code{0x20}.
37030 For example, the byte @code{0x7d} would be transmitted as the two
37031 bytes @code{0x7d 0x5d}. The bytes @code{0x23} (@sc{ascii} @samp{#}),
37032 @code{0x24} (@sc{ascii} @samp{$}), and @code{0x7d} (@sc{ascii}
37033 @samp{@}}) must always be escaped. Responses sent by the stub
37034 must also escape @code{0x2a} (@sc{ascii} @samp{*}), so that it
37035 is not interpreted as the start of a run-length encoded sequence
37038 Response @var{data} can be run-length encoded to save space.
37039 Run-length encoding replaces runs of identical characters with one
37040 instance of the repeated character, followed by a @samp{*} and a
37041 repeat count. The repeat count is itself sent encoded, to avoid
37042 binary characters in @var{data}: a value of @var{n} is sent as
37043 @code{@var{n}+29}. For a repeat count greater or equal to 3, this
37044 produces a printable @sc{ascii} character, e.g.@: a space (@sc{ascii}
37045 code 32) for a repeat count of 3. (This is because run-length
37046 encoding starts to win for counts 3 or more.) Thus, for example,
37047 @samp{0* } is a run-length encoding of ``0000'': the space character
37048 after @samp{*} means repeat the leading @code{0} @w{@code{32 - 29 =
37051 The printable characters @samp{#} and @samp{$} or with a numeric value
37052 greater than 126 must not be used. Runs of six repeats (@samp{#}) or
37053 seven repeats (@samp{$}) can be expanded using a repeat count of only
37054 five (@samp{"}). For example, @samp{00000000} can be encoded as
37057 The error response returned for some packets includes a two character
37058 error number. That number is not well defined.
37060 @cindex empty response, for unsupported packets
37061 For any @var{command} not supported by the stub, an empty response
37062 (@samp{$#00}) should be returned. That way it is possible to extend the
37063 protocol. A newer @value{GDBN} can tell if a packet is supported based
37066 At a minimum, a stub is required to support the @samp{g} and @samp{G}
37067 commands for register access, and the @samp{m} and @samp{M} commands
37068 for memory access. Stubs that only control single-threaded targets
37069 can implement run control with the @samp{c} (continue), and @samp{s}
37070 (step) commands. Stubs that support multi-threading targets should
37071 support the @samp{vCont} command. All other commands are optional.
37076 The following table provides a complete list of all currently defined
37077 @var{command}s and their corresponding response @var{data}.
37078 @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for details about the File
37079 I/O extension of the remote protocol.
37081 Each packet's description has a template showing the packet's overall
37082 syntax, followed by an explanation of the packet's meaning. We
37083 include spaces in some of the templates for clarity; these are not
37084 part of the packet's syntax. No @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to
37085 separate its components. For example, a template like @samp{foo
37086 @var{bar} @var{baz}} describes a packet beginning with the three ASCII
37087 bytes @samp{foo}, followed by a @var{bar}, followed directly by a
37088 @var{baz}. @value{GDBN} does not transmit a space character between the
37089 @samp{foo} and the @var{bar}, or between the @var{bar} and the
37092 @cindex @var{thread-id}, in remote protocol
37093 @anchor{thread-id syntax}
37094 Several packets and replies include a @var{thread-id} field to identify
37095 a thread. Normally these are positive numbers with a target-specific
37096 interpretation, formatted as big-endian hex strings. A @var{thread-id}
37097 can also be a literal @samp{-1} to indicate all threads, or @samp{0} to
37100 In addition, the remote protocol supports a multiprocess feature in
37101 which the @var{thread-id} syntax is extended to optionally include both
37102 process and thread ID fields, as @samp{p@var{pid}.@var{tid}}.
37103 The @var{pid} (process) and @var{tid} (thread) components each have the
37104 format described above: a positive number with target-specific
37105 interpretation formatted as a big-endian hex string, literal @samp{-1}
37106 to indicate all processes or threads (respectively), or @samp{0} to
37107 indicate an arbitrary process or thread. Specifying just a process, as
37108 @samp{p@var{pid}}, is equivalent to @samp{p@var{pid}.-1}. It is an
37109 error to specify all processes but a specific thread, such as
37110 @samp{p-1.@var{tid}}. Note that the @samp{p} prefix is @emph{not} used
37111 for those packets and replies explicitly documented to include a process
37112 ID, rather than a @var{thread-id}.
37114 The multiprocess @var{thread-id} syntax extensions are only used if both
37115 @value{GDBN} and the stub report support for the @samp{multiprocess}
37116 feature using @samp{qSupported}. @xref{multiprocess extensions}, for
37119 Note that all packet forms beginning with an upper- or lower-case
37120 letter, other than those described here, are reserved for future use.
37122 Here are the packet descriptions.
37127 @cindex @samp{!} packet
37128 @anchor{extended mode}
37129 Enable extended mode. In extended mode, the remote server is made
37130 persistent. The @samp{R} packet is used to restart the program being
37136 The remote target both supports and has enabled extended mode.
37140 @cindex @samp{?} packet
37141 Indicate the reason the target halted. The reply is the same as for
37142 step and continue. This packet has a special interpretation when the
37143 target is in non-stop mode; see @ref{Remote Non-Stop}.
37146 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
37148 @item A @var{arglen},@var{argnum},@var{arg},@dots{}
37149 @cindex @samp{A} packet
37150 Initialized @code{argv[]} array passed into program. @var{arglen}
37151 specifies the number of bytes in the hex encoded byte stream
37152 @var{arg}. See @code{gdbserver} for more details.
37157 The arguments were set.
37163 @cindex @samp{b} packet
37164 (Don't use this packet; its behavior is not well-defined.)
37165 Change the serial line speed to @var{baud}.
37167 JTC: @emph{When does the transport layer state change? When it's
37168 received, or after the ACK is transmitted. In either case, there are
37169 problems if the command or the acknowledgment packet is dropped.}
37171 Stan: @emph{If people really wanted to add something like this, and get
37172 it working for the first time, they ought to modify ser-unix.c to send
37173 some kind of out-of-band message to a specially-setup stub and have the
37174 switch happen "in between" packets, so that from remote protocol's point
37175 of view, nothing actually happened.}
37177 @item B @var{addr},@var{mode}
37178 @cindex @samp{B} packet
37179 Set (@var{mode} is @samp{S}) or clear (@var{mode} is @samp{C}) a
37180 breakpoint at @var{addr}.
37182 Don't use this packet. Use the @samp{Z} and @samp{z} packets instead
37183 (@pxref{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}).
37185 @cindex @samp{bc} packet
37188 Backward continue. Execute the target system in reverse. No parameter.
37189 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
37192 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
37194 @cindex @samp{bs} packet
37197 Backward single step. Execute one instruction in reverse. No parameter.
37198 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
37201 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
37203 @item c @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
37204 @cindex @samp{c} packet
37205 Continue. @var{addr} is address to resume. If @var{addr} is omitted,
37206 resume at current address.
37208 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
37212 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
37214 @item C @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
37215 @cindex @samp{C} packet
37216 Continue with signal @var{sig} (hex signal number). If
37217 @samp{;@var{addr}} is omitted, resume at same address.
37219 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
37223 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
37226 @cindex @samp{d} packet
37229 Don't use this packet; instead, define a general set packet
37230 (@pxref{General Query Packets}).
37234 @cindex @samp{D} packet
37235 The first form of the packet is used to detach @value{GDBN} from the
37236 remote system. It is sent to the remote target
37237 before @value{GDBN} disconnects via the @code{detach} command.
37239 The second form, including a process ID, is used when multiprocess
37240 protocol extensions are enabled (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}), to
37241 detach only a specific process. The @var{pid} is specified as a
37242 big-endian hex string.
37252 @item F @var{RC},@var{EE},@var{CF};@var{XX}
37253 @cindex @samp{F} packet
37254 A reply from @value{GDBN} to an @samp{F} packet sent by the target.
37255 This is part of the File-I/O protocol extension. @xref{File-I/O
37256 Remote Protocol Extension}, for the specification.
37259 @anchor{read registers packet}
37260 @cindex @samp{g} packet
37261 Read general registers.
37265 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
37266 Each byte of register data is described by two hex digits. The bytes
37267 with the register are transmitted in target byte order. The size of
37268 each register and their position within the @samp{g} packet are
37269 determined by the @value{GDBN} internal gdbarch functions
37270 @code{DEPRECATED_REGISTER_RAW_SIZE} and @code{gdbarch_register_name}. The
37271 specification of several standard @samp{g} packets is specified below.
37273 When reading registers from a trace frame (@pxref{Analyze Collected
37274 Data,,Using the Collected Data}), the stub may also return a string of
37275 literal @samp{x}'s in place of the register data digits, to indicate
37276 that the corresponding register has not been collected, thus its value
37277 is unavailable. For example, for an architecture with 4 registers of
37278 4 bytes each, the following reply indicates to @value{GDBN} that
37279 registers 0 and 2 have not been collected, while registers 1 and 3
37280 have been collected, and both have zero value:
37284 <- @code{xxxxxxxx00000000xxxxxxxx00000000}
37291 @item G @var{XX@dots{}}
37292 @cindex @samp{G} packet
37293 Write general registers. @xref{read registers packet}, for a
37294 description of the @var{XX@dots{}} data.
37304 @item H @var{op} @var{thread-id}
37305 @cindex @samp{H} packet
37306 Set thread for subsequent operations (@samp{m}, @samp{M}, @samp{g},
37307 @samp{G}, et.al.). @var{op} depends on the operation to be performed:
37308 it should be @samp{c} for step and continue operations (note that this
37309 is deprecated, supporting the @samp{vCont} command is a better
37310 option), @samp{g} for other operations. The thread designator
37311 @var{thread-id} has the format and interpretation described in
37312 @ref{thread-id syntax}.
37323 @c 'H': How restrictive (or permissive) is the thread model. If a
37324 @c thread is selected and stopped, are other threads allowed
37325 @c to continue to execute? As I mentioned above, I think the
37326 @c semantics of each command when a thread is selected must be
37327 @c described. For example:
37329 @c 'g': If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
37330 @c selected, returns the register block from that thread;
37331 @c otherwise returns current registers.
37333 @c 'G' If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
37334 @c selected, sets the registers of the register block of
37335 @c that thread; otherwise sets current registers.
37337 @item i @r{[}@var{addr}@r{[},@var{nnn}@r{]]}
37338 @anchor{cycle step packet}
37339 @cindex @samp{i} packet
37340 Step the remote target by a single clock cycle. If @samp{,@var{nnn}} is
37341 present, cycle step @var{nnn} cycles. If @var{addr} is present, cycle
37342 step starting at that address.
37345 @cindex @samp{I} packet
37346 Signal, then cycle step. @xref{step with signal packet}. @xref{cycle
37350 @cindex @samp{k} packet
37353 FIXME: @emph{There is no description of how to operate when a specific
37354 thread context has been selected (i.e.@: does 'k' kill only that
37357 @item m @var{addr},@var{length}
37358 @cindex @samp{m} packet
37359 Read @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
37360 Note that @var{addr} may not be aligned to any particular boundary.
37362 The stub need not use any particular size or alignment when gathering
37363 data from memory for the response; even if @var{addr} is word-aligned
37364 and @var{length} is a multiple of the word size, the stub is free to
37365 use byte accesses, or not. For this reason, this packet may not be
37366 suitable for accessing memory-mapped I/O devices.
37367 @cindex alignment of remote memory accesses
37368 @cindex size of remote memory accesses
37369 @cindex memory, alignment and size of remote accesses
37373 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
37374 Memory contents; each byte is transmitted as a two-digit hexadecimal
37375 number. The reply may contain fewer bytes than requested if the
37376 server was able to read only part of the region of memory.
37381 @item M @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
37382 @cindex @samp{M} packet
37383 Write @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
37384 @var{XX@dots{}} is the data; each byte is transmitted as a two-digit
37385 hexadecimal number.
37392 for an error (this includes the case where only part of the data was
37397 @cindex @samp{p} packet
37398 Read the value of register @var{n}; @var{n} is in hex.
37399 @xref{read registers packet}, for a description of how the returned
37400 register value is encoded.
37404 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
37405 the register's value
37409 Indicating an unrecognized @var{query}.
37412 @item P @var{n@dots{}}=@var{r@dots{}}
37413 @anchor{write register packet}
37414 @cindex @samp{P} packet
37415 Write register @var{n@dots{}} with value @var{r@dots{}}. The register
37416 number @var{n} is in hexadecimal, and @var{r@dots{}} contains two hex
37417 digits for each byte in the register (target byte order).
37427 @item q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
37428 @itemx Q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
37429 @cindex @samp{q} packet
37430 @cindex @samp{Q} packet
37431 General query (@samp{q}) and set (@samp{Q}). These packets are
37432 described fully in @ref{General Query Packets}.
37435 @cindex @samp{r} packet
37436 Reset the entire system.
37438 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{R} packet instead.
37441 @cindex @samp{R} packet
37442 Restart the program being debugged. @var{XX}, while needed, is ignored.
37443 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
37445 The @samp{R} packet has no reply.
37447 @item s @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
37448 @cindex @samp{s} packet
37449 Single step. @var{addr} is the address at which to resume. If
37450 @var{addr} is omitted, resume at same address.
37452 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
37456 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
37458 @item S @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
37459 @anchor{step with signal packet}
37460 @cindex @samp{S} packet
37461 Step with signal. This is analogous to the @samp{C} packet, but
37462 requests a single-step, rather than a normal resumption of execution.
37464 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
37468 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
37470 @item t @var{addr}:@var{PP},@var{MM}
37471 @cindex @samp{t} packet
37472 Search backwards starting at address @var{addr} for a match with pattern
37473 @var{PP} and mask @var{MM}. @var{PP} and @var{MM} are 4 bytes.
37474 @var{addr} must be at least 3 digits.
37476 @item T @var{thread-id}
37477 @cindex @samp{T} packet
37478 Find out if the thread @var{thread-id} is alive. @xref{thread-id syntax}.
37483 thread is still alive
37489 Packets starting with @samp{v} are identified by a multi-letter name,
37490 up to the first @samp{;} or @samp{?} (or the end of the packet).
37492 @item vAttach;@var{pid}
37493 @cindex @samp{vAttach} packet
37494 Attach to a new process with the specified process ID @var{pid}.
37495 The process ID is a
37496 hexadecimal integer identifying the process. In all-stop mode, all
37497 threads in the attached process are stopped; in non-stop mode, it may be
37498 attached without being stopped if that is supported by the target.
37500 @c In non-stop mode, on a successful vAttach, the stub should set the
37501 @c current thread to a thread of the newly-attached process. After
37502 @c attaching, GDB queries for the attached process's thread ID with qC.
37503 @c Also note that, from a user perspective, whether or not the
37504 @c target is stopped on attach in non-stop mode depends on whether you
37505 @c use the foreground or background version of the attach command, not
37506 @c on what vAttach does; GDB does the right thing with respect to either
37507 @c stopping or restarting threads.
37509 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
37515 @item @r{Any stop packet}
37516 for success in all-stop mode (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
37518 for success in non-stop mode (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop})
37521 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@r{[}:@var{thread-id}@r{]]}@dots{}
37522 @cindex @samp{vCont} packet
37523 @anchor{vCont packet}
37524 Resume the inferior, specifying different actions for each thread.
37525 If an action is specified with no @var{thread-id}, then it is applied to any
37526 threads that don't have a specific action specified; if no default action is
37527 specified then other threads should remain stopped in all-stop mode and
37528 in their current state in non-stop mode.
37529 Specifying multiple
37530 default actions is an error; specifying no actions is also an error.
37531 Thread IDs are specified using the syntax described in @ref{thread-id syntax}.
37533 Currently supported actions are:
37539 Continue with signal @var{sig}. The signal @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
37543 Step with signal @var{sig}. The signal @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
37546 @item r @var{start},@var{end}
37547 Step once, and then keep stepping as long as the thread stops at
37548 addresses between @var{start} (inclusive) and @var{end} (exclusive).
37549 The remote stub reports a stop reply when either the thread goes out
37550 of the range or is stopped due to an unrelated reason, such as hitting
37551 a breakpoint. @xref{range stepping}.
37553 If the range is empty (@var{start} == @var{end}), then the action
37554 becomes equivalent to the @samp{s} action. In other words,
37555 single-step once, and report the stop (even if the stepped instruction
37556 jumps to @var{start}).
37558 (A stop reply may be sent at any point even if the PC is still within
37559 the stepping range; for example, it is valid to implement this packet
37560 in a degenerate way as a single instruction step operation.)
37564 The optional argument @var{addr} normally associated with the
37565 @samp{c}, @samp{C}, @samp{s}, and @samp{S} packets is
37566 not supported in @samp{vCont}.
37568 The @samp{t} action is only relevant in non-stop mode
37569 (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop}) and may be ignored by the stub otherwise.
37570 A stop reply should be generated for any affected thread not already stopped.
37571 When a thread is stopped by means of a @samp{t} action,
37572 the corresponding stop reply should indicate that the thread has stopped with
37573 signal @samp{0}, regardless of whether the target uses some other signal
37574 as an implementation detail.
37576 The stub must support @samp{vCont} if it reports support for
37577 multiprocess extensions (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}). Note that in
37578 this case @samp{vCont} actions can be specified to apply to all threads
37579 in a process by using the @samp{p@var{pid}.-1} form of the
37583 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
37586 @cindex @samp{vCont?} packet
37587 Request a list of actions supported by the @samp{vCont} packet.
37591 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@dots{}@r{]}
37592 The @samp{vCont} packet is supported. Each @var{action} is a supported
37593 command in the @samp{vCont} packet.
37595 The @samp{vCont} packet is not supported.
37598 @item vFile:@var{operation}:@var{parameter}@dots{}
37599 @cindex @samp{vFile} packet
37600 Perform a file operation on the target system. For details,
37601 see @ref{Host I/O Packets}.
37603 @item vFlashErase:@var{addr},@var{length}
37604 @cindex @samp{vFlashErase} packet
37605 Direct the stub to erase @var{length} bytes of flash starting at
37606 @var{addr}. The region may enclose any number of flash blocks, but
37607 its start and end must fall on block boundaries, as indicated by the
37608 flash block size appearing in the memory map (@pxref{Memory Map
37609 Format}). @value{GDBN} groups flash memory programming operations
37610 together, and sends a @samp{vFlashDone} request after each group; the
37611 stub is allowed to delay erase operation until the @samp{vFlashDone}
37612 packet is received.
37622 @item vFlashWrite:@var{addr}:@var{XX@dots{}}
37623 @cindex @samp{vFlashWrite} packet
37624 Direct the stub to write data to flash address @var{addr}. The data
37625 is passed in binary form using the same encoding as for the @samp{X}
37626 packet (@pxref{Binary Data}). The memory ranges specified by
37627 @samp{vFlashWrite} packets preceding a @samp{vFlashDone} packet must
37628 not overlap, and must appear in order of increasing addresses
37629 (although @samp{vFlashErase} packets for higher addresses may already
37630 have been received; the ordering is guaranteed only between
37631 @samp{vFlashWrite} packets). If a packet writes to an address that was
37632 neither erased by a preceding @samp{vFlashErase} packet nor by some other
37633 target-specific method, the results are unpredictable.
37641 for vFlashWrite addressing non-flash memory
37647 @cindex @samp{vFlashDone} packet
37648 Indicate to the stub that flash programming operation is finished.
37649 The stub is permitted to delay or batch the effects of a group of
37650 @samp{vFlashErase} and @samp{vFlashWrite} packets until a
37651 @samp{vFlashDone} packet is received. The contents of the affected
37652 regions of flash memory are unpredictable until the @samp{vFlashDone}
37653 request is completed.
37655 @item vKill;@var{pid}
37656 @cindex @samp{vKill} packet
37657 Kill the process with the specified process ID. @var{pid} is a
37658 hexadecimal integer identifying the process. This packet is used in
37659 preference to @samp{k} when multiprocess protocol extensions are
37660 supported; see @ref{multiprocess extensions}.
37670 @item vRun;@var{filename}@r{[};@var{argument}@r{]}@dots{}
37671 @cindex @samp{vRun} packet
37672 Run the program @var{filename}, passing it each @var{argument} on its
37673 command line. The file and arguments are hex-encoded strings. If
37674 @var{filename} is an empty string, the stub may use a default program
37675 (e.g.@: the last program run). The program is created in the stopped
37678 @c FIXME: What about non-stop mode?
37680 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
37686 @item @r{Any stop packet}
37687 for success (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
37691 @cindex @samp{vStopped} packet
37692 @xref{Notification Packets}.
37694 @item X @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
37696 @cindex @samp{X} packet
37697 Write data to memory, where the data is transmitted in binary.
37698 @var{addr} is address, @var{length} is number of bytes,
37699 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
37709 @item z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{kind}
37710 @itemx Z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{kind}
37711 @anchor{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}
37712 @cindex @samp{z} packet
37713 @cindex @samp{Z} packets
37714 Insert (@samp{Z}) or remove (@samp{z}) a @var{type} breakpoint or
37715 watchpoint starting at address @var{address} of kind @var{kind}.
37717 Each breakpoint and watchpoint packet @var{type} is documented
37720 @emph{Implementation notes: A remote target shall return an empty string
37721 for an unrecognized breakpoint or watchpoint packet @var{type}. A
37722 remote target shall support either both or neither of a given
37723 @samp{Z@var{type}@dots{}} and @samp{z@var{type}@dots{}} packet pair. To
37724 avoid potential problems with duplicate packets, the operations should
37725 be implemented in an idempotent way.}
37727 @item z0,@var{addr},@var{kind}
37728 @itemx Z0,@var{addr},@var{kind}@r{[};@var{cond_list}@dots{}@r{]}@r{[};cmds:@var{persist},@var{cmd_list}@dots{}@r{]}
37729 @cindex @samp{z0} packet
37730 @cindex @samp{Z0} packet
37731 Insert (@samp{Z0}) or remove (@samp{z0}) a memory breakpoint at address
37732 @var{addr} of type @var{kind}.
37734 A memory breakpoint is implemented by replacing the instruction at
37735 @var{addr} with a software breakpoint or trap instruction. The
37736 @var{kind} is target-specific and typically indicates the size of
37737 the breakpoint in bytes that should be inserted. E.g., the @sc{arm}
37738 and @sc{mips} can insert either a 2 or 4 byte breakpoint. Some
37739 architectures have additional meanings for @var{kind};
37740 @var{cond_list} is an optional list of conditional expressions in bytecode
37741 form that should be evaluated on the target's side. These are the
37742 conditions that should be taken into consideration when deciding if
37743 the breakpoint trigger should be reported back to @var{GDBN}.
37745 The @var{cond_list} parameter is comprised of a series of expressions,
37746 concatenated without separators. Each expression has the following form:
37750 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
37751 @var{len} is the length of the bytecode expression and @var{expr} is the
37752 actual conditional expression in bytecode form.
37756 The optional @var{cmd_list} parameter introduces commands that may be
37757 run on the target, rather than being reported back to @value{GDBN}.
37758 The parameter starts with a numeric flag @var{persist}; if the flag is
37759 nonzero, then the breakpoint may remain active and the commands
37760 continue to be run even when @value{GDBN} disconnects from the target.
37761 Following this flag is a series of expressions concatenated with no
37762 separators. Each expression has the following form:
37766 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
37767 @var{len} is the length of the bytecode expression and @var{expr} is the
37768 actual conditional expression in bytecode form.
37772 see @ref{Architecture-Specific Protocol Details}.
37774 @emph{Implementation note: It is possible for a target to copy or move
37775 code that contains memory breakpoints (e.g., when implementing
37776 overlays). The behavior of this packet, in the presence of such a
37777 target, is not defined.}
37789 @item z1,@var{addr},@var{kind}
37790 @itemx Z1,@var{addr},@var{kind}@r{[};@var{cond_list}@dots{}@r{]}
37791 @cindex @samp{z1} packet
37792 @cindex @samp{Z1} packet
37793 Insert (@samp{Z1}) or remove (@samp{z1}) a hardware breakpoint at
37794 address @var{addr}.
37796 A hardware breakpoint is implemented using a mechanism that is not
37797 dependant on being able to modify the target's memory. @var{kind}
37798 and @var{cond_list} have the same meaning as in @samp{Z0} packets.
37800 @emph{Implementation note: A hardware breakpoint is not affected by code
37813 @item z2,@var{addr},@var{kind}
37814 @itemx Z2,@var{addr},@var{kind}
37815 @cindex @samp{z2} packet
37816 @cindex @samp{Z2} packet
37817 Insert (@samp{Z2}) or remove (@samp{z2}) a write watchpoint at @var{addr}.
37818 @var{kind} is interpreted as the number of bytes to watch.
37830 @item z3,@var{addr},@var{kind}
37831 @itemx Z3,@var{addr},@var{kind}
37832 @cindex @samp{z3} packet
37833 @cindex @samp{Z3} packet
37834 Insert (@samp{Z3}) or remove (@samp{z3}) a read watchpoint at @var{addr}.
37835 @var{kind} is interpreted as the number of bytes to watch.
37847 @item z4,@var{addr},@var{kind}
37848 @itemx Z4,@var{addr},@var{kind}
37849 @cindex @samp{z4} packet
37850 @cindex @samp{Z4} packet
37851 Insert (@samp{Z4}) or remove (@samp{z4}) an access watchpoint at @var{addr}.
37852 @var{kind} is interpreted as the number of bytes to watch.
37866 @node Stop Reply Packets
37867 @section Stop Reply Packets
37868 @cindex stop reply packets
37870 The @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}, @samp{s}, @samp{vCont},
37871 @samp{vAttach}, @samp{vRun}, @samp{vStopped}, and @samp{?} packets can
37872 receive any of the below as a reply. Except for @samp{?}
37873 and @samp{vStopped}, that reply is only returned
37874 when the target halts. In the below the exact meaning of @dfn{signal
37875 number} is defined by the header @file{include/gdb/signals.h} in the
37876 @value{GDBN} source code.
37878 As in the description of request packets, we include spaces in the
37879 reply templates for clarity; these are not part of the reply packet's
37880 syntax. No @value{GDBN} stop reply packet uses spaces to separate its
37886 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
37887 number). This is equivalent to a @samp{T} response with no
37888 @var{n}:@var{r} pairs.
37890 @item T @var{AA} @var{n1}:@var{r1};@var{n2}:@var{r2};@dots{}
37891 @cindex @samp{T} packet reply
37892 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
37893 number). This is equivalent to an @samp{S} response, except that the
37894 @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pairs can carry values of important registers
37895 and other information directly in the stop reply packet, reducing
37896 round-trip latency. Single-step and breakpoint traps are reported
37897 this way. Each @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair is interpreted as follows:
37901 If @var{n} is a hexadecimal number, it is a register number, and the
37902 corresponding @var{r} gives that register's value. @var{r} is a
37903 series of bytes in target byte order, with each byte given by a
37904 two-digit hex number.
37907 If @var{n} is @samp{thread}, then @var{r} is the @var{thread-id} of
37908 the stopped thread, as specified in @ref{thread-id syntax}.
37911 If @var{n} is @samp{core}, then @var{r} is the hexadecimal number of
37912 the core on which the stop event was detected.
37915 If @var{n} is a recognized @dfn{stop reason}, it describes a more
37916 specific event that stopped the target. The currently defined stop
37917 reasons are listed below. @var{aa} should be @samp{05}, the trap
37918 signal. At most one stop reason should be present.
37921 Otherwise, @value{GDBN} should ignore this @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair
37922 and go on to the next; this allows us to extend the protocol in the
37926 The currently defined stop reasons are:
37932 The packet indicates a watchpoint hit, and @var{r} is the data address, in
37935 @cindex shared library events, remote reply
37937 The packet indicates that the loaded libraries have changed.
37938 @value{GDBN} should use @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} to fetch a new
37939 list of loaded libraries. @var{r} is ignored.
37941 @cindex replay log events, remote reply
37943 The packet indicates that the target cannot continue replaying
37944 logged execution events, because it has reached the end (or the
37945 beginning when executing backward) of the log. The value of @var{r}
37946 will be either @samp{begin} or @samp{end}. @xref{Reverse Execution},
37947 for more information.
37951 @itemx W @var{AA} ; process:@var{pid}
37952 The process exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This is only
37953 applicable to certain targets.
37955 The second form of the response, including the process ID of the exited
37956 process, can be used only when @value{GDBN} has reported support for
37957 multiprocess protocol extensions; see @ref{multiprocess extensions}.
37958 The @var{pid} is formatted as a big-endian hex string.
37961 @itemx X @var{AA} ; process:@var{pid}
37962 The process terminated with signal @var{AA}.
37964 The second form of the response, including the process ID of the
37965 terminated process, can be used only when @value{GDBN} has reported
37966 support for multiprocess protocol extensions; see @ref{multiprocess
37967 extensions}. The @var{pid} is formatted as a big-endian hex string.
37969 @item O @var{XX}@dots{}
37970 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data, to be
37971 written as the program's console output. This can happen at any time
37972 while the program is running and the debugger should continue to wait
37973 for @samp{W}, @samp{T}, etc. This reply is not permitted in non-stop mode.
37975 @item F @var{call-id},@var{parameter}@dots{}
37976 @var{call-id} is the identifier which says which host system call should
37977 be called. This is just the name of the function. Translation into the
37978 correct system call is only applicable as it's defined in @value{GDBN}.
37979 @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for a list of implemented
37982 @samp{@var{parameter}@dots{}} is a list of parameters as defined for
37983 this very system call.
37985 The target replies with this packet when it expects @value{GDBN} to
37986 call a host system call on behalf of the target. @value{GDBN} replies
37987 with an appropriate @samp{F} packet and keeps up waiting for the next
37988 reply packet from the target. The latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
37989 or @samp{s} action is expected to be continued. @xref{File-I/O Remote
37990 Protocol Extension}, for more details.
37994 @node General Query Packets
37995 @section General Query Packets
37996 @cindex remote query requests
37998 Packets starting with @samp{q} are @dfn{general query packets};
37999 packets starting with @samp{Q} are @dfn{general set packets}. General
38000 query and set packets are a semi-unified form for retrieving and
38001 sending information to and from the stub.
38003 The initial letter of a query or set packet is followed by a name
38004 indicating what sort of thing the packet applies to. For example,
38005 @value{GDBN} may use a @samp{qSymbol} packet to exchange symbol
38006 definitions with the stub. These packet names follow some
38011 The name must not contain commas, colons or semicolons.
38013 Most @value{GDBN} query and set packets have a leading upper case
38016 The names of custom vendor packets should use a company prefix, in
38017 lower case, followed by a period. For example, packets designed at
38018 the Acme Corporation might begin with @samp{qacme.foo} (for querying
38019 foos) or @samp{Qacme.bar} (for setting bars).
38022 The name of a query or set packet should be separated from any
38023 parameters by a @samp{:}; the parameters themselves should be
38024 separated by @samp{,} or @samp{;}. Stubs must be careful to match the
38025 full packet name, and check for a separator or the end of the packet,
38026 in case two packet names share a common prefix. New packets should not begin
38027 with @samp{qC}, @samp{qP}, or @samp{qL}@footnote{The @samp{qP} and @samp{qL}
38028 packets predate these conventions, and have arguments without any terminator
38029 for the packet name; we suspect they are in widespread use in places that
38030 are difficult to upgrade. The @samp{qC} packet has no arguments, but some
38031 existing stubs (e.g.@: RedBoot) are known to not check for the end of the
38034 Like the descriptions of the other packets, each description here
38035 has a template showing the packet's overall syntax, followed by an
38036 explanation of the packet's meaning. We include spaces in some of the
38037 templates for clarity; these are not part of the packet's syntax. No
38038 @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to separate its components.
38040 Here are the currently defined query and set packets:
38046 Turn on or off the agent as a helper to perform some debugging operations
38047 delegated from @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Control Agent}).
38049 @item QAllow:@var{op}:@var{val}@dots{}
38050 @cindex @samp{QAllow} packet
38051 Specify which operations @value{GDBN} expects to request of the
38052 target, as a semicolon-separated list of operation name and value
38053 pairs. Possible values for @var{op} include @samp{WriteReg},
38054 @samp{WriteMem}, @samp{InsertBreak}, @samp{InsertTrace},
38055 @samp{InsertFastTrace}, and @samp{Stop}. @var{val} is either 0,
38056 indicating that @value{GDBN} will not request the operation, or 1,
38057 indicating that it may. (The target can then use this to set up its
38058 own internals optimally, for instance if the debugger never expects to
38059 insert breakpoints, it may not need to install its own trap handler.)
38062 @cindex current thread, remote request
38063 @cindex @samp{qC} packet
38064 Return the current thread ID.
38068 @item QC @var{thread-id}
38069 Where @var{thread-id} is a thread ID as documented in
38070 @ref{thread-id syntax}.
38071 @item @r{(anything else)}
38072 Any other reply implies the old thread ID.
38075 @item qCRC:@var{addr},@var{length}
38076 @cindex CRC of memory block, remote request
38077 @cindex @samp{qCRC} packet
38078 Compute the CRC checksum of a block of memory using CRC-32 defined in
38079 IEEE 802.3. The CRC is computed byte at a time, taking the most
38080 significant bit of each byte first. The initial pattern code
38081 @code{0xffffffff} is used to ensure leading zeros affect the CRC.
38083 @emph{Note:} This is the same CRC used in validating separate debug
38084 files (@pxref{Separate Debug Files, , Debugging Information in Separate
38085 Files}). However the algorithm is slightly different. When validating
38086 separate debug files, the CRC is computed taking the @emph{least}
38087 significant bit of each byte first, and the final result is inverted to
38088 detect trailing zeros.
38093 An error (such as memory fault)
38094 @item C @var{crc32}
38095 The specified memory region's checksum is @var{crc32}.
38098 @item QDisableRandomization:@var{value}
38099 @cindex disable address space randomization, remote request
38100 @cindex @samp{QDisableRandomization} packet
38101 Some target operating systems will randomize the virtual address space
38102 of the inferior process as a security feature, but provide a feature
38103 to disable such randomization, e.g.@: to allow for a more deterministic
38104 debugging experience. On such systems, this packet with a @var{value}
38105 of 1 directs the target to disable address space randomization for
38106 processes subsequently started via @samp{vRun} packets, while a packet
38107 with a @var{value} of 0 tells the target to enable address space
38110 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
38115 The request succeeded.
38118 An error occurred. @var{nn} are hex digits.
38121 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QDisableRandomization} is not supported
38125 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38126 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
38127 This should only be done on targets that actually support disabling
38128 address space randomization.
38131 @itemx qsThreadInfo
38132 @cindex list active threads, remote request
38133 @cindex @samp{qfThreadInfo} packet
38134 @cindex @samp{qsThreadInfo} packet
38135 Obtain a list of all active thread IDs from the target (OS). Since there
38136 may be too many active threads to fit into one reply packet, this query
38137 works iteratively: it may require more than one query/reply sequence to
38138 obtain the entire list of threads. The first query of the sequence will
38139 be the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query; subsequent queries in the
38140 sequence will be the @samp{qsThreadInfo} query.
38142 NOTE: This packet replaces the @samp{qL} query (see below).
38146 @item m @var{thread-id}
38148 @item m @var{thread-id},@var{thread-id}@dots{}
38149 a comma-separated list of thread IDs
38151 (lower case letter @samp{L}) denotes end of list.
38154 In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or
38155 more thread IDs, separated by commas.
38156 @value{GDBN} will respond to each reply with a request for more thread
38157 ids (using the @samp{qs} form of the query), until the target responds
38158 with @samp{l} (lower-case ell, for @dfn{last}).
38159 Refer to @ref{thread-id syntax}, for the format of the @var{thread-id}
38162 @item qGetTLSAddr:@var{thread-id},@var{offset},@var{lm}
38163 @cindex get thread-local storage address, remote request
38164 @cindex @samp{qGetTLSAddr} packet
38165 Fetch the address associated with thread local storage specified
38166 by @var{thread-id}, @var{offset}, and @var{lm}.
38168 @var{thread-id} is the thread ID associated with the
38169 thread for which to fetch the TLS address. @xref{thread-id syntax}.
38171 @var{offset} is the (big endian, hex encoded) offset associated with the
38172 thread local variable. (This offset is obtained from the debug
38173 information associated with the variable.)
38175 @var{lm} is the (big endian, hex encoded) OS/ABI-specific encoding of the
38176 load module associated with the thread local storage. For example,
38177 a @sc{gnu}/Linux system will pass the link map address of the shared
38178 object associated with the thread local storage under consideration.
38179 Other operating environments may choose to represent the load module
38180 differently, so the precise meaning of this parameter will vary.
38184 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
38185 Hex encoded (big endian) bytes representing the address of the thread
38186 local storage requested.
38189 An error occurred. @var{nn} are hex digits.
38192 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qGetTLSAddr} is not supported by the stub.
38195 @item qGetTIBAddr:@var{thread-id}
38196 @cindex get thread information block address
38197 @cindex @samp{qGetTIBAddr} packet
38198 Fetch address of the Windows OS specific Thread Information Block.
38200 @var{thread-id} is the thread ID associated with the thread.
38204 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
38205 Hex encoded (big endian) bytes representing the linear address of the
38206 thread information block.
38209 An error occured. This means that either the thread was not found, or the
38210 address could not be retrieved.
38213 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qGetTIBAddr} is not supported by the stub.
38216 @item qL @var{startflag} @var{threadcount} @var{nextthread}
38217 Obtain thread information from RTOS. Where: @var{startflag} (one hex
38218 digit) is one to indicate the first query and zero to indicate a
38219 subsequent query; @var{threadcount} (two hex digits) is the maximum
38220 number of threads the response packet can contain; and @var{nextthread}
38221 (eight hex digits), for subsequent queries (@var{startflag} is zero), is
38222 returned in the response as @var{argthread}.
38224 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query instead (see above).
38228 @item qM @var{count} @var{done} @var{argthread} @var{thread}@dots{}
38229 Where: @var{count} (two hex digits) is the number of threads being
38230 returned; @var{done} (one hex digit) is zero to indicate more threads
38231 and one indicates no further threads; @var{argthreadid} (eight hex
38232 digits) is @var{nextthread} from the request packet; @var{thread}@dots{}
38233 is a sequence of thread IDs from the target. @var{threadid} (eight hex
38234 digits). See @code{remote.c:parse_threadlist_response()}.
38238 @cindex section offsets, remote request
38239 @cindex @samp{qOffsets} packet
38240 Get section offsets that the target used when relocating the downloaded
38245 @item Text=@var{xxx};Data=@var{yyy}@r{[};Bss=@var{zzz}@r{]}
38246 Relocate the @code{Text} section by @var{xxx} from its original address.
38247 Relocate the @code{Data} section by @var{yyy} from its original address.
38248 If the object file format provides segment information (e.g.@: @sc{elf}
38249 @samp{PT_LOAD} program headers), @value{GDBN} will relocate entire
38250 segments by the supplied offsets.
38252 @emph{Note: while a @code{Bss} offset may be included in the response,
38253 @value{GDBN} ignores this and instead applies the @code{Data} offset
38254 to the @code{Bss} section.}
38256 @item TextSeg=@var{xxx}@r{[};DataSeg=@var{yyy}@r{]}
38257 Relocate the first segment of the object file, which conventionally
38258 contains program code, to a starting address of @var{xxx}. If
38259 @samp{DataSeg} is specified, relocate the second segment, which
38260 conventionally contains modifiable data, to a starting address of
38261 @var{yyy}. @value{GDBN} will report an error if the object file
38262 does not contain segment information, or does not contain at least
38263 as many segments as mentioned in the reply. Extra segments are
38264 kept at fixed offsets relative to the last relocated segment.
38267 @item qP @var{mode} @var{thread-id}
38268 @cindex thread information, remote request
38269 @cindex @samp{qP} packet
38270 Returns information on @var{thread-id}. Where: @var{mode} is a hex
38271 encoded 32 bit mode; @var{thread-id} is a thread ID
38272 (@pxref{thread-id syntax}).
38274 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} query instead
38277 Reply: see @code{remote.c:remote_unpack_thread_info_response()}.
38281 @cindex non-stop mode, remote request
38282 @cindex @samp{QNonStop} packet
38284 Enter non-stop (@samp{QNonStop:1}) or all-stop (@samp{QNonStop:0}) mode.
38285 @xref{Remote Non-Stop}, for more information.
38290 The request succeeded.
38293 An error occurred. @var{nn} are hex digits.
38296 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QNonStop} is not supported by
38300 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38301 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
38302 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set non-stop} command;
38303 @pxref{Non-Stop Mode}.
38305 @item QPassSignals: @var{signal} @r{[};@var{signal}@r{]}@dots{}
38306 @cindex pass signals to inferior, remote request
38307 @cindex @samp{QPassSignals} packet
38308 @anchor{QPassSignals}
38309 Each listed @var{signal} should be passed directly to the inferior process.
38310 Signals are numbered identically to continue packets and stop replies
38311 (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}). Each @var{signal} list item should be
38312 strictly greater than the previous item. These signals do not need to stop
38313 the inferior, or be reported to @value{GDBN}. All other signals should be
38314 reported to @value{GDBN}. Multiple @samp{QPassSignals} packets do not
38315 combine; any earlier @samp{QPassSignals} list is completely replaced by the
38316 new list. This packet improves performance when using @samp{handle
38317 @var{signal} nostop noprint pass}.
38322 The request succeeded.
38325 An error occurred. @var{nn} are hex digits.
38328 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QPassSignals} is not supported by
38332 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote pass-signals}
38333 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote pass-signals}).
38334 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38335 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
38337 @item QProgramSignals: @var{signal} @r{[};@var{signal}@r{]}@dots{}
38338 @cindex signals the inferior may see, remote request
38339 @cindex @samp{QProgramSignals} packet
38340 @anchor{QProgramSignals}
38341 Each listed @var{signal} may be delivered to the inferior process.
38342 Others should be silently discarded.
38344 In some cases, the remote stub may need to decide whether to deliver a
38345 signal to the program or not without @value{GDBN} involvement. One
38346 example of that is while detaching --- the program's threads may have
38347 stopped for signals that haven't yet had a chance of being reported to
38348 @value{GDBN}, and so the remote stub can use the signal list specified
38349 by this packet to know whether to deliver or ignore those pending
38352 This does not influence whether to deliver a signal as requested by a
38353 resumption packet (@pxref{vCont packet}).
38355 Signals are numbered identically to continue packets and stop replies
38356 (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}). Each @var{signal} list item should be
38357 strictly greater than the previous item. Multiple
38358 @samp{QProgramSignals} packets do not combine; any earlier
38359 @samp{QProgramSignals} list is completely replaced by the new list.
38364 The request succeeded.
38367 An error occurred. @var{nn} are hex digits.
38370 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QProgramSignals} is not supported
38374 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote program-signals}
38375 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote program-signals}).
38376 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38377 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
38379 @item qRcmd,@var{command}
38380 @cindex execute remote command, remote request
38381 @cindex @samp{qRcmd} packet
38382 @var{command} (hex encoded) is passed to the local interpreter for
38383 execution. Invalid commands should be reported using the output
38384 string. Before the final result packet, the target may also respond
38385 with a number of intermediate @samp{O@var{output}} console output
38386 packets. @emph{Implementors should note that providing access to a
38387 stubs's interpreter may have security implications}.
38392 A command response with no output.
38394 A command response with the hex encoded output string @var{OUTPUT}.
38396 Indicate a badly formed request.
38398 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qRcmd} is not recognized.
38401 (Note that the @code{qRcmd} packet's name is separated from the
38402 command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
38403 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
38406 @item qSearch:memory:@var{address};@var{length};@var{search-pattern}
38407 @cindex searching memory, in remote debugging
38409 @cindex @samp{qSearch:memory} packet
38411 @cindex @samp{qSearch memory} packet
38412 @anchor{qSearch memory}
38413 Search @var{length} bytes at @var{address} for @var{search-pattern}.
38414 @var{address} and @var{length} are encoded in hex.
38415 @var{search-pattern} is a sequence of bytes, hex encoded.
38420 The pattern was not found.
38422 The pattern was found at @var{address}.
38424 A badly formed request or an error was encountered while searching memory.
38426 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSearch:memory} is not recognized.
38429 @item QStartNoAckMode
38430 @cindex @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet
38431 @anchor{QStartNoAckMode}
38432 Request that the remote stub disable the normal @samp{+}/@samp{-}
38433 protocol acknowledgments (@pxref{Packet Acknowledgment}).
38438 The stub has switched to no-acknowledgment mode.
38439 @value{GDBN} acknowledges this reponse,
38440 but neither the stub nor @value{GDBN} shall send or expect further
38441 @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments in the current connection.
38443 An empty reply indicates that the stub does not support no-acknowledgment mode.
38446 @item qSupported @r{[}:@var{gdbfeature} @r{[};@var{gdbfeature}@r{]}@dots{} @r{]}
38447 @cindex supported packets, remote query
38448 @cindex features of the remote protocol
38449 @cindex @samp{qSupported} packet
38450 @anchor{qSupported}
38451 Tell the remote stub about features supported by @value{GDBN}, and
38452 query the stub for features it supports. This packet allows
38453 @value{GDBN} and the remote stub to take advantage of each others'
38454 features. @samp{qSupported} also consolidates multiple feature probes
38455 at startup, to improve @value{GDBN} performance---a single larger
38456 packet performs better than multiple smaller probe packets on
38457 high-latency links. Some features may enable behavior which must not
38458 be on by default, e.g.@: because it would confuse older clients or
38459 stubs. Other features may describe packets which could be
38460 automatically probed for, but are not. These features must be
38461 reported before @value{GDBN} will use them. This ``default
38462 unsupported'' behavior is not appropriate for all packets, but it
38463 helps to keep the initial connection time under control with new
38464 versions of @value{GDBN} which support increasing numbers of packets.
38468 @item @var{stubfeature} @r{[};@var{stubfeature}@r{]}@dots{}
38469 The stub supports or does not support each returned @var{stubfeature},
38470 depending on the form of each @var{stubfeature} (see below for the
38473 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSupported} is not recognized,
38474 or that no features needed to be reported to @value{GDBN}.
38477 The allowed forms for each feature (either a @var{gdbfeature} in the
38478 @samp{qSupported} packet, or a @var{stubfeature} in the response)
38482 @item @var{name}=@var{value}
38483 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and associated
38484 with the specified @var{value}. The format of @var{value} depends
38485 on the feature, but it must not include a semicolon.
38487 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and does not
38488 need an associated value.
38490 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is not supported.
38492 The remote protocol feature @var{name} may be supported, and
38493 @value{GDBN} should auto-detect support in some other way when it is
38494 needed. This form will not be used for @var{gdbfeature} notifications,
38495 but may be used for @var{stubfeature} responses.
38498 Whenever the stub receives a @samp{qSupported} request, the
38499 supplied set of @value{GDBN} features should override any previous
38500 request. This allows @value{GDBN} to put the stub in a known
38501 state, even if the stub had previously been communicating with
38502 a different version of @value{GDBN}.
38504 The following values of @var{gdbfeature} (for the packet sent by @value{GDBN})
38509 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports multiprocess
38510 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
38511 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
38512 including @samp{multiprocess+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
38513 @xref{multiprocess extensions}, for details.
38516 This feature indicates that @value{GDBN} supports the XML target
38517 description. If the stub sees @samp{xmlRegisters=} with target
38518 specific strings separated by a comma, it will report register
38522 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports the
38523 @samp{qRelocInsn} packet (@pxref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate
38524 instruction reply packet}).
38527 Stubs should ignore any unknown values for
38528 @var{gdbfeature}. Any @value{GDBN} which sends a @samp{qSupported}
38529 packet supports receiving packets of unlimited length (earlier
38530 versions of @value{GDBN} may reject overly long responses). Additional values
38531 for @var{gdbfeature} may be defined in the future to let the stub take
38532 advantage of new features in @value{GDBN}, e.g.@: incompatible
38533 improvements in the remote protocol---the @samp{multiprocess} feature is
38534 an example of such a feature. The stub's reply should be independent
38535 of the @var{gdbfeature} entries sent by @value{GDBN}; first @value{GDBN}
38536 describes all the features it supports, and then the stub replies with
38537 all the features it supports.
38539 Similarly, @value{GDBN} will silently ignore unrecognized stub feature
38540 responses, as long as each response uses one of the standard forms.
38542 Some features are flags. A stub which supports a flag feature
38543 should respond with a @samp{+} form response. Other features
38544 require values, and the stub should respond with an @samp{=}
38547 Each feature has a default value, which @value{GDBN} will use if
38548 @samp{qSupported} is not available or if the feature is not mentioned
38549 in the @samp{qSupported} response. The default values are fixed; a
38550 stub is free to omit any feature responses that match the defaults.
38552 Not all features can be probed, but for those which can, the probing
38553 mechanism is useful: in some cases, a stub's internal
38554 architecture may not allow the protocol layer to know some information
38555 about the underlying target in advance. This is especially common in
38556 stubs which may be configured for multiple targets.
38558 These are the currently defined stub features and their properties:
38560 @multitable @columnfractions 0.35 0.2 0.12 0.2
38561 @c NOTE: The first row should be @headitem, but we do not yet require
38562 @c a new enough version of Texinfo (4.7) to use @headitem.
38564 @tab Value Required
38568 @item @samp{PacketSize}
38573 @item @samp{qXfer:auxv:read}
38578 @item @samp{qXfer:btrace:read}
38583 @item @samp{qXfer:features:read}
38588 @item @samp{qXfer:libraries:read}
38593 @item @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
38598 @item @samp{qXfer:sdata:read}
38603 @item @samp{qXfer:spu:read}
38608 @item @samp{qXfer:spu:write}
38613 @item @samp{qXfer:siginfo:read}
38618 @item @samp{qXfer:siginfo:write}
38623 @item @samp{qXfer:threads:read}
38628 @item @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
38633 @item @samp{qXfer:uib:read}
38638 @item @samp{qXfer:fdpic:read}
38643 @item @samp{Qbtrace:off}
38648 @item @samp{Qbtrace:bts}
38653 @item @samp{QNonStop}
38658 @item @samp{QPassSignals}
38663 @item @samp{QStartNoAckMode}
38668 @item @samp{multiprocess}
38673 @item @samp{ConditionalBreakpoints}
38678 @item @samp{ConditionalTracepoints}
38683 @item @samp{ReverseContinue}
38688 @item @samp{ReverseStep}
38693 @item @samp{TracepointSource}
38698 @item @samp{QAgent}
38703 @item @samp{QAllow}
38708 @item @samp{QDisableRandomization}
38713 @item @samp{EnableDisableTracepoints}
38718 @item @samp{QTBuffer:size}
38723 @item @samp{tracenz}
38728 @item @samp{BreakpointCommands}
38735 These are the currently defined stub features, in more detail:
38738 @cindex packet size, remote protocol
38739 @item PacketSize=@var{bytes}
38740 The remote stub can accept packets up to at least @var{bytes} in
38741 length. @value{GDBN} will send packets up to this size for bulk
38742 transfers, and will never send larger packets. This is a limit on the
38743 data characters in the packet, including the frame and checksum.
38744 There is no trailing NUL byte in a remote protocol packet; if the stub
38745 stores packets in a NUL-terminated format, it should allow an extra
38746 byte in its buffer for the NUL. If this stub feature is not supported,
38747 @value{GDBN} guesses based on the size of the @samp{g} packet response.
38749 @item qXfer:auxv:read
38750 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet
38751 (@pxref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}).
38753 @item qXfer:btrace:read
38754 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:btrace:read}
38755 packet (@pxref{qXfer btrace read}).
38757 @item qXfer:features:read
38758 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:features:read} packet
38759 (@pxref{qXfer target description read}).
38761 @item qXfer:libraries:read
38762 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet
38763 (@pxref{qXfer library list read}).
38765 @item qXfer:libraries-svr4:read
38766 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read} packet
38767 (@pxref{qXfer svr4 library list read}).
38769 @item qXfer:memory-map:read
38770 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read} packet
38771 (@pxref{qXfer memory map read}).
38773 @item qXfer:sdata:read
38774 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:sdata:read} packet
38775 (@pxref{qXfer sdata read}).
38777 @item qXfer:spu:read
38778 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:spu:read} packet
38779 (@pxref{qXfer spu read}).
38781 @item qXfer:spu:write
38782 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:spu:write} packet
38783 (@pxref{qXfer spu write}).
38785 @item qXfer:siginfo:read
38786 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:siginfo:read} packet
38787 (@pxref{qXfer siginfo read}).
38789 @item qXfer:siginfo:write
38790 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:siginfo:write} packet
38791 (@pxref{qXfer siginfo write}).
38793 @item qXfer:threads:read
38794 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:threads:read} packet
38795 (@pxref{qXfer threads read}).
38797 @item qXfer:traceframe-info:read
38798 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
38799 packet (@pxref{qXfer traceframe info read}).
38801 @item qXfer:uib:read
38802 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:uib:read}
38803 packet (@pxref{qXfer unwind info block}).
38805 @item qXfer:fdpic:read
38806 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:fdpic:read}
38807 packet (@pxref{qXfer fdpic loadmap read}).
38810 The remote stub understands the @samp{QNonStop} packet
38811 (@pxref{QNonStop}).
38814 The remote stub understands the @samp{QPassSignals} packet
38815 (@pxref{QPassSignals}).
38817 @item QStartNoAckMode
38818 The remote stub understands the @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet and
38819 prefers to operate in no-acknowledgment mode. @xref{Packet Acknowledgment}.
38822 @anchor{multiprocess extensions}
38823 @cindex multiprocess extensions, in remote protocol
38824 The remote stub understands the multiprocess extensions to the remote
38825 protocol syntax. The multiprocess extensions affect the syntax of
38826 thread IDs in both packets and replies (@pxref{thread-id syntax}), and
38827 add process IDs to the @samp{D} packet and @samp{W} and @samp{X}
38828 replies. Note that reporting this feature indicates support for the
38829 syntactic extensions only, not that the stub necessarily supports
38830 debugging of more than one process at a time. The stub must not use
38831 multiprocess extensions in packet replies unless @value{GDBN} has also
38832 indicated it supports them in its @samp{qSupported} request.
38834 @item qXfer:osdata:read
38835 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:osdata:read} packet
38836 ((@pxref{qXfer osdata read}).
38838 @item ConditionalBreakpoints
38839 The target accepts and implements evaluation of conditional expressions
38840 defined for breakpoints. The target will only report breakpoint triggers
38841 when such conditions are true (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
38843 @item ConditionalTracepoints
38844 The remote stub accepts and implements conditional expressions defined
38845 for tracepoints (@pxref{Tracepoint Conditions}).
38847 @item ReverseContinue
38848 The remote stub accepts and implements the reverse continue packet
38852 The remote stub accepts and implements the reverse step packet
38855 @item TracepointSource
38856 The remote stub understands the @samp{QTDPsrc} packet that supplies
38857 the source form of tracepoint definitions.
38860 The remote stub understands the @samp{QAgent} packet.
38863 The remote stub understands the @samp{QAllow} packet.
38865 @item QDisableRandomization
38866 The remote stub understands the @samp{QDisableRandomization} packet.
38868 @item StaticTracepoint
38869 @cindex static tracepoints, in remote protocol
38870 The remote stub supports static tracepoints.
38872 @item InstallInTrace
38873 @anchor{install tracepoint in tracing}
38874 The remote stub supports installing tracepoint in tracing.
38876 @item EnableDisableTracepoints
38877 The remote stub supports the @samp{QTEnable} (@pxref{QTEnable}) and
38878 @samp{QTDisable} (@pxref{QTDisable}) packets that allow tracepoints
38879 to be enabled and disabled while a trace experiment is running.
38881 @item QTBuffer:size
38882 The remote stub supports the @samp{QTBuffer:size} (@pxref{QTBuffer-size})
38883 packet that allows to change the size of the trace buffer.
38886 @cindex string tracing, in remote protocol
38887 The remote stub supports the @samp{tracenz} bytecode for collecting strings.
38888 See @ref{Bytecode Descriptions} for details about the bytecode.
38890 @item BreakpointCommands
38891 @cindex breakpoint commands, in remote protocol
38892 The remote stub supports running a breakpoint's command list itself,
38893 rather than reporting the hit to @value{GDBN}.
38896 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace:off} packet.
38899 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace:bts} packet.
38904 @cindex symbol lookup, remote request
38905 @cindex @samp{qSymbol} packet
38906 Notify the target that @value{GDBN} is prepared to serve symbol lookup
38907 requests. Accept requests from the target for the values of symbols.
38912 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
38913 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
38914 The target requests the value of symbol @var{sym_name} (hex encoded).
38915 @value{GDBN} may provide the value by using the
38916 @samp{qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}} message, described
38920 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}
38921 Set the value of @var{sym_name} to @var{sym_value}.
38923 @var{sym_name} (hex encoded) is the name of a symbol whose value the
38924 target has previously requested.
38926 @var{sym_value} (hex) is the value for symbol @var{sym_name}. If
38927 @value{GDBN} cannot supply a value for @var{sym_name}, then this field
38933 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
38934 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
38935 The target requests the value of a new symbol @var{sym_name} (hex
38936 encoded). @value{GDBN} will continue to supply the values of symbols
38937 (if available), until the target ceases to request them.
38942 @itemx QTDisconnected
38949 @itemx qTMinFTPILen
38951 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
38953 @item qThreadExtraInfo,@var{thread-id}
38954 @cindex thread attributes info, remote request
38955 @cindex @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} packet
38956 Obtain a printable string description of a thread's attributes from
38957 the target OS. @var{thread-id} is a thread ID;
38958 see @ref{thread-id syntax}. This
38959 string may contain anything that the target OS thinks is interesting
38960 for @value{GDBN} to tell the user about the thread. The string is
38961 displayed in @value{GDBN}'s @code{info threads} display. Some
38962 examples of possible thread extra info strings are @samp{Runnable}, or
38963 @samp{Blocked on Mutex}.
38967 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
38968 Where @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is a hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data,
38969 comprising the printable string containing the extra information about
38970 the thread's attributes.
38973 (Note that the @code{qThreadExtraInfo} packet's name is separated from
38974 the command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
38975 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
38994 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
38996 @item qXfer:@var{object}:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
38997 @cindex read special object, remote request
38998 @cindex @samp{qXfer} packet
38999 @anchor{qXfer read}
39000 Read uninterpreted bytes from the target's special data area
39001 identified by the keyword @var{object}. Request @var{length} bytes
39002 starting at @var{offset} bytes into the data. The content and
39003 encoding of @var{annex} is specific to @var{object}; it can supply
39004 additional details about what data to access.
39006 Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All
39007 @samp{qXfer:@var{object}:read:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
39008 formats, listed below.
39011 @item qXfer:auxv:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
39012 @anchor{qXfer auxiliary vector read}
39013 Access the target's @dfn{auxiliary vector}. @xref{OS Information,
39014 auxiliary vector}. Note @var{annex} must be empty.
39016 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39017 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39019 @item qXfer:btrace:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
39020 @anchor{qXfer btrace read}
39022 Return a description of the current branch trace.
39023 @xref{Branch Trace Format}. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer}
39024 packet may have one of the following values:
39028 Returns all available branch trace.
39031 Returns all available branch trace if the branch trace changed since
39032 the last read request.
39035 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it
39036 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39038 @item qXfer:features:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
39039 @anchor{qXfer target description read}
39040 Access the @dfn{target description}. @xref{Target Descriptions}. The
39041 annex specifies which XML document to access. The main description is
39042 always loaded from the @samp{target.xml} annex.
39044 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39045 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39047 @item qXfer:libraries:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
39048 @anchor{qXfer library list read}
39049 Access the target's list of loaded libraries. @xref{Library List Format}.
39050 The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
39051 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
39053 Targets which maintain a list of libraries in the program's memory do
39054 not need to implement this packet; it is designed for platforms where
39055 the operating system manages the list of loaded libraries.
39057 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39058 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39060 @item qXfer:libraries-svr4:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
39061 @anchor{qXfer svr4 library list read}
39062 Access the target's list of loaded libraries when the target is an SVR4
39063 platform. @xref{Library List Format for SVR4 Targets}. The annex part
39064 of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty (@pxref{qXfer read}).
39066 This packet is optional for better performance on SVR4 targets.
39067 @value{GDBN} uses memory read packets to read the SVR4 library list otherwise.
39069 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39070 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39072 @item qXfer:memory-map:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
39073 @anchor{qXfer memory map read}
39074 Access the target's @dfn{memory-map}. @xref{Memory Map Format}. The
39075 annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
39076 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
39078 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39079 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39081 @item qXfer:sdata:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
39082 @anchor{qXfer sdata read}
39084 Read contents of the extra collected static tracepoint marker
39085 information. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must
39086 be empty (@pxref{qXfer read}). @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint
39089 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39090 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
39091 (@pxref{qSupported}).
39093 @item qXfer:siginfo:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
39094 @anchor{qXfer siginfo read}
39095 Read contents of the extra signal information on the target
39096 system. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be
39097 empty (@pxref{qXfer read}).
39099 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39100 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
39101 (@pxref{qSupported}).
39103 @item qXfer:spu:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
39104 @anchor{qXfer spu read}
39105 Read contents of an @code{spufs} file on the target system. The
39106 annex specifies which file to read; it must be of the form
39107 @file{@var{id}/@var{name}}, where @var{id} specifies an SPU context ID
39108 in the target process, and @var{name} identifes the @code{spufs} file
39109 in that context to be accessed.
39111 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39112 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
39113 (@pxref{qSupported}).
39115 @item qXfer:threads:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
39116 @anchor{qXfer threads read}
39117 Access the list of threads on target. @xref{Thread List Format}. The
39118 annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
39119 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
39121 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39122 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39124 @item qXfer:traceframe-info:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
39125 @anchor{qXfer traceframe info read}
39127 Return a description of the current traceframe's contents.
39128 @xref{Traceframe Info Format}. The annex part of the generic
39129 @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty (@pxref{qXfer read}).
39131 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39132 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39134 @item qXfer:uib:read:@var{pc}:@var{offset},@var{length}
39135 @anchor{qXfer unwind info block}
39137 Return the unwind information block for @var{pc}. This packet is used
39138 on OpenVMS/ia64 to ask the kernel unwind information.
39140 This packet is not probed by default.
39142 @item qXfer:fdpic:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
39143 @anchor{qXfer fdpic loadmap read}
39144 Read contents of @code{loadmap}s on the target system. The
39145 annex, either @samp{exec} or @samp{interp}, specifies which @code{loadmap},
39146 executable @code{loadmap} or interpreter @code{loadmap} to read.
39148 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39149 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39151 @item qXfer:osdata:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
39152 @anchor{qXfer osdata read}
39153 Access the target's @dfn{operating system information}.
39154 @xref{Operating System Information}.
39161 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the
39162 target. There may be more data at a higher address (although
39163 it is permitted to return @samp{m} even for the last valid
39164 block of data, as long as at least one byte of data was read).
39165 @var{data} may have fewer bytes than the @var{length} in the
39169 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the target.
39170 There is no more data to be read. @var{data} may have fewer bytes
39171 than the @var{length} in the request.
39174 The @var{offset} in the request is at the end of the data.
39175 There is no more data to be read.
39178 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
39181 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered reading the data.
39182 @var{nn} is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
39185 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not recognized by
39186 the stub, or that the object does not support reading.
39189 @item qXfer:@var{object}:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
39190 @cindex write data into object, remote request
39191 @anchor{qXfer write}
39192 Write uninterpreted bytes into the target's special data area
39193 identified by the keyword @var{object}, starting at @var{offset} bytes
39194 into the data. @var{data}@dots{} is the binary-encoded data
39195 (@pxref{Binary Data}) to be written. The content and encoding of @var{annex}
39196 is specific to @var{object}; it can supply additional details about what data
39199 Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All
39200 @samp{qXfer:@var{object}:write:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
39201 formats, listed below.
39204 @item qXfer:siginfo:write::@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
39205 @anchor{qXfer siginfo write}
39206 Write @var{data} to the extra signal information on the target system.
39207 The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be
39208 empty (@pxref{qXfer write}).
39210 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39211 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
39212 (@pxref{qSupported}).
39214 @item qXfer:spu:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
39215 @anchor{qXfer spu write}
39216 Write @var{data} to an @code{spufs} file on the target system. The
39217 annex specifies which file to write; it must be of the form
39218 @file{@var{id}/@var{name}}, where @var{id} specifies an SPU context ID
39219 in the target process, and @var{name} identifes the @code{spufs} file
39220 in that context to be accessed.
39222 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39223 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39229 @var{nn} (hex encoded) is the number of bytes written.
39230 This may be fewer bytes than supplied in the request.
39233 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
39236 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered writing the data.
39237 @var{nn} is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
39240 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not
39241 recognized by the stub, or that the object does not support writing.
39244 @item qXfer:@var{object}:@var{operation}:@dots{}
39245 Requests of this form may be added in the future. When a stub does
39246 not recognize the @var{object} keyword, or its support for
39247 @var{object} does not recognize the @var{operation} keyword, the stub
39248 must respond with an empty packet.
39250 @item qAttached:@var{pid}
39251 @cindex query attached, remote request
39252 @cindex @samp{qAttached} packet
39253 Return an indication of whether the remote server attached to an
39254 existing process or created a new process. When the multiprocess
39255 protocol extensions are supported (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}),
39256 @var{pid} is an integer in hexadecimal format identifying the target
39257 process. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} will omit the @var{pid} field and
39258 the query packet will be simplified as @samp{qAttached}.
39260 This query is used, for example, to know whether the remote process
39261 should be detached or killed when a @value{GDBN} session is ended with
39262 the @code{quit} command.
39267 The remote server attached to an existing process.
39269 The remote server created a new process.
39271 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
39275 Enable branch tracing for the current thread using bts tracing.
39280 Branch tracing has been enabled.
39282 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
39286 Disable branch tracing for the current thread.
39291 Branch tracing has been disabled.
39293 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
39298 @node Architecture-Specific Protocol Details
39299 @section Architecture-Specific Protocol Details
39301 This section describes how the remote protocol is applied to specific
39302 target architectures. Also see @ref{Standard Target Features}, for
39303 details of XML target descriptions for each architecture.
39306 * ARM-Specific Protocol Details::
39307 * MIPS-Specific Protocol Details::
39310 @node ARM-Specific Protocol Details
39311 @subsection @acronym{ARM}-specific Protocol Details
39314 * ARM Breakpoint Kinds::
39317 @node ARM Breakpoint Kinds
39318 @subsubsection @acronym{ARM} Breakpoint Kinds
39319 @cindex breakpoint kinds, @acronym{ARM}
39321 These breakpoint kinds are defined for the @samp{Z0} and @samp{Z1} packets.
39326 16-bit Thumb mode breakpoint.
39329 32-bit Thumb mode (Thumb-2) breakpoint.
39332 32-bit @acronym{ARM} mode breakpoint.
39336 @node MIPS-Specific Protocol Details
39337 @subsection @acronym{MIPS}-specific Protocol Details
39340 * MIPS Register packet Format::
39341 * MIPS Breakpoint Kinds::
39344 @node MIPS Register packet Format
39345 @subsubsection @acronym{MIPS} Register Packet Format
39346 @cindex register packet format, @acronym{MIPS}
39348 The following @code{g}/@code{G} packets have previously been defined.
39349 In the below, some thirty-two bit registers are transferred as
39350 sixty-four bits. Those registers should be zero/sign extended (which?)
39351 to fill the space allocated. Register bytes are transferred in target
39352 byte order. The two nibbles within a register byte are transferred
39353 most-significant -- least-significant.
39358 All registers are transferred as thirty-two bit quantities in the order:
39359 32 general-purpose; sr; lo; hi; bad; cause; pc; 32 floating-point
39360 registers; fsr; fir; fp.
39363 All registers are transferred as sixty-four bit quantities (including
39364 thirty-two bit registers such as @code{sr}). The ordering is the same
39369 @node MIPS Breakpoint Kinds
39370 @subsubsection @acronym{MIPS} Breakpoint Kinds
39371 @cindex breakpoint kinds, @acronym{MIPS}
39373 These breakpoint kinds are defined for the @samp{Z0} and @samp{Z1} packets.
39378 16-bit @acronym{MIPS16} mode breakpoint.
39381 16-bit @acronym{microMIPS} mode breakpoint.
39384 32-bit standard @acronym{MIPS} mode breakpoint.
39387 32-bit @acronym{microMIPS} mode breakpoint.
39391 @node Tracepoint Packets
39392 @section Tracepoint Packets
39393 @cindex tracepoint packets
39394 @cindex packets, tracepoint
39396 Here we describe the packets @value{GDBN} uses to implement
39397 tracepoints (@pxref{Tracepoints}).
39401 @item QTDP:@var{n}:@var{addr}:@var{ena}:@var{step}:@var{pass}[:F@var{flen}][:X@var{len},@var{bytes}]@r{[}-@r{]}
39402 @cindex @samp{QTDP} packet
39403 Create a new tracepoint, number @var{n}, at @var{addr}. If @var{ena}
39404 is @samp{E}, then the tracepoint is enabled; if it is @samp{D}, then
39405 the tracepoint is disabled. @var{step} is the tracepoint's step
39406 count, and @var{pass} is its pass count. If an @samp{F} is present,
39407 then the tracepoint is to be a fast tracepoint, and the @var{flen} is
39408 the number of bytes that the target should copy elsewhere to make room
39409 for the tracepoint. If an @samp{X} is present, it introduces a
39410 tracepoint condition, which consists of a hexadecimal length, followed
39411 by a comma and hex-encoded bytes, in a manner similar to action
39412 encodings as described below. If the trailing @samp{-} is present,
39413 further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow to specify this tracepoint's
39419 The packet was understood and carried out.
39421 @xref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate instruction reply packet}.
39423 The packet was not recognized.
39426 @item QTDP:-@var{n}:@var{addr}:@r{[}S@r{]}@var{action}@dots{}@r{[}-@r{]}
39427 Define actions to be taken when a tracepoint is hit. @var{n} and
39428 @var{addr} must be the same as in the initial @samp{QTDP} packet for
39429 this tracepoint. This packet may only be sent immediately after
39430 another @samp{QTDP} packet that ended with a @samp{-}. If the
39431 trailing @samp{-} is present, further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow,
39432 specifying more actions for this tracepoint.
39434 In the series of action packets for a given tracepoint, at most one
39435 can have an @samp{S} before its first @var{action}. If such a packet
39436 is sent, it and the following packets define ``while-stepping''
39437 actions. Any prior packets define ordinary actions --- that is, those
39438 taken when the tracepoint is first hit. If no action packet has an
39439 @samp{S}, then all the packets in the series specify ordinary
39440 tracepoint actions.
39442 The @samp{@var{action}@dots{}} portion of the packet is a series of
39443 actions, concatenated without separators. Each action has one of the
39449 Collect the registers whose bits are set in @var{mask}. @var{mask} is
39450 a hexadecimal number whose @var{i}'th bit is set if register number
39451 @var{i} should be collected. (The least significant bit is numbered
39452 zero.) Note that @var{mask} may be any number of digits long; it may
39453 not fit in a 32-bit word.
39455 @item M @var{basereg},@var{offset},@var{len}
39456 Collect @var{len} bytes of memory starting at the address in register
39457 number @var{basereg}, plus @var{offset}. If @var{basereg} is
39458 @samp{-1}, then the range has a fixed address: @var{offset} is the
39459 address of the lowest byte to collect. The @var{basereg},
39460 @var{offset}, and @var{len} parameters are all unsigned hexadecimal
39461 values (the @samp{-1} value for @var{basereg} is a special case).
39463 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
39464 Evaluate @var{expr}, whose length is @var{len}, and collect memory as
39465 it directs. @var{expr} is an agent expression, as described in
39466 @ref{Agent Expressions}. Each byte of the expression is encoded as a
39467 two-digit hex number in the packet; @var{len} is the number of bytes
39468 in the expression (and thus one-half the number of hex digits in the
39473 Any number of actions may be packed together in a single @samp{QTDP}
39474 packet, as long as the packet does not exceed the maximum packet
39475 length (400 bytes, for many stubs). There may be only one @samp{R}
39476 action per tracepoint, and it must precede any @samp{M} or @samp{X}
39477 actions. Any registers referred to by @samp{M} and @samp{X} actions
39478 must be collected by a preceding @samp{R} action. (The
39479 ``while-stepping'' actions are treated as if they were attached to a
39480 separate tracepoint, as far as these restrictions are concerned.)
39485 The packet was understood and carried out.
39487 @xref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate instruction reply packet}.
39489 The packet was not recognized.
39492 @item QTDPsrc:@var{n}:@var{addr}:@var{type}:@var{start}:@var{slen}:@var{bytes}
39493 @cindex @samp{QTDPsrc} packet
39494 Specify a source string of tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr}.
39495 This is useful to get accurate reproduction of the tracepoints
39496 originally downloaded at the beginning of the trace run. @var{type}
39497 is the name of the tracepoint part, such as @samp{cond} for the
39498 tracepoint's conditional expression (see below for a list of types), while
39499 @var{bytes} is the string, encoded in hexadecimal.
39501 @var{start} is the offset of the @var{bytes} within the overall source
39502 string, while @var{slen} is the total length of the source string.
39503 This is intended for handling source strings that are longer than will
39504 fit in a single packet.
39505 @c Add detailed example when this info is moved into a dedicated
39506 @c tracepoint descriptions section.
39508 The available string types are @samp{at} for the location,
39509 @samp{cond} for the conditional, and @samp{cmd} for an action command.
39510 @value{GDBN} sends a separate packet for each command in the action
39511 list, in the same order in which the commands are stored in the list.
39513 The target does not need to do anything with source strings except
39514 report them back as part of the replies to the @samp{qTfP}/@samp{qTsP}
39517 Although this packet is optional, and @value{GDBN} will only send it
39518 if the target replies with @samp{TracepointSource} @xref{General
39519 Query Packets}, it makes both disconnected tracing and trace files
39520 much easier to use. Otherwise the user must be careful that the
39521 tracepoints in effect while looking at trace frames are identical to
39522 the ones in effect during the trace run; even a small discrepancy
39523 could cause @samp{tdump} not to work, or a particular trace frame not
39526 @item QTDV:@var{n}:@var{value}
39527 @cindex define trace state variable, remote request
39528 @cindex @samp{QTDV} packet
39529 Create a new trace state variable, number @var{n}, with an initial
39530 value of @var{value}, which is a 64-bit signed integer. Both @var{n}
39531 and @var{value} are encoded as hexadecimal values. @value{GDBN} has
39532 the option of not using this packet for initial values of zero; the
39533 target should simply create the trace state variables as they are
39534 mentioned in expressions.
39536 @item QTFrame:@var{n}
39537 @cindex @samp{QTFrame} packet
39538 Select the @var{n}'th tracepoint frame from the buffer, and use the
39539 register and memory contents recorded there to answer subsequent
39540 request packets from @value{GDBN}.
39542 A successful reply from the stub indicates that the stub has found the
39543 requested frame. The response is a series of parts, concatenated
39544 without separators, describing the frame we selected. Each part has
39545 one of the following forms:
39549 The selected frame is number @var{n} in the trace frame buffer;
39550 @var{f} is a hexadecimal number. If @var{f} is @samp{-1}, then there
39551 was no frame matching the criteria in the request packet.
39554 The selected trace frame records a hit of tracepoint number @var{t};
39555 @var{t} is a hexadecimal number.
39559 @item QTFrame:pc:@var{addr}
39560 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
39561 currently selected frame whose PC is @var{addr};
39562 @var{addr} is a hexadecimal number.
39564 @item QTFrame:tdp:@var{t}
39565 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
39566 currently selected frame that is a hit of tracepoint @var{t}; @var{t}
39567 is a hexadecimal number.
39569 @item QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}
39570 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
39571 currently selected frame whose PC is between @var{start} (inclusive)
39572 and @var{end} (inclusive); @var{start} and @var{end} are hexadecimal
39575 @item QTFrame:outside:@var{start}:@var{end}
39576 Like @samp{QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}}, but select the first
39577 frame @emph{outside} the given range of addresses (exclusive).
39580 @cindex @samp{qTMinFTPILen} packet
39581 This packet requests the minimum length of instruction at which a fast
39582 tracepoint (@pxref{Set Tracepoints}) may be placed. For instance, on
39583 the 32-bit x86 architecture, it is possible to use a 4-byte jump, but
39584 it depends on the target system being able to create trampolines in
39585 the first 64K of memory, which might or might not be possible for that
39586 system. So the reply to this packet will be 4 if it is able to
39593 The minimum instruction length is currently unknown.
39595 The minimum instruction length is @var{length}, where @var{length} is greater
39596 or equal to 1. @var{length} is a hexadecimal number. A reply of 1 means
39597 that a fast tracepoint may be placed on any instruction regardless of size.
39599 An error has occurred.
39601 An empty reply indicates that the request is not supported by the stub.
39605 @cindex @samp{QTStart} packet
39606 Begin the tracepoint experiment. Begin collecting data from
39607 tracepoint hits in the trace frame buffer. This packet supports the
39608 @samp{qRelocInsn} reply (@pxref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate
39609 instruction reply packet}).
39612 @cindex @samp{QTStop} packet
39613 End the tracepoint experiment. Stop collecting trace frames.
39615 @item QTEnable:@var{n}:@var{addr}
39617 @cindex @samp{QTEnable} packet
39618 Enable tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr} in a started tracepoint
39619 experiment. If the tracepoint was previously disabled, then collection
39620 of data from it will resume.
39622 @item QTDisable:@var{n}:@var{addr}
39624 @cindex @samp{QTDisable} packet
39625 Disable tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr} in a started tracepoint
39626 experiment. No more data will be collected from the tracepoint unless
39627 @samp{QTEnable:@var{n}:@var{addr}} is subsequently issued.
39630 @cindex @samp{QTinit} packet
39631 Clear the table of tracepoints, and empty the trace frame buffer.
39633 @item QTro:@var{start1},@var{end1}:@var{start2},@var{end2}:@dots{}
39634 @cindex @samp{QTro} packet
39635 Establish the given ranges of memory as ``transparent''. The stub
39636 will answer requests for these ranges from memory's current contents,
39637 if they were not collected as part of the tracepoint hit.
39639 @value{GDBN} uses this to mark read-only regions of memory, like those
39640 containing program code. Since these areas never change, they should
39641 still have the same contents they did when the tracepoint was hit, so
39642 there's no reason for the stub to refuse to provide their contents.
39644 @item QTDisconnected:@var{value}
39645 @cindex @samp{QTDisconnected} packet
39646 Set the choice to what to do with the tracing run when @value{GDBN}
39647 disconnects from the target. A @var{value} of 1 directs the target to
39648 continue the tracing run, while 0 tells the target to stop tracing if
39649 @value{GDBN} is no longer in the picture.
39652 @cindex @samp{qTStatus} packet
39653 Ask the stub if there is a trace experiment running right now.
39655 The reply has the form:
39659 @item T@var{running}@r{[};@var{field}@r{]}@dots{}
39660 @var{running} is a single digit @code{1} if the trace is presently
39661 running, or @code{0} if not. It is followed by semicolon-separated
39662 optional fields that an agent may use to report additional status.
39666 If the trace is not running, the agent may report any of several
39667 explanations as one of the optional fields:
39672 No trace has been run yet.
39674 @item tstop[:@var{text}]:0
39675 The trace was stopped by a user-originated stop command. The optional
39676 @var{text} field is a user-supplied string supplied as part of the
39677 stop command (for instance, an explanation of why the trace was
39678 stopped manually). It is hex-encoded.
39681 The trace stopped because the trace buffer filled up.
39683 @item tdisconnected:0
39684 The trace stopped because @value{GDBN} disconnected from the target.
39686 @item tpasscount:@var{tpnum}
39687 The trace stopped because tracepoint @var{tpnum} exceeded its pass count.
39689 @item terror:@var{text}:@var{tpnum}
39690 The trace stopped because tracepoint @var{tpnum} had an error. The
39691 string @var{text} is available to describe the nature of the error
39692 (for instance, a divide by zero in the condition expression).
39693 @var{text} is hex encoded.
39696 The trace stopped for some other reason.
39700 Additional optional fields supply statistical and other information.
39701 Although not required, they are extremely useful for users monitoring
39702 the progress of a trace run. If a trace has stopped, and these
39703 numbers are reported, they must reflect the state of the just-stopped
39708 @item tframes:@var{n}
39709 The number of trace frames in the buffer.
39711 @item tcreated:@var{n}
39712 The total number of trace frames created during the run. This may
39713 be larger than the trace frame count, if the buffer is circular.
39715 @item tsize:@var{n}
39716 The total size of the trace buffer, in bytes.
39718 @item tfree:@var{n}
39719 The number of bytes still unused in the buffer.
39721 @item circular:@var{n}
39722 The value of the circular trace buffer flag. @code{1} means that the
39723 trace buffer is circular and old trace frames will be discarded if
39724 necessary to make room, @code{0} means that the trace buffer is linear
39727 @item disconn:@var{n}
39728 The value of the disconnected tracing flag. @code{1} means that
39729 tracing will continue after @value{GDBN} disconnects, @code{0} means
39730 that the trace run will stop.
39734 @item qTP:@var{tp}:@var{addr}
39735 @cindex tracepoint status, remote request
39736 @cindex @samp{qTP} packet
39737 Ask the stub for the current state of tracepoint number @var{tp} at
39738 address @var{addr}.
39742 @item V@var{hits}:@var{usage}
39743 The tracepoint has been hit @var{hits} times so far during the trace
39744 run, and accounts for @var{usage} in the trace buffer. Note that
39745 @code{while-stepping} steps are not counted as separate hits, but the
39746 steps' space consumption is added into the usage number.
39750 @item qTV:@var{var}
39751 @cindex trace state variable value, remote request
39752 @cindex @samp{qTV} packet
39753 Ask the stub for the value of the trace state variable number @var{var}.
39758 The value of the variable is @var{value}. This will be the current
39759 value of the variable if the user is examining a running target, or a
39760 saved value if the variable was collected in the trace frame that the
39761 user is looking at. Note that multiple requests may result in
39762 different reply values, such as when requesting values while the
39763 program is running.
39766 The value of the variable is unknown. This would occur, for example,
39767 if the user is examining a trace frame in which the requested variable
39772 @cindex @samp{qTfP} packet
39774 @cindex @samp{qTsP} packet
39775 These packets request data about tracepoints that are being used by
39776 the target. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfP} to get the first piece
39777 of data, and multiple @code{qTsP} to get additional pieces. Replies
39778 to these packets generally take the form of the @code{QTDP} packets
39779 that define tracepoints. (FIXME add detailed syntax)
39782 @cindex @samp{qTfV} packet
39784 @cindex @samp{qTsV} packet
39785 These packets request data about trace state variables that are on the
39786 target. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfV} to get the first vari of data,
39787 and multiple @code{qTsV} to get additional variables. Replies to
39788 these packets follow the syntax of the @code{QTDV} packets that define
39789 trace state variables.
39795 @cindex @samp{qTfSTM} packet
39796 @cindex @samp{qTsSTM} packet
39797 These packets request data about static tracepoint markers that exist
39798 in the target program. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfSTM} to get the
39799 first piece of data, and multiple @code{qTsSTM} to get additional
39800 pieces. Replies to these packets take the following form:
39804 @item m @var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra}
39806 @item m @var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra},@var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra}@dots{}
39807 a comma-separated list of markers
39809 (lower case letter @samp{L}) denotes end of list.
39811 An error occurred. @var{nn} are hex digits.
39813 An empty reply indicates that the request is not supported by the
39817 @var{address} is encoded in hex.
39818 @var{id} and @var{extra} are strings encoded in hex.
39820 In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or
39821 more markers, separated by commas. @value{GDBN} will respond to each
39822 reply with a request for more markers (using the @samp{qs} form of the
39823 query), until the target responds with @samp{l} (lower-case ell, for
39826 @item qTSTMat:@var{address}
39828 @cindex @samp{qTSTMat} packet
39829 This packets requests data about static tracepoint markers in the
39830 target program at @var{address}. Replies to this packet follow the
39831 syntax of the @samp{qTfSTM} and @code{qTsSTM} packets that list static
39832 tracepoint markers.
39834 @item QTSave:@var{filename}
39835 @cindex @samp{QTSave} packet
39836 This packet directs the target to save trace data to the file name
39837 @var{filename} in the target's filesystem. @var{filename} is encoded
39838 as a hex string; the interpretation of the file name (relative vs
39839 absolute, wild cards, etc) is up to the target.
39841 @item qTBuffer:@var{offset},@var{len}
39842 @cindex @samp{qTBuffer} packet
39843 Return up to @var{len} bytes of the current contents of trace buffer,
39844 starting at @var{offset}. The trace buffer is treated as if it were
39845 a contiguous collection of traceframes, as per the trace file format.
39846 The reply consists as many hex-encoded bytes as the target can deliver
39847 in a packet; it is not an error to return fewer than were asked for.
39848 A reply consisting of just @code{l} indicates that no bytes are
39851 @item QTBuffer:circular:@var{value}
39852 This packet directs the target to use a circular trace buffer if
39853 @var{value} is 1, or a linear buffer if the value is 0.
39855 @item QTBuffer:size:@var{size}
39856 @anchor{QTBuffer-size}
39857 @cindex @samp{QTBuffer size} packet
39858 This packet directs the target to make the trace buffer be of size
39859 @var{size} if possible. A value of @code{-1} tells the target to
39860 use whatever size it prefers.
39862 @item QTNotes:@r{[}@var{type}:@var{text}@r{]}@r{[};@var{type}:@var{text}@r{]}@dots{}
39863 @cindex @samp{QTNotes} packet
39864 This packet adds optional textual notes to the trace run. Allowable
39865 types include @code{user}, @code{notes}, and @code{tstop}, the
39866 @var{text} fields are arbitrary strings, hex-encoded.
39870 @subsection Relocate instruction reply packet
39871 When installing fast tracepoints in memory, the target may need to
39872 relocate the instruction currently at the tracepoint address to a
39873 different address in memory. For most instructions, a simple copy is
39874 enough, but, for example, call instructions that implicitly push the
39875 return address on the stack, and relative branches or other
39876 PC-relative instructions require offset adjustment, so that the effect
39877 of executing the instruction at a different address is the same as if
39878 it had executed in the original location.
39880 In response to several of the tracepoint packets, the target may also
39881 respond with a number of intermediate @samp{qRelocInsn} request
39882 packets before the final result packet, to have @value{GDBN} handle
39883 this relocation operation. If a packet supports this mechanism, its
39884 documentation will explicitly say so. See for example the above
39885 descriptions for the @samp{QTStart} and @samp{QTDP} packets. The
39886 format of the request is:
39889 @item qRelocInsn:@var{from};@var{to}
39891 This requests @value{GDBN} to copy instruction at address @var{from}
39892 to address @var{to}, possibly adjusted so that executing the
39893 instruction at @var{to} has the same effect as executing it at
39894 @var{from}. @value{GDBN} writes the adjusted instruction to target
39895 memory starting at @var{to}.
39900 @item qRelocInsn:@var{adjusted_size}
39901 Informs the stub the relocation is complete. @var{adjusted_size} is
39902 the length in bytes of resulting relocated instruction sequence.
39904 A badly formed request was detected, or an error was encountered while
39905 relocating the instruction.
39908 @node Host I/O Packets
39909 @section Host I/O Packets
39910 @cindex Host I/O, remote protocol
39911 @cindex file transfer, remote protocol
39913 The @dfn{Host I/O} packets allow @value{GDBN} to perform I/O
39914 operations on the far side of a remote link. For example, Host I/O is
39915 used to upload and download files to a remote target with its own
39916 filesystem. Host I/O uses the same constant values and data structure
39917 layout as the target-initiated File-I/O protocol. However, the
39918 Host I/O packets are structured differently. The target-initiated
39919 protocol relies on target memory to store parameters and buffers.
39920 Host I/O requests are initiated by @value{GDBN}, and the
39921 target's memory is not involved. @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol
39922 Extension}, for more details on the target-initiated protocol.
39924 The Host I/O request packets all encode a single operation along with
39925 its arguments. They have this format:
39929 @item vFile:@var{operation}: @var{parameter}@dots{}
39930 @var{operation} is the name of the particular request; the target
39931 should compare the entire packet name up to the second colon when checking
39932 for a supported operation. The format of @var{parameter} depends on
39933 the operation. Numbers are always passed in hexadecimal. Negative
39934 numbers have an explicit minus sign (i.e.@: two's complement is not
39935 used). Strings (e.g.@: filenames) are encoded as a series of
39936 hexadecimal bytes. The last argument to a system call may be a
39937 buffer of escaped binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
39941 The valid responses to Host I/O packets are:
39945 @item F @var{result} [, @var{errno}] [; @var{attachment}]
39946 @var{result} is the integer value returned by this operation, usually
39947 non-negative for success and -1 for errors. If an error has occured,
39948 @var{errno} will be included in the result. @var{errno} will have a
39949 value defined by the File-I/O protocol (@pxref{Errno Values}). For
39950 operations which return data, @var{attachment} supplies the data as a
39951 binary buffer. Binary buffers in response packets are escaped in the
39952 normal way (@pxref{Binary Data}). See the individual packet
39953 documentation for the interpretation of @var{result} and
39957 An empty response indicates that this operation is not recognized.
39961 These are the supported Host I/O operations:
39964 @item vFile:open: @var{pathname}, @var{flags}, @var{mode}
39965 Open a file at @var{pathname} and return a file descriptor for it, or
39966 return -1 if an error occurs. @var{pathname} is a string,
39967 @var{flags} is an integer indicating a mask of open flags
39968 (@pxref{Open Flags}), and @var{mode} is an integer indicating a mask
39969 of mode bits to use if the file is created (@pxref{mode_t Values}).
39970 @xref{open}, for details of the open flags and mode values.
39972 @item vFile:close: @var{fd}
39973 Close the open file corresponding to @var{fd} and return 0, or
39974 -1 if an error occurs.
39976 @item vFile:pread: @var{fd}, @var{count}, @var{offset}
39977 Read data from the open file corresponding to @var{fd}. Up to
39978 @var{count} bytes will be read from the file, starting at @var{offset}
39979 relative to the start of the file. The target may read fewer bytes;
39980 common reasons include packet size limits and an end-of-file
39981 condition. The number of bytes read is returned. Zero should only be
39982 returned for a successful read at the end of the file, or if
39983 @var{count} was zero.
39985 The data read should be returned as a binary attachment on success.
39986 If zero bytes were read, the response should include an empty binary
39987 attachment (i.e.@: a trailing semicolon). The return value is the
39988 number of target bytes read; the binary attachment may be longer if
39989 some characters were escaped.
39991 @item vFile:pwrite: @var{fd}, @var{offset}, @var{data}
39992 Write @var{data} (a binary buffer) to the open file corresponding
39993 to @var{fd}. Start the write at @var{offset} from the start of the
39994 file. Unlike many @code{write} system calls, there is no
39995 separate @var{count} argument; the length of @var{data} in the
39996 packet is used. @samp{vFile:write} returns the number of bytes written,
39997 which may be shorter than the length of @var{data}, or -1 if an
40000 @item vFile:unlink: @var{pathname}
40001 Delete the file at @var{pathname} on the target. Return 0,
40002 or -1 if an error occurs. @var{pathname} is a string.
40004 @item vFile:readlink: @var{filename}
40005 Read value of symbolic link @var{filename} on the target. Return
40006 the number of bytes read, or -1 if an error occurs.
40008 The data read should be returned as a binary attachment on success.
40009 If zero bytes were read, the response should include an empty binary
40010 attachment (i.e.@: a trailing semicolon). The return value is the
40011 number of target bytes read; the binary attachment may be longer if
40012 some characters were escaped.
40017 @section Interrupts
40018 @cindex interrupts (remote protocol)
40020 When a program on the remote target is running, @value{GDBN} may
40021 attempt to interrupt it by sending a @samp{Ctrl-C}, @code{BREAK} or
40022 a @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g},
40023 control of which is specified via @value{GDBN}'s @samp{interrupt-sequence}.
40025 The precise meaning of @code{BREAK} is defined by the transport
40026 mechanism and may, in fact, be undefined. @value{GDBN} does not
40027 currently define a @code{BREAK} mechanism for any of the network
40028 interfaces except for TCP, in which case @value{GDBN} sends the
40029 @code{telnet} BREAK sequence.
40031 @samp{Ctrl-C}, on the other hand, is defined and implemented for all
40032 transport mechanisms. It is represented by sending the single byte
40033 @code{0x03} without any of the usual packet overhead described in
40034 the Overview section (@pxref{Overview}). When a @code{0x03} byte is
40035 transmitted as part of a packet, it is considered to be packet data
40036 and does @emph{not} represent an interrupt. E.g., an @samp{X} packet
40037 (@pxref{X packet}), used for binary downloads, may include an unescaped
40038 @code{0x03} as part of its packet.
40040 @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g} is also known as Magic SysRq g.
40041 When Linux kernel receives this sequence from serial port,
40042 it stops execution and connects to gdb.
40044 Stubs are not required to recognize these interrupt mechanisms and the
40045 precise meaning associated with receipt of the interrupt is
40046 implementation defined. If the target supports debugging of multiple
40047 threads and/or processes, it should attempt to interrupt all
40048 currently-executing threads and processes.
40049 If the stub is successful at interrupting the
40050 running program, it should send one of the stop
40051 reply packets (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}) to @value{GDBN} as a result
40052 of successfully stopping the program in all-stop mode, and a stop reply
40053 for each stopped thread in non-stop mode.
40054 Interrupts received while the
40055 program is stopped are discarded.
40057 @node Notification Packets
40058 @section Notification Packets
40059 @cindex notification packets
40060 @cindex packets, notification
40062 The @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol includes @dfn{notifications},
40063 packets that require no acknowledgment. Both the GDB and the stub
40064 may send notifications (although the only notifications defined at
40065 present are sent by the stub). Notifications carry information
40066 without incurring the round-trip latency of an acknowledgment, and so
40067 are useful for low-impact communications where occasional packet loss
40070 A notification packet has the form @samp{% @var{data} #
40071 @var{checksum}}, where @var{data} is the content of the notification,
40072 and @var{checksum} is a checksum of @var{data}, computed and formatted
40073 as for ordinary @value{GDBN} packets. A notification's @var{data}
40074 never contains @samp{$}, @samp{%} or @samp{#} characters. Upon
40075 receiving a notification, the recipient sends no @samp{+} or @samp{-}
40076 to acknowledge the notification's receipt or to report its corruption.
40078 Every notification's @var{data} begins with a name, which contains no
40079 colon characters, followed by a colon character.
40081 Recipients should silently ignore corrupted notifications and
40082 notifications they do not understand. Recipients should restart
40083 timeout periods on receipt of a well-formed notification, whether or
40084 not they understand it.
40086 Senders should only send the notifications described here when this
40087 protocol description specifies that they are permitted. In the
40088 future, we may extend the protocol to permit existing notifications in
40089 new contexts; this rule helps older senders avoid confusing newer
40092 (Older versions of @value{GDBN} ignore bytes received until they see
40093 the @samp{$} byte that begins an ordinary packet, so new stubs may
40094 transmit notifications without fear of confusing older clients. There
40095 are no notifications defined for @value{GDBN} to send at the moment, but we
40096 assume that most older stubs would ignore them, as well.)
40098 Each notification is comprised of three parts:
40100 @item @var{name}:@var{event}
40101 The notification packet is sent by the side that initiates the
40102 exchange (currently, only the stub does that), with @var{event}
40103 carrying the specific information about the notification.
40104 @var{name} is the name of the notification.
40106 The acknowledge sent by the other side, usually @value{GDBN}, to
40107 acknowledge the exchange and request the event.
40110 The purpose of an asynchronous notification mechanism is to report to
40111 @value{GDBN} that something interesting happened in the remote stub.
40113 The remote stub may send notification @var{name}:@var{event}
40114 at any time, but @value{GDBN} acknowledges the notification when
40115 appropriate. The notification event is pending before @value{GDBN}
40116 acknowledges. Only one notification at a time may be pending; if
40117 additional events occur before @value{GDBN} has acknowledged the
40118 previous notification, they must be queued by the stub for later
40119 synchronous transmission in response to @var{ack} packets from
40120 @value{GDBN}. Because the notification mechanism is unreliable,
40121 the stub is permitted to resend a notification if it believes
40122 @value{GDBN} may not have received it.
40124 Specifically, notifications may appear when @value{GDBN} is not
40125 otherwise reading input from the stub, or when @value{GDBN} is
40126 expecting to read a normal synchronous response or a
40127 @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgment to a packet it has sent.
40128 Notification packets are distinct from any other communication from
40129 the stub so there is no ambiguity.
40131 After receiving a notification, @value{GDBN} shall acknowledge it by
40132 sending a @var{ack} packet as a regular, synchronous request to the
40133 stub. Such acknowledgment is not required to happen immediately, as
40134 @value{GDBN} is permitted to send other, unrelated packets to the
40135 stub first, which the stub should process normally.
40137 Upon receiving a @var{ack} packet, if the stub has other queued
40138 events to report to @value{GDBN}, it shall respond by sending a
40139 normal @var{event}. @value{GDBN} shall then send another @var{ack}
40140 packet to solicit further responses; again, it is permitted to send
40141 other, unrelated packets as well which the stub should process
40144 If the stub receives a @var{ack} packet and there are no additional
40145 @var{event} to report, the stub shall return an @samp{OK} response.
40146 At this point, @value{GDBN} has finished processing a notification
40147 and the stub has completed sending any queued events. @value{GDBN}
40148 won't accept any new notifications until the final @samp{OK} is
40149 received . If further notification events occur, the stub shall send
40150 a new notification, @value{GDBN} shall accept the notification, and
40151 the process shall be repeated.
40153 The process of asynchronous notification can be illustrated by the
40156 <- @code{%%Stop:T0505:98e7ffbf;04:4ce6ffbf;08:b1b6e54c;thread:p7526.7526;core:0;}
40159 <- @code{T0505:68f37db7;04:40f37db7;08:63850408;thread:p7526.7528;core:0;}
40161 <- @code{T0505:68e3fdb6;04:40e3fdb6;08:63850408;thread:p7526.7529;core:0;}
40166 The following notifications are defined:
40167 @multitable @columnfractions 0.12 0.12 0.38 0.38
40176 @tab @var{reply}. The @var{reply} has the form of a stop reply, as
40177 described in @ref{Stop Reply Packets}. Refer to @ref{Remote Non-Stop},
40178 for information on how these notifications are acknowledged by
40180 @tab Report an asynchronous stop event in non-stop mode.
40184 @node Remote Non-Stop
40185 @section Remote Protocol Support for Non-Stop Mode
40187 @value{GDBN}'s remote protocol supports non-stop debugging of
40188 multi-threaded programs, as described in @ref{Non-Stop Mode}. If the stub
40189 supports non-stop mode, it should report that to @value{GDBN} by including
40190 @samp{QNonStop+} in its @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
40192 @value{GDBN} typically sends a @samp{QNonStop} packet only when
40193 establishing a new connection with the stub. Entering non-stop mode
40194 does not alter the state of any currently-running threads, but targets
40195 must stop all threads in any already-attached processes when entering
40196 all-stop mode. @value{GDBN} uses the @samp{?} packet as necessary to
40197 probe the target state after a mode change.
40199 In non-stop mode, when an attached process encounters an event that
40200 would otherwise be reported with a stop reply, it uses the
40201 asynchronous notification mechanism (@pxref{Notification Packets}) to
40202 inform @value{GDBN}. In contrast to all-stop mode, where all threads
40203 in all processes are stopped when a stop reply is sent, in non-stop
40204 mode only the thread reporting the stop event is stopped. That is,
40205 when reporting a @samp{S} or @samp{T} response to indicate completion
40206 of a step operation, hitting a breakpoint, or a fault, only the
40207 affected thread is stopped; any other still-running threads continue
40208 to run. When reporting a @samp{W} or @samp{X} response, all running
40209 threads belonging to other attached processes continue to run.
40211 In non-stop mode, the target shall respond to the @samp{?} packet as
40212 follows. First, any incomplete stop reply notification/@samp{vStopped}
40213 sequence in progress is abandoned. The target must begin a new
40214 sequence reporting stop events for all stopped threads, whether or not
40215 it has previously reported those events to @value{GDBN}. The first
40216 stop reply is sent as a synchronous reply to the @samp{?} packet, and
40217 subsequent stop replies are sent as responses to @samp{vStopped} packets
40218 using the mechanism described above. The target must not send
40219 asynchronous stop reply notifications until the sequence is complete.
40220 If all threads are running when the target receives the @samp{?} packet,
40221 or if the target is not attached to any process, it shall respond
40224 @node Packet Acknowledgment
40225 @section Packet Acknowledgment
40227 @cindex acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
40228 @cindex packet acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
40229 By default, when either the host or the target machine receives a packet,
40230 the first response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
40231 the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request retransmission).
40232 This mechanism allows the @value{GDBN} remote protocol to operate over
40233 unreliable transport mechanisms, such as a serial line.
40235 In cases where the transport mechanism is itself reliable (such as a pipe or
40236 TCP connection), the @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments are redundant.
40237 It may be desirable to disable them in that case to reduce communication
40238 overhead, or for other reasons. This can be accomplished by means of the
40239 @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet; @pxref{QStartNoAckMode}.
40241 When in no-acknowledgment mode, neither the stub nor @value{GDBN} shall send or
40242 expect @samp{+}/@samp{-} protocol acknowledgments. The packet
40243 and response format still includes the normal checksum, as described in
40244 @ref{Overview}, but the checksum may be ignored by the receiver.
40246 If the stub supports @samp{QStartNoAckMode} and prefers to operate in
40247 no-acknowledgment mode, it should report that to @value{GDBN}
40248 by including @samp{QStartNoAckMode+} in its response to @samp{qSupported};
40249 @pxref{qSupported}.
40250 If @value{GDBN} also supports @samp{QStartNoAckMode} and it has not been
40251 disabled via the @code{set remote noack-packet off} command
40252 (@pxref{Remote Configuration}),
40253 @value{GDBN} may then send a @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet to the stub.
40254 Only then may the stub actually turn off packet acknowledgments.
40255 @value{GDBN} sends a final @samp{+} acknowledgment of the stub's @samp{OK}
40256 response, which can be safely ignored by the stub.
40258 Note that @code{set remote noack-packet} command only affects negotiation
40259 between @value{GDBN} and the stub when subsequent connections are made;
40260 it does not affect the protocol acknowledgment state for any current
40262 Since @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments are enabled by default when a
40263 new connection is established,
40264 there is also no protocol request to re-enable the acknowledgments
40265 for the current connection, once disabled.
40270 Example sequence of a target being re-started. Notice how the restart
40271 does not get any direct output:
40276 @emph{target restarts}
40279 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
40283 Example sequence of a target being stepped by a single instruction:
40286 -> @code{G1445@dots{}}
40291 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
40295 <- @code{1455@dots{}}
40299 @node File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
40300 @section File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
40301 @cindex File-I/O remote protocol extension
40304 * File-I/O Overview::
40305 * Protocol Basics::
40306 * The F Request Packet::
40307 * The F Reply Packet::
40308 * The Ctrl-C Message::
40310 * List of Supported Calls::
40311 * Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes::
40313 * File-I/O Examples::
40316 @node File-I/O Overview
40317 @subsection File-I/O Overview
40318 @cindex file-i/o overview
40320 The @dfn{File I/O remote protocol extension} (short: File-I/O) allows the
40321 target to use the host's file system and console I/O to perform various
40322 system calls. System calls on the target system are translated into a
40323 remote protocol packet to the host system, which then performs the needed
40324 actions and returns a response packet to the target system.
40325 This simulates file system operations even on targets that lack file systems.
40327 The protocol is defined to be independent of both the host and target systems.
40328 It uses its own internal representation of datatypes and values. Both
40329 @value{GDBN} and the target's @value{GDBN} stub are responsible for
40330 translating the system-dependent value representations into the internal
40331 protocol representations when data is transmitted.
40333 The communication is synchronous. A system call is possible only when
40334 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
40335 or @samp{s} packets. While @value{GDBN} handles the request for a system call,
40336 the target is stopped to allow deterministic access to the target's
40337 memory. Therefore File-I/O is not interruptible by target signals. On
40338 the other hand, it is possible to interrupt File-I/O by a user interrupt
40339 (@samp{Ctrl-C}) within @value{GDBN}.
40341 The target's request to perform a host system call does not finish
40342 the latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} action. That means,
40343 after finishing the system call, the target returns to continuing the
40344 previous activity (continue, step). No additional continue or step
40345 request from @value{GDBN} is required.
40348 (@value{GDBP}) continue
40349 <- target requests 'system call X'
40350 target is stopped, @value{GDBN} executes system call
40351 -> @value{GDBN} returns result
40352 ... target continues, @value{GDBN} returns to wait for the target
40353 <- target hits breakpoint and sends a Txx packet
40356 The protocol only supports I/O on the console and to regular files on
40357 the host file system. Character or block special devices, pipes,
40358 named pipes, sockets or any other communication method on the host
40359 system are not supported by this protocol.
40361 File I/O is not supported in non-stop mode.
40363 @node Protocol Basics
40364 @subsection Protocol Basics
40365 @cindex protocol basics, file-i/o
40367 The File-I/O protocol uses the @code{F} packet as the request as well
40368 as reply packet. Since a File-I/O system call can only occur when
40369 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the continuing or stepping target,
40370 the File-I/O request is a reply that @value{GDBN} has to expect as a result
40371 of a previous @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} packet.
40372 This @code{F} packet contains all information needed to allow @value{GDBN}
40373 to call the appropriate host system call:
40377 A unique identifier for the requested system call.
40380 All parameters to the system call. Pointers are given as addresses
40381 in the target memory address space. Pointers to strings are given as
40382 pointer/length pair. Numerical values are given as they are.
40383 Numerical control flags are given in a protocol-specific representation.
40387 At this point, @value{GDBN} has to perform the following actions.
40391 If the parameters include pointer values to data needed as input to a
40392 system call, @value{GDBN} requests this data from the target with a
40393 standard @code{m} packet request. This additional communication has to be
40394 expected by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{m}
40398 @value{GDBN} translates all value from protocol representation to host
40399 representation as needed. Datatypes are coerced into the host types.
40402 @value{GDBN} calls the system call.
40405 It then coerces datatypes back to protocol representation.
40408 If the system call is expected to return data in buffer space specified
40409 by pointer parameters to the call, the data is transmitted to the
40410 target using a @code{M} or @code{X} packet. This packet has to be expected
40411 by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{M} or @code{X}
40416 Eventually @value{GDBN} replies with another @code{F} packet which contains all
40417 necessary information for the target to continue. This at least contains
40424 @code{errno}, if has been changed by the system call.
40431 After having done the needed type and value coercion, the target continues
40432 the latest continue or step action.
40434 @node The F Request Packet
40435 @subsection The @code{F} Request Packet
40436 @cindex file-i/o request packet
40437 @cindex @code{F} request packet
40439 The @code{F} request packet has the following format:
40442 @item F@var{call-id},@var{parameter@dots{}}
40444 @var{call-id} is the identifier to indicate the host system call to be called.
40445 This is just the name of the function.
40447 @var{parameter@dots{}} are the parameters to the system call.
40448 Parameters are hexadecimal integer values, either the actual values in case
40449 of scalar datatypes, pointers to target buffer space in case of compound
40450 datatypes and unspecified memory areas, or pointer/length pairs in case
40451 of string parameters. These are appended to the @var{call-id} as a
40452 comma-delimited list. All values are transmitted in ASCII
40453 string representation, pointer/length pairs separated by a slash.
40459 @node The F Reply Packet
40460 @subsection The @code{F} Reply Packet
40461 @cindex file-i/o reply packet
40462 @cindex @code{F} reply packet
40464 The @code{F} reply packet has the following format:
40468 @item F@var{retcode},@var{errno},@var{Ctrl-C flag};@var{call-specific attachment}
40470 @var{retcode} is the return code of the system call as hexadecimal value.
40472 @var{errno} is the @code{errno} set by the call, in protocol-specific
40474 This parameter can be omitted if the call was successful.
40476 @var{Ctrl-C flag} is only sent if the user requested a break. In this
40477 case, @var{errno} must be sent as well, even if the call was successful.
40478 The @var{Ctrl-C flag} itself consists of the character @samp{C}:
40485 or, if the call was interrupted before the host call has been performed:
40492 assuming 4 is the protocol-specific representation of @code{EINTR}.
40497 @node The Ctrl-C Message
40498 @subsection The @samp{Ctrl-C} Message
40499 @cindex ctrl-c message, in file-i/o protocol
40501 If the @samp{Ctrl-C} flag is set in the @value{GDBN}
40502 reply packet (@pxref{The F Reply Packet}),
40503 the target should behave as if it had
40504 gotten a break message. The meaning for the target is ``system call
40505 interrupted by @code{SIGINT}''. Consequentially, the target should actually stop
40506 (as with a break message) and return to @value{GDBN} with a @code{T02}
40509 It's important for the target to know in which
40510 state the system call was interrupted. There are two possible cases:
40514 The system call hasn't been performed on the host yet.
40517 The system call on the host has been finished.
40521 These two states can be distinguished by the target by the value of the
40522 returned @code{errno}. If it's the protocol representation of @code{EINTR}, the system
40523 call hasn't been performed. This is equivalent to the @code{EINTR} handling
40524 on POSIX systems. In any other case, the target may presume that the
40525 system call has been finished --- successfully or not --- and should behave
40526 as if the break message arrived right after the system call.
40528 @value{GDBN} must behave reliably. If the system call has not been called
40529 yet, @value{GDBN} may send the @code{F} reply immediately, setting @code{EINTR} as
40530 @code{errno} in the packet. If the system call on the host has been finished
40531 before the user requests a break, the full action must be finished by
40532 @value{GDBN}. This requires sending @code{M} or @code{X} packets as necessary.
40533 The @code{F} packet may only be sent when either nothing has happened
40534 or the full action has been completed.
40537 @subsection Console I/O
40538 @cindex console i/o as part of file-i/o
40540 By default and if not explicitly closed by the target system, the file
40541 descriptors 0, 1 and 2 are connected to the @value{GDBN} console. Output
40542 on the @value{GDBN} console is handled as any other file output operation
40543 (@code{write(1, @dots{})} or @code{write(2, @dots{})}). Console input is handled
40544 by @value{GDBN} so that after the target read request from file descriptor
40545 0 all following typing is buffered until either one of the following
40550 The user types @kbd{Ctrl-c}. The behaviour is as explained above, and the
40552 system call is treated as finished.
40555 The user presses @key{RET}. This is treated as end of input with a trailing
40559 The user types @kbd{Ctrl-d}. This is treated as end of input. No trailing
40560 character (neither newline nor @samp{Ctrl-D}) is appended to the input.
40564 If the user has typed more characters than fit in the buffer given to
40565 the @code{read} call, the trailing characters are buffered in @value{GDBN} until
40566 either another @code{read(0, @dots{})} is requested by the target, or debugging
40567 is stopped at the user's request.
40570 @node List of Supported Calls
40571 @subsection List of Supported Calls
40572 @cindex list of supported file-i/o calls
40589 @unnumberedsubsubsec open
40590 @cindex open, file-i/o system call
40595 int open(const char *pathname, int flags);
40596 int open(const char *pathname, int flags, mode_t mode);
40600 @samp{Fopen,@var{pathptr}/@var{len},@var{flags},@var{mode}}
40603 @var{flags} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
40607 If the file does not exist it will be created. The host
40608 rules apply as far as file ownership and time stamps
40612 When used with @code{O_CREAT}, if the file already exists it is
40613 an error and open() fails.
40616 If the file already exists and the open mode allows
40617 writing (@code{O_RDWR} or @code{O_WRONLY} is given) it will be
40618 truncated to zero length.
40621 The file is opened in append mode.
40624 The file is opened for reading only.
40627 The file is opened for writing only.
40630 The file is opened for reading and writing.
40634 Other bits are silently ignored.
40638 @var{mode} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
40642 User has read permission.
40645 User has write permission.
40648 Group has read permission.
40651 Group has write permission.
40654 Others have read permission.
40657 Others have write permission.
40661 Other bits are silently ignored.
40664 @item Return value:
40665 @code{open} returns the new file descriptor or -1 if an error
40672 @var{pathname} already exists and @code{O_CREAT} and @code{O_EXCL} were used.
40675 @var{pathname} refers to a directory.
40678 The requested access is not allowed.
40681 @var{pathname} was too long.
40684 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
40687 @var{pathname} refers to a device, pipe, named pipe or socket.
40690 @var{pathname} refers to a file on a read-only filesystem and
40691 write access was requested.
40694 @var{pathname} is an invalid pointer value.
40697 No space on device to create the file.
40700 The process already has the maximum number of files open.
40703 The limit on the total number of files open on the system
40707 The call was interrupted by the user.
40713 @unnumberedsubsubsec close
40714 @cindex close, file-i/o system call
40723 @samp{Fclose,@var{fd}}
40725 @item Return value:
40726 @code{close} returns zero on success, or -1 if an error occurred.
40732 @var{fd} isn't a valid open file descriptor.
40735 The call was interrupted by the user.
40741 @unnumberedsubsubsec read
40742 @cindex read, file-i/o system call
40747 int read(int fd, void *buf, unsigned int count);
40751 @samp{Fread,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
40753 @item Return value:
40754 On success, the number of bytes read is returned.
40755 Zero indicates end of file. If count is zero, read
40756 returns zero as well. On error, -1 is returned.
40762 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
40766 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
40769 The call was interrupted by the user.
40775 @unnumberedsubsubsec write
40776 @cindex write, file-i/o system call
40781 int write(int fd, const void *buf, unsigned int count);
40785 @samp{Fwrite,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
40787 @item Return value:
40788 On success, the number of bytes written are returned.
40789 Zero indicates nothing was written. On error, -1
40796 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
40800 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
40803 An attempt was made to write a file that exceeds the
40804 host-specific maximum file size allowed.
40807 No space on device to write the data.
40810 The call was interrupted by the user.
40816 @unnumberedsubsubsec lseek
40817 @cindex lseek, file-i/o system call
40822 long lseek (int fd, long offset, int flag);
40826 @samp{Flseek,@var{fd},@var{offset},@var{flag}}
40828 @var{flag} is one of:
40832 The offset is set to @var{offset} bytes.
40835 The offset is set to its current location plus @var{offset}
40839 The offset is set to the size of the file plus @var{offset}
40843 @item Return value:
40844 On success, the resulting unsigned offset in bytes from
40845 the beginning of the file is returned. Otherwise, a
40846 value of -1 is returned.
40852 @var{fd} is not a valid open file descriptor.
40855 @var{fd} is associated with the @value{GDBN} console.
40858 @var{flag} is not a proper value.
40861 The call was interrupted by the user.
40867 @unnumberedsubsubsec rename
40868 @cindex rename, file-i/o system call
40873 int rename(const char *oldpath, const char *newpath);
40877 @samp{Frename,@var{oldpathptr}/@var{len},@var{newpathptr}/@var{len}}
40879 @item Return value:
40880 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
40886 @var{newpath} is an existing directory, but @var{oldpath} is not a
40890 @var{newpath} is a non-empty directory.
40893 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} is a directory that is in use by some
40897 An attempt was made to make a directory a subdirectory
40901 A component used as a directory in @var{oldpath} or new
40902 path is not a directory. Or @var{oldpath} is a directory
40903 and @var{newpath} exists but is not a directory.
40906 @var{oldpathptr} or @var{newpathptr} are invalid pointer values.
40909 No access to the file or the path of the file.
40913 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} was too long.
40916 A directory component in @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} does not exist.
40919 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
40922 The device containing the file has no room for the new
40926 The call was interrupted by the user.
40932 @unnumberedsubsubsec unlink
40933 @cindex unlink, file-i/o system call
40938 int unlink(const char *pathname);
40942 @samp{Funlink,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len}}
40944 @item Return value:
40945 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
40951 No access to the file or the path of the file.
40954 The system does not allow unlinking of directories.
40957 The file @var{pathname} cannot be unlinked because it's
40958 being used by another process.
40961 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
40964 @var{pathname} was too long.
40967 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
40970 A component of the path is not a directory.
40973 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
40976 The call was interrupted by the user.
40982 @unnumberedsubsubsec stat/fstat
40983 @cindex fstat, file-i/o system call
40984 @cindex stat, file-i/o system call
40989 int stat(const char *pathname, struct stat *buf);
40990 int fstat(int fd, struct stat *buf);
40994 @samp{Fstat,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len},@var{bufptr}}@*
40995 @samp{Ffstat,@var{fd},@var{bufptr}}
40997 @item Return value:
40998 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
41004 @var{fd} is not a valid open file.
41007 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist or the
41008 path is an empty string.
41011 A component of the path is not a directory.
41014 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
41017 No access to the file or the path of the file.
41020 @var{pathname} was too long.
41023 The call was interrupted by the user.
41029 @unnumberedsubsubsec gettimeofday
41030 @cindex gettimeofday, file-i/o system call
41035 int gettimeofday(struct timeval *tv, void *tz);
41039 @samp{Fgettimeofday,@var{tvptr},@var{tzptr}}
41041 @item Return value:
41042 On success, 0 is returned, -1 otherwise.
41048 @var{tz} is a non-NULL pointer.
41051 @var{tvptr} and/or @var{tzptr} is an invalid pointer value.
41057 @unnumberedsubsubsec isatty
41058 @cindex isatty, file-i/o system call
41063 int isatty(int fd);
41067 @samp{Fisatty,@var{fd}}
41069 @item Return value:
41070 Returns 1 if @var{fd} refers to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise.
41076 The call was interrupted by the user.
41081 Note that the @code{isatty} call is treated as a special case: it returns
41082 1 to the target if the file descriptor is attached
41083 to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise. Implementing through system calls
41084 would require implementing @code{ioctl} and would be more complex than
41089 @unnumberedsubsubsec system
41090 @cindex system, file-i/o system call
41095 int system(const char *command);
41099 @samp{Fsystem,@var{commandptr}/@var{len}}
41101 @item Return value:
41102 If @var{len} is zero, the return value indicates whether a shell is
41103 available. A zero return value indicates a shell is not available.
41104 For non-zero @var{len}, the value returned is -1 on error and the
41105 return status of the command otherwise. Only the exit status of the
41106 command is returned, which is extracted from the host's @code{system}
41107 return value by calling @code{WEXITSTATUS(retval)}. In case
41108 @file{/bin/sh} could not be executed, 127 is returned.
41114 The call was interrupted by the user.
41119 @value{GDBN} takes over the full task of calling the necessary host calls
41120 to perform the @code{system} call. The return value of @code{system} on
41121 the host is simplified before it's returned
41122 to the target. Any termination signal information from the child process
41123 is discarded, and the return value consists
41124 entirely of the exit status of the called command.
41126 Due to security concerns, the @code{system} call is by default refused
41127 by @value{GDBN}. The user has to allow this call explicitly with the
41128 @code{set remote system-call-allowed 1} command.
41131 @item set remote system-call-allowed
41132 @kindex set remote system-call-allowed
41133 Control whether to allow the @code{system} calls in the File I/O
41134 protocol for the remote target. The default is zero (disabled).
41136 @item show remote system-call-allowed
41137 @kindex show remote system-call-allowed
41138 Show whether the @code{system} calls are allowed in the File I/O
41142 @node Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
41143 @subsection Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
41144 @cindex protocol-specific representation of datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
41147 * Integral Datatypes::
41149 * Memory Transfer::
41154 @node Integral Datatypes
41155 @unnumberedsubsubsec Integral Datatypes
41156 @cindex integral datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
41158 The integral datatypes used in the system calls are @code{int},
41159 @code{unsigned int}, @code{long}, @code{unsigned long},
41160 @code{mode_t}, and @code{time_t}.
41162 @code{int}, @code{unsigned int}, @code{mode_t} and @code{time_t} are
41163 implemented as 32 bit values in this protocol.
41165 @code{long} and @code{unsigned long} are implemented as 64 bit types.
41167 @xref{Limits}, for corresponding MIN and MAX values (similar to those
41168 in @file{limits.h}) to allow range checking on host and target.
41170 @code{time_t} datatypes are defined as seconds since the Epoch.
41172 All integral datatypes transferred as part of a memory read or write of a
41173 structured datatype e.g.@: a @code{struct stat} have to be given in big endian
41176 @node Pointer Values
41177 @unnumberedsubsubsec Pointer Values
41178 @cindex pointer values, in file-i/o protocol
41180 Pointers to target data are transmitted as they are. An exception
41181 is made for pointers to buffers for which the length isn't
41182 transmitted as part of the function call, namely strings. Strings
41183 are transmitted as a pointer/length pair, both as hex values, e.g.@:
41190 which is a pointer to data of length 18 bytes at position 0x1aaf.
41191 The length is defined as the full string length in bytes, including
41192 the trailing null byte. For example, the string @code{"hello world"}
41193 at address 0x123456 is transmitted as
41199 @node Memory Transfer
41200 @unnumberedsubsubsec Memory Transfer
41201 @cindex memory transfer, in file-i/o protocol
41203 Structured data which is transferred using a memory read or write (for
41204 example, a @code{struct stat}) is expected to be in a protocol-specific format
41205 with all scalar multibyte datatypes being big endian. Translation to
41206 this representation needs to be done both by the target before the @code{F}
41207 packet is sent, and by @value{GDBN} before
41208 it transfers memory to the target. Transferred pointers to structured
41209 data should point to the already-coerced data at any time.
41213 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct stat
41214 @cindex struct stat, in file-i/o protocol
41216 The buffer of type @code{struct stat} used by the target and @value{GDBN}
41217 is defined as follows:
41221 unsigned int st_dev; /* device */
41222 unsigned int st_ino; /* inode */
41223 mode_t st_mode; /* protection */
41224 unsigned int st_nlink; /* number of hard links */
41225 unsigned int st_uid; /* user ID of owner */
41226 unsigned int st_gid; /* group ID of owner */
41227 unsigned int st_rdev; /* device type (if inode device) */
41228 unsigned long st_size; /* total size, in bytes */
41229 unsigned long st_blksize; /* blocksize for filesystem I/O */
41230 unsigned long st_blocks; /* number of blocks allocated */
41231 time_t st_atime; /* time of last access */
41232 time_t st_mtime; /* time of last modification */
41233 time_t st_ctime; /* time of last change */
41237 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
41238 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
41239 structure is of size 64 bytes.
41241 The values of several fields have a restricted meaning and/or
41247 A value of 0 represents a file, 1 the console.
41250 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
41253 Valid mode bits are described in @ref{Constants}. Any other
41254 bits have currently no meaning for the target.
41259 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
41264 These values have a host and file system dependent
41265 accuracy. Especially on Windows hosts, the file system may not
41266 support exact timing values.
41269 The target gets a @code{struct stat} of the above representation and is
41270 responsible for coercing it to the target representation before
41273 Note that due to size differences between the host, target, and protocol
41274 representations of @code{struct stat} members, these members could eventually
41275 get truncated on the target.
41277 @node struct timeval
41278 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct timeval
41279 @cindex struct timeval, in file-i/o protocol
41281 The buffer of type @code{struct timeval} used by the File-I/O protocol
41282 is defined as follows:
41286 time_t tv_sec; /* second */
41287 long tv_usec; /* microsecond */
41291 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
41292 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
41293 structure is of size 8 bytes.
41296 @subsection Constants
41297 @cindex constants, in file-i/o protocol
41299 The following values are used for the constants inside of the
41300 protocol. @value{GDBN} and target are responsible for translating these
41301 values before and after the call as needed.
41312 @unnumberedsubsubsec Open Flags
41313 @cindex open flags, in file-i/o protocol
41315 All values are given in hexadecimal representation.
41327 @node mode_t Values
41328 @unnumberedsubsubsec mode_t Values
41329 @cindex mode_t values, in file-i/o protocol
41331 All values are given in octal representation.
41348 @unnumberedsubsubsec Errno Values
41349 @cindex errno values, in file-i/o protocol
41351 All values are given in decimal representation.
41376 @code{EUNKNOWN} is used as a fallback error value if a host system returns
41377 any error value not in the list of supported error numbers.
41380 @unnumberedsubsubsec Lseek Flags
41381 @cindex lseek flags, in file-i/o protocol
41390 @unnumberedsubsubsec Limits
41391 @cindex limits, in file-i/o protocol
41393 All values are given in decimal representation.
41396 INT_MIN -2147483648
41398 UINT_MAX 4294967295
41399 LONG_MIN -9223372036854775808
41400 LONG_MAX 9223372036854775807
41401 ULONG_MAX 18446744073709551615
41404 @node File-I/O Examples
41405 @subsection File-I/O Examples
41406 @cindex file-i/o examples
41408 Example sequence of a write call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
41409 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be written:
41412 <- @code{Fwrite,3,1234,6}
41413 @emph{request memory read from target}
41416 @emph{return "6 bytes written"}
41420 Example sequence of a read call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
41421 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be read:
41424 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
41425 @emph{request memory write to target}
41426 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
41427 @emph{return "6 bytes read"}
41431 Example sequence of a read call, call fails on the host due to invalid
41432 file descriptor (@code{EBADF}):
41435 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
41439 Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} before syscall on
41443 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
41448 Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} after syscall on
41452 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
41453 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
41457 @node Library List Format
41458 @section Library List Format
41459 @cindex library list format, remote protocol
41461 On some platforms, a dynamic loader (e.g.@: @file{ld.so}) runs in the
41462 same process as your application to manage libraries. In this case,
41463 @value{GDBN} can use the loader's symbol table and normal memory
41464 operations to maintain a list of shared libraries. On other
41465 platforms, the operating system manages loaded libraries.
41466 @value{GDBN} can not retrieve the list of currently loaded libraries
41467 through memory operations, so it uses the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read}
41468 packet (@pxref{qXfer library list read}) instead. The remote stub
41469 queries the target's operating system and reports which libraries
41472 The @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet returns an XML document which
41473 lists loaded libraries and their offsets. Each library has an
41474 associated name and one or more segment or section base addresses,
41475 which report where the library was loaded in memory.
41477 For the common case of libraries that are fully linked binaries, the
41478 library should have a list of segments. If the target supports
41479 dynamic linking of a relocatable object file, its library XML element
41480 should instead include a list of allocated sections. The segment or
41481 section bases are start addresses, not relocation offsets; they do not
41482 depend on the library's link-time base addresses.
41484 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
41485 library lists. @xref{Expat}.
41487 A simple memory map, with one loaded library relocated by a single
41488 offset, looks like this:
41492 <library name="/lib/libc.so.6">
41493 <segment address="0x10000000"/>
41498 Another simple memory map, with one loaded library with three
41499 allocated sections (.text, .data, .bss), looks like this:
41503 <library name="sharedlib.o">
41504 <section address="0x10000000"/>
41505 <section address="0x20000000"/>
41506 <section address="0x30000000"/>
41511 The format of a library list is described by this DTD:
41514 <!-- library-list: Root element with versioning -->
41515 <!ELEMENT library-list (library)*>
41516 <!ATTLIST library-list version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
41517 <!ELEMENT library (segment*, section*)>
41518 <!ATTLIST library name CDATA #REQUIRED>
41519 <!ELEMENT segment EMPTY>
41520 <!ATTLIST segment address CDATA #REQUIRED>
41521 <!ELEMENT section EMPTY>
41522 <!ATTLIST section address CDATA #REQUIRED>
41525 In addition, segments and section descriptors cannot be mixed within a
41526 single library element, and you must supply at least one segment or
41527 section for each library.
41529 @node Library List Format for SVR4 Targets
41530 @section Library List Format for SVR4 Targets
41531 @cindex library list format, remote protocol
41533 On SVR4 platforms @value{GDBN} can use the symbol table of a dynamic loader
41534 (e.g.@: @file{ld.so}) and normal memory operations to maintain a list of
41535 shared libraries. Still a special library list provided by this packet is
41536 more efficient for the @value{GDBN} remote protocol.
41538 The @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read} packet returns an XML document which lists
41539 loaded libraries and their SVR4 linker parameters. For each library on SVR4
41540 target, the following parameters are reported:
41544 @code{name}, the absolute file name from the @code{l_name} field of
41545 @code{struct link_map}.
41547 @code{lm} with address of @code{struct link_map} used for TLS
41548 (Thread Local Storage) access.
41550 @code{l_addr}, the displacement as read from the field @code{l_addr} of
41551 @code{struct link_map}. For prelinked libraries this is not an absolute
41552 memory address. It is a displacement of absolute memory address against
41553 address the file was prelinked to during the library load.
41555 @code{l_ld}, which is memory address of the @code{PT_DYNAMIC} segment
41558 Additionally the single @code{main-lm} attribute specifies address of
41559 @code{struct link_map} used for the main executable. This parameter is used
41560 for TLS access and its presence is optional.
41562 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
41563 SVR4 library lists. @xref{Expat}.
41565 A simple memory map, with two loaded libraries (which do not use prelink),
41569 <library-list-svr4 version="1.0" main-lm="0xe4f8f8">
41570 <library name="/lib/ld-linux.so.2" lm="0xe4f51c" l_addr="0xe2d000"
41572 <library name="/lib/libc.so.6" lm="0xe4fbe8" l_addr="0x154000"
41574 </library-list-svr>
41577 The format of an SVR4 library list is described by this DTD:
41580 <!-- library-list-svr4: Root element with versioning -->
41581 <!ELEMENT library-list-svr4 (library)*>
41582 <!ATTLIST library-list-svr4 version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
41583 <!ATTLIST library-list-svr4 main-lm CDATA #IMPLIED>
41584 <!ELEMENT library EMPTY>
41585 <!ATTLIST library name CDATA #REQUIRED>
41586 <!ATTLIST library lm CDATA #REQUIRED>
41587 <!ATTLIST library l_addr CDATA #REQUIRED>
41588 <!ATTLIST library l_ld CDATA #REQUIRED>
41591 @node Memory Map Format
41592 @section Memory Map Format
41593 @cindex memory map format
41595 To be able to write into flash memory, @value{GDBN} needs to obtain a
41596 memory map from the target. This section describes the format of the
41599 The memory map is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
41600 (@pxref{qXfer memory map read}) packet and is an XML document that
41601 lists memory regions.
41603 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
41604 memory maps. @xref{Expat}.
41606 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
41609 <?xml version="1.0"?>
41610 <!DOCTYPE memory-map
41611 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Memory Map V1.0//EN"
41612 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-memory-map.dtd">
41618 Each region can be either:
41623 A region of RAM starting at @var{addr} and extending for @var{length}
41627 <memory type="ram" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
41632 A region of read-only memory:
41635 <memory type="rom" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
41640 A region of flash memory, with erasure blocks @var{blocksize}
41644 <memory type="flash" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}">
41645 <property name="blocksize">@var{blocksize}</property>
41651 Regions must not overlap. @value{GDBN} assumes that areas of memory not covered
41652 by the memory map are RAM, and uses the ordinary @samp{M} and @samp{X}
41653 packets to write to addresses in such ranges.
41655 The formal DTD for memory map format is given below:
41658 <!-- ................................................... -->
41659 <!-- Memory Map XML DTD ................................ -->
41660 <!-- File: memory-map.dtd .............................. -->
41661 <!-- .................................... .............. -->
41662 <!-- memory-map.dtd -->
41663 <!-- memory-map: Root element with versioning -->
41664 <!ELEMENT memory-map (memory | property)>
41665 <!ATTLIST memory-map version CDATA #FIXED "1.0.0">
41666 <!ELEMENT memory (property)>
41667 <!-- memory: Specifies a memory region,
41668 and its type, or device. -->
41669 <!ATTLIST memory type CDATA #REQUIRED
41670 start CDATA #REQUIRED
41671 length CDATA #REQUIRED
41672 device CDATA #IMPLIED>
41673 <!-- property: Generic attribute tag -->
41674 <!ELEMENT property (#PCDATA | property)*>
41675 <!ATTLIST property name CDATA #REQUIRED>
41678 @node Thread List Format
41679 @section Thread List Format
41680 @cindex thread list format
41682 To efficiently update the list of threads and their attributes,
41683 @value{GDBN} issues the @samp{qXfer:threads:read} packet
41684 (@pxref{qXfer threads read}) and obtains the XML document with
41685 the following structure:
41688 <?xml version="1.0"?>
41690 <thread id="id" core="0">
41691 ... description ...
41696 Each @samp{thread} element must have the @samp{id} attribute that
41697 identifies the thread (@pxref{thread-id syntax}). The
41698 @samp{core} attribute, if present, specifies which processor core
41699 the thread was last executing on. The content of the of @samp{thread}
41700 element is interpreted as human-readable auxilliary information.
41702 @node Traceframe Info Format
41703 @section Traceframe Info Format
41704 @cindex traceframe info format
41706 To be able to know which objects in the inferior can be examined when
41707 inspecting a tracepoint hit, @value{GDBN} needs to obtain the list of
41708 memory ranges, registers and trace state variables that have been
41709 collected in a traceframe.
41711 This list is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
41712 (@pxref{qXfer traceframe info read}) packet and is an XML document.
41714 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
41715 traceframe info discovery. @xref{Expat}.
41717 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
41720 <?xml version="1.0"?>
41721 <!DOCTYPE traceframe-info
41722 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Memory Map V1.0//EN"
41723 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-traceframe-info.dtd">
41729 Each traceframe block can be either:
41734 A region of collected memory starting at @var{addr} and extending for
41735 @var{length} bytes from there:
41738 <memory start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
41743 The formal DTD for the traceframe info format is given below:
41746 <!ELEMENT traceframe-info (memory)* >
41747 <!ATTLIST traceframe-info version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
41749 <!ELEMENT memory EMPTY>
41750 <!ATTLIST memory start CDATA #REQUIRED
41751 length CDATA #REQUIRED>
41754 @node Branch Trace Format
41755 @section Branch Trace Format
41756 @cindex branch trace format
41758 In order to display the branch trace of an inferior thread,
41759 @value{GDBN} needs to obtain the list of branches. This list is
41760 represented as list of sequential code blocks that are connected via
41761 branches. The code in each block has been executed sequentially.
41763 This list is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:btrace:read}
41764 (@pxref{qXfer btrace read}) packet and is an XML document.
41766 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
41767 traceframe info discovery. @xref{Expat}.
41769 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
41772 <?xml version="1.0"?>
41774 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Branch Trace V1.0//EN"
41775 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-btrace.dtd">
41784 A block of sequentially executed instructions starting at @var{begin}
41785 and ending at @var{end}:
41788 <block begin="@var{begin}" end="@var{end}"/>
41793 The formal DTD for the branch trace format is given below:
41796 <!ELEMENT btrace (block)* >
41797 <!ATTLIST btrace version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
41799 <!ELEMENT block EMPTY>
41800 <!ATTLIST block begin CDATA #REQUIRED
41801 end CDATA #REQUIRED>
41804 @include agentexpr.texi
41806 @node Target Descriptions
41807 @appendix Target Descriptions
41808 @cindex target descriptions
41810 One of the challenges of using @value{GDBN} to debug embedded systems
41811 is that there are so many minor variants of each processor
41812 architecture in use. It is common practice for vendors to start with
41813 a standard processor core --- ARM, PowerPC, or @acronym{MIPS}, for example ---
41814 and then make changes to adapt it to a particular market niche. Some
41815 architectures have hundreds of variants, available from dozens of
41816 vendors. This leads to a number of problems:
41820 With so many different customized processors, it is difficult for
41821 the @value{GDBN} maintainers to keep up with the changes.
41823 Since individual variants may have short lifetimes or limited
41824 audiences, it may not be worthwhile to carry information about every
41825 variant in the @value{GDBN} source tree.
41827 When @value{GDBN} does support the architecture of the embedded system
41828 at hand, the task of finding the correct architecture name to give the
41829 @command{set architecture} command can be error-prone.
41832 To address these problems, the @value{GDBN} remote protocol allows a
41833 target system to not only identify itself to @value{GDBN}, but to
41834 actually describe its own features. This lets @value{GDBN} support
41835 processor variants it has never seen before --- to the extent that the
41836 descriptions are accurate, and that @value{GDBN} understands them.
41838 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
41839 target descriptions. @xref{Expat}.
41842 * Retrieving Descriptions:: How descriptions are fetched from a target.
41843 * Target Description Format:: The contents of a target description.
41844 * Predefined Target Types:: Standard types available for target
41846 * Standard Target Features:: Features @value{GDBN} knows about.
41849 @node Retrieving Descriptions
41850 @section Retrieving Descriptions
41852 Target descriptions can be read from the target automatically, or
41853 specified by the user manually. The default behavior is to read the
41854 description from the target. @value{GDBN} retrieves it via the remote
41855 protocol using @samp{qXfer} requests (@pxref{General Query Packets,
41856 qXfer}). The @var{annex} in the @samp{qXfer} packet will be
41857 @samp{target.xml}. The contents of the @samp{target.xml} annex are an
41858 XML document, of the form described in @ref{Target Description
41861 Alternatively, you can specify a file to read for the target description.
41862 If a file is set, the target will not be queried. The commands to
41863 specify a file are:
41866 @cindex set tdesc filename
41867 @item set tdesc filename @var{path}
41868 Read the target description from @var{path}.
41870 @cindex unset tdesc filename
41871 @item unset tdesc filename
41872 Do not read the XML target description from a file. @value{GDBN}
41873 will use the description supplied by the current target.
41875 @cindex show tdesc filename
41876 @item show tdesc filename
41877 Show the filename to read for a target description, if any.
41881 @node Target Description Format
41882 @section Target Description Format
41883 @cindex target descriptions, XML format
41885 A target description annex is an @uref{http://www.w3.org/XML/, XML}
41886 document which complies with the Document Type Definition provided in
41887 the @value{GDBN} sources in @file{gdb/features/gdb-target.dtd}. This
41888 means you can use generally available tools like @command{xmllint} to
41889 check that your feature descriptions are well-formed and valid.
41890 However, to help people unfamiliar with XML write descriptions for
41891 their targets, we also describe the grammar here.
41893 Target descriptions can identify the architecture of the remote target
41894 and (for some architectures) provide information about custom register
41895 sets. They can also identify the OS ABI of the remote target.
41896 @value{GDBN} can use this information to autoconfigure for your
41897 target, or to warn you if you connect to an unsupported target.
41899 Here is a simple target description:
41902 <target version="1.0">
41903 <architecture>i386:x86-64</architecture>
41908 This minimal description only says that the target uses
41909 the x86-64 architecture.
41911 A target description has the following overall form, with [ ] marking
41912 optional elements and @dots{} marking repeatable elements. The elements
41913 are explained further below.
41916 <?xml version="1.0"?>
41917 <!DOCTYPE target SYSTEM "gdb-target.dtd">
41918 <target version="1.0">
41919 @r{[}@var{architecture}@r{]}
41920 @r{[}@var{osabi}@r{]}
41921 @r{[}@var{compatible}@r{]}
41922 @r{[}@var{feature}@dots{}@r{]}
41927 The description is generally insensitive to whitespace and line
41928 breaks, under the usual common-sense rules. The XML version
41929 declaration and document type declaration can generally be omitted
41930 (@value{GDBN} does not require them), but specifying them may be
41931 useful for XML validation tools. The @samp{version} attribute for
41932 @samp{<target>} may also be omitted, but we recommend
41933 including it; if future versions of @value{GDBN} use an incompatible
41934 revision of @file{gdb-target.dtd}, they will detect and report
41935 the version mismatch.
41937 @subsection Inclusion
41938 @cindex target descriptions, inclusion
41941 @cindex <xi:include>
41944 It can sometimes be valuable to split a target description up into
41945 several different annexes, either for organizational purposes, or to
41946 share files between different possible target descriptions. You can
41947 divide a description into multiple files by replacing any element of
41948 the target description with an inclusion directive of the form:
41951 <xi:include href="@var{document}"/>
41955 When @value{GDBN} encounters an element of this form, it will retrieve
41956 the named XML @var{document}, and replace the inclusion directive with
41957 the contents of that document. If the current description was read
41958 using @samp{qXfer}, then so will be the included document;
41959 @var{document} will be interpreted as the name of an annex. If the
41960 current description was read from a file, @value{GDBN} will look for
41961 @var{document} as a file in the same directory where it found the
41962 original description.
41964 @subsection Architecture
41965 @cindex <architecture>
41967 An @samp{<architecture>} element has this form:
41970 <architecture>@var{arch}</architecture>
41973 @var{arch} is one of the architectures from the set accepted by
41974 @code{set architecture} (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
41977 @cindex @code{<osabi>}
41979 This optional field was introduced in @value{GDBN} version 7.0.
41980 Previous versions of @value{GDBN} ignore it.
41982 An @samp{<osabi>} element has this form:
41985 <osabi>@var{abi-name}</osabi>
41988 @var{abi-name} is an OS ABI name from the same selection accepted by
41989 @w{@code{set osabi}} (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the Current ABI}).
41991 @subsection Compatible Architecture
41992 @cindex @code{<compatible>}
41994 This optional field was introduced in @value{GDBN} version 7.0.
41995 Previous versions of @value{GDBN} ignore it.
41997 A @samp{<compatible>} element has this form:
42000 <compatible>@var{arch}</compatible>
42003 @var{arch} is one of the architectures from the set accepted by
42004 @code{set architecture} (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
42006 A @samp{<compatible>} element is used to specify that the target
42007 is able to run binaries in some other than the main target architecture
42008 given by the @samp{<architecture>} element. For example, on the
42009 Cell Broadband Engine, the main architecture is @code{powerpc:common}
42010 or @code{powerpc:common64}, but the system is able to run binaries
42011 in the @code{spu} architecture as well. The way to describe this
42012 capability with @samp{<compatible>} is as follows:
42015 <architecture>powerpc:common</architecture>
42016 <compatible>spu</compatible>
42019 @subsection Features
42022 Each @samp{<feature>} describes some logical portion of the target
42023 system. Features are currently used to describe available CPU
42024 registers and the types of their contents. A @samp{<feature>} element
42028 <feature name="@var{name}">
42029 @r{[}@var{type}@dots{}@r{]}
42035 Each feature's name should be unique within the description. The name
42036 of a feature does not matter unless @value{GDBN} has some special
42037 knowledge of the contents of that feature; if it does, the feature
42038 should have its standard name. @xref{Standard Target Features}.
42042 Any register's value is a collection of bits which @value{GDBN} must
42043 interpret. The default interpretation is a two's complement integer,
42044 but other types can be requested by name in the register description.
42045 Some predefined types are provided by @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Predefined
42046 Target Types}), and the description can define additional composite types.
42048 Each type element must have an @samp{id} attribute, which gives
42049 a unique (within the containing @samp{<feature>}) name to the type.
42050 Types must be defined before they are used.
42053 Some targets offer vector registers, which can be treated as arrays
42054 of scalar elements. These types are written as @samp{<vector>} elements,
42055 specifying the array element type, @var{type}, and the number of elements,
42059 <vector id="@var{id}" type="@var{type}" count="@var{count}"/>
42063 If a register's value is usefully viewed in multiple ways, define it
42064 with a union type containing the useful representations. The
42065 @samp{<union>} element contains one or more @samp{<field>} elements,
42066 each of which has a @var{name} and a @var{type}:
42069 <union id="@var{id}">
42070 <field name="@var{name}" type="@var{type}"/>
42076 If a register's value is composed from several separate values, define
42077 it with a structure type. There are two forms of the @samp{<struct>}
42078 element; a @samp{<struct>} element must either contain only bitfields
42079 or contain no bitfields. If the structure contains only bitfields,
42080 its total size in bytes must be specified, each bitfield must have an
42081 explicit start and end, and bitfields are automatically assigned an
42082 integer type. The field's @var{start} should be less than or
42083 equal to its @var{end}, and zero represents the least significant bit.
42086 <struct id="@var{id}" size="@var{size}">
42087 <field name="@var{name}" start="@var{start}" end="@var{end}"/>
42092 If the structure contains no bitfields, then each field has an
42093 explicit type, and no implicit padding is added.
42096 <struct id="@var{id}">
42097 <field name="@var{name}" type="@var{type}"/>
42103 If a register's value is a series of single-bit flags, define it with
42104 a flags type. The @samp{<flags>} element has an explicit @var{size}
42105 and contains one or more @samp{<field>} elements. Each field has a
42106 @var{name}, a @var{start}, and an @var{end}. Only single-bit flags
42110 <flags id="@var{id}" size="@var{size}">
42111 <field name="@var{name}" start="@var{start}" end="@var{end}"/>
42116 @subsection Registers
42119 Each register is represented as an element with this form:
42122 <reg name="@var{name}"
42123 bitsize="@var{size}"
42124 @r{[}regnum="@var{num}"@r{]}
42125 @r{[}save-restore="@var{save-restore}"@r{]}
42126 @r{[}type="@var{type}"@r{]}
42127 @r{[}group="@var{group}"@r{]}/>
42131 The components are as follows:
42136 The register's name; it must be unique within the target description.
42139 The register's size, in bits.
42142 The register's number. If omitted, a register's number is one greater
42143 than that of the previous register (either in the current feature or in
42144 a preceding feature); the first register in the target description
42145 defaults to zero. This register number is used to read or write
42146 the register; e.g.@: it is used in the remote @code{p} and @code{P}
42147 packets, and registers appear in the @code{g} and @code{G} packets
42148 in order of increasing register number.
42151 Whether the register should be preserved across inferior function
42152 calls; this must be either @code{yes} or @code{no}. The default is
42153 @code{yes}, which is appropriate for most registers except for
42154 some system control registers; this is not related to the target's
42158 The type of the register. @var{type} may be a predefined type, a type
42159 defined in the current feature, or one of the special types @code{int}
42160 and @code{float}. @code{int} is an integer type of the correct size
42161 for @var{bitsize}, and @code{float} is a floating point type (in the
42162 architecture's normal floating point format) of the correct size for
42163 @var{bitsize}. The default is @code{int}.
42166 The register group to which this register belongs. @var{group} must
42167 be either @code{general}, @code{float}, or @code{vector}. If no
42168 @var{group} is specified, @value{GDBN} will not display the register
42169 in @code{info registers}.
42173 @node Predefined Target Types
42174 @section Predefined Target Types
42175 @cindex target descriptions, predefined types
42177 Type definitions in the self-description can build up composite types
42178 from basic building blocks, but can not define fundamental types. Instead,
42179 standard identifiers are provided by @value{GDBN} for the fundamental
42180 types. The currently supported types are:
42189 Signed integer types holding the specified number of bits.
42196 Unsigned integer types holding the specified number of bits.
42200 Pointers to unspecified code and data. The program counter and
42201 any dedicated return address register may be marked as code
42202 pointers; printing a code pointer converts it into a symbolic
42203 address. The stack pointer and any dedicated address registers
42204 may be marked as data pointers.
42207 Single precision IEEE floating point.
42210 Double precision IEEE floating point.
42213 The 12-byte extended precision format used by ARM FPA registers.
42216 The 10-byte extended precision format used by x87 registers.
42219 32bit @sc{eflags} register used by x86.
42222 32bit @sc{mxcsr} register used by x86.
42226 @node Standard Target Features
42227 @section Standard Target Features
42228 @cindex target descriptions, standard features
42230 A target description must contain either no registers or all the
42231 target's registers. If the description contains no registers, then
42232 @value{GDBN} will assume a default register layout, selected based on
42233 the architecture. If the description contains any registers, the
42234 default layout will not be used; the standard registers must be
42235 described in the target description, in such a way that @value{GDBN}
42236 can recognize them.
42238 This is accomplished by giving specific names to feature elements
42239 which contain standard registers. @value{GDBN} will look for features
42240 with those names and verify that they contain the expected registers;
42241 if any known feature is missing required registers, or if any required
42242 feature is missing, @value{GDBN} will reject the target
42243 description. You can add additional registers to any of the
42244 standard features --- @value{GDBN} will display them just as if
42245 they were added to an unrecognized feature.
42247 This section lists the known features and their expected contents.
42248 Sample XML documents for these features are included in the
42249 @value{GDBN} source tree, in the directory @file{gdb/features}.
42251 Names recognized by @value{GDBN} should include the name of the
42252 company or organization which selected the name, and the overall
42253 architecture to which the feature applies; so e.g.@: the feature
42254 containing ARM core registers is named @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core}.
42256 The names of registers are not case sensitive for the purpose
42257 of recognizing standard features, but @value{GDBN} will only display
42258 registers using the capitalization used in the description.
42261 * AArch64 Features::
42266 * Nios II Features::
42267 * PowerPC Features::
42272 @node AArch64 Features
42273 @subsection AArch64 Features
42274 @cindex target descriptions, AArch64 features
42276 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.aarch64.core} feature is required for AArch64
42277 targets. It should contain registers @samp{x0} through @samp{x30},
42278 @samp{sp}, @samp{pc}, and @samp{cpsr}.
42280 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.aarch64.fpu} feature is optional. If present,
42281 it should contain registers @samp{v0} through @samp{v31}, @samp{fpsr},
42285 @subsection ARM Features
42286 @cindex target descriptions, ARM features
42288 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core} feature is required for non-M-profile
42290 It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r13}, @samp{sp},
42291 @samp{lr}, @samp{pc}, and @samp{cpsr}.
42293 For M-profile targets (e.g. Cortex-M3), the @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core}
42294 feature is replaced by @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.m-profile}. It should contain
42295 registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r13}, @samp{sp}, @samp{lr}, @samp{pc},
42298 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.fpa} feature is optional. If present, it
42299 should contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f7} and @samp{fps}.
42301 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.xscale.iwmmxt} feature is optional. If present,
42302 it should contain at least registers @samp{wR0} through @samp{wR15} and
42303 @samp{wCGR0} through @samp{wCGR3}. The @samp{wCID}, @samp{wCon},
42304 @samp{wCSSF}, and @samp{wCASF} registers are optional.
42306 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.vfp} feature is optional. If present, it
42307 should contain at least registers @samp{d0} through @samp{d15}. If
42308 they are present, @samp{d16} through @samp{d31} should also be included.
42309 @value{GDBN} will synthesize the single-precision registers from
42310 halves of the double-precision registers.
42312 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.neon} feature is optional. It does not
42313 need to contain registers; it instructs @value{GDBN} to display the
42314 VFP double-precision registers as vectors and to synthesize the
42315 quad-precision registers from pairs of double-precision registers.
42316 If this feature is present, @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.vfp} must also
42317 be present and include 32 double-precision registers.
42319 @node i386 Features
42320 @subsection i386 Features
42321 @cindex target descriptions, i386 features
42323 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.core} feature is required for i386/amd64
42324 targets. It should describe the following registers:
42328 @samp{eax} through @samp{edi} plus @samp{eip} for i386
42330 @samp{rax} through @samp{r15} plus @samp{rip} for amd64
42332 @samp{eflags}, @samp{cs}, @samp{ss}, @samp{ds}, @samp{es},
42333 @samp{fs}, @samp{gs}
42335 @samp{st0} through @samp{st7}
42337 @samp{fctrl}, @samp{fstat}, @samp{ftag}, @samp{fiseg}, @samp{fioff},
42338 @samp{foseg}, @samp{fooff} and @samp{fop}
42341 The register sets may be different, depending on the target.
42343 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.sse} feature is optional. It should
42344 describe registers:
42348 @samp{xmm0} through @samp{xmm7} for i386
42350 @samp{xmm0} through @samp{xmm15} for amd64
42355 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.avx} feature is optional and requires the
42356 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.sse} feature. It should
42357 describe the upper 128 bits of @sc{ymm} registers:
42361 @samp{ymm0h} through @samp{ymm7h} for i386
42363 @samp{ymm0h} through @samp{ymm15h} for amd64
42366 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.linux} feature is optional. It should
42367 describe a single register, @samp{orig_eax}.
42369 @node MIPS Features
42370 @subsection @acronym{MIPS} Features
42371 @cindex target descriptions, @acronym{MIPS} features
42373 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cpu} feature is required for @acronym{MIPS} targets.
42374 It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31}, @samp{lo},
42375 @samp{hi}, and @samp{pc}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending
42378 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cp0} feature is also required. It should
42379 contain at least the @samp{status}, @samp{badvaddr}, and @samp{cause}
42380 registers. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
42382 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.fpu} feature is currently required, though
42383 it may be optional in a future version of @value{GDBN}. It should
42384 contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31}, @samp{fcsr}, and
42385 @samp{fir}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
42387 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.dsp} feature is optional. It should
42388 contain registers @samp{hi1} through @samp{hi3}, @samp{lo1} through
42389 @samp{lo3}, and @samp{dspctl}. The @samp{dspctl} register should
42390 be 32-bit and the rest may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
42392 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.linux} feature is optional. It should
42393 contain a single register, @samp{restart}, which is used by the
42394 Linux kernel to control restartable syscalls.
42396 @node M68K Features
42397 @subsection M68K Features
42398 @cindex target descriptions, M68K features
42401 @item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.m68k.core}
42402 @itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.core}
42403 @itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.fido.core}
42404 One of those features must be always present.
42405 The feature that is present determines which flavor of m68k is
42406 used. The feature that is present should contain registers
42407 @samp{d0} through @samp{d7}, @samp{a0} through @samp{a5}, @samp{fp},
42408 @samp{sp}, @samp{ps} and @samp{pc}.
42410 @item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.fp}
42411 This feature is optional. If present, it should contain registers
42412 @samp{fp0} through @samp{fp7}, @samp{fpcontrol}, @samp{fpstatus} and
42416 @node Nios II Features
42417 @subsection Nios II Features
42418 @cindex target descriptions, Nios II features
42420 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.nios2.cpu} feature is required for Nios II
42421 targets. It should contain the 32 core registers (@samp{zero},
42422 @samp{at}, @samp{r2} through @samp{r23}, @samp{et} through @samp{ra}),
42423 @samp{pc}, and the 16 control registers (@samp{status} through
42426 @node PowerPC Features
42427 @subsection PowerPC Features
42428 @cindex target descriptions, PowerPC features
42430 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.core} feature is required for PowerPC
42431 targets. It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31},
42432 @samp{pc}, @samp{msr}, @samp{cr}, @samp{lr}, @samp{ctr}, and
42433 @samp{xer}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
42435 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.fpu} feature is optional. It should
42436 contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31} and @samp{fpscr}.
42438 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.altivec} feature is optional. It should
42439 contain registers @samp{vr0} through @samp{vr31}, @samp{vscr},
42442 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.vsx} feature is optional. It should
42443 contain registers @samp{vs0h} through @samp{vs31h}. @value{GDBN}
42444 will combine these registers with the floating point registers
42445 (@samp{f0} through @samp{f31}) and the altivec registers (@samp{vr0}
42446 through @samp{vr31}) to present the 128-bit wide registers @samp{vs0}
42447 through @samp{vs63}, the set of vector registers for POWER7.
42449 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.spe} feature is optional. It should
42450 contain registers @samp{ev0h} through @samp{ev31h}, @samp{acc}, and
42451 @samp{spefscr}. SPE targets should provide 32-bit registers in
42452 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.core} and provide the upper halves in
42453 @samp{ev0h} through @samp{ev31h}. @value{GDBN} will combine
42454 these to present registers @samp{ev0} through @samp{ev31} to the
42457 @node TIC6x Features
42458 @subsection TMS320C6x Features
42459 @cindex target descriptions, TIC6x features
42460 @cindex target descriptions, TMS320C6x features
42461 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.tic6x.core} feature is required for TMS320C6x
42462 targets. It should contain registers @samp{A0} through @samp{A15},
42463 registers @samp{B0} through @samp{B15}, @samp{CSR} and @samp{PC}.
42465 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.tic6x.gp} feature is optional. It should
42466 contain registers @samp{A16} through @samp{A31} and @samp{B16}
42467 through @samp{B31}.
42469 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.tic6x.c6xp} feature is optional. It should
42470 contain registers @samp{TSR}, @samp{ILC} and @samp{RILC}.
42472 @node Operating System Information
42473 @appendix Operating System Information
42474 @cindex operating system information
42480 Users of @value{GDBN} often wish to obtain information about the state of
42481 the operating system running on the target---for example the list of
42482 processes, or the list of open files. This section describes the
42483 mechanism that makes it possible. This mechanism is similar to the
42484 target features mechanism (@pxref{Target Descriptions}), but focuses
42485 on a different aspect of target.
42487 Operating system information is retrived from the target via the
42488 remote protocol, using @samp{qXfer} requests (@pxref{qXfer osdata
42489 read}). The object name in the request should be @samp{osdata}, and
42490 the @var{annex} identifies the data to be fetched.
42493 @appendixsection Process list
42494 @cindex operating system information, process list
42496 When requesting the process list, the @var{annex} field in the
42497 @samp{qXfer} request should be @samp{processes}. The returned data is
42498 an XML document. The formal syntax of this document is defined in
42499 @file{gdb/features/osdata.dtd}.
42501 An example document is:
42504 <?xml version="1.0"?>
42505 <!DOCTYPE target SYSTEM "osdata.dtd">
42506 <osdata type="processes">
42508 <column name="pid">1</column>
42509 <column name="user">root</column>
42510 <column name="command">/sbin/init</column>
42511 <column name="cores">1,2,3</column>
42516 Each item should include a column whose name is @samp{pid}. The value
42517 of that column should identify the process on the target. The
42518 @samp{user} and @samp{command} columns are optional, and will be
42519 displayed by @value{GDBN}. The @samp{cores} column, if present,
42520 should contain a comma-separated list of cores that this process
42521 is running on. Target may provide additional columns,
42522 which @value{GDBN} currently ignores.
42524 @node Trace File Format
42525 @appendix Trace File Format
42526 @cindex trace file format
42528 The trace file comes in three parts: a header, a textual description
42529 section, and a trace frame section with binary data.
42531 The header has the form @code{\x7fTRACE0\n}. The first byte is
42532 @code{0x7f} so as to indicate that the file contains binary data,
42533 while the @code{0} is a version number that may have different values
42536 The description section consists of multiple lines of @sc{ascii} text
42537 separated by newline characters (@code{0xa}). The lines may include a
42538 variety of optional descriptive or context-setting information, such
42539 as tracepoint definitions or register set size. @value{GDBN} will
42540 ignore any line that it does not recognize. An empty line marks the end
42543 @c FIXME add some specific types of data
42545 The trace frame section consists of a number of consecutive frames.
42546 Each frame begins with a two-byte tracepoint number, followed by a
42547 four-byte size giving the amount of data in the frame. The data in
42548 the frame consists of a number of blocks, each introduced by a
42549 character indicating its type (at least register, memory, and trace
42550 state variable). The data in this section is raw binary, not a
42551 hexadecimal or other encoding; its endianness matches the target's
42554 @c FIXME bi-arch may require endianness/arch info in description section
42557 @item R @var{bytes}
42558 Register block. The number and ordering of bytes matches that of a
42559 @code{g} packet in the remote protocol. Note that these are the
42560 actual bytes, in target order and @value{GDBN} register order, not a
42561 hexadecimal encoding.
42563 @item M @var{address} @var{length} @var{bytes}...
42564 Memory block. This is a contiguous block of memory, at the 8-byte
42565 address @var{address}, with a 2-byte length @var{length}, followed by
42566 @var{length} bytes.
42568 @item V @var{number} @var{value}
42569 Trace state variable block. This records the 8-byte signed value
42570 @var{value} of trace state variable numbered @var{number}.
42574 Future enhancements of the trace file format may include additional types
42577 @node Index Section Format
42578 @appendix @code{.gdb_index} section format
42579 @cindex .gdb_index section format
42580 @cindex index section format
42582 This section documents the index section that is created by @code{save
42583 gdb-index} (@pxref{Index Files}). The index section is
42584 DWARF-specific; some knowledge of DWARF is assumed in this
42587 The mapped index file format is designed to be directly
42588 @code{mmap}able on any architecture. In most cases, a datum is
42589 represented using a little-endian 32-bit integer value, called an
42590 @code{offset_type}. Big endian machines must byte-swap the values
42591 before using them. Exceptions to this rule are noted. The data is
42592 laid out such that alignment is always respected.
42594 A mapped index consists of several areas, laid out in order.
42598 The file header. This is a sequence of values, of @code{offset_type}
42599 unless otherwise noted:
42603 The version number, currently 8. Versions 1, 2 and 3 are obsolete.
42604 Version 4 uses a different hashing function from versions 5 and 6.
42605 Version 6 includes symbols for inlined functions, whereas versions 4
42606 and 5 do not. Version 7 adds attributes to the CU indices in the
42607 symbol table. Version 8 specifies that symbols from DWARF type units
42608 (@samp{DW_TAG_type_unit}) refer to the type unit's symbol table and not the
42609 compilation unit (@samp{DW_TAG_comp_unit}) using the type.
42611 @value{GDBN} will only read version 4, 5, or 6 indices
42612 by specifying @code{set use-deprecated-index-sections on}.
42613 GDB has a workaround for potentially broken version 7 indices so it is
42614 currently not flagged as deprecated.
42617 The offset, from the start of the file, of the CU list.
42620 The offset, from the start of the file, of the types CU list. Note
42621 that this area can be empty, in which case this offset will be equal
42622 to the next offset.
42625 The offset, from the start of the file, of the address area.
42628 The offset, from the start of the file, of the symbol table.
42631 The offset, from the start of the file, of the constant pool.
42635 The CU list. This is a sequence of pairs of 64-bit little-endian
42636 values, sorted by the CU offset. The first element in each pair is
42637 the offset of a CU in the @code{.debug_info} section. The second
42638 element in each pair is the length of that CU. References to a CU
42639 elsewhere in the map are done using a CU index, which is just the
42640 0-based index into this table. Note that if there are type CUs, then
42641 conceptually CUs and type CUs form a single list for the purposes of
42645 The types CU list. This is a sequence of triplets of 64-bit
42646 little-endian values. In a triplet, the first value is the CU offset,
42647 the second value is the type offset in the CU, and the third value is
42648 the type signature. The types CU list is not sorted.
42651 The address area. The address area consists of a sequence of address
42652 entries. Each address entry has three elements:
42656 The low address. This is a 64-bit little-endian value.
42659 The high address. This is a 64-bit little-endian value. Like
42660 @code{DW_AT_high_pc}, the value is one byte beyond the end.
42663 The CU index. This is an @code{offset_type} value.
42667 The symbol table. This is an open-addressed hash table. The size of
42668 the hash table is always a power of 2.
42670 Each slot in the hash table consists of a pair of @code{offset_type}
42671 values. The first value is the offset of the symbol's name in the
42672 constant pool. The second value is the offset of the CU vector in the
42675 If both values are 0, then this slot in the hash table is empty. This
42676 is ok because while 0 is a valid constant pool index, it cannot be a
42677 valid index for both a string and a CU vector.
42679 The hash value for a table entry is computed by applying an
42680 iterative hash function to the symbol's name. Starting with an
42681 initial value of @code{r = 0}, each (unsigned) character @samp{c} in
42682 the string is incorporated into the hash using the formula depending on the
42687 The formula is @code{r = r * 67 + c - 113}.
42689 @item Versions 5 to 7
42690 The formula is @code{r = r * 67 + tolower (c) - 113}.
42693 The terminating @samp{\0} is not incorporated into the hash.
42695 The step size used in the hash table is computed via
42696 @code{((hash * 17) & (size - 1)) | 1}, where @samp{hash} is the hash
42697 value, and @samp{size} is the size of the hash table. The step size
42698 is used to find the next candidate slot when handling a hash
42701 The names of C@t{++} symbols in the hash table are canonicalized. We
42702 don't currently have a simple description of the canonicalization
42703 algorithm; if you intend to create new index sections, you must read
42707 The constant pool. This is simply a bunch of bytes. It is organized
42708 so that alignment is correct: CU vectors are stored first, followed by
42711 A CU vector in the constant pool is a sequence of @code{offset_type}
42712 values. The first value is the number of CU indices in the vector.
42713 Each subsequent value is the index and symbol attributes of a CU in
42714 the CU list. This element in the hash table is used to indicate which
42715 CUs define the symbol and how the symbol is used.
42716 See below for the format of each CU index+attributes entry.
42718 A string in the constant pool is zero-terminated.
42721 Attributes were added to CU index values in @code{.gdb_index} version 7.
42722 If a symbol has multiple uses within a CU then there is one
42723 CU index+attributes value for each use.
42725 The format of each CU index+attributes entry is as follows
42731 This is the index of the CU in the CU list.
42733 These bits are reserved for future purposes and must be zero.
42735 The kind of the symbol in the CU.
42739 This value is reserved and should not be used.
42740 By reserving zero the full @code{offset_type} value is backwards compatible
42741 with previous versions of the index.
42743 The symbol is a type.
42745 The symbol is a variable or an enum value.
42747 The symbol is a function.
42749 Any other kind of symbol.
42751 These values are reserved.
42755 This bit is zero if the value is global and one if it is static.
42757 The determination of whether a symbol is global or static is complicated.
42758 The authorative reference is the file @file{dwarf2read.c} in
42759 @value{GDBN} sources.
42763 This pseudo-code describes the computation of a symbol's kind and
42764 global/static attributes in the index.
42767 is_external = get_attribute (die, DW_AT_external);
42768 language = get_attribute (cu_die, DW_AT_language);
42771 case DW_TAG_typedef:
42772 case DW_TAG_base_type:
42773 case DW_TAG_subrange_type:
42777 case DW_TAG_enumerator:
42779 is_static = (language != CPLUS && language != JAVA);
42781 case DW_TAG_subprogram:
42783 is_static = ! (is_external || language == ADA);
42785 case DW_TAG_constant:
42787 is_static = ! is_external;
42789 case DW_TAG_variable:
42791 is_static = ! is_external;
42793 case DW_TAG_namespace:
42797 case DW_TAG_class_type:
42798 case DW_TAG_interface_type:
42799 case DW_TAG_structure_type:
42800 case DW_TAG_union_type:
42801 case DW_TAG_enumeration_type:
42803 is_static = (language != CPLUS && language != JAVA);
42811 @appendix Manual pages
42815 * gdb man:: The GNU Debugger man page
42816 * gdbserver man:: Remote Server for the GNU Debugger man page
42817 * gcore man:: Generate a core file of a running program
42818 * gdbinit man:: gdbinit scripts
42824 @c man title gdb The GNU Debugger
42826 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gdb
42827 gdb [@option{-help}] [@option{-nh}] [@option{-nx}] [@option{-q}]
42828 [@option{-batch}] [@option{-cd=}@var{dir}] [@option{-f}]
42829 [@option{-b}@w{ }@var{bps}]
42830 [@option{-tty=}@var{dev}] [@option{-s} @var{symfile}]
42831 [@option{-e}@w{ }@var{prog}] [@option{-se}@w{ }@var{prog}]
42832 [@option{-c}@w{ }@var{core}] [@option{-p}@w{ }@var{procID}]
42833 [@option{-x}@w{ }@var{cmds}] [@option{-d}@w{ }@var{dir}]
42834 [@var{prog}|@var{prog} @var{procID}|@var{prog} @var{core}]
42837 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gdb
42838 The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
42839 going on ``inside'' another program while it executes -- or what another
42840 program was doing at the moment it crashed.
42842 @value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
42843 these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
42847 Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
42850 Make your program stop on specified conditions.
42853 Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
42856 Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
42857 effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
42860 You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C, C@t{++}, Fortran and
42863 @value{GDBN} is invoked with the shell command @code{gdb}. Once started, it reads
42864 commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit with the @value{GDBN}
42865 command @code{quit}. You can get online help from @value{GDBN} itself
42866 by using the command @code{help}.
42868 You can run @code{gdb} with no arguments or options; but the most
42869 usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument or two, specifying an
42870 executable program as the argument:
42876 You can also start with both an executable program and a core file specified:
42882 You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
42883 to debug a running process:
42891 would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
42892 named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
42893 With option @option{-p} you can omit the @var{program} filename.
42895 Here are some of the most frequently needed @value{GDBN} commands:
42897 @c pod2man highlights the right hand side of the @item lines.
42899 @item break [@var{file}:]@var{functiop}
42900 Set a breakpoint at @var{function} (in @var{file}).
42902 @item run [@var{arglist}]
42903 Start your program (with @var{arglist}, if specified).
42906 Backtrace: display the program stack.
42908 @item print @var{expr}
42909 Display the value of an expression.
42912 Continue running your program (after stopping, e.g. at a breakpoint).
42915 Execute next program line (after stopping); step @emph{over} any
42916 function calls in the line.
42918 @item edit [@var{file}:]@var{function}
42919 look at the program line where it is presently stopped.
42921 @item list [@var{file}:]@var{function}
42922 type the text of the program in the vicinity of where it is presently stopped.
42925 Execute next program line (after stopping); step @emph{into} any
42926 function calls in the line.
42928 @item help [@var{name}]
42929 Show information about @value{GDBN} command @var{name}, or general information
42930 about using @value{GDBN}.
42933 Exit from @value{GDBN}.
42937 For full details on @value{GDBN},
42938 see @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
42939 by Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch. The same text is available online
42940 as the @code{gdb} entry in the @code{info} program.
42944 @c man begin OPTIONS gdb
42945 Any arguments other than options specify an executable
42946 file and core file (or process ID); that is, the first argument
42947 encountered with no
42948 associated option flag is equivalent to a @option{-se} option, and the second,
42949 if any, is equivalent to a @option{-c} option if it's the name of a file.
42951 both long and short forms; both are shown here. The long forms are also
42952 recognized if you truncate them, so long as enough of the option is
42953 present to be unambiguous. (If you prefer, you can flag option
42954 arguments with @option{+} rather than @option{-}, though we illustrate the
42955 more usual convention.)
42957 All the options and command line arguments you give are processed
42958 in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the @option{-x}
42964 List all options, with brief explanations.
42966 @item -symbols=@var{file}
42967 @itemx -s @var{file}
42968 Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
42971 Enable writing into executable and core files.
42973 @item -exec=@var{file}
42974 @itemx -e @var{file}
42975 Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when
42976 appropriate, and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core
42979 @item -se=@var{file}
42980 Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
42983 @item -core=@var{file}
42984 @itemx -c @var{file}
42985 Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
42987 @item -command=@var{file}
42988 @itemx -x @var{file}
42989 Execute @value{GDBN} commands from file @var{file}.
42991 @item -ex @var{command}
42992 Execute given @value{GDBN} @var{command}.
42994 @item -directory=@var{directory}
42995 @itemx -d @var{directory}
42996 Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source files.
42999 Do not execute commands from @file{~/.gdbinit}.
43003 Do not execute commands from any @file{.gdbinit} initialization files.
43007 ``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
43008 messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
43011 Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the command
43012 files specified with @option{-x} (and @file{.gdbinit}, if not inhibited).
43013 Exit with nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN}
43014 commands in the command files.
43016 Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for example to
43017 download and run a program on another computer; in order to make this
43018 more useful, the message
43021 Program exited normally.
43025 (which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under @value{GDBN} control
43026 terminates) is not issued when running in batch mode.
43028 @item -cd=@var{directory}
43029 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
43030 instead of the current directory.
43034 Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a subprocess. It tells
43035 @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line number in a standard,
43036 recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is displayed (which
43037 includes each time the program stops). This recognizable format looks
43038 like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by the file name, line number
43039 and character position separated by colons, and a newline. The
43040 Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two @samp{\032}
43041 characters as a signal to display the source code for the frame.
43044 Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
43045 interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
43047 @item -tty=@var{device}
43048 Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
43052 @c man begin SEEALSO gdb
43054 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
43055 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
43056 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
43063 should give you access to the complete manual.
43065 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
43066 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
43070 @node gdbserver man
43071 @heading gdbserver man
43073 @c man title gdbserver Remote Server for the GNU Debugger
43075 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gdbserver
43076 gdbserver @var{comm} @var{prog} [@var{args}@dots{}]
43078 gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
43080 gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
43084 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gdbserver
43085 @command{gdbserver} is a program that allows you to run @value{GDBN} on a different machine
43086 than the one which is running the program being debugged.
43089 @subheading Usage (server (target) side)
43092 Usage (server (target) side):
43095 First, you need to have a copy of the program you want to debug put onto
43096 the target system. The program can be stripped to save space if needed, as
43097 @command{gdbserver} doesn't care about symbols. All symbol handling is taken care of by
43098 the @value{GDBN} running on the host system.
43100 To use the server, you log on to the target system, and run the @command{gdbserver}
43101 program. You must tell it (a) how to communicate with @value{GDBN}, (b) the name of
43102 your program, and (c) its arguments. The general syntax is:
43105 target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [@var{args} ...]
43108 For example, using a serial port, you might say:
43112 @c @file would wrap it as F</dev/com1>.
43113 target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
43116 target> gdbserver @file{/dev/com1} emacs foo.txt
43120 This tells @command{gdbserver} to debug emacs with an argument of foo.txt, and
43121 to communicate with @value{GDBN} via @file{/dev/com1}. @command{gdbserver} now
43122 waits patiently for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate with it.
43124 To use a TCP connection, you could say:
43127 target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
43130 This says pretty much the same thing as the last example, except that we are
43131 going to communicate with the @code{host} @value{GDBN} via TCP. The @code{host:2345} argument means
43132 that we are expecting to see a TCP connection from @code{host} to local TCP port
43133 2345. (Currently, the @code{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number you
43134 want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any existing TCP
43135 ports on the target system. This same port number must be used in the host
43136 @value{GDBN}s @code{target remote} command, which will be described shortly. Note that if
43137 you chose a port number that conflicts with another service, @command{gdbserver} will
43138 print an error message and exit.
43140 @command{gdbserver} can also attach to running programs.
43141 This is accomplished via the @option{--attach} argument. The syntax is:
43144 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
43147 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't
43148 necessary to point @command{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
43150 To start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
43151 or process ID to attach, use the @option{--multi} command line option.
43152 In such case you should connect using @kbd{target extended-remote} to start
43153 the program you want to debug.
43156 target> gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
43160 @subheading Usage (host side)
43166 You need an unstripped copy of the target program on your host system, since
43167 @value{GDBN} needs to examine it's symbol tables and such. Start up @value{GDBN} as you normally
43168 would, with the target program as the first argument. (You may need to use the
43169 @option{--baud} option if the serial line is running at anything except 9600 baud.)
43170 That is @code{gdb TARGET-PROG}, or @code{gdb --baud BAUD TARGET-PROG}. After that, the only
43171 new command you need to know about is @code{target remote}
43172 (or @code{target extended-remote}). Its argument is either
43173 a device name (usually a serial device, like @file{/dev/ttyb}), or a @code{HOST:PORT}
43174 descriptor. For example:
43178 @c @file would wrap it as F</dev/ttyb>.
43179 (gdb) target remote /dev/ttyb
43182 (gdb) target remote @file{/dev/ttyb}
43187 communicates with the server via serial line @file{/dev/ttyb}, and:
43190 (gdb) target remote the-target:2345
43194 communicates via a TCP connection to port 2345 on host `the-target', where
43195 you previously started up @command{gdbserver} with the same port number. Note that for
43196 TCP connections, you must start up @command{gdbserver} prior to using the `target remote'
43197 command, otherwise you may get an error that looks something like
43198 `Connection refused'.
43200 @command{gdbserver} can also debug multiple inferiors at once,
43203 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Inferiors and Programs}
43204 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n 'Inferiors and Programs'}.
43207 @ref{Inferiors and Programs}.
43209 In such case use the @code{extended-remote} @value{GDBN} command variant:
43212 (gdb) target extended-remote the-target:2345
43215 The @command{gdbserver} option @option{--multi} may or may not be used in such
43219 @c man begin OPTIONS gdbserver
43220 There are three different modes for invoking @command{gdbserver}:
43225 Debug a specific program specified by its program name:
43228 gdbserver @var{comm} @var{prog} [@var{args}@dots{}]
43231 The @var{comm} parameter specifies how should the server communicate
43232 with @value{GDBN}; it is either a device name (to use a serial line),
43233 a TCP port number (@code{:1234}), or @code{-} or @code{stdio} to use
43234 stdin/stdout of @code{gdbserver}. Specify the name of the program to
43235 debug in @var{prog}. Any remaining arguments will be passed to the
43236 program verbatim. When the program exits, @value{GDBN} will close the
43237 connection, and @code{gdbserver} will exit.
43240 Debug a specific program by specifying the process ID of a running
43244 gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
43247 The @var{comm} parameter is as described above. Supply the process ID
43248 of a running program in @var{pid}; @value{GDBN} will do everything
43249 else. Like with the previous mode, when the process @var{pid} exits,
43250 @value{GDBN} will close the connection, and @code{gdbserver} will exit.
43253 Multi-process mode -- debug more than one program/process:
43256 gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
43259 In this mode, @value{GDBN} can instruct @command{gdbserver} which
43260 command(s) to run. Unlike the other 2 modes, @value{GDBN} will not
43261 close the connection when a process being debugged exits, so you can
43262 debug several processes in the same session.
43265 In each of the modes you may specify these options:
43270 List all options, with brief explanations.
43273 This option causes @command{gdbserver} to print its version number and exit.
43276 @command{gdbserver} will attach to a running program. The syntax is:
43279 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
43282 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't
43283 necessary to point @command{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
43286 To start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
43287 or process ID to attach, use this command line option.
43288 Then you can connect using @kbd{target extended-remote} and start
43289 the program you want to debug. The syntax is:
43292 target> gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
43296 Instruct @code{gdbserver} to display extra status information about the debugging
43298 This option is intended for @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to
43301 @item --remote-debug
43302 Instruct @code{gdbserver} to display remote protocol debug output.
43303 This option is intended for @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to
43307 Specify a wrapper to launch programs
43308 for debugging. The option should be followed by the name of the
43309 wrapper, then any command-line arguments to pass to the wrapper, then
43310 @kbd{--} indicating the end of the wrapper arguments.
43313 By default, @command{gdbserver} keeps the listening TCP port open, so that
43314 additional connections are possible. However, if you start @code{gdbserver}
43315 with the @option{--once} option, it will stop listening for any further
43316 connection attempts after connecting to the first @value{GDBN} session.
43318 @c --disable-packet is not documented for users.
43320 @c --disable-randomization and --no-disable-randomization are superseded by
43321 @c QDisableRandomization.
43326 @c man begin SEEALSO gdbserver
43328 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
43329 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
43330 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
43336 should give you access to the complete manual.
43338 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
43339 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
43346 @c man title gcore Generate a core file of a running program
43349 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gcore
43350 gcore [-o @var{filename}] @var{pid}
43354 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gcore
43355 Generate a core dump of a running program with process ID @var{pid}.
43356 Produced file is equivalent to a kernel produced core file as if the process
43357 crashed (and if @kbd{ulimit -c} were used to set up an appropriate core dump
43358 limit). Unlike after a crash, after @command{gcore} the program remains
43359 running without any change.
43362 @c man begin OPTIONS gcore
43364 @item -o @var{filename}
43365 The optional argument
43366 @var{filename} specifies the file name where to put the core dump.
43367 If not specified, the file name defaults to @file{core.@var{pid}},
43368 where @var{pid} is the running program process ID.
43372 @c man begin SEEALSO gcore
43374 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
43375 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
43376 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
43383 should give you access to the complete manual.
43385 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
43386 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
43393 @c man title gdbinit GDB initialization scripts
43396 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gdbinit
43397 @ifset SYSTEM_GDBINIT
43398 @value{SYSTEM_GDBINIT}
43407 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gdbinit
43408 These files contain @value{GDBN} commands to automatically execute during
43409 @value{GDBN} startup. The lines of contents are canned sequences of commands,
43412 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Sequences}
43413 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n Sequences}.
43419 Please read more in
43421 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Startup}
43422 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n Startup}.
43429 @ifset SYSTEM_GDBINIT
43430 @item @value{SYSTEM_GDBINIT}
43432 @ifclear SYSTEM_GDBINIT
43433 @item (not enabled with @code{--with-system-gdbinit} during compilation)
43435 System-wide initialization file. It is executed unless user specified
43436 @value{GDBN} option @code{-nx} or @code{-n}.
43439 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{System-wide configuration}
43440 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n 'System-wide configuration'}.
43443 @ref{System-wide configuration}.
43447 User initialization file. It is executed unless user specified
43448 @value{GDBN} options @code{-nx}, @code{-n} or @code{-nh}.
43451 Initialization file for current directory. It may need to be enabled with
43452 @value{GDBN} security command @code{set auto-load local-gdbinit}.
43455 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Init File in the Current Directory}
43456 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n 'Init File in the Current Directory'}.
43459 @ref{Init File in the Current Directory}.
43464 @c man begin SEEALSO gdbinit
43466 gdb(1), @code{info -f gdb -n Startup}
43468 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
43469 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
43470 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
43476 should give you access to the complete manual.
43478 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
43479 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
43485 @node GNU Free Documentation License
43486 @appendix GNU Free Documentation License
43489 @node Concept Index
43490 @unnumbered Concept Index
43494 @node Command and Variable Index
43495 @unnumbered Command, Variable, and Function Index
43500 % I think something like @@colophon should be in texinfo. In the
43502 \long\def\colophon{\hbox to0pt{}\vfill
43503 \centerline{The body of this manual is set in}
43504 \centerline{\fontname\tenrm,}
43505 \centerline{with headings in {\bf\fontname\tenbf}}
43506 \centerline{and examples in {\tt\fontname\tentt}.}
43507 \centerline{{\it\fontname\tenit\/},}
43508 \centerline{{\bf\fontname\tenbf}, and}
43509 \centerline{{\sl\fontname\tensl\/}}
43510 \centerline{are used for emphasis.}\vfill}
43512 % Blame: doc@@cygnus.com, 1991.